Reliant Medical Alarms FORM 10 K User Guide

UNITED STATES  
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION  
Washington, D.C. 20549  
FORM 10-K  
Annual report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of  
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934  
For the fiscal year ended  
December 31, 2003  
Transition report pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of  
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934  
For the transition period from  
to  
Commission file number  
001-07260  
Nortel Networks Corporation  
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)  
Canada  
Not Applicable  
(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)  
(State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)  
8200 Dixie Road, Suite 100, Brampton, Ontario, Canada  
(Address of principal executive offices)  
L6T 5P6  
(Zip Code)  
Registrant’s telephone number including area code:  
(905) 863-0000  
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:  
Name of each exchange on which registered  
Title of each class  
Common Shares without nominal or par value  
4.25% Convertible Senior Notes Due 2008  
New York Stock Exchange  
New York Stock Exchange  
The common shares are also listed on the Toronto Stock Exchange in Canada  
None  
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act  
of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been  
subject to filing requirements for the past 90 days.  
Yes  
No  
Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be  
contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form  
10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.  
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is an accelerated filer (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Act).  
Yes  
No  
On December 31, 2004, 4,268,236,086 common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation were issued and outstanding. Non-affiliates of  
the registrant held 4,261,699,641 common shares having an aggregate market value of $14,788,097,754 based upon the last sale price  
on the New York Stock Exchange on December 31, 2004, of $3.47 per share; for purposes of this calculation, shares held by directors  
and executive officers have been excluded.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
PART I  
Business  
Overview  
1
1
ITEM 1.  
Developments in 2003 and 2004  
Networking solutions  
Wireless Networks  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
Sales and distribution  
Backlog  
Product standards, certification and regulation  
Sources and availability of materials  
Seasonality  
Strategic alliances, acquisitions and minority investments  
Research and development  
Intellectual property  
Employee relations  
Environmental matters  
Financial information by operating segment and product category  
Financial information by geographic area  
Working capital  
Risk factors  
Properties  
2
5
6
9
11  
14  
17  
17  
18  
18  
19  
19  
20  
20  
21  
22  
22  
22  
23  
23  
24  
25  
29  
ITEM 2.  
ITEM 3.  
ITEM 4.  
Legal Proceedings  
Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders  
PART II  
Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity and Related Stockholder Matters  
Securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans  
Dividends  
Canadian tax matters  
Sales of unregistered securities  
Selected Financial Data (Unaudited)  
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations  
Business overview  
29  
29  
30  
30  
30  
31  
35  
37  
41  
54  
72  
73  
80  
82  
89  
91  
92  
92  
93  
93  
111  
112  
113  
ITEM 5.  
ITEM 6.  
ITEM 7.  
Developments in 2003 and 2004  
Results of operations — continuing operations  
Results of operations — discontinued operations  
Liquidity and capital resources  
Off-balance sheet arrangements, contractual obligations and contingent liabilities and commitments  
Application of critical accounting estimates  
Accounting change and recent accounting pronouncements  
Market risk  
Equity price risk  
Environmental matters  
Legal proceedings  
Risk factors/forward looking statements  
Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure about Market Risk  
Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data  
Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure  
ITEM 7A.  
ITEM 8.  
ITEM 9.  
i
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Controls and Procedures  
113  
ITEM 9A.  
PART III  
Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant  
138  
142  
144  
145  
145  
151  
151  
154  
155  
158  
160  
161  
161  
164  
165  
165  
166  
ITEM 10.  
ITEM 11.  
Executive officers and certain other non-executive board appointed officers of the Registrant  
Section 16(a) beneficial ownership reporting compliance  
Executive Compensation  
Summary compensation table  
Option grants in 2003  
Aggregate option exercises in 2004 and 2003 and year-end option values  
Long-term incentive plans — awards in last fiscal year  
Retirement plans  
Certain employment arrangements  
Compensation of directors  
Compensation committee interlocks and insider participation  
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management  
Equity compensation plan information  
Certain Relationships and Related Transactions  
Indebtedness of management  
ITEM 12.  
ITEM 13.  
ITEM 14.  
Principal Accountant Fees and Services  
PART IV  
Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules and Reports on Form 8-K  
168  
223  
ITEM 15.  
SIGNATURES  
All dollar amounts in this document are in United States dollars unless otherwise stated.  
NORTEL NETWORKS, NORTEL NETWORKS LOGO, NT, the GLOBEMARK, BUSINESS WITHOUT BOUNDARIES, DMS, OPTERA  
and UNIVERSAL EDGE are trademarks of Nortel Networks.  
ACCESSNODE is a trademark of Zhone Technologies Inc.  
CDMA2000 is a trademark of the Telecommunications Industry Association.  
CDMAONE — design mark is a trademark of the CDMA Development Group, Inc.  
JUNGLEMUX is a trademark of GE Industrial Systems Technology Management Inc.  
MOODY’S is a trademark of Moody’s Investors Service, Inc.  
RCMP is a trademark of the Royal Canadian Mounted Police.  
S&P and STANDARD & POOR’S are trademarks of The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc.  
ii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PART I  
ITEM 1. Business  
Overview  
Nortel Networks Corporation is a recognized leader in delivering communications capabilities that enhance the human experience, ignite and  
power global commerce, and secure and protect the world’s most critical information. We offer converged multimedia networks that use  
innovative packet, wireless, voice and optical technologies and are underpinned by high standards of security and reliability. For both service  
providers and enterprises, these networks help to drive increased profitability and productivity by reducing costs and enabling new business  
and consumer services opportunities. We refer to the communications technology, infrastructure and related professional services that we  
supply as “networking solutions”. Our business consists of the design, development, manufacture, assembly, marketing, sale, licensing,  
installation, servicing and support of these networking solutions. A substantial portion of our business has a technology focus and is dedicated  
to research and development. This focus forms a core strength and is a factor that we believe differentiates us from many of our competitors.  
We envision a network society where people will be able to connect and interact with information and with each other instantly, simply and  
reliably, accessing data, voice and multimedia communications services and sharing experiences anywhere, anytime.  
Our networking solutions enable our service provider and enterprise customers to provide their own customers or employees with services to  
communicate locally, regionally or globally through the use of data, voice and multimedia communications. Our service provider customers  
include local and long-distance communications companies, wireless service providers and cable operators. Our networking solutions enable  
our service provider customers to deploy reliable, robust networks that create opportunities to provide revenue-generating services and cost  
savings. Our enterprise customers include large and small businesses, governments and institutions. Our networking solutions enable our  
enterprise customers to deploy secure networks with seamless connectivity that provide opportunities for cost efficiency and increased  
productivity.  
During 2003 and up to September 30, 2004, we conducted our business through the following four reportable segments: Wireless Networks;  
Enterprise Networks; Wireline Networks; and Optical Networks. We refer you to the descriptions of each of these segments below. Effective  
October 1, 2004, we established a new organizational structure that included, among other things, combining the businesses of our four  
segments into two business organizations: (i) Carrier Networks and Global Operations; and (ii) Enterprise Networks. We are reviewing the  
impact of these changes to our reportable segments under applicable accounting standards. The new structure reflects the evolution of the  
network transformation to converged networks. For financial information by reporting segment and product category, see “Segment  
information” in note 6 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements and “Results of operations — continuing operations — Segment  
revenues” in Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, or MD&A.  
The Company’s principal executive offices are located at 8200 Dixie Road, Suite 100, Brampton, Ontario, Canada, L6T 5P6, telephone number  
(905) 863-0000. The Company was incorporated in Canada on March 7, 2000 under the name New Nortel Inc. On May 1, 2000, the Company  
participated in a Canadian court-approved plan of arrangement under which, among other things, the Company exchanged its common shares  
for all of the outstanding common shares of Nortel Networks Limited (previously known as Nortel Networks Corporation); Nortel Networks  
Limited, or NNL, became the principal operating subsidiary of the Company; and the Company changed its name to Nortel Networks  
Corporation.  
Where we say “we”, “us”, “our” or “Nortel Networks”, we mean Nortel Networks Corporation or Nortel Networks Corporation and its  
subsidiaries, as applicable. References to “the Company” mean Nortel Networks Corporation without its subsidiaries. Where we refer to the  
“industry”, we mean the telecommunications industry.  
The Company makes its Annual Report on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K and all amendments to  
those reports available free of charge under “Investor Relations” on our website at  
as soon as reasonably practicable after we  
www.nortel.com  
electronically file this material with, or furnish this material to, the United States Securities and Exchange Commission, or SEC. We have  
adopted a Code of Ethics known as “Living the Values: A Guide to Ethical Business Practices at Nortel Networks”. We make our Code of  
Ethics, and all amendments to and waivers of (in accordance with applicable laws) our Code of Ethics, available free of charge under  
“Corporate Information” on our website at  
Dixie Road, Suite 100,  
or by writing to our corporate secretary at Nortel Networks Corporation, 8200  
www.nortel.com  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brampton, Ontario L6T 5P6. Information contained on our website is not incorporated by reference into our annual report on Form 10-K.  
Developments in 2003 and 2004  
Business environment  
In 2003, customer spending remained cautious as a result of tightened capital markets, mainly in the first half of 2003, and customers  
realigning capital spending with their current levels of revenues and profits in order to maximize their return on invested capital. We  
experienced continued industry adjustment and capital spending restrictions by our service provider customers. In 2003, many of our customers  
continued to focus on conserving capital, decreasing their debt levels, reducing costs and/or increasing the capacity utilization rates and  
efficiency of their existing networks. Also, excess network capacity and competition continued to exist in the industry, which led to continued  
pricing pressures on the sale of certain of our products.  
During the second half of 2003 and into 2004, we began to experience a period of relative industry stability following an unprecedented period  
of business realignment that commenced in 2001 in response to a significant industry adjustment. Throughout the second half of 2003 and into  
2004, we announced several new contracts across all of our reportable segments, but primarily in our Wireless Networks segment, as certain  
service provider customers began to expand and upgrade their existing networks.  
The period of relative industry stability that had characterized the second half of 2003 continued into 2004. The moderate growth in 2004 has  
primarily been a result of customers increasing their investments in:  
voice over packet technologies;  
third generation wireless technologies; and  
expansion and enhancement of existing networks due to subscriber growth and competitive pressures.  
In 2004, spending in these areas of our business has been partially offset by customers limiting their investments in mature technologies as they  
focus on maximizing return on investment capital. In addition, we have continued to experience pricing pressures on sales of certain of our  
products as a result of increased competition, particularly from low cost competitors. Further, while customer support generally remains strong,  
the ongoing restatement activities and the internal restructuring and realignment programs initiated in August 2004 have adversely impacted  
business performance in 2004.  
Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters  
In May 2003, we commenced certain balance sheet reviews at the direction of certain members of former management that led to a  
comprehensive review and analysis of our assets and liabilities, or the Comprehensive Review, which resulted in the restatement (effected in  
December 2003) of our consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2002, 2001 and 2000 and for the quarters ended  
March 31, 2003 and June 30, 2003, or the First Restatement.  
In late October 2003, the Audit Committees of the Boards of Directors of Nortel Networks and NNL, or the Audit Committee, initiated an  
independent review of the facts and circumstances leading to the First Restatement, or the Independent Review, and engaged the law firm now  
known as Wilmer Cutler Pickering Hale & Dorr LLP, or WCPHD, to advise it in connection with the Independent Review. The Audit  
Committee sought to gain a full understanding of the events that caused significant excess liabilities to be maintained on the balance sheet that  
needed to be restated, and to recommend that our Board of Directors adopt, and direct management to implement, necessary remedial measures  
to address personnel, controls, compliance and discipline. In January 2005, the Audit Committee reported the findings of the Independent  
Review, together with its recommendations for governing principles for remedial measures that were developed for the Audit Committee by  
WCPHD. Each of our and NNL’s Boards of Directors has adopted these recommendations in their entirety and directed our management to  
develop a detailed plan and timetable for their implementation, and will monitor their implementation.  
As the Independent Review progressed, the Audit Committee directed new corporate management to examine in depth the concerns identified  
by WCPHD regarding provisioning activity and to review certain provision releases. That examination, and other errors identified by  
management, led to the restatement (effected today) of our financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001 and the  
quarters ended March 31, 2003 and 2002, June 30, 2003 and 2002 and September 30, 2003 and 2002, or the Second Restatement, and our  
revision of previously announced unaudited results for the year ended December 31, 2003.  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The need for the Second Restatement resulted in delays in filing our and NNL’s 2003 Annual Reports on Form 10-K, or the 2003 Annual  
Reports, and Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q for the first, second and third quarters of 2004, or the 2004 Quarterly Reports, beyond the SEC’s  
required filing dates in 2004. We refer to the 2003 Annual Reports and the 2004 Quarterly Reports together as the Reports.  
Over the course of the Second Restatement process, management identified certain accounting practices that it determined should be adjusted  
for as part of the Second Restatement. In particular, management identified certain errors related to revenue recognition and undertook a  
process of focused revenue reviews. As described in more detail in the “Controls and Procedures” section of this report, in light of the resulting  
adjustments to revenues previously reported in relevant periods, the Audit Committee has determined to review the facts and circumstances  
leading to the restatement of these revenues for specific transactions identified in the Second Restatement. This review will have a particular  
emphasis on the underlying conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues. The Audit Committee will seek a full understanding of  
the historic events that required the revenues for these specific transactions to be restated and will consider any appropriate additional remedial  
measures, including those involving internal controls and processes. The Audit Committee has engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection  
with this review. See “Risk factors/forward looking statements.”  
The key developments in 2004 with respect to the foregoing matters are the following:  
In connection with the Independent Review, we terminated for cause (i) our former president and chief executive officer, former chief  
financial officer and former controller in April 2004 and (ii) seven additional senior finance employees with significant responsibilities  
for our financial reporting as a whole or for their respective business units and geographic regions in August 2004.  
We are under investigation by the SEC and the Ontario Securities Commission, or OSC, Enforcement Staff and have received a U.S.  
federal grand jury subpoena for the production of certain documents sought in connection with an ongoing criminal investigation being  
conducted by the U.S. Attorney’s Office for the Northern District of Texas, Dallas Division. Further, the Integrated Market Enforcement  
Team of the Royal Canadian Mounted Police, or RCMP, has advised us that it would be commencing a criminal investigation into Nortel  
Networks financial accounting situation. In addition, numerous class action complaints have been filed against Nortel Networks,  
including class action complaints under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act, or ERISA. In addition, a derivative action  
complaint has been filed against Nortel Networks. See “Contingencies” in note 22 in the accompanying consolidated financial  
statements.  
As a result of the delay in filing the Reports, we and NNL were not in compliance with our obligations to deliver the Reports under our  
and NNL’s public debt indentures and were required to seek waivers from Export Development Corporation, or EDC, under the EDC  
Support Facility. If we and NNL fail to file all of the Reports by January 15, 2005, EDC will have the right, on such date (absent a further  
waiver in relation to the delayed filings and certain additional breaches under the EDC Support Facility, or the Related Breaches), to  
(i) terminate the EDC Support Facility and (ii) exercise certain rights against collateral or require NNL to cash collateralize all existing  
support. In addition, the Related Breaches will continue beyond the filing of the Reports. These delays have also resulted in our inability  
to use, in its current form, the remaining approximately $800 million of capacity under our shelf registration statement filed with the SEC  
for various types of securities. In addition, these delays resulted in our termination of our $750 million April 2000 five year credit  
facilities. See “Liquidity and capital resources” in the MD&A section of this report  
The OSC issued an order prohibiting all trading by directors, officers and certain current and former employees in the securities of Nortel  
Networks Corporation and NNL. The order remains in effect until two full business days following the receipt by the OSC of all filings  
required to be made by us and NNL pursuant to Ontario securities laws.  
We postponed our Annual Shareholders’ Meeting for 2003 due to the delay in filing our 2003 financial statements.  
As a result of the delayed filing of certain of our Reports, we are in breach of the continued listing requirements of the Toronto Stock  
Exchange, or TSX, and the New York Stock Exchange, or NYSE. Although each of the TSX and NYSE has verbally confirmed that it  
has not commenced, nor has any intention of commencing, any suspension or delisting procedures in respect of the Company’s and  
NNL’s listed securities, the commencement of any suspension or delisting procedures by either exchange remains, at all times, at the  
discretion of such exchange and would be publicly announced by the exchange. The NYSE granted us and NNL an extension of up to  
March 31, 2005 to file our 2003 Annual Reports, during which time the Nortel Networks Corporation common shares and our and NNL’s  
other securities will remain listed on the NYSE. The extension is subject to review by the NYSE on an ongoing basis.  
We suspended as of March 10, 2004: the purchase of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares under the stock purchase plans for  
eligible employees in eligible countries that facilitate the acquisition of Nortel Networks  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Corporation common shares; the exercise of outstanding options granted under Nortel Networks Corporation 2000 Stock Option Plan, or  
the 2000 Plan, and the Nortel Networks Corporation 1986 Stock Option Plan as amended and restated, or the 1986 Plan, or the grant of  
any additional options under those plans, or the exercise of outstanding options granted under employee stock option plans previously  
assumed by us in connection with mergers and acquisitions; and the purchase of units in a Nortel Networks stock fund or purchase of  
Nortel Networks Corporation common shares under our defined contribution and investment plans, until such time as, at the earliest, we  
are in compliance with U.S. and Canadian regulatory securities filing requirements.  
On April 28, 2004, Standard and Poor’s, or S&P, downgraded its ratings on NNL, including its long-term corporate credit ratings from  
“B” to “B-” and its preferred shares ratings from “CCC” to “CCC-”. At the same time, it revised its outlook to developing from negative.  
On April 28, 2004, Moody’s Investor’s Service, Inc. changed its outlook to potential downgrade from uncertain. See “Liquidity and  
capital resources — Credit ratings” in the MD&A section of this report.  
Strategic plan  
On August 19, 2004, we first announced a new strategic plan, which contains the following principal components:  
a renewed commitment to best corporate practices and ethical conduct, including the establishment of the office of a chief ethics  
and compliance officer which has been filled on an interim basis pending the permanent appointment of Susan E. Shepard, as now  
announced;  
a streamlined organizational structure to reflect alignment with carrier converged networks;  
an increased focus on the enterprise market and customers;  
optimized research and development programs for highly secure, available and reliable converged networks;  
the establishment of a chief strategy officer to drive partnerships, new markets and acquisitions;  
the establishment of a chief marketing officer to drive overall marketing strategy;  
the strategic review of embedded services to assess opportunities in the professional services business; and  
a distinct focus on government and defense customers.  
Our strategic plan also includes a work plan involving focused workforce reductions of approximately 3,250 employees, a voluntary retirement  
program, real estate optimization and other cost containment actions such as reductions in information services costs, outsourced services and  
other discretionary spending. Approximately 64% of employee actions related to the focused workforce reduction were completed by the end  
of 2004, including approximately 55% that were notified of termination or acceptance of voluntary retirement, with the remainder comprising  
voluntary attrition of employees that were not replaced. The remainder of employee actions are expected to be completed by June 30, 2005. In  
addition, however, the Company continues to hire in certain strategic areas such as investments in the finance organization. Our intention is  
that our strategic plan will enable us to build on our market leadership in developing the converged networks of the future and improve  
business efficiency and operating cost performance in an increasingly competitive market. It is our intention to be optimally positioned to  
maximize strategic opportunities as they arise and leverage our acknowledged strengths in high reliability networks and strong customer  
loyalty. We continue to drive the business forward with a focus on costs, cash and revenues as strategic goals. We remain committed to our  
business strategy of technology and solutions evolution in helping our customers transform their networks and implement new applications and  
services to drive improved productivity.  
Other business developments  
We engaged in a number of activities in 2003 and 2004, in part to respond to the industry environment and in part to address various business  
matters that arose during those periods. Some of our activities and other business developments included:  
2003  
realigning our business activities in France and Germany;  
reducing undrawn customer financing commitments;  
entering into an agreement with EDC regarding arrangements to provide support for certain of our performance-related obligations;  
and  
substantially completing the wind-down of our discontinued access solutions operations.  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2004  
the announcement of our planned divestiture of substantially all of our remaining manufacturing operations to Flextronics  
International Ltd., or Flextronics;  
the contribution of certain assets and liabilities of our directory and operator services business in return for a 24% interest in  
VoltDelta, Resources LLC;  
the entering into an agreement with Foundry Networks, Inc., or Foundry, to settle outstanding patent infringement claims and  
counterclaims by us and Foundry; and  
a strategic arrangement with Bharat Sanchar Nigram Limited to establish a wireless network in India.  
For information on these and other developments in 2003, see “Special charges” in note 7, “Acquisitions, divestitures and closures” in note 10,  
“Long-term debt, credit and support facilities” in note 11 and “Subsequent events” in note 23 of the accompanying consolidated financial  
statements and “Developments in 2003 and 2004” in the MD&A section of this report.  
Networking solutions  
Networking  
In our industry, networking refers to:  
the connecting of two or more communications devices, such as telephones and personal computers, across short or long distances  
to create a “network”;  
the connecting of two or more networks; or  
the connecting of equipment used in a network.  
Network components  
A telecommunications network generally consists of equipment and software that enable network access, core networking and network  
services. Network access equipment and software enables information to enter or exit a network, and resides with or near an end-user of the  
network. Network access can be obtained through the use of either wireline cable (such as fiber optic, copper wire or coaxial) or wireless radio  
signals.  
Core networking equipment and software direct, route or “switch” the data, voice and multimedia communications signals from one part of the  
network to another. Core network equipment and software also transport communications signals to and from network access equipment and  
other core networking equipment located in another location. These functions are carried out primarily through the use of routers, circuit and  
packet switches, and fiber optic technologies.  
Network services consist of various user capabilities that are enabled through the use of software elements in a network. User capabilities may  
be configured to extend throughout the network and include features such as location-based services, security services, calling features and  
multimedia services. Network services can be personalized to suit the user’s needs and to support various applications.  
Networking solutions  
Our networking solutions include network equipment, software and other technologies that enable communications between two or more  
points defining a network through the use of data, voice and multimedia networking. Our networking solutions may consist of a combination of  
products and services provided by our four reportable segments consisting of Wireless Networks, Enterprise Networks, Wireline Networks and  
Optical Networks. For a discussion of our recent establishment of a new organizational structure that includes, among other things, combining  
the businesses of our four segments into two business organizations, see “Business — Overview”.  
Networking solutions can be circuit-based or packet-based. Our circuit-based networking solutions consist of technologies that require a  
separate network circuit to be maintained for each communications signal for the duration of the transmission. Our packet-based networking  
solutions consist of technologies which involve the conversion of a data, voice or multimedia communications signal into pieces, or “packets”,  
that are directed or routed through the network independently and then re-  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
assembled at the destination. This enables large numbers of communications signals to be directed or routed simultaneously and more  
efficiently than in circuit networking. Our data networking solutions consist of products and services designed to enable the transportation of  
data information across a network. Our security solutions consist of products and services designed to ensure that information can be securely  
transported across a network and to prevent unauthorized users from being able to disrupt the network.  
Wireless Networks includes network access and core networking solutions for voice and data communications that span second and third  
generation wireless technologies and most major global standards for mobile networks. Enterprise Networks includes circuit and packet voice  
solutions, and data networking and security solutions used by our enterprise customers. Wireline Networks includes circuit and packet voice  
solutions, and data networking and security solutions used by our service provider customers. Optical Networks includes metropolitan, regional  
and long-haul optical transport and switching solutions and managed broadband services. Within each of our reportable segments, our  
networking solutions also consist of related professional services which may include: strategic planning, network design and engineering;  
network optimization; network operations planning and consulting; and installation and ongoing technical support.  
For more information about our networking solutions, please refer to our segment descriptions below.  
Wireless Networks  
Products  
Wireless networking, also known as mobility networking, refers to communications networks that enable end-users to be mobile while they  
send and receive voice and data communications using wireless devices, such as cellular telephones, personal digital assistants and other  
computing and communications devices. These networks use specialized network access equipment and specialized core networking  
equipment that enable an end-user to be connected and identified when not in a fixed location. The technology for wireless communications  
networks has evolved and continues to evolve, through various technology “generations”.  
Our existing wireless solutions span second and third generation wireless technologies and most major global digital standards for mobile  
networks. The majority of wireless communications networks existing today are still based on second generation, or 2G, wireless technologies,  
which consist of circuit switching technology with modest data transmission capabilities. However, third generation, or 3G, networks have  
been launched in several regions. 3G wireless technologies consist of packet networking technology with high-speed data, voice and  
multimedia transmission capabilities.  
We support all of the following primary international standards for wireless communications networks:  
Time Division Multiple Access, or TDMA, is a 2G wireless standard supported mainly in the United States, Canada and the  
Caribbean and Latin America region, or CALA.  
Code Division Multiple Access, or CDMA, is a 2G wireless standard, also known as IS-95 or cdmaOne, and is supported globally.  
CDMA networks are evolving to 3G according to the CDMA 3G 1xRTT (single channel (1x) Radio Transmission Technology)  
standard, also known as CDMA2000, for voice and high-speed data mobility. CDMA 3G 1xEV-DO, or Evolution Data Optimized,  
and CDMA 3G 1xEV-DV, or Evolution Data and Voice, are extensions of CDMA 3G standards for high speed wireless networks  
for data, voice and multimedia communications.  
Global System for Mobile communications, or GSM, is a 2G wireless standard supported globally. GSM networks are evolving to  
carry data, as well as voice, with the introduction of General Packet Radio Standard, or GPRS. GPRS is viewed as a “2.5G”  
technology that provides faster and therefore increased data transmission capabilities. Enhanced Data Rates for Global Evolution,  
or EDGE, is a further evolution of GSM systems to support higher data speeds. In addition to higher data speeds, EDGE provides  
increased voice capacity for existing GSM operators. An additional variant of this standard, called GSM-R, focuses on the delivery  
of communications and control services for railway systems.  
Universal Mobile Telecommunications System, or UMTS, is now a commercial standard for 3G networks based on Wideband  
CDMA, or WCDMA, technology. UMTS combines WCDMA-based radio access with packet switching technology to yield high  
capacity, high speed wireless networks for data, voice and multimedia communications.  
We also offer a range of related professional services to our customers.  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Network access  
Radio network access equipment uses radio waves to provide wireless access to the subscriber’s device, enabling the wireless subscriber to  
connect to the network to send and receive data, voice and multimedia communications. The key network elements in radio access are base  
station transceivers or access points and base station/radio network controllers. We offer our customers a wide range of base station  
transceivers and base station controllers for all of the standards that we support.  
Core networking  
Core networking equipment directs, routes or “switches” communications signals within a service provider’s wireless communications  
network. The key network elements in the core part of a wireless communications network are mobile switching centers, home location  
registers and packet data serving nodes.  
Mobile switching centers direct or “switch” data, voice and multimedia communications signals from one network circuit to  
another and also support advanced voice services like 3-way calling, calling party number/name delivery, call holding and call  
redirection.  
A home location register is a database that contains subscriber data, such as provisioning and service information, and dynamic  
information, such as the wireless handset’s current location.  
Packet data serving nodes are hardware and software network equipment elements that aggregate and manage data communications  
between wireless subscriber devices and public/private data networks, such as the Internet. Packet data serving nodes deliver  
valuable network services including content-based billing, security, virtual private networks and quality of service.  
Our mobile switching centers, home location registers and packet data serving nodes support all of the primary international standards for  
wireless communications networks.  
Product development  
Our wireless networking products in development include the next evolution of our CDMA 3G, GSM/GPRS/EDGE, wireless local area  
network, or WLAN, and UMTS products.  
Our CDMA 3G 1xRTT products are generally available and have been deployed in several commercial networks in all our  
geographic regions. Our CDMA 3G 1xEV-DO product is currently being deployed by several large operators in the United States  
and Brazil and is generally available for commercial deployment. We are currently working with the various standards bodies to  
finalize the specifications for CDMA 3G 1xEV-DV.  
There are several GSM/GPRS/EDGE products that are being developed to allow GSM operators to offer higher data rates on  
existing GSM spectrum allocations. We have successfully completed customer trials of Adaptive MultiRate, or AMR, base station  
transceivers. AMR allows service providers to use the radio spectrum allocated to them more efficiently to support more customers  
on the same network.  
The enhanced version of our GSM base station controller, the GSM BSC 3000 (formerly, the BSCe3), became generally available  
for commercial deployment in 2003. Our EDGE base station transceivers, including both hardware and software, are currently in  
customer trials and are being deployed by several customers in the United States.  
Our UMTS radio network access and core networking products are generally available and have been launched by several operators  
in the Europe, Middle East and Africa region, or EMEA, and in the United States. Our UMTS networking products have been  
deployed in the initial launch of the first commercial UMTS network to be deployed in the United States. We are continuing to  
develop our UMTS solutions for use in the Asia Pacific (including Greater China) region.  
We are working at establishing strategic relationships with other companies for research, development and manufacture of  
equipment that conforms to the Chinese 3G TD-SCDMA standard.  
We continue to work on developing access technologies such as UMTS-HSDPA, or High Speed Downlink Packet Access, 1x-EV,  
or single channel Evolution, OFDM, or Orthogonal Frequency Division Multiplexing, and MIMO, or Multiple Input Multiple  
Output, antenna technologies to increase the speed and efficiency of broadband wireless access from 3G networks deployed today.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Our Wireless Mesh Network solution, designed to allow our customers to reduce the costs of high-speed wireless data transport  
from wireless access networks to wired broadband networks, is now generally available and has been deployed in the United States  
and Asia Pacific.  
Our enterprise grade WLAN access products are generally available for commercial deployment by our wireless service provider  
customers.  
Markets  
We anticipate that demand for wireless networking equipment will be driven by continued subscriber and traffic growth, and the effectiveness  
of 2.5G and 3G wireless networking systems. There are two key aspects to the migration from 2G wireless communications technologies to  
2.5G and 3G wireless communications technologies. The first is that all current 3G technologies, including CDMA 3G and UMTS, are based  
on spread spectrum technology. The second is that the migration from 2G to 2.5G and 3G technologies is largely based on a transition from  
circuit switching technologies in 2G core networks to packet-based networking technologies in 3G core networks. We believe that our  
extensive experience in deploying CDMA wireless communications networks, combined with our expertise in packet-based networking for  
wireline networks, will be a competitive strength during the migration from 2G wireless communications networks to 2.5G and 3G wireless  
communications networks.  
Commercial CDMA 3G networks have been launched in the United States, Canada, CALA and the Asia Pacific region. CDMA networks  
operating in the 450 MHz radio spectrum are also expanding into Central and Eastern Europe. GPRS and UMTS networks have already been  
launched in EMEA, the Asia Pacific region and the United States. In addition, EDGE has been launched to support higher speed transmission  
of data in the United States and also by several operators in Western Europe and the Asia Pacific region. GSM-R has already been deployed by  
many countries across the world, including member states of the European Union, China and India. The GSM-R market is one of the fastest  
growing segments of the overall wireless market.  
In the United States, Canada and CALA, usage rates of wireless communications services continue to increase, and we anticipate that capital  
spending decisions by wireless service providers will be driven by capacity requirements, new wireless subscribers, increased use of wireless  
devices for Internet access and technology migration from 2G wireless technologies to 2.5G and 3G wireless technologies. We also anticipate  
that the migration from 2G to 2.5G and 3G wireless will initially be driven by CDMA 3G 1xRTT and 1xEV-DO deployment for CDMA-based  
networks, and by GPRS, EDGE and UMTS deployment for GSM- and TDMA-based networks.  
Within EMEA, wireless subscriber growth remains slower in many Western European countries, largely due to relatively high wireless  
subscriber penetration levels. However, other parts of EMEA continue to grow their subscriber base due to the lower market penetration for  
wireless services. Investment decisions by wireless service providers in Western Europe are being driven by anticipated growth in wireless data  
communications services. As a result, infrastructure spending in Western Europe is currently primarily driven by the migration from GSM to  
GPRS and UMTS technologies, and the associated migration from circuit switching technologies to packet-based networking technologies.  
In the Asia Pacific region, we anticipate that capital spending by wireless service providers will be driven by the migration to 3G technologies  
in Japan and Korea, and by continued growth in wireless subscribers in the People’s Republic of China, or China. Growth in China may be  
further driven by anticipated new national licenses for 3G. However, the timing of the issuance of new national licenses for 3G in China is  
uncertain. The issuance of new national licenses for 3G in China is also expected to impact the entire 3G market. Many countries in South and  
South East Asia have very low wireless subscriber penetration levels, and are expected to experience increased wireless subscriber growth over  
the next five years. India is also anticipated to be a major wireless infrastructure market in the next five years.  
Customers  
Our Wireless Networks customers are wireless service providers, and their customers are the subscribers for wireless communications services.  
The top 20 global wireless service providers collectively account for a majority of all wireless subscribers around the world. We are currently  
focused on increasing our market presence among the top global wireless service providers. None of our Wireless Networks customers  
represented more than 10% of Nortel Networks consolidated revenues in 2003.  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Competition  
Our major competitors in the global wireless infrastructure business have traditionally included Telefonaktiebolaget LM Ericsson, Nokia  
Corporation, Siemens Aktiengesellschaft, Motorola, Inc. and Lucent Technologies Inc. Nokia and Siemens compete in the sale of GSM and  
UMTS equipment, whereas Lucent competes in the sale of CDMA and UMTS equipment. Motorola is a competitor in the sale of GSM, UMTS  
and CDMA equipment. Ericsson competes in the sale of equipment for all of the major wireless communications technologies. More recently,  
Samsung Electronics Co., Ltd. has emerged as a competitor in the sale of CDMA systems, and Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. and ZTE  
Corporation have emerged as competitors for GSM, CDMA and UMTS systems in China and many other developing countries. NEC  
Corporation and Fujitsu Limited have emerged as competitors for UMTS equipment.  
The primary global factors of competition for our Wireless Networks products include:  
technology leadership, product features and availability;  
product quality and reliability;  
conformity to existing and emerging regulatory and industry standards;  
warranty and customer support;  
price and cost of ownership;  
interoperability with other networking products;  
network management capabilities;  
traditional supplier relationships, particularly in EMEA and the Asia Pacific region;  
regulatory certification; and  
provision of customer financing.  
We intend to compete with our traditional and emerging competitors as the global market for wireless networking equipment migrates to 3G  
technologies.  
Enterprise Networks  
Products  
Our Enterprise Networks solutions portfolio provides data, voice and multimedia communications solutions for our enterprise customers. We  
also provide our enterprise customers with related professional services.  
Circuit and packet voice solutions  
Our voice portfolio includes a broad range of circuit and packet voice communications solutions.  
Our communications servers and remote gateway products provide converged data, voice and multimedia communications systems,  
using voice over internet protocol, or IP, or session initiation protocol, or SIP, for service providers and enterprises. SIP is a  
standard protocol for initiating an interactive user session that involves multimedia elements such as video, voice, chat, gaming and  
virtual reality. Our enterprise solutions can be used by customers building new networks and customers who want to transform their  
existing communications network into a more cost effective, packet-based network supporting data, voice and multimedia  
communications.  
Our customer premises-based circuit and packet telephone switching systems are designed for small, medium and large commercial  
enterprises and government agencies. These systems provide or can be configured with multiple applications, including voice  
communications features, such as voice messaging, call waiting and call forwarding, as well as advanced voice services, converged  
multimedia applications and other networking capabilities.  
Our customer contact center, messaging and interactive voice and web service solutions are advanced communications tools  
designed to work with our customer premises-based solutions. These tools enable employees to efficiently and productively  
communicate with business contacts and other employees regardless of where they are located, the applicable time zone or whether  
they choose to interact over the telephone or the Internet.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Data networking and security solutions  
We offer a broad range of data networking (packet switching and routing) and security solutions for our enterprise customers. Our packet  
switching and routing systems include data switching systems, aggregation products, virtual private network gateways and routers, including:  
Our data switches, secure routers and associated security products provide data switching designed to allow our customers to  
provide Internet data security and IP services including IP routing, virtual private networks, deep packet inspection, firewall  
applications, policy management and data traffic flow management. These products also enable our customers to manage and  
prioritize the Internet content that is provided to end-users and balance the amount of communications traffic on multiple Internet  
servers.  
Our Ethernet switch portfolio is a series of high performance packet switches for our enterprise customers’ small to large local area  
networks that use the Ethernet, a standard computer networking protocol for local area networks.  
Our multi-protocol routers offer high-speed, high-capacity and medium-capacity data switching to support a wide range of data  
communications technologies, including multi-protocol label switching, asynchronous transfer mode, IP and frame relay services.  
Our Ethernet routing switches deliver IP routing and switching.  
Our portfolio of WLAN service switching products is designed to provide secure and efficient transmission of WLAN data and  
voice traffic for mobile users. Our WLAN voice products integrate with our communications servers and gateway products to  
provide a wireless voice over IP solution for our customers.  
Our portfolio of optical network switching products is designed to extend the range of storage area networks to enable our  
customers to consolidate their data servers. Our products enable enterprises to deploy these storage area networks in alternate  
locations, providing geographic redundancy as part of their business continuity strategy.  
Product development  
We are currently focused on developing products that support the continuing evolution of voice and data communications systems toward  
converged or combined data, voice and multimedia networks, including:  
The continued development of our multimedia communication server for enterprise, a product that provides the capability to deliver  
converged data, voice and multimedia applications and enhanced networking capabilities.  
Additions to the applications in our communications server products to allow integration of voice over IP, voice extensible markup  
language, new operating systems and servers, and voice recognition speech products.  
New developments in data networking products that will deliver resiliency, enable increased data network traffic and provide  
suitable service levels and network connectivity and power to devices over the same line.  
The development of the next generation web platform, which will feature higher performance, scalability (that is, the ability to  
grow a service or capability with incremental cost) and integrated applications.  
Enhancements to our security portfolio including the new secure sockets layer, or SSL, and switching products and a new high-end  
secure router product. In addition, we have entered into and continue to pursue strategic relationships that enhance our end-to-end  
security solutions.  
Updates to our customer premises-based telephone systems to support our software that enables those systems to function entirely  
as a packet-based system or as a hybrid packet and circuit switching system.  
Markets  
We offer Enterprise Networks products to enterprises around the world. With the growth of data, voice and multimedia communications over  
the public telephone network, the public Internet and private voice and data communications networks, there is an increasing opportunity to  
converge disparate networks towards a single, high performance network that can support various types of communications traffic and  
applications.  
We believe that in order to meet the growing demand for increased capacity at lower per-minute rates, enterprises will transition their circuit-  
based voice communications to more cost effective packet-based technologies. As a result, we anticipate growth in demand for packet-based  
networking equipment that supports the convergence of data, voice and multimedia communications over a single communications network  
and that provides greater network capacity, reliability, speed, quality and performance. However, the rate of growth of this progression is  
unclear.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Globally, enterprise customers continue to invest in equipment for their communications networks, primarily for network security and  
resiliency, for voice over IP, WLANs and for virtual private networks. In the United States and Canada, enterprise customers are investing in  
voice over IP as they transition from legacy voice products to our enterprise line of communication servers and remote gateway products that  
enable conversion from voice communication networks to packet-based networks supporting data, voice and multimedia communications. In  
EMEA, our customers are beginning to invest in new technologies, such as voice over IP. In the Asia Pacific region, Enterprise Networks  
customers are investing in networking equipment to improve the connections among their regional sites and branch offices. In CALA,  
enterprises are continuing to drive demand for networking equipment that supports the growing use of the Internet in the region.  
Customers  
We offer our products and services to a broad range of enterprise customers around the world, including large businesses and their branch  
offices, small businesses and home offices, as well as government agencies, educational and other institutions and utility organizations. Key  
industry sectors for our business customers include the telecommunications, high-technology manufacturing, government (including the  
defense sector) and financial services sectors. We also serve customers in the healthcare, retail, education, hospitality, services, transportation  
and other industry sectors. We are currently focused on increasing our market presence with enterprise customers. In particular, we intend to  
focus on leading enterprise customers with high performance networking needs. Certain of our service provider customers also act as a  
distribution channel for our Enterprise Networks sales and include incumbent local telephone companies, competitive local telephone  
companies and system integrators. None of our Enterprise Networks customers represented more than 10% of Nortel Networks consolidated  
revenues in 2003.  
Competition  
Our principal competitors in the sale of our Enterprise Networks solutions are Cisco Systems, Inc., Avaya Inc., Siemens, Alcatel S.A., and  
NEC Corporation. Avaya is our largest competitor in the sale of voice equipment while Cisco is our largest competitor in the sale of data  
networking equipment to enterprises. We also compete with smaller companies that address specific niches, such as Juniper Networks, Inc.,  
3Com Corporation, Foundry Networks, Inc., Extreme Networks, Inc. and Enterasys Networks, Inc. in data networking; and Mitel Networks  
Corporation in Internet-based voice communications solutions. We expect competition to remain intense as enterprises look for ways to  
maximize the effectiveness of their existing networks while reducing ongoing capital expenditures and operating costs.  
The principal global factors of competition in the sale of our Enterprise Networks solutions include:  
technology leadership, product features and availability;  
product quality and reliability;  
conformity to existing and emerging regulatory and industry standards;  
sales distribution and channel marketing strategy;  
warranty and customer support;  
price and cost of ownership;  
interoperability with other networking products;  
installed base of product;  
alternative solutions offered to enterprises by service providers;  
the leveraging of existing customer-supplier relationships; and  
the availability of distribution channels.  
Wireline Networks  
Products  
Our Wireline Networks portfolio addresses the demand by our service provider customers for cost efficient data, voice and multimedia  
communications solutions. Our wireline solutions, including related professional services, simplify network architectures by bringing data,  
voice, multimedia and emerging broadband applications for revenue generating services together on one packet network.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Circuit and packet voice solutions  
We are a leader in the development and deployment of highly scalable circuit switched and secure voice over packet solutions such as voice  
over IP for wireline and wireless service providers around the world. Our voice over packet solutions offer service providers opportunities for  
new revenue sources and sustainable operating and capital cost reduction, as well as high levels of reliability and network resiliency. Our  
solutions include the following:  
Our wireline voice over packet network solutions for service providers, which include softswitches and media gateways. The  
portfolio provides the complete range of voice over packet solutions, including local, toll, long-distance and international gateway  
capabilities, and enables voice applications to run on the new multi-services packet network. These solutions leverage more  
efficient packet-based, as opposed to circuit-based, technologies that drive reduced capital and operational costs for service  
providers and provide a platform for the delivery of new revenue-generating services, such as Centrex IP and voice over IP virtual  
private networks.  
Our multimedia communications services portfolio allows our customers to deploy new, enhanced multimedia services, including  
video, collaboration and personal agent services. The portfolio includes a session initiation protocol-based application server that  
can enable an interactive user session involving multimedia elements. For example, personal agent services allow users to  
customize their communications by selecting the medium over which they wish to receive a particular message (such as wireline or  
wireless telephony, e-mail and instant messaging) by setting screening criteria such as time of day and day of week, month or year.  
Our DMS portfolio is a family of digital, circuit-based telephone switches that provides local, toll, long-distance and international  
gateway capabilities for service providers. Our DMS systems enable service providers to connect end-users making local and long-  
distance telephone calls. The DMS family of products can evolve to voice over packet solutions.  
Our Nortel Networks Developers Partner Program helps to drive the interoperability of our voice over IP multimedia  
communications and DMS portfolios with third party vendors including infrastructure and application companies.  
These solutions work alone or in combination with each other to provide traditional voice services, advanced packet voice services and  
enhanced multimedia services to service providers around the world.  
Data networking and security solutions  
We offer a wide range of data networking (packet switching and routing) solutions to our service provider customers. Our wide area network,  
or WAN, solutions and IP service routers enable our service provider customers to offer connectivity solutions and high value services to both  
enterprises and residential customers. Connectivity solutions include packet services such as: frame relay; Asynchronous Transfer Mode, or  
ATM; Ethernet; and IP access for digital subscriber line and cable users. High-value services, such as IP virtual private networks, enable an  
enterprise to connect with other enterprise sites and remote users and to securely connect with business partners. These high-value services also  
provide enhanced network capabilities, such as network security, network address translation and class of service, that enable service providers  
to offer a wide range of networking services beyond basic connection to the network. In 2004, we announced a new multiservice provider edge  
networking device that allows service providers to converge multiple networks at the network edge to enable the delivery of voice, data,  
multimedia and wireless services over a single, converged network. When we refer to the network edge, we are referring to the point at which  
access networks meet the core network.  
Product development  
Research and development investments are focused on creating new and improving existing, packet-based residential and business services for  
wireline and wireless service providers. Also, we continue to develop products that support the evolution of data, voice and multimedia  
communications systems toward converged or combined voice and data networks, including:  
Enhancements to our voice over packet solutions that will allow service providers to connect any business telephone system, using  
standard voice over IP protocols, into a common dialing plan with connectivity to the public switched telephone network.  
Additional enhancements to our packet voice solutions will continue to focus on interoperability with other manufacturers’  
equipment, including gateway and integrated access device manufacturers, as well as on meeting the needs of the Asian and  
European markets. We continue to make improvements to our softswitch portfolio by utilizing the latest commercial technology to  
provide our customers with converged wireline and wireless service support, superior application choices, integrated network  
management and linear scalable capacity.  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enhancements to the MCS 5200, part of our multimedia communications portfolio, that will allow a service provider to offer  
intelligent multimedia services across any manufacturer’s circuit switches. Additionally, development will focus on increasing the  
breadth and usability of the MCS 5200 applications.  
Additions to the DMS portfolio that will allow service providers to offer and manage IP voice and multimedia (Centrex IP) services  
to those businesses that use traditional business telephones as well as businesses that use next generation telephones designed for  
use in IP networks.  
Enhancements to our IP services router that enable an increase in the number of residential subscribers and virtual private network  
sites that can be supported, and the amount of bandwidth that can be applied to an enterprise site. Development will also focus on  
enhancing the ability of our service provider customers to provide additional revenue-generating services.  
A focus on cable standards compliance to enhance our solutions for the cable operator markets in the United States, Canada and  
EMEA, including support for the open cable standard protocol for cable media gateways.  
Enhancements to our WAN switch portfolio to improve interoperability with other vendors’ products. In addition, development will  
focus on enhancing the migration to converged networks which simultaneously support data, voice and multimedia.  
Continued development of a multiservice provider edge networking device designed to converge multiple communications services  
operating at the IP or multi-protocol label switching network edge. This device is currently undergoing customer trials and is not  
yet generally available. As well, we continue to develop enhancements to our existing line of WAN switch and IP service router  
products that are intended to efficiently aggregate different types of data traffic at the network edge.  
Continued integration of a service provider core network router into our voice over packet portfolio to enable us to provide a  
complete end-to-end solution.  
Markets  
With the growth of data, voice and multimedia communications over the public telephone network, the public Internet and private voice and  
data communications networks, there is an increasing opportunity to converge disparate networks towards a single, high performance packet  
network that can support most types of communications traffic and applications. Converged voice and data networks also provide an  
opportunity for service providers to offer new revenue-generating services while reducing their ongoing operational costs year over year as  
they incorporate packet-based technology in their networks. We believe our advantage lies in our ability to transition and upgrade our  
customers’ installed base of voice and data network solutions to a multimedia IP network.  
To meet the growing demand for new revenue generating services and network efficiency, we anticipate growth in demand for packet-based  
networking equipment that supports the convergence of data, voice and multimedia communications over a single communications network  
and that provides greater network capacity, reliability, speed, quality and performance. We anticipate a continued increase in deployments of  
service provider voice over IP networks worldwide. While we anticipate growth in voice over IP networks, we also anticipate a decline in  
legacy voice networks.  
Cable operators and new Internet telephone service providers are entering the voice and data markets and are increasing the competitive  
pressure on established service providers. For example, cable operators provide high speed data services as well as voice services by using  
voice over IP technology. Similarly, established service providers are using existing broadband networks and expanding those broadband  
networks to offer bundled services such as telephone, high speed Internet and television services across those broadband networks.  
The market for our Wireline Networks products is global. Service providers are expected over the long term to continue to modernize with  
packet-based networks and converge voice and data communications networks in order to deploy new revenue-generating service offerings.  
We anticipate an increased emphasis by service providers towards end-user networks in addition to their efforts to modernize the inter-  
connection of those networks. In EMEA, we also continue to see market demand for certain networking products, including equipment for  
voice over IP and equipment for virtual private networking. In EMEA, we anticipate continued opportunities with alternate operators, cable  
operators and wireless operators and anticipate new opportunities in emerging markets.  
In the Asia Pacific region, we continue to see market demand for certain networking products, including equipment for voice over IP and  
multimedia services and equipment for virtual private networking. Deregulation in China has created opportunities for new entrants who are  
building out their networks with packet-based technologies. In CALA, service  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
providers are also focused on implementing voice over IP technology to enable opportunities for additional growth, network efficiency and  
revenue-generating services. There is also a growing demand for voice over IP technology among cable operators in CALA.  
Customers  
We offer our Wireline Networks products and services to a wide range of wireline and wireless service providers around the world. We are  
focused on increasing our market presence with key global service providers which we currently expect to account for a substantial proportion  
of service provider capital spending in 2004 and beyond. Our service provider customers include local and long distance telephone companies,  
wireless service providers, cable operators and other communications service providers.  
We also offer applicable data networking and security solutions from our Wireline Networks to enterprises for private networking, as well as to  
service providers and system integrators that in turn build, operate and manage networks for their customers such as businesses, government  
agencies and utility organizations. None of our Wireline Networks customers represented more than 10% of Nortel Networks consolidated  
revenues in 2003.  
Competition  
Our principal competitors in the Wireline Networks business are large communications companies such as Siemens, Alcatel, Cisco and Lucent.  
In addition, we compete with smaller companies that address specific niches within this market, such as Sonus Systems Limited, BroadSoft,  
Inc. and Taqua Inc. in packet and Internet-based voice communications solutions; Juniper and Laurel Networks, Inc. in multiservice provider  
edge solutions; and Ciena Corporation (which acquired Wavesmith Networks, Inc. in 2003) in multiservice WAN solutions; and Redback  
Networks Inc. in aggregation products. Certain competitors are also strong on a regional basis, such as ZTE Corporation and Huawei in the  
Asia Pacific region. Some niche competitors are partnering with larger companies to enhance their product offerings and large communications  
competitors are also looking for these partnerships or alliances to complete their product offerings. No one competitor is dominant in the  
Wireline Networks market.  
The primary global factors of competition for our wireline products include:  
technology leadership, product features and availability;  
price and total cost of ownership;  
ability to create new revenue-generating services for service providers and cable operators;  
conformity to existing and emerging regulatory and industry standards;  
installed base of products and customer relationships;  
network management capabilities;  
product quality and reliability; and  
warranty and customer support.  
Competition remains intense as a result of reduced investment in existing legacy networks by service providers, the continued consolidation in  
the service provider industry, and the continued focus by suppliers on selling to large service providers with financial resources.  
Optical Networks  
Products  
Our Optical Networks solutions portfolio addresses the varying optical communication needs of service providers and enterprises. Optical  
networks transport data, voice and multimedia communications within and between cities, countries or continents by transmitting  
communications signals in the form of light waves through fiber optic cables. Optical networking is the most common method for transporting  
communications signals between the various locations within a service provider’s network and is unmatched for delivering vast amounts of  
data reliably and cost-effectively with service and bandwidth flexibility and scalability.  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Our optical networking solutions are designed to provide metropolitan, regional and long-haul, high-capacity transport and switching of data,  
voice and multimedia communications signals. These solutions include photonic Dense Wavelength Division Multiplexing, or DWDM,  
transmission solutions, synchronous optical transmission solutions, optical switching solutions and network management and intelligence  
software. We also offer our customers a variety of related professional services. Our solutions include the following:  
Our photonic networking DWDM solutions allow multiple light wave signals to be transmitted on the same fiber optic strand  
simultaneously by using different wavelengths of light to distinguish specific signals, thereby increasing the capacity and flexibility  
of a network. Our long-haul DWDM line systems span distances up to 2,000 kilometers and our metro DWDM series provides  
networking solutions within a city or region for up to 350 kilometres.  
Our synchronous optical transmission systems use traditional optical standards, including the Synchronous Optical Network, or  
SONET, standard, which is the most common standard in the United States and Canada and some countries in the Asia Pacific  
region, and the Synchronous Digital Hierarchy, or SDH, standard, which is the most common standard in EMEA and many other  
countries. Our synchronous next-generation SONET/SDH solutions comprise multi-service optical platforms that integrate diverse  
protocols and technologies to deliver services over a cost effective, scalable and reliable converged services network.  
Our optical switching solutions enable communication signals in optical fibers to be selectively directed or “switched” from one  
network circuit to another.  
Our network management software and intelligence solutions are designed to give our customers the ability to monitor and improve  
the performance of their networks.  
Our Optical Networks solutions enable customers to enhance and transform their networks towards a scalable and reliable network for  
delivering diverse high speed data and voice communication services. Such network transformation is expected to increase deployment of  
managed broadband services, such as:  
Optical Ethernet solutions that combine the strengths of the Ethernet network computing protocol with those of optical  
communications. Optical Ethernet solutions transport communications signals carrying Ethernet packets in the form of light waves  
through fiber optic cables between locations within a city or between cities.  
Optical storage connectivity solutions, which allow the interconnection of data centers for the efficient preservation and sharing of  
business-critical data to ensure business continuity and disaster recovery.  
Managed wavelength solutions, which offer multiple protocol and transmission speed networking capability to reliably interconnect  
business sites.  
In addition, in February 2004, we announced strategic alliances with Calix Networks, Inc., ECI Telecom Ltd. and KEYMILE AG that will  
expand our broadband networking solutions portfolio and enable our service provider customers to deliver a new set of emerging broadband  
services to their enterprise and residential end-users.  
Product development  
We are focused on developing next generation optical networking systems, including the evolution of our next generation SONET/SDH  
systems, our metro DWDM systems and our optical long-haul line and terminal solutions. In 2003, we:  
introduced an advanced metro optical network product, our Optical Multiservice Edge 6500, that enables the convergence of  
multiple platforms onto a single platform, enabling reduced network costs and enhanced functionality;  
enhanced the capabilities of our existing metro optical network products to enable new storage area solutions that address emerging  
enterprise business continuity requirements; and  
introduced a new long-haul product that utilizes photonic networking DWDM technology, which assists customers in lowering their  
network costs by providing improved optical performance.  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
We continue to develop and enhance our Optical Networks portfolio, including by:  
enhancing our optical Ethernet portfolio by introducing new Ethernet switching and transport capabilities designed to improve the  
productivity of our enterprise customers and the services offered by our service provider customers;  
introducing in 2004, a new common photonic layer product that simplifies and automates the deployment and operation of medium  
and long-haul optical links;  
introducing the second release of our high density optical switching system to provide additional customer applications; and  
investing in improving the density, capacity and flexibility of our optical long-haul transmission systems.  
We also continue to invest in core technologies, such as efficient service adaptation, aggregation, switching and management, that enable our  
customers worldwide to deploy innovative optical networking services which we believe will lead the networking transformation towards high  
performance packet-based networks.  
Markets  
We are a leading provider of optical networking products to service providers and enterprises around the world. Compared to the last few  
years, the global optical market has stabilized. Service providers remain focused on maximizing return on invested capital by increasing their  
capacity utilization rates and the efficiency of their existing networks. Some service providers have delayed the deployment of next generation  
products. However, there remain opportunities to deliver new technologies and services that enable service providers to offer additional  
revenue-generating services. We also expect that enterprises will continue to generate demand for optical networking solutions that enable  
them to operate their networks more efficiently.  
The outlook for optical equipment sales may be further impacted by service providers preferring to lease excess network capacity from others  
or purchase assets from other operators rather than making capital investments in their own networks. We expect that any additional capital  
spending by our customers will continue to be directed toward opportunities that enhance customer performance, generate revenue and reduce  
costs in the near term. However, as service providers begin to more effectively utilize and eventually exceed their network capacity, we expect  
that they may incrementally enhance that capacity. The timing and impact of these developments remain difficult to predict.  
The market for our Optical Networks solutions is global. In the United States and Canada, new networks are not currently being built by  
service providers in anticipation of market demand, but are instead being built to more closely align with actual end-user demand. Several  
service providers in the United States have announced plans to deploy optical fiber networks to allow access to these networks by residential  
end-users. Within EMEA, the building of pan-European optical networks by service providers is now mature and many service providers have  
begun to focus on building their metropolitan and regional optical networks. We expect that the increased usage of broadband wireless data  
provided by 3G networks may eventually drive the increased deployment of optical networks. The demand for additional and enhanced  
services by enterprises is increasing in Europe and may also encourage service providers to invest in the creation of networks that offer  
services such as optical Ethernet and storage connectivity. In EMEA, European government-sponsored service providers and networking  
equipment suppliers enjoy favorable positions within many European countries.  
In the Asia Pacific region, the industry is continuing to develop and may provide a significant market for new optical networking equipment  
over the next several years. As a result, there has been an increased focus on the Asia Pacific region by virtually all suppliers of optical  
networking equipment. Similar to what is occurring in Europe within the EMEA region, the Asia Pacific region may experience increased  
demand for additional and enhanced services by enterprises which may encourage service providers to invest in the creation of networks that  
offer services such as optical Ethernet and storage connectivity. In CALA, where a few service providers account for a significant percentage  
of the industry, the building of national optical network infrastructures is largely complete.  
Customers  
Our Optical Networks business is primarily focused on offering our optical networking solutions to service providers around the world. The  
service provider customers for our optical networking products include local and long-distance telephone companies, cable operators, Internet  
service providers and other communications service providers. We are currently focused on increasing our market presence with key service  
provider customers worldwide, which we expect to account for a substantial proportion of service provider optical capital spending.  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
We are also focused on enterprises and we continue to provide optical solutions for private enterprise networking and also for service providers  
to build and operate custom dedicated networks for enterprises. We leverage numerous channels for delivering optical networking solutions to  
enterprises from our own direct sales force for large enterprises and governments and through distributors, resellers and partners to offer our  
solution to medium-sized enterprises and smaller enterprises. None of our Optical Networks customers represented more than 10% of Nortel  
Networks consolidated revenues in 2003.  
Competition  
Our major competitors in the sale of optical networking equipment include Alcatel, Lucent, Siemens, Fujitsu Limited, Marconi plc, Cisco,  
Huawei, NEC, Ciena and ADVA International Inc. Market position in the global market for optical networking equipment can fluctuate  
significantly on a quarter-by-quarter basis. However, we continue to be a leading global provider of optical networking equipment. No one  
competitor is dominant in the optical networking equipment market.  
The primary global factors of competition for our Optical Networks products include:  
technology leadership, product features and availability;  
product quality and reliability;  
conformity to existing and emerging regulatory and industry standards;  
warranty and customer support;  
price and cost of ownership;  
interoperability with other networking products;  
network management capabilities;  
traditional supplier relationships, particularly in EMEA and the Asia Pacific region; and  
regulatory certification, particularly for incumbent local and long-distance telephone companies.  
Our focus is on increasing market share relative to our competitors.  
Sales and distribution  
All of our reportable segments use the Nortel Networks direct sales force to market and sell to customers around the world. The Nortel  
Networks global sales force operates on a regional basis and markets and sells our products and services to customers located in the following  
regional areas: Canada; United States; CALA; EMEA; and Asia Pacific. Our sales office bases for our direct sales force are aligned with our  
customers on a country and regional basis.  
We have dedicated sales account teams for certain major service provider customers. These dedicated teams are located close to the customers’  
main purchasing locations. In addition, teams within the regional sales groups are dedicated to our enterprise customers. Our Enterprise  
Networks sales teams work directly with the top regional enterprises, and are also responsible for managing regional distribution channels. We  
also have centralized marketing, product management and technical support teams dedicated to individual product lines that support the global  
sales and support teams.  
In the Asia Pacific region, particularly in China, we also use agents to interface with our customers. In addition, we have some small non-  
exclusive distribution agreements with distributors in EMEA, CALA and the Asia Pacific region. In Enterprise Networks, certain service  
providers, system integrators, value-added resellers and stocking distributors act as non-exclusive distribution channels for our products.  
Backlog  
Our backlog was approximately $3.3 billion and $3.3 billion as of September 30, 2004 and September 30, 2003, respectively. A majority of  
backlog consists of orders confirmed with a binding purchase order or contract for our network solutions typically scheduled for delivery to our  
customers within the next twelve months. A significant portion of backlog may also include orders that relate to revenue that has been deferred  
for periods longer than twelve months. However, orders are subject to possible rescheduling by customers. Although we believe that the orders  
included in the backlog are firm, we may elect to permit cancellation of orders without penalty where management believes that it is in our best  
interest to do so. Prior  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
to including orders in backlog, customers must have approved credit status. However, from time to time, some customers may become unable  
to pay for or finance their purchases in which case the order is removed from our backlog.  
Product standards, certification and regulations  
Our products are subject to equipment standards, registration and certification in Canada, the United States, the European Union and other  
countries. We design and manufacture our products to satisfy a variety of regulatory requirements and protocols established to, for instance,  
avoid interference among users of radio frequencies and to permit interconnection of equipment. For example, our equipment must satisfy the  
United States Federal Communications Commission’s, or FCC, emissions testing requirements, and must be certified to safety, electrical noise  
and communications standards compliance. Different regulations and regulatory processes exist in each country.  
In order for our products to be used in some jurisdictions, regulatory approval and, in some cases, specific country compliance testing and re-  
testing may be required. The delays inherent in this regulatory approval process may force us to reschedule, postpone or cancel introduction of  
products or new capabilities in certain geographic areas, and may result in reductions in our sales. The failure to comply with current or future  
regulations or changes in the interpretation of existing regulations in a particular country could result in the suspension or cessation of sales in  
that country or require us to incur substantial costs to modify our products to comply with the regulations of that country. To support our  
compliance efforts, we work with consultants and testing laboratories as necessary to ensure that our products comply with the requirements of  
Industry Canada in Canada, the FCC in the United States and the European Telecommunications Standards Institute in Western Europe, as well  
as with the various regulations of other countries. For additional information, see “Environmental Matters.”  
The operations of our service provider customers are subject to extensive country-specific telecommunications regulations. In the United  
States, on February 20, 2003, the FCC announced a decision in its triennial review proceeding of the agency’s rules regarding unbundled  
network elements. The text of the FCC’s order and reasons for the decision were released on August 21, 2003. The FCC decision, subsequent  
judicial review of the decision and the FCC’s reconsideration of its decision and subsequent adoption on December 15, 2004 of new  
unbundling rules in response to the remand by the U.S. Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit are affecting, and may continue to affect, the  
decisions of certain of our United States-based service provider customers regarding investment in their telecommunications infrastructure.  
These unbundled network elements rules and/or material changes in other country-specific telecommunications regulations at any time or from  
time to time may affect capital spending by service providers in the United States and/or around the world, and this may in turn affect the  
United States and/or global markets for networking solutions.  
Sources and availability of materials  
Since 1999, our manufacturing and supply chain strategy has evolved and has resulted in the gradual transformation of our traditional  
manufacturing model, in which our products were primarily manufactured and assembled in-house, to primarily an outsourced model which  
relies on electronic manufacturing services, or EMS, suppliers. By the end of 2003, most of our manufacturing activities had been divested to  
leading EMS suppliers. We have continued to pursue an outsourced manufacturing model and in January 2004 announced our intention to  
divest substantially all of our remaining manufacturing activities. On June 29, 2004, we announced that we had reached an agreement with  
Flextronics to divest substantially all of Nortel Networks remaining manufacturing operations, located in Canada and Brazil, with the  
anticipation that Flextronics will also acquire similar operations in France and Northern Ireland, subject to the completion of the required  
information and consultation processes. For recent developments in the evolution of our supply chain strategy, see “Developments in 2003 and  
2004” in the MD&A section of this report.  
We believe that the use of an outsourced manufacturing model has enabled us to benefit from leading manufacturing technologies, leverage  
existing resources from around the world, lower our cost of sales, adjust to fluctuations in market demand and decrease our investment in plant,  
equipment and inventories. We continue to retain in-house all strategic management and overall control responsibilities associated with our  
various supply chains, including all customer interfaces, customer service, order management, quality assurance, product cost-management,  
new product introduction, and network solutions integration, testing and fulfillment.  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Through our existing manufacturing model, we are generally able to obtain sufficient materials and components from global sources to meet  
the needs of our four reportable segments. In each of our reportable segments, we:  
make significant purchases of electronic components and assemblies, optical components, original equipment manufacturer, or  
OEM, products, software products, outsourced assemblies and other materials and components from many domestic and foreign  
sources;  
develop and maintain alternative sources for certain essential materials and components; and  
occasionally maintain special inventories of components internally or request that they be maintained by suppliers to satisfy  
customer demand or to minimize effects of possible market shortages.  
Comparing 2003 to 2002, we observed fewer instances of supply surpluses because of adjustments to eliminate excess capacity. In 2003, we  
continued our focus on inventory management and component cost reduction. In 2004, we continued to purchase, manufacture, or otherwise  
obtain sufficient components and materials to supply our products, systems and networks within customary delivery periods.  
For more information on our supply arrangements, see “Commitments” in note 14 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements and  
“Developments in 2003 and 2004” and “Liquidity and capital resources — Contractual cash obligations — Outsourcing contracts” in the  
MD&A section of this report.  
Seasonality  
Prior to 2001, our business results in all of our reportable segments were generally strongest in our fourth quarter, second strongest in our  
second quarter, third strongest in our third quarter and the weakest in our first quarter, primarily due to the networking industry purchasing  
cycles exhibited by our customers. The industry adjustment and economic downturn in the United States and elsewhere in 2001 and 2002  
affected our customers’ traditional purchasing patterns, the demand for our products and services and the traditional seasonality of our  
business. In 2003, we began to experience a period of relative industry stability. While our customers increased their purchasing levels in the  
fourth quarter of 2003, our customers continued to spend cautiously. We experienced a seasonal decline in revenues in the first quarter of 2004  
compared to the fourth quarter of 2003, followed by growth in the second quarter of 2004 compared to the first quarter of 2004 in all of our  
four reportable segments. There will be a sequential decline in revenue in the third quarter of 2004 compared to the second quarter of 2004 and  
that we expect the fourth quarter of 2004 will be the strongest quarter in 2004. The quarterly profile of our business results in 2004 is not  
expected to be consistent across all of our reportable segments and there is no assurance that our results of operations for any quarter will  
necessarily be consistent with our historical quarterly profile or indicative of our expected results in future quarters. See “Results of operations  
— continuing operations — 2004 and 2005” and “Risk factors/forward looking statements” in the MD&A section of this report.  
Strategic alliances, acquisitions and minority investments  
We use strategic alliances to deliver certain solutions to our customers. These alliances are typically formed to fill product or service gaps in  
areas that support our core businesses. We believe strategic alliances also augment our access to potential new customers. We intend to  
continue to pursue strategic alliances with businesses that offer technology and/or resources that would enhance our ability to compete in  
existing markets or exploit new market opportunities.  
In 2003, we increased our then existing majority positions in certain companies to 100% ownership. See “Developments in 2003 and 2004 —  
Ownership adjustment in our French and German operations” in the MD&A section of this report. However, we did not make any material  
acquisitions in 2003 or in 2004. In the future, we may consider selective opportunistic acquisitions of companies with resources and product or  
service offerings capable of providing us with additional enhancements to our networking solutions or access to new markets. For information  
regarding the risks associated with strategic alliances and acquisitions, see “Risk factors/forward looking statements” in the MD&A section of  
this report.  
We continue to hold minority investments in certain “start-up” businesses with technology, products or services that, at the time of investment,  
had the potential to fulfill key existing or emerging market opportunities. When minority investments are no longer required to maintain our  
strategic relationship, or the relationship is no longer strategic to our core businesses, we intend to exit such investments at an opportune time.  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Our investment activity remained at a low level in 2003 and in 2004. We may make selective minority investments in start-up ventures and  
certain other companies where we believe the relationship could lay the foundation for future alliances that would support our customer  
solutions. In certain circumstances, we may also acquire an equity position in a company as consideration for a divested business. See  
“Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Directory and operator services business” in the MD&A section of this report.  
Research and development  
In order to remain among the technology leaders in anticipated growth areas, we intend to continue to make strategic investments in our  
research and development activities. Our research and development activities — specifically, research, design and development, systems  
engineering and other product development activities — represent focused investments to drive market leadership across our product  
portfolios. We refer you to the four “Product development” discussions contained in the descriptions of Wireless Networks, Enterprise  
Networks, Wireline Networks and Optical Networks above.  
Our research and development investments are focused on network transformation and next generation products and solutions including  
wireless voice and data, voice over packet, multimedia services and applications, broadband networking and network security. We also conduct  
network planning and systems engineering on behalf of, or in conjunction with, major customers. Although we derive many of our products  
from substantial internal research and development activities, we supplement this with technology acquired or licensed from third parties.  
Our research and development forms a core strength and is a factor differentiating us from many of our competitors. As at December 31, 2003,  
we employed approximately 13,600 regular full-time research and development employees (excluding employees on notice of termination)  
including approximately:  
5,310 regular full-time research and development employees in Canada;  
5,010 regular full-time research and development employees in the United States;  
2,400 regular full-time research and development employees in EMEA; and  
880 regular full-time research and development employees in other countries.  
In August and September 2004, we announced a new strategic plan that includes a focused workforce reduction of approximately 3,250  
employees, or about 10% of our workforce. It is expected that approximately 1,400 regular full-time research and development employees will  
be affected by the workforce reduction, which is expected to principally affect employees in Wireline Networks and Optical Networks. See  
“Employee relations”.  
We also conduct research and development activities through affiliated laboratories in other countries.  
The following table sets forth our consolidated expenses for research and development for each of the three fiscal years ended December 31:  
(millions of dollars)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
R&D expense  
R&D costs incurred on behalf of others  
$
$
1,960  
72  
$
$
2,083  
49  
$
$
3,116  
68  
(a)  
Total  
2,032  
2,132  
3,184  
(a)  
These costs included research and development charged to our customers pursuant to contracts that provided for full recovery of the estimated cost of development,  
material, engineering, installation and all other applicable costs, which were accounted for as contract costs.  
Intellectual property  
Our intellectual property is fundamental to Nortel Networks and the business of each of our four reportable segments. In particular, our success  
is dependent upon our proprietary technology. We generate, maintain, utilize and enforce a substantial portfolio of intellectual property rights,  
including trademarks, and an extensive portfolio of patents covering significant innovations arising from research and development activities.  
In all of our reportable segments, we use our intellectual property rights to protect our investments in research and development activities, to  
strengthen our leadership positions, to protect our good name, to promote our brand name recognition, to enhance our competitiveness and to  
otherwise support our business goals and objectives. However, our intellectual property rights may be challenged, invalidated or circumvented,  
or  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
fail to provide us with significant competitive advantages. See “Risk factors/forward looking statements” in the MD&A section of this report.  
The duration and level of protection of our intellectual property rights are dependent upon the laws and requirements of the jurisdictions  
providing or controlling those rights.  
As of December 31, 2003, we had, on a consolidated basis, approximately:  
3,200 United States patents;  
2,800 patents in other countries; and  
6,200 pending patent applications worldwide.  
We were granted 464 United States patents in 2003.  
Our patents outside of the United States are primarily counterparts to our United States patents. We have entered into some mutual patent  
cross-license agreements with several major corporations to enable each party to operate without risk of a patent infringement claim from the  
other. In addition, we are actively licensing certain of our patents and/or technology to third parties. We also occasionally license single patents  
or groups of patents from third parties.  
Our trademark and trade name, Nortel Networks, is one of our most valuable assets. We sell our products primarily under the Nortel Networks  
brand name. We have registered the Nortel Networks trademark, and many of our other trademarks, in countries around the world. On a  
consolidated basis as of December 31, 2003, we owned approximately 120 registered trademarks in the United States, and approximately 2,040  
registered trademarks in other countries. In addition, as of December 31, 2003, we had approximately 160 pending trademark registrations  
worldwide.  
Employee relations  
At December 31, 2003, we employed approximately 35,160 regular full-time employees (excluding employees on notice of termination),  
including approximately:  
12,990 regular full-time employees in the United States;  
9,430 regular full-time employees in Canada;  
7,840 regular full-time employees in EMEA; and  
4,900 regular full-time employees in other countries.  
We also employ individuals on a regular part-time basis and on a temporary full-time basis. In addition, we engage the services of contractors  
as required.  
As part of our resizing activities to further reduce our cost structure and streamline operations, we notified for termination and provisioned for  
the exit of approximately 1,800 regular full-time employees during 2003. As well, divestitures and outsourcing affecting non-core businesses  
completed or entered into in 2003 resulted in additional reductions. On June 29, 2004, we announced that we had reached an agreement with  
Flextronics to divest certain manufacturing operations in Canada and Brazil, with the anticipation that Flextronics will also acquire similar  
operations in France and Northern Ireland, subject to the completion of the required information and consultation process. Under the terms of  
the agreement, it is intended that approximately 2,500 Nortel Networks employees would transfer to Flextronics by the end of June 2005. In  
addition, in August and September 2004 we announced a new strategic plan, including a new streamlined organizational structure which will  
lead to an anticipated reduction in employees of approximately 3,250, or about 10% of the workforce. Approximately 64% of employee actions  
related to the focused workforce reduction were completed by the end of 2004, including approximately 55% that were notified of termination  
or acceptance of voluntary retirement, with the remainder comprising voluntary attrition of employees that were not replaced. The remainder of  
employee actions are expected to be completed by June 30, 2005. In addition, however, the Company continues to hire in certain strategic areas  
such as investments in the finance organization. The workforce reduction will be subject to completion of the appropriate information and  
consultation processes with the relevant employee representatives in certain jurisdictions, as required by law. For additional information, see  
“Sources and availability of materials”, “Special charges” in note 7 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements and “Results of  
operations — continuing operations — Operating expenses — Special charges” in the MD&A section of this report.  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
At December 31, 2003, labor contracts covered approximately five percent of our employees worldwide. At the same date, five labor contracts  
covered approximately ten percent of our employees in Canada including:  
one labor contract covering approximately eight percent of Canadian unionized employees which was renewed, ratified and became  
effective February 26, 2003;  
one labor contract covering less than one percent of Canadian unionized employees which was renewed, ratified and became  
effective August 16, 2003;  
one labor contract covering approximately ten percent of Canadian unionized employees which was renewed, ratified and became  
effective June 19, 2003;  
one labor contract covering approximately 64% of Canadian unionized employees which was renewed, ratified and became  
effective April 13, 2004; and  
one labor contract covering approximately 18% of Canadian unionized employees which expires in 2008.  
At December 31, 2003, labor contracts covered approximately four percent of our employees in EMEA and all of our employees in Brazil.  
These labor contracts generally have a one-year term, and primarily relate to remuneration. We have no labor contracts in the United States.  
We believe our employee relations are generally positive. Employee morale continues to be an area of focus as a result of ongoing workforce  
reductions associated with our restructuring activities occurring since 2001, the recent reductions resulting from our strategic plan announced  
in August and September 2004, and the restatement of our financial results and related matters. Although the recruitment and retention of  
technically skilled employees in recent years was highly competitive in the global networking industry, the economic conditions during the  
past few years have lessened the competition for skilled employees in our industry. We do, however, believe that our ability to recruit and  
retain skilled employees will continue to be critical to our future success. During 2003, approximately 1,200 regular full-time employees were  
hired globally. From the beginning of 2004 until November 30, 2004, approximately 2,300 regular full-time employees were hired. See “Risk  
factors/forward looking statements” in the MD&A section of this report.  
Environmental matters  
Our operations are subject to a wide range of environmental laws in various jurisdictions around the world. We seek to operate our business in  
compliance with such laws. In Europe, we expect to become subject to new product content laws and product takeback and recycling  
requirements that will require full compliance by 2006. We expect that these laws will require us to incur additional compliance costs.  
Although costs relating to environmental matters have not resulted in a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial  
condition and liquidity in the past, there can be no assurance that we will not be required to incur such costs in the future. We have a corporate  
environmental management system standard and an environmental program to promote compliance. We also have a periodic, risk-based,  
integrated environment, health and safety audit program. As part of our environmental program, we attempt to evaluate and assume  
responsibility for the environmental impacts of our products throughout their life cycles. Our environmental program focuses on design for the  
environment, supply chain and packaging reduction issues. We work with our suppliers and other external groups to encourage the sharing of  
non-proprietary information on environmental research. For additional information on environmental matters, see “Contingencies —  
Environmental matters” in note 22 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Financial information by operating segment and product category  
For financial information by operating segment and product category, see “Segment information” in note 6 of the accompanying consolidated  
financial statements and “Results of operations — continuing operations — Segment revenues” in the MD&A section of this report.  
Financial information by geographic area  
For financial information by geographic area, see “Segment information” in note 6 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements and  
“Results of operations — continuing operations — Geographic revenues” in the MD&A section of this report.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Working capital  
For a discussion of our working capital practices, see “Long-term debt, credit and support facilities” in note 11 of the accompanying  
consolidated financial statements and “Liquidity and capital resources” in the MD&A section of this report.  
Risk factors  
THIS ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K CONTAINS FORWARD LOOKING INFORMATION THAT IS SUBJECT TO  
IMPORTANT RISKS AND UNCERTAINTIES. THE RESULTS OR EVENTS PREDICTED IN THESE STATEMENTS MAY  
DIFFER MATERIALLY FROM ACTUAL RESULTS OR EVENTS. RESULTS OR EVENTS COULD DIFFER FROM CURRENT  
EXPECTATIONS AS A RESULT OF A WIDE RANGE OF RISK FACTORS. FOR INFORMATION REGARDING SOME OF THE  
RISK FACTORS INVOLVED IN OUR BUSINESS AND OPERATIONS, SEE “RISK FACTORS/FORWARD LOOKING  
STATEMENTS” IN THE MD&A SECTION OF THIS REPORT.  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ITEM 2. Properties  
At December 31, 2003, we operated 208 sites around the world occupying approximately 13.7 million square feet. The following table sets  
forth additional information regarding these sites:  
Number of Sites  
Type of Site*  
Manufacturing and repair  
Owned  
Leased  
Geographic Locations  
All geographic regions  
8
Distribution centers  
3
3
14  
6
174  
14  
United States, Canada, EMEA and the Asia Pacific region  
All geographic regions  
United States, Canada, EMEA and the Asia Pacific region  
Offices (administration, sales and field service)  
Research and development  
TOTAL**  
194  
*
Indicates the primary use of the site. A number of our sites are mixed-use facilities.  
**  
Excludes approximately 8.7 million square feet, consisting primarily of leased and/or vacant property designated as part of a planned square footage reduction in  
connection with our restructuring activities commenced in 2001. At December 31, 2003 approximately 2.8 million square feet of such property was sub-leased.  
At December 31, 2003, our facilities were primarily used, on a consolidated basis, approximately as follows:  
21% by Wireless Networks;  
12% by Enterprise Networks;  
10% by Wireline Networks;  
6% by Optical Networks;  
29% by global operations; and  
22% by one or more of our reporting segments and/or corporate facilities.  
In 2003, we continued to reduce the number of sites and square footage of our global facilities to better align ourselves with current market  
conditions. We believe our facilities are suitable and adequate, and have sufficient capacity to meet our current needs. We continue to evaluate  
our future real estate needs based on the current industry environment and taking into account our business requirements. In 2004, we  
purchased land and two buildings that were previously leased by Nortel Networks. Our strategic plan announced in August and  
September 2004 includes the reduction of approximately 2 million square feet of occupied space as a result of workforce reductions and  
improved space utilization through the consolidation of locations. We expect the square footage reduction to be completed by the end of 2005.  
For additional details, see “Special charges” in note 7 and “Long-term debt, credit and support facilities” in note 11 of the accompanying  
consolidated financial statements, and “Liquidity and capital resources — Sources of liquidity” in the MD&A section of this report.  
Security over substantially all of Nortel Networks Limited’s assets, including certain real estate assets in North America, became effective in  
April 2002 under certain credit and security agreements entered into by Nortel Networks Limited and several of its subsidiaries. For additional  
details regarding these agreements and the security, see “Long-term debt, credit and support facilities” in note 11, “Subsequent events” in note  
23 and “Supplemental consolidating financial information” in note 24 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements and  
“Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Credit facilities and security agreements” and “Liquidity and capital resources — Sources of liquidity —  
Available support facility” in the MD&A section of this report.  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ITEM 3. Legal Proceedings  
Subsequent to the February 15, 2001 announcement in which Nortel Networks provided revised guidance for financial performance for the  
2001 fiscal year and the first quarter of 2001, Nortel Networks and certain of its then current officers and directors were named as defendants  
in more than twenty-five purported class action lawsuits. These lawsuits in the U.S. District Courts for the Eastern District of New York, for  
the Southern District of New York and for the District of New Jersey and the provinces of Ontario, Quebec and British Columbia in Canada,  
on behalf of shareholders who acquired Nortel Networks Corporation securities as early as October 24, 2000 and as late as February 15, 2001,  
allege, among other things, violations of U.S. federal and Canadian provincial securities laws. These matters also have been the subject of  
review by Canadian and U.S. securities regulatory authorities. On May 11, 2001, the defendants filed motions to dismiss and/or stay in  
connection with the three proceedings in Quebec primarily based on the factual allegations lacking substantial connection to Quebec and the  
inclusion of shareholders resident in Quebec in the class claimed in the Ontario lawsuit. The plaintiffs in two of these proceedings in Quebec  
obtained court approval for discontinuances of their proceedings on January 17, 2002. The motion to dismiss and/or stay the third proceeding  
was heard on November 6, 2001 and the court deferred any determination on the motion to the judge who will hear the application for  
authorization to commence a class proceeding. On December 6, 2001, the defendants filed a motion seeking leave to appeal that decision. The  
motion for leave to appeal was dismissed on March 11, 2002. On October 16, 2001, an order in the Southern District of New York was filed  
consolidating twenty-five of the related U.S. class action lawsuits into a single case, appointing class plaintiffs and counsel for such plaintiffs.  
The plaintiffs served a consolidated amended complaint on January 18, 2002. On December 17, 2001, the defendants in the British Columbia  
action served notice of a motion requesting the court to decline jurisdiction and to stay all proceedings on the grounds that British Columbia is  
an inappropriate forum. The motion has been adjourned at the plaintiffs’ request to a future date to be set by the parties.  
A class action lawsuit against Nortel Networks was also filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York on behalf of  
shareholders who acquired the securities of JDS between January 18, 2001 and February 15, 2001, alleging violations of the same U.S. federal  
securities laws as the above-noted lawsuits.  
On April 1, 2002, Nortel Networks filed a motion to dismiss both the above consolidated U.S. shareholder class action and the above JDS  
shareholder class action complaints on the grounds that they failed to state a cause of action under U.S. federal securities laws. With respect to  
the JDS shareholder class action complaint, Nortel Networks also moved to dismiss on the separate basis that JDS shareholders lacked standing  
to sue Nortel Networks. On January 3, 2003, the District Court granted the motion to dismiss the JDS shareholder class action complaint and  
denied the motion to dismiss the consolidated U.S. class action complaint. Plaintiffs appealed the dismissal of the JDS shareholder class action  
complaint. On November 19, 2003, oral argument was held before the Second Circuit on the JDS shareholders’ appeal of the dismissal of their  
complaint. On May 19, 2004, the Second Circuit issued an opinion affirming the dismissal of the JDS shareholder class action complaint and  
on July 14, 2004 the Second Circuit denied plaintiffs’ motion for rehearing. On October 12, 2004, the plaintiffs filed a petition for writ of  
certiorari in the U.S. Supreme Court. On November 12, 2004, the defendants filed Brief for the Respondents in Opposition, and on  
November 22, 2004, the plaintiffs filed Reply to Brief in Opposition. With respect to the consolidated U.S. shareholder class action, the  
plaintiffs served a motion for class certification on March 21, 2003. On May 30, 2003, the defendants served an opposition to the motion for  
class certification. Plaintiffs’ reply was served on August 1, 2003. The District Court held oral arguments on September 3, 2003 and issued an  
order granting class certification on September 5, 2003. On September 23, 2003, the defendants filed a motion in the Second Circuit for  
permission to appeal the class certification decision. The plaintiffs’ opposition to the motion was filed on October 2, 2003. On November 24,  
2003, the Second Circuit denied the motion. On March 10, 2004, the District Court approved the form of notice to the class which was  
published and mailed.  
On July 17, 2002, a new purported class action lawsuit (the “Ontario Claim”) was filed in the Ontario Superior Court of Justice, Commercial  
List, naming Nortel Networks, certain of its current and former officers and directors and its auditors as defendants. The factual allegations in  
the Ontario Claim are substantially similar to the allegations in the consolidated amended complaint filed in the U.S. District Court described  
above. The Ontario Claim is on behalf of all Canadian residents who purchased Nortel Networks Corporation securities (including options on  
Nortel Networks Corporation securities) between October 24, 2000 and February 15, 2001. The plaintiffs claim damages of Canadian $5,000,  
plus punitive damages in the amount of Canadian $1,000, prejudgment and postjudgment interest and costs of the action. On September 23,  
2003, the Court issued an order allowing the plaintiffs to proceed to amend the Ontario Claim and requiring that the plaintiffs serve class  
certification materials by December 15, 2003. On September 24, 2003, the plaintiffs filed a notice of discontinuance of the original action filed  
in Ontario. On December 12, 2003, plaintiffs’ counsel requested an extension of time to January 21, 2004 to deliver class certification  
materials. On January 21, 2004, plaintiffs’ counsel advised the Court that the two representative plaintiffs in the action no longer wished to  
proceed, but counsel was prepared to deliver draft certification  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
materials pending the replacement of the representative plaintiffs. On February 19, 2004, the plaintiffs’ counsel advised the Court of a potential  
new representative plaintiff. On February 26, 2004, the defendants requested the Court to direct the plaintiffs’ counsel to bring a motion to  
permit the withdrawal of the current representative plaintiffs and to substitute the proposed representative plaintiff. On June 8, 2004, the Court  
signed an order allowing a Second Fresh as Amended Statement of Claim that substituted one new representative plaintiff, but did not change  
the substance of the prior claim.  
A purported class action lawsuit was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Middle District of Tennessee on December 21, 2001, on behalf of  
participants and beneficiaries of the Nortel Networks Long-Term Investment Plan (the “Plan”) at any time during the period of March 7, 2000  
through the filing date and who made or maintained Plan investments in Nortel Networks Corporation common shares, under the Employee  
Retirement Income Security Act (“ERISA”) for Plan-wide relief and alleging, among other things, material misrepresentations and omissions  
to induce Plan participants to continue to invest in and maintain investments in Nortel Networks Corporation common shares in the Plan. A  
second purported class action lawsuit, on behalf of the Plan and Plan participants for whose individual accounts the Plan purchased Nortel  
Networks Corporation common shares during the period from October 27, 2000 to February 15, 2001 and making similar allegations was filed  
in the same court on March 12, 2002. A third purported class action lawsuit, on behalf of persons who are or were Plan participants or  
beneficiaries at any time since March 1, 1999 to the filing date and making similar allegations, was filed in the same court on March 21, 2002.  
The first and second purported class action lawsuits were consolidated by a new purported class action complaint, filed on May 15, 2002 in the  
same court and making similar allegations, on behalf of Plan participants and beneficiaries who directed the Plan to purchase or hold shares of  
certain funds, which held primarily Nortel Networks Corporation common shares, during the period from March 7, 2000 through December 21,  
2001. On September 24, 2002, plaintiffs in the consolidated action filed a motion to consolidate all the actions and to transfer them to the U.S.  
District Court for the Southern District of New York. The plaintiffs then filed a motion to withdraw the pending motion to consolidate and  
transfer. The withdrawal was granted by the District Court on December 30, 2002. A fourth purported class action lawsuit, on behalf of the  
Plan and Plan participants for whose individual accounts the Plan held Nortel Networks Corporation common shares during the period from  
March 7, 2000 through March 31, 2001 and making similar allegations, was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New  
York on March 12, 2003. On March 18, 2003, plaintiffs in the fourth purported class action filed a motion with the Judicial Panel on  
Multidistrict Litigation to transfer all the actions to the Southern District of New York for coordinated or consolidated proceedings pursuant to  
28 U.S.C. section 1407. On June 24, 2003, the Judicial Panel on Multidistrict Litigation issued a transfer order transferring the Southern  
District of New York action to the Middle District of Tennessee (the “Consolidated ERISA Action”). On September 12, 2003, the plaintiffs in  
all the actions filed a consolidated class action complaint. On October 28, 2003, the defendants filed a motion to dismiss the complaint and a  
motion to stay discovery pending disposition of the motion to dismiss. On March 30, 2004, the plaintiffs filed a motion for certification of a  
class consisting of participants in, or beneficiaries of, the Plan who held shares of the Nortel Networks Stock Fund during the period from  
March 7, 2000 through March 31, 2001. On April 27, 2004, the Court granted the defendants’ motion to stay discovery pending resolution of  
defendants’ motion to dismiss. On June 15, 2004, the plaintiffs filed a First Amended Consolidated Class Action Complaint that added  
additional current and former officers and employees as defendants and expanded the purported class period to extend from March 7, 2000  
through to June 15, 2004.  
On March 4, 1997, Bay Networks, Inc. (“Bay Networks”), a company acquired on August 31, 1998, announced that shareholders had filed two  
separate lawsuits in the U.S. District Court for the Northern District of California (the “Federal Court”) and the California Superior Court,  
County of Santa Clara (the “California Court”), against Bay Networks and ten of Bay Networks’ then current and former officers and directors  
purportedly on behalf of a class of shareholders who purchased Bay Networks’ common shares during the period of May 1, 1995 through  
October 14, 1996. On August 17, 2000, the Federal Court granted the defendants’ motion to dismiss the federal complaint. On August 1, 2001,  
the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Ninth Circuit denied the plaintiffs’ appeal of that decision. On April 18, 1997, a second lawsuit was filed in  
the California Court, purportedly on behalf of a class of shareholders who acquired Bay Networks’ common shares pursuant to the registration  
statement and prospectus that became effective on November 15, 1995. The two actions in the California Court were consolidated in  
April 1998; however, the California Court denied the plaintiffs’ motion for class certification. In January 2000, the California Court of Appeal  
rejected the plaintiffs’ appeal of the decision. A petition for review was filed with the California Supreme Court by the plaintiffs and was  
denied. In February 2000, new plaintiffs who allege to have been shareholders of Bay Networks during the relevant periods, filed a motion for  
intervention in the California Court seeking to become the representatives of a class of shareholders. The motion was granted on June 8, 2001  
and the new plaintiffs filed their complaint-in-intervention on an individual and purported class representative basis alleging misrepresentations  
made in connection with the purchase and sale of securities of Bay Networks in violation of California statutory and common law. On  
March 11, 2002, the California Court granted the defendants’ motion to strike the class allegations. The plaintiffs were permitted to proceed on  
their individual claims. The intervenor-plaintiffs appealed the dismissal of their class allegations. On July 25, 2003, the California Court of  
Appeal reversed the trial court’s dismissal of the intervenor-plaintiffs’ class allegations. On September 3, 2003, the defendants filed a petition  
for review with the  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
California Supreme Court seeking permission to appeal the Court of Appeal decision. On October 22, 2003, the California Supreme Court  
denied, without opinion, the defendants’ petition for review. On December 22, 2003, the plaintiffs served their motion for certification of a  
class of purchasers of Bay Networks’ common shares from July 25, 1995 through to October 14, 1996. Hearing of the plaintiffs’ motion for  
class certification was held on May 4, 2004. On July 27, 2004, the Court entered an Amended Order Denying Motion of Intervenor Plaintiffs  
for Class Certification and Setting Further Hearing. On August 9, 2004, the intervenor-plaintiffs obtained Court approval to dismiss their  
claims and this action and, on September 30, 2004, the Court entered dismissal with prejudice of the entire action of all parties and all causes of  
action.  
Subsequent to the March 10, 2004 announcement in which Nortel Networks indicated it was likely that it would need to revise its previously  
announced unaudited results for the year ended December 31, 2003, and the results reported in certain of its quarterly reports for 2003, and to  
restate its previously filed financial results for one or more earlier periods, Nortel Networks and certain of its then current and former officers  
and directors were named as defendants in 27 purported class action lawsuits. These lawsuits in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District  
of New York on behalf of shareholders who acquired Nortel Networks Corporation securities as early as February 16, 2001 and as late as  
May 15, 2004, allege, among other things, violations of U.S. federal securities laws. These matters are also the subject of investigations by  
Canadian and U.S. securities regulatory and criminal investigative authorities (see note 23). On June 30, 2004, the Court signed Orders  
consolidating the 27 class actions and appointing lead plaintiffs and lead counsel. The plaintiffs filed a consolidated class action complaint on  
September 10, 2004, alleging a class period of April 24, 2003, through and including April 27, 2004. On November 5, 2004, Nortel Networks  
Corporation and the Audit Committee Defendants filed a motion to dismiss the consolidated class action complaint.  
On May 18, 2004, a purported class action lawsuit was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Middle District of Tennessee on behalf of  
participants and beneficiaries of the Plan at any time during the period of December 23, 2003 through the filing date and who made or  
maintained Plan investments in Nortel Networks Corporation common shares, under the ERISA for Plan-wide relief and alleging, among other  
things, breaches of fiduciary duty. On September 3, 2004, the Court signed a stipulated order consolidating this action with the Consolidated  
ERISA Action described above. On June 16, 2004, a second purported class action lawsuit, on behalf of the Plan and Plan participants for  
whose individual accounts the Plan purchased Nortel Networks Corporation common shares during the period from October 24, 2000 to  
June 16, 2004, and making similar allegations, was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. On August 6, 2004,  
the Judicial Panel on Multidistrict Litigation issued a conditional transfer order to transfer this action to the U.S. District Court for the Middle  
District of Tennessee for coordinated or consolidated proceedings pursuant to 28 U.S.C. section 1407 with the Consolidated ERISA Action  
described above. On August 20, 2004, plaintiffs filed a notice of opposition to the conditional transfer order with the Judicial Panel. On  
December 6, 2004, the Judicial Panel denied the opposition and ordered the action transferred to the U.S. District Court for the Middle District  
of Tennessee for coordinated or consolidated proceedings with the Consolidated ERISA Action described above.  
On July 28, 2004, Nortel Networks and NNL, and certain directors and officers, and certain former directors and officers, of Nortel Networks  
and NNL, were named as defendants in a purported class proceeding in the Ontario Superior Court of Justice on behalf of shareholders who  
acquired Nortel Networks Corporation securities as early as November 12, 2002 and as late as July 28, 2004. This lawsuit alleges, among other  
things, breaches of trust and fiduciary duty, oppressive conduct and misappropriation of corporate assets and trust property in respect of the  
payment of cash bonuses to executives, officers and employees in 2003 and 2004 under the Nortel Networks Return to Profitability bonus  
program and seeks damages of Canadian $250 and an order under the Canada Business Corporations Act directing that an investigation be  
made respecting these bonus payments.  
On July 30, 2004, a shareholders’ derivative complaint was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York against  
certain directors and officers, and certain former directors and officers, of Nortel Networks alleging, among other things, breach of fiduciary  
duties owed to Nortel Networks during the period from 2000 to 2003 including by causing Nortel Networks to engage in unlawful conduct or  
failing to prevent such conduct; causing Nortel Networks to issue false statements; and violating the law.  
Except as otherwise described herein, in each of the matters described above, the plaintiffs are seeking an unspecified amount of monetary  
damages.  
Nortel Networks is also a defendant in various other suits, claims, proceedings and investigations which arise in the normal course of business.  
Nortel Networks is unable to ascertain the ultimate aggregate amount of monetary liability or financial impact to Nortel Networks of the above  
matters which, unless otherwise specified, seek damages from the defendants of material or  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
indeterminate amounts or could result in fines and penalties. Nortel Networks cannot determine whether these actions, suits, claims and  
proceedings will, individually or collectively, have a material adverse effect on the business, results of operations, financial condition and  
liquidity of Nortel Networks. Nortel Networks and any named directors and officers of Nortel Networks intend to vigorously defend these  
actions, suits, claims and proceedings.  
On April 5, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that the SEC had issued a formal order of investigation in connection with Nortel Networks  
previous restatement of its financial results for certain periods, as announced in October 2003, and Nortel Networks announcements in  
March 2004 regarding the likely need to revise certain previously announced results and restate previously filed financial results for one or  
more earlier periods. The matter had been the subject of an informal SEC inquiry. On April 13, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that it had  
received a letter from the staff of the Ontario Securities Commission (“OSC”) advising that there is an OSC Enforcement Staff investigation  
into the same matters that are the subject of the SEC investigation.  
On May 14, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that it had received a Federal Grand Jury Subpoena for the production of certain documents,  
including financial statements and corporate, personnel and accounting records, prepared during the period from January 1, 2000 to the date of  
the subpoena. The materials sought are pertinent to an ongoing criminal investigation being conducted by the U.S. Attorney’s Office for the  
Northern District of Texas, Dallas Division.  
On August 16, 2004, Nortel Networks received a letter from the Integrated Market Enforcement Team of the Royal Canadian Mounted Police  
(“RCMP”) advising Nortel Networks that the RCMP would be commencing a criminal investigation into Nortel Networks financial accounting  
situation.  
Environmental matters  
Nortel Networks operations are subject to a wide range of environmental laws in various jurisdictions around the world. Nortel Networks seeks  
to operate its business in compliance with such laws. In 2004, Nortel Networks expects to become subject to new European product content  
laws and product takeback and recycling requirements that will require full compliance by 2006. It is expected that these laws will require  
Nortel Networks to incur additional compliance costs. Although costs relating to environmental matters have not resulted in a material adverse  
effect on the business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity in the past, there can be no assurance that Nortel Networks will  
not be required to incur such costs in the future. Nortel Networks has a corporate environmental management system standard and an  
environmental program to promote such compliance. Moreover, Nortel Networks has a periodic, risk-based, integrated environment, health and  
safety audit program.  
Nortel Networks environmental program focuses its activities on design for the environment, supply chain and packaging reduction issues.  
Nortel Networks works with its suppliers and other external groups to encourage the sharing of non-proprietary information on environmental  
research.  
Nortel Networks is exposed to liabilities and compliance costs arising from its past and current generation, management and disposal of  
hazardous substances and wastes. As of December 31, 2003, the accruals on the consolidated balance sheet for environmental matters were  
$33. Based on information available as of December 31, 2003, management believes that the existing accruals are sufficient to satisfy probable  
and reasonably estimable environmental liabilities related to known environmental matters. Any additional liability that may result from these  
matters, and any additional liabilities that may result in connection with other locations currently under investigation, are not expected to have  
a material adverse effect on the business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity of Nortel Networks.  
Nortel Networks has remedial activities under way at 12 sites which are either currently or previously owned or occupied facilities. An  
estimate of Nortel Networks anticipated remediation costs associated with all such sites, to the extent probable and reasonably estimable, is  
included in the environmental accruals referred to above in an approximate amount of $33.  
Nortel Networks is also listed as a potentially responsible party (“PRP”) under the U.S. Comprehensive Environmental Response,  
Compensation and Liability Act (“CERCLA”) at six Superfund sites in the U.S. An estimate of Nortel Networks share of the anticipated  
remediation costs associated with such Superfund sites is expected to be de minimis and is included in the environmental accruals of $33  
referred to above.  
Liability under CERCLA may be imposed on a joint and several basis, without regard to the extent of Nortel Networks involvement. In  
addition, the accuracy of Nortel Networks estimate of environmental liability is affected by several uncertainties such as additional  
requirements which may be identified in connection with remedial activities, the complexity  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
and evolution of environmental laws and regulations, and the identification of presently unknown remediation requirements. Consequently,  
Nortel Networks liability could be greater than its current estimate.  
ITEM 4. Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders  
Not applicable.  
PART II  
ITEM 5. Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity and Related Stockholder Matters  
The common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation are listed and posted for trading on the New York Stock Exchange in the United States  
and on the Toronto Stock Exchange in Canada. The following table sets forth the high and low sale prices of the common shares as reported on  
the New York Stock Exchange composite tape and on the Toronto Stock Exchange.  
New York  
Stock Exchange  
composite tape  
Toronto  
Stock Exchange  
(Canadian $)  
High  
Low  
High  
Low  
2004  
2003  
2002  
Fourth Quarter  
Third Quarter  
Second Quarter  
First Quarter  
Fourth Quarter  
Third Quarter  
Second Quarter  
First Quarter  
Fourth Quarter  
Third Quarter  
Second Quarter  
First Quarter  
$
3.91  
5.05  
6.33  
8.50  
4.80  
4.73  
3.55  
2.72  
2.75  
1.70  
4.73  
8.77  
$
2.92  
3.16  
3.01  
4.30  
3.98  
2.68  
2.06  
1.68  
0.43  
0.45  
1.31  
4.22  
$
4.80  
6.40  
8.35  
11.94  
6.37  
6.50  
4.81  
4.13  
3.61  
2.60  
7.54  
13.99  
$
3.49  
4.11  
4.16  
5.53  
5.17  
3.84  
3.04  
2.59  
0.67  
0.70  
2.01  
6.75  
On December 31, 2004, the last sale price on the New York Stock Exchange was $3.47 and on the Toronto Stock Exchange was Canadian  
$4.16.  
On December 31, 2004, approximately 196,852 registered shareholders held 100% of the outstanding common shares of Nortel Networks  
Corporation. This included the Canadian Depository for Securities and the Depository Trust Company, two clearing corporations, which held a  
total of approximately 97% of the common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation on behalf of other shareholders.  
Securities authorized for issuance under equity compensation plans  
For a discussion of Nortel Networks equity compensation plans, please see “Equity compensation plan information” in Item 12, “Security  
Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management”.  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dividends  
On June 15, 2001, Nortel Networks Corporation announced that its Board of Directors decided to discontinue the declaration and payment of  
common share dividends. As a result, dividends have not been declared and paid on Nortel Networks Corporation common shares since  
June 29, 2001, and future dividends will not be declared unless and until the Board of Directors decides otherwise. On July 26, 2001, the Board  
of Directors of Nortel Networks Corporation suspended the operation of the Nortel Networks Corporation Dividend Reinvestment and Stock  
Purchase Plan.  
In the first and second quarters of 2001, Nortel Networks Corporation declared and paid a cash dividend of $0.01875 per common share. This  
represents a total dividend of $0.0375 per common share for 2001 and aggregate dividend payments of $123 million.  
Canadian tax matters  
Dividends  
Under the United States-Canada Income Tax Convention (1980), or the Convention, Canadian withholding tax of 15% generally applies to the  
gross amount of dividends (including stock dividends) paid or credited to beneficial owners of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares:  
who are resident in the United States for the purposes of the Convention; and  
who do not hold the shares in connection with a business carried on through a permanent establishment or a fixed base in Canada.  
The Convention provides an exemption from withholding tax on dividends paid or credited to certain tax-exempt organizations that are resident  
in the United States for purposes of the Convention. Persons who are subject to the United States federal income tax on dividends may be  
entitled, subject to certain limitations, to either a credit or deduction with respect to Canadian income taxes withheld with respect to dividends  
paid or credited on Nortel Networks Corporation common shares.  
Sales or other dispositions of shares  
Gains on sales or other dispositions of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares by a non-resident of Canada are generally not subject to  
Canadian income tax, unless the holder realizes the gains in connection with a business carried on in Canada. A gain realized upon the  
disposition of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares by a resident of the United States that is otherwise subject to Canadian tax may be  
exempt from Canadian tax under the Convention. Where Nortel Networks Corporation common shares are disposed of by way of an  
acquisition of such common shares by Nortel Networks Corporation, other than a purchase in the open market in the manner in which common  
shares would normally be purchased by any member of the public in the open market, the amount paid by Nortel Networks Corporation in  
excess of the paid-up capital of such common shares will be treated as a dividend, and will be subject to non-resident withholding tax as  
described above under the heading “Dividends”.  
Sales of unregistered securities  
During the fourth quarter of 2003, Nortel Networks Corporation did not issue any common shares under the Nortel Networks/BCE 1985 Stock  
Option Plan or the Nortel Networks/BCE 1999 Stock Option Plan. Any common shares issued under these plans are deemed to be exempt from  
registration under the United States Securities Act of 1933, as amended, pursuant to Regulation S. All funds received by Nortel Networks  
Corporation in connection with the exercise of stock options granted under the two Nortel Networks/BCE stock option plans are transferred in  
full to BCE pursuant to the terms of the May 1, 2000 plan of arrangement, except for nominal amounts paid to Nortel Networks Corporation to  
round up fractional entitlements into whole shares. Nortel Networks Corporation keeps these nominal amounts and uses them for general  
corporate purposes.  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ITEM 6. Selected Financial Data (Unaudited)  
The selected financial data presented below was derived from Nortel Networks Corporation’s audited consolidated financial statements and  
related notes thereto included elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K except for the summarized balance sheet data as of December 31,  
2001 and 2000. Readers should note the following information regarding the selected financial data presented below.  
Nortel Networks Corporation has restated its previously reported consolidated financial statements for the fiscal years ended December 31,  
2002 and 2001 and the quarters ended March 31, June 30 and September 30, 2003. The selected financial data presented below includes all  
such restatements and covers the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001 as well as selected balance sheet data as of December 31,  
2003, 2002, 2001 and 2000. In connection with the restatement of the fiscal years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, and the quarters ended  
March 31, June 30 and September 30, 2003, Nortel Networks identified certain adjustments to its previously reported consolidated financial  
statements for periods prior to fiscal 2001. The net effect of the adjustments relating to periods prior to fiscal 2001 have been reflected in the  
selected financial data presented below as adjustments to accumulated deficit as of December 31, 2000. The disclosure presented below  
addresses the adjustments identified in the Second Restatement that related to the periods prior to 2001.  
Except for selected balance sheet data as of December 31, 2000, financial data for the years ended December 31, 2000 and 1999 has not been  
restated or presented in the selected financial data presented below. Due to the identified material weaknesses in our internal controls over  
financial reporting, significant turnover in Nortel Networks finance personnel, changes in accounting systems, documentation weaknesses, a  
likely inability to obtain third party corroboration in certain cases due to the substantial industry adjustment in recent years and the passage of  
time generally, Nortel Networks has determined that extensive additional efforts over an extended period of time would be required to restate  
its 2000 and 1999 selected financial data. Nortel Networks also believes that selected financial data for these periods would not be meaningful  
to investors due to the significant industry adjustment in the telecommunications industry beginning in 2001, which significantly impacted  
Nortel Networks financial results in 2001 and subsequent periods and limits the relevance of financial results in periods prior to 2001 for  
purposes of analysis of trends in subsequent periods. Previously reported financial information for 2000 and 1999 should not be relied upon.  
See the “Controls and Procedures — Additional Background — Second Restatement — Estimates; Omissions of 1999 and 2000 Selected  
Financial Data; Decision Not to Amend Certain Previous Filings” section of this report.  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(millions of U.S. dollars, except per share amounts)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
As restated*  
As restated*  
Results of Operations  
Revenues  
$
10,193  
1,960  
$
11,008  
2,083  
$
18,900  
3,116  
Research and development expense  
Special charges  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
Operating earnings (loss)  
Other income (expense) — net  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Cumulative effect of accounting changes — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss)  
284  
45  
445  
80  
262  
184  
(12)  
434  
595  
1,500  
(3,072)  
(5)  
11,426  
3,390  
(25,020)  
(506)  
468  
2,751  
(2,893)  
(101)  
(23,270)  
(2,467)  
15  
(2,994)  
(25,722)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
0.06  
0.04  
(0.75)  
(0.03)  
(7.30)  
(0.78)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
0.10  
(0.78)  
(8.08)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
0.06  
0.04  
(0.75)  
(0.03)  
(7.30)  
(0.78)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
Dividends declared per common share  
0.10  
(0.78)  
(8.08)  
0.0375  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
2000**  
As restated*  
As restated*  
As restated*  
Financial Position as of December 31  
Total assets  
Total debt  
Minority interests in subsidiary companies  
Total shareholders’ equity  
$
16,591  
4,027  
617  
$
16,961  
4,233  
631  
$
21,971  
5,212  
654  
$
44,337  
2,454  
758  
3,945  
3,053  
4,808  
27,862  
See notes 4, 7 and 10 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements for the impact of accounting changes, special charges and acquisitions, divestitures and closures,  
respectively, that affect the comparability of the above selected financial data.  
*
See note 3 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
**  
Total assets as of December 31, 2000 increased by $1,744 as a result of the Second Restatement, primarily due to increases in inventories — net and deferred income taxes-  
net. Accumulated deficit as of December 31, 2000, increased by $1,432 as a result of the Second Restatement, as further described below.  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following information provides detailed disclosure in respect of each material component of the Second Restatement adjustments to the  
accumulated deficit as of December 31, 2000:  
Summary of Second Restatement Adjustments on Accumulated Deficit as of December 31, 2000:  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Total  
Adjustments  
Revenues  
Cost of revenues  
$
$
(3,379)  
(1,214)  
Gross profit  
(2,165)  
623  
(186)  
296  
Income tax benefit  
Foreign exchange  
Other adjustments  
Net increase to accumulated deficit  
(1,432)  
Revenues and cost of revenues adjustments  
Revenues were impacted by various errors related to revenue recognition resulting in a cumulative decrease of $3,379 for the years prior to  
2001. The net impact to cost of revenues related to these revenue adjustments and other items was a cumulative decrease of $1,214 for the  
years prior to 2001.  
Revenues were recognized on certain sales for which it was subsequently determined that the criteria for revenue recognition under SAB 101  
or SOP 97-2, as applicable, had not been met, including arrangements in which legal title or risk of loss on products did not transfer to the  
buyer until full payment was received, and arrangements where delivery had not occurred. Revenues and related cost of revenues for these  
arrangements should have been deferred to later periods when title or risk of loss had passed and all criteria for revenue recognition had been  
met. Therefore, adjustments were made to defer revenues and related cost of revenues from the periods in which they were originally recorded  
and to recognize them in the periods in which all revenue recognition criteria were met.  
Revenues were recognized on certain sales for which it was subsequently determined that the criteria for revenue recognition under SOP 97-2  
had not been met, including arrangements in which the criteria for fixed or determinable fees was not met. Revenues and related cost of  
revenues for these agreements were deferred to later periods when payments became due and all criteria for revenue recognition had been met.  
In certain multiple element arrangements, total arrangement fees were recognized as revenue at the time of delivery of software or hardware,  
but prior to the delivery of future contractual or implicit PCS or other services. Revenues should have been allocated to these future  
deliverables based on their fair value and recognized ratably over the PCS period or as the future obligations were performed. Adjustments  
were made to appropriately allocate revenue among the accounting units and recognize the allocated revenue in accordance with the applicable  
revenue recognition guidance. In certain circumstances where the criteria to treat delivered software and hardware elements and undelivered  
PCS services as separate accounting units were not met, the entire arrangement fee was deferred and recognized over the PCS period.  
Revenues were also recognized for certain contracts that involved undelivered elements as a result of product development delays. The lack of  
relative fair value for the undelivered element meant that revenues and cost of revenues for all products delivered should have been deferred  
until the undelivered element was delivered. As originally recorded, revenues were recognized upon delivery of an alternative product and  
costs were accrued for the  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
undelivered element. To correct for these items, related cost provisions were reversed and revenues and associated cost of revenues were  
recognized in the appropriate periods when all elements had been delivered.  
Revenues were recognized upon product delivery to a certain reseller who lacked economic substance apart from Nortel Networks. Revenue  
should have been deferred and only recognized by Nortel Networks upon sale by the reseller to an end customer. Correction of this resulted in  
revenues and cost of revenues being deferred with ultimate recognition in 2001.  
Other adjustments included corrections related to errors in the application of percentage-of-completion accounting for certain contracts,  
specific contracts with reciprocal arrangements that should have been treated as a reduction of revenues, and other errors related to non-cash  
incentives and concessions provided to customers and other calculation errors.  
Other adjustments  
The income tax benefit as a result of the restatement decreased the accumulated deficit by $623. The determination of the functional currency  
for certain entities was re-examined, and as a result Nortel Networks determined that the accounting for certain global headquarter functions  
needed to be restated back to 1986 to reflect a U.S. dollar functional currency designation. This resulted in an increase of $186 to accumulated  
deficit and a decrease to accumulated other comprehensive loss as of December 31, 2000. Other adjustments of $296 included the corrections  
of errors in respect to each of intercompany related items, the accounting associated with sales of receivables, the calculation of the valuation  
of deferred compensation on certain acquisitions and various other adjustments. Reflected in these adjustments were reclassifications of certain  
items to or from cost of revenues.  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ITEM 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of  
Operations — Table of Contents  
37  
37  
37  
38  
39  
40  
41  
41  
41  
41  
42  
42  
48  
49  
49  
49  
50  
50  
51  
51  
51  
51  
52  
52  
52  
53  
53  
53  
53  
53  
53  
53  
53  
54  
54  
54  
54  
54  
56  
58  
60  
61  
63  
63  
65  
65  
65  
66  
67  
68  
68  
Business overview  
Our business  
Our segments  
Our business environment  
How we measure performance  
Our strategic plan and outlook  
Developments in 2003 and 2004  
2003 consolidated results summary  
Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters  
Comprehensive Review and First Restatement  
Independent Review  
Second Restatement  
Material weaknesses in internal control over financial reporting identified in Second Restatement  
Revenue Independent Review  
Personnel actions  
EDC Support Facility  
Credit facilities and security agreements  
Debt securities  
Shelf registration statement  
Credit ratings  
Regulatory actions and pending litigation  
Stock-based compensation plans  
Evolution of our supply chain strategy  
Other business developments  
Shareholder rights plan  
Ownership adjustment in our French and German operations  
Customer financing commitments  
Sale of Entrust shares  
Real estate  
Customer contract settlement  
Directory and operator services business  
Bharat Sanchar Nigram Limited contract  
Patent infringement settlement  
Customer financing arrangements  
Results of operations — continuing operations  
Segment revenues  
Geographic revenues  
Consolidated revenues  
Wireless Networks revenues  
Enterprise Networks revenues  
Wireline Networks revenues  
Optical Networks revenues  
Gross profit and gross margin  
Segment gross profit and gross margin  
Operating expenses  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Segment selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Segment research and development expense  
Segment contribution margin  
Segment Management EBT  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Amortization of intangibles  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges  
Gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Results of operations — discontinued operations  
Liquidity and capital resources  
Cash flows  
Uses of liquidity  
Contractual cash obligations  
JDS purchase arrangement  
Customer financing  
Joint ventures/minority interests  
Discontinued operations  
Sources of liquidity  
Credit facilities  
Available support facility  
68  
68  
69  
71  
71  
72  
72  
72  
72  
73  
73  
75  
76  
77  
77  
78  
78  
78  
78  
78  
79  
80  
80  
80  
81  
81  
82  
82  
83  
84  
85  
85  
86  
86  
87  
88  
89  
89  
89  
90  
91  
92  
92  
93  
93  
93  
99  
Shelf registration statement and base shelf prospectus  
Credit ratings  
Off-balance sheet arrangements  
Bid, performance related and other bonds  
Receivables securitization and certain lease financing transactions  
Other indemnifications or guarantees  
Application of critical accounting estimates  
Revenue recognition  
Provisions for doubtful accounts  
Provisions for inventory  
Income taxes  
Tax asset valuation  
Tax contingencies  
Goodwill valuation  
Pension and post-retirement benefits  
Special charges  
Other contingencies  
Accounting changes and recent accounting pronouncements  
Accounting changes  
Recent accounting pronouncements  
Market risk  
Equity price risk  
Environmental matters  
Legal proceedings  
Risk factors/forward looking statements  
Risks relating to our restatements and related matters  
Risks relating to our business  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations  
You should read this Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operation, or MD&A, in combination with  
the accompanying audited consolidated financial statements prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the  
United States, or U.S. GAAP. As discussed herein, this MD&A gives effect to the Second Restatement as described below in “Developments in  
2003 and 2004 — Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters” and in “Restatement” in note 3 of the  
accompanying audited consolidated financial statements. A number of our and Nortel Networks Limited’s past filings with the United States  
Securities and Exchange Commission, or SEC, remain subject to ongoing review by the SEC’s Division of Corporation Finance. In addition,  
the Second Restatement involved the restatement of our consolidated financial statements for 2001 and 2002 and the first, second and third  
quarters of 2003. Amendments to our prior filings with the SEC would be required in order for us to be in full compliance with our reporting  
obligations under the Exchange Act. However, we do not believe that it will be feasible to amend our Annual Report on Form 10-K/A for the  
year ended December 31, 2002, or 2002 Form 10-K/A, and our 2003 Form 10-Qs due to, among other factors, identified material weaknesses  
in our internal control over financial reporting, the significant turnover in our finance personnel, changes in accounting systems,  
documentation weaknesses, a likely inability to obtain third party corroboration in certain cases due to the substantial industry adjustment in  
recent years and the passage of time generally. In addition, disclosure in the 2002 Form 10-K/A and 2003 Form 10-Qs would in large part  
repeat the disclosure expected to be contained in this report and the 2004 Form 10-Qs. Accordingly, we do not plan to amend our 2002 Form  
10-K/A and 2003 Form 10-Qs. We believe that we have included in this report all information needed for current investor understanding.  
Ongoing SEC review may require us to amend this Annual Report on Form 10-K or our other public filings further. See “Risk factors/forward  
looking statements”.  
This section contains forward looking statements and should be read in conjunction with the risk factors described below under “Risk  
factors/forward looking statements”. All dollar amounts in this MD&A are in millions of United States, or U.S., dollars unless otherwise  
stated.  
Where we say “we”, “us”, “our” or “Nortel Networks”, we mean Nortel Networks Corporation or Nortel Networks Corporation and its  
subsidiaries, as applicable, and where we refer to the “industry”, we mean the telecommunications industry.  
Business overview  
Our business  
Nortel Networks is a recognized leader in delivering communications capabilities that enhance the human experience, ignite and power global  
commerce, and secure and protect the world’s most critical information. Serving both service provider and enterprise customers, we deliver  
innovative technology solutions encompassing end-to-end broadband, Voice over IP, multimedia services and applications, and wireless  
broadband solutions designed to help people solve the world’s greatest challenges. Our business consists of the design, development,  
manufacture, assembly, marketing, sale, licensing, installation, servicing and support of these networking solutions. A substantial portion of  
our business has a technology focus and is dedicated to research and development, or R&D. This focus forms a core strength and is a factor  
that we believe differentiates us from many of our competitors. We envision a networked society where people are able to connect and interact  
with information and with each other instantly, simply and reliably, accessing data, voice and multimedia communications services and sharing  
experiences anywhere, anytime.  
The common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation are publicly traded on the New York Stock Exchange, or NYSE, and Toronto Stock  
Exchange, or TSX, under the symbol “NT”. Nortel Networks Limited, or NNL is our principal direct operating subsidiary and its results are  
consolidated into our results. Nortel Networks holds all of NNL’s outstanding common shares but none of its outstanding preferred shares.  
NNL’s preferred shares are reported in minority interests in subsidiary companies in the consolidated balance sheets and dividends and the  
related taxes on preferred shares are reported in minority interests — net of tax in the consolidated statements of operations.  
Our segments  
During 2003 and up to September 30, 2004, our operations were organized into four reportable segments as follows:  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Wireless Networks — Our Wireless Networks segment provides communications networks that enable end-users to be mobile  
while they send and receive voice and data communications using wireless devices, such as cellular telephones, personal digital  
assistants and other computing and communications devices. Our Wireless Networks customers are wireless service providers, and  
their customers are the subscribers for wireless communications services.  
Enterprise Networks — Our Enterprise Networks segment provides data, voice and multimedia communications solutions for our  
enterprise customers. Our Enterprise Networks customers consist of a broad range of enterprise customers around the world,  
including large businesses and their branch offices, small businesses and home offices, as well as government agencies, educational  
and other institutions and utility organizations.  
Wireline Networks — Our Wireline Networks segment addresses the demand by our service provider customers for cost efficient  
data, voice and multimedia communications solutions. We offer our Wireline Networks products and services to a wide range of  
wireline and wireless service providers around the world. Our service provider customers include local and long distance telephone  
companies, wireless service providers, cable operators and other communication service providers. We also provide services to our  
data networking and security customers which consist of system integrators that in turn build, operate and manage networks for  
their customers, such as businesses, government agencies and utility organizations.  
Optical Networks — Our Optical Networks segment solutions transport data, voice and multimedia communications within and  
between cities, countries or continents by transmitting communications signals in the form of light waves through fiber optic cables.  
Our Optical Networks business is primarily focused on offering our optical networking solutions to service providers around the  
world. The service provider customers for our optical networking products include local and long-distance telephone companies,  
cable operators, Internet service providers and other communications service providers.  
Effective October 1, 2004, we established a new streamlined organizational structure that included, among other things, combining the  
businesses of our four segments into two business organizations: (i) Carrier Networks and Global Operations, and (ii) Enterprise Networks. We  
are reviewing the impact of these changes on our reportable segments under Statement of Financial Accounting Standards, or SFAS, No. 131,  
“Disclosures about segments of an enterprise and related information”.  
Our business environment  
In 2001, we entered into an unprecedented period of business realignment in response to a significant adjustment in the industry. Industry  
demand for networking equipment dramatically declined in response to the industry adjustment, severe economic downturns in various regions  
around the world and a tightening in global capital markets. We implemented a company-wide restructuring plan to streamline our operations  
and activities around core markets and operations, which included significant workforce reductions, global real estate closures and dispositions,  
substantial write-downs of our capital assets, goodwill and other intangible assets and extensive contract settlements with customers and  
suppliers around the world. As a result of these actions, our workforce declined significantly from January 1, 2001 to December 31, 2003 and  
over the same time period, we significantly reduced our facilities. In 2003, customer spending remained cautious as a result of tightened capital  
markets mainly in the first half of 2003 and customers realigning capital spending with their current levels of revenues and profits in order to  
maximize their return on invested capital. We experienced continued industry adjustment and capital spending restrictions by our service  
provider customers. Also, excess network capacity and competition continued to exist in the industry which led to continued pricing pressures  
on the sale of certain of our products.  
During the second half of 2003 and in 2004, we began to experience a period of relative industry stability. Throughout the second half of 2003  
and in 2004, we announced several new contracts across all of our reportable segments, but primarily in our Wireless Networks segment, as  
certain service provider customers began to expand and upgrade their existing networks. In 2004, however, we continued to experience pricing  
pressures on sales of certain products across all of our reportable segments primarily as a result of increased competition.  
As first announced on August 19, 2004, we have put in place a new strategic plan that recognizes these industry dynamics and the evolution of  
the converged network (see “Our strategic plan and outlook”). In an increasingly cost-competitive environment, we are taking steps that we  
believe will better position us to grow market share and improve our results and cash generation. As part of our strategic plan, we also  
announced a focused workforce reduction of approximately 3,250 employees.  
In May 2003, we commenced certain balance sheet reviews at the direction of certain members of former management that led to a  
comprehensive review and analysis of our assets and liabilities, or the Comprehensive Review, which resulted in the  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
restatement (effected in December 2003) of our consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2002, 2001 and 2000 and  
for the quarters ended March 31, 2003 and June 30, 2003, or the First Restatement. In late October 2003, the Audit Committees of our and  
NNL’s Boards of Directors, or the Audit Committee, initiated an independent review of the facts and circumstances leading to the First  
Restatement, or the Independent Review, and engaged the law firm now known as Wilmer Cutler Pickering Hale & Dorr LLP, or WCPHD, to  
advise it in connection with the Independent Review. The Audit Committee sought to gain a full understanding of the events that caused  
significant excess liabilities to be maintained on the balance sheet that needed to be restated, and to recommend that our Board of Directors  
adopt, and direct management to implement, necessary remedial measures to address personnel, controls, compliance and discipline. In  
January 2005, the Audit Committee reported the findings of the Independent Review, together with its recommendations for governing  
principles for remedial measures that were developed for the Audit Committee by WCPHD. Each of our and NNL’s Boards of Directors has  
adopted these recommendations in their entirety and directed our management to develop a detailed plan and timetable for their  
implementation, and will monitor their implementation.  
As the Independent Review progressed, the Audit Committee directed new corporate management to examine in depth the concerns identified  
by WCPHD regarding provisioning activity and to review certain provision releases. That examination, and other errors identified by  
management, led to the restatement (effected today) of our financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001 and the  
quarters ended March 31, 2003 and 2002, June 30, 2003 and 2002 and September 30, 2003 and 2002, or the Second Restatement, and our  
revision of previously announced unaudited results for the year ended December 31, 2003. The need for the Second Restatement resulted in  
delays in filing our and NNL’s 2003 Annual Reports on Form 10-K, or the 2003 Annual Reports, and Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q for the  
first, second and third quarters of 2004, or the 2004 Quarterly Reports, beyond the SEC’s required filing dates in 2004. We refer to the 2003  
Annual Reports and the 2004 Quarterly Reports together as the Reports.  
Over the course of the Second Restatement process, management identified certain accounting practices that it determined should be adjusted  
as part of the Second Restatement. In particular, management identified certain errors related to revenue recognition and undertook a process of  
revenue reviews. As described in more detail in the “Controls and Procedures” section of this report, in light of the resulting adjustments to  
revenues previously reported in relevant periods, the Audit Committee has determined to review the facts and circumstances leading to the  
restatement of these revenues for specific transactions identified in the Second Restatement. This review will have a particular emphasis on the  
underlying conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues. The Audit Committee will seek a full understanding of the historic  
events that required the revenues for these specific transactions to be restated and will consider any appropriate additional remedial measures,  
including those involving internal controls and processes. The Audit Committee has engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection with this  
review. See “Risk factors/forward looking statements.”  
Over the course of the Second Restatement, we and our independent auditors identified a number of material weaknesses in our internal control  
over financial reporting. Further, in connection with the Independent Review, we terminated for cause our former president and chief executive  
officer, former chief financial officer and former controller in April 2004 and seven additional senior finance employees with significant  
responsibilities for our financial reporting as a whole or for their respective business units and geographic areas in August 2004. We are subject  
to significant pending civil litigation and ongoing regulatory and criminal investigations in the U.S. and Canada, which could require us to pay  
substantial judgments, settlements, fines or other penalties.  
We are currently in a challenging transitional period in connection with the completion of our restatement activity and as we implement the  
new strategic plan. We believe that our strategic plan will enable us to build on our market leadership in developing the converged networks of  
the future and improve business efficiency and operating cost performance in an increasingly competitive market.  
How we measure performance  
Each reportable segment is allocated resources and assets based on whether projected customer demand would support additional investment.  
We make adjustments to reduce resources and assets within a reportable segment in response to market conditions or where opportunities for  
improved efficiencies present themselves.  
Our president and chief executive officer, or CEO, has been identified as the chief operating decision maker in assessing the performance of  
the segments and the allocation of resources to the segments. Each reportable segment is managed separately with each segment manager  
reporting directly to the CEO. The CEO relies on the information derived directly from our management reporting system. In 2003, we  
reported that the primary financial measure used by the former chief operating decision maker in assessing performance and allocating  
resources to the segments was contribution margin, a measure that was comprised of gross profit less selling, general and administrative  
expense, or SG&A. In April 2004, our and NNL’s boards of directors appointed a new CEO. Commencing in the second quarter of 2004, the  
primary financial measure used by our CEO in assessing performance and allocating resources to the segments is management earnings  
(loss) before income taxes, or Management EBT, a measure that includes contribution margin, R&D expense, interest expense, other income  
(expense) — net, minority interest — net of tax and equity in net loss of associated companies — net of tax. As a result of the change in the  
primary financial measure used to assess the performance of our segments during the period in which the  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reports have been delayed, and because both contribution margin and Management EBT were available to the former chief operating decision  
maker during 2003, we have determined that it is appropriate to disclose both contribution margin and Management EBT for the periods  
presented. See “Segment information — General description” in note 6 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
From a liquidity perspective, we maintain strict controls over our sources and uses of cash. We also focus on the liquidity and cash flows of our  
customers in an effort to minimize our credit risk. We closely monitor our inventory levels, both in our manufacturing facilities as well as at  
our contract manufacturers, in an effort to minimize our exposure to excess supply and subsequent cash costs incurred as a result of excess  
capacity.  
Our strategic plan and outlook  
On August 19, 2004, we announced a new strategic plan intended to enable us to build on our market leadership in developing the converged  
networks of the future and improve business efficiency and operating cost performance in an increasingly competitive market. We provided  
further details concerning the strategic plan on September 30, 2004 and December 14, 2004. It is our intention to be optimally positioned to  
maximize strategic opportunities as they arise and leverage our acknowledged strengths in high reliability networks and strong customer  
loyalty. We continue to drive our business forward with a focus on costs, cash and revenues as strategic goals. We remain committed to our  
business strategy of technology and solutions evolution in helping our customers transform their networks and implement new applications and  
services to drive improved productivity, reduced costs and revenue growth.  
The principal components of the strategic plan are:  
a renewed commitment to best corporate practices and ethical conduct, including the establishment of the office of a chief ethics and  
compliance officer, which has been filled on an interim basis pending the permanent appointment of Susan E. Shepard, as now  
announced;  
a streamlined organizational structure to reflect alignment with carrier converged networks;  
an increased focus on the enterprise market and customers;  
optimized R&D programs for highly secure, available and reliable converged networks;  
the establishment of a chief strategy officer to drive partnerships, new markets and acquisitions;  
the establishment of a chief marketing officer to drive overall marketing strategy;  
the strategic review of embedded services to assess opportunities in the professional services business; and  
a distinct focus on government and defense customers.  
Our strategic plan also includes a work plan involving focused workforce reductions of approximately 3,250 employees, a voluntary retirement  
program, real estate optimization and other cost containment actions such as reductions in information services costs, outsourced services and  
other discretionary spending. Our workforce actions are focused to disproportionately protect customer and sales facing roles as well as  
continue our focus on new innovative solutions. Approximately 64% of employee actions related to the focused workforce reduction were  
completed by the end of 2004, including approximately 55% that were notified of termination or acceptance of voluntary retirement, with the  
remainder comprised of voluntary attrition of employees that were not replaced. The remainder of employee actions are expected to be  
completed by June 30, 2005. In addition, however, the Company continues to hire in certain strategic areas such as investments in the finance  
organization. These focused headcount reductions are intended to result in ongoing cost reductions in R&D and SG&A expenses and cost of  
sales. These actions are subject to the completion of required jurisdictional consultation and regulatory approvals. This workforce reduction is  
in addition to the workforce reduction that will result from our agreement with Flextronics International Ltd., or Flextronics (for more  
information, see “Evolution of our supply chain strategy”). We expect the real estate actions to be completed by the end of 2005.  
We estimate charges to the income statement associated with our overall work plan in the aggregate of approximately $450 comprised of  
approximately $220 with respect to the workforce reductions and approximately $230 with respect to the real estate actions. No charges are  
expected to be recorded with respect to the other cost containment actions. Approximately 25% of the aggregate income statement charges  
were incurred in 2004 with the remainder expected to be incurred in 2005.  
The associated cash costs of the work plan of approximately $430 are expected to be split approximately equally between the workforce  
reductions and real estate actions. Approximately 10% of these cash costs were incurred in 2004 and approximately 40% are expected to be  
incurred in 2005. The remaining 50% of the cash costs relates to the real estate actions and are expected be incurred in 2006 through to 2022  
for ongoing lease costs related to impacted real estate facilities.  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In addition to the above, we also expect to incur capital cash costs of approximately $50 in 2005 for facility improvements related to the real  
estate actions.  
We anticipate cost savings from the implementation of the work plan of approximately $500 in 2005, which is expected to increase on an  
annualized basis beyond 2005 as the full impact of the work plan is realized. We expect that this work plan will primarily be funded with cash  
from operations.  
We expect that our consolidated revenues in 2004 will be slightly lower compared with 2003. The 2003 consolidated revenues included  
revenues that were deferred from prior periods. We see growth opportunities in emerging markets such as China and India. Further, we believe  
security and reliability for service provider networks are increasingly important to governments, defense interests and enterprises around the  
world.  
Developments in 2003 and 2004  
2003 consolidated results summary  
During 2003, we began to experience a period of relative industry stability following an unprecedented period of business realignment that  
commenced in 2001 in response to a significant industry adjustment. In 2003, our consolidated revenues were $3,266 in the fourth quarter,  
$2,344 in the third quarter, $2,285 in the second quarter and $2,298 in the first quarter. Although our revenues declined 7% in 2003 ($10,193 in  
2003 compared to $11,008 in 2002), this decline represented a substantial improvement from the revenue decline of 42% experienced in 2002  
compared to 2001 ($11,008 in 2002 compared to $18,900 in 2001). As well, throughout the second half of 2003, we announced several new  
contracts across all of our reportable segments, but primarily in our Wireless Networks segment, as certain service provider customers began to  
expand and upgrade their existing networks.  
Our gross margin increased to 42.6% in 2003 compared to 35.5% in 2002, an improvement of approximately 7 percentage points. SG&A  
expense declined 24% in 2003 compared to 2002 and R&D expense declined 6% in 2003 compared to 2002. The percentage declines in SG&A  
and R&D expense were primarily due to actions taken to better align our expenses with the volume of business in 2003. Our R&D expense did  
not decline to the same extent as our SG&A expense on a percentage basis due to our technology focus and commitment to invest in next  
generation solutions. Special charges substantially declined in 2003 compared to 2002, primarily as a result of a substantial reduction in  
charges associated with workforce reductions and goodwill impairment related to our restructuring work plan initiated in 2001.  
Our discontinued operations contributed $184 of net earnings in 2003 compared to a net loss of $101 in 2002. The $184 of net earnings was  
primarily the result of the completion of a number of transactions in 2003 associated with the wind-down activities of our discontinued  
operations.  
As a result of these improvements, we reported net earnings before cumulative effect of accounting changes of $446 in 2003 compared to a net  
loss before cumulative effect of accounting changes of $2,994 in 2002.  
Throughout 2003, we maintained our strong liquidity position. In 2003, our cash and cash equivalents, or cash, increased $207 from $3,790 at  
December 31, 2002 to $3,997 at December 31, 2003. The improvement was primarily due to an increase in cash of $390 from our discontinued  
operations, an increase in cash of $85 from our operating activities and favorable foreign exchange impacts of $176. These increases in cash  
were partially offset by $359 of cash used in our financing activities and $85 used in our investing activities. As of December 31, 2003, our  
long term debt totaled $4,010.  
Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters  
Comprehensive Review and First Restatement  
In May 2003, we commenced certain balance sheet reviews at the direction of certain members of former management that led to the  
Comprehensive Review, which resulted in the First Restatement. See notes 3 and 23 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements  
and the “Controls and Procedures” section of this report.  
In connection with the Comprehensive Review, Deloitte & Touche LLP, or D&T, our independent auditors, informed the Audit Committee on  
July 24, 2003 of a “reportable condition” that did not constitute a “material weakness” in our internal  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
control over financial reporting (throughout this report, unless otherwise indicated, “reportable condition” and “material weakness” have the  
meanings as formerly set forth under standards established by the American Institute of Certified Public Accountants, or AICPA). Later, on  
November 18, 2003, as part of the communications by D&T to the Audit Committee with respect to D&T’s interim audit procedures for the  
year ended December 31, 2003, D&T informed the Audit Committee that it had identified certain reportable conditions, each of which  
constituted a material weakness in our internal control over financial reporting. These material weaknesses identified in the First Restatement  
were also later identified in connection with the Second Restatement together with certain additional material weaknesses in our internal  
control over financial reporting, as described in greater detail in the “Controls and Procedures” section of this report.  
Independent Review  
In late October 2003, the Audit Committee initiated the Independent Review and engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection with the  
Independent Review in order to gain a full understanding of the events that caused significant excess liabilities to be maintained on the balance  
sheet that needed to be restated, and to recommend that our Board of Directors adopt, and direct management to implement, necessary remedial  
measures to address personnel, controls, compliance and discipline. The Independent Review focused initially on events relating to the  
establishment and release of contractual liability and other related provisions (also called accruals reserves, or accrued liabilities) in the second  
half of 2002 and the first half of 2003, including the involvement of senior corporate leadership. As the Independent Review evolved, its focus  
broadened to include specific provisioning activities in each of the business units and geographic regions. In light of concerns raised in the  
initial phase of the Independent Review, the Audit Committee expanded the review to include provisioning activities in the third and fourth  
quarters of 2003.  
As discussed more fully in the “Controls and Procedures” section of this report, the Independent Review concluded that “[i]n summary, former  
corporate management (now terminated for cause) and former finance management (now terminated for cause) in the Company’s finance  
organization endorsed, and employees carried out, accounting practices relating to the recording and release of provisions that were not in  
compliance with [U.S. GAAP] in at least four quarters, including the third and fourth quarters of 2002 and the first and second quarters of  
2003. In three of those four quarters — when Nortel was at, or close to break even — these practices were undertaken to meet internally  
imposed... targets. While the dollar value of most of the individual provisions was relatively small, the aggregate value of the provisions made  
the difference between a profit and a reported loss, on a pro forma basis, in the fourth quarter of 2002 and the difference between a loss and a  
reported profit, on a pro forma basis, in the first and second quarters of 2003.”  
Second Restatement  
As the Independent Review progressed, the Audit Committee directed new corporate management to examine in depth the concerns identified  
by WCPHD regarding provisioning activity and to review provision releases, down to a low threshold. That examination, and other errors  
identified by management, led to the Second Restatement.  
Over the course of the Second Restatement process, management identified certain accounting practices that it determined should be adjusted  
as part of the Second Restatement. In particular, management identified certain errors related to revenue recognition and undertook a process of  
revenue reviews, resulting in adjustments to previously reported revenues during the periods 1999 through 2003. Other accounting practices  
that management examined and adjusted as part of the Second Restatement included, among other things the following:  
intercompany balances that did not eliminate upon consolidation and related provisions;  
our foreign exchange accounting, as part of the plan to address our identified material weakness related to foreign currency  
translation;  
the accounting treatment of the February 2001 acquisition of the 980 NPLC business from JDS Uniphase Corporation, or JDS, and  
the related OEM Purchase and Sale Agreement;  
special charges relating to goodwill, inventory impairment, contract settlement costs and other charges; and  
the accounting treatment of certain elements of discontinued operations.  
Years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001  
The following tables present the impact of the Second Restatement adjustments on our previously reported consolidated statements of  
operations data for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001. The Second Restatement adjustments related primarily to the following  
items, each of which reflect a number of related adjustments that have been aggregated for disclosure purposes, and are described in the  
paragraphs following the tables below. See “Restatement” in note 3 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
revenues and cost of revenues;  
foreign exchange;  
intercompany balances;  
special charges;  
other;  
reclassifications; and  
discontinued operations.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consolidated Statement of Operations data for the year ended December 31, 2002  
As previously  
reported  
Adjustments  
As restated  
Revenues  
Gross profit  
Operating earnings (loss)  
$
10,569  
3,771  
(3,435)  
$
439  
134  
363  
$
11,008  
3,905  
(3,072)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of  
associated companies  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss)  
(3,721)  
(3,286)  
20  
372  
393  
(121)  
272  
(3,349)  
(2,893)  
(101)  
(3,266)  
(2,994)  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
(0.86)  
0.01  
$
$
0.11  
(0.04)  
$
$
(0.75)  
(0.03)  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
(0.85)  
0.07  
(0.78)  
Consolidated Statement of Operations data for the year ended December 31, 2001  
As previously  
reported  
Adjustments  
As restated  
Revenues  
Gross profit  
$
17,408  
3,394  
$
1,492  
894  
$
18,900  
4,288  
Operating earnings (loss)  
(26,469)  
1,449  
(25,020)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of  
associated companies  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss)  
(27,176)  
(24,174)  
(2,996)  
1,339  
904  
529  
(25,837)  
(23,270)  
(2,467)  
(27,155)  
1,433  
(25,722)  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
(7.58)  
(0.94)  
$
$
0.28  
0.16  
$
$
(7.30)  
(0.78)  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
(8.52)  
0.44  
(8.08)  
Revenues and cost of revenues  
Revenues and cost of revenues were impacted by various errors related to revenue recognition, corrections to foreign exchange accounting,  
intercompany related items, special charges and other adjustments, including financial statement reclassifications. The net impact to revenues  
of the adjustments was an increase of $439 and $1,492 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. The net impact to cost  
of revenues related to these revenue adjustments, and the other corrections, was an increase of $305 and $598 for the years ended  
December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. The Second Restatement adjustments to revenues and cost of revenues related primarily to the  
following items:  
incorrect application of SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin, or SAB, No. 104, Revenue Recognition (preceded by SAB 101), or SAB  
104, or AICPA Statement of Position, or SOP, 97-2, Software Revenue Recognition, or SOP 97-2, the most significant of which  
related to revenue that should have been deferred until title or risk of loss had passed, or products had been delivered;  
incorrect recognition of revenue upon product delivery to a certain reseller; and  
various other adjustments, primarily related to specific contracts and transactions and errors related to non-cash incentives and  
concessions provided to customers.  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Foreign exchange  
As part of the plan to address a material weakness reported in our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2003, a  
review of foreign exchange accounting was undertaken. The net impact was a decrease to pre-tax loss of $63 and $132 for the years ended  
December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. The significant items were as follows:  
we re-examined the determination of the functional currency for certain entities based on the guidance under SFAS No. 52,  
“Foreign Currency Translation”, or SFAS No. 52. As a result, we identified four instances in which the functional currency  
designation of an entity was incorrect. These revisions resulted in increases or decreases to other income (expense) — net; and  
we identified two instances of incorrect treatment of foreign currency translation gains and losses arising from significant  
intercompany positions. The net impact of the adjustments was an increase or decrease to other income (expense) — net, with an  
offset to accumulated other comprehensive loss.  
Intercompany balances  
Historically, we had certain intercompany balances that did not eliminate upon consolidation , or out-of-balance positions, and had recorded  
provisions accordingly. As part of the Second Restatement, we reviewed these provisions and determined that they should not have been  
recorded. We recorded adjustments in the appropriate periods to reverse these provisions and to correct the significant out-of-balance positions.  
The net impact of the adjustments to correct the significant out-of-balance positions was a decrease of $36 and an increase of $42 to the  
previously reported pre-tax loss for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Special charges  
As part of the Second Restatement, we re-examined the components of special charges, and recorded decreases to special charges of $78 and  
$845 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. The adjustments are discussed below.  
The accounting for the deferred consideration associated with the acquisition of the 980 NPLC business from JDS and the related OEM  
Purchase and Sale Agreement in February 2001 was re-examined. Upon re-examination, it was determined that adjustments were required to  
reflect the appropriate purchase price and amount allocated to goodwill. The impact of the adjustments was a $473 decrease to special charges  
to reduce the goodwill impairment for the year ended December 31, 2001. Other impacts included a decrease to goodwill amortization of $52  
for the year ended December 31, 2001 and an increase to cost of revenues of $148 and $152 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001,  
respectively, with corresponding reversals of these amounts which were previously recorded against common shares.  
As part of the Second Restatement, we determined that adjustments were required for various other acquisitions to the amounts allocated to  
goodwill as a result of corrections to purchase accounting allocations, and to correct valuations of consideration paid. The impact of the  
adjustments to goodwill was a decrease to special charges of $222 to reduce the impairment of goodwill for the year ended December 31, 2001.  
Other impacts included an increase to deferred stock option compensation expense of $24 and $123 for the years ended December 31, 2002  
and 2001, respectively, and a decrease to goodwill amortization of $39 for the year ended December 31, 2001.  
Also as part of the Second Restatement, we reclassified inventory impairments of $89 to cost of revenues, previously incorrectly classified as  
special charges. We also determined that certain items were either recorded in special charges in error or, although correctly recorded when  
originally recognized, were not adjusted in the appropriate subsequent periods for changes in estimates and/or assumptions. The adjustments to  
special charges for these other items were an increase of $11 and a decrease of $150 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001,  
respectively.  
Other  
We recorded other adjustments primarily to correct certain accruals, provisions and other transactions, which were either initially recorded  
incorrectly in prior periods, or not properly released or adjusted for changes in estimates and/or assumptions in the appropriate subsequent  
periods. These adjustments decreased the net loss for the year ended December 31, 2002 by $314 and increased the net loss for the year ended  
December 31, 2001 by $59, and included tax and minority interests impacts of all Second Restatement adjustments.  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The adjustment to income tax benefit, substantially all as a result of the Second Restatement adjustments, was an increase of $15 and a  
decrease of $401 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. The adjustment to minority interests as a result of the Second  
Restatement adjustments was an increase of $26 and a decrease of $12 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Reclassifications  
As a result of the restatement process, various presentation inconsistencies were identified. Adjustments were made to appropriately reflect  
certain items in the statement of operations. The reclassifications were made for royalty expense, gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets,  
minority interests — net of tax (now reported separately), and other items including certain functional spending and specific expenses.  
Discontinued operations  
As a result of the restatement process, the initial provision for loss on disposal of the access solutions discontinued operations recorded in  
June 2001, and the subsequent activity during 2001 through 2004 were re-examined. We concluded that the net loss on disposal of operations  
recognized in the second quarter of 2001 was overstated by $738, of which $520 comprised items that should have been charged to continuing  
operations. In addition, other adjustments were necessary to correct certain items that were either initially recorded incorrectly, or not properly  
released or adjusted for changes in estimates in the appropriate periods subsequent to the second quarter of 2001. The net impact of all of these  
changes on net loss from discontinued operations — net of tax was an increase of $121 and a decrease of $529 for the years ended  
December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively, and an increase to net loss of $121 and $7 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001,  
respectively.  
First, second and third quarters of 2003  
The following tables present the impact of the Second Restatement adjustments on our previously reported consolidated statements of  
operations data for the first, second and third quarters of 2003 (the fourth quarter of 2003 had not been previously reported). The Second  
Restatement adjustments are described in the paragraphs following the tables below.  
Consolidated Statement of Operations data for the three months ended March 31, 2003  
As previously  
reported  
Adjustments  
As restated  
Revenues  
Gross profit  
Operating earnings (loss)  
$
2,377  
1,044  
(133)  
(182)  
(171)  
190  
$
(79)  
(149)  
(120)  
(31)  
(63)  
(68)  
$
2,298  
895  
(253)  
(213)  
(234)  
122  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of associated companies  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss)  
11  
(135)  
(124)  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
(0.04)  
0.04  
$
$
(0.02)  
(0.01)  
$
$
(0.06)  
0.03  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
0.00  
(0.03)  
(0.03)  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consolidated Statement of Operations data for the three months ended June 30, 2003  
As previously  
reported  
Adjustments As restated  
Revenues  
Gross profit  
Operating earnings (loss)  
$
2,338  
1,028  
90  
$
(53)  
(146)  
(186)  
(154)  
(131)  
(7)  
$
2,285  
882  
(96)  
(87)  
(93)  
(8)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of associated companies  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss)  
67  
38  
(1)  
37  
(138)  
(101)  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
0.01  
0.00  
$
$
(0.03)  
0.00  
$
$
(0.02)  
0.00  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
0.01  
(0.03)  
(0.02)  
Consolidated Statement of Operations data for the three months ended September 30, 2003  
As previously  
reported  
Adjustments As restated  
Revenues  
Gross profit  
Operating earnings (loss)  
$
2,266  
1,192  
124  
179  
130  
55  
$
78  
$
2,344  
1,130  
52  
147  
88  
(62)  
(72)  
(32)  
(42)  
(12)  
(54)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of associated companies  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss)  
43  
131  
185  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
0.03  
0.01  
$
$
(0.01)  
0.00  
$
$
0.02  
0.01  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
0.04  
(0.01)  
0.03  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consolidated Statement of Operations data for the nine months ended September 30, 2003  
As  
previously  
reported  
Adjustments  
As restated  
Revenues  
Gross profit  
Operating earnings (loss)  
$
6,981  
3,264  
81  
64  
(3)  
244  
233  
$
(54)  
(357)  
(378)  
(217)  
(236)  
(87)  
$
6,927  
2,907  
(297)  
(153)  
(239)  
157  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of associated companies  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss)  
(327)  
(94)  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
0.00  
0.05  
$
$
(0.06)  
(0.01)  
$
$
(0.06)  
0.04  
Basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
0.05  
(0.07)  
(0.02)  
Revenues and cost of revenues  
Revenues and cost of revenues were impacted by various errors related to revenue recognition, corrections to foreign exchange accounting,  
intercompany related items, special charges and other adjustments, including financial statement reclassifications. The net impact to revenues  
of the adjustments was a decrease of $79, a decrease of $53 and an increase of $78 for the first, second and third quarters of 2003, respectively.  
The net impact to cost of revenues related to these revenue adjustments, and the other corrections, was an increase of $70, $93 and $140 for the  
first, second, and third quarters of 2003, respectively. The Second Restatement adjustments to revenues and cost of revenues in each of these  
periods related primarily to the following items:  
incorrect application of SAB 104 or SOP 97-2, the most significant of which related to revenue that should have been deferred until  
title or risk of loss had passed, or products had been delivered;  
incorrect application of AICPA SOP 81-1, Accounting for Performance of Construction-Type and Certain Production-Type  
Contracts, or SOP 81-1, with respect to percentage-of-completion accounting for certain long-term constructions contracts; and  
various other adjustments, primarily related to specific contracts and transactions, including two transactions recorded in the first  
quarter of 2003 which should have been recorded in 2002.  
Foreign exchange  
As part of the plan to address a material weakness reported in our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended September 30, 2003, a  
review of foreign exchange accounting was undertaken. The net impact to pre-tax loss was a decrease of $91 and $15, and an increase of $8 for  
the first, second, and third quarters of 2003, respectively. The significant items were as follows:  
we re-examined the determination of the functional currency for certain entities based on the guidance under SFAS No. 52. As a  
result, we identified four instances in which the functional currency designation of an entity was incorrect. These revisions resulted  
in increases or decreases to other income (expense) — net;  
we identified two instances of incorrect treatment of significant intercompany positions. The net impact of the adjustments was an  
increase or decrease to other income (expense) — net, with an offset to accumulated other comprehensive loss; and  
we identified errors in the revaluation of certain foreign denominated customer financing provisions within discontinued operations,  
which increased other income and decreased net earnings from discontinued operations.  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Intercompany balances  
Historically, we had certain intercompany balances that did not eliminate upon consolidation, or out-of-balance positions, and had recorded  
provisions accordingly. As part of the Second Restatement, we reviewed these provisions and determined that they should not have been  
recorded. We recorded adjustments in the appropriate periods to reverse these provisions and to correct the significant out-of-balance positions.  
The net impact of these adjustments was an increase of $6, $14 and $3 to pre-tax loss for the first, second, and third quarters of 2003,  
respectively.  
Special charges  
As part of the Second Restatement, we reviewed the components of special charges and recorded an increase to special charges of $28, a  
decrease of $20 and an increase of $10 for the first, second and third quarters of 2003, respectively. We determined that certain items were  
either recorded in special charges in error or, although correctly recorded when originally recognized, were not adjusted in the appropriate  
subsequent periods for changes in estimates and/or assumptions. These items related to contract settlement costs, plant and equipment  
impairment costs, and severance and fringe benefit related costs.  
Other  
We recorded other adjustments primarily to correct certain accruals, provisions and other transactions, which were either initially recorded  
incorrectly in prior periods, or not properly released or adjusted for changes in estimates and/or assumptions in the appropriate subsequent  
periods. The impact of these adjustments was an increase of $7, $94 and $10 to the pre-tax loss for the first, second, and third quarters of 2003,  
respectively, primarily due to increased cost of revenues for customer and contract related accruals, warranty costs, and other accruals.  
Reclassifications  
As a result of the restatement process, various presentation inconsistencies were identified. Adjustments were made to appropriately reflect  
certain items in the statement of operations. The reclassifications were made for royalty expense, gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets,  
and other items including certain functional spending and specific expenses.  
Discontinued operations  
As a result of the restatement process, the initial provision for loss on disposal of the access solutions discontinued operations recorded in  
June 2001, and the subsequent activity during 2001 through 2004 were re-examined. We concluded that the net loss on disposal of operations  
recognized in the second quarter of 2001 was overstated by $738, of which $520 comprised items that should have been charged to continuing  
operations. In addition, other adjustments were necessary to correct certain items that were either initially recorded incorrectly, or not properly  
released or adjusted for changes in estimates in the appropriate periods subsequent to the second quarter of 2001. The net impact of all of these  
changes on net earnings from discontinued operations — net of tax was a decrease of $68, $7 and $12 for the first, second, and third quarters of  
2003, respectively. This was primarily due to the elimination of a gain in the first quarter of 2003 of $90 on redemption of an investment  
interest due to the reversal in an earlier period of a full valuation allowance that had been recorded against the investment interest when  
acquired.  
Material weaknesses in internal control over financial reporting identified in Second Restatement  
As described above and in the “Controls and Procedures” section of this report, two material weaknesses in our internal control over financial  
reporting were identified at the time of the First Restatement. Over the course of the Second Restatement, we and D&T identified a number of  
additional material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting, as further described in the “Controls and Procedures” section of  
this report. D&T confirmed to the Audit Committee these material weaknesses, listed below, on January 10, 2005:  
lack of compliance with written Nortel Networks procedures for monitoring and adjusting balances related to certain accruals and  
provisions, including restructuring charges and contract and customer accruals;  
lack of compliance with Nortel Networks procedures for appropriately applying applicable GAAP to the initial recording of certain  
liabilities including those described in SFAS No. 5, “Accounting for Contingencies”, or SFAS No. 5, and to foreign currency  
translation as described in SFAS No. 52;  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
lack of sufficient personnel with appropriate knowledge, experience and training in U.S. GAAP and lack of sufficient analysis and  
documentation of the application of U.S. GAAP to transactions, including but not limited to revenue transactions;  
lack of a clear organization and accountability structure within the accounting function, including insufficient review and  
supervision, combined with financial reporting systems that are not integrated and which require extensive manual interventions;  
lack of sufficient awareness of, and timely and appropriate remediation of, internal control issues by Nortel Networks personnel;  
and  
an inappropriate ‘tone at the top’, which contributed to the lack of a strong control environment; as reported in the Independent  
Review Summary set forth in the “Controls and Procedures” section of this report, there was a Management ‘tone at the top’ that  
conveyed the strong leadership message that earnings targets could be met through application of accounting practices that finance  
managers knew or ought to have known were not in compliance with U.S. GAAP and that questioning these practices was not  
acceptable”.  
Upon completion of management’s assessment of our internal control over financial reporting as at December 31, 2004 pursuant to SOX 404,  
we currently expect to conclude that the first five of these six Material Weaknesses continue to exist at December 31, 2004. We continue to  
identify, develop and begin to implement remedial measures to address them, as described in the ”Controls and Procedures“ section of this  
report. See also notes 3 and 23 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Revenue Independent Review  
Over the course of the Second Restatement process, management identified certain accounting practices that it determined should be adjusted  
as part of the Second Restatement. In particular, management identified certain errors related to revenue recognition and undertook a process of  
revenue reviews. In light of the resulting adjustments to revenues previously reported, the Audit Committee has determined to review the facts  
and circumstances leading to the restatement of these revenues for specific transactions identified in the Second Restatement. The review will  
have a particular emphasis on the underlying conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues. The Audit Committee will seek a full  
understanding of the historic events that required the revenues for these specific transactions to be restated and will consider any appropriate  
additional remedial measures, including those involving internal controls and processes. The Audit Committee has engaged WCPHD to advise  
it in connection with this review.  
Personnel actions  
In connection with the Independent Review, we have, among other actions, terminated for cause:  
our former president and chief executive officer, former chief financial officer and former controller in April 2004 (the former chief  
financial officer and former controller having been placed on paid leaves of absence in March 2004) and  
seven additional senior finance employees with significant responsibilities for our financial reporting as a whole or for their  
respective business units and geographic regions in August 2004.  
Each of these former members of management had responsibility for their respective positions at the time of the Comprehensive Review and  
First Restatement. The Board of Directors determined that each of these individuals had significant responsibilities for our financial reporting  
as a whole, or for their respective business units and geographic regions, and that each was aware, or ought to have been aware, that our  
provisioning activity, described above, did not comply with U.S. GAAP.  
EDC Support Facility  
The delayed filing of the Reports with the SEC, the trustees under our and NNL’s public debt indentures and Export Development Canada, or  
EDC, gave EDC the right to (i) terminate its commitments under the $750 EDC support facility, or the EDC Support Facility, relating to  
certain of our performance related obligations arising out of normal course business activities and (ii) exercise certain rights against the  
collateral pledged under related security agreements or require NNL to cash collateralize all existing support. NNL has obtained waivers from  
EDC with respect to these and related matters to permit continued access to the EDC Support Facility in accordance with its terms while we  
complete our filing obligations with respect to the Reports. The waivers have also applied to certain additional breaches under the EDC  
Support Facility relating to the delayed filings and the restatements and revisions to our and NNL’s prior financial results, or the Related  
Breaches. In connection with such waivers, EDC reclassified the previously committed $300 revolving small bond sub-facility of the EDC  
Support Facility as uncommitted support during the waiver period. The $300 revolving small bond facility will not become committed support  
until all of the Reports have been filed with the SEC and NNL obtains a permanent waiver of the Related Breaches.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
As we and NNL will not have filed all of the Reports by January 15, 2005, EDC will have the right, on such date, (absent a further waiver in  
relation to the delayed filings and the Related Breaches), to (i) terminate the EDC Support Facility (ii) exercise certain rights against collateral  
or require NNL to cash collaterize all existing support, or (iii) require NNL to cash collaterize all existing support.  
In addition, the Related Breaches will continue beyond the filing of the Reports. Accordingly, EDC will have the right (absent a further waiver  
of the Related Breaches) beginning on January 15, 2005 to terminate or suspend the EDC Support Facility or exercise certain rights against  
collateral notwithstanding the filing of the Reports. While NNL is seeking a permanent waiver from EDC in connection with the Related  
Breaches, there can be no assurance that NNL will receive any waiver or as to the terms of any such waiver.  
As of December 31, 2004, approximately $296 of outstanding support under the EDC Support Facility was outstanding, $212 of which was  
outstanding under the revolving small bond sub-facility. See “Available support facility” and “Risk factors/forward looking statements”.  
Credit facilities and security agreements  
On April 28, 2004, NNL terminated the NNL and Nortel Networks Inc., or NNI, $750 April 2000 five year credit facilities, or the Five Year  
Facilities. Absent such termination, the banks would have been permitted, upon 30 days’ notice, to terminate their commitments under the Five  
Year Facilities as a result of NNL’s failure to file the NNL 2003 Annual Report on Form 10-K by April 29, 2004. Upon termination, the Five  
Year Facilities were undrawn.  
As a result of the termination of the Five Year Facilities, certain foreign security agreements entered into by NNL and various of its  
subsidiaries, under which shares of certain subsidiaries of NNL incorporated outside of the U.S. and Canada were pledged in favor of the banks  
under the Five Year Facilities, EDC and the holders of our and NNL’s outstanding public debt securities, also terminated in accordance with  
their terms (see note 23 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements). In addition, the guarantees by certain subsidiaries of NNL  
incorporated outside of the U.S. and Canada terminated in accordance with their terms. Because certain of the foreign security agreements,  
including those relating to Nortel Networks S.A., were in place as of December 31, 2003, we have included Nortel Networks S.A. financial  
statements in this report notwithstanding the subsequent termination of these agreements. Security agreements remain in place under which  
substantially all of the assets of NNL located in the U.S. and Canada and those of most of its U.S. and Canadian subsidiaries, including the  
shares of certain of NNL’s U.S. and Canadian subsidiaries, are pledged in favor of EDC and the holders of our and NNL’s outstanding public  
debt securities. In addition, the guarantees by certain of NNL’s wholly owned subsidiaries, including NNI, most of NNL’s Canadian  
subsidiaries, Nortel Networks (Asia) Limited, Nortel Networks (Ireland) Limited and Nortel Networks U.K. Limited, of NNL’s obligations  
under the EDC Support Facility and our and NNL’s outstanding public debt securities, remain in place. See “Liquidity and capital resources”.  
Debt securities  
As a result of the delay in filing the Reports, we and NNL have not been in compliance with our obligations to deliver the Reports to the  
trustees under our and NNL’s public debt indentures. As of December 31, 2004, approximately $1,800 of notes of NNL (or its subsidiaries)  
and $1,800 of our convertible debt securities were outstanding.  
These delays have not resulted in an automatic event of default and acceleration of the outstanding long-term debt and such default and  
acceleration cannot occur unless notice by holders of at least 25% of the outstanding principal amount of any relevant series of debt securities  
of such non-compliance is provided to us or NNL, as applicable, and we or NNL, as applicable, fail to file and deliver the relevant Report  
within 90 days after such notice is provided, all in accordance with the terms of the indentures. While such notice could have been given at any  
time after March 30, 2004, neither we nor NNL has received a notice to the date of this report. As a result of the continuing delay in filing  
certain of our Reports, we and NNL continue to be in breach of our obligations under our and NNL’s public debt indentures, as described  
above. If notice were given and acceleration of our debt securities were to occur, we may be unable to meet our payment obligations.  
Based on publicly available information, we have reason to believe that more than 25% of the outstanding principal amount of the $150 of  
7.875% notes due June 2026 issued by a subsidiary of NNL and guaranteed by us are held by one holder, or a group of related holders. Other  
than with respect to that series of debt securities, based on such publicly available information, neither we nor NNL are aware of any holder, or  
group of related holders, that holds at least 25% of the outstanding principal amount of any relevant series of debt securities. However, based  
on such publicly available information, we have reason to believe that there is sufficient concentration among holders of the $150 of 7.40%  
notes due June 2006 issued by NNL that the acquisition of a relatively small additional amount of these notes by certain holders could  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
result in a holder or a group of related holders holding 25% or more of the outstanding principal amount of these notes. See “Liquidity and  
capital resources” and “Risk factors/forward looking statements”.  
Shelf registration statement  
Owing to the delayed filing of the Reports, we are currently unable to use, in its current form, the remaining approximately $800 of capacity  
under our shelf registration statement filed with the SEC for various types of securities. See “Liquidity and capital resources” and “Risk  
factors/forward looking statements”.  
Credit ratings  
On April 28, 2004, Standard and Poor’s, or S&P, downgraded its ratings on NNL, including its long-term corporate credit ratings from “B” to  
“B-” and its preferred shares rating from “CCC” to “CCC-”. At the same time, it revised its outlook to developing from negative. On April 28,  
2004, Moody’s Investors Service, Inc., or Moody’s, changed its outlook to potential downgrade from uncertain. See “Credit ratings” and “Risk  
factors/forward looking statements”.  
Regulatory actions and pending litigation  
We are under investigation by the SEC and the Ontario Securities Commission, or OSC, Enforcement Staff. In addition, Nortel Networks has  
received a U.S. federal grand jury subpoena for the production of certain documents sought in connection with an ongoing criminal  
investigation being conducted by the U.S. Attorney’s Office for the Northern District of Texas, Dallas Division. Further, the Integrated Market  
Enforcement Team of the Royal Canadian Mounted Police, or RCMP, has advised us that it would be commencing a criminal investigation  
into our financial accounting situation. We will continue to cooperate fully with all authorities in connection with these investigations and  
reviews. See “Legal proceedings” and “Risk factors/forward looking statements”.  
In addition, numerous class action complaints have been filed against Nortel Networks, including class action complaints under the Employee  
Retirement Income Security Act, or ERISA. In addition, a derivative action complaint has been filed against Nortel Networks. These pending  
civil litigation actions and regulatory and criminal investigations are significant and if decided against us, could materially adversely affect our  
financial condition and liquidity by requiring us to pay substantial judgments, settlements, fines or other penalties. See “Liquidity and capital  
resources”, “Legal proceedings” and “Risk factors/forward looking statements”.  
On May 31, 2004, the OSC issued a final order prohibiting all trading by our directors, officers and certain current and former employees in the  
securities of Nortel Networks Corporation and NNL. This order will remain in effect until two full business days following the receipt by the  
OSC of all filings required to be made by us and NNL pursuant to Ontario securities laws.  
We and NNL continue to provide periodic updates to the NYSE and the TSX concerning our and NNL’s delay in filing certain of the Reports.  
The NYSE granted us and NNL an extension of up to March 31, 2005 to file our 2003 Annual Reports, during which the Nortel Networks  
Corporation common shares and our and NNL’s other securities remain listed on the NYSE. To the date of this report, neither the NYSE nor  
the TSX has commenced any suspension or delisting procedures in respect of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares or other of our or  
NNL’s listed securities. The commencement of any suspension or delisting procedure by either exchange remains, at all times, at the discretion  
of such exchange, and would be publicly announced by the exchange. See “Risk factors/forward looking statements”.  
Stock-based compensation plans  
As a result of our March 10, 2004 announcement that we and NNL would need to delay the filing of our 2003 Annual Reports, we suspended  
as of March 10, 2004: the purchase of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares under the stock purchase plans for eligible employees in  
eligible countries that facilitate the acquisition of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares; the exercise of outstanding options granted  
under the Nortel Networks Corporation 2000 Stock Option Plan, or the 2000 Plan, or Nortel Networks Corporation 1986 Stock Option Plan as  
amended and restated, or the 1986 Plan, or the grant of any additional options under those plans, or the exercise of outstanding options granted  
under employee stock option plans previously assumed by us in connection with mergers and acquisitions; and the purchase of units in a Nortel  
Networks stock fund or purchase of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares under our defined contribution and investments plans, until  
such time as, at the earliest, that we are in compliance with U.S. and Canadian regulatory securities filing requirements.  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Evolution of our supply chain strategy  
Over the last five years, we have divested most of our manufacturing activities to Electronic Manufacturing Services, or EMS, suppliers. On  
June 29, 2004, we announced an agreement with Flextronics regarding the divestiture of substantially all of our remaining manufacturing  
operations, including product integration, testing and repair operations carried out in our Systems Houses in Calgary and Montreal, Canada and  
Campinas, Brazil, as well as certain activities related to these locations, including the management of the supply chain, related suppliers, and  
third-party logistics. In Europe, Flextronics has made an offer to purchase similar operations at our Monkstown, Northern Ireland and  
Chateaudun, France Systems Houses, subject to the completion of the required information and consultation process.  
Under the terms of the agreement and offer, Flextronics will also acquire our global repair services, as well as certain design assets in Ottawa,  
Canada and Monkstown related to hardware and embedded software design, and related product verification for certain established optical  
products.  
We have entered into a four year supply agreement with Flextronics for manufacturing services (whereby Flextronics will manage  
approximately $2,500 of our annual cost of sales) and a three year supply agreement for design services. The transfer of the optical design  
operations and related assets in Ottawa and Monkstown closed in the fourth quarter of 2004. The portions of the transaction related to the  
manufacturing activities in Montreal and Calgary are expected to close in the first and second quarters of 2005, respectively. The balance of the  
transaction is expected to close on separate dates occurring during the first half of 2005. These transactions are subject to customary conditions  
and regulatory approvals.  
The successful completion of the agreement and offer with Flextronics will result in the transfer of approximately 2,500 of our employees to  
Flextronics. We expect to receive cash proceeds ranging from approximately $675 to $725, which will be allocated to each separate closing  
and, with respect to each closing, will be paid on an installment basis up to nine months thereafter. Such payments will be subject to a number  
of adjustments, including from potential post-closing date asset valuations and potential post-closing indemnity payments. Flextronics also has  
the ability in certain cases to exercise rights to sell back to us certain inventory and equipment after the expiration of a specified period (of up  
to fifteen months) following each respective closing date. We do not expect such rights to be exercised with respect to any material amount of  
inventory and/or equipment. The cash proceeds estimate is comprised of approximately $475 to $525 for inventory and equipment and $200  
for intangible assets. The cash proceeds would be partially offset by related estimated transaction costs (including transition, potential  
severance, and information technology implementation and real estate costs) of approximately $200.  
We also announced that we plan to create Solutions Operations Centers in Calgary and Montreal and, pending the completion of information  
and consultation processes in Europe, in Monkstown and Chateaudun. These centers are expected to have overall responsibility for the strategic  
management and control of our various supply chains, including all customer interfaces, customer service, order management, quality  
assurance, product cost management, new product introduction, and network solutions integration, testing and fulfillment.  
We believe that the use of an outsourced manufacturing model has enabled us to benefit from leading manufacturing technologies, leverage  
existing resources from around the world, lower our cost of sales, quickly adjust to fluctuations in market demand and decrease our investment  
in plant, equipment and inventories. We continue to retain in-house all strategic management and overall control responsibilities associated  
with our various supply chains, including all customer interfaces, customer service, order management, quality assurance, product cost-  
management, new product introduction, and network solutions integration, testing and fulfillment.  
Other business developments  
Shareholder rights plan  
At our Annual and Special Shareholders’ Meeting on April 24, 2003, our shareholders approved the reconfirmation and amendment of our  
shareholder rights plan which will expire at the Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held in 2006 unless it is reconfirmed at that time. Under  
the shareholder rights plan, one right for each Nortel Networks Corporation common share outstanding may be issued. These rights become  
exercisable upon the occurrence of certain events associated with an unsolicited takeover bid.  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ownership adjustment in our French and German operations  
On September 18, 2003, consistent with our overall global business strategy, we realigned our business activities in France and Germany by  
increasing our ownership in our core businesses in these countries. As a result of this realignment, we acquired the 42% minority interest in  
Nortel Networks Germany GmbH & Co. KG and the 45% minority interest in Nortel Networks France S.A.S., or NNF, previously held by  
European Aeronautic Defence and Space Company EADS N.V., or EADS, our former partner in three European joint ventures. At the  
completion of these transactions, our ownership in each company increased to 100%. These companies are responsible for the sales and  
marketing of our products in Germany and France. At the same time, EADS increased its ownership in EADS Telecom S.A.S. (formerly  
EADS Defence and Security Networks S.A.S.), or EADS Telecom, from 59% to 100% as a result of acquiring our equity ownership in that  
company. For additional information, see “Nortel Networks Germany and Nortel Networks France” in note 10 of the accompanying  
consolidated financial statements.  
Customer financing commitments  
During 2003, we reduced our undrawn customer financing commitments by $651 primarily as a result of the expiration or cancellation of  
commitments and changing customer business plans. As of December 31, 2003, approximately $108 of the $177 in undrawn commitments was  
not available for funding under the terms of our financing agreements. For additional information, see “Customer financing”.  
Sale of Entrust shares  
On February 3, 2004, we sold approximately 7 million common shares of Entrust Inc., or Entrust, for cash consideration of $33, resulting in a  
gain of $18. In connection with this transaction, we no longer hold any equity interest in Entrust.  
Real estate  
On March 1, 2004, we purchased land and two buildings for $87 that were previously leased by us, which leases expired on February 28, 2004.  
As a result, we extinguished a debt of $87.  
Customer contract settlement  
On May 7, 2004, we received $80 in proceeds from the sale of certain assets in connection with a customer contract settlement in Latin  
America. This resulted in a gain of $78, which will be included in (gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets for the three months ended  
June 30, 2004.  
Directory and operator services business  
On August 2, 2004, we completed the contribution of certain assets and liabilities of our directory and operator services, or DOS, business to  
VoltDelta, Resources LLC, or VoltDelta, a wholly owned subsidiary of Volt Information Sciences, Inc., or VIS, in return for a 24% interest in  
VoltDelta. After a period of two years, we and VIS each have an option to cause us to sell our VoltDelta shares to VIS for proceeds ranging  
from $25 to $70. As a result of this transaction, approximately 160 of our DOS employees in North America and Mexico joined VoltDelta. We  
recorded a gain on sale of businesses and assets of approximately $50 in the third quarter of 2004.  
Bharat Sanchar Nigram Limited contract  
In August 2004, we entered into a contract with Bharat Sanchar Nigram Limited to establish a wireless network in India. Our commitments to  
date for orders received under this contract have resulted in an estimated project loss of approximately $130, which has been recorded in the  
third quarter of 2004.  
Patent infringement settlement  
On October 26, 2004, we entered into an agreement with Foundry Networks, Inc., or Foundry, to settle outstanding patent infringement claims  
and counterclaims by us and Foundry. As part of the settlement, we granted Foundry a four year license under certain patents and Foundry paid  
$35 to us.  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer financing arrangements  
On December 15 and 16, 2004, we sold certain notes receivable and convertible notes receivable that had been received as a result of the  
restructuring of a customer financing arrangement for cash proceeds of $116. The net carrying amount of the notes receivable and convertible  
notes receivable was $56.  
On December 23, 2004, a customer financing arrangement was restructured. The notes receivable that were restructured had a net carrying  
amount as of December 31, 2003 of $13, net of provisions for doubtful accounts of $147 ($55 of the provision is included in discontinued  
operations). We are currently assessing the value of the restructured notes receivable and expect that an increase in value from the net carrying  
amount has occurred.  
Results of operations — continuing operations  
Segment revenues  
The following table summarizes our revenues for 2003, 2002 and 2001 by segment:  
For the years ended December 31,  
2003 vs 2002  
$ Change % Change  
2002 vs 2001  
2003  
2002  
2001  
$ Change  
% Change  
Wireless Networks  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
$
4,389  
2,589  
2,005  
1,179  
$
4,161  
2,422  
2,572  
1,820  
$
$
5,699  
3,222  
4,328  
5,050  
$
228  
167  
(567)  
(641)  
(2)  
5
7
(22)  
$
(1,538)  
(800)  
(1,756)  
(3,230)  
(568)  
(27)  
(25)  
(41)  
(64)  
(35)  
(a)  
Other  
31  
33  
601  
(6)  
(7)  
(95)  
$
10,193  
$
11,008  
18,900  
$
(815)  
$
(7,892)  
(42)  
Consolidated  
“Other” represented miscellaneous business activities and corporate functions.  
Geographic revenues  
The following table summarizes our geographic revenues based on the location of the customer:  
For the years ended December 31,  
2003 vs 2002  
$ Change % Change  
2002 vs 2001  
2003  
2002  
2001  
$ Change  
% Change  
United States  
EMEA  
Canada  
$
$
5,424  
2,366  
587  
1,307  
509  
$
$
5,823  
2,500  
648  
1,483  
554  
$
$
10,136  
$
(399)  
(134)  
(61)  
(176)  
(45)  
(7)  
(5)  
(9)  
$
(4,313)  
(1,880)  
(428)  
(806)  
(465)  
(43)  
(a)  
4,380  
1,076  
2,289  
(43)  
(40)  
(35)  
Asia Pacific  
(12)  
(b)  
CALA  
1,019  
(8)  
(7)  
(46)  
10,193  
11,008  
18,900  
$
(815)  
$
(7,892)  
(42)  
Consolidated  
(a)  
(b)  
The Europe, Middle East and Africa region, or EMEA.  
The Caribbean and Latin America region, or CALA.  
Consolidated revenues  
The following chart summarizes our quarterly revenues during 2003 and 2002:  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2003 vs. 2002  
Our consolidated revenues declined 7% in 2003 compared to 2002. There were substantial declines in Wireline Networks and Optical  
Networks while Wireless Networks increased 5% and Enterprise Networks increased 7%. The decline was primarily due to the continued  
industry adjustment and capital spending restrictions experienced by our service provider customers. As well, the decline in 2003 was  
attributable to tightened capital markets mainly experienced in the first half of 2003 as customer spending remained cautious, with many of our  
customers realigning capital spending with their current levels of revenues and profits in order to maximize their return on invested capital.  
Many of our customers continued to focus on conserving capital, decreasing their debt levels, reducing costs and/or increasing the capacity  
utilization rates and efficiency of existing networks. Also, excess network capacity and competition continued to exist in the industry which led  
to continued pricing pressures on the sale of certain of our products.  
From a geographic perspective, the 7% decline in revenues in 2003 compared to 2002 was due to a:  
7% decline in revenues in the U.S. primarily due to capital spending restrictions experienced by our service provider customers and  
their focus on capital and cash flow management in 2003 as well as tightened capital markets mainly during the first half of 2003.  
This was partially offset by the release of certain software including the general availability of Succession 3.0 in the fourth quarter  
of 2003 which triggered the recognition of associated revenues deferred from prior periods. In addition, revenues increased due to  
the recognition of deferred revenues associated with certain data switch upgrades. Further, Global System for Mobile  
communications, or GSM, and Code Division Multiple Access, or CDMA, customers upgraded and expanded their existing  
networks in the second half of 2003;  
12% decline in revenues in Asia Pacific due to capital spending restrictions by our service provider customers;  
5% decline in revenues in EMEA primarily due to capital spending restrictions by service provider and enterprise customers and  
tightened capital markets mainly during the first half of 2003 which was partially offset by increases in revenue related to new  
GSM contracts with certain service providers and the impact of favorable foreign exchange effects associated with the euro;  
9% decline in revenues in Canada primarily due to capital spending restrictions experienced by our service provider customers and  
their focus on capital and cash flow management, the completion of certain customer deployments as well as tightened capital  
markets mainly during the first half of 2003, which was partially offset by the impact of favorable foreign exchange effects  
associated with the Canadian dollar; and  
8% decline in revenues in CALA primarily due to the completion of a major contract in the first quarter of 2002 and continued  
capital spending restrictions experienced by our service provider customers, which was partially offset by increases in revenue  
related to new GSM contracts with certain service providers.  
2002 vs. 2001  
Our consolidated revenues declined 42% in 2002 compared to 2001. Following a period of rapid infrastructure build-out and strong economic  
growth in 1999 and 2000, we saw severe economic downturns in various regions around the world and a continued tightening in the global  
capital markets and slowdown in the industry throughout 2001. Our revenues declined sequentially in 2001 due to lower capital spending by  
industry participants and substantially less demand for our products and services as customers focused on maximizing their return on invested  
capital. During 2002, we continued to see these constraints on capital expenditures by our customers. Also, excess network capacity continued  
to exist in the industry. In addition, we saw continuing consolidation of service providers within the industry. This environment created a  
change in our customers’ focus from building new networks to conserving capital, decreasing their debt levels, reducing costs and/or increasing  
the capacity utilization rates and efficiency of existing networks.  
From a geographic perspective, the 42% decline in revenues in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily due to a 43% decline in the U.S., a 43%  
decline in EMEA, a 35% decline in Asia Pacific, a 46% decline in CALA and a 40% decline in Canada. All regional declines in 2002  
compared to 2001 were primarily the result of the factors mentioned above.  
2004 and 2005  
We expect that our consolidated revenues in 2004 will be slightly lower compared with 2003. The 2003 consolidated revenues included  
revenues that were deferred from prior periods. Although we expect a slight decline of consolidated revenues in 2004 as compared to 2003, we  
saw growth in several areas in 2004 primarily as a result of customers increasing their investments in:  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
voice over packet technologies;  
third generation wireless technologies; and  
expansion and enhancement of existing networks due to subscriber growth and competitive pressures.  
The period of relative industry stability that had characterized the second half of 2003 continued into 2004. For 2005, we expect revenue  
growth over 2004 primarily due to continued growth in the above areas.  
Spending in these areas of our business has been partially offset by customers limiting their investment in mature technologies as they focus on  
maximizing return on investment capital. In addition, we have continued to experience pricing pressures on sales of certain of our products as a  
result of increased competition particularly from low cost suppliers. Further, while customer support generally remains strong, we believe the  
ongoing restatement activities and the internal restructuring and realignment programs initiated in August 2004 have adversely impacted  
business performance in 2004.  
Consolidated revenues for the third and fourth quarters of 2004 reflect certain of these trends, with third quarter 2004 consolidated revenues  
lower than previously announced preliminary unaudited consolidated revenues for the second quarter of 2004. Our fourth quarter is expected to  
be our strongest quarter in 2004. Our quarterly results of operations will not necessarily be consistent with our historical quarterly profile or  
indicative of our expected results in future quarters. See “Risk factors/forward looking statements” for other factors that may affect our  
revenues.  
Wireless Networks revenues  
The following chart summarizes recent quarterly revenues for Wireless Networks:  
2003 vs. 2002  
Wireless Networks revenues increased 5% in 2003 compared to 2002 due to a 31% increase in the second half of 2003 partially offset by a  
17% decrease in the first half of 2003 compared to the same periods in 2002. The 31% increase in the second half of 2003 was primarily due to  
increased spending by our wireless service provider customers on our GSM, CDMA and UMTS technologies as a result of new contracts with  
certain customers and other customers expanding their existing networks to meet increased subscriber demand. The 17% decline in the first  
half of 2003 was primarily due to the ongoing focus by wireless service providers on capital and cash flow management and increased  
competition for customers by wireless service providers. As a result, many of our customers heavily scrutinized their capital expenditure  
requirements and postponed or reduced their capital spending during the first six months of 2003.  
CDMA revenues increased in 2003 compared to 2002 due to a substantial increase in revenues in the second half of 2003 compared to the  
same period in 2002. This substantial increase was partially offset by a decrease in the first half of 2003 compared to the same period in 2002.  
The substantial increase in CDMA revenues in the second half of 2003 compared to the same period in 2002 was primarily due to a substantial  
increase in the U.S. and Canada as a result of our customers expanding their existing networks and upgrading their existing networks to higher  
data speeds. The substantial increase in the U.S. and Canada was partially offset by a substantial decrease in EMEA. This substantial decline  
was primarily due to the completion of key customer network deployments during the first half of 2003, which had been underway in 2002.  
The decrease in CDMA revenues in the first half of 2003 compared to the same period in 2002 was primarily due to a  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
substantial decline in Canada and a decline in the U.S. as customers continued to experience capital spending restrictions as a result of their  
continued focus on capital and cash flow management. In Asia Pacific, CDMA revenues increased substantially in the first half of 2003  
compared to the same period in 2002 primarily due to new contracts with certain service provider customers and other customers expanding  
their existing networks to meet increased subscriber demand.  
GSM revenues increased significantly in 2003 compared to 2002 due to a substantial increase in revenues in the second half of 2003 compared  
to the same period in 2002. This substantial increase was partially offset by a significant decrease in the first half of 2003 compared to the same  
period in 2002.  
The substantial increase in GSM revenues in the second half of 2003 compared to the same period in 2002 was primarily due to a substantial  
increase in the U.S. and EMEA. The substantial increase in the U.S was primarily due to accelerated network expansions with certain service  
providers to meet increased subscriber demand. The substantial increase in EMEA was mainly due to new contracts with certain service  
provider customers and other customers expanding their existing networks.  
The significant decrease in GSM revenues in the first half of 2003 compared to the same period in 2002 was primarily due to substantial  
declines in Canada and Asia Pacific and a significant decline in the U.S. The substantial decline in Asia Pacific was mainly due to a decline in  
the overall growth rate of GSM technology deployments by wireless service providers in the second half of 2002 and the first half of 2003. As  
of the beginning of the first quarter of 2003, many of our GSM customers in Asia Pacific had completed their current network deployments  
and, as a result, they had sufficient capacity to meet additional subscriber demand. The substantial decline in Canada and the significant decline  
in the U.S. were mainly due to the completion of network deployments by certain service providers. In EMEA and CALA, GSM revenues  
increased substantially in the first half of 2003 primarily due to new contracts with certain service providers.  
Universal Mobile Telecommunications Systems, or UMTS, revenues increased substantially in 2003 compared to 2002. This substantial  
increase was primarily due to new contracts with certain service providers and the continued transition to this next generation technology.  
Time Division Multiple Access, or TDMA, revenues declined substantially in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to the continued transition  
to newer wireless technologies. The substantial decline was primarily due to customers in the U.S. and CALA continuing to migrate from the  
mature TDMA technology to GSM and CDMA technologies. In 2003, TDMA revenues accounted for less than 6% of total Wireless Networks  
revenues, down from 11% in 2002.  
From a geographic perspective, the 5% increase in Wireless Networks revenues in 2003 compared to 2002 was primarily due to a:  
6% increase in the U.S. primarily due to certain of our major GSM and CDMA customers upgrading and expanding their existing  
networks to meet increased subscriber demand in the second half of the year;  
15% increase in EMEA primarily due to new GSM contracts with certain service providers and other customers expanding their  
existing networks to meet increased subscriber demand; and  
15% increase in CALA primarily due to new GSM contracts with certain service providers and other customers expanding their  
existing networks to meet increased subscriber demand; partially offset by  
16% decline in Canada primarily due to the completion of key customer network deployments, customers’ focus on capital and  
cash flow management and a slower subscriber growth.  
2002 vs. 2001  
The 27% decline in Wireless Networks revenues in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily due to a continued deterioration in wireless service  
providers’ financial condition, slower subscriber growth and increased competition for customers by service providers which resulted in the  
decision of many wireless service providers to delay capital expenditures.  
CDMA revenues declined in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to continued capital spending constraints and financial difficulties  
experienced by our customers globally. In 2002, we continued to experience significant pricing pressures on our CDMA technologies in the  
U.S. and CALA resulting from the increased competition for customers.  
TDMA revenues declined substantially in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to a substantial decline in the U.S. and CALA as customers  
migrated from TDMA to CDMA and GSM technologies as a result of TDMA technology and networks being in their maturity stage.  
Continued capital spending constraints and financial difficulties experienced by our customers  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
globally also contributed to the TDMA revenue declines. In 2002, we continued to experience significant pricing pressures on our TDMA  
technologies in the U.S. resulting from the increased competition for customers. TDMA revenues continued to be a smaller portion of Wireless  
Networks in 2002 compared to 2001.  
GSM revenues declined substantially in 2002 compared to 2001 due to substantial declines in Asia Pacific and EMEA. These substantial  
declines were primarily due to a continued deterioration in wireless service providers’ financial condition and slower subscriber growth, and  
delays in capital expenditures. Also in Asia Pacific, customers began to deploy CDMA technology solutions as they migrated away from the  
maturing GSM technologies. This shift in technology focus contributed to the substantial decline in GSM revenues in Asia Pacific.  
In 2002, UMTS revenues continued to be an insignificant portion of overall Wireless Networks revenues. While the first commercial launches  
in the industry did take place in EMEA and Asia Pacific, technology issues associated with third generation, or 3G, handsets contributed to  
delays in larger deployments of 3G networks in 2002. Also, some of our 3G customers in EMEA incurred significant costs in 2002 associated  
with licensing fees, which, along with their continued focus on improving their financial performance, limited their spending on network  
deployments. As a result, 3G network deployments suffered delays in EMEA in 2002.  
From a geographic perspective, the 27% decline in Wireless Networks revenues in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily due to a 54% decline  
in revenues in Asia Pacific, a 16% decline in revenues in the U.S., a 25% decline in revenues in EMEA and a 27% decline in revenues in  
CALA. The declines in all regions were mainly due to the continued deterioration in wireless service providers’ financial condition and  
subscriber growth and increased competition for customers by service providers which resulted in the decision of many wireless service  
providers to delay capital expenditures.  
2004 and 2005  
During 2003 and 2004, Wireless Networks revenues continued to be primarily generated by sales of CDMA and GSM technologies. Also,  
revenues associated with our TDMA technology continued to decline in 2004 compared to 2003 due to the continued transition to newer  
wireless technologies. Regarding our UMTS technology, revenues have grown compared to 2003 as a result of contracts announced in the  
second half of 2003 and in 2004 and the continued transition to this next generation technology. We expect a growing percentage of our  
Wireless Networks revenues to come from our UMTS technology. While we have seen encouraging indicators in certain areas of the wireless  
market, we can provide no assurance that these growth areas that have begun to emerge will continue in the future.  
Enterprise Networks revenues  
The following chart summarizes recent quarterly revenues for Enterprise Networks:  
2003 vs. 2002  
Enterprise Networks revenues increased 7% in 2003 compared to 2002 due to a substantial increase in the circuit and packet voice portion of  
this segment offset by a significant decrease in the data networking and security portion of this segment.  
Revenues from the circuit and packet voice portion of this segment increased substantially in 2003 compared to 2002. We experienced a  
substantial increase in revenues associated with our traditional circuit switching and interactive voice response products primarily due to the  
release of certain software including Succession 3.0. The general availability of this software in the fourth quarter of 2003 triggered the  
recognition of associated revenues deferred from prior periods, resulting in a net  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
increase in revenues of $150 in 2003. In addition, there was a substantial increase in revenues associated with our Internet Protocol, or IP,  
telephony solutions as customers continued to migrate towards converged packet voice solutions.  
Revenues associated with the data networking and security portion of this segment decreased significantly in 2003 compared to 2002. The  
significant decrease in revenues was primarily due to a decline in new service contracts and service contract renewals, a decline in revenues  
associated with our legacy routing portfolio and a decline in revenue from certain of our data networking products primarily due to pricing  
pressures driven by increased competition. This was partially offset by a net increase in previously deferred revenues associated with certain  
data switch upgrades of approximately $60 in 2003.  
Enterprise Networks revenues declined sequentially in the first and second quarters of 2003 and increased sequentially in the third and fourth  
quarters of 2003. The sequential declines in the first half of 2003 were primarily due to customers having sufficient network capacity,  
continued capital spending restrictions by our customers and delays associated with the establishment of new channel relationships to address  
demand from small and medium sized enterprise customers. The sequential increases in revenues in the second half of 2003 were primarily due  
to a sequential increase in revenues associated with our IP telephony solutions as our customers continued to migrate toward packet voice  
solutions as well as revenue recognized due to the release of certain software including Succession 3.0 in the fourth quarter of 2003. Further,  
we experienced sequential revenue increases in the third and fourth quarters of 2003 from our interactive voice response and security products  
as a result of certain new product releases in the second half of 2003.  
From a geographic perspective, the 7% increase in Enterprise Networks revenues in 2003 compared to 2002 was primarily due to a:  
14% increase in revenues in the U.S. primarily due to the release of certain software including the general availability of Succession  
3.0 in the fourth quarter of 2003 which triggered the recognition of associated revenues deferred from prior periods. In addition,  
revenues increased due to the recognition of deferred revenues associated with certain data switch upgrades; partially offset by  
19% decline in revenues in CALA primarily due to the reduction of inventory by the distribution network in the region and the  
unfavorable economic conditions in certain countries.  
2002 vs. 2001  
The 25% reduction in Enterprise Networks revenues in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily a result of enterprise customers continuing to  
reduce their spending due to the ongoing industry adjustment, the overall economic conditions and uncertainties surrounding the technology  
evolution of next generation products.  
Revenues from the circuit and packet voice portion of this segment declined substantially in 2002 compared to 2001. The substantial decline  
was primarily due to reductions in customer spending in the U.S. and EMEA. Revenues for traditional circuit switching products did begin to  
show signs of improvement in the U.S. in the second half of 2002 after experiencing sequential quarterly reductions during 2001 and the first  
half of 2002. In 2002, traditional circuit switching also continued its evolution towards IP telephony solutions, as reliability and quality of  
service concerns, traditionally associated with voice over packet solutions, were reduced. Regardless, customers remained cautious in 2002  
with respect to their investment decisions due to uncertainties surrounding the migration to packet voice solutions.  
The data networking and security portion of this segment experienced significant declines in 2002 compared to 2001. The significant decline in  
revenues was primarily due to customer spending constraints and a decline in demand for mature products across all regions. Pricing pressures  
continued in 2002 in the data networking and security portion of this segment as we experienced continued significant competition for  
enterprise customers.  
From a geographic perspective, the 25% decline in Enterprise Networks revenues in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily due to a 28%  
decline in the U.S., a 23% decline in EMEA and a 17% decline in Asia Pacific. These declines were all primarily due to the ongoing industry  
adjustment, the overall economic conditions and uncertainties surrounding the technology evolution of next generation products.  
2004 and 2005  
During 2004, our Enterprise Networks customers have continued to increase the deployment of voice over packet technologies in their  
communications networks. We expect that data, voice and multimedia communications will continue to converge, and enterprises will look for  
ways to maximize the effectiveness of their existing networks while reducing ongoing  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
capital expenditures and operating costs. Also, we anticipate that demand will continue to decline for our traditional circuit switching products,  
however, it is difficult to determine the extent to which future declines in demand will occur as a result of the migration to voice over packet  
technologies. In 2005, we are focused on increasing our market presence with enterprise customers. In particular, we are focusing on leading  
enterprise customers with high performance networking needs. While we have seen encouraging indicators in certain parts of the enterprise  
market, we can provide no assurance that the growth areas that have begun to emerge will continue in the future.  
Wireline Networks revenues  
The following chart summarizes recent quarterly revenues for Wireline Networks:  
2003 vs. 2002  
Wireline Networks revenues declined 22% in 2003 compared to 2002. This decline was primarily due to a substantial reduction in capital  
spending by our service provider customers as a result of the continued industry adjustment.  
Revenues from the circuit and packet voice portion of this segment decreased substantially in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to a  
substantial decrease in our traditional circuit switching product revenues and also uncertainty related to the impact of the Federal  
Communications Commission, or FCC, decision regarding the regulation of the availability of unbundled network elements, or UNEs, released  
on August 21, 2003 and subsequent judicial review and FCC reconsideration of the decision. The substantial decline in our circuit switching  
revenues was primarily due to the continuing impact of capital spending restrictions experienced by our service provider customers during  
2003 and tightened capital markets mainly during the first half of 2003. Revenues from our packet voice solutions increased substantially  
across all regions except EMEA in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to new service provider contracts throughout 2003.  
Revenues from the data networking and security portion of this segment decreased significantly in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to  
substantial declines in the U.S. and Asia Pacific and a significant decline in CALA. In these regions, we experienced a decline in demand for  
our mature products primarily due to the ongoing shift towards IP-based technology.  
From a geographic perspective, the 22% decline in Wireline Networks revenues in 2003 compared to 2002 was primarily due to a:  
32% decline in revenues in the U.S. primarily due to the continuing impact of capital spending restrictions experienced by our  
service provider customers, tightened capital markets mainly during the first half of 2003 and also uncertainty related to the impact  
of the FCC decision regarding the regulation of the availability of UNEs;  
43% decline in revenues in CALA primarily due to the completion of a major contract in the first quarter of 2002 and continued  
capital spending restrictions experienced by our service provider customers; and  
5% decline in revenues in EMEA primarily due to a reduction in capital spending by service provider customers during 2003 and  
tightened capital markets mainly during the first half of 2003; partially offset by  
15% increase in Canada primarily due to increased revenues from our packet voice solutions primarily due to new service provider  
contracts throughout 2003.  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2002 vs. 2001  
The 41% decline in Wireline Networks revenues in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily due to a substantial reduction in capital spending by  
our service provider customers.  
The considerable decline in the circuit and packet voice portion of this segment was the result of continued reduced demand in the local  
exchange and interexchange carrier markets due to the significant industry adjustment, including industry consolidation and tightened capital  
markets, and the substantial decline in demand for traditional circuit switching products. During 2002, many of our service provider customers  
continued to delay their investment decisions on our packet voice solutions due to the technology evolution uncertainty in the industry. In  
2002, we continued to experience significant pricing pressures on our traditional circuit switching products due to the increased competition for  
service provider customers.  
The considerable decline in revenues in the data networking and security portion of this segment was primarily due to a decline in demand for  
mature products, compounded by the ongoing industry adjustment as our service provider customers, in all regions, continued to reduce their  
capital expenditures.  
From a geographic perspective, the 41% decline in Wireline Networks revenues in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily due to a 41% decline  
in the U.S., a 32% decline in EMEA, a 57% decline in CALA, and a 39% decline in Asia Pacific. The declines in all regions were primarily  
attributable to the substantial reduction in spending by our service provider customers as a result of the factors mentioned above.  
2004 and 2005  
In 2004, our service provider customers continued to increase the deployment of packet-based technologies in their communications networks  
as they looked for ways to optimize their existing networks and offer new revenue generating services while limiting capital expenditures and  
operating costs. However, the timing of when service provider customers will deploy packet-based technologies on a wider scale is still  
unclear. Further, it is difficult to determine the effect the FCC decision regarding the regulation of the availability of UNEs and subsequent  
adoption on December 15, 2004 of new unbundling rules in response to the remand by the U.S. Court of Appeals for the D.C. Circuit will have  
on our business. The demand for our traditional circuit switching products has continued to decline as certain service providers continued to  
reduce their capital expenditures on these legacy technologies. While we have seen encouraging indicators in certain areas of the wireline  
service provider market, we can provide no assurance that the growth areas that have begun to emerge will continue in the future.  
Optical Networks revenues  
The following chart summarizes recent quarterly revenues for Optical Networks:  
2003 vs. 2002  
Optical Networks revenues declined 35% in 2003 compared to 2002. The decline was primarily the result of the continuing industry  
adjustment, excess capacity, tightened capital markets mainly during the first half of 2003 and reductions in capital spending by our EMEA,  
U.S. and Canada customers in both the long-haul and metro optical portions of this segment.  
Revenues in the long-haul portion of this segment declined substantially in 2003 compared to 2002. The substantial decline was primarily due  
to the continuing industry adjustment, excess capacity, tightened capital markets mainly during the first  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
half of 2003 and continued capital spending restrictions in the U.S., Canada and EMEA as customers continued to focus on maximizing return  
on invested capital by increasing the capacity utilization rates and efficiency of existing networks. In Asia Pacific, optical long-haul revenues  
declined substantially in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to the completion of network build-outs for certain customers in 2002 that were  
not repeated in 2003. In addition, significant excess inventories continued to exist in this portion of the segment which resulted in ongoing  
pricing pressures across all regions.  
In the fourth quarter of 2002, we sold certain optical components assets to Bookham Technology plc, or Bookham. As a result, our results in  
2003 in the long-haul portion of this segment do not reflect revenues generated from these assets. In 2002, revenues generated from the optical  
components assets sold to Bookham were approximately 3% of the total Optical Networks revenues of $1,820.  
Revenues in the metro optical portion of this segment were relatively flat in 2003 compared to 2002. This was primarily due to a substantial  
decrease in EMEA partially offset by an increase in revenues in the U.S. and a substantial increase in Asia Pacific. The substantial decrease in  
EMEA was primarily the result of the continued industry adjustment, tightened capital markets mainly during the first half of 2003 and  
customer spending restrictions. The increase in revenues in the U.S. and the substantial increase in Asia Pacific were primarily due to new  
customer contracts during the first half of 2003 for expansions of existing networks to meet increased customer demand.  
From a geographic perspective, the 35% decline in Optical Networks revenues in 2003 compared to 2002 was primarily due to a:  
35% decline in the U.S., 40% decline in EMEA and a 32% decline in Canada primarily related to a substantial reduction in capital  
spending as a result of the continuing industry adjustment, tightened capital markets mainly during the first half of 2003 and  
customers continuing to focus on maximizing return on invested capital; and  
33% decline in Asia Pacific primarily related to contractual issues experienced with certain customers in the fourth quarter of 2003  
and the completion of network build-outs for certain customers in the long-haul portion of this segment in 2002 that were not  
repeated in 2003.  
2002 vs. 2001  
The 64% decline in Optical Networks revenues in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily the result of substantial reductions in capital spending  
by our major U.S. and EMEA customers. These reductions were partially offset by a significant increase in Asia Pacific revenues primarily due  
to new customer contracts for expansions of existing networks to meet increased customer demand.  
Our major customers in the long-haul portion of this segment focused on maximizing return on invested capital by increasing the capacity  
utilization rates and efficiency of existing networks. Revenues in the optical long-haul portion of the segment declined substantially in 2002  
compared to 2001. The considerable decline was primarily due to the continued industry adjustment, including industry consolidation,  
continued capital spending constraints and, to a lesser extent, the large redeployment of assets that occurred in 2001 and continued throughout  
2002. The spending constraints and redeployment of assets were caused primarily by significant excess inventories which resulted in  
significant pricing pressures.  
Revenues in the metro optical portion of the segment were primarily driven by demand for enterprise connectivity and storage solutions. The  
substantial decline in revenue in the metro optical portion of the segment in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily due to a decline in demand  
for mature products. This substantial decline was compounded by the ongoing industry adjustment as customers continued to focus on  
optimizing existing networks and delayed the deployment of next generation products. Industry consolidation also contributed to the reduction  
in service provider capital spending during 2002 and 2001. The then current generation of metro products, namely, the OPTera Metro family of  
products, were the key products contributing to revenue in 2002 and accounted for a substantial portion of the overall Optical Networks  
revenues. Revenue in the metro optical portion of the segment increased as a percentage of total Optical Networks revenue in 2002 compared  
to 2001.  
From a geographic perspective, the 64% decline in Optical Networks revenues in 2002 compared to 2001 was primarily due to a 76% decline  
in revenues in U.S., a 61% decline in revenues in EMEA and a 72% decline in revenues in CALA. The declines in all these regions were  
primarily due to the continued industry adjustment, including industry consolidation, capital spending constraints and the redeployment of  
assets in 2001 and 2002.  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2004 and 2005  
During 2004, our major customers in the optical long-haul portion of Optical Networks remained focused on maximizing return on their  
invested capital by increasing the capacity utilization rates and efficiency of existing networks. We expect that any additional capital spending  
by those customers in the near term will be increasingly directed to opportunities that enhance customer performance, revenue generation and  
cost reduction.  
We see an increase in demand for metro Dense Wavelength Division Multiplexing, or metro DWDM. This increase is primarily due to new  
network deployments by certain customers and other customers expanding their networks, driven by emerging applications such as Cable  
Video on Demand, all of which have resulted in a need for low cost, high capacity connectivity between network sites. As a result, we expect  
that the metro optical portion of this segment will continue to represent a larger percentage of overall Optical Networks revenues. While we  
have seen encouraging indicators in certain parts of the optical market, we can provide no assurance that the growth areas that have begun to  
emerge will continue in the future.  
Gross profit and gross margin  
For the years ended December 31,  
2003 vs 2002  
Change % Change  
2002 vs 2001  
Change % Change  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Gross profit  
$
4,341  
$
3,905  
$
4,288  
$
436  
11  
$
(383)  
(9)  
Gross margin  
42.6%  
35.5%  
22.7%  
7.1 pts  
12.8 pts  
Gross margin improved 7.1 percentage points in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to:  
an increase related to continued improvements in our cost structure primarily as a result of favorable supplier pricing and changes  
in product mix that resulted in increased volumes of certain products with higher margins; and  
an increase of approximately 4 percentage points related to reduced inventory provisioning and contract and customer settlement  
costs. In 2003, we recorded approximately $299 of incremental inventory provisions compared to approximately $689 of similar  
incremental charges in 2002; partially offset by  
pricing pressures on certain of our products; and  
an increase in expense related to our employee return to profitability, or RTP, and regular bonus plans.  
Gross margin improved 12.8 percentage points in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
an increase of approximately 9 percentage points related to reduced inventory provisioning and contract and customer settlement  
costs. In 2002, we recorded approximately $689 of incremental inventory provisions compared to approximately $1,631 of similar  
incremental charges in 2001;  
improvements in our cost structure to more closely reflect our sales volume and as a result of favorable supplier pricing; partially  
offset by  
pricing pressures on certain of our products.  
While we cannot predict the extent to which changes in product mix and pricing pressures will impact our gross margin, we continue to see the  
effects of improvements in our product costs primarily due to favorable material pricing. Considering the impacts of our strategic plan  
described under “Business overview — Our strategic plan and outlook” and the higher costs associated with initial customer deployments in  
emerging markets, we expect that gross margin will trend in the range of 40% to 44% through 2005. See “Risk factors/forward looking  
statements” for factors that may affect our gross margins.  
Segment gross profit and gross margin  
Wireless Networks  
Wireless Networks gross margin improved by approximately 6 percentage points in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to:  
changes in product mix mainly related to increased volumes of certain products with higher margins;  
improvements in our product costs primarily as a result of favorable material pricing which was partially offset by  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
reductions in the selling price of certain products; and  
improvements in other operations related costs; partially offset by  
an increase in contract-related costs including customer trials.  
Wireless Networks gross margin improved by approximately 15 percentage points in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
changes in product mix mainly related to increased volumes of certain products with higher margins;  
improvements in our product costs primarily as a result of favorable material pricing;  
reduced inventory provisioning as a result of our inventory levels being better aligned to customer demand and a decrease in other  
contract and customer settlement costs; and  
improvements in other operations related costs.  
Enterprise Networks  
Enterprise Networks gross margin improved by approximately 4 percentage points in 2003 compared to 2002 and by approximately  
2 percentage points in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
improvements in our product costs primarily as a result of favorable material pricing;  
changes in product mix mainly related to increased volumes of certain products with higher margins;  
reductions in other operations related costs including product defects, customer service and warranty costs; and  
reduced inventory provisioning as a result of our inventory levels being better aligned to customer demand and a decrease in other  
contract and customer settlement costs; partially offset by  
reductions in the selling price of certain of our products.  
Wireline Networks  
Wireline Networks gross margin declined by approximately 4 percentage points in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to:  
changes in product mix mainly related to decreased volumes of certain products with higher margins; partially offset by  
improvements in our cost structure as a result of favorable supplier pricing and design improvements;  
reductions in other operations related costs, mainly in the U.S. and Canada; and  
reduced inventory provisioning as a result of our inventory levels being better aligned to customer demand.  
Wireline Networks gross margin improved by approximately 14 percentage points in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
improvements in our cost structure as a result of favorable supplier pricing and design improvements;  
reductions in other operations related costs, mainly in the U.S. and Canada; and  
reduced inventory provisioning as a result of our inventory levels being better aligned to customer demand.  
Optical Networks  
Optical Networks gross margin improved by approximately 26 percentage points in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to:  
reduced inventory provisioning and other contract and customer settlement costs throughout 2003 including a reduction in accruals  
of $53 associated with a certain customer bankruptcy settlement;  
reductions in operations related costs throughout 2003 mainly in the U.S., Canada and EMEA;  
improvements in our cost structure primarily as a result of favorable supplier pricing which were partially offset by continued  
pricing pressures on the sale of certain products;  
the sale of certain optical components assets to Bookham and, as a result, our 2003 gross margin excluded the impact of excess  
capacity of those optical components assets; and  
reduced warranty charges in 2003.  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Optical Networks gross margin declined by approximately 5 percentage points in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
pricing pressures on the sale of certain products; partially offset by  
reduced inventory provisioning and other contract and customer settlement costs in 2002.  
Operating expenses  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
For the years ended December 31,  
2003 vs 2002  
2002 vs 2001  
2003  
2002  
2001  
$ Change  
% Change  
$ Change  
% Change  
SG&A expense  
$
1,939  
$
2,553  
$
6,111  
$
(614)  
(24)  
$
(3,558)  
(58)  
As % of revenues  
19.0%  
23.2%  
32.3%  
(4.2 pts)  
(9.1 pts)  
SG&A expense declined $614 in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to:  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions and associated reductions in other related costs such as information services and  
real estate; and  
a net decrease of $471 (recovery of $180 in 2003 and expense of $291 in 2002) related to decreased provisioning for trade and  
customer financing receivables; partially offset by  
an increase of approximately $120 related to our RTP and regular bonus plans in 2003 compared to 2002; and  
an increase due to significant foreign exchange impacts associated with the Canadian dollar, euro and British pound; and  
an increase related to our stock-based compensation, including restricted stock unit and stock option programs, both of which are  
not allocated across all of our reportable segments.  
SG&A expense declined $3,558 in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
the impact of workforce reductions which, in turn, resulted in a reduction in other related costs including information services and  
real estate; and  
a decrease of $1,500 (expense of $291 in 2002 and expense of $1,791 in 2001) related to decreased provisioning for trade and  
customer financing receivables.  
Overall in 2004, we expect increased SG&A expense compared to 2003 primarily as a result of net trade and customer financing receivable  
recoveries of $180 that were included in our SG&A expense in 2003 that are not expected to be repeated in 2004, negative foreign exchange  
impacts, increases in our stock-based compensation programs and costs of approximately $115 related to our restatement activities. Although  
we expect increased SG&A expense in 2004 compared to 2003, through the implementation of our strategic plan, we expect to reduce  
operating expenses (both SG&A and R&D expense) to 35% of revenues or lower on an annualized basis in 2005. See “Business overview —  
Our strategic plan and outlook”.  
Segment selling, general and administrative expense  
Wireless Networks  
Wireless Networks SG&A expense decreased substantially in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to:  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions and organizational realignment across all regions and associated reductions in  
other related costs such as information services and real estate; and  
a decrease in provisioning for trade and customer financing receivables.  
Wireless Networks SG&A expense decreased substantially in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions and organizational realignment across all regions and associated reductions in  
other related costs such as information services and real estate; partially offset by  
an increase in provisioning for trade and customer financing receivables.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Enterprise Networks  
Enterprise Networks SG&A expense decreased in 2003 compared to 2002 and decreased substantially in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due  
to:  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions, primarily in the U.S. and Canada, and associated reductions in other related costs  
such as information services and real estate; and  
a decrease in provisioning for trade receivables.  
Wireline Networks  
Wireline Networks SG&A expense decreased substantially in 2003 compared to 2002 and in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
a decrease in provisioning for trade and customer financing receivables; and  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions, primarily in the U.S. and Canada, and associated reductions in other related costs  
such as information services and real estate.  
Optical Networks  
Optical Networks SG&A expense decreased substantially in 2003 compared to 2002 and in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions across all regions and associated reductions in other related costs such as  
information services and real estate;  
reduction in accruals of approximately $4 associated with a certain customer bankruptcy settlement; and  
a decrease in provisioning for trade and customer financing receivables.  
In addition, Optical Networks SG&A expense decreased substantially in 2003 compared to 2002 due to a reduction in accruals in 2003  
associated with a customer contract settlement.  
Research and development expense  
For the years ended December 31,  
2003 vs 2002  
$ Change % Change  
2002 vs 2001  
2003  
2002  
2001  
$ Change  
% Change  
R&D expense  
As % of revenues  
$
1,960  
19.2%  
$
2,083  
18.9%  
$
3,116  
16.5%  
$
(123)  
0.3 pts  
(6)  
$
(1,033)  
2.4 pts  
(33)  
R&D expense decreased $123 in 2003 compared to 2002 and decreased $1,033 in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to our workforce  
reductions and a reduced level of R&D activity consistent with the volume of business. The $123 decline in 2003 compared to 2002 was net of  
increases in R&D expense due to significant foreign exchange impacts associated with the Canadian dollar, euro and British pound in 2003 and  
increases in expenses associated with our RTP and regular bonus plans.  
Our continued strategic investments in R&D are aligned with technology leadership in anticipated growth areas. Although we experienced a  
substantial decline in demand for our networking equipment in 2001 through 2003, we maintained a technology focus and commitment to  
invest in new innovative solutions where we believed we would achieve the greatest future benefit from this investment. As a result, our R&D  
expense as a percentage of our consolidated revenues remained relatively flat at 19.2% in 2003 compared to 18.9% in 2002, both of which  
were up from 16.5% in 2001.  
We expect to continue to manage R&D expense according to the requirements of our business, allocating resources and investment where  
customer demand dictates, and reducing resources and investment where opportunities for improved efficiencies present themselves. Our R&D  
efforts are currently focused on secure and reliable converged networks including:  
packetization of voice and multimedia IP telephony solutions services;  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
services edge capability to realize simplification of customer network operations and broadband access technologies, including  
wireless and wireline; and  
enhanced network security to ensure the level of reliability and performance that has traditionally existed in carrier networks.  
We expect that our R&D expense as a percentage of revenue in 2004 will be similar to 2003 and 2005 will be lower than 2004 as we seek to  
achieve ongoing cost reductions in R&D as part of our strategic plan first announced in August 2004. See “Business overview — Our strategic  
plan and outlook”.  
Segment research and development expense  
Wireless Networks  
Wireless Networks R&D expense increased slightly in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to:  
significant unfavorable foreign exchange impacts associated with the Canadian dollar and euro; partially offset by  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions;  
transitioning R&D activities into lower cost markets; and  
focused cost-savings initiatives.  
Wireless Networks R&D expense decreased in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
reductions in our UMTS R&D programs as a result of delays in commercial launches by wireless carriers in EMEA;  
focused cost-savings initiatives; partially offset by  
continued investment in the development of new products.  
Enterprise Networks  
Enterprise Networks R&D expense was up slightly in 2003 compared to 2002 primarily due to:  
unfavorable foreign exchange impacts associated with the Canadian dollar; partially offset by  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions that targeted a level of R&D that was more representative of the volume of our  
business.  
Enterprise Networks R&D expense decreased substantially in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions that targeted a level of R&D expense that was more representative of the volume  
of our business; and  
effectively prioritizing investment in data products and increased outsourcing activity.  
Wireline Networks  
Wireline Networks R&D expense decreased significantly in 2003 compared to 2002 and decreased substantially in 2002 compared to 2001  
primarily due to:  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions that targeted a level of R&D expense that was more representative of the volume  
of our business; and  
effectively prioritizing investment in data products and increased outsourcing activity.  
Optical Networks  
Optical Networks R&D expense decreased substantially in 2003 compared to 2002 and in 2002 compared to 2001 primarily due to:  
the continued impact of our workforce reductions that targeted a level of R&D expense that was more representative  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
of the volume of our business.  
Segment contribution margin  
For the years ended December 31,  
2003 vs 2002  
$ Change % Change  
2002 vs 2001  
$ Change % Change  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Wireless Networks  
$
$
1,573  
560  
612  
(2)  
(341)  
$
1,104  
316  
736  
(778)  
(26)  
$
515  
263  
611  
(1,524)  
(1,688)  
$
469  
244  
(124)  
776  
(315)  
42  
77  
(17)  
100  
(1,212)  
$
589  
53  
125  
746  
1,662  
114  
20  
20  
49  
98  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
Other  
2,402  
$
1,352  
$
(1,823)  
$
1,050  
78  
$
3,175  
174  
Total  
As a result of the gross margin and SG&A expense changes discussed above, our total segment contribution margin improved by $1,050 in  
2003 compared to 2002 and by $3,175 in 2002 compared to 2001. See “Segment information” in note 6 of the accompanying consolidated  
financial statements.  
Segment Management EBT  
For the years ended December 31,  
2003 vs 2002  
$ Change % Change  
2002 vs 2001  
2003  
2002  
2001  
$ Change  
% Change  
Wireless Networks  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
Other  
$
$
695  
279  
171  
(260)  
(306)  
$
256  
29  
178  
(1,274)  
(209)  
$
(456)  
(141)  
(205)  
(2,504)  
(2,634)  
$
439  
250  
(7)  
1,014  
(97)  
171  
862  
(4)  
80  
(46)  
$
712  
170  
383  
1,230  
2,425  
156  
121  
187  
49  
92  
579  
$
(1,020)  
$
(5,940)  
$
1,599  
157  
$
4,920  
83  
Total  
The changes in segment Management EBT are a result of the gross margin, SG&A expense and R&D expense changes discussed above. See  
“Segment information” in note 6 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements for a reconciliation of segment Management EBT to  
net earnings (loss) from continuing operations.  
Amortization of intangibles  
The amortization of acquired technology was $101 and $157 in 2003 and 2002, respectively, and primarily reflected the charge related to the  
acquisition of Alteon WebSystems, Inc, or Alteon. The remaining net carrying value of acquired technology was fully amortized in the third  
quarter of 2003.  
On January 1, 2002, we adopted the provisions of SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets”, or SFAS 142. As a result,  
amortization of goodwill, including goodwill recorded in past business combinations, and amortization of intangibles with an indefinite life  
ceased upon adoption of SFAS 142.  
The amortization of goodwill for 2001 primarily reflected the charges related to the acquisitions of Bay Networks, Inc., Alteon, Xros, Inc.,  
Qtera Corporation, Clarify Inc. and the acquisition of JDS’s Switzerland-based subsidiary and its related assets in Poughkeepsie, New York  
(also known as the 980 NPLC business).  
The net carrying value of goodwill was $2,305 on December 31, 2003 and $2,199 on December 31, 2002.  
Deferred stock option compensation  
For acquisitions completed subsequent to July 1, 2000, we were required to allocate a portion of the purchase price to deferred compensation  
related to unvested stock options held by employees of the acquired companies. This deferred compensation was amortized to net earnings  
(loss) based on the graded vesting schedule of the stock option awards.  
Deferred stock option compensation was $16 in 2003 compared to $110 in 2002 and $248 in 2001. The declines were  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
primarily due to the completion of the deferred compensation amortization associated with certain employees’ stock option vesting periods and  
the cancellation of unvested stock options that were held by employees whose employment was terminated.  
Special charges  
During 2003, we continued to implement our restructuring work plan initiated in 2001. In addition, as described below, certain exit activities  
were initiated in 2003. Special charges recorded from January 1, 2001 to December 31, 2003 were as follows:  
Contract  
settlement  
and lease  
costs  
Intangible  
asset  
impair-  
ments  
Plant and  
equipment  
write downs  
Workforce  
reduction  
Other  
Total  
45  
Provision balance as of January 1, 2001  
$
45  
$
$
$
$
$
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
Revisions to prior accruals  
Cash drawdowns  
Non-cash drawdowns  
1,174  
42  
(1,003)  
14  
897  
(108)  
(110)  
1,000  
(59)  
(941)  
11,426  
11,426  
3,517  
(127)  
(1,121)  
(12,760)  
8
39  
(2)  
(8)  
407  
(11,833)  
Foreign exchange and other adjustments  
10  
(2)  
Provision balance as of December 31, 2001  
$
282  
$
677  
$
$
29  
$
$
988  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
Revisions to prior accruals  
Cash drawdowns  
Non-cash drawdowns  
Foreign exchange and other adjustments  
952  
(132)  
(788)  
(100)  
(2)  
225  
8
(286)  
475  
(55)  
(420)  
(20)  
595  
27  
595  
1,679  
(179)  
(1,094)  
(1,142)  
(6)  
(622)  
(4)  
(a)  
Provision balance as of December 31, 2002  
$
$
212  
$
$
620  
$
$
$
9
$
$
841  
Other special charges  
Revisions to prior accruals  
Cash drawdowns  
Non-cash drawdowns  
Foreign exchange and other adjustments  
199  
(44)  
(274)  
(41)  
12  
64  
19  
(275)  
74  
(28)  
(46)  
(9)  
337  
(53)  
(558)  
(87)  
40  
28  
(a)  
Provision balance as of December 31, 2003  
64  
456  
$
$
$
520  
a)  
As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, the short-term provision balance was $206 and $507, respectively, and the long-term provision balance was $314 and $334,  
respectively, which was included in long-term provisions, as a component of other liabilities.  
We implemented our work plan to streamline our operations and activities around our core markets and leadership strategies during 2001 in  
light of the significant downturn in both the telecommunications industry and the economic environment, and capital market trends impacting  
our operations and expected future growth rates. This work plan was adjusted during 2001, 2002 and 2003 to reflect the continued decline in  
the industry and economic environment, and in the capital markets. In addition, we initiated activities in 2003 to exit certain leased facilities  
and leases for assets no longer used across all segments.  
In 2003, we recorded special charges of $284, net of revisions of $53, related to our restructuring work plan and contract settlement and lease  
costs. Workforce reduction charges of $199 related to the cost of severance and benefits associated with approximately 1,800 employees  
notified of termination during 2003 which extended across all segments. Net revisions of $44 to reduce prior accruals primarily related to  
termination benefits where actual costs were lower than our original estimates across all segments. During 2003, the workforce reduction  
provision balance was drawn down by cash payments of $274 and by a non-cash pension settlement loss of $41. The remaining provision is  
expected to be substantially drawn down by the end of 2005. Contract settlement and lease costs were $64 and consisted of negotiated  
settlements to cancel or renegotiate contracts and net lease charges related to leased facilities (comprised of office, warehouse and  
manufacturing space) and leased furniture that were identified as no longer required across all segments. These lease costs, net of anticipated  
sublease income, included non-cancelable lease terms from the date leased facilities ceased to be used and termination penalties.  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In addition to these charges were revisions to prior accruals of $19 resulting primarily from changes in estimates for sublease income and costs  
to vacate certain properties, across all segments. During 2003, the provision balance for contract settlement and lease costs was drawn down by  
cash payments of $275. The remaining provision, net of approximately $317 in estimated sublease income, is expected to be substantially  
drawn down by the end of 2013. Also, we recorded charges of $74 related to current period write downs to fair value less costs to sell for  
various leasehold improvements and excess Optical Networks equipment held for sale. Net revisions of $28 to reduce prior accruals related to  
adjustments in our original plans or estimates for the closure of certain facilities. In 2003, we concluded that an impairment of our goodwill did  
not exist and no write down was recorded.  
In 2002, we recorded special charges of $2,095, net of revisions of $179, related to our restructuring work plan and contract settlement and  
lease costs. Workforce reduction charges of $952 were related to the cost of severance and benefits associated with the approximately 12,700  
employees notified of termination which was primarily in the U.S., Canada and EMEA and extended across all segments. Net revisions of $132  
to reduce prior accruals primarily related to termination benefits where actual costs were lower than our original estimates across all segments.  
Workforce reduction charges included $124 for pension and post-retirement benefits other than pension, settlement and curtailment costs.  
During 2002, the workforce reduction provision balance was drawn down by cash payments of $788 and by $100 of non-cash pension and  
post-retirement benefits other than pension, settlement and curtailment costs attributable to the notified employee group charged against the  
provision. Contract settlement and lease costs of $225 consisted of negotiated settlements to cancel or renegotiate contracts and net lease  
charges related to leased facilities (comprised of office, warehouse and manufacturing space) and leased manufacturing equipment that were no  
longer required, across all segments. In addition to these charges were net revisions of $8 primarily from changes in estimates for sublease  
income and costs to vacate certain properties, across all segments. During the year ended December 31, 2002, the provision balance for  
contract settlement and lease costs was drawn down by cash payments of $286. The remaining provision balance was net of approximately  
$402 in estimated sublease revenue. Plant and equipment charges of $475 were related to current period write downs to fair value less costs to  
sell for various owned facilities and plant and manufacturing related equipment. These charges included $358 related to specialized plant  
infrastructure and equipment within Optical Networks and the remaining charges for facilities and equipment arising across all segments.  
Offsetting these charges were revisions of $55 to prior write downs of assets held for sale related primarily to additional proceeds from  
disposals of equipment from Optical Networks and other segments in excess of amounts previously expected and adjustments to original plans  
or estimated amounts for certain facility closures across all segments. Also in 2002, we recorded $27 related to the write downs of certain  
acquired technology in Optical Networks due to our reassessment of market conditions.  
In 2002, we also completed the SFAS 142 transitional impairment test and concluded at that time that there was no impairment of recorded  
goodwill, as the fair values of our reporting units exceeded their carrying amounts as of January 1, 2002. Therefore, the second step of the  
transitional impairment test under SFAS 142 was not required to be performed in 2002. However, as a result of the continued decline in 2002  
in both our overall market value generally and within Optical Networks specifically, we evaluated the goodwill associated with the businesses  
within Optical Networks for potential impairment. The conclusion of those evaluations was that the fair value associated with these businesses  
could no longer support the carrying value of the remaining goodwill associated with them. As a result, we recorded a goodwill write down of  
$595 in 2002.  
In 2001, we recorded special charges of $14,816, net of revisions, related to our restructuring work plan and write downs of goodwill and other  
assets. These special charges related to workforce reduction costs of $1,174, contract settlement and lease costs of $897, plant and equipment  
write downs of $1,000, other charges of $39, intangible asset impairments of $407 and a goodwill write down of $11,426.  
On December 31, 2003, our workforce was 35,160. In 2004 and into 2005, our focus is on managing each of our businesses based on financial  
performance, the market and customer priorities. In the third quarter of 2004, we announced a strategic plan that includes a work plan  
involving focused workforce reductions and a voluntary retirement program relating in the aggregate to approximately 3,250 employees, real  
estate optimization and other cost containment actions such as reductions in information services costs, outsourced services and other  
discretionary spending. Expected cash costs in connection with this work plan are approximately $430. See “Business overview — Our  
strategic plan and outlook”.  
For additional information on expected future cash outflows related to special charges, see “Liquidity and capital resources — Uses of  
liquidity”. For additional information related to our restructuring activities, see “Special charges” in note 7 of the accompanying consolidated  
financial statements.  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets  
In 2003, gain on sale of businesses and assets of $4 was primarily due to the recognition of the remaining unamortized deferred gain related to  
the sale of substantially all of the assets of our Cogent Defence Systems, or CDS, business during the year ended December 31, 2001. The  
remaining unamortized deferred gain of $23 was recognized as a result of the sale of our 41% interest in EADS Telecom as discussed in  
“Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Other business developments — Ownership adjustment in our French and German operations”. This gain  
was partially offset by a loss due to retirement of fixed assets.  
In 2002, gain on sale of businesses and assets of $21 was primarily related to:  
a gain of $29 on the sale of certain assets relating to our optical components business to Bookham;  
a gain of $41 related to a previously deferred gain associated with the sale of substantially all of the assets of our CDS business to  
EADS Telecom as well as the cancellation and replacement of a call option to acquire an additional approximate 7% ownership  
interest in NNF which was originally included as part of the consideration received on the sale of these assets; and  
a gain of $10 on the sale of certain assets of our Service Commerce operation support system business to MetaSolv, Inc; partially  
offset by  
a loss of $68 due to retirement of fixed assets.  
In 2001, loss on sale of businesses and assets of $138 was primarily related to a $233 write down of our Service Commerce operation support  
system business to its net realizable value in the fourth quarter of 2001. The write down related primarily to goodwill and included the  
operations acquired on the acquisition of Architel Systems Corporation. Net realizable value was determined based on the anticipated proceeds  
on the sale of the business, which was completed on February 1, 2002. This loss was partially offset by net gains associated with both the  
outsourcing of certain activities as part of our continued supply chain transformation strategy that began in 1999 and the divestiture of certain  
non-core businesses in connection with our restructuring work plan. The loss was also partially offset by a gain of $37 associated with the sale  
of assets of our CDS business.  
For additional information relating to these asset sales, see “Acquisitions, divestitures and closures” in note 10 and “Commitments” in note 14  
of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Other income (expense) — net  
In 2003, other income — net was $445, which primarily included:  
gain of $96 related to the sale of our interest in EADS Telecom in conjunction with the changes in ownership of our French and  
German operations;  
interest income of $75 on our short-term investments;  
gain of $30 related to a certain customer bankruptcy settlement;  
a payment of $25 received from a settlement related to intellectual property use;  
foreign exchange gains of $105 primarily related to day-to-day transactional activities;  
gain of $6 related to sale of our interest in Bookham;  
gain of $31 related to the sale of Arris Group, Inc., or Arris Group, shares. For additional information on our investment in Arris  
Group see “Results of operations — discontinued operations”;  
gain of $10 related to sale of certain minority investments;  
dividend income of $19 on our short-term investments; and  
royalty income of $15 from patented technology.  
In 2002, other expense — net of $5 was primarily related to a foreign exchange loss of $65 and a $39 loss on the sale or write down of certain  
minority investments, partially offset by interest income of $88 on our short-term investments.  
In 2001, other expense — net of $506 was primarily related to a foreign exchange loss of $152 and a $368 loss on the sale or write down of  
certain minority investments. This write down occurred during the third quarter of 2001 from our review of our investment portfolio, and was  
due to a change in our strategic focus relative to certain minority investments, as well as an other than temporary decline in carrying values  
caused by the continued significant downturn in both the industry and  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
economic environment. Public company investments were generally written down against earnings to their then current market value. Private  
company investments were written down to the estimated current market value by applying a telecommunications market average adjustment  
factor calculated using the declines of a representative group of public companies.  
Interest expense  
In 2003, interest expense decreased $63 ($209 in 2003 compared to $272 in 2002) primarily due to a reduction in the outstanding balances of  
our notes payable and long-term debt.  
In 2002, interest expense decreased $39 ($272 in 2002 compared to $311 in 2001). The decrease was primarily related to a lower level of short-  
term notes payable in 2002, partially offset by additional interest expense due to long-term debt offerings during 2001.  
Interest rates on our outstanding notes payable and long-term debt remained relatively flat during these periods.  
Our quarterly interest expense in the first quarter of 2004 and the second quarter of 2004 was $52 and $50, respectively. We expect that the  
quarterly interest expense for the remainder of 2004 will remain at similar levels.  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
In 2003, we recorded a tax benefit of $80 on pre-tax earnings of $281 from continuing operations before minority interests and equity in net  
loss of associated companies. This tax benefit resulted from tax audit settlements and the benefit of various R&D related tax incentives. This  
benefit was partially offset by income tax provisions in certain taxable jurisdictions and various corporate minimum related income taxes.  
In 2002, we recorded a tax benefit of $468 on a pre-tax loss of $3,349 from continuing operations before minority interests and equity in net  
loss of associated companies. Our valuation allowances on tax benefits recorded in 2002 were $811. We assessed positive evidence including  
forecasts of future taxable income to support realization of the net deferred tax assets, and other negative evidence including our eight  
consecutive quarters of tax losses, and concluded that it was more likely than not that a portion of our deferred income tax asset would not be  
realized.  
As of December 31, 2003, we have substantial loss carryforwards and valuation allowances in our significant tax jurisdictions. These loss  
carryforwards will serve to minimize our future cash income related taxes.  
We will continue to assess the valuation allowance recorded against our deferred tax assets on a quarterly basis. The valuation allowance is in  
accordance with SFAS No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes”, which requires that a tax valuation allowance be established when it is more  
likely than not that some portion or all of a company’s deferred tax assets will not be realized. Our valuation allowance is primarily attributed  
to ongoing industry concerns. Given the magnitude of our valuation allowance, future adjustments to this allowance based on actual cash  
results could result in a significant adjustment to our effective tax rate. For additional information, see “Application of critical accounting  
estimates — Income Taxes — Tax asset valuation”.  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
As a result of the items discussed above under “Results of operations — continuing operations”, net earnings from continuing operations were  
$262 in 2003. This amount represented an improvement of $3,155 compared to our net loss from continuing operations of $2,893 in 2002.  
Also, our net loss from continuing operations improved by $20,377 in 2002 compared to our net loss from continuing operations of $23,270 in  
2001.  
Results of operations — discontinued operations  
In 2003, we completed a number of transactions including the sale of certain assets and common shares of businesses associated with our  
discontinued operations as well as the restructuring and/or collection of trade and customer financing receivables and a certain promissory note  
receivable. We continued to wind-down our access solutions operations and recorded net earnings from discontinued operations of $184 (net of  
tax) related to the sale of certain components of this business and other associated wind-down activities. We also continued to reassess the  
remaining provisions associated with  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
our discontinued operations and recorded any resulting gains or losses in net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations in the period in  
which they occurred.  
As of December 31, 2003, there was no change to the initial disposal strategy or intent to exit the business which was approved by the Board of  
Directors on June 14, 2001. However, the prolonged deterioration in the industry and market conditions during 2002 and 2003 delayed certain  
disposal activities beyond the original planned timeframe of one year. In particular, actions involving negotiations with customers, who were  
also affected by industry conditions, took longer than expected. Although disposal activities continued beyond the one-year period, we  
continue to present the access solutions operations as discontinued operations in the accompanying consolidated financial statements. As of  
December 31, 2003, we had substantially completed the wind-down of our access solutions operations. Net earnings from discontinued  
operations of $184 (net of tax) primarily related to a number of transactions in 2003 as follows, as well as gains of $68 associated with  
provision reassessments:  
a gain of $14 on the sale of certain assets related to our fixed wireless access operations to Airspan Networks, Inc. for cash  
consideration of $13 on December 23, 2003;  
a gain of $17 in the fourth quarter of 2003 associated with a cash settlement of $17 related to a certain note receivable which had  
been previously reserved;  
a gain of $12 on March 24, 2003 from the sale of 8 million common shares of Arris Group, back to Arris Group for cash  
consideration of $28 pursuant to a March 11, 2003 agreement. In addition, on March 18, 2003, we assigned our membership  
interest in Arris Interactive LLC, or Arris, to ANTEC Corporation, an Arris Group company, for cash consideration of $88,  
resulting in a loss of $2. Also in connection with these transactions, we received $11 upon the settlement of a sales representation  
agreement with Arris Group and recorded a gain of $11; and  
a gain of $66 in the first quarter of 2003 from the settlement of certain trade and customer financing receivables, the majority of  
which was previously provisioned.  
Following the March 2003 Arris Group transactions, we reduced our interest in Arris Group to 18.8%, and ceased equity accounting for the  
investment. As a result, we reclassified our remaining ownership interest in Arris Group as an available-for-sale investment within continuing  
operations effective in the second quarter of 2003. We continued to dispose of our interest in Arris Group in 2003 and the gain or loss on the  
sale of shares subsequent to the first quarter of 2003 was included in other income (expense) — net. We sold 9 million common shares of Arris  
Group on November 24, 2003. As of December 31, 2003, we owned 5 million Arris Group common shares or 6.6% of Arris Group’s  
outstanding common shares.  
For additional information, see “Discontinued operations” in note 20 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements and “Other  
income (expense) — net”.  
Liquidity and capital resources  
Cash flows  
The following table summarizes our cash flows by activity and cash on hand as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Net cash from (used in) operating activities of continuing operations  
Net cash from (used in) investing activities of continuing operations  
Net cash from (used in) financing activities of continuing operations  
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents  
$
85  
(85)  
(359)  
176  
$
(768)  
129  
532  
74  
Net cash from (used in) continuing operations  
Net cash from (used in) discontinued operations  
(183)  
390  
(33)  
349  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period  
207  
3,790  
316  
3,474  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of period  
$
3,997  
$
3,790  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In 2003, we continued to strengthen our liquidity position. As of December 31, 2003, our primary source of liquidity was cash. At  
December 31, 2003, we had cash of $3,997 excluding $63 of restricted cash and cash equivalents. We believe this cash will be sufficient to  
fund the changes to our business model in accordance with the strategic plan (see “Business overview — Our strategic plan and outlook”),  
manage our investments and meet our customer commitments for at least the next 12 months. However, if capital spending by service  
providers and other customers changes from what we currently expect, we may be required to adjust our current business model. As a result,  
our revenues and cash flows may be materially lower than we expect and we may be required to further reduce our investments or take other  
measures in order to meet our cash requirements. In the future, we may seek additional funds from liquidity generating transactions and other  
sources of external financing. We continue to routinely monitor the capital markets for opportunities to improve our capital structure and  
financial flexibility. Our ability and willingness to access the capital markets is based on many factors including market conditions and overall  
financial objectives. Currently our ability is limited due to the impact of the delay in filing the Reports and the findings of the Independent  
Review and related matters. We cannot provide any assurance that our net cash requirements will be as we currently expect, that we will  
continue to have access to the EDC Support Facility when and as needed or that liquidity generating transactions or financings will be available  
to us on acceptable terms. In addition, we have not assumed the need to make any payments in respect of judgments, settlements, fines or other  
penalties in connection with our pending civil litigation or investigations related to the First Restatement and Second Restatement, which could  
have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or liquidity, other than anticipated professional fees and expenses. See “Risk  
factors/forward looking statements”.  
In 2003, our cash flows from operating activities were $85 due to net earnings from continuing operations of $262, less adjustments of $24 for  
non-cash and other items and $153 related to the change in our operating assets and liabilities. The use of cash of $153 resulting from the  
change in our operating assets and liabilities was primarily due to:  
net cash of $200 from a reduction in restricted cash and cash equivalents primarily due to the release of restricted cash upon the  
utilization of our EDC Support Facility as well as the release of other restrictions on cash through cancellation, renegotiation and/or  
fulfillment of our contractual obligations with certain customers;  
net cash of $18 from income taxes; and  
net cash of $429 from inventory primarily related to product shipments exceeding additions to inventories during 2003; more than  
offset by  
$231 related to accounts receivable primarily due to a significant increase in billings in the fourth quarter of 2003 as a result of the  
substantial increase in revenues in the fourth quarter of 2003 compared to the fourth quarter of 2002;  
$558 in restructuring related cash outflows; and  
a net decrease of $11 related to accounts payable and accrued liabilities and other operating assets and liabilities.  
The net decrease of $11 related to accounts payable and accrued liabilities and other operating assets and liabilities was mainly a result of:  
contributions to our defined benefit pension plans of approximately $300;  
the settlement of the liability associated with the put option related to the sale of our interest in EADS Telecom in conjunction with  
the changes in ownership of our French and German operations;  
payments of certain contract manufacturer and supplier accruals;  
settlement of certain obligations related to our internal information systems infrastructure;  
activities associated with our outsourcing contracts; partially offset by  
cash collections of outstanding customer financing amounts associated with certain customers;  
reduction of certain customer contract settlement costs; and  
the proportionate decrease in these assets and liabilities as a result of the decline in sales volumes and the associated size of our  
business.  
As a result of previously incurred tax losses and tax credits, we do not expect that we will have to make significant cash income tax payments  
in the foreseeable future.  
Cash flows used in investing activities were $85 and were primarily due to $172 in plant and equipment expenditures and $58 associated with  
acquisitions of certain investments and businesses including the ownership adjustment in our French and German operations. These amounts  
were partially offset by proceeds of $107 from the sale of certain investments and businesses which we no longer considered strategic and  
proceeds of $38 primarily from the sale of plant and equipment in the  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
U.S.  
Cash flows used in financing activities were $359 and were primarily due to $270 used to reduce our long-term debt, a reduction of our notes  
payable by a net amount of $45 and $35 used in connection with the payment of dividends to NNL’s preferred shareholders.  
In 2003, our cash increased $176 due to favorable effects of changes in foreign exchange rates. Approximately $150 of the favorable impact  
was the result of favorable changes in the euro and the British pound.  
Also in 2003, our discontinued operations generated net cash of $390 related to certain investing and operating activities. We generated $241  
of cash from investing activities primarily related to proceeds from the sale of the common shares of Arris and the settlement of certain  
customer financing receivables. The remaining cash of $149 was generated from operating activities related to the continued wind down of our  
discontinued operations.  
Uses of liquidity  
Our cash requirements for the next 12 months are primarily to fund:  
operations;  
research and development;  
costs relating to workforce reduction and other restructuring activities;  
capital expenditures;  
debt service;  
pension and post-retirement benefits; and  
costs in relation to the restatement activities, matters related to the Independent Review and other related matters, including  
regulatory and other legal proceedings.  
In particular, we are subject to significant pending civil litigation actions and regulatory and criminal investigations which could materially  
adversely affect our financial condition and liquidity by requiring us to pay substantial judgments, settlements, fines or other penalties. See  
“Risk factors/forward looking statements”. Considerable effort and resources have been expended on our restatement activities in 2004,  
including the dedicated effort of hundreds of employees and numerous external consultants and advisors. The estimated costs of our  
restatement activities in 2004 are approximately $115, which amount will be included in SG&A expense in our consolidated statements of  
operations in the periods in which the costs are incurred.  
Also, from time to time, we may purchase our outstanding debt securities and/or convertible notes in privately negotiated or open market  
transactions, by tender offer or otherwise, in compliance with applicable laws. As well, we expect to be required to fund some portion of our  
aggregate undrawn customer financing commitments.  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contractual cash obligations  
Payments due  
2006  
Total  
obligations  
(a)  
Contractual cash obligations  
2004  
2005  
2007  
2008  
Thereafter  
(b)  
Long-term debt  
$
$
119  
$
$
16  
$
$
1,492  
$
15  
131  
104  
59  
$
$
1,816  
113  
104  
49  
$
552  
649  
104  
248  
$
4,010  
(c)  
Operating leases  
163  
1,209  
161  
145  
170  
159  
1,123  
104  
95  
145  
102  
104  
72  
1,360  
2,434  
681  
668  
170  
Purchase obligations  
Outsourcing contracts  
Obligations under special charges  
Pension, post-retirement and post-employment obligations  
Other long-term liabilities reflected on the balance sheet  
6
13  
4
3
3
47  
76  
Total contractual cash obligations  
1,980  
1,503  
1,919  
$
312  
2,085  
$
1,600  
$
9,399  
(a)  
(b)  
Amounts represented our known, undiscounted, minimum contractual payment obligations under our long-term obligations and include amounts identified as contractual  
obligations in current liabilities of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Included principal payments due on long term debt and $178 of capital lease obligations. As described in note 12 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements,  
we have entered into certain interest rate swap contracts which swap fixed rate payments for floating rate payments. For additional information, also see note 11 “Long-  
term debt, credit and support facilities” to the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
(c)  
For additional information, see note 14 “Commitments” to the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Purchase obligations  
Purchase obligation amounts in the above table represent the minimum obligation under our supply arrangements related to product and/or  
services entered into in the normal course of our business. Where the arrangement specifies quantity, pricing and timing information, we have  
included that arrangement in the amounts presented above. In certain cases, these arrangements define an end date of the contract, but do not  
specify timing of payments between December 31, 2003 and the end date of the agreement. In those cases, we have estimated the timing of the  
payments based on forecasted usage rates.  
During the third quarter of 2003, we renegotiated a key supply arrangement that was initially put into place prior to the industry and economic  
downturn that commenced in 2001. The renegotiated agreement is reflective of the current market environment, and the terms include a  
reduction in our minimum spending levels plus an extension in the time period, from 2004 to 2009, within which these minimum levels must  
be met. As well, we are no longer obligated to compensate the supplier for direct costs if the minimum spending levels are not met. The  
renegotiated agreement includes a graduated liquidated damages remedy for the benefit of the supplier if the minimum spending levels are not  
met by the end of the agreement in 2009. However, based upon the renegotiated terms, we expect to meet the minimum spending levels. The  
remaining minimum purchase obligation has been reflected in the contractual cash obligations table above.  
Outsourcing contracts  
Outsourcing contract amounts in the table above represent our minimum contractual obligation for services provided to us primarily related to  
a portion of information services, payroll, capital services, accounts payable and training and human resource functions. The amount payable  
under our outsourcing contracts is variable to the extent that our workforce fluctuates from the baseline levels contained in the contracts and  
our contractual obligation could increase above such baseline amount. If our workforce were to fall below the baseline levels in the contracts,  
we would be required to make the minimum payments included above.  
Obligations under special charges  
Balance sheet provisions of $64 for workforce reduction costs, included in restructuring in current liabilities in the accompanying consolidated  
financial statements, have not been reflected in the contractual cash obligations table above. The remaining balance sheet provision of $456,  
net of approximately $317 in estimated sublease revenues, related to contract settlement and lease costs and is expected to be substantially  
drawn down by the end of 2013.  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pension, post-retirement and post-employment obligations  
During 2003, we made cash contributions to our defined benefit pension plans of approximately $300. In 2004, we made cash contributions of  
approximately $140 to our defined benefit pension plans, which excludes $78 of deferred contributions for 2004 which were made in 2003, and  
approximately $30 to our post-retirement benefit plans.  
Other long-term liabilities reflected on the balance sheets  
The contractual cash obligations table above primarily included long-term balance sheet reserves related to asset retirement costs and deferred  
compensation accruals. Payment information related to our asset retirement costs has been presented based on the termination date of the  
associated lease contracts. Payment information related to our deferred compensation accruals has been presented based on the anticipated  
retirement dates of the employees participating in the programs.  
JDS purchase arrangement  
We agreed with JDS that if we purchased a minimum amount of designated products determined as a percentage of our total purchases for such  
products during the period from January 1, 2001 to December 31, 2003, we would earn consideration from JDS as a reduction, in whole or in  
part, of the deferred consideration otherwise payable in our common shares to JDS. We believe that our purchases over the term of the  
purchase arrangement were sufficient to meet the required measurement metrics to December 31, 2003. No amounts relating to this  
arrangement have been reflected in the contractual cash obligations table above. See note 3 “Restatement” to the accompanying consolidated  
financial statements for information regarding changes in the accounting for the deferred consideration.  
Customer financing  
Generally, customer financing arrangements may include financing with deferred payment terms in connection with the sale of our products  
and services, as well as funding for non-product costs associated with network installation and integration of our products and services. We  
may also provide funding for working capital purposes and equity financing. The following table provides information related to our customer  
financing commitments, excluding our discontinued operations as of:  
December 31,  
2003  
2002  
Drawn and outstanding — gross  
Provisions for doubtful accounts  
$
$
401  
(281)  
$
$
1,120  
(824)  
Drawn and outstanding — net  
120  
180  
296  
831  
(a)  
Undrawn commitments  
Total customer financing  
300  
1,127  
(a)  
(b)  
Included short-term and long-term amounts. Short-term and long-term amounts were included in accounts receivable — net and other assets, respectively, in the  
consolidated balance sheets.  
On January 8, 2004, Nortel Networks renegotiated an agreement with a certain customer which reduced Nortel Networks aggregate undrawn customer financing  
commitments from $177 to $69.  
In 2003, we entered into certain agreements to restructure and/or settle various customer financing and related receivables. As a result of these  
transactions, we received cash consideration of approximately $230 to settle outstanding receivables of approximately $610 (with a net  
carrying value of approximately $120). Also, we recorded net customer financing bad debt recoveries of $113 as a result of these favorable  
settlements and adjustments to other existing provisions.  
During 2003, we reduced undrawn commitments by $651 primarily as a result of the expiration or cancellation of commitments and changing  
customer business plans. As of December 31, 2003, approximately $108 of the $177 in undrawn commitments was not available for funding  
under the terms of our financing agreements.  
We continue to regularly assess the levels of our customer financing provisions based on a loan-by-loan review to evaluate whether the terms  
of each loan reflect current market conditions. We review the ability of our customers to meet their repayment obligations and determine our  
provisions accordingly. Commitments to extend future financing generally have conditions for funding, fixed expiration or termination dates  
and specific interest rates and purposes. We cannot predict with certainty the extent to which our customers will satisfy the applicable  
conditions for funding, and subsequently request funding, prior to the termination date of the commitments. We are currently directly  
supporting most outstanding balances and expect to initially fund any future commitments in the normal course of business from our working  
capital.  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
We expect to fund substantially all of our current remaining undrawn commitments of $69 in 2004 or 2005. However, we also expect that we  
will be able to arrange for third party lenders to assume these obligations in the same timeframe.  
Joint ventures/minority interests  
As discussed in “Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Other business developments — Ownership adjustment in our French and German  
operations”, on October 19, 2002, we entered into a number of put option and call option agreements as well as a share exchange agreement  
with EADS, our partner at that time in three European joint ventures. During 2003, the options and share exchange were exercised which  
resulted in us acquiring all of the equity interest of EADS in Nortel Networks Germany and Nortel Networks France. For additional  
information, see “Nortel Networks Germany and Nortel Networks France” in note 10 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Discontinued operations  
As of December 31, 2003, accruals related to our discontinued access solutions operations totaled $6 and were related to future contractual  
obligations and estimated liabilities during the planned period of disposition. The remaining accruals are expected to be substantially drawn  
down by cash payments by the end of 2005.  
For additional information related to our discontinued operations, see “Discontinued operations” in note 20 of the accompanying consolidated  
financial statements.  
Sources of liquidity  
Credit facilities  
As of December 31, 2003, we had $750 in undrawn credit under the Five Year Facilities scheduled to expire in April 2005. These credit  
facilities were entered into on April 12, 2000 by NNL and NNI and permitted borrowings for general corporate purposes. The Five Year  
Facilities contained a financial covenant requiring that NNL’s consolidated tangible net worth be not less than $1,888 at any time. As of  
December 31, 2003, we were in compliance with this covenant and there were no amounts drawn under the Five Year Facilities. On April 28,  
2004, we notified the lenders under the Five Year Facilities that we were terminating these facilities. Due to NNL’s failure to file its 2003  
Annual Report on Form 10-K by April 29, 2004, the banks under the Five Year Facilities would have otherwise been permitted to, upon  
30 days’ notice, terminate their commitments under the Five Year Facilities. Upon termination, we were in compliance with that financial  
covenant and the Five Year Facilities were undrawn. For additional information relating to the Five Year Facilities and the impact of the  
termination of these facilities under the related security agreements, see “Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Nortel Networks Audit  
Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters — Credit facilities and security agreements” and “Risk factors/forward looking  
statements”.  
Available support facility  
On February 14, 2003, NNL entered into the EDC Support Facility. As of December 31, 2003, the facility provided for up to $750 in support  
including:  
$300 of committed revolving support for performance bonds or similar instruments, of which $151 was utilized;  
$150 of uncommitted support for receivables sales and/or securitizations, of which none was utilized; and  
$300 of uncommitted support for performance bonds and/or receivables sales and/or securitizations, of which $183 was utilized.  
For additional information related to the EDC Support Facility subsequent to December 31, 2003 and waivers obtained in connection with the  
defaults arising under the EDC Support Facility from the delay in filing the Reports, see “Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Nortel Networks  
Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters — EDC Support Facility” and “Risk factors/forward looking statements”.  
On March 29, 2004, NNL and EDC amended the EDC Support Facility to provide that EDC may suspend its obligation to issue NNL any  
additional support if events occur that would have a material adverse effect on NNL’s business, financial position or results of operation. As a  
result of an amendment on December 10, 2004, the EDC Support Facility will expire on  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
December 31, 2006.  
The EDC Support Facility does not materially restrict NNL’s ability to sell any of its assets (subject to certain maximum amounts) or to  
purchase or pre-pay any of its currently outstanding debt. The EDC Support Facility can be suspended or terminated if NNL’s senior long-term  
debt rating by Moody’s has been downgraded to less than B3 or if its debt rating by S&P has been downgraded to less than B–.  
As of December 31, 2003, NNL’s obligations under the EDC Support Facility were secured on an equal and ratable basis under the security  
agreements entered into by NNL and various of our subsidiaries that pledged substantially all of NNL’s and its subsidiaries’ assets in favor of  
the holders of NNL’s public debt securities and the holders of our 4.25% Convertible Senior Notes. As of December 31, 2003, the security  
provided under the security agreements was comprised of:  
pledges of substantially all of the assets of NNL and those of most of its U.S. and Canadian subsidiaries;  
share pledges in certain of NNL’s other subsidiaries; and  
guarantees by certain of NNL’s wholly owned subsidiaries organized in Canada, England, Ireland and Hong Kong.  
If NNL’s senior long-term debt rating by Moody’s returns to Baa2 (with a stable outlook) and its rating by S&P returns to BBB (with a stable  
outlook), the security and guarantees will be released in full. If the EDC Support Facility is terminated, or expires, the security and guarantees  
will also be released in full. NNL may provide EDC with cash collateral in an amount equal to the total amount of its outstanding obligations  
and undrawn commitments and expenses under this facility (or any other alternative collateral or arrangements acceptable to EDC) in lieu of  
the security provided under the security agreements. Accordingly, if the EDC Support Facility is secured by cash or other alternate collateral or  
arrangements acceptable to EDC, the security and guarantees will also be released in full.  
For information related to our outstanding public debt, see “Long-term debt, credit and support facilities” in note 11 of the accompanying  
consolidated financial statements. For additional financial information related to those subsidiaries providing guarantees as of December 31,  
2003, see “Supplemental consolidating financial information” in note 24 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements. For  
information related to the security pledged, those subsidiaries providing guarantees and the impact of the termination of the Five Year Facilities  
on the related security agreements, subsequent to December 31, 2003, see “Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Nortel Networks Audit  
Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters — Credit facilities and security agreements”. For information related to our debt  
ratings, see “Credit ratings” below. See “Risk factors/forward looking statements” for factors that may affect our ability to comply with  
covenants and conditions in our EDC Support Facility in the future.  
Shelf registration statement and base shelf prospectus  
In 2002, we filed a shelf registration statement with the SEC and a base shelf prospectus with the applicable securities regulatory authorities in  
Canada, to qualify for the potential sale of up to $2,500 of various types of securities in the U.S. and/or Canada. The qualifying securities  
include common shares, preferred shares, debt securities, warrants to purchase equity or debt securities, share purchase contracts and share  
purchase or equity units (subject to certain approvals). As of December 31, 2003, approximately $1,700 under the shelf registration statement  
and base shelf prospectus has been utilized. As of June 6, 2004, the Canadian shelf registration expired. Owing to matters described above in  
“Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters” with respect to the  
delayed filing of the Reports, we are currently unable to utilize the remaining capacity under the SEC shelf registration statement in its current  
form. For the same reasons, we are also unable to permit holders of our prepaid forward purchase contracts to exercise certain “early  
settlement” rights and receive Nortel Networks Corporation common shares in advance of the otherwise applicable August 15, 2005 settlement  
date. These rights will again become exercisable upon the effectiveness of a registration statement (or a post-effective amendment to the shelf  
registration statement) filed with the SEC (with respect to the common shares to be delivered) that contains a related current prospectus. Under  
the terms of the Purchase Contract and Unit Agreement which governs the purchase contracts, we have agreed to use commercially reasonable  
efforts to have, in effect, a registration statement covering the common shares to be delivered and to provide a prospectus in connection  
therewith.  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Credit ratings  
Rating on long-term debt  
issued or guaranteed by  
Nortel Networks  
Limited/Nortel Networks  
Corporation  
Rating on  
preferred shares  
issued by  
Nortel Networks  
Limited  
Rating agency  
Last change  
Standard & Poor’s Ratings Service  
Moody’s Investors Service, Inc.  
B–  
B3  
CCC–  
Caa3  
April 28, 2004  
November 1, 2002  
On April 28, 2004, S&P downgraded its ratings on NNL, including its long-term corporate credit rating from “B” to “B–” and its preferred  
shares rating from “CCC” to “CCC–”. At the same time, it revised its outlook to developing from negative. Moody’s outlook changed to  
review for potential downgrade from uncertain on April 28, 2004. There can be no assurance that our credit ratings will not be lowered or that  
these ratings agencies will not issue adverse commentaries, potentially resulting in higher financing costs and reduced access to capital markets  
or alternative financing arrangements. A reduction in our credit ratings may also affect our ability, and the cost, to securitize receivables, obtain  
bid, performance related and other bonds, access the EDC Support Facility and/or enter into normal course derivative or hedging transactions.  
Off-balance sheet arrangements  
Bid, performance related and other bonds  
We have entered into bid, performance related and other bonds in connection with various contracts. Bid bonds generally have a term of less  
than twelve months, depending on the length of the bid period for the applicable contract. Performance related and other bonds generally have  
a term of twelve months and are typically renewed, as required, over the term of the applicable contract. The various contracts to which these  
bonds apply generally have terms ranging from two to five years. Any potential payments which might become due under these bonds would  
be related to our non-performance under the applicable contract. Historically, we have not had to make material payments and we do not  
anticipate that we will be required to make material payments under these types of bonds.  
The following table provides information related to these types of bonds as of:  
December 31,  
2003  
2002  
(a)  
Bid and performance related bonds  
Other bonds  
$
$
427  
53  
$
$
299  
136  
(b)  
Total bid, performance related and other bonds  
480  
435  
(a)  
(b)  
Net of restricted cash and cash equivalents of $14 as of December 31, 2003 and $188 as of December 31, 2002.  
Net of restricted cash and cash equivalents of $31 as of December 31, 2003 and $26 as of December 31, 2002.  
The criteria under which bid, performance related and other bonds can be obtained changed due to the industry environment primarily in 2002  
and 2001. During that timeframe, in addition to the payment of higher fees, we experienced significant cash collateral requirements in  
connection with obtaining new bid, performance related and other bonds. Given that the EDC Support Facility is used to support bid and  
performance bonds with varying terms, including those with at least 365 day terms, we will likely need to increase our use of cash collateral to  
support these obligations beginning on January 1, 2006 absent a further extension of the facility.  
The EDC Support Facility provides support for certain obligations under bid and performance related bonds and has reduced the requirement to  
provide cash collateral to support these obligations. As of December 31, 2003, the EDC Support Facility provided for up to $750 in support, of  
which $300 was committed revolving support for performance bonds of which $151 was utilized. The remainder was uncommitted support,  
subject to certain limitations, for performance bonds, receivables sales and/or securitizations of which $183 was utilized as of December 31,  
2003. Any bid or performance related bonds with terms that extend beyond December 31, 2006 are currently not eligible for the support  
provided by this facility. In addition to the support facility with EDC, our existing security agreements permit us to secure additional  
obligations under bid and performance related bonds with the assets pledged under the security agreements and to provide cash collateral  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
as security for these types of bonds. See “Available support facility” for additional information on the EDC Support Facility and the security  
agreements and see “Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters  
— EDC Support Facility” for additional information in connection with amendments to the EDC Support Facility and developments in  
connection with the EDC Support Facility and related security agreements subsequent to December 31, 2003.  
Receivables securitization and certain lease financing transactions  
In January 2003, the Financial Accounting Standards Board, or FASB, issued FASB Interpretation, or FIN, No. 46, “Consolidation of Variable  
Interest Entities — an Interpretation of Accounting Research Bulletin No. 51, “Consolidated Financial Statements”, or FIN 46, and in  
December 2003, the FASB issued a revision of FIN 46 — FIN 46 (Revised 2003), or FIN 46R. FIN 46R provides guidance with respect to the  
consolidation of variable interest entities, or VIEs. VIEs are characterized as entities in which equity investors do not have a “controlling  
financial interest” or there is not sufficient equity at risk for the entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support.  
Reporting entities which have a variable interest in such an entity and are deemed to be the primary beneficiary must consolidate the variable  
interest entity.  
As of December 31, 2003, our participation in a lease financing transaction was structured through a single transaction variable interest entity  
which did not have sufficient equity at risk as defined in FIN 46R and is no longer considered an off-balance sheet arrangement effective  
July 1, 2003. We retained certain risks associated with guaranteeing recovery of the unamortized principal balance of the special purpose  
entity’s debt which represented the majority of the risks associated with the variable interest entity’s activities. For additional information, see  
“Consolidation of variable interest entities” in note 4(d) of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
We have also conducted certain receivable sales transactions either directly with financial institutions or with multi-seller conduits. Under  
some of these agreements, we have continued as servicing agent and/or have provided limited recourse. The fair value of these retained  
interests is based on the market value of servicing the receivables, historical payment patterns, expected future cash flows and appropriate  
discount rates as applicable. Where we have acted as the servicing agent, we generally have not recorded an asset or liability related to  
servicing as the annual servicing fees were equivalent to those that would have been paid to a third party servicing agent. Also, we have not  
historically experienced significant credit losses with respect to receivables sold with limited recourse. As of December 31, 2003, we were not  
required to, and did not, consolidate or provide any of the additional disclosures set out in FIN 46R with respect to the variable interest entities  
involving receivable sales because we were not considered the primary beneficiary.  
Additionally, we have agreed to indemnify our counterparties in receivables securitization transactions. The indemnifications provided to  
counterparties in these types of transactions may require us to compensate counterparties for costs incurred as a result of changes in laws and  
regulations (including tax legislation) or in the interpretations of such laws and regulations, or as a result of regulatory penalties that may be  
suffered by the counterparty as a consequence of the transaction. Certain receivables securitization transactions include indemnifications  
requiring the repurchase of the receivables if the particular transaction becomes invalid. As of December 31, 2003, we had approximately $327  
of securitized receivables which were subject to repurchase under this provision, in which case we would assume all rights to collect such  
receivables. The indemnification provisions generally expire upon expiration of the securitization agreements, which extend through 2005, or  
collection of the receivable amount by the counterparty. We are generally unable to estimate the maximum potential liability for all of these  
types of indemnification guarantees as certain agreements do not specify a maximum amount and the amounts are dependent upon the outcome  
of future contingent events, the nature and likelihood of which cannot be determined at this time. Historically, we have not made any  
significant indemnification payments or receivable repurchases under these agreements and no significant liability has been accrued in the  
accompanying consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligation associated with these guarantees.  
Other indemnifications or guarantees  
Through our normal course of business, we have also entered into other indemnifications or guarantees that arise in various types of  
arrangements including:  
business sale and business combination agreements;  
intellectual property indemnification obligations;  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
lease agreements;  
third party debt agreements;  
indemnification of banks and agents under our credit and support facilities and security agreements; and  
other indemnification agreements.  
In 2003, we did not make any significant payments under any of these indemnifications or guarantees. In certain cases, due to the nature of the  
agreement, we have not been able to estimate our maximum potential loss or the maximum potential loss has not been specified. For additional  
information, see “Guarantees” in note 13 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Application of critical accounting estimates  
Our accompanying consolidated financial statements are based on the selection and application of accounting policies, generally accepted in  
the U.S., which require us to make significant estimates and assumptions. We believe that the following accounting estimates may involve a  
higher degree of judgment and complexity in their application and represent our critical accounting estimates. The application of these  
estimates requires us to make subjective and objective judgments.  
In general, any changes in estimates or assumptions relating to revenue recognition, provisions for doubtful accounts, provisions for inventory  
and other contingencies (excluding legal contingencies) are directly reflected in the results of our reportable operating segments. Changes in  
estimates or assumptions pertaining to our tax asset valuations, our pension and post-retirement benefits and our legal contingencies are  
generally not reflected in our reportable operating segments, but are reflected on a consolidated basis.  
We have discussed the application of these critical accounting estimates with the Audit Committee of our Board of Directors.  
Revenue recognition  
Our material revenue streams are the result of a wide range of activities, from custom design and installation over a period of time to a single  
delivery of equipment to a customer. Our networking solutions also cover a broad range of technologies and are offered on a global basis. As a  
result, our revenue recognition policies can differ depending on the level of customization within the solution and the contractual terms with  
the customer. Newer technologies within one of our reporting segments may also have different revenue recognition policies, depending on,  
among other factors, the specific performance and acceptance criteria within the applicable contract. Therefore, management must use  
judgment in determining how to apply the current accounting standards and interpretations, not only based on the networking solution, but also  
within networking solutions based on reviewing the level of customization and contractual terms with the customer. As a result, our revenues  
may fluctuate from period to period based on the mix of solutions sold and the geographic region in which they are sold.  
When a sale involves multiple deliverables where the deliverables are governed by more than one authoritative standard, we evaluate all  
deliverables to determine whether they represent separate units of accounting based on the following criteria:  
whether the delivered item has value to the customer on a stand-alone basis;  
whether there is objective and reliable evidence of the fair value of the undelivered item(s); and  
if the contract includes a general right of return relative to the delivered item, delivery or performance of the undelivered item(s) is  
considered probable and is substantially in our control.  
Our determination of whether deliverables within a multiple element arrangement can be treated separately for revenue recognition purposes  
involves significant estimates and judgment, such as whether fair value can be established on undelivered obligations and/or whether delivered  
elements have standalone value to the customer. Changes to our assessment of the accounting units in an arrangement and/or our ability to  
establish fair values could significantly change the timing of revenue recognition.  
If objective and reliable evidence of fair value exists for all units of accounting in the contract, revenue is allocated to each unit of accounting  
or element based on relative fair values. In situations where there is objective and reliable evidence of fair value for all undelivered elements,  
but not for delivered elements, the residual method is used to allocate the contract consideration. Under the residual method, the amount of  
revenue allocated to delivered elements equals the total arrangement consideration less the aggregate fair value of any undelivered elements.  
Each unit of accounting is then accounted for under the applicable revenue recognition guidance. If fair value does not exist for any  
undelivered element,  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
revenue is not recognized until the earlier of (i) the undelivered element is delivered or (ii) fair value of the undelivered element exists, unless  
the undelivered element is a service, in which case revenue is recognized as the service is performed once the service is the only undelivered  
element.  
Our assessment of which revenue recognition guidance is appropriate to account for a deliverable also can involve significant judgment. For  
instance, the determination of whether software is more than incidental to hardware can impact whether the hardware is accounted for under  
software revenue recognition or general revenue recognition guidance. This assessment could impact the amount and timing of revenue  
recognition.  
For accounting units related to customized network solutions and certain network build outs, revenues are recognized under SOP 81-1 using  
the percentage-of-completion method. In using the percentage-of-completion method, revenues are generally recorded based on a measure of  
the percentage of costs incurred to date on a contract relative to the estimated total expected contract costs. Significant judgment is often  
required when estimating total contract costs and progress to completion on these arrangements, as well as whether a loss is expected to be  
incurred on the contract. Management uses historical experience, project plans and an assessment of the risks and uncertainties inherent in the  
arrangement to establish these estimates. Uncertainties include implementation delays or performance issues that may or may not be within our  
control. Changes in these estimates could result in a material impact on revenues and net earnings (loss).  
We make certain sales through multiple distribution channels, primarily resellers and distributors. These customers are generally given certain  
rights of return. Accruals for estimated sales returns and other allowances and deferrals are recorded as a reduction of revenue at the time of  
revenue recognition. These provisions are based on contract terms and prior claims experience and involve significant estimates. If these  
estimates are significantly different from actual results, our revenue could be impacted.  
We provide extended payment terms on certain software contracts and may sell these receivables to third parties. The fees on these contracts  
are considered fixed or determinable if the contracts are similar to others for which we have a standard business practice of providing extended  
payment terms and have a history of successfully collecting under the original payment terms without making concessions. If fees are not  
considered fixed or determinable at the outset of the arrangement, revenue for delivered products is deferred until the fees become legally due  
and payable and therefore estimates and judgment in this area can impact the timing of revenue recognition.  
The collectibility of trade and notes receivables is also critical in determining whether revenue should be recognized, especially considering the  
current economic environment within our industry. As part of the revenue recognition process, we determine whether trade or notes receivables  
are reasonably assured of collection and whether there has been deterioration in the credit quality of our customers that could result in our  
inability to collect the receivables. We will defer revenue but recognize related costs if we are uncertain as to whether we will be able to collect  
the receivable. As a result, our estimates and judgment regarding customer credit quality could significantly impact the timing and amount of  
revenue recognition.  
For further information on our revenue recognition policies relating to our material revenue streams, you should also refer to note 2(d) of the  
accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Provisions for doubtful accounts  
In establishing the appropriate provisions for trade, notes and long-term receivables due from customers, we make assumptions with respect to  
their future collectibility. Our assumptions are based on an individual assessment of a customer’s credit quality as well as subjective factors  
and trends, including the aging of receivable balances. Generally, these individual credit assessments occur prior to the inception of the credit  
exposure and at regular reviews during the life of the exposure and consider:  
a customer’s ability to meet and sustain its financial commitments;  
a customer’s current and projected financial condition;  
the positive or negative effects of the current and projected industry outlook; and  
the economy in general.  
Once we consider all of these individual factors, we make a determination as to the probability of default. An appropriate provision is then  
made, which takes into consideration the severity of the likely loss on the outstanding receivable balance based on our experience in collecting  
these amounts. In addition to these individual assessments, in general, outstanding trade  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
accounts receivable amounts that are greater than 365 days are fully provisioned for and amounts greater than 180 days are 50% provisioned  
for. In subsequent periods, we may be required to make adjustments once further information becomes available or actual events occur. As a  
result, we may incur significant adjustments to our provisions for trade, notes and long-term receivables.  
We recorded net receivable recoveries, related to continuing operations, of $180 in 2003. In 2002 and 2001, we recorded receivable provisions,  
related to continuing operations, of $291 and $1,791, respectively. The net receivable recoveries of $180 in 2003 primarily related to trade and  
customer financing receivable recoveries as a result of favorable settlements related to our sale or restructuring of various receivables as well as  
net recoveries on other trade and customer financing receivables due to subsequent collections for amounts exceeding our original estimates of  
net recovery. These recoveries were partially offset by receivable provisions recorded during 2003 that related to our normal business activity.  
The receivable provisions recorded in 2002 and 2001 primarily related to the financial difficulties of several of our service provider and  
enterprise customers as a result of the significant industry adjustment.  
The following table summarizes our accounts receivable and long-term receivable balances and related reserves of our continuing operations as  
of:  
December 31,  
2003  
2002  
Gross accounts receivable  
Provision for doubtful accounts  
$
$
2,699  
(194)  
$
$
2,730  
(502)  
Accounts receivable — net  
2,505  
2,228  
Accounts receivable provision as a percentage of gross accounts receivables  
7%  
18%  
Gross long-term receivables  
Provision for doubtful accounts  
$
$
386  
(297)  
$
$
1,054  
(780)  
Net long-term receivables  
89  
274  
Long-term receivable provision as a percentage of gross long-term receivables  
77%  
74%  
Throughout 2002 and 2001, we recorded significant provisions related to receivables from our continuing operations compared to 2003 when  
we recorded significant net recoveries. Given the current market conditions and creditworthiness of some of our customers, it is difficult to  
determine the extent to which this trend will continue in the future.  
Provisions for inventory  
Management must make estimates about the future customer demand for our products when establishing the appropriate provisions for  
inventory. When making these estimates, we consider general economic conditions and growth prospects within our customers’ ultimate  
marketplace, and the market acceptance of our current and pending products. These judgments must be made in the context of our customers’  
shifting technology needs and changes in the geographic mix of our customers. With respect to our provisioning policy, in general, we fully  
reserve for surplus inventory in excess of our 365 day demand forecast or that we deem to be obsolete. Generally, our inventory provisions  
have an inverse relationship with the projected demand for our products. For example, our provisions usually increase as projected demand  
decreases due to adverse changes in the conditions mentioned above. We have experienced significant changes in required provisions in recent  
periods due to changes in strategic direction, such as discontinuances of product lines, as well as declining market conditions. A  
misinterpretation or misunderstanding of any of these conditions could result in inventory losses in excess of the provisions determined to be  
appropriate as of the balance sheet date.  
We recorded inventory provisions, related to continuing operations, of $1,226 as of December 31, 2003, $1,180 as of December 31, 2002 and  
$918 as of December 31, 2001. The increase in inventory provisions was primarily due to our inventory levels being aligned to decreased  
customer demand in 2003 compared to 2002 and 2001. The following table summarizes our inventory balances and other related reserves of  
our continuing operations as of:  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
December 31,  
2003  
2002  
Gross inventory  
Inventory provisions  
$
$
2,416  
(1,226)  
$
$
2,686  
(1,180)  
Inventories — net  
1,190  
1,506  
Inventory provisions as a percentage of gross inventory  
51%  
(120)  
44%  
(171)  
(a)  
Other reserves for claims related to our contract manufacturers and suppliers  
(a)  
This amount was included in other accrued liabilities and related to cancellation charges, contracted for inventory in excess of future demand and the settlement of certain  
other claims.  
As of December 31, 2003, our inventory provisions as a percentage of gross inventory was 51%. In the future, we may be required to make  
significant adjustments to these provisions for the sale and/or disposition of inventory that was previously provided for.  
Customers continued to be cautious with their capital expenditures in 2004. As a result, we will continue to closely monitor our inventory  
provisions to ensure that they appropriately reflect the current market conditions. However, the inventory provisions we have recorded in the  
past may not be reflective of those in future quarters.  
Income taxes  
Tax asset valuation  
Our net deferred tax asset balance was $3,575 at December 31, 2003 and $3,035 at December 31, 2002. The $540 increase was primarily due  
to the impact of foreign exchange effects related primarily to the Canadian dollar and the British pound. We currently have deferred tax assets  
resulting from net operating loss carryforwards, tax credit carryforwards and deductible temporary differences, all of which are available to  
reduce future taxes payable in our significant tax jurisdictions. Generally, our loss carryforward periods range from seven years to an indefinite  
period. As a result, we do not expect that a significant portion of these carryforwards will expire in the near future.  
We assess the realization of these deferred tax assets quarterly to determine whether an income tax valuation allowance is required. Based on  
available evidence, both positive and negative, we determine whether it is more likely than not that all or a portion of the remaining net  
deferred tax assets will be realized. The main factors that we consider include:  
cumulative losses in recent years;  
history of loss carryforwards and other tax assets expiring;  
the carryforward period associated with the deferred tax assets;  
the nature of the income that can be used to realize the deferred tax assets;  
our net earnings/loss; and  
future earnings potential determined through the use of internal forecasts.  
In evaluating the positive and negative evidence, the weight given to each type of evidence must be proportionate to the extent to which it can  
be objectively verified. If it is our belief that it is more likely than not that some portion of these assets will not be realized, an income tax  
valuation allowance is recorded.  
In 2003, our gross income tax valuation allowances increased to $3,344 as of December 31, 2003 from $3,024 as of December 31, 2002. The  
increase was primarily due to the impact of foreign exchange effects and additional valuation allowances recorded against the deferred tax  
assets recognized in connection with our minimum pension liability, partially offset by drawdowns related to our 2003 net earnings. We  
assessed positive evidence including forecasts of future taxable income to support realization of the net deferred tax assets, and negative  
evidence including our cumulative loss position, and concluded that the valuation allowances as of December 31, 2003 were appropriate.  
If market conditions deteriorate further or future results of operations are less than expected, future assessments may result in a determination  
that some or all of the net deferred tax assets are not realizable. As a result, we may need to establish an  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
additional tax valuation allowance for all or a portion of the net deferred tax assets, which may have a material adverse effect on our business,  
results of operations and financial condition. Alternatively, if our future results of operations are better than expected, these assessments may  
result in the reduction of our valuation allowances. Given the magnitude of our valuation allowance, future adjustments to this allowance based  
on actual results could result in a significant adjustment to our net earnings.  
Tax contingencies  
We are subject to ongoing examinations by certain taxation authorities of the jurisdictions in which we operate. We regularly assess the status  
of these examinations and the potential for adverse outcomes to determine the adequacy of the provision for income and other taxes. We  
believe that we have adequately provided for tax adjustments that we believe are probable as a result of any ongoing examination.  
We had previously entered into Advance Pricing Arrangements, or APAs, with the taxation authorities of the U.S. and Canada in connection  
with our intercompany transfer pricing and cost sharing arrangements between Canada and the U.S. These arrangements expired in 1999 and  
2000. In 2002, we filed APA requests with the taxation authorities of the U.S. Canada and the United Kingdom, or the U.K., that are expected  
to apply to the taxation years beginning in 2000. The APA requests are currently under consideration. We have applied the transfer pricing  
methodology proposed in the APA requests since 2001. As part of the APA applications, we have requested that the methodology adopted in  
2001 be applied retroactively to the 2000 taxation year. If the retroactive application is accepted by the taxation authorities, it would result in  
an increase in taxable income in certain jurisdictions offset by an equal decrease in taxable income in the other jurisdictions. We have provided  
for any taxes and interest that would be due as a result of retroactive application of the APAs.  
Although the outcome of the APA applications are uncertain, we do not believe the ultimate resolution of these negotiations will have a  
material adverse effect on our consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows. However, if this matter is resolved  
unfavorably, it could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity.  
Goodwill valuation  
Commencing January 1, 2002, we test goodwill for possible impairment on an annual basis on October 1 of each year and at any other time if  
an event occurs or circumstances change that would more likely than not reduce the fair value of a reporting unit below its carrying amount.  
Circumstances that could trigger an impairment test include, but are not limited to:  
a significant adverse change in the business climate or legal factors;  
an adverse action or assessment by a regulator;  
unanticipated competition;  
loss of key personnel;  
the likelihood that a reporting unit or a significant portion of a reporting unit will be sold or disposed of;  
results of testing for recoverability of a significant asset group within a reporting unit; and/or  
recognition of a goodwill impairment loss in the financial statements of a subsidiary that is a component of a reporting unit.  
The determination as to whether a write down of goodwill is necessary involves significant judgment based on the short-term and long-term  
projections of the future performance of the reporting unit to which the goodwill is attributed. The assumptions supporting the estimated future  
cash flows of the reporting unit, including the discount rate used and estimated terminal value, reflect our best estimates.  
We have not yet finalized our assessment for potential triggering events for fiscal year 2004 and further have not yet completed our annual  
impairment test for 2004, which is to be performed effective October 1, 2004. The results of these assessments may or may not result in a  
triggering event. We do not believe that our goodwill impairment test would result in an impairment charge.  
In 2003, we concluded that an impairment of our goodwill did not exist and no write down was recorded.  
In 2002, we incurred a goodwill write down of $595. As a result of the continued decline in both our overall market value generally and within  
Optical Networks specifically, we evaluated the goodwill associated with the businesses within Optical Networks for potential impairment. The  
conclusion of those evaluations was that the fair value associated with the businesses within Optical Networks could no longer support the  
carrying value of the remaining goodwill associated with them. Fair value was estimated using the then expected present value of discounted  
future cash flows of these businesses. The discount rate used ranged from 12% to 16% and the terminal values were estimated based on  
terminal growth rates ranging from 3% to 5%.  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In 2001, we incurred a goodwill write down of $11,426. In 2001, we performed an assessment of the carrying values of goodwill associated  
with our acquisitions. The assessment during that period was performed in light of the significant negative industry and economic trends  
impacting our operations and expected future growth rates, and the adjustment of technology valuations. The conclusion of our assessment was  
that the decline in market conditions within the industry was significant and other than temporary. The write downs were primarily related to  
the goodwill within Enterprise Networks, Optical Networks and Other. Fair value was determined based on discounted future cash flows for  
the businesses within these reportable segments that had separately distinguishable goodwill balances and whose operations had not yet been  
fully integrated. The cash flow periods used were five years, the discount rate used was 20%, and the terminal values were estimated based  
upon terminal growth rates ranging from 5% to 11%. The discount rate was based on our weighted average cost of capital, adjusted for the  
risks associated with the operations.  
The carrying value of goodwill was $2,305 as of December 31, 2003 and $2,199 as of December 31, 2002. The increase in goodwill primarily  
related to our acquisition of the minority interests in our French and German operations as discussed in “Developments in 2003 and 2004”. For  
additional information on this transaction, including the allocation of the purchase price, see “Nortel Networks Germany and Nortel Networks  
France” in note 10 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Pension and post-retirement benefits  
We maintain various pension and post-retirement benefit plans for our employees globally. These plans include significant pension and post-  
retirement benefit obligations which are calculated based on actuarial valuations. Key assumptions are made in determining these obligations  
and related expenses, including expected rates of return on plan assets and discount rates.  
For 2003, the expected long-term rate of return on plan assets used to estimate pension expenses was 7.8% on a weighted average basis, which  
was the rate determined at September 30, 2002. The expected long-term rate of return on plan assets remained unchanged from 2002. The  
discount rates used to estimate the net pension obligations and expenses for 2003 were 5.8% and 6.3%, respectively, on a weighted average  
basis, compared to 6.3% and 6.7%, respectively, in 2002.  
The key assumptions used to estimate the post-retirement costs for 2003 were an expected long-term rate of return on plan assets of 8.0% and a  
discount rate of 6.0% and 6.8% for the obligations and costs, respectively, both on a weighted average basis. The expected long-term rate of  
return on plan assets remained unchanged from 2002. The discount rates for the obligations and costs decreased in 2003 to 6.0% and 6.8%,  
respectively, from 6.8% and 7.0%, respectively, in 2002 due to the decline experienced in global interest rates during 2001 through 2002.  
The difference between the expected long-term rate of return on plan assets and the discount rate reported for the net pension obligations and  
expenses and those rates reported for the net post-retirement benefit obligations and costs is due to the weighted-average calculation as a result  
of the number of countries in which we offer either pension or pension and post-retirement benefits. In developing these assumptions, we  
evaluated, among other things, input from our actuaries, expected long-term market returns and current high-quality bond rates.  
Changes in net periodic pension and post retirement benefit expense may occur in the future due to changes in our expected rate of return on  
plan assets and discount rate resulting from economic events. The following table highlights the sensitivity of our pension and post retirement  
benefit expense to changes in these assumptions, assuming all other assumptions remain constant:  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Effect on 2003 pre-tax  
post-retirement  
Effect on 2003 pre-tax  
pension expense *  
Change in Assumption  
benefit expense  
Increase/(decrease)  
($50)  
Increase/(decrease)  
$ <1  
1 percentage point increase in the expected return on assets  
1 percentage point decrease in the expected return on assets  
1 percentage point increase in the discount rate  
50  
(73)  
67  
<1  
(3)  
2
1 percentage point decrease in the discount rate  
*
excludes settlement costs (lump sum and termination payments to participants which discharges our obligations)  
Plan assets were primarily comprised of debt and equity securities. Included in the equity securities of the defined benefit plan were common  
shares of Nortel Networks Corporation with an aggregate market value of $13 (0.2 % of total plan assets) as of December 31, 2003 and $3  
(0.1% of total plan assets) as of December 31, 2002.  
Unrecognized actuarial gains and losses are being recognized over approximately a 12 year period, which represents the weighted-average  
expected remaining service life of the employee group. Unrecognized actuarial gains and losses arise from several factors including experience  
and assumption changes in the obligations and from the difference between expected returns and actual returns on assets. At the end of 2003,  
we had unrecognized net actuarial losses related to the defined benefit plans of $1,664 which could result in an increase to pension expenses in  
future years depending on several factors, including whether such losses exceed the corridor in accordance with SFAS No. 87, “Employers’  
Accounting for Pensions”. The post-retirement benefit plans had unrecognized actuarial losses of $119 at the end of 2003.  
The estimated accumulated benefit obligations for the defined benefit plans exceeded the fair value of the plan assets at September 30, 2003 as  
a result of reductions in discount rates and changes in foreign exchange rates which more than offset the favorable impacts of strong pension  
asset returns and the voluntary contributions made by us during 2003. Accordingly, we recorded a non-cash charge of $219 ($187 after tax) to  
shareholders’ equity for the minimum pension liability. A similar charge may be required in the future as the impact of changes in global  
capital markets and interest rates on the value of our pension plan assets and obligations is measured.  
During 2003, we made cash contributions to our defined benefit pension plans of approximately $300. In 2004, we expect to make cash  
contributions of approximately $140 to our defined benefit pension plans, which excludes $78 of deferred contributions for 2004 that were  
made in 2003, and approximately $30 to our post-retirement benefit plans.  
For 2004, our expected rate of return on plan assets was lowered from 7.8% to 7.4% for defined benefit pension plans and was lowered from  
8.0% to 6.0% for 2004 for post-retirement benefit plans. Also for 2004, we lowered our discount rate on a weighted-average basis for pension  
expenses from 6.3% to 5.8% for the defined benefit pension plans and from 6.8% to 6.0% for post-retirement benefit plans given the declining  
trend in current global interest rates. We will continue to evaluate our expected long-term rates of return on plan assets and discount rates at  
least annually and make adjustments as necessary, which could change the pension and post-retirement obligations and expenses in the future.  
If the actual operation of the plans differs from the assumptions, additional contributions by us may be required. If we are required to make  
significant contributions to fund the defined benefit plans, reported results could be materially and adversely affected and our cash flow  
available for other uses may be significantly reduced.  
For additional information, see “Employee benefit plans” in note 9 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
Special charges  
In 2001 we entered into an unprecedented period of business realignment in response to a significant adjustment in the industry. We  
implemented a company-wide restructuring plan to streamline our operations and activities around core markets and operations, which  
included significant workforce reductions, global real estate closures and dispositions, substantial write-downs of our plant and equipment,  
goodwill and other intangible assets and extensive contract settlements with customers and suppliers around the world. As a result of these  
actions, our workforce declined significantly from January 1, 2001 to December 31, 2003 and over the same time period, we significantly  
reduced our facilities.  
At each reporting date, we evaluate our accruals related to workforce reduction charges, contract settlement and lease costs  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
and plant and equipment write downs to ensure that these accruals are still appropriate. As of December 31, 2003, we had $64 in accruals  
related to workforce reduction charges and $456 in accruals related to contract settlement and lease costs, which included significant estimates,  
primarily related to sublease income over the lease terms and other costs for vacated properties. In certain instances, we may determine that  
these accruals are no longer required because of efficiencies in carrying out our restructuring work plan. In these cases, we reverse any related  
accrual to income when it is determined it is no longer required. Alternatively, in certain circumstances, we may determine that certain accruals  
are insufficient as new events occur or as additional information is obtained. In these cases, we would increase the applicable existing accrual  
with the offset recorded against income.  
Other contingencies  
We are subject to the possibility of various loss contingencies arising in the ordinary course of business. As a result, we consider the likelihood  
of loss or impairment of an asset or the incurrence of a liability, as well as our ability to reasonably estimate the amount of loss, in determining  
loss contingencies. We recognize a reserve for an estimated loss contingency when it is probable that an asset has been impaired or a liability  
has been incurred and the amount of loss can be reasonably estimated. We regularly evaluate current information available to us to determine  
whether such accruals should be adjusted.  
We are also subject to proceedings, lawsuits, investigations and other claims (some of which may involve substantial dollar amounts),  
including proceedings under laws and government regulations related to securities, income and other taxes, environmental, labor, product and  
other matters. In particular, our two restatements of our consolidated financial statements and related events have caused us to be subject to  
ongoing regulatory and criminal investigations and significant pending civil litigation actions in the U.S. and Canada. We are required to assess  
the likelihood of any adverse judgments or outcomes in any of these matters, as well as potential ranges of probable losses. A determination of  
the amount of reserves required, if any, for these contingencies is based on an analysis of each individual issue. The required reserves may  
change in the future due to new developments in each matter or changes in approach such as a change in settlement strategy in dealing with  
these matters. We cannot determine whether these matters will, individually or collectively, have a material adverse effect on our business,  
results of operations and financial condition. See “Risk factors/forward looking statements”.  
For more information related to our outstanding legal and other proceedings, see “Contingencies” in note 22 of the accompanying consolidated  
financial statements.  
Accounting changes and recent accounting pronouncements  
Accounting changes  
Our consolidated financial statements are based on the selection and application of accounting policies, generally accepted in the U.S. For more  
information related to the accounting policies that we adopted as a result of new accounting standards, see “Accounting changes” in note 4 of  
the accompanying consolidated financial statements. The following summarizes the accounting changes that we have adopted:  
Guarantees — the adoption of FASB Interpretation FIN No. 45, “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for  
Guarantees, Including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others — an Interpretation of FASB Statement Nos. 5, 57 and 107  
and Rescission of FIN No. 34” did not have a material impact on our results of operations and financial condition.  
Asset retirement obligations — the adoption of SFAS No. 143, “Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations”, or SFAS No. 143,  
resulted in a decrease to net earnings of $12 (net of tax of nil) which has been reported as a cumulative effect of accounting changes  
— net of tax, an increase in plant and equipment — net of $4 and an asset retirement obligation liability of $16 as of January 1,  
2003. The adoption of SFAS No. 143 did not have a material impact on depreciation and accretion expense.  
Accounting for costs associated with exit or disposal activities — the adoption of SFAS No. 146, “Accounting for Costs Associated  
with Exit or Disposal Activities” did not have a material impact on our results of operations and financial condition.  
Consolidation of variable interest entities — the adoption of FIN 46 resulted in the inclusion of $184 in long-term debt and $183 of  
plant and equipment — net. These amounts represented both the collateral and maximum exposure to loss as a result of our  
involvement with VIEs.  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accounting for certain financial instruments with characteristics of both liabilities and equity — the adoption of SFAS No. 150,  
“Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with Characteristics of both Liabilities and Equity” did not have a material impact  
on our results of operations and financial condition.  
Accounting for revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables — the adoption of Emerging Issues Task Force 00-21, “Revenue  
Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables” did not have a material impact on our results of operations and financial condition.  
Amendment of SFAS No. 133 on derivative instruments and hedging activities — the adoption of SFAS No. 149, “Amendment of  
SFAS No. 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities” did not have a material impact on our results of operations and  
financial condition.  
Determining whether an arrangement contains a lease — the impact of the adoption of the Emerging Issues Task Force 01-8,  
“Determining Whether an Arrangement Contains a Lease” on our future results of operations and financial condition will depend  
on the terms contained in contracts signed or contracts amended in the future.  
Pensions and other post-retirement benefits — the adoption of SFAS No. 132 (Revised 2003), “Employers’ Disclosures about  
Pensions and Other Post-retirement Benefits” requires additional disclosures regarding defined benefit pension plan and other post-  
retirement benefit plan assets, obligations, cash flows and net cost as well as retaining a number of disclosures required by SFAS  
No. 132, “Employers’ Disclosures about Pensions and Other Post-retirement Benefits”. The applicable current year requirements  
have been applied in the presentation of the consolidated financial statements.  
Stock-based compensation — we adopted SFAS No. 148, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation — Transition and  
Disclosure — an Amendment of FASB Statement No. 123” which amended the transitional provisions of SFAS No. 123,  
“Accounting for Stock-based Compensation” for companies electing to recognize employee stock-based compensation using the  
fair value based method. Effective January 1, 2003 we elected to expense employee stock-based compensation using the fair value  
based method prospectively for all awards granted, modified, or settled on or after January 1, 2003. The impact of the adoption of  
the fair value based method for expense recognition of employee awards resulted in $26 (net of tax of nil) of stock option expense  
during 2003.  
Accounting for goodwill and other intangible assets — the adoption of SFAS No. 142, effective January 1, 2002, which changed  
the accounting for goodwill from an amortization method to an impairment approach, had a material impact on our results of  
operations and financial condition through the elimination of amortization expense.  
Impairment or disposal of long-lived assets (plant and equipment and acquired technology) — the adoption of SFAS No. 144,  
“Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets” resulted in write downs for plant and equipment of $382 related  
to long-lived assets held and used, and $38 related to long-lived assets held for sale for the year ended December 31, 2002. See  
“Special charges” in note 7 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements for further information regarding these write  
downs.  
Derivative financial instruments — the adoption of SFAS No. 133 and the corresponding amendments under SFAS No. 138,  
“Accounting for Certain Derivative Instruments and Certain Hedging Activities — an Amendment of SFAS No. 133” resulted in a  
cumulative decrease in net loss of $15 (net of tax of $9), which has been reported as cumulative effect of accounting changes-net of  
tax and a charge to other comprehensive income of $7 (net of tax of $4) in 2001.  
Recent accounting pronouncements  
On December 8, 2003, the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003, or the MPDIM Act, was signed into law  
in the U.S. The MPDIM Act introduced a prescription drug benefit under Medicare (specifically, Medicare Part D) as well as a federal subsidy  
to sponsors of retiree health care benefit plans that provide a benefit that is at least actuarially equivalent to Medicare Part D. As permitted by  
FASB Staff Position, or FSP, Financial Accounting Standard, or FAS 106-1, “Accounting and Disclosure Requirements Related to the  
Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003”, we chose to make the one-time deferral election which remained  
in effect for our plans in the U.S. until the earlier of the issuance of specific authoritative guidance by the FASB on how to account for the  
federal subsidy to be provided to plan sponsors under the MPDIM Act, or the remeasurement of plan assets and obligations subsequent to  
January 31, 2004. Therefore, our post-retirement benefit obligation as of December 31, 2003 and net post-retirement benefit cost for the year  
ended December 31, 2003 did not reflect the effects of the MPDIM Act on the plans. On May 19, 2004, FSP FAS 106-2, “Accounting and  
Disclosure Requirements Related to the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003”, or FSP FAS 106-2, was  
issued by the FASB to provide guidance relating to the prescription drug subsidy provided by the MPDIM Act. We expect to have portions of  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
our post-retirement benefit plans qualify as actuarially equivalent to the benefit provided under the MPDIM Act, for which it expects to receive  
federal subsidies. We expect that other portions of the plans will not be actuarially equivalent. The financial impact of the federal subsidies was  
determined by remeasuring our retiree life and medical obligation as of January 1, 2004, as provided under the retroactive application provision  
of FSP FAS 106-2. The effective date of FSP FAS 106-2 is the first annual or interim period beginning after June 15, 2004, with earlier  
adoption encouraged. We adopted FSP FAS 106-2 for the three-month period ended June 30, 2004. As a result of adoption, the accrued post-  
retirement benefit obligation decreased by $31. Net periodic post-retirement benefit costs are expected to decrease by $2 for 2004, as a result of  
the subsidy.  
In March 2004, the Emerging Issues Task Force, or EITF reached consensus on Issue No. 03-1, “The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary  
Impairment and Its Application to Certain Investments”, or EITF 03-1. EITF 03-1 provides guidance on determining when an investment is  
considered impaired, whether that impairment is other than temporary and the measurement of an impairment loss. EITF 03-1 is applicable to  
marketable debt and equity securities within the scope of SFAS No. 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities”,  
or SFAS 115, and SFAS No. 124, “Accounting for Certain Investments Held by Not-for-Profit Organizations”, and equity securities that are  
not subject to the scope of SFAS 115 and not accounted for under the equity method of accounting. In September 2004, the FASB issued FSP  
EITF 03-1-1, “Effective Date of Paragraphs 10-20 of EITF Issue No. 03-1, ‘The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its  
Application to Certain Investments’”, which delays the effective date for the measurement and recognition criteria contained in EITF 03-1 until  
final application guidance is issued. The delay does not suspend the requirement to recognize other-than-temporary impairments as required by  
existing authoritative literature. The adoption of EITF 03-1 is not expected to have a material impact on our results of operations and financial  
position.  
On September 30, 2004, the EITF reached a consensus on Issue No. 04-8, “The Effect of Contingently Convertible Debt on Diluted Earnings  
Per Share”, or EITF 04-8, which addresses when the dilutive effect of contingently convertible debt instruments should be included in diluted  
earnings (loss) per share. EITF 04-8 requires that contingently convertible debt instruments be included in the computation of diluted earnings  
(loss) per share regardless of whether the market price trigger has been met. EITF 04-8 also requires that prior period diluted earnings  
(loss) per share amounts presented for comparative purposes be restated. EITF 04-8 is effective for reporting periods ending after  
December 15, 2004. The adoption of EITF 04-8 is not expected to have an impact on our diluted earnings (loss) per share.  
Market risk  
Market risk represents the risk of loss that may impact our consolidated financial statements through adverse changes in financial market prices  
and rates. Our market risk exposure results primarily from fluctuations in interest rates and foreign exchange rates. To manage the risk from  
these fluctuations, we enter into various derivative-hedging transactions that we have authorized under our policies and procedures. We  
maintain risk management control systems to monitor market risks and counterparty risks. These systems rely on analytical techniques  
including both sensitivity analysis and value-at-risk estimations. We do not hold or issue financial instruments for trading purposes.  
For a discussion of our accounting policies for derivative financial instruments, see “Significant accounting policies” in note 2(t) and  
“Accounting changes” in note 4(e), (g), and (m) of the accompanying consolidated financial statements. Additional disclosure of our financial  
instruments is included in “Financial instruments and hedging activities” in note 12 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
We manage foreign exchange exposures using forward and option contracts to hedge sale and purchase commitments. Our most significant  
foreign exchange exposures are in the Canadian dollar, the British pound and the euro. We enter into U.S. to Canadian dollar forward and  
option contracts intended to hedge the U.S. to Canadian dollar exposure on future revenues and expenditure streams. In accordance with SFAS  
No. 133, we recognize the gains and losses on the effective portion of these contracts in income when the hedged transaction occurs. Any  
ineffective portion of these contracts is recognized in income immediately.  
We expect to continue to expand our business globally and, as such, expect that an increasing proportion of our business may be denominated  
in currencies other than U.S. dollars. As a result, fluctuations in foreign currencies may have a material impact on our business, results of  
operations and financial condition. We try to minimize the impact of such currency fluctuations through our ongoing commercial practices and  
by attempting to hedge our major currency exposures. In attempting to manage this foreign exchange risk, we identify operations and  
transactions that may have exposure based upon the excess or deficiency of foreign currency receipts over foreign currency expenditures. Our  
significant currency flows for the year ended December 31, 2003 were in U.S. dollars, Canadian dollars, British pounds and euros. The net  
impact of foreign exchange fluctuations resulted in a gain of $105 in 2003, a loss of $65 in 2002 and a loss of $152 in 2001. Given our  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
exposure to international markets, we regularly monitor all of our material foreign currency exposures. We cannot predict whether we will  
incur foreign exchange gains or losses in the future. However, if significant foreign exchange losses are experienced, they could have a  
material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.  
We use sensitivity analysis to measure our foreign currency risk by computing the potential decrease in cash flows that may result from  
adverse changes in foreign exchange rates. The balances are segregated by source currency, and a hypothetical unfavorable variance in foreign  
exchange rates of 10% is applied to each net source currency position using year-end rates, to determine the potential decrease in cash flows  
over the next year. The sensitivity analysis includes all foreign currency-denominated cash, short-term and long-term debt, and derivative  
instruments that will impact cash flows over the next year that are held at December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. The underlying cash  
flows that relate to the hedged firm commitments are not included in the analysis. The analysis is performed at the reporting date and assumes  
no future changes in the balances or timing of cash flows from the year-end position. Further, the model assumes no correlation in the  
movement of foreign exchange rates. Based on a one-year time horizon, a 10% adverse change in exchange rates would result in a potential  
decrease in after-tax cash flows of $195 as of December 31, 2003 and $132 as of December 31, 2002. This potential decrease would result  
primarily from our exposure to the Canadian dollar, the British pound and the euro.  
A portion of our long-term debt is subject to changes in fair value resulting from changes in market interest rates. We have hedged a portion of  
this exposure to interest rate volatility using fixed for floating interest rate swaps. The change in fair value of the swaps are recognized in  
earnings with offsetting amounts related to the change in the fair value of the hedged debt attributable to interest rate changes. Any ineffective  
portion of the swaps is recognized in income immediately. We record net settlements on these swap instruments as adjustments to interest  
expense.  
Historically, we have managed interest rate exposures, as they relate to interest expense, using a diversified portfolio of fixed and floating rate  
instruments denominated in several major currencies. We use sensitivity analysis to measure our interest rate risk. The sensitivity analysis  
includes cash, our outstanding floating rate long-term debt and any outstanding instruments that convert fixed rate long-term debt to floating  
rate. A 100 basis point adverse change in interest rates would result in a potential decrease in cash flows of $51 as of December 31, 2003 and  
$39 as of December 31, 2002.  
Equity price risk  
The values of our equity investments in several publicly traded companies are subject to market price volatility. These investments are  
generally in companies in the technology industry sector and are classified as available for sale. We typically do not attempt to reduce or  
eliminate the market exposure on these investment securities. We also hold certain derivative instruments or warrants that are subject to market  
price volatility because their value is based on the common share price of a publicly traded company. These derivative instruments are  
generally acquired through business acquisitions or divestitures. In addition, derivative instruments may also be purchased to hedge exposure  
to certain compensation obligations that vary based on future Nortel Networks Corporation common share prices. We do not hold equity  
securities or derivative instruments for trading purposes. As of December 31, 2003, a hypothetical 20% adverse change in the stock prices of  
our publicly traded equity securities and the related underlying stock prices of publicly traded equity securities for certain of our derivative  
instruments would result in a loss in their aggregate fair values of $52 and $12, respectively, which would be offset by a corresponding  
reduction in future compensation expense. As of December 31, 2002, a hypothetical 20% adverse change in the stock prices of our publicly  
traded equity securities and the related underlying stock prices of publicly traded equity securities for certain of our derivative instruments  
would result in a loss in their aggregate fair values of $27.  
Environmental matters  
We are subject to numerous environmental protection laws and regulations in various jurisdictions around the world, primarily due to our  
manufacturing operations. As a result, we are exposed to liabilities and compliance costs arising from our past and current generation,  
management and disposition of hazardous substances and wastes.  
We have remedial activities under way at twelve of our facilities which are either currently occupied or were previously owned or occupied.  
We have also been listed as a potentially responsible party at six Superfund sites in the U.S. An estimate of our anticipated remediation costs  
associated with all such facilities and sites, to the extent probable and reasonably estimable, is included in our environmental accruals in an  
approximate amount of $33.  
For a discussion of Environmental matters, see “Contingencies” in note 22 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements.  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Legal proceedings  
Nortel Networks and/or certain of our directors and officers have been named as defendants in various class action lawsuits. We are unable to  
determine the ultimate aggregate amount of monetary liability or financial impact to us in these legal matters, which unless otherwise specified,  
seek damages from the defendants of material or indeterminate amounts. We are also a defendant in various other suits, claims, proceedings  
and investigations which are in the normal course of business. We cannot determine whether these matters will, individually or collectively,  
have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. We, and any of our named directors or  
officers, intend to vigorously defend these actions, suits, claims, proceedings and investigations. We are also subject to significant pending  
civil litigation and ongoing regulatory and criminal investigations in the U.S. and Canada which could require us to pay substantial judgments,  
settlements, fines or other penalties. For additional information related to our legal proceedings, see “Contingencies” in note 22 of the  
accompanying consolidated financial statements and “Risk factors/forward looking statements”.  
Risk factors/forward looking statements  
You should carefully consider the risks described below before investing in our securities. The risks described below are not the only ones  
facing us. Additional risks not currently known to us or that we currently believe are immaterial may also impair our business, results of  
operations, financial condition and liquidity. Unless required by applicable securities laws, we do not have any intention or obligation to  
publicly update or revise any forward looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.  
Certain statements in this Annual Report on Form 10-K contain words such as “could”, “expects”, “may”, “anticipates”, “believes”,  
“intends”, “estimates”, “plans”, “envisions”, “seeks” and other similar language and are considered forward looking statements. These  
statements are based on our current expectations, estimates, forecasts and projections about the operating environment, economies and  
markets in which we operate. In addition, other written or oral statements which are considered forward looking may be made by us or others  
on our behalf. These statements are subject to important risks, uncertainties and assumptions, which are difficult to predict and the actual  
outcome may be materially different. In particular, the risks described below could cause actual events to differ materially from those  
contemplated in forward looking statements.  
Risks relating to our restatements and related matters  
Our two restatements of our consolidated financial statements and related events have had, and will continue to have, a material  
adverse effect on us.  
In May 2003, we commenced certain balance sheet reviews at the direction of certain members of former management that led to the  
Comprehensive Review, which resulted in the First Restatement. In late October 2003, the Audit Committee initiated the Independent Review  
and engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection with the Independent Review. The Audit Committee sought to gain a full understanding of the  
events that caused significant excess liabilities to be maintained on the balance sheet that needed to be restated, and to recommend that our  
Board of Directors adopt, and direct management to implement, necessary remedial measures to address personnel, controls, compliance and  
discipline. As the Independent Review progressed, the Audit Committee directed new corporate management to examine in depth the concerns  
identified by WCPHD regarding provisioning activity and to review certain provision releases. That examination, and other errors identified by  
management, led to the Second Restatement and our revision of previously announced unaudited results for the year ended December 31, 2003.  
The need for the Second Restatement resulted in delays in filing the Reports.  
Over the course of the Second Restatement process, management identified certain accounting practices that it determined should be adjusted  
as part of the Second Restatement. In particular, management identified certain errors related to revenue recognition and undertook a process of  
revenue reviews. In light of the resulting adjustments to revenues previously reported, the Audit Committee has determined to review the facts  
and circumstances leading to the restatement of these revenues for specific transactions identified in the Second Restatement. The review will  
have a particular emphasis on the underlying conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues. The Audit Committee will seek a full  
understanding of the historic events that required the revenues for these specific transactions to be restated and will consider any appropriate  
additional remedial measures, including those involving internal controls and processes. The Audit Committee has engaged WCPHD to advise  
it in connection with this review.  
For more information on the Comprehensive Review, Independent Review, First Restatement, Second Restatement and Revenue Independent  
Review, see the “MD&A” and “Controls and Procedures” sections of this report.  
As a result of these events, we have become subject to the following key risks, each of which is described in more detail below. Each of these  
risks could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity.  
We are subject to ongoing regulatory and criminal investigations in the U.S. and Canada, which could require us to pay substantial  
fines or other penalties.  
We are subject to significant pending civil litigation, which if decided against us, could require us to pay  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
substantial judgments, settlements or other penalties.  
Material adverse legal judgments, fines, penalties or settlements could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of  
operations, financial condition and liquidity, which could be very significant.  
We cannot predict the outcome of the Revenue Independent Review being undertaken by our Audit Committee.  
We and our independent auditors have identified a number of material weaknesses related to our internal control over financial  
reporting, which could continue to impact our ability to report our results of operations and financial condition accurately and in a  
timely manner.  
The governing principles of the Independent Review particularly as they relate to remedial measures may take time to implement.  
The delayed filing of our Reports and related matters caused us to breach our public debt indentures and seek waivers from EDC  
under the EDC Support Facility, which may affect our liquidity. The continuing delays in filing certain of our Reports and related  
matters has resulted in a continuing breach of our public debt indentures and our obligations under the EDC Support Facility. It is  
possible that the holders of our public debt will seek to accelerate the maturity of that debt and EDC will not grant us additional  
waivers.  
Our credit ratings have been downgraded, we are currently unable to access our shelf registration statement filed with the SEC and  
we terminated the Five Year Facilities, each of which may affect our liquidity.  
The delay in filing certain of our Reports could cause the TSX and/or the NYSE to commence suspension or delisting procedures in  
respect of Nortel Networks Corporation’s common shares or other of our or NNL’s listed securities.  
Continuing negative publicity may adversely affect our business and the market price of our publicly traded securities.  
We may not be able to attract or retain the personnel necessary to achieve our business objectives.  
Ongoing SEC review may require us to amend our public disclosures further.  
We are subject to ongoing regulatory and criminal investigations in the U.S. and Canada, which could require us to pay substantial  
fines or other penalties.  
We are under investigation by the SEC and the OSC. On April 5, 2004, we announced that the SEC had issued a formal order of investigation  
in connection with our previous restatement of financial results for certain periods and our announcements in March 2004 regarding the likely  
need to revise certain previously announced results and restate previously filed financial results for one or more earlier periods.  
On April 13, 2004, we announced that we had received a letter from the staff of the OSC advising us of an OSC Enforcement Staff  
investigation into the same matters that are the subject of the SEC investigation.  
We have also received a U.S. federal grand jury subpoena for the production of certain documents sought in connection with an ongoing  
criminal investigation being conducted by the U.S. Attorney’s Office for the Northern District of Texas, Dallas Division. Further, the  
Integrated Market Enforcement Team of the RCMP has advised us that it would be commencing a criminal investigation into our financial  
accounting situation.  
Our senior management and Board of Directors have been required to devote significant time to these investigations and related matters. We  
cannot predict when these investigations will be completed, nor can we predict what the results of these investigations may be. Expenses  
incurred in connection with these investigations (which include substantial fees of lawyers and other professional advisors and potential  
obligations to indemnify officers and directors who may be parties to such actions) could adversely affect our cash position. We may be  
required to pay material fines, consent to injunctions on future conduct or suffer other penalties, each of which could have a material adverse  
effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. The investigations may adversely affect our ability to obtain,  
and/or increase the cost of obtaining, directors’ and officers’ liability insurance and/or other types of insurance, which could have a material  
adverse affect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. In addition, the findings and outcomes of the Independent Review  
and the regulatory and criminal investigations may affect the course of the civil litigation pending against us, which are more fully described  
below.  
The effects and results of these or other investigations may have a material adverse effect on our business, results of  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
operations, financial condition and liquidity.  
We are subject to significant pending civil litigation, which if decided against us, could require us to pay substantial judgments,  
settlements or other penalties.  
In addition to being subject to litigation in the ordinary course of business, we are currently, and may in the future be, subject to class actions,  
other securities litigation and other actions arising in relation to our accounting restatements. Subsequent to our March 10, 2004 announcement  
of the likely need for the Second Restatement, numerous class action complaints, including ERISA class action complaints and a derivative  
action complaint, have been filed against Nortel Networks and certain current and former officers and directors.  
We expect that this litigation will be time consuming, expensive and distracting from the conduct of our daily business. The adverse resolution  
of any specific lawsuit could have a material adverse effect on our ability to favorably resolve other lawsuits and on our financial condition and  
liquidity. We are unable at this time to estimate what our ultimate liability in these matters may be, and it is possible that we will be required to  
pay substantial judgments, settlements or other penalties and incur expenses that could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of  
operations, financial condition and liquidity, and such effects could be very significant. Expenses incurred in connection with these  
investigations (which include substantial fees of lawyers and other professional advisors and potential obligations to indemnify officers and  
directors who may be parties to such actions) could adversely affect our cash position.  
We cannot predict the outcome of the Revenue Independent Review being undertaken by our Audit Committee.  
As discussed in greater detail in the “Controls and Procedures” section of this report, our Audit Committee initiated the Revenue Independent  
Review to achieve a full understanding of the historic events that required revenues for certain specific transactions to be restated. The  
Revenue Independent Review will have a particular emphasis on the underlying conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues.  
The review will also consider any appropriate additional remedial measures, including those involving internal controls and processes. The  
Audit Committee has engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection with this review. We cannot predict the outcome of the Revenue Independent  
Review.  
Material adverse legal judgments, fines, penalties or settlements could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and  
liquidity, which could be very significant.  
We estimate that our available cash and our cash flow from operations will be adequate to fund our operations and service our debt for at least  
the next 12 months. In making this estimate, we have not assumed the need to make any payments in connection with our pending civil  
litigation or investigations related to the First Restatement and Second Restatement, other than our anticipated professional fees and expenses.  
Any material adverse legal judgments, fines, penalties or settlements arising from the pending civil litigation and investigations could require  
additional funding which may not be available on commercially reasonable terms, or at all. This could have a material adverse effect on our  
business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity, including by:  
requiring us to dedicate a substantial portion of our cash and/or cash flow from operations to payments of such judgments, fines,  
penalties or settlements, thereby reducing the availability of our cash and/or cash flow to fund working capital, capital expenditures,  
R&D efforts and other general corporate purposes, including debt reduction;  
making it more difficult for us to satisfy our payment obligations with respect to our outstanding indebtedness;  
increasing the difficulty and/or cost to us of refinancing our indebtedness;  
increasing our vulnerability to general adverse economic and industry conditions;  
limiting our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our businesses and the industries in which we operate;  
making it more difficult for us to make acquisitions and investments;  
limiting our ability to obtain, and/or increase the cost of obtaining, directors’ and officers’ liability insurance and/or other types of  
insurance; and  
restricting our ability to introduce new technologies and products and/or exploit business opportunities.  
We and our independent auditors have identified a number of material weaknesses related to our internal control over financial  
reporting, which could continue to impact our ability to report our results of operations and financial condition accurately and in a  
timely manner.  
Two material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting were identified at the time of the First Restatement. Over the course of  
Second Restatement, we and D&T identified a number of additional material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting. D&T  
confirmed to the Audit Committee these material weaknesses, listed below, on January 10, 2005:  
lack of compliance with written Nortel Networks procedures for monitoring and adjusting balances related to certain accruals and  
provisions, including restructuring charges and contract and customer accruals;  
lack of compliance with Nortel Networks procedures for applying applicable GAAP to the initial recording of certain liabilities  
including those described in SFAS No. 5, and to foreign currency translation as described in SFAS No. 52;  
lack of sufficient personnel with appropriate knowledge, experience and training in U.S. GAAP and lack of sufficient analysis and  
documentation of the application of U.S. GAAP to transactions, including but not limited to revenue transactions;  
lack of a clear organization and accountability structure within the accounting function, including insufficient review and  
supervision, combined with financial reporting systems that are not integrated and which require extensive manual interventions;  
lack of sufficient awareness of, and timely and appropriate remediation of, internal control issues by Nortel Networks personnel;  
and  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
an inappropriate ‘tone at the top’, which contributed to the lack of a strong control environment; as reported in the Independent  
Review Summary set forth in the “Controls and Procedures” section of this report, there was a “Management ‘tone at the top’ that  
conveyed the strong leadership message that earnings targets could be met through application of accounting practices that finance  
managers knew or ought to have known were not in compliance with U.S. GAAP and that questioning these practices was not  
acceptable”.  
Upon completion of management’s assessment of our internal control over financial reporting as at December 31, 2004 pursuant to SOX 404,  
we currently expect to conclude that the first five of these six material weaknesses continue to exist as at December 31, 2004, and we continue  
to identify, develop and begin to implement remedial measures to address them. These material weaknesses, if not fully addressed, could result  
in accounting errors such as those underlying the restatements of our consolidated financial statements more fully discussed in “Developments  
in 2003 and 2004—Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters” in the MD&A and “Controls and  
Procedures” section of this report. While our Board of Directors has approved the adoption of all of the recommendations for remedial  
measures contained in the “Summary of Findings and of Recommended Remedial Measures of the Independent Review” in the “Controls and  
Procedures” section of this report, and our management has adopted a number of measures to strengthen our internal control over financial  
reporting and address the material weaknesses identified above, we may be unable to address such material weaknesses in a timely manner,  
which could adversely impact the accuracy and timeliness of future reports and filings we make with the SEC and OSC.  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In addition, starting with our fiscal year 2004 Annual Report on Form 10-K, we must comply with Section 404(a) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of  
2002, and the related SEC rules, which require management to assess the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting annually  
and to include in our Annual Report on Form 10-K a management report on that assessment, together with an attestation by our independent  
registered public accounting firm. In light of the material weaknesses identified in connection with the First Restatement and Second  
Restatement, our management expects to conclude that our internal control over financial reporting as at December 31, 2004 is ineffective, and  
D&T has advised us that they expect their report on management’s assessment of internal control over financial reporting also to indicate that  
internal control over financial reporting is ineffective. While we are implementing steps to ensure the effectiveness of our internal control over  
financial reporting, failure to restore the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting could continue to impact our ability to  
report our financial condition and results of operations accurately and could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of  
operations, financial condition and liquidity.  
The governing principles of the Independent Review for remedial measures may take time to implement.  
As a result of the Independent Review, a number of significant remedial steps have been identified as necessary to improve our process and  
procedures. These remedial steps may take time to implement. In addition, the process of implementing the governing principles of the  
Independent Review may be time consuming for our senior management and disrupt our business.  
The delayed filing of our Reports and related matters caused us to breach our public debt indentures and seek waivers from EDC  
under the EDC Support Facility, which may affect our liquidity. Continuing delays in filing certain of our Reports and related matters  
has resulted in a breach of our public debt indentures and our obligations under the EDC Support Facility. It is possible that the  
.
holders of our public debt will seek to accelerate the maturity of that debt and EDC will not grant us additional waivers  
As a result of the delayed filing of our Reports, we and NNL breached our obligations to deliver the Reports to the trustees under our and  
NNL’s public debt indentures. While continuing delays in filing certain of our Reports will not result in an automatic event of default and  
acceleration of the outstanding debt, if holders of 25% of the outstanding principal amount of  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
any relevant series of debt securities provide notice of this non-compliance and we or NNL, as applicable, fail to file and deliver the relevant  
Report within 90 days after the notice is provided, then the trustee under the indenture or the holders will have the right to accelerate the  
maturity of the relevant series of debt securities. While such notice could have been given any time after March 30, 2004, neither we nor NNL  
has received a notice as of the date of this report. If the required percentage of holders under one series of debt securities were to give such a  
notice and, after the 90 day cure period expired, were to accelerate the maturity of such series of debt securities, then the principal amount of  
each other series of debt securities could, upon 10 days notice, be accelerated without the lapse of an additional 90 day cure period. If an  
acceleration of our debt securities were to occur, we may be unable to meet our payment obligations. Based on publicly available information,  
we have reason to believe that more than 25% of the outstanding principal amount of the $150 of 7.875% notes due June 2026 issued by a  
subsidiary of NNL and guaranteed by us are held by one holder, or a group of related holders. Other than with respect to that series of debt  
securities, based on such publicly available information, neither we nor NNL are aware of any holder, or group of related holders, that holds at  
least 25% of the outstanding principal amount of any relevant series of debt securities. However, based on such publicly available information,  
we have reason to believe that there is sufficient concentration among holders of the $150 of 7.40% notes due June 2006 issued by NNL that  
the acquisition of a relatively small additional amount of these notes by certain holders could result in a holder or a group of related holders  
holding 25% or more of the outstanding principal amount of these notes. See “Liquidity and capital resources”.  
As a result of the delayed filing of our Reports and the Related Breaches, we were also required to seek waivers from EDC under the EDC  
Support Facility. Our continuing delays in filing certain of our Reports will require us to seek an additional waiver from EDC. EDC may not  
grant an additional waiver and the terms of such a waiver may be unfavorable. If we do not obtain an additional waiver from EDC, EDC would  
have the right to terminate the EDC Support Facility, require cash collateral, or exercise its rights against the collateral pledged under the  
related security agreements. In addition, the Related Breaches will continue beyond the filing of the Reports. Accordingly, EDC has the right  
(absent a further waiver of the Related Breaches) to terminate or suspend the EDC Support Facility notwithstanding the filing of the Reports.  
While NNL is seeking a permanent waiver from EDC in connection with the Related Breaches, there can be no assurance that NNL will  
receive such waiver, or any waiver or as to the terms of any such waiver.  
Any future delay in the filing of our periodic reports with the SEC would similarly result in a breach of our public debt indentures and require  
us to seek additional waivers from EDC under the EDC Support Facility, which could reduce our access to the EDC Support Facility and may  
adversely affect our liquidity.  
Our credit ratings have been downgraded, we are currently unable to access our shelf registration statement filed with the SEC and  
NNL terminated the Five Year Facilities, each of which may adversely affect our liquidity.  
On April 28, 2004, S&P downgraded its ratings of NNL, including its long-term corporate credit rating from “B” to “B-” and its preferred  
share rating from “CCC” to “CCC-”. At the same time, it revised its outlook to developing from negative. Moody’s current long-term debt  
rating for NNL is “B3” and its preferred share rating is “Caa3”. On April 28, 2004, Moody’s changed its outlook to potential downgrade from  
uncertain. These ratings are below investment grade. Our credit ratings could be lowered or rating agencies could issue adverse commentaries  
in the future, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. These ratings  
and our current credit condition affect, among other things, our ability to raise debt, access the commercial paper market (which is currently  
closed to us), engage in alternative financing arrangements, and affect our ability, and the cost, to securitize receivables, obtain customer bid,  
performance-related and other bonds and contracts, access the EDC Support Facility and/or enter into normal course derivative or hedging  
transactions and also affect the price of our stock.  
As a result of a ratings downgrade in 2002, security agreements became effective under which substantially all of NNL’s assets located in the  
U.S. and Canada and those of most of our U.S. and Canadian subsidiaries, including the shares of certain of NNL’s U.S. and Canadian  
subsidiaries, were pledged. In addition, certain of NNL’s wholly owned subsidiaries have guaranteed NNL’s obligations under the EDC  
Support Facility and NNL’s and Nortel Networks outstanding debt securities. These agreements will continue to secure the EDC Support  
Facility and our and NNL’s outstanding public debt until the EDC Support Facility expires, alternative collateral is provided, alternative  
arrangements are made, or NNL’s public debt ratings return to at least BBB (stable outlook) by S&P and Baa2 (stable outlook) by Moody’s.  
The continued existence of these security arrangements may adversely affect our ability to incur additional debt or obtain alternative financing  
arrangements. In addition, EDC is not obligated to make any support available under the EDC Support Facility if NNL’s senior long-term  
rating by Moody’s is downgraded to less than B3 or if its debt rating by S&P is downgraded to less than B-.  
In addition, in April 2004, NNL terminated the Five Year Facilities. Absent this termination, the banks would have been permitted, upon  
30 days notice, to terminate their commitments under the Five Year Facilities as a result of NNL’s failure to file the NNL 2003 Annual Report  
on Form 10-K by April 29, 2004. Although the Five Year Facilities were undrawn at termination, this termination may adversely affect our  
liquidity.  
Further, the delayed filing of the Reports has resulted in our inability to use, in its current form, the remaining approximately $800 of capacity  
under our shelf registration statement filed with the SEC for various types of securities. As a result, our ability to access the capital markets is  
constrained, which may adversely affect our liquidity.  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The delay in filing certain of our Reports could cause the Toronto Stock Exchange and/or the New York Stock Exchange to commence  
suspension or delisting procedures in respect of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares or other of our or NNL’s listed  
securities.  
Although we have cured breaches of the TSX’s and NYSE’s continued listing requirements caused by the delayed filing of our and NNL’s  
2003 Annual Reports, the delayed filing of certain of our Reports causes us to continue to be in breach of these listing requirements. Although  
each of the NYSE and TSX has verbally confirmed that it has not commenced, nor has any intention of commencing, any suspension or  
delisting procedures in respect of our and NNL’s listed securities at the date of this report, the commencement of any suspension or delisting  
procedures by either exchange remains, at all times, at the discretion of such exchange and would be publicly announced by the exchange.  
Pending the filing of our and NNL’s 2003 Annual Reports, the NYSE had permitted our and NNL’s listed securities to continue to be traded on  
the exchange for the three month period ended March 31, 2005. In exercising the discretion relating to the grant of that additional three month  
period and the continued listing of our and NNL’s securities in light of the delayed filing of certain of our Reports, the NYSE’s procedures  
provide that the NYSE would consider, among other things, the likelihood of the relevant Reports being filed, the Company’s and NNL’s  
general financial status and the frequency and detail of the Company’s and NNL’s ongoing disclosures to the market on the status of such  
filings.  
If a suspension or delisting were to occur, there would be significantly less liquidity in the suspended or delisted securities. In addition, our  
ability to raise additional necessary capital through equity or debt financing, and attract and retain personnel by means of equity compensation,  
would be greatly impaired. Furthermore, with respect to any suspended or delisted securities, we would expect decreases in institutional and  
other investor demand, analyst coverage, market making activity and information available concerning trading prices and volume, and fewer  
broker-dealers would be willing to execute trades with respect to such securities. A suspension or delisting would likely decrease the  
attractiveness of our common shares or other listed securities of Nortel Networks Corporation and NNL to investors and cause the trading  
volume of our common shares or other listed securities of Nortel Networks Corporation and NNL to decline, which could result in a decline in  
the market price of such securities.  
Continuing negative publicity may adversely affect our business and the market price of our publicly traded securities.  
As a result of the First Restatement and Second Restatement, we have been the subject of continuing negative publicity. This negative publicity  
has contributed to significant declines in the prices of our publicly traded securities. This negative publicity may have an effect on the terms  
under which some customers and suppliers are willing to continue to do business with us and could affect our financial performance or  
financial condition. We also believe that many of our employees are operating under stressful conditions, which reduce morale and could lead  
to increased employee turnover. Continuing negative publicity could have a material adverse effect on our business and the market price of our  
publicly traded securities.  
As a result of the delay in the filing of our 2003 Annual Report (containing our audited consolidated financial statements for the year ended  
December 31, 2003), we were required to apply to the Ontario Superior Court of Justice for an order permitting the postponement of our 2004  
Annual Shareholders’ Meeting. The Ontario Superior Court of Justice granted that order, which permitted us to extend the time for calling the  
meeting to a date not later than December 31, 2004, or such later date as the Court may permit. As a result of the continued delay in the filing  
of our 2003 Annual Report, in October 2004 we announced that we intended to seek a further order extending the time for calling the meeting  
to a date no later than March 31, 2005, which order the Court granted on December 10, 2004. A further extension to a date no later than  
May 31, 2005 was obtained from the Court on December 21, 2004 to permit us to comply with a specific SEC rule which would require us, in  
our circumstances, to provide to shareholders our 2004 audited financial statements either prior to or concurrently with the mailing of proxy  
materials for the Meeting. This postponement has, among other things, contributed to the continuing negative publicity related to us, which  
may adversely affect our business and the market price of our publicly traded securities.  
We may not be able to attract or retain the personnel necessary to achieve our business objectives.  
Competition for certain key positions and specialized technical personnel in the high-technology industry remains strong. Our future success  
depends in part on our continued ability to hire, assimilate in a timely manner and retain qualified personnel, particularly in key senior  
management positions and in our key areas of potential growth. An important factor in attracting and retaining qualified employees is our  
ability to provide employees with the opportunity to participate in the potential growth of our business through programs such as stock option  
plans, restricted stock unit plans and employee investment and share purchase plans. The scope and value of these programs will be adversely  
affected by the volatility or negative performance of the market price for our common shares.  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In connection with the delay in filing our 2003 Annual Reports, as of March 10, 2004, we suspended the purchase of our common shares under  
the stock purchase plans for eligible employees in eligible countries that facilitate the acquisition of our common shares; the exercise of  
outstanding options granted under the 2000 Plan or the 1986 Plan, or the grant of any additional options under those plans, or the exercise of  
outstanding options granted under employee stock option plans previously assumed by us in connection with mergers and acquisitions; and the  
purchase of units in Nortel Networks stock fund or purchase of our common shares under our defined contribution and investments plans until  
such time as, at the earliest, we are in compliance with U.S. and Canadian regulatory securities filing requirements. On May 31, 2004, the OSC  
issued a final order prohibiting all trading by our directors, officers and certain current and former employees in our securities and those of  
NNL. This order will remain in effect until two full business days following the receipt by the OSC of all filings required to be made by us and  
NNL pursuant to Ontario securities law. Accordingly, our ability to provide employees with the opportunity to participate in our stock option  
plans, restricted stock unit plans and employee investment and share purchase plans has been adversely affected and certain employees have  
not been able to trade in our securities. The current suspension of these programs and OSC trading order, and any future suspension or OSC  
order, may have a material adverse effect on our ability to hire, assimilate in a timely manner and retain qualified personnel.  
In addition, in 2004 we terminated for cause our former president and chief executive officer, former chief financial officer, former controller  
and seven additional individuals with significant responsibilities for financial reporting. In August and September 2004, as part of our new  
strategic plan, we announced an anticipated workforce reduction of approximately 3,250 employees. Approximately 64% of employee actions  
related to the focused workforce reduction were completed by the end of 2004, including approximately 55% that were notified of termination  
or acceptance of voluntary retirement, with the remainder comprised of voluntary attrition of employees that were not replaced. The remainder  
of employee actions are expected to be completed by June 30, 2005. In addition, in 2001, 2002 and 2003, we implemented a company-wide  
restructuring plan, which included a reduction of approximately two-thirds of our workforce over the three-year period.  
We may find it more difficult to attract or retain qualified employees because of our recent significant workforce reductions, business  
performance, management changes, restatement activities and resulting negative publicity and the resulting impacts on our incentive programs  
and incentive compensation plans. If we have not properly sized our workforce and retained those employees with the appropriate skills, our  
ability to compete effectively may be adversely affected. We are also more dependent on those employees we have retained, as many have  
taken on increased responsibilities due to workforce reductions. If we are not successful in attracting, recruiting or retaining qualified  
employees, including members of senior management, we may not have the personnel necessary to achieve our business objectives, including  
the implementation of our remedial measures.  
Ongoing SEC review may require us to amend our public disclosures further.  
We have received comments on our periodic filings from the staff of the SEC’s Division of Corporation Finance. As part of this comment  
process, we may receive further comments from the staff of the SEC relating to this Annual Report on Form 10-K and our other periodic  
filings. As a result, we may be required by the SEC to amend this Form 10-K or other reports filed with the SEC in order to make adjustments  
or additional disclosures. However, we do not believe that it will be feasible to amend our 2002 Form 10-K/A or 2003 Form 10-Qs due to,  
among other factors, the identified material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting, the significant turnover in our finance  
personnel, changes in accounting systems, documentation weaknesses, a likely inability to obtain third party corroboration in certain cases due  
to the substantial industry adjustment in recent years and the passage of time generally. Amendments to our prior filings would be required for  
us to be in full compliance with our Exchange Act reporting obligations.  
Risks relating to our business  
We continue to restructure our business to respond to industry and market conditions. The assumptions underlying our restructuring  
efforts may prove to be inaccurate and we may have to restructure our business again in the future.  
We continue to restructure our business to realign resources and achieve desired cost savings in an increasingly competitive market. Our new  
strategic plan includes an anticipated further workforce reduction of approximately 3,250 employees. We have based our restructuring efforts  
on certain assumptions regarding the cost structure of our business. Our current assumptions may or may not be correct and as a result, we may  
determine that further restructuring in the future will be needed. Our restructuring efforts may not be sufficient for us to achieve improved  
results and meet the changes in industry and market conditions, including increased competition. In particular, we face increased competition  
from low cost competitors such as Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. and ZTE Corporation. We must manage the potentially higher growth areas  
of our business, as well as the non-core areas, in order for us to achieve improved results.  
We have made, and will continue to make, judgments as to whether we should further reduce our workforce or exit, or dispose of, certain  
businesses. These workforce reductions may impair our ability to achieve our current or future business objectives. Costs incurred in  
connection with restructuring efforts may be higher than estimated. Any decision by management to further limit investment or exit, or dispose  
of, businesses may result in the recording of additional charges.  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
As a result, the costs actually incurred in connection with the restructuring efforts may be higher than originally planned and may not lead to  
the anticipated cost savings and/or improved results.  
As part of our review of restructured businesses, we look at the recoverability of their tangible and intangible assets. Future market conditions  
may trigger further write downs of these assets due to uncertainties in:  
the estimates and assumptions used in asset valuations, which are based on our forecasts of future business performance; and  
accounting estimates related to the useful life and recoverability of the net book value of these assets, including inventory,  
goodwill, net deferred taxes and other intangible assets.  
We will continue to review our restructuring work plan based on our ongoing assessment of the industry and the business environment.  
Our operating results have historically been subject to yearly and quarterly fluctuations and are expected to continue to fluctuate,  
which may adversely affect the market price of our publicly traded securities.  
Our operating results have historically been, and are expected to continue to be, subject to quarterly and yearly fluctuations as a result of a  
number of factors. These factors include:  
our ability to execute our strategic plan, including the planned workforce reductions, without negatively impacting our relationships  
with our customers, the delivery of products based on new and developing technologies at competitive prices, the effectiveness of  
our internal processes and organizations and the retention of qualified personnel;  
our ability to focus on the day-to-day operation of our business while implementing improvements in our internal controls and  
procedures, including our accounting systems, and addressing the civil litigation actions and investigations related to our  
restatements;  
our ability to successfully implement programs to stimulate customer spending by anticipating and offering the kinds of products  
and services customers will require in the future to increase the efficiency and profitability of their networks;  
our ability to successfully complete programs on a timely basis to reduce our cost structure, including fixed costs, to streamline our  
operations and to reduce product costs;  
our ability to successfully comply with increased and complex regulations;  
our ability to focus our business on what we believe to be potentially higher growth, higher margin businesses and to dispose of or  
exit non-core businesses;  
increased price and product competition in the networking industry, including from low cost competitors;  
the inherent uncertainties of using forecasts, estimates and assumptions for asset valuations and in determining the amounts of  
accrued liabilities, provisions and other items in our consolidated financial statements;  
the impact of changes in global capital markets and interest rates on our pension plan assets and obligations;  
fluctuations in our gross margins;  
the development, introduction and market acceptance of new technologies, and integrated networking solutions, as well as the  
adoption of new networking standards;  
the overall trend toward industry consolidation and rationalization among our customers, competitors and suppliers;  
our ability to make investments, including acquisitions, to strengthen our business;  
the ability of our customers and suppliers to obtain financing to fund capital expenditures;  
variations in sales channels, product costs and the mix of products sold;  
the size and timing of customer orders and shipments;  
our ability to continue to obtain customer performance bonds and contracts;  
our ability to maintain appropriate inventory levels;  
the impact of acquired businesses and technologies;  
the impact of our product development schedules, product quality variances, manufacturing capacity and lead times required to  
produce our products; and  
the impact of higher insurance premiums and deductibles and greater limitations on insurance coverage.  
Our decision to adopt fair value accounting for employee stock options on a prospective basis as of January 1, 2003 has  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
caused us to record an expense over the stock option vesting period, based on the fair value at the date the options are granted, and could have a  
significant negative effect on our reported results.  
Additionally, we are required to perform goodwill impairment tests on an annual basis and between annual tests in certain circumstances, to  
value our deferred tax assets and to accrue unfunded pension liabilities, each of which may result in a negative effect on our reported results.  
We enter into agreements that may require us to make certain indemnification payments to third parties in the event of certain changes in an  
underlying economic characteristic related to assets, liabilities or equity securities of such third parties. The occurrence of events that may  
cause us to become liable to make an indemnification payment is not within our control and an obligation to make a significant indemnification  
payment under such agreements could have a significant negative effect on our reported results.  
As a consequence, operating results for a particular future period are difficult to predict, and therefore, prior results are not necessarily  
indicative of results to be expected in future periods. Any of the foregoing factors, or any other factors described herein, could have a material  
adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition that could adversely affect the price of our publicly traded  
securities.  
Global economic conditions and other trends and factors affecting the telecommunications industry are beyond our control and may  
result in reduced demand and pricing pressure on our products.  
There are trends and factors affecting the industry that are beyond our control and may affect our operations. These trends and factors include:  
adverse changes in the public and private equity and debt markets and our ability, as well as the ability of our customers and  
suppliers, to obtain financing or to fund working capital and capital expenditures;  
adverse changes in the credit quality of our customers and suppliers;  
adverse changes in the market conditions in our industry and the specific markets for our products;  
the trend towards the sale of converged networking solutions, which could lead to reduced capital spending on multiple networks  
by our customers;  
visibility to, and the actual size and timing of, capital expenditures by our customers;  
inventory practices, including the timing of product and service deployment, of our customers;  
the amount of network capacity and the network capacity utilization rates of our customers, and the amount of sharing and/or  
acquisition of new and/or existing network capacity by our customers;  
policies of our customers regarding utilization of single or multiple vendors for the products they purchase;  
the overall trend toward industry consolidation and rationalization among our customers, competitors and suppliers;  
conditions in the broader market for communications products, including data networking products and computerized information  
access equipment and services;  
increased price competition, particularly from low cost competitors;  
changes in legislation or accounting rules and governmental and environmental regulation or intervention affecting communications  
or data networking;  
computer viruses, break-ins and similar disruptions from unauthorized tampering with our computer systems; and  
acts of war or terrorism that could lead to disruptions in general global economic activity, changes in logistics and security  
arrangements and reduced customer demand for our products and services.  
Cautious capital spending in our industry has affected, and could affect, demand for, or pricing pressures on, our products.  
Our gross margins may decline, which would reduce our operating results and could contribute to volatility in the market price of our  
publicly traded securities.  
Our gross margins may be negatively affected as a result of a number of factors, including:  
increased price competition, particularly from low cost competitors;  
changes in product and geographic mix;  
customer and contract settlement costs;  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
higher product, material or labor costs;  
increased inventory provisions or contract and customer settlement costs;  
warranty costs;  
obsolescence charges;  
loss of cost savings on future inventory purchases as a result of high inventory levels;  
introduction of new products and costs of entering new markets;  
increased levels of customer services;  
changes in distribution channels;  
excess capacity or excess fixed assets;  
accruals for employee incentive bonuses;  
further restructuring costs; and  
costs related to our restatements, including the possibility of substantial fines, settlements and/or damages or other penalties, and/or  
remedial actions.  
Lower than expected gross margins would negatively affect our operating results and could contribute to volatility in the market price of our  
publicly traded securities.  
Cash flow fluctuations may affect our ability to fund our working capital requirements or achieve our business objectives in a timely  
manner. Additional sources of funds may not be available or may not be available on acceptable terms.  
Our working capital requirements and cash flows historically have been, and are expected to continue to be, subject to quarterly and yearly  
fluctuations, depending on such factors as timing and size of capital expenditures, levels of sales, timing of deliveries and collection of  
receivables, inventory levels, customer payment terms, customer financing obligations and supplier terms and conditions. In addition, if the  
industry or our current condition deteriorates, notwithstanding the EDC Support Facility, an increased portion of our cash and cash equivalents  
may be restricted as cash collateral for customer performance bonds and contracts. We believe our cash on hand will be sufficient to fund our  
current business model, manage our investments and meet our customer commitments for at least the next 12 months. In making this estimate,  
we have not made provision for any material payments in connection with our pending civil litigation actions and investigations related to the  
First Restatement and Second Restatement, other than our anticipated professional fees and expenses. Any material adverse legal judgments,  
fines, penalties or settlements arising from these pending civil litigation actions and investigations could require additional funding which may  
not be available on commercially reasonable terms, or at all. This could have a material adverse effect on our liquidity, which could be very  
significant.  
In addition, a greater than expected slow down in capital spending by service providers and other customers may require us to adjust our  
current business model. As a result, our revenues and cash flows may be materially lower than we expect and we may be required to further  
reduce our capital expenditures and investments or take other measures in order to meet our cash requirements.  
We may seek additional funds from liquidity-generating transactions and other sources of external financing (which may include a variety of  
debt, convertible debt and/or equity financings). We cannot provide any assurance that our net cash requirements will be as we currently  
expect, that we will continue to have access to the EDC Support Facility when and as needed, or that liquidity-generating transactions or  
financings will be available to us on acceptable terms or at all. Our inability to manage cash flow fluctuations resulting from the above factors  
and the potential reduction, expiry or termination of the EDC Support Facility could have a material adverse effect on our ability to fund our  
working capital requirements from operating cash flows and other sources of liquidity or to achieve our business objectives in a timely manner.  
We may be materially and adversely affected by cautious capital spending by our customers. The loss of customers in certain markets  
could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.  
We expect that our consolidated revenues in 2004 will be slightly lower compared to 2003. The 2003 consolidated revenues included revenues  
that were deferred from prior periods. Continued cautiousness in capital spending by service providers and other customers may affect our  
revenues more than we currently expect. Our revenues and operating results have been and may continue to be materially and adversely  
affected by the continued cautiousness in capital spending by our customers. We have focused on the larger customers in certain markets,  
which provide a substantial portion of our revenues. A reduction or delay in business from one or more of these customers, or a failure to  
achieve a significant market share with  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
these customers, could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.  
Our business may be materially and adversely affected by our high level of debt.  
In order to finance our business, we have incurred significant levels of debt compared to historical levels, and we may need to secure additional  
sources of funding, which may include debt or convertible debt financing, in the future. A high level of debt, arduous or restrictive terms and  
conditions related to accessing certain sources of funding, failure to meet the covenants in the EDC Support Facility and any significant  
reduction in, or access to, such facility, poor business performance or lower than expected cash inflows could materially and adversely affect  
our ability to fund the operation of our business.  
Other effects of a high level of debt include the following:  
we may have difficulty borrowing money in the future or accessing other sources of funding;  
we may need to use a large portion of our cash flow from operations to pay principal and interest on our indebtedness, which would  
reduce the amount of cash available to finance our operations and other business activities;  
a high debt level, arduous or restrictive terms and conditions, or lower than expected cash flows would make us more vulnerable to  
economic downturns and adverse developments in our business; and  
if operating cash flows are not sufficient to meet our operating expenses, capital expenditures and debt service requirements as they  
become due, we may be required, in order to meet our debt service obligations, to delay or reduce capital expenditures or the  
introduction of new products, sell assets and/or forego business opportunities including acquisitions, research and development  
projects or product design enhancements.  
An increased portion of our cash and cash equivalents may be restricted as cash collateral if we are unable to secure alternative  
support for certain obligations arising out of our normal course business activities.  
The EDC Support Facility may not provide all the support we require for certain of our obligations arising out of our normal course of business  
activities. In particular, although this facility provides for up to $750 in support, the $300 revolving small bond sub-facility will not become  
committed support until all of the Reports are filed and NNL obtains a permanent waiver of the Related Breaches. As of December 31, 2004,  
there was approximately $296 of outstanding support utilized under the EDC Support Facility, approximately $212 of which was outstanding  
under the small bond sub-facility. In addition, bid and performance related bonds with terms that extend beyond December 31, 2006, which,  
absent any early termination of the EDC Support Facility, is the expiry date of this facility, are currently not eligible for the support provided  
by the EDC Support Facility. Given that the EDC Support Facility is used to support bid and performance bonds with varying terms, including  
those with at least 365 days, we may need to increase our use of cash collateral to support these obligations beginning on January 1, 2006  
absent a further extension of the facility. Unless EDC agrees to extend the facility or agrees to provide support outside the scope of the facility,  
we may be required to provide cash collateral to support these obligations. We cannot provide any assurance that we will reach an agreement  
with EDC on these matters. Under the terms of the waiver letter with EDC dated March 29, 2004, EDC may also suspend its obligation to issue  
NNL any additional support if events occur that have a material adverse effect on NNL’s business, financial position or results of operations. If  
we do not have access to sufficient support under the EDC Support Facility, and if we are unable to secure alternative support, an increased  
portion of our cash and cash equivalents may be restricted as cash collateral, which could adversely affect our ability to fund some of our  
normal course business activities, capital expenditures, R&D and our ability to borrow in the future.  
An inability of our subsidiaries to provide us with funding in sufficient amounts could adversely affect our ability to meet our  
.
obligations  
We may at times depend primarily on loans, dividends or other forms of financing from our subsidiaries to meet our obligations to pay interest  
and principal on outstanding public debt and to pay corporate expenses. If our subsidiaries are unable to pay dividends or provide us with loans  
or other forms of financing in sufficient amounts, it could adversely affect our ability to meet our obligations.  
We may need to make larger contributions to our defined benefit plans in the future.  
We currently maintain various defined benefit plans in North America and the U.K. which cover various categories of employees and retirees,  
which represent our major retirement plans. In addition, we have smaller retirement plans in other countries. Our obligations to make  
contributions to fund benefit obligations under these plans are based on actuarial  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
valuations, which themselves are based on certain assumptions about the long-term operation of the plans, including employee turnover and  
retirement rates, the performance of the financial markets and interest rates. If experience differs from the assumptions, the amounts we are  
obligated to contribute to the plans may increase. In particular, the performance of the financial markets is difficult to predict, particularly in  
periods of high volatility in the equity markets. If the financial markets perform lower than the assumptions, we may have to make larger  
contributions in the future than we would otherwise have to make and expenses related to defined benefit plans could increase. Similarly,  
changes in interest rates can impact our contribution requirements. In a low interest rate environment, the likelihood of required contributions  
in the future increases. If interest rates are lower in the future than we assume they will be, then we would probably be required to make larger  
contributions than we would otherwise have to make.  
In addition, the 2004 decision of the Supreme Court of Canada in “Monsanto Canada Inc. v. Superintendent of Financial Services” has caused  
companies in Canada that sponsor defined benefit plans, including us, to review certain of our past activities that may have triggered partial  
wind-ups of such plans to determine whether a distribution of plan surplus, if any, should have occurred at the time of any triggering event.  
Although the full impact of the decision remains unclear and we have not yet made any determination regarding our plans, if it is determined  
that a distribution of plan surplus should have occurred at the time of any triggering event, we may be required to make a distribution out of our  
plan assets, which may lead to an increase in the amount of future contributions that we are required to make.  
If market conditions deteriorate or future results of operations are less than expected, an additional valuation allowance may be  
required for all or a portion of our deferred tax assets.  
We currently have deferred tax assets, which may be used to reduce taxable income in the future. We assess the realization of these deferred  
tax assets quarterly, and if we determine that it is more likely than not that some portion of these assets will not be realized, an income tax  
valuation allowance is recorded. Our valuation allowance is primarily attributable to continued uncertainty in the industry. If market conditions  
deteriorate or future results of operations are less than expected, future assessments may result in a determination that it is more likely than not  
that some or all of our net deferred tax assets are not realizable. As a result, we may need to establish an additional valuation allowance for all  
or a portion of our net deferred tax assets, which may have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial  
condition.  
Our performance may be materially and adversely affected if our expectations regarding market demand for particular products  
prove to be wrong.  
We expect that data communications traffic will grow at a faster rate than the growth expected for voice traffic and that the use of the Internet  
will continue to increase. We expect the growth of data traffic and the use of the Internet will significantly impact traditional voice networks,  
both wireline and wireless. We believe that this will create market discontinuities, which will make traditional voice network products and  
services less effective as they were not designed for data traffic. We believe that these market discontinuities in turn will lead to the  
convergence of data and voice through upgrades of traditional voice networks to transport large volumes of data traffic or through the  
construction of new networks designed to transport both voice and data traffic. Either approach would require significant capital expenditures  
by service providers. We also believe that such developments will give rise to the demand for IP optimized networking solutions, and third  
generation, or 3G, wireless networks.  
We cannot be sure what the rate of this convergence of voice and data networks will be, due to the dynamic and rapidly evolving nature of the  
communications business, the technology involved and the availability of capital. Consequently, market discontinuities and the resulting  
demand for IP-optimized networking solutions or 3G wireless networks may not continue. Alternatively, the pace of that development may be  
slower than currently anticipated. The market may also develop in an unforeseen direction. Certain events, including the commercial  
availability and actual implementation of new technologies, including 3G networks, or the evolution of other technologies, may occur, which  
would affect the extent or timing of anticipated market demand, or increase demand for products based on other technologies, or reduce the  
demand for IP-optimized networking solutions or 3G wireless networks. Any such change in demand may reduce purchases of our networking  
solutions by our customers, require increased expenditures to develop and market different technologies, or provide market opportunities for  
our competitors. Our performance may also be materially and adversely affected by a lack of growth in the rate of data traffic, a reduction in  
the use of the Internet or a reduction in the demand for IP-optimized networking solutions or 3G wireless networks in the future.  
We have made, and may continue to make, strategic acquisitions. If we are not successful in operating or integrating these acquisitions,  
our business, results of operations and financial condition may be materially and adversely affected.  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In the past, we acquired companies that we believed would enhance the expansion of our business and products. We may make selective  
opportunistic acquisitions of companies or businesses with resources and product or service offerings capable of providing us with additional  
product and/or market strengths. Acquisitions involve significant risks and uncertainties, including:  
the industry may develop in a different direction than anticipated and the technologies we acquire may not prove to be those we  
need;  
the future valuations of acquired businesses may decrease from the market price we paid for these acquisitions;  
the revenues of acquired businesses may not offset increased operating expenses associated with these acquisitions;  
potential difficulties in completing in-process research and development projects and delivering high quality products to our  
customers;  
potential difficulties in integrating new products, software, businesses and operations in an efficient and effective manner;  
our customers or customers of the acquired businesses may defer purchase decisions as they evaluate the impact of the acquisitions  
on our future product strategy;  
potential loss of key employees of the acquired businesses;  
diversion of the attention of our senior management from the operation of our daily business;  
entering new markets in which we have limited experience and where competitors may have a stronger market presence;  
potential issuance of common stock that would dilute our shareholders’ percentage ownership; and  
potential assumption of liabilities.  
Our inability to successfully operate and integrate newly acquired businesses appropriately, effectively and in a timely manner could have a  
material adverse effect on our ability to take advantage of further growth in demand for IP-optimized network solutions and other advances in  
technology, as well as on our revenues, gross margins and expenses.  
Acquisitions are inherently risky, and no assurance can be given that our previous or future acquisitions will be successful and will not  
materially adversely affect our business, operating results, or financial condition. Failure to manage and successfully integrate acquisitions  
could materially harm our business and operating results.  
We operate in highly dynamic and volatile industries characterized by rapidly changing technologies, evolving industry standards,  
frequent new product introductions and short product life cycles.  
The markets for our products are characterized by rapidly changing technologies, evolving industry standards, frequent new product  
introductions and short product life cycles. Our success depends, in substantial part, on the timely and successful introduction of high quality  
new products and upgrades, as well as cost reductions on current products to address the operational speed, bandwidth, efficiency and cost  
requirements of our customers. Our success will also depend on our ability to comply with emerging industry standards, to operate with  
products of other suppliers, to integrate, simplify and reduce the number of software programs used in our portfolio of products, to address  
emerging market trends, to provide our customers with new revenue-generating opportunities and to compete with technological and product  
developments carried out by others. The development of new, technologically advanced products, including IP-optimized networking  
solutions, software products and 3G wireless networks, is a complex and uncertain process requiring high levels of innovation, as well as the  
accurate anticipation of technological and market trends. Investments in this development may result in our expenses growing at a faster rate  
than our revenues, particularly since the initial investment to bring a product to market may be high. We may not be successful in targeting  
new market opportunities, in developing and commercializing new products in a timely manner or in achieving market acceptance for our new  
products.  
The success of new or enhanced products, including IP-optimized networking solutions and 3G wireless networks, depends on a number of  
other factors, including the timely introduction of those products, market acceptance of new technologies and industry standards, the quality  
and robustness of new or enhanced products, competing product offerings, the pricing and marketing of those products and the availability of  
funding for those networks. Products and technologies developed by our competitors may render our products obsolete. Hackers may attempt  
to disrupt or exploit our customers’ use of our technologies. If we fail to respond in a timely and effective manner to unanticipated changes in  
one or more of the technologies affecting telecommunications and data networking or our new products or product enhancements fail to  
achieve market acceptance, our ability to compete effectively in our industry, and our sales, market share and customer relationships  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
could be materially and adversely affected.  
In addition, unanticipated changes in market demand for products based on a specific technology, particularly lower than anticipated, or delays  
in, demand for IP-optimized networking solutions, particularly long-haul and metro optical networking solutions, or 3G wireless networks,  
could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition if we fail to respond to those changes in a  
timely and effective manner.  
We face significant competition and may not be able to maintain our market share and may suffer from competitive pricing practices.  
We operate in a highly volatile industry that is characterized by industry rationalization and consolidation, vigorous competition for market  
share and rapid technological development. Competition is heightened in periods of slow overall market growth. These factors could result in  
aggressive pricing practices and growing competition from smaller niche companies, established competitors, as well as well-capitalized  
computer systems and communications companies, which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on our gross margins.  
Since some of the markets in which we compete are characterized by the potential for rapid growth and, in certain cases, low barriers to entry  
and rapid technological changes, smaller, specialized companies and start-up ventures are now, or may in the future become, principal  
competitors. We may also face competition from the resale of used telecommunications equipment, including our own on occasion, by failed,  
downsized or consolidated high technology enterprises and telecommunications service providers. In addition, we face the risk that certain of  
our competitors may enter into additional business combinations, accelerate product development, or engage in aggressive price reductions or  
other competitive practices, which make them more powerful or aggressive competitors.  
We expect that we will face additional competition from existing competitors and from a number of companies that have entered or may enter  
our existing and future markets. In particular, we currently, and may in the future, face increased competition from low cost competitors such  
as Huawei Technologies Co., Ltd. and ZTE Corporation. Some of our current and potential competitors have greater marketing, technical and  
financial resources, including access to capital markets and/or the ability to provide customer financing in connection with the sale of products.  
Many of our current and potential competitors have also established, or may in the future establish, relationships with our current and potential  
customers. Other competitive factors include the ability to provide new technologies and products, end-to-end networking solutions, and new  
product features, such as security, as well as conformance to industry standards. Increased competition could result in price reductions,  
negatively affecting our operating results, reducing profit margins and could potentially lead to a loss of market share.  
For a list of our principal competitors, see “Competition” in each of the business segment descriptions in the “Business” section of this report.  
We face certain barriers in our efforts to expand internationally.  
We intend to continue to pursue international and emerging market growth opportunities. In many international markets, long-standing  
relationships between potential customers and their local suppliers and protective regulations, including local content requirements and type  
approvals, create barriers to entry. In addition, pursuing international opportunities may require significant investments for an extended period  
before returns on such investments, if any, are realized and such investments may result in expenses growing at a faster rate than revenues.  
Furthermore, those projects and investments could be adversely affected by:  
reversals or delays in the opening of foreign markets to new competitors;  
trade protection measures;  
exchange controls;  
currency fluctuations;  
investment policies;  
restrictions on repatriation of cash;  
nationalization of local industry;  
economic, social and political risks;  
taxation;  
interest rates;  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
challenges in staffing and managing international opportunities;  
other factors, depending on the country involved; and  
acts of war or terrorism.  
Difficulties in foreign financial markets and economies and of foreign financial institutions, particularly in emerging markets, could adversely  
affect demand from customers in the affected countries. An inability to maintain or expand our business in international and emerging markets  
could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.  
Fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates could negatively impact our business, results of operations and financial condition.  
As an increasing proportion of our business may be denominated in currencies other than U.S. dollars, fluctuations in foreign currency  
exchange rates may have an adverse impact on our business, results of operations and financial condition. Our primary currency exposures are  
to Canadian dollars, British pounds and the euro. These exposures may change over time as we change the geographic mix of our global  
business and as our business practices evolve. For instance, if we increase our presence in emerging markets, we may see an increase in our  
exposure to emerging market currencies, such as, for example, the Indian rupee. These currencies may be affected by internal factors and  
external developments in other countries. Also, our ability to enter into normal course derivative or hedging transactions in the future may be  
impacted by our current credit condition. We cannot predict whether foreign exchange losses will be incurred in the future, and significant  
foreign exchange rate fluctuations may have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.  
If we fail to protect our intellectual property rights, or if we are subject to adverse judgments or settlements arising out of disputes  
regarding intellectual property rights, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be materially and adversely  
affected.  
Our industry is subject to uncertainty over adoption of industry standards and protection of intellectual property rights. Our success is  
dependent on our proprietary technology, for the protection of which we rely on patent, copyright, trademark and trade secret laws. Our  
business is global and the level of protection of our proprietary technology provided by those laws varies by jurisdiction. Our issued patents  
may be challenged, invalidated or circumvented, and our rights under issued patents may not provide us with competitive advantages. Patents  
may not be issued from pending applications, and claims in patents issued in the future may not be sufficiently broad to protect our proprietary  
technology. In addition, claims of intellectual property infringement or trade secret misappropriation may be asserted against us or our  
customers in connection with their use of our products and the outcome of any of those claims may be uncertain. An unfavorable outcome in  
such a claim could require us to cease offering for sale the products that are the subject of such a claim, pay substantial monetary damages to a  
third party and/or make ongoing royalty payments to a third party. In addition, any defense of claims of intellectual property infringement or  
trade secret misappropriation may require extensive participation by senior management and/or other key employees and may reduce their time  
and ability to focus on other aspects of our business. A failure by us to react to changing industry standards, the lack of broadly-accepted  
industry standards, successful claims of intellectual property infringement or other intellectual property claims against us or our customers, or a  
failure by us to protect our proprietary technology could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial  
condition. In addition, if others infringe on our intellectual property rights, we may not be able to successfully contest such challenges.  
Rationalization and consolidation in the industry may lead to increased competition and harm our business.  
The industry has experienced consolidation and rationalization and we expect this trend to continue. There have been adverse changes in the  
public and private equity and debt markets for industry participants which have affected their ability to obtain financing or to fund capital  
expenditures. Some operators have experienced financial difficulty and have, or may, file for bankruptcy protection or be acquired by other  
operators. Other operators may merge and we and one or more of our competitors may each supply products to the companies that have  
merged or will merge. This rationalization and/or consolidation could result in our dependence on a smaller number of customers, purchasing  
decision delays by the merged companies and/or our playing a lesser role, or no longer playing a role, in the supply of communications  
products to the merged companies. This rationalization and/or consolidation, including the acquisition by Cingular Wireless of AT&T  
Wireless, could also cause increased competition among our customers and pressure on the pricing of their products and services, which could  
cause further financial difficulties for our customers. A rationalization of industry participants could also increase the supply of used  
communications products for resale, resulting in increased competition and pressure on the pricing for our new products. In addition,  
telecommunications equipment suppliers may enter into business combinations, or may be acquired by or sell a substantial portion of their  
assets to other competitors, resulting in accelerated product  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
development, increased financial strength, or a broader base of customers, creating even more powerful or aggressive competitors. We may  
also see rationalization among equipment/component suppliers. The business failures of operators, competitors or suppliers may cause  
uncertainty among investors and in the industry generally and harm our business.  
Changes in regulation of the Internet and/or other aspects of the industry may affect the manner in which we conduct our business and  
may materially and adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition.  
Investment decisions of our customers could be affected by regulation of the Internet or other aspects of the industry in any country where we  
operate. We could also be materially and adversely affected by an increase in competition among equipment suppliers or by reduced capital  
spending by our customers, as a result of a change in the regulation of the industry. If a jurisdiction in which we operate adopts measures which  
affect the regulation of the Internet and/or other aspects of the industry, we could experience both decreased demand for our products and  
increased costs of selling such products. Changes in laws or regulations governing the Internet, Internet commerce and/or other aspects of the  
industry could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.  
In the U.S., on February 20, 2003, the FCC announced a decision in its triennial review proceeding of the agency’s rules regarding UNEs. The  
text of the FCC’s order and reasons for the decision were released on August 21, 2003. The uncertainty surrounding the impact of the FCC  
decision and subsequent adoption on December 15, 2004 of new unbundling rules in response to the remand by the U.S. Court of Appeals for  
the D.C. Circuit is affecting, and may continue to affect, the decisions of certain of our U.S.-based service provider customers regarding  
investment in their telecommunications infrastructure. These UNE rules and/or material changes in other country-specific telecommunications  
or other regulations may affect capital spending by certain of our service provider customers, which could have a material adverse effect on our  
business, results of operations and financial condition.  
In Europe, we expect to become subject to new product content laws and product takeback and recycling requirements that will require full  
compliance by 2006. We expect that these laws will require us to incur additional compliance costs. Although compliance costs relating to  
environmental matters have not resulted in a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition in the past,  
they may result in a material adverse effect in the future.  
Our stock price has historically been volatile and further declines in the market price of our publicly traded securities may negatively  
impact our ability to make future acquisitions, raise capital, issue debt and retain employees.  
Our publicly traded securities have experienced, and may continue to experience, substantial price volatility, including considerable decreases,  
particularly as a result of variations between our actual or anticipated financial results and the published expectations of analysts and as a result  
of announcements by our competitors and us, including our announcements related to the Independent Review, our management changes, the  
First Restatement and the Second Restatement, the regulatory and criminal investigations, the class action litigations and other civil  
proceedings and related matters. Our credit quality, any equity or equity related offerings, operating results and prospects, restatements of  
previously issued financial statements, including any exclusion of our publicly traded securities from any widely followed stock market  
indices, among other factors, will also affect the market price of our publicly traded securities.  
The stock markets have experienced extreme price fluctuations that have affected the market price and trading volumes of many technology  
and telecommunications companies in particular, with potential consequential negative effects on the trading of securities of those companies.  
A major decline in the capital markets generally, or an adjustment in the market price or trading volumes of our publicly traded securities, may  
negatively impact our ability to raise capital, issue debt, secure customer business, retain employees or make future acquisitions. These factors,  
as well as general economic and geopolitical conditions, and continued negative events within the technology sector, may in turn have a  
material adverse effect on the market price of our publicly traded securities.  
Early settlement of our purchase contracts is currently not available to holders of purchase contracts. Acceleration of the settlement  
date on early settlement of our purchase contracts could contribute to volatility in the market price of our common shares.  
Owing to matters described above in “Developments in 2003 and 2004 — Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review;  
restatements; related matters” with respect to the delayed filing of the Reports, we are currently unable to permit holders of our prepaid forward  
purchase contracts to exercise certain “early settlement” rights and receive Nortel Networks Corporation common shares in advance of the  
otherwise applicable August 15, 2005 settlement date. These rights again will become exercisable upon the effectiveness of a registration  
statement (or a post-effective amendment to the shelf registration  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
statement) filed with the SEC (with respect to the common shares to be delivered) that contains a related current prospectus. Under the terms of  
the Purchase Contract and Unit Agreement, which governs the purchase contracts, we have agreed to use commercially reasonable efforts to  
have in effect a registration statement covering the common shares to be delivered and to provide a prospectus in connection therewith.  
On June 12, 2002, concurrent with the offering of our common shares, 28,750 equity units were offered, each initially evidencing ownership of  
a prepaid forward purchase contract, or purchase contract, entitling the holder to receive our common shares, and specified zero-coupon U.S.  
treasury strips. As of December 31, 2004, 3,840 purchase contracts were outstanding. The aggregate number of our common shares issuable on  
the settlement date of the remaining purchase contracts will be between approximately 65 million and 78 million shares, subject to some anti-  
dilution adjustments (which include adjustments for a possible consolidation of our common shares), depending on the applicable market value  
of Nortel Networks common shares. The settlement date for each purchase contract is August 15, 2005, subject to acceleration or early  
settlement in certain cases.  
If we are involved in a merger, amalgamation, arrangement, consolidation or other reorganization event (other than with or into NNL or certain  
other subsidiaries) in which all of our common shares are exchanged for consideration of at least 30% of the value of which consists of cash or  
cash equivalents, then a holder of purchase contracts may elect to accelerate and settle some or all of its purchase contracts, for our common  
shares. The settlement date under each purchase contract will automatically accelerate upon the occurrence of specified events of bankruptcy,  
insolvency or reorganization with respect to us. Upon acceleration of the settlement date, holders will be entitled to receive 20,263.12 common  
shares per purchase contract (regardless of the market price of our common shares at that time), subject to some anti-dilution adjustments. A  
holder of purchase contracts may also elect to accelerate the settlement date of some or all of its purchase contracts. Upon an early settlement,  
the holder will receive 16,885.93 common shares per purchase contract (regardless of the market price of Nortel Networks common shares at  
that time), subject to some anti-dilution adjustments. For more information on early settlement of our purchase contracts, see “Capital stock —  
Prepaid forward purchase contracts” in note 16 of the accompanying consolidated financial statements. An acceleration of the settlement date  
or early settlement of our purchase contracts could contribute to volatility in the market price of our common shares.  
Industry concerns could continue and increase our exposure to our customers’ credit risk and the risk that our customers will not be  
able to fulfill their payment obligations to us under customer financing arrangements.  
The competitive environment in which we operate has required us in the past to provide significant amounts of medium-term and long-term  
customer financing. Customer financing arrangements may include financing in connection with the sale of our products and services, funding  
for certain non-product and service costs associated with network installation and integration of our products and services, financing for  
working capital and equity financing. While we have significantly reduced our customer financing exposure, we expect we may continue in the  
future to provide customer financing to customers in areas that are strategic to our core business activity.  
We expect to continue to hold most current and future customer financing obligations for longer periods prior to any possible placement with  
third-party lenders, due to, among other factors, recent economic uncertainty in various countries, adverse capital market conditions, our  
current credit condition, adverse changes in the credit quality of our customers and reduced demand for telecommunications financing in  
capital and bank markets. In addition, risks generally associated with customer financing, including the risks associated with new technologies,  
new network construction, market demand and competition, customer business plan viability and funding risks, may require us to hold certain  
customer financing obligations over a longer term. We may not be able to place any of our current or future customer financing obligations  
with third-party lenders on acceptable terms.  
Certain customers have been experiencing financial difficulties and have failed to meet their financial obligations. As a result, we have  
incurred charges for increased provisions related to certain trade and customer financing receivables. If there are further increases in the failure  
of our customers to meet their customer financing and receivables obligations to us or if the assumptions underlying the amount of provisions  
we have taken with respect to customer financing and receivables obligations do not reflect actual future financial conditions and customer  
payment levels, we could incur losses in excess of our provisions, which could have a material adverse effect on our cash flow and operating  
results.  
Negative developments associated with our supply contracts and contract manufacturing agreements may materially and adversely  
affect our business, results of operations, financial condition and supply relationships.  
We have entered into supply contracts with customers to provide products and services, which in some cases involve new  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
technologies currently being developed, or which we have not yet commercially deployed, or which require us to build networks. Some of  
these supply contracts contain delivery and installation timetables, performance criteria and other contractual obligations which, if not met,  
could result in our having to pay substantial penalties or liquidated damages and/or the termination of the supply contract. Unexpected  
developments in these supply contracts could have a material adverse effect on our revenues, cash flows and relationships with our customers.  
Our ability to meet customer demand is, in part, dependent on us obtaining timely and adequate component parts and products from suppliers,  
contract manufacturers, and internal manufacturing capacity. As part of the transformation of our supply chain from a vertically integrated  
manufacturing model to a virtually integrated model, we have outsourced substantially all of our manufacturing capacity to contract  
manufacturers, including an agreement with Flextronics announced on June 29, 2004 regarding the divestiture of certain of our manufacturing  
operations and related activities. The transfer to Flextronics of our optical design operations and related assets in Ottawa, Canada and  
Monkstown, Northern Ireland was completed in the fourth quarter of 2004. The transfer of our manufacturing activities in Montreal, Canada is  
expected to be completed in the first quarter of 2005. The balance of the divestiture is anticipated to close in the first half of 2005, subject to  
completion of the required information and consultation processes with the relevant employee representatives. Upon the completion of the  
divestiture, a significant portion of our supply chain will be concentrated with Flextronics. We work closely with our suppliers and contract  
manufacturers to address quality issues and to meet increases in customer demand, when needed, and we also manage our internal  
manufacturing capacity, quality, and inventory levels as required. However, we may encounter shortages of quality components and/or  
products in the future. In addition, our component suppliers and contract manufacturers have experienced, and may continue to experience, a  
consolidation in the industry and financial difficulties, both of which may result in fewer sources of components or products and greater  
exposure to the financial stability of our suppliers. A reduction or interruption in component supply or external manufacturing capacity, a  
significant increase in the price of one or more components, or excessive inventory levels could materially and negatively affect our gross  
margins and our operating results and could materially damage customer relationships.  
Many of our current and planned products are highly complex and may contain defects or errors that are detected only after  
deployment in telecommunications networks, which could harm our reputation.  
Our products are highly complex, and some of them can be fully tested only when deployed in telecommunications networks or with other  
equipment. From time to time, our products have contained undetected defects, errors or failures. The occurrence of any defects, errors or  
failures could result in cancellation of orders, product returns, diversion of our resources, legal actions by our customers or our customers’ end  
users and other losses to us or to our customers or end users. Any of these occurrences could also result in the loss of or delay in market  
acceptance of our products and loss of sales, which would harm our business and adversely affect our business, results of operations and  
financial condition.  
Our business may suffer if our strategic alliances are not successful.  
We have entered into a number of strategic alliances with suppliers, developers and members in our industry to facilitate product compatibility,  
encourage adoption of industry standards or to offer complementary product or service offerings to meet customer needs. In some cases, the  
companies with which we have strategic alliances also compete against us in some of our business areas. If a member of a strategic alliance  
fails to perform its obligations, if the relationship fails to develop as expected or if the relationship is terminated, we could experience delays in  
product availability or impairment of our relationships with our customers.  
In addition to the investigations and litigation arising out of our restatements, we are also subject to numerous class actions and other  
lawsuits as well as lawsuits in the ordinary course of business.  
In addition to the investigations and litigation arising out of our restatements, we are currently a defendant in numerous class actions and other  
lawsuits, including lawsuits initiated on behalf of holders of our common shares, which seek damages of material and indeterminate amounts,  
as well as lawsuits in the ordinary course of our business. In the future, we may be subject to similar litigation. The defense of these lawsuits  
may divert our management’s attention, and we may incur significant expenses in defending these lawsuits (including substantial fees of  
lawyers and other professional advisors and potential obligations to indemnify officers and directors who may be parties to such actions). In  
addition, we may be required to pay judgments or settlements that could have a material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial  
condition and liquidity.  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ITEM 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk  
Refer to “Market risk” in Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PART II  
ITEM 8. Consolidated Financial Statements and Supplementary Data  
INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS  
PAGE  
F-1  
F-2  
F-3  
F-4  
F-5  
F-6  
Report of Independent Registered Chartered Accountants  
Consolidated Statements of Operations  
Consolidated Balance Sheets  
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity and Comprehensive Income (Loss)  
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows  
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements  
* * * * * * * * *  
Quarterly Financial Data (Unaudited)  
F-92  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS  
To the Shareholders and Board of Directors of Nortel Networks Corporation  
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Nortel Networks Corporation and its subsidiaries (“Nortel Networks”) as of  
December 31, 2003 and 2002 and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in equity and comprehensive income (loss) and  
cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2003. These financial statements are the responsibility of Nortel  
Networks management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.  
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those  
standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material  
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An  
audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall  
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.  
In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Nortel Networks as of  
December 31, 2003 and 2002 and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December  
31, 2003 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.  
As described in note 3 to the consolidated financial statements, the accompanying consolidated financial statements of Nortel Networks as of  
December 31, 2002, and for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001 have been restated.  
As described in note 4 to the consolidated financial statements, effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks changed its method of accounting  
for stock-based compensation and asset retirement obligations, in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”)  
SFAS No. 148, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation — Transition and Disclosure”, and SFAS No. 143, “Accounting for Asset  
Retirement Obligations”, respectively. Also, as described in note 4, effective January 1, 2002, Nortel Networks changed its method of  
accounting for goodwill in accordance with SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets”.  
On January 10, 2005, we reported separately to the Shareholders of Nortel Networks on consolidated financial statements for the same periods,  
audited in accordance with Canadian generally accepted auditing standards and prepared in accordance with Canadian generally accepted  
accounting principles.  
/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP  
Independent Registered Chartered Accountants  
Toronto, Canada  
January 10, 2005  
F-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS CORPORATION  
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31  
(millions of U.S. dollars, except per share amounts)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
As restated *  
As restated *  
Revenues  
Cost of revenues  
$
10,193  
5,852  
$
11,008  
7,103  
$
18,900  
14,612  
Gross profit  
4,341  
3,905  
4,288  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
In-process research and development expense  
Amortization of intangibles  
Acquired technology and other  
Goodwill  
1,939  
1,960  
2,553  
2,083  
6,111  
3,116  
15  
101  
16  
157  
110  
806  
4,058  
248  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
284  
(4)  
595  
1,500  
(21)  
11,426  
3,390  
138  
Operating earnings (loss)  
45  
(3,072)  
(5)  
(25,020)  
(506)  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense  
Long-term debt  
Other  
445  
(181)  
(28)  
(220)  
(52)  
(208)  
(103)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of associated  
companies  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
281  
80  
(3,349)  
468  
(25,837)  
2,751  
361  
(63)  
(36)  
(2,881)  
5
(17)  
(23,086)  
(34)  
Minority interests — net of tax  
Equity in net loss of associated companies — net of tax  
(150)  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
262  
184  
(2,893)  
(101)  
(23,270)  
(2,467)  
Net earnings (loss) before cumulative effect of accounting changes  
Cumulative effect of accounting changes — net of tax  
446  
(12)  
(2,994)  
(25,737)  
15  
Net earnings (loss)  
$
434  
$
(2,994)  
$
(25,722)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
0.06  
0.04  
$
$
(0.75)  
(0.03)  
$
$
(7.30)  
(0.78)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
0.10  
(0.78)  
(8.08)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
0.06  
0.04  
$
(0.75)  
(0.03)  
$
(7.30)  
(0.78)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
Dividends declared per common share  
$
$
0.10  
$
$
(0.78)  
$
$
(8.08)  
0.0375  
* See note 3  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements  
F-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS CORPORATION  
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
2003  
2002  
As restated *  
ASSETS  
Current assets  
Cash and cash equivalents  
Restricted cash and cash equivalents  
Accounts receivable — net  
Inventories — net  
Income taxes recoverable  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other current assets  
$
3,997  
63  
2,505  
1,190  
90  
369  
315  
$
3,790  
249  
2,228  
1,506  
114  
790  
650  
8,529  
9,327  
Total current assets  
Investments  
Plant and equipment — net  
Goodwill  
Intangible assets — net  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other assets  
244  
1,656  
2,305  
86  
3,397  
374  
237  
1,692  
2,199  
139  
2,582  
785  
$
$
16,591  
$
$
16,961  
Total assets  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Current liabilities  
Notes payable  
Trade and other accounts payable  
Payroll and benefit-related liabilities  
Contractual liabilities  
17  
861  
764  
30  
803  
485  
530  
894  
Restructuring  
206  
507  
Other accrued liabilities  
Long-term debt due within one year  
2,505  
119  
3,257  
243  
5,002  
6,219  
Total current liabilities  
Long-term debt  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other liabilities  
3,891  
191  
2,945  
3,960  
337  
2,761  
12,029  
617  
13,277  
631  
Total liabilities  
Minority interests in subsidiary companies  
Commitments and contingencies (notes 14 and 22)  
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Common shares, without par value — Authorized shares: unlimited;  
Issued and outstanding shares: 4,166,714,475 for 2003 and 3,844,171,700 for 2002  
Additional paid-in capital  
33,674  
3,341  
33,234  
3,753  
Deferred stock option compensation  
(17)  
Accumulated deficit  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss  
(32,532)  
(538)  
(32,966)  
(951)  
3,945  
3,053  
Total shareholders’ equity  
$
16,591  
$
16,961  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity  
* See note 3  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.  
F-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS CORPORATION  
Consolidated Statements of Changes in Equity and Comprehensive Income (Loss)  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
As restated *  
As restated *  
Common shares  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
$
33,234  
3
413  
(11)  
35  
$
32,245  
863  
1
$
29,141  
207  
Common shares issued (cancelled) — net  
Conversion of prepaid forward purchase contracts  
Common shares issued (cancelled) related to acquisitions — net  
Fair value and costs associated with assumed options and stock purchase plans  
(12)  
137  
2,509  
388  
Balance at the end of the year  
33,674  
33,234  
32,245  
Additional paid-in capital  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
3,753  
3,256  
12  
623  
(1)  
3,637  
(10)  
10  
Adjustments as of January 1, 2001 due to restatement *  
Additions resulting from acquisition related share cancellations  
Prepaid forward purchase contracts issued  
Prepaid forward purchase contracts settled  
Fair value and costs associated with assumed options and stock purchase plans  
Stock option compensation  
11  
(413)  
(35)  
26  
(137)  
(401)  
Cancellation of deferred stock options  
Tax benefit associated with stock options  
(1)  
(13)  
13  
(85)  
105  
Balance at the end of the year  
3,341  
3,753  
3,256  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
(17)  
(140)  
(413)  
(56)  
(8)  
Adjustments as of January 1, 2001 due to restatement *  
Additions resulting from acquisitions  
Amortization of deferred stock option compensation  
Cancellation of deferred stock options  
16  
1
110  
13  
252  
85  
Balance at the end of the year  
(17)  
(140)  
Accumulated deficit  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
Adjustments as of January 1, 2001 due to restatement *  
Net earnings (loss)  
(32,966)  
(29,972)  
(2,695)  
(1,432)  
(25,722)  
(123)  
434  
(2,994)  
Dividends on common shares  
Balance at the end of the year  
(32,532)  
(32,966)  
(29,972)  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
(951)  
529  
57  
15  
(188)  
(581)  
157  
19  
11  
(557)  
(499)  
189  
(134)  
(39)  
(7)  
Adjustments as of January 1, 2001 due to restatement *  
Foreign currency translation adjustment  
Unrealized gain (loss) on investments — net  
Unrealized derivative gain (loss) on cash flow hedges — net  
Minimum pension liability adjustment — net  
Cumulative effect of accounting change — net  
(84)  
(7)  
Other comprehensive income (loss)  
Balance at the end of the year  
Total shareholders’ equity  
413  
(538)  
3,945  
(370)  
(951)  
3,053  
(271)  
(581)  
4,808  
$
$
$
Total comprehensive income (loss) for the year  
Net earnings (loss)  
Other comprehensive income (loss)  
$
$
434  
413  
$
$
(2,994)  
(370)  
$
$
(25,722)  
(271)  
847  
(3,364)  
(25,993)  
Total comprehensive income (loss) for the year  
* See note 3  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements  
F-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS CORPORATION  
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
As restated *  
As restated *  
Cash flows from (used in) operating activities  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Adjustments to reconcile net earnings (loss) from continuing operations to net cash from (used in) operating activities, net  
of effects from acquisitions and divestitures of businesses:  
Amortization and depreciation  
$
262  
$
(2,893)  
$
(23,270)  
541  
87  
701  
1,142  
17  
5,665  
15  
12,760  
150  
In-process research and development expense  
Non-cash portion of special charges and related asset write downs  
Equity in net loss of associated companies  
36  
Current and deferred stock option compensation  
Deferred income taxes  
Other liabilities  
(Gain) loss on repurchases of outstanding debt securities  
(Gain) loss on sale or write down of investments and businesses  
Other — net  
42  
110  
(425)  
(2)  
(60)  
18  
248  
(1,513)  
(9)  
506  
(50)  
161  
(4)  
(51)  
(786)  
(153)  
(191)  
815  
(1,529)  
7,183  
Change in operating assets and liabilities  
Net cash from (used in) operating activities of continuing operations  
85  
(768)  
206  
Cash flows from (used in) investing activities  
Expenditures for plant and equipment  
Proceeds on disposals of plant and equipment  
Acquisitions of investments and businesses — net of cash acquired  
Proceeds on sale of investments and businesses  
(172)  
38  
(58)  
(352)  
406  
(29)  
(1,302)  
208  
(79)  
604  
107  
104  
Net cash from (used in) investing activities of continuing operations  
(85)  
129  
(569)  
Cash flows from (used in) financing activities  
Dividends on common shares  
Dividends paid by subsidiaries to minority interests  
Increase (decrease) in notes payable — net  
Proceeds from long-term debt  
Repayments of long-term debt  
Repayments of capital leases payable  
Issuance of common shares  
(35)  
(45)  
(270)  
(12)  
3
(26)  
(333)  
33  
(611)  
(17)  
863  
(123)  
(27)  
(230)  
3,286  
(470)  
(26)  
146  
Issuance of prepaid forward purchase contracts  
623  
Net cash from (used in) financing activities of continuing operations  
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents  
(359)  
176  
532  
74  
2,556  
(10)  
Net cash from (used in) continuing operations  
Net cash from (used in) discontinued operations  
(183)  
390  
(33)  
349  
2,183  
(331)  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year  
207  
3,790  
316  
3,474  
1,852  
1,622  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year  
$
3,997  
$
3,790  
$
3,474  
* See note 3  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements  
F-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS CORPORATION  
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements  
(millions of U.S. dollars, except per share amounts, unless otherwise stated)  
1. Nortel Networks Corporation  
Nortel Networks Corporation (“Nortel Networks”) is a recognized leader in delivering communications capabilities, serving both service  
provider and enterprise customers. Nortel Networks delivers innovative technology solutions encompassing end-to-end broadband, Voice  
over IP, multimedia services and applications, and wireless broadband solutions. Nortel Networks business consists of the design,  
development, manufacture, assembly, marketing, sale, licensing, installation, servicing and support of these networking solutions. A  
substantial portion of Nortel Networks business has a technology focus and is dedicated to research and development.  
For 2003, Nortel Networks operations were organized into four reportable segments consisting of Wireless Networks, Enterprise  
Networks, Wireline Networks and Optical Networks. See note 6 for information concerning a change in Nortel Networks organizational  
structure in 2004.  
The common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation are publicly traded on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) and Toronto Stock  
Exchange (“TSX”) under the symbol “NT”. Nortel Networks Limited (“NNL”) is Nortel Networks principal direct operating subsidiary  
and its results are consolidated into Nortel Networks results. Nortel Networks holds all of NNL’s outstanding common shares but none of  
its outstanding preferred shares. NNL’s preferred shares are reported in minority interests in subsidiary companies in the consolidated  
balance sheets and dividends and the related taxes on preferred shares are reported in minority interests — net of tax in the consolidated  
statements of operations.  
2. Significant accounting policies  
Basis of presentation  
The consolidated financial statements of Nortel Networks have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally  
accepted in the United States (“U.S.”) (“GAAP”) and the rules and regulations of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the  
“SEC”) for the preparation of financial statements. Although Nortel Networks is headquartered in Canada, the consolidated financial  
statements are expressed in U.S. dollars as the greater part of the financial results and net assets of Nortel Networks are denominated in  
U.S. dollars.  
As described in note 3, the consolidated statements of operations, changes in equity and comprehensive income (loss) and cash flows for  
the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001 and the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2002, including the applicable  
notes, were restated.  
(a) Principles of consolidation  
The financial statements of entities which are controlled by Nortel Networks through voting equity interests, referred to as  
subsidiaries, are consolidated. Entities which are jointly controlled, referred to as joint ventures, and entities which are not  
controlled but over which Nortel Networks has the ability to exercise significant influence, referred to as associated companies, are  
accounted for using the equity method. Variable Interest Entities (“VIEs”) (which include, but are not limited to, special purpose  
entities, trusts, partnerships, certain joint ventures and other legal structures), as defined by the Financial Accounting Standards  
Board (“FASB”) in FASB Interpretation (“FIN”) No. 46 (Revised 2003), “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities — an  
Interpretation of Accounting Research Bulletin No. 51” (“FIN 46R”), are entities in which equity investors do not have the  
characteristics of a “controlling financial interest” or there is not sufficient equity at risk for the entity to finance its activities  
without additional subordinated financial support. VIEs are consolidated by Nortel Networks when it is determined that it will, as  
the primary beneficiary, absorb the majority of the VIEs expected losses and/or expected residual returns. Intercompany accounts  
and transactions are eliminated upon consolidation and unrealized intercompany gains and losses are eliminated when accounting  
under the equity method.  
(b) Use of estimates  
Nortel Networks makes estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of  
contingent assets and liabilities as of the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported  
F-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results may differ from those estimates. Estimates are used  
when accounting for items and matters such as revenue recognition, allowances for uncollectible accounts receivable and customer  
financing, receivables sales, inventory obsolescence, product warranty, amortization, asset valuations, impairment assessments,  
employee benefits including pensions, taxes, restructuring and other provisions, in-process research and development (“IPR&D”),  
stock-based compensation and contingencies.  
(c) Translation of foreign currencies  
The consolidated financial statements of Nortel Networks are presented in U.S. dollars. The financial statements of Nortel  
Networks operations whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar (except for highly inflationary economies as described below)  
are translated into U.S. dollars at the exchange rates in effect at the balance sheet dates for assets and liabilities, and at average rates  
for the period for revenues and expenses. The unrealized translation gains and losses on Nortel Networks net investment in these  
operations, including long-term intercompany advances considered to form part of the net investment, are accumulated as a  
component of other comprehensive income (loss) (“OCI”).  
Transactions and financial statements for Nortel Networks operations in countries considered to have highly inflationary economies  
and whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar are translated into U.S. dollars at the exchange rates in effect at the balance  
sheet dates for monetary assets and liabilities, and at historical exchange rates for non-monetary assets and liabilities. Revenue and  
expenses are translated at average rates for the period, except for amortization and depreciation which are translated on the same  
basis as the related assets. Resulting translation gains or losses are reflected in net earnings (loss).  
When appropriate, Nortel Networks may hedge a designated portion of the exposure to foreign exchange gains and losses incurred  
on the translation of specific foreign operations. Hedging instruments used by Nortel Networks can include foreign currency  
denominated debt, foreign currency swaps and foreign currency forward contracts that are denominated in the same currency as the  
hedged foreign operations. The translation gains and losses on the effective portion of the hedging instruments that qualify for  
hedge accounting are recorded in OCI; other translation gains and losses are recorded in net earnings (loss).  
(d) Revenue recognition  
Nortel Networks products and services are generally sold as part of a contract and the terms of the contracts, taken as a whole,  
determine the appropriate revenue recognition methods.  
Depending upon the terms of the contract and types of products and services sold, Nortel Networks recognizes revenue under  
American Institute of Certified Public Accountants Statement of Position (“SOP”) 81-1, “Accounting for Performance of  
Construction-Type and Certain Production-Type Contracts” (“SOP 81-1”), SOP 97-2, “Software Revenue Recognition” (“SOP 97-  
2”), and SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin (“SAB”) 104, “Revenue Recognition” (“SAB 104”), which was preceded by SAB 101,  
“Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements” (“SAB 101”). Revenue is recognized net of cash discounts and allowances.  
Effective July 1, 2003, for contracts involving multiple deliverables, where the deliverables are governed by more than one  
authoritative accounting standard, Nortel Networks generally applies the FASB Emerging Issues Task Force (“EITF”) Issue  
No. 00-21, “Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables” (“EITF 00-21”), and evaluates each deliverable to determine  
whether it represents a separate unit of accounting based on the following criteria: (a) whether the delivered item has value to the  
customer on a standalone basis, (b) whether there is objective and reliable evidence of the fair value of the undelivered item(s), and  
(c) if the contract includes a general right of return relative to the delivered item, delivery or performance of the undelivered item(s)  
is considered probable and substantially in the control of Nortel Networks. If objective and reliable evidence of fair value exists for  
all units of accounting in the contract, revenue is allocated to each unit of accounting or element based on relative fair values. In  
situations where there is objective and reliable evidence of fair value for all undelivered elements, but not for delivered elements,  
the residual method is used to allocate the contract consideration. Under the residual method, the amount of revenue allocated to  
delivered elements equals the total arrangement consideration less the aggregate fair value of any undelivered elements. Each unit  
of accounting is then accounted for under the applicable revenue recognition guidance.  
F-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For arrangements that include hardware and software where software is considered more than incidental to the hardware, provided  
that the software is not essential to the functionality of the hardware and the hardware and software represent separate units of  
accounting, revenue related to the software element is recognized under SOP 97-2 and revenue related to the hardware element is  
recognized under SOP 81-1 or SAB 104. For arrangements where the software is considered more than incidental and essential to  
the functionality of the hardware, or where the hardware is not considered a separate unit of accounting from the software  
deliverables, revenue is recognized for the software and the hardware as a single unit of accounting pursuant to SOP 97-2 for off-  
the-shelf products and pursuant to SOP 81-1 for customized products.  
Prior to July 1, 2003, for contracts involving multiple elements, Nortel Networks allocated revenue to each element based on the  
relative fair value or the residual method, as applicable. Provided none of the undelivered elements are essential to the functionality  
of the delivered elements, revenue related to the software element is recognized under SOP 97-2 and revenue related to the  
hardware element is recognized under SOP 81-1 or SAB 101.  
For accounting units related to customized network solutions and certain network build outs, revenues are recognized under SOP  
81-1 using the percentage-of-completion method. In using the percentage-of-completion method, revenues are generally recorded  
based on a measure of the percentage of costs incurred to date on a contract relative to the estimated total expected contract costs.  
Profit estimates on long-term contracts are revised periodically based on changes in circumstances and any losses on contracts are  
recognized in the period that such losses become known. Generally, the terms of long-term contracts provide for progress billing  
based on completion of certain phases of work. Contract revenues recognized, based on costs incurred towards the completion of  
the project, that are unbilled are accumulated in the contracts in progress account included in accounts receivable — net. Billings in  
excess of revenues recognized to date on long-term contracts are recorded as advance billings in excess of revenues within other  
accrued liabilities.  
Revenue for hardware that does not require significant customization, and where any software is considered incidental, is  
recognized under SAB 104. Under SAB 104, revenue is recognized provided that persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists,  
delivery has occurred or services have been rendered, the fee is fixed or determinable and collectibility is reasonably assured. For  
hardware, delivery is considered to have occurred upon shipment provided that risk of loss, and title in certain jurisdictions, have  
been transferred to the customer.  
Engineering, installation and other service revenues are recognized as the services are performed.  
Nortel Networks makes certain sales through multiple distribution channels, primarily resellers and distributors. These customers  
are generally given certain rights of return. For products sold through these distribution channels, revenue is recognized from  
product sale at the time of shipment to the distribution channel when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery has  
occurred, the fee is fixed or determinable and collection is reasonably assured. Accruals for estimated sales returns and other  
allowances are recorded at the time of revenue recognition and are based on contract terms and prior claims experience.  
Software revenue is generally recognized under SOP 97-2. For software arrangements involving multiple elements, Nortel  
Networks allocates revenue to each element based on the relative fair value or the residual method, as applicable, and using vendor  
specific objective evidence of fair values, which is based on prices charged when the element is sold separately. Software revenue  
accounted for under SOP 97-2 is recognized when: persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists; the software is delivered in  
accordance with all terms and conditions of the customer contracts; the fee is fixed or determinable; and collection is reasonably  
assured. Revenue related to post-contract support, including technical support and unspecified when-and-if available software  
upgrades (“PCS”), is recognized ratably over the PCS term. Nortel Networks provides extended payment terms on certain software  
contracts and may sell these receivables to third parties. The fees on these contracts are considered fixed or determinable if the  
contracts are similar to others for which Nortel Networks has a standard business practice of providing extended payment terms and  
has a history of successfully collecting under the original payment terms without making concessions.  
Under SAB 104 or SOP 97-2, if fair value does not exist for any undelivered element, revenue is not recognized until the earlier of  
(i) the undelivered element is delivered or (ii) fair value of the undelivered element exists, unless the undelivered element is a  
service, in which case revenue is recognized as the service is performed once the service is the only undelivered element.  
(e) Research and development  
F-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Research and development (“R&D”) costs are charged to net earnings (loss) in the periods in which they are incurred. However,  
costs incurred pursuant to specific contracts with third parties for which Nortel Networks is obligated to deliver a product are  
charged to cost of revenues in the same period as the related revenue is recognized. Related global investment tax credits are  
deducted from the income tax provision.  
(f) Income taxes  
Nortel Networks provides for income taxes using the asset and liability method. This approach recognizes the amount of taxes  
payable or refundable for the current year as well as deferred tax assets and liabilities for the future tax consequence of events  
recognized in the consolidated financial statements and tax returns. Deferred income taxes are adjusted to reflect the effects of  
changes in tax laws or enacted tax rates.  
In establishing the appropriate income tax valuation allowances, Nortel Networks assesses the realizability of its net deferred tax  
assets quarterly and based on all available evidence, both positive and negative, determines whether it is more likely than not that  
the remaining net deferred tax assets or a portion thereof will be realized.  
(g) Earnings (loss) per common share  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share is calculated by dividing the net earnings (loss) by the weighted-average number of Nortel  
Networks Corporation’s common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings (loss) per common share is calculated by  
dividing the applicable net earnings (loss) by the sum of the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding and all  
additional common shares that would have been outstanding if potentially dilutive common shares had been issued during the  
period. The treasury stock method is used to compute the dilutive effect of warrants, options and similar instruments. The if-  
converted method is used to compute the dilutive effect of convertible debt. A comparison of the conditions required for issuance of  
shares compared to those existing at the end of the period is used to compute the dilutive effect of contingently issuable shares.  
(h) Cash and cash equivalents  
Cash and cash equivalents consist of cash on hand, balances with banks and short-term investments. All highly liquid investments  
with original maturities of three months or less are classified as cash and cash equivalents. The fair value of cash and cash  
equivalents approximates the amounts shown in the consolidated financial statements.  
(i) Restricted cash and cash equivalents  
Cash and cash equivalents are considered restricted when they are subject to contingent rights of a third party customer under bid,  
performance related and other bonds associated with contracts that Nortel Networks is not able to unilaterally revoke.  
(j) Provision for doubtful accounts  
The provision for doubtful accounts for trade, notes and long-term receivables due from customers is established based on an  
assessment of a customer’s credit quality, as well as subjective factors and trends, including the aging of receivable balances.  
Generally, these credit assessments occur prior to the inception of the credit exposure and at regular reviews during the life of the  
exposure.  
Customer financing receivables include receivables from customers with deferred payment terms. Customer financing receivables  
are considered impaired when they are classified as non-performing, payment arrears exceed 90 days or a major credit event such as  
a material default has occurred, and management determines that collection of amounts due according to the contractual terms is  
doubtful. Provisions for impaired customer financing receivables are recorded based on the expected recovery of defaulted  
customer obligations, being the present value of expected cash flows, or the realizable value of the collateral if recovery of the  
receivables is dependent upon a liquidation of the assets. Interest income on impaired customer finance receivables is recognized as  
the cash payments are collected.  
(k) Inventories  
F-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Inventories are valued at the lower of cost (calculated generally on a first-in, first-out basis) or market. The cost of finished goods  
and work in process is comprised of material, labor and manufacturing overhead. Provisions for inventory are based on estimates of  
future customer demand for products, including general economic conditions, growth prospects within the customer’s ultimate  
marketplaces and market acceptance of current and pending products. In addition, full provisions are generally recorded for surplus  
inventory in excess of one year’s forecast demand or inventory deemed obsolete.  
(l) Receivables sales  
Transfers of accounts receivable that meet the criteria for surrender of control under FASB Statement of Financial Accounting  
Standard (“SFAS”) No. 140, “Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities”, are  
accounted for as sales. Generally, Nortel Networks retains servicing rights and, in some cases, provides limited recourse when it  
sells receivables. A gain or loss is recorded in other income (expense) — net at the date of the receivables sale and is based upon, in  
part, the previous carrying amount of the receivables involved in the transfer allocated between the assets sold and the retained  
interests based on their relative fair value at the date of the transfer. Fair value is generally estimated based on the present value of  
the estimated future cash flows expected under management’s assumptions, including discount rates assigned commensurate with  
risks. Retained interests are classified as available-for-sale securities.  
Nortel Networks, when acting as the servicing agent, generally does not record an asset or liability related to servicing as the annual  
servicing fees are equivalent to those that would be paid to a third party servicing agent. Certain transactions will enable Nortel  
Networks, when acting as the servicing agent, to receive a servicing bonus at the maturity of the transaction if certain performance  
criteria are met. The ultimate collection of servicing bonuses is based primarily on the collectibility and credit experience of the  
receivables sold and is sometimes paid at the discretion of the transferee. Nortel Networks initially records the non-discretionary  
servicing bonus at fair value which is the discounted value of the estimated future cash flows taking into consideration future  
estimated interest rates and credit losses. Generally, the discretionary servicing bonus is initially recorded at a fair value of nil due  
to the fact that it is paid at the discretion of the transferee and based on the determination that future credit losses will offset any  
such servicing bonus.  
Nortel Networks reviews the fair value assigned to retained interests, including the servicing bonus, at each reporting date  
subsequent to the date of the transfer to determine if there is an other than temporary impairment. Fair value is reviewed using  
similar valuation techniques as those used to initially measure the retained interest and, if a change in events or circumstances  
warrants, the fair value is adjusted and any other than temporary impairments are recorded in other income (expense) — net.  
(m) Investments  
Investments in publicly traded equity securities of companies over which Nortel Networks does not exert significant influence are  
accounted for at fair value and are classified as available for sale. Unrealized holding gains and losses related to these securities are  
excluded from net earnings (loss) and are included in OCI until such gains or losses are realized.  
Investments in equity securities of private companies over which Nortel Networks does not exert significant influence are  
accounted for using the cost method. Investments in associated companies and joint ventures are accounted for using the equity  
method. An impairment loss is recorded when there has been a loss in value of the investment that is other than temporary.  
Nortel Networks monitors its investments for factors indicating other than temporary impairment and records a charge to net  
earnings (loss) when appropriate.  
(n) Plant and equipment  
Plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is generally calculated on a straight-line basis  
over the expected useful lives of the plant and equipment. The expected useful lives of buildings are twenty to forty years, and of  
machinery and equipment are five to ten years.  
(o) Impairment or disposal of long-lived assets (plant and equipment and acquired technology)  
F-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Long-lived assets held and used  
Nortel Networks tests long-lived assets or asset groups held and used for recoverability when events or changes in circumstances  
indicate that their carrying amount may not be recoverable. Circumstances which could trigger a review include, but are not limited  
to: significant decreases in the market price of the asset; significant adverse changes in the business climate or legal factors; the  
accumulation of costs significantly in excess of the amount originally expected for the acquisition or construction of the asset;  
current period cash flow or operating losses combined with a history of losses or a forecast of continuing losses associated with the  
use of the asset; and a current expectation that the asset will more likely than not be sold or disposed of significantly before the end  
of its estimated useful life.  
Recoverability is assessed based on the carrying amount of the asset and the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected to result  
from the use and the eventual disposal of the asset or asset group. An impairment loss is recognized when the carrying amount is  
not recoverable and exceeds the fair value of the asset or asset group. The impairment loss is measured as the amount by which the  
carrying amount exceeds fair value.  
Long-lived assets held for sale  
Long-lived assets are classified as held for sale when certain criteria are met, which include: management’s commitment to a plan  
to sell the assets; the availability of the assets for immediate sale in their present condition; whether an active program to locate  
buyers and other actions to sell the assets have been initiated; whether the sale of the assets is probable and their transfer is expected  
to qualify for recognition as a completed sale within one year; whether the assets are being marketed at reasonable prices in relation  
to their fair value; and how unlikely it is that significant changes will be made to the plan to sell the assets.  
Nortel Networks measures long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less cost to sell.  
These assets are not depreciated. Fair value is determined using quoted market prices or the anticipated cash flows discounted at a  
rate commensurate with the risk involved.  
Long-lived assets to be disposed of other than by sale  
Nortel Networks classifies assets that will be disposed of other than by sale as held and used until the disposal transaction occurs.  
The assets continue to be depreciated based on revisions to their estimated useful lives until the date of disposal or abandonment.  
Recoverability is assessed based on the carrying amount of the asset and the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected to result  
from the remaining period of use and the eventual disposal of the asset or asset group. An impairment loss is recognized when the  
carrying amount is not recoverable and exceeds the fair value of the asset or asset group. The impairment loss is measured as the  
amount by which the carrying amount exceeds fair value.  
(p) Goodwill  
Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price of an acquired enterprise over the fair value of the identifiable assets acquired  
and liabilities assumed. Nortel Networks tests for impairment of goodwill on an annual basis as of October 1 and at any other time  
if events occur or circumstances change that would indicate that it is more likely than not that the fair value of the reporting unit has  
been reduced below its carrying amount (see note 4(k)).  
Circumstances that could trigger an impairment test include: a significant adverse change in the business climate or legal factors; an  
adverse action or assessment by a regulator; unanticipated competition; the loss of key personnel; the likelihood that a reporting  
unit or significant portion of a reporting unit will be sold or otherwise disposed of; the results of testing for recoverability of a  
significant asset group within a reporting unit; and the recognition of a goodwill impairment loss in the financial statements of a  
subsidiary that is a component of a reporting unit.  
The impairment test for goodwill is a two-step process. Step one consists of a comparison of the fair value of a reporting unit with  
its carrying amount, including the goodwill allocated to the reporting unit. Measurement of the fair value of a reporting unit is based  
on one or more fair value measures including present value techniques of estimated future cash flows and estimated amounts at  
which the unit as a whole could be bought or sold in a current transaction between willing parties. Nortel Networks also considers  
its market capitalization as of the date of the impairment test. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit exceeds the fair value,  
step two requires the fair value  
F-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
of the reporting unit to be allocated to the underlying assets and liabilities of that reporting unit, resulting in an implied fair value of  
goodwill. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss  
equal to the excess is recorded in net earnings (loss).  
(q) Intangible assets  
Acquired technology represents the value of the proprietary know-how which was technologically feasible as of the acquisition  
date, and is charged to net earnings (loss) on a straight-line basis over its estimated useful life of two to three years. Other intangible  
assets are amortized into net earnings (loss) based on their expected pattern of benefit to future periods using estimates of  
undiscounted cash flows.  
IPR&D represents the value, on closing of a business combination, of acquired research and development which was not  
technologically feasible as of the acquisition date and, other than its intended use, had no alternative future use. Independent  
valuations are performed to assess and allocate a value to IPR&D. The value allocated to IPR&D represents the estimated fair value  
based on risk-adjusted future cash flows generated from the products that would result from each of the in-process projects.  
Estimated future after tax cash flows of each project, on a product by product basis, are based on Nortel Networks estimates of  
revenues less operating expenses, cash flow adjustments, income taxes and charges for the use of contributory assets. Future cash  
flows are also adjusted for the value contributed by any core technology and development efforts that would be completed post-  
acquisition. IPR&D is charged to net earnings (loss) as of the date of acquisition.  
(r) Warranty costs  
As part of the normal sale of product, Nortel Networks provides its customers with product warranties that extend for periods  
generally ranging from one to six years from the date of sale. A liability for the expected cost of warranty-related claims is  
established when products are sold. In estimating warranty liability, historical material replacement costs and the associated labor to  
correct the product defect are considered. Revisions are made when actual experience differs materially from historical experience.  
Known product defects are specifically accrued for as Nortel Networks becomes aware of such defects.  
(s) Pension, post-retirement and post-employment benefits  
Pension expense, based on management’s assumptions, consists of the: actuarially computed costs of pension benefits in respect of  
the current year’s service; imputed returns on plan assets and imputed interest on pension obligations; and straight-line amortization  
under the corridor approach of experience gains and losses, assumption changes and plan amendments over the expected average  
remaining service life of the employee group.  
The expected costs of post-retirement and certain post-employment benefits, other than pensions, for active employees are accrued  
in the consolidated financial statements during the years employees provide service to Nortel Networks. These costs are recorded  
based on actuarial methods and assumptions. Other post-employment benefits are recognized when the event triggering the  
obligation occurs.  
(t) Derivative financial instruments  
F-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Nortel Networks net earnings (loss) and cash flows may be negatively impacted by fluctuating interest rates, foreign exchange rates  
and equity prices. To effectively manage these market risks, Nortel Networks enters into foreign currency forward contracts,  
foreign currency swaps, foreign currency option contracts, interest rate swaps and equity forward contracts. Nortel Networks does  
not hold or issue derivative instruments for trading purposes. Nortel Networks policy is to formally document all relationships  
between hedging instruments and hedged items, as well as its risk management objectives and strategy for undertaking various  
hedge transactions. Where hedge accounting will be applied, this process includes linking all derivatives to specific assets and  
liabilities on the consolidated balance sheet or to specific firm commitments or forecasted transactions. Nortel Networks also  
formally assesses, both at the hedge’s inception and on an ongoing basis, as applicable, whether the derivatives that are used in  
hedging transactions are highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of hedged items.  
For a derivative designated as a fair value hedge, changes in the fair value of the derivative and of the hedged item attributable to  
the hedged risk are recognized in net earnings (loss). For a derivative designated as a cash flow hedge, the effective portions of  
changes in the fair value of the derivative are recorded in OCI and are recognized in net earnings (loss) when the hedged item  
affects net earnings (loss). Ineffective portions of changes in the fair value of cash flow hedges are recognized in other income  
(expense) — net. If the derivative used in an economic hedging relationship is not designated in an accounting hedging relationship  
or if it has become ineffective, changes in the fair value of the derivative are recognized in net earnings (loss).  
When a cash flow or fair value hedging relationship is terminated because the derivative is sold, terminated or de-designated as a  
hedge, the accumulated OCI balance to the termination date or the fair value basis adjustment recorded on the hedged item is  
amortized into other income (expense) — net or interest expense on an effective yield basis over the original term of the hedging  
relationship. If a cash flow or fair value hedging relationship is terminated because the underlying hedged item is repaid or is sold,  
or it is no longer probable that the hedged forecasted transaction will occur, the accumulated balance in OCI or the fair value basis  
adjustment recorded on the hedged item is recorded immediately in net earnings (loss).  
Nortel Networks generally classifies cash flows resulting from its derivative financial instruments in the same manner as the cash  
flows from the item that the derivative is hedging. Typically, this is within cash flows from (used in) operating activities in the  
consolidated statements of cash flows, or, for derivatives designated as hedges relating to the cash flows associated with settlement  
of the principal component of long-term debt, within cash flows from (used in) financing activities.  
Nortel Networks may also invest in warrants to purchase securities of other companies as a strategic investment or receive warrants  
in various transactions. Warrants that relate to publicly traded companies or that can be net share settled are deemed to be derivative  
financial instruments. Such warrants, however, are generally not eligible to be designated as hedging instruments as there is no  
corresponding underlying exposure. In addition, Nortel Networks may enter into certain commercial contracts containing embedded  
derivative financial instruments. Generally, for these embedded derivatives, for which the economic characteristics and risks are not  
clearly and closely related to the economic characteristics and risks of the host contract, the changes in fair value are recorded in net  
earnings (loss).  
(u) Stock-based compensation  
In December 2002, the FASB issued Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 148, “Accounting for Stock-  
Based Compensation — Transition and Disclosure — an Amendment of FASB Statement No. 123” (“SFAS 148”), which amended  
the transitional provisions of SFAS No. 123, “Accounting for Stock-based Compensation” (“SFAS 123”), for companies electing to  
recognize employee stock-based compensation using the fair value based method.  
Prior to January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks, as permitted under SFAS 123, applied the intrinsic value method under Accounting  
Principles Board Opinion (“APB”) No. 25, “Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees” (“APB 25”), and related interpretations in  
accounting for its employee stock-based compensation plans.  
Effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks elected to expense employee stock-based compensation using the fair value based  
method prospectively for all awards granted, modified, or settled on or after January 1, 2003. The fair value at grant date of stock  
options is estimated using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. Compensation expense is recognized on a straight line basis  
over the stock option vesting period. The impact of the adoption of the  
F-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
fair value based method for expense recognition of employee awards resulted in $26 (net of tax of nil) of stock option expense  
during 2003.  
Stock-based awards that are settled or may be settled in cash or shares purchased on the open market at the option of employees or  
directors are recorded as liabilities. The measurement of the liability and compensation cost for these awards is based on the  
intrinsic value of the award and is recorded in net earnings (loss) over the vesting period of the award. Changes in Nortel Networks  
payment obligation subsequent to vesting of the award and prior to the settlement date are recorded in net earnings (loss) in the  
period incurred. The payment amount is established for Stock Appreciation Rights (“SARs”) on the date of exercise of the award by  
the employee, for Restricted Stock Units (“RSUs”) on the vesting date of the award and for Deferred Stock Units (“DSUs”) on the  
later of the date of termination of employment and/or directorship. Stock-based awards which are substantively discretionary in  
nature are recorded in the period that the issuance and settlement of the award is approved.  
Nortel Networks has stock purchase plans for eligible employees in eligible countries, and a stock purchase plan for eligible  
unionized employees in Canada (collectively, the “ESPPs”), to facilitate the acquisition of the common shares of Nortel Networks  
Corporation at a discount. Nortel Networks contribution to the ESPPs is recorded as compensation expense on a quarterly basis as  
the obligation to contribute is incurred.  
Had Nortel Networks applied the fair value based method to all stock-based awards in all periods, reported net earnings (loss) and  
earnings (loss) per common share would have been adjusted to the pro forma amounts indicated below for the following years  
ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Net earnings (loss) — reported  
Stock-based compensation — reported  
Deferred stock option compensation — reported  
Stock-based compensation — pro forma  
$
$
434  
55  
16  
$
$
(2,994)  
18  
79  
(1,149)  
$ (25,722)  
15  
(a)  
(b)  
151  
(1,766)  
(c)  
(481)  
Net earnings (loss) — pro forma  
24  
(4,046)  
$ (27,322)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share:  
Reported  
Pro forma  
$
$
0.10  
0.01  
$
$
(0.78)  
(1.06)  
$
$
(8.08)  
(8.58)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share:  
Reported  
Pro forma  
$
$
0.10  
0.01  
$
$
(0.78)  
(1.06)  
$
$
(8.08)  
(8.58)  
(a) Stock-based compensation — reported, included, for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001:  
i.  
Stock option expense of $26, nil and nil, respectively, which was net of tax of nil in each period;  
ii.  
Employer portion of ESPPs contributions expense of $6, $6 and $12, respectively, which was net of tax of nil, $2 and $6,  
respectively;  
iii. RSUs expense of $19, $5 and $4, respectively, which was net of tax of nil, $1 and $2, respectively; and  
iv. DSUs expense of $4, $7 and $(1), respectively, which was net of tax of nil, $3 and nil, respectively.  
(b) Deferred stock option compensation — reported, represented the amortization of deferred stock option compensation related  
primarily to unvested stock options held by employees of companies acquired in a purchase acquisition. For the years ended  
December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, the amounts were net of tax of nil, $31 and $97, respectively. In 2001, amortization of deferred  
stock option compensation of $4 was included within discontinued operations.  
(c) Stock-based compensation — pro forma expense for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001 was net of tax of nil, $170  
and $484, respectively.  
The following weighted-average assumptions were used in computing the fair value of stock options for purposes of expense recognition  
and pro forma disclosures, as applicable, for the following periods:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Black-Scholes weighted-average assumptions  
Expected dividend yield  
Expected volatility  
Risk-free interest rate  
Expected option life in years  
0.00%  
92.49%  
2.81%  
4
0.00%  
71.33%  
4.49%  
4
0.00%  
70.64%  
4.74%  
4
$
1.57  
$
3.50  
$
8.38  
Weighted-average stock option fair value per option granted  
F-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(v) Recent accounting pronouncements  
(i) On December 8, 2003, the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of 2003 (the “MPDIM Act”) was  
signed into law in the U.S. The MPDIM Act introduced a prescription drug benefit under Medicare (specifically, Medicare Part  
D) as well as a federal subsidy to sponsors of retiree health care benefit plans that provide a benefit that is at least actuarially  
equivalent to Medicare Part D. As permitted by FASB Staff Position (“FSP”) Financial Accounting Standard (“FAS”) 106-1,  
“Accounting and Disclosure Requirements Related to the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act of  
2003”, Nortel Networks chose to make the one-time deferral election which remained in effect for its plans in the U.S. until the  
earlier of the issuance of specific authoritative guidance by the FASB on how to account for the federal subsidy to be provided  
to plan sponsors under the MPDIM Act, or the remeasurement of plan assets and obligations subsequent to January 31, 2004.  
Therefore, Nortel Networks post-retirement benefit obligation as of December 31, 2003 and net post-retirement benefit cost for  
the year ended December 31, 2003 did not reflect the effects of the MPDIM Act on the plans. On May 19, 2004, FSP FAS 106-  
2, “Accounting and Disclosure Requirements Related to the Medicare Prescription Drug, Improvement and Modernization Act  
of 2003” (“FSP FAS 106-2”) was issued by the FASB to provide guidance relating to the prescription drug subsidy provided by  
the MPDIM Act. Nortel Networks expects to have portions of its post-retirement benefit plans qualify as actuarially equivalent  
to the benefit provided under the MPDIM Act, for which it expects to receive federal subsidies. Nortel Networks expects that  
other portions of the plans will not be actuarially equivalent. The financial impact of the federal subsidies was determined by  
remeasuring Nortel Networks retiree life and medical obligation as of January 1, 2004, as provided under the retroactive  
application provision of FSP FAS 106-2. The effective date of FSP FAS 106-2 is the first annual or interim period beginning  
after June 15, 2004, with earlier adoption encouraged. Nortel Networks adopted FSP FAS 106-2 for the three-month period  
ended June 30, 2004. As a result of adoption, the accrued post-retirement benefit obligation decreased by $31. Net periodic  
post-retirement benefit costs are expected to decrease by $2 for 2004, as a result of the subsidy.  
(ii) In March 2004, the EITF reached consensus on Issue No. 03-1, “The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its  
Application to Certain Investments” (“EITF 03-1”). EITF 03-1 provides guidance on determining when an investment is  
considered impaired, whether that impairment is other than temporary and the measurement of an impairment loss. EITF 03-1  
is applicable to marketable debt and equity securities within the scope of SFAS No. 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments  
in Debt and Equity Securities” (“SFAS 115”), and SFAS No. 124, “Accounting for Certain Investments Held by Not-for-Profit  
Organizations”, and equity securities that are not subject to the scope of SFAS 115 and not accounted for under the equity  
method of accounting. In September 2004, the FASB issued FSP EITF 03-1-1, “Effective Date of Paragraphs 10-20 of EITF  
Issue No. 03-1, “The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its Application to Certain Investments””, which  
delays the effective date for the measurement and recognition criteria contained in EITF 03-1 until final application guidance is  
issued. The delay does not suspend the requirement to recognize other-than-temporary impairments as required by existing  
authoritative literature. The adoption of EITF 03-1 is not expected to have a material impact on Nortel Networks results of  
operations and financial position.  
(iii) On September 30, 2004, the EITF reached a consensus on Issue No. 04-8, “The Effect of Contingently Convertible Debt on  
Diluted Earnings Per Share” (“EITF 04-8”), which addresses when the dilutive effect of contingently convertible debt  
instruments should be included in diluted earnings (loss) per share. EITF 04-8 requires that contingently convertible debt  
instruments be included in the computation of diluted earnings (loss) per share regardless of whether the market price trigger  
has been met. EITF 04-8 also requires that prior period diluted earnings (loss) per share amounts presented for comparative  
purposes be restated. EITF 04-8 is effective for reporting periods ending after December 15, 2004. The adoption of EITF 04-8  
is not expected to have an impact on Nortel Networks diluted earnings (loss) per share.  
Comparative figures  
Certain 2002 and 2001 figures in the consolidated financial statements have been reclassified to conform to the 2003 presentation and  
have been restated as set out in note 3.  
F-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Restatement  
First Restatement  
In May 2003, Nortel Networks commenced certain balance sheet reviews at the direction of certain members of former management that  
led to a comprehensive review and analysis of its assets and liabilities (the “Comprehensive Review”), which resulted in the restatement  
(effected in December 2003) of its consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2002, 2001 and 2000 and for the  
quarters ended March 31, 2003 and June 30, 2003 (the “First Restatement”).  
The Comprehensive Review purported to (i) identify balance sheet accounts that, as of June 30, 2003, were not supportable and required  
adjustment; (ii) determine whether such adjustments related to the third quarter of 2003 or prior periods and (iii) document certain  
account balances in accordance with Nortel Networks accounting policies and procedures. The Comprehensive Review as supplemented  
by additional procedures carried out between July 2003 and November 2003 to quantify the effects of potential adjustments in the  
relevant periods and review the appropriateness of releases of certain contractual liability and other related provisions (also called  
accruals, reserves or accrued liabilities) in the six fiscal quarters ending with the fiscal quarter ended June 30, 2003 formed the basis for  
the adjustments made to the financial statements in the First Restatement.  
On December 23, 2003, Nortel Networks filed with the SEC an amended Annual Report on Form 10-K/A for the year ended  
December 31, 2002 (the “2002 Form 10-K/A”) and amended Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q/A for the first and second quarters of 2003  
(the “2003 Form 10-Q/As”) reflecting the First Restatement. As disclosed in those reports, the net effect of the First Restatement  
adjustments was a reduction in accumulated deficit of $497, $178 and $31 as of December 31, 2002, 2001 and 2000, respectively.  
Second Restatement  
In late October 2003, the Audit Committee of Nortel Networks and NNL’s Boards of Directors (the “Audit Committee”) initiated an  
independent review of the facts and circumstances leading to the First Restatement (the “Independent Review”) and engaged the law firm  
now known as Wilmer Cutler Pickering Hale & Dorr LLP (“WCPHD”) to advise it in connection with the Independent Review. The  
Audit Committee sought to gain a full understanding of the events that caused significant excess liabilities to be maintained on the  
balance sheet that needed to be restated, and to recommend that the Board adopt, and direct management to implement, necessary  
remedial measures to address personnel, controls, compliance and discipline. The Independent Review focused initially on events relating  
to the establishment and release of contractual liability and other related provisions in the second half of 2002 and the first half of 2003,  
including the involvement of senior corporate leadership. As the Independent Review evolved, its focus broadened to include specific  
provisioning activities in each of the business units and geographic regions. In light of concerns raised in the initial phase of the  
Independent Review, the Audit Committee expanded the review to include provisioning activities in the third and fourth quarters of 2003.  
As the Independent Review progressed, the Audit Committee directed new corporate management to examine in depth the concerns  
identified by WCPHD regarding provisioning activity and to review provision releases in each of the four quarters of 2003, down to a  
low threshold. That examination, and other errors identified by management, led to the restatement of Nortel Networks consolidated  
financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001 and the quarters ended March 31, 2003 and 2002, June 30, 2003  
and 2002 and September 30, 2003 and 2002 (the “Second Restatement”).  
Over the course of the Second Restatement process, management also identified certain accounting practices that it determined should be  
adjusted as part of the Second Restatement. In particular, management identified certain errors related to revenue recognition and  
undertook a process of revenue reviews. In light of the resulting adjustments to revenues previously reported, the Audit Committee has  
determined to review the facts and circumstances leading to the restatement of these revenues for specific transactions identified in the  
Second Restatement. This review will have a particular emphasis on the underlying conduct that led to the initial recognition of these  
revenues. Other accounting practices that management examined and adjusted as part of the Second Restatement included, among other  
things, the following:  
Nortel Networks foreign exchange accounting as part of management’s plan to address an identified material weakness related  
to foreign currency translation;  
intercompany balances that did not eliminate upon consolidation and related provisions;  
the accounting treatment of the February 2001 acquisition of the 980 NPLC business from JDS Uniphase Corporation (“JDS”)  
and the related OEM Purchase and Sale Agreement;  
special charges relating to goodwill, inventory impairment, contract settlement costs and other charges; and  
the accounting treatment of certain elements of discontinued operations.  
Due to, among other factors, significant turnover in Nortel Networks finance personnel, changes in accounting systems, documentation  
weaknesses, and identified material weaknesses in internal control over financial reporting, the Second Restatement involved hundreds of  
Nortel Networks finance personnel and a number of outside consultants and advisors. The process required the review and verification of  
a substantial number of documents and  
F-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
communications and related accounting entries over multiple fiscal periods. In addition, the review of accruals and provisions and the  
application of accounting literature to certain matters in the Second Restatement, including revenue recognition, foreign exchange,  
special charges and discontinued operations, was complicated by the passage of time, lack of availability of supporting records and the  
turnover of finance personnel. As a result of this complexity, estimates and assumptions that impact both the quantum of the various  
recorded adjustments and the fiscal period to which they were attributed were required in the determination of certain of the Second  
Restatement adjustments. Nortel Networks believes the procedures followed in determining such estimates were appropriate and  
reasonable using the best available information.  
The following tables present the impact of the Second Restatement adjustments on Nortel Networks previously reported consolidated  
statements of operations and a summary of the adjustments from the Second Restatement for the years ended December 31, 2002 and  
2001. The Second Restatement adjustments related primarily to the following items, each of which reflect a number of related  
adjustments that have been aggregated for disclosure purposes, and are described in the paragraphs following the tables below:  
Revenues and cost of revenues;  
Foreign exchange;  
Intercompany balances;  
Special charges;  
Other;  
Reclassifications; and  
Discontinued operations.  
F-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consolidated Statement of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2002  
As previously  
reported  
Adjustments  
As restated  
Revenues  
Cost of revenues  
$
10,569  
6,798  
$
439  
305  
$
11,008  
7,103  
Gross profit  
3,771  
134  
3,905  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Amortization of acquired technology and other  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges  
2,636  
2,208  
157  
(83)  
(125)  
2,553  
2,083  
157  
87  
23  
110  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
595  
1,578  
(55)  
(78)  
34  
595  
1,500  
(21)  
Operating earnings (loss)  
(3,435)  
(30)  
363  
25  
(3,072)  
(5)  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense  
Long-term debt  
Other  
(215)  
(41)  
(5)  
(11)  
(220)  
(52)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of associated  
companies  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
(3,721)  
453  
372  
15  
(3,349)  
468  
(3,268)  
387  
5
(2,881)  
5
Minority interests — net of tax  
Equity in net loss of associated companies — net of tax  
(18)  
1
(17)  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
(3,286)  
20  
393  
(121)  
(2,893)  
(101)  
Net earnings (loss)  
$
(3,266)  
$
272  
$
(2,994)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
$
$
(0.86)  
0.01  
$
$
0.11  
(0.04)  
$
$
(0.75)  
(0.03)  
— from discontinued operations  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
(0.85)  
0.07  
(0.78)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
$
$
(0.86)  
0.01  
$
$
0.11  
(0.04)  
$
$
(0.75)  
(0.03)  
— from discontinued operations  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
(0.85)  
0.07  
(0.78)  
F-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Summary of Restatement Adjustments for the year ended December 31, 2002:  
Revenues  
and cost of  
revenues  
Inter-  
company  
balances  
Dis-  
continued  
operations  
Foreign  
exchange  
Special  
charges  
Reclassifi-  
cations  
Total  
adjustments  
Other  
Revenues  
Cost of revenues  
$
442  
153  
$
(3)  
(51)  
$
(16)  
$
237  
$
(64)  
$
46  
$
$
439  
305  
Gross profit  
289  
48  
16  
(237)  
64  
(46)  
134  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges — other special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense — long term debt  
Interest expense — other  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
Minority interests — net of tax  
(1)  
(14)  
3
3
24  
(78)  
(115)  
(89)  
33  
(22)  
(1)  
38  
115  
(21)  
(83)  
(125)  
23  
(78)  
34  
25  
(5)  
(11)  
15  
5
(4)  
19  
(5)  
(14)  
15  
26  
1
(112)  
Equity in net loss of associated companies — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
1
(121)  
(121)  
Total restatement adjustments  
$
289  
$
(63)  
$
36  
$
(183)  
$ 314  
$
$
(121)  
$
272  
F-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consolidated Statement of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2001  
As previously  
reported  
Adjustments  
As restated  
Revenues  
Cost of revenues  
$
17,408  
14,014  
$
1,492  
598  
$
18,900  
14,612  
Gross profit  
3,394  
894  
4,288  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
In-process research and development expense  
Amortization of intangibles  
Acquired technology and other  
Goodwill  
5,809  
3,202  
15  
302  
(86)  
6,111  
3,116  
15  
806  
4,149  
109  
(91)  
139  
806  
4,058  
248  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
12,121  
3,540  
112  
(695)  
(150)  
26  
11,426  
3,390  
138  
Operating earnings (loss)  
(26,469)  
(388)  
1,449  
(118)  
(25,020)  
(506)  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense  
Long-term debt  
Other  
(204)  
(115)  
(4)  
12  
(208)  
(103)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of associated  
companies  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
(27,176)  
3,152  
1,339  
(401)  
(25,837)  
2,751  
(24,024)  
938  
(34)  
(23,086)  
(34)  
Minority interests — net of tax  
Equity in net loss of associated companies — net of tax  
(150)  
(150)  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
(24,174)  
(2,996)  
904  
529  
(23,270)  
(2,467)  
Net earnings (loss) before cumulative effect of accounting changes  
Cumulative effect of accounting change — net of tax  
(27,170)  
15  
1,433  
(25,737)  
15  
Net earnings (loss)  
$
(27,155)  
$
1,433  
$
(25,722)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
(7.58)  
(0.94)  
$
$
0.28  
0.16  
$
$
(7.30)  
(0.78)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
(8.52)  
0.44  
(8.08)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
(7.58)  
(0.94)  
$
$
0.28  
0.16  
$
$
(7.30)  
(0.78)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
(8.52)  
0.44  
(8.08)  
F-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Summary of Restatement Adjustments for the year ended December 31, 2001:  
Revenues  
and cost of  
revenues  
Inter-  
company  
balances  
Dis-  
continued  
operations  
Foreign  
exchange  
Special  
charges  
Reclassifi-  
cations  
Total  
adjustments  
Other  
Revenues  
Cost of revenues  
$
1,534  
522  
$
(42)  
(73)  
$
45  
$
152  
$
(88)  
$
40  
$
$
1,492  
598  
Gross profit  
1,012  
31  
(45)  
(152)  
88  
(40)  
894  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Amortization of intangibles — goodwill  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges  
(31)  
42  
(27)  
(91)  
123  
(233)  
(54)  
(12)  
(5)  
536  
302  
(86)  
(91)  
139  
16  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
8
10  
(695)  
(150)  
(3)  
(22)  
(4)  
2
29  
90  
(22)  
(695)  
(150)  
26  
(118)  
(4)  
12  
(401)  
(34)  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense — long term debt  
Interest expense — other  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
Minority interests — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss) from  
(194)  
(401)  
(12)  
discontinued operations — net of tax  
529  
529  
Total restatement adjustments  
$
1,012  
$
(132)  
$
(42)  
$
661  
$ (59)  
$
$
(7)  
$
1,433  
Additionally, the cumulative effect of the Second Restatement adjustments was a (decrease) increase to additional paid-in capital, deferred  
stock option compensation, accumulated deficit and accumulated other comprehensive loss as of January 1, 2001, as previously reported, of  
$(10), $56, $1,432 and $(189), respectively. The effect of the Second Restatement adjustments on the consolidated balance sheet as of  
December 31, 2002 is shown following the discussion below.  
Revenues and cost of revenues  
Revenues and cost of revenues were impacted by various errors related to revenue recognition, corrections to foreign exchange accounting,  
intercompany related items, special charges and other adjustments, including financial statement reclassifications. These items are further  
described below. The net impact to revenues of the adjustments was an increase of $439 and $1,492 for the years ended December 31, 2002  
and 2001, respectively. The net impact to cost of revenues related to these revenue adjustments, and the other corrections was an increase of  
$305 and $598 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. The following table summarizes the revenue recognition  
adjustments and other adjustments to revenues and cost of revenues, which increased gross profit by $134 and increased gross profit by $894  
for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively:  
F-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Revenues  
2002  
Cost of revenues  
2002  
2001  
2001  
Revenue recognition adjustments:  
Application of SAB 101 or SOP 97-2  
Title and delivery  
Undelivered elements and liquidated damages  
Fixed or determinable fees  
Reseller transactions  
Other revenue recognition adjustments  
$
211  
45  
133  
$
1,624  
(190)  
151  
(51)  
$
107  
117  
(71)  
$
727  
(231)  
83  
(57)  
53  
Increase associated with revenue recognition adjustments  
442  
1,534  
153  
522  
Other adjustments:  
Foreign exchange  
Intercompany  
Special charges  
Other  
(3)  
(42)  
(51)  
(16)  
237  
(64)  
46  
(73)  
45  
152  
(88)  
40  
Reclassifications  
Total increase to revenues and cost of revenues  
$
439  
$
1,492  
$
305  
$
598  
Application of SAB 101 or SOP 97-2  
Title and delivery  
Revenues were recognized on certain sales (primarily prior to 2001) for which it was subsequently determined that the criteria for revenue  
recognition under SAB 101 or SOP 97-2, as applicable, had not been met, including arrangements in which legal title or risk of loss on  
products did not transfer to the buyer until full payment was received, and arrangements where delivery had not occurred. Revenues and related  
cost of revenues for these agreements should have been deferred until title or risk of loss had passed and all criteria for revenue recognition had  
been met. Therefore, adjustments were made to defer revenues and related cost of revenues from the periods in which they were originally  
recorded and to recognize them in the periods in which all revenue recognition criteria were met.  
Undelivered elements and liquidated damages  
In certain multiple element arrangements, total arrangement fees were recognized as revenue at the time of delivery of software or hardware,  
but prior to the delivery of future contractual or implicit PCS or other services. Revenues should have been allocated to these future  
deliverables based on their fair value and recognized ratably over the PCS period or as the future obligations were performed. As well, in  
certain circumstances where the criteria to treat delivered software and hardware elements and undelivered PCS services as separate accounting  
units were not met, the entire arrangement fee should have been recognized over the PCS period. Adjustments were made to appropriately  
allocate revenue among the accounting units and recognize the allocated revenue in accordance with the applicable revenue recognition  
guidance.  
Revenues were also recognized for certain contracts that involved undelivered elements as a result of product development delays. The lack of  
relative fair value for the undelivered element meant that revenues and cost of revenues for all products delivered should have been deferred  
until the undelivered element was delivered. As originally recorded, revenues were recognized upon delivery of an alternative product and  
costs were accrued for the undelivered element. To correct for these items, related cost provisions were reversed and revenues and associated  
cost of revenues were recognized in the appropriate periods when all elements had been delivered.  
Revenues were recognized on certain contracts with potential liquidated damages arising primarily from network outages, shipment delays or  
product development delays on undelivered elements. Generally, revenues and related cost of revenues should have been deferred up to the  
maximum potential liquidated damages until the damages had been incurred or there was no longer a possibility of incurring such damages.  
Specific contracts, primarily in the Asia region, had the potential for liquidated damages plus right of return privileges if such damages  
exceeded contractually defined thresholds due to a product development delay (undelivered element). Revenues for all products delivered  
should have been deferred until the undelivered element was delivered. After delivery of the undelivered element, and in light of a lack of a  
reasonable and reliable history of comparable product returns on which to base a returns allowance, revenues should have been deferred until  
the right of return had lapsed or until expected returns could be reasonably estimated. After the right of return had lapsed or reasonable  
estimates of expected returns could be made, revenues should have  
F-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
continued to be deferred up to the amount of the maximum potential liquidated damages until either the earlier of when the damages were  
incurred, or there was no longer the possibility of incurring any damages. As originally recorded, cost provisions were recorded for the  
amount of the estimated damages and/or cost of product replacement. To correct these items, related cost provisions were reversed and  
revenues and associated cost of revenues were recognized in the appropriate periods.  
Fixed or determinable fees  
Revenues were recognized on certain sales for which it was subsequently determined that the criteria for revenue recognition under SOP  
97-2 had not been met, including arrangements in which the criteria for fixed or determinable fees was not met. Revenues and related  
cost of revenues for these agreements were deferred to later periods when payments became due and all criteria for revenue recognition  
had been met.  
Reseller transactions  
Prior to 2001, revenues were recognized upon product delivery to a certain reseller who lacked economic substance apart from Nortel  
Networks. Revenue should have been deferred and only recognized by Nortel Networks upon sale by the reseller to an end customer.  
Correction of this resulted in revenues and cost of revenues being deferred with ultimate recognition in 2001.  
Other revenue recognition adjustments  
Other adjustments included corrections related to an overstatement of revenues and cost of revenues related to a specific contract in the  
Caribbean and Latin American (“CALA”) region, two specific transactions recorded in the first quarter of 2003 which should have been  
recorded in 2002, a specific contract with a reciprocal arrangement that should have been treated as a reduction of revenues and therefore  
the revenues recorded in 2001 have been reversed, errors in the application of percentage-of-completion accounting for certain contracts,  
other errors related to non-cash incentives and concessions provided to customers and other calculation errors.  
Foreign exchange  
As part of the plan to address a material weakness reported in Nortel Networks Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended  
September 30, 2003, a review of foreign exchange accounting was undertaken. The net impact was an increase to pre-tax loss of $63 and  
$132 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. The following presents the impact of these restatement adjustments  
on the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31, which are described below:  
2002  
2001  
Gross profit  
Presentation errors  
Other errors  
$
$
42  
6
$
$
31  
Total increase to gross profit  
48  
31  
Operating expenses  
Presentation errors  
$
$
(1)  
$
$
(31)  
(31)  
Total decrease to operating expenses  
(1)  
Other expense  
Functional currency designation  
Intercompany transaction designation  
Presentation errors  
$
87  
(43)  
43  
$
133  
14  
62  
Other errors  
25  
(15)  
Total increase to other expense  
Total increase to pre-tax loss  
$
$
112  
63  
$
$
194  
132  
Presentation errors  
F-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For a period of six consecutive quarters ended June 30, 2002, foreign exchange gains or losses were recorded to various components of  
the consolidated statements of operations rather than as part of other income (expense) — net. This presentation has been adjusted with  
no effect on net earnings (loss) in any period.  
Functional currency designation  
The determination of the functional currency for certain entities was re-examined, based on the guidance under SFAS No. 52, “Foreign  
Currency Translation” (“SFAS 52”). As a result, Nortel Networks identified four instances in which the functional currency designation  
of an entity was incorrect. These revisions resulted in increases or decreases to other income (expense) — net.  
Intercompany transaction designation  
Nortel Networks identified two instances of incorrect treatment of significant foreign currency translation gains and losses arising from  
intercompany positions. Under SFAS 52, intercompany foreign currency transactions that were long-term in nature should have been  
recorded in accumulated other comprehensive loss on the balance sheet when translated rather than recorded as a transactional gain or  
loss in the statement of operations. The net impact of the adjustments was an increase or decrease to other income (expense) — net, with  
an offset to accumulated other comprehensive loss.  
Other errors  
Other errors identified were related to translation of foreign denominated intercompany transactions, revaluation of certain foreign  
denominated intercompany transactions and accounting for mark-to-market adjustments for foreign exchange contracts as required under  
SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities” (“SFAS 133”).  
Intercompany balances  
Historically, Nortel Networks had certain intercompany balances that did not eliminate upon consolidation (“out-of-balance positions”),  
and provisions had been recorded accordingly. As part of the Second Restatement, Nortel Networks reviewed these provisions and  
determined that they should not have been recorded. Adjustments were recorded in the appropriate periods to reverse these provisions  
and to correct the significant out-of-balance positions. The adjustments to reverse the provisions affected the second quarter of 2003 and  
periods prior to 2000. The net impact of the adjustments to correct the significant out-of-balance positions was a decrease of $36 and an  
increase of $42 to the previously reported pre-tax loss for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Special charges  
As part of the Second Restatement, the components of special charges were re-examined and decreases to special charges of $78 and  
$845 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively, were recorded. The following table summarizes the adjustments,  
which are discussed below:  
2002  
2001  
Goodwill impairment  
980 NPLC business acquisition  
Other acquisitions  
$
$
$
$
$
$
473  
222  
Total decrease from goodwill impairment  
695  
Other special charges  
Inventory impairment reclassification  
Other adjustments  
89  
(11)  
150  
Total decrease other special charges  
Total decrease to special charges  
$
$
78  
78  
$
$
150  
845  
Goodwill impairment — 980 NPLC business acquisition  
As a result of issues raised in connection with the Independent Review, the accounting for the deferred consideration associated with the  
acquisition of the JDS Zurich, Switzerland based subsidiary and related assets in Poughkeepsie, New York (the “980 NPLC business”)  
from JDS (the “Purchase Agreement”) and the related OEM Purchase and Sale Agreement (the “OEM Agreement”) in February 2001  
was re-examined as part of the Second Restatement. The  
F-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
purchase price was originally recorded as $2,818, payable in common shares of Nortel Networks, $2,318 of which was delivered upon  
closing and $500 of which was deferred. The deferred consideration could be reduced to zero if Nortel Networks met certain performance  
criteria under the OEM Agreement. The original accounting assumed the Purchase Agreement and the OEM Agreement were two  
transactions with separate economic value. As a result, the deferred consideration was included in the purchase price of the 980 NPLC  
business and any reduction in the deferred consideration over time was reflected as a reduction of cost of revenues.  
Based on the re-examination, Nortel Networks has determined that it lacks sufficient independent evidence of the fair value of the OEM  
Agreement to record the Purchase Agreement and the OEM Agreement as separate transactions. Accordingly, as part of the Second  
Restatement, Nortel Networks revised the accounting for the Purchase Agreement and the OEM Agreement. The assets acquired from  
JDS have been valued based on the value of the consideration issued in accordance with the guidance in APB Opinion No. 16, “Business  
Combinations”; no value has now been attributed to the deferred consideration at the date of the acquisition and no purchase discounts  
have been subsequently recognized. Therefore, the purchase price and, as a result, the amount allocated to goodwill have been reduced by  
$500. The purchase price and the amount allocated to goodwill were further reduced by $25 for an unrelated correction to the liabilities  
assumed at acquisition. These reductions in the amount allocated to goodwill reduced the goodwill impairment subsequently recorded in  
June 2001 by $473 and reduced the amount of goodwill amortization for the year ended December 31, 2001 by $52. Other impacts  
included an increase to cost of revenues (reversing the previous reductions for purchase discounts) of $148 and $152 for the years ended  
December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively, with corresponding reversals of these amounts which were previously recorded against  
common shares.  
Goodwill impairment — other acquisitions  
As part of the Second Restatement, a review of the accounting for various other acquisitions determined that adjustments were required  
to the amounts allocated to goodwill as a result of the corrections to purchase accounting allocations, and to correct valuations of the  
consideration paid. The adjustments related to purchase accounting allocations were as a result of the incorrect calculation of the  
valuation of deferred compensation on the acquisitions of Alteon WebSystems Inc. (“Alteon”) and CoreTek Inc. (“CoreTek”). In  
addition, Nortel Networks determined that it had incorrectly calculated the amount of consideration paid in the acquisition of CoreTek  
due to inappropriate measurement dates for valuing the equity instruments issued. The reductions in the amounts allocated to goodwill  
reduced the goodwill impairment that was subsequently recorded in June 2001 by $222, and reduced the amount of goodwill amortization  
for the year ended December 31, 2001 by $39. Other impacts included an increase to deferred stock option compensation expense of $24  
and $123 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Other special charges  
As part of the Second Restatement, inventory impairments of $89 previously incorrectly classified as special charges in the year ended  
December 31, 2002 were reclassified to cost of revenues. Also impacting special charges were adjustments for restructuring related to  
contract settlement costs, including real estate related items, severance and fringe benefit related costs and plant and equipment  
impairment costs. Nortel Networks determined that these items were either recorded in special charges in error or, although correctly  
recorded when originally recognized, were not adjusted in the appropriate subsequent periods for changes in estimates and/or  
assumptions. The adjustments to special charges for these other items were an increase of $11 and a decrease of $150 for the years ended  
December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. The following presents the impact of these other adjustments on special charges for the years  
ended December 31:  
2002  
2001  
Other adjustments  
Contract settlement costs  
Severance and fringe benefit related costs  
Plant and equipment impairment costs  
$
$
36  
(21)  
(4)  
$
$
(85)  
(35)  
(30)  
Increase (decrease) to special charges  
11  
(150)  
Other  
Other adjustments were primarily to correct certain accruals, provisions or other transactions which were either initially recorded  
incorrectly in prior periods, or not properly released or adjusted for changes in estimates and/or assumptions in the appropriate  
subsequent periods. The components of these adjustments are described below.  
F-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2002  
2001  
Other adjustments  
Cost of revenues  
$
64  
115  
89  
4
19  
(19)  
15  
26  
1
$
88  
233  
54  
3
(22)  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
Minority interests — net of tax  
Equity in net loss of associated companies — net of tax  
(2)  
(401)  
(12)  
Decrease (increase) to net loss  
$
314  
$
(59)  
Cost of revenues  
For the year ended December 31, 2002, the decrease to cost of revenues of $64 was comprised primarily of reductions of approximately  
$43 to inventory provisions and related accruals (such as accounts payable and contract manufacturer related accruals, including  
approximately $39 for a correction to the accounting for a spares inventory management program which should have been treated as  
warranty costs), approximately $19 decrease related to customer and contract related accruals and other accruals for such items as  
vacation and fringe benefits, partially offset by an increase of approximately $15 for warranty costs.  
For the year ended December 31, 2001, the decrease to cost of revenues of $88 was comprised primarily of reductions of approximately  
$84 to contract and customer related accruals and approximately $72 for inventory provisions and related accruals (such as accounts  
payable and contract manufacturer related accruals, including approximately $16 for correction to the accounting for a spares inventory  
management program which should have been treated as warranty costs), partially offset by increases of approximately $53 for warranty  
costs and approximately $14 for a correction to the accounting for retention bonuses associated with an acquisition.  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
For the year ended December 31, 2002, the decrease of $115 to selling, general and administrative expense was comprised primarily of  
reductions of approximately $45 related to contract amendments and settlements with certain service providers, approximately $30 for  
salary and fringe benefit related accruals, approximately $29 from the reversal of rent expense associated with certain facilities for  
corrections to accounting for sale-leaseback transactions, approximately $13 related to the capitalization of certain software development  
costs under SOP 98-1, “Accounting for Software Development Costs”, and decreases to other accruals, partially offset by a net increase  
of $19 in bad debt expense.  
For the year ended December 31, 2001, the decrease of $233 to selling, general and administrative expense was comprised primarily of  
reductions of approximately $88 from the reversal of bad debt expense related to revenue and receivables that had been reversed as part  
of the Second Restatement, approximately $52 from adjustments to customer and contractual accruals, approximately $41 for the reversal  
of items previously expensed related to reciprocal agreements with customers (the offset was a reduction to revenues primarily in prior  
periods), approximately $30 related to contract amendments and settlements with certain service providers and decreases to other  
accruals.  
Research and development expense  
For the year ended December 31, 2002, the decrease of $89 in research and development expense was primarily the result of a decrease  
of approximately $68 to correctly treat certain software repair costs as warranty costs, reductions to accruals related to various research  
and development projects and to other accruals for such items as vacation and fringe benefits.  
For the year ended December 31, 2001, the decrease of $54 in research and development expense was primarily the result of a decrease  
of approximately $36 to correctly treat certain software repair costs as warranty costs, reductions to accruals related to various research  
and development projects and to other accruals for such items as vacation and fringe benefits.  
F-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other income (expense) — net  
For the year ended December 31, 2002, the decrease of $19 in other expense was primarily the result of a $10 reversal of an item  
previously expensed related to a reciprocal agreement (offset by a reduction to revenues in a prior period), a $9 decrease from corrections  
to interest rate swaps relating to debt buybacks and the reduction to other accruals totaling $38, partially offset by a $20 increase from  
adjustments to the recognition of income and expense associated with sales of receivables and an $18 increase from corrections to the  
timing of the recognition of impairment of investments.  
For the year ended December 31, 2001, the $22 increase to other expense was primarily the result of adjustments of approximately $40  
for the recognition of the income and expense associated with the sale of receivables, partially offset by decreases to other accruals.  
Interest expense  
For the year ended December 31, 2002, the increase to interest expense of $19 was primarily the result of a $32 increase related to long-  
term debt for corrections to accounting for certain sale-leaseback transactions, partially offset by a $13 decrease from adjustments to the  
timing of the recognition of costs associated with sales of receivables and customer financing.  
For the year ended December 31, 2001, the increase to interest expense of $2 was primarily the result of a $10 increase related to long-  
term debt recognized on certain sale-leaseback transactions, partially offset by a $4 decrease from adjustments to the timing of the  
recognition of costs associated with sales of receivables and customer financing.  
Income taxes and minority interests  
Income tax benefit and minority interests were also adjusted as part of the Second Restatement. The adjustment to income tax benefit,  
substantially all as a result of the Second Restatement adjustments, was an increase of $15 and a decrease of $401 for the years ended  
December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. In addition to the reclassifications noted below, the adjustment to minority interests as a  
result of the Second Restatement adjustments was an increase of $26 and a decrease of $12 for the years ended December 31, 2002 and  
2001, respectively.  
Reclassifications  
As a result of the restatement process, various presentation inconsistencies were identified. Adjustments were made to appropriately  
reflect certain items in the consolidated statements of operations. The reclassifications were made for royalty expense, (gain) loss on sale  
of businesses and assets, minority interest — net of tax (now reported separately), and other items including certain functional spending  
and specific expenses. The amounts that were reclassified for the years ended December 31 are detailed below:  
F-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Royalty  
expense  
Disposal  
of assets  
Minority  
interests  
Other  
Total  
2002 Reclassifications  
Cost of revenues  
$
49  
(49)  
$
7
$
(21)  
21  
$
(10)  
33  
(22)  
(1)  
$
46  
33  
(22)  
(1)  
38  
(115)  
21  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Deferred stock option compensation  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
Other expense  
38  
(45)  
Minority interests — net of tax  
Net impact of reclassifications  
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
$
2001 Reclassifications  
Cost of revenues  
59  
(20)  
1
(12)  
(5)  
16  
40  
(12)  
(5)  
16  
29  
(90)  
22  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Deferred stock option compensation  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
Other expense  
29  
(9)  
(59)  
(22)  
22  
Minority interests — net of tax  
Net impact of reclassifications  
$
$
$
$
$
Discontinued operations  
As a result of the restatement process, the initial provision for loss on disposal of the access solutions discontinued operations recorded in  
June 2001, and the subsequent activity during 2001 through 2004 were re-examined. Nortel Networks concluded that the net loss on  
disposal of operations recognized in the second quarter of 2001 was overstated. In addition, other adjustments were necessary to correct  
certain items that were either initially recorded incorrectly, or not properly released or adjusted for changes in estimates in the appropriate  
periods subsequent to the second quarter of 2001. The net impact of all of these changes was an increase of $121 and a decrease of $529  
to net loss from discontinued operations — net of tax for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively, as follows:  
2002  
2001  
Decrease to net loss on disposal of operations  
Items that should have been charged to continuing operations  
Overstatement of accruals  
Investment impairments  
Tax effect on the above  
$
$
$
520  
438  
41  
(261)  
Decrease to net loss on disposal of operations — net of tax  
Other adjustments  
738  
(209)  
(121)  
Decrease (increase) to the net loss from discontinued operations — net of tax  
$
(121)  
529  
Decrease to net loss on disposal of operations — net of tax  
The components of the decrease to the initial loss on disposal of operations recorded in the second quarter of 2001 were as follows:  
a $520 decrease for contingent liabilities and customer financing provisions that should have been charged to continuing operations  
rather than discontinued operations;  
a $438 decrease to accruals for contingent liabilities and for other contingencies that did not meet the definition of a liability under  
SFAS No. 5, “Accounting for Contingencies”, when initially recorded;  
a $41 decrease for investment impairments that should have been charged to the net loss from discontinued operations rather than  
the net loss on disposal of operations; and  
the tax effect on the above of $261.  
F-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other adjustments  
In periods subsequent to the second quarter of 2001, adjustments were necessary to record gains and losses from the reassessment of the  
remaining discontinued operations provisions in net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations, in accordance with APB No. 30,  
“Reporting the Results of Operations — Reporting the Effects of Disposal of a Segment of a Business, and Extraordinary, Unusual and  
Infrequently Occurring Events and Transactions” (“APB 30”). These adjustments, which included gains and losses arising from  
divestitures of the access solutions assets, were previously recorded as an increase or decrease to the estimated remaining provisions for  
discontinued operations on the consolidated balance sheets. In the Second Restatement, these adjustments were appropriately recorded in  
net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax in the period they occurred.  
For the year ended December 31, 2002, these adjustments increased the net loss from discontinued operations by approximately $121.  
This consisted primarily of $206 for additional customer financing provisions, partially offset by the release of $51 due to changes in  
estimates for other provisions, and an increase to the income tax recovery of $16.  
For the balance of the year ended December 31, 2001, the adjustments increased the net loss from discontinued operations by  
approximately $209. This consisted primarily of $223 for additional provisions related to the discontinued operations, and $126 for  
equity losses and impairment charges on investments, partially offset by $104 due to the reversal of a provision originally recorded in  
error related to an investment interest, $16 for contingent liabilities that should have been charged to continuing operations, and $15 for  
gross margin impacts resulting from revenue recognition adjustments as detailed above.  
Balance sheet  
The following table presents the impact of the Second Restatement adjustments on Nortel Networks previously reported consolidated  
balance sheet as of December 31, 2002. The impact on inventories — net and various liabilities, including deferred revenue, was  
primarily due to the adjustments to revenues and cost of revenues described above. The adjustments to plant and equipment — net and  
long-term debt primarily related to corrections to the accounting for certain sale-leaseback transactions. In addition, there were  
reclassifications resulting from the restatement adjustments and to conform to the 2003 presentation in the consolidated balance sheet.  
F-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consolidated Balance Sheet as of December 31, 2002  
As previously  
reported  
Adjustments  
As restated  
ASSETS  
Current assets  
Cash and cash equivalents  
Restricted cash and cash equivalents  
Accounts receivable — net  
Inventories — net  
Income taxes recoverable  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other current assets  
$
3,791  
249  
2,163  
986  
58  
$
(1)  
65  
520  
56  
$
3,790  
249  
2,228  
1,506  
114  
790  
681  
790  
650  
(31)  
8,718  
609  
9,327  
Total current assets  
Investments  
Plant and equipment — net  
Goodwill  
Intangible assets — net  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other assets  
248  
1,467  
2,201  
139  
2,579  
761  
(11)  
225  
(2)  
3
24  
237  
1,692  
2,199  
139  
2,582  
785  
$
$
16,113  
$
$
848  
$
$
16,961  
Total assets  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Current liabilities  
Notes payable  
Trade and other accounts payable  
Payroll and benefit-related liabilities  
Contractual liabilities  
Restructuring  
Other accrued liabilities  
Long-term debt due within one year  
30  
872  
507  
1,215  
548  
2,974  
233  
(69)  
(22)  
(321)  
(41)  
283  
10  
30  
803  
485  
894  
507  
3,257  
243  
6,379  
(160)  
6,219  
Total current liabilities  
Long-term debt  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other liabilities  
3,749  
345  
2,323  
211  
(8)  
438  
3,960  
337  
2,761  
12,796  
665  
481  
13,277  
631  
Total liabilities  
Minority interests in subsidiary companies  
(34)  
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Common shares, without par value  
Additional paid-in capital  
33,583  
3,754  
(349)  
(1)  
33,234  
3,753  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Accumulated deficit  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss  
(91)  
(33,239)  
(1,355)  
74  
273  
404  
(17)  
(32,966)  
(951)  
2,652  
401  
848  
3,053  
Total shareholders’ equity  
$
16,113  
$
$
16,961  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity  
4. Accounting changes  
(a) Guarantees  
In November 2002, the FASB issued FIN 45, “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including  
Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others — an interpretation of FASB Statements No. 5,  
F-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
57 and 107 and rescission of FASB interpretation No. 34” (“FIN 45”). FIN 45 defines a guarantee as a contract that contingently  
requires a guarantor to pay a guaranteed party as a result of changes in an underlying economic characteristic (such as interest rates  
or market value) that is related to an asset, a liability or an equity security of the guaranteed party or a third party’s failure to  
perform under a specified agreement. FIN 45 requires that a liability be recognized for the estimated fair value of the guarantee at  
its inception. Guarantees issued prior to January 1, 2003 are not subject to the recognition and measurement provisions, but are  
subject to expanded disclosure requirements. Nortel Networks has entered into agreements that contain features which meet the  
definition of a guarantee under FIN 45. Effective December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks adopted the disclosure requirements of FIN  
45. In addition, effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks adopted the initial recognition and measurement provisions of FIN 45  
which apply on a prospective basis to certain guarantees issued or modified after December 31, 2002. The adoption of FIN 45 did  
not have a material impact on the results of operations and financial condition of Nortel Networks (see note 13).  
(b) Asset retirement obligations  
In June 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 143, “Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations” (“SFAS 143”), which applies to  
certain obligations associated with the retirement of tangible long-lived assets. SFAS 143 requires that a liability be initially  
recognized for the estimated fair value of the obligation when it is incurred. The associated asset retirement cost is capitalized as  
part of the carrying amount of the long-lived asset and depreciated over the remaining life of the underlying asset and the associated  
liability is accreted to the estimated fair value of the obligation at the settlement date through periodic accretion charges to net  
earnings (loss). When the obligation is settled, any difference between the final cost and the recorded amount is recognized as  
income or loss on settlement. Effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks adopted the initial recognition and measurement  
provisions of SFAS 143 and identified certain asset retirement obligations to remediate leased premises and buildings and  
equipment situated on leased land. The adoption of SFAS 143 resulted in a decrease to net earnings (loss) of $12 (net of tax of nil)  
which has been reported as a cumulative effect of accounting changes — net of tax, an increase in plant and equipment — net of $4  
and an asset retirement obligation liability of $16 as of January 1, 2003. The adoption of SFAS 143 did not have a material impact  
on depreciation and accretion expense or basic and diluted earnings (loss) per share.  
(c) Accounting for costs associated with exit or disposal activities  
In June 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 146, “Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities” (“SFAS 146”),  
which is effective for exit or disposal activities initiated after December 31, 2002. SFAS 146 supercedes EITF Issue No. 94-3,  
“Liability Recognition for Certain Employee Termination Benefits and Other Costs to Exit an Activity (including Certain Costs  
Incurred in a Restructuring)” (“EITF 94-3”). SFAS 146 requires recognition of costs associated with an exit or disposal activity  
when the liability is incurred, whereas under EITF 94-3, a liability for an exit cost was recognized when an entity committed to an  
exit plan. In addition, SFAS 146 establishes that fair value is the objective for initial measurement of the liability. The effect of  
SFAS 146 was to change the timing of recognition and the basis for measuring certain liabilities and therefore created valuation  
differences between SFAS 146 and EITF 94-3. Exit and disposal activities initiated before December 31, 2002 continue to be  
accounted for under EITF 94-3. Nortel Networks adopted the requirements of SFAS 146 effective January 1, 2003. The adoption of  
SFAS 146 did not have a material impact on Nortel Networks results of operations and financial condition.  
(d) Consolidation of variable interest entities  
In January 2003, the FASB issued FIN 46, “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities — an interpretation of Accounting Research  
Bulletin No. 51, ‘Consolidated Financial Statements’” (“FIN 46”). FIN 46 clarifies the application of consolidation guidance to  
those entities defined as VIEs (which includes, but is not limited to, special purpose entities, trusts, partnerships, certain joint  
ventures and other legal structures) in which equity investors do not have the characteristics of a “controlling financial interest” or  
there is not sufficient equity at risk for the entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support. FIN 46  
applied immediately to all VIEs created after January 31, 2003 and by the beginning of the first interim or annual reporting period  
commencing after June 15, 2003 for VIEs created prior to February 1, 2003. In October 2003, the FASB issued FSP FIN 46-6,  
“Effective Date of FASB Interpretation No. 46”, deferring the effective date for applying the provisions of FIN 46 for VIEs created  
prior to February 1, 2003 to the end of the first interim or annual period ending after December 15, 2003. While the criteria for  
deferral were met, Nortel Networks elected early application of FIN 46.  
F-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Effective July 1, 2003, Nortel Networks prospectively began consolidating two VIEs for which Nortel Networks was considered the  
primary beneficiary following the guidance of FIN 46, on the basis that Nortel Networks retained certain risks associated with  
guaranteeing recovery of the unamortized principal balance of the VIEs’ debt, in two lease financing transactions, which  
represented the majority of the risks associated with the respective VIEs’ activities. The amount of the guarantees will be adjusted  
over time as the underlying debt matures. As of December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks consolidated balance sheet included $184 of  
long-term debt (see note 11) and $183 of plant and equipment — net (see note 5) related to these VIEs. These amounts represented  
both the collateral and maximum exposure to loss as a result of Nortel Networks involvement with these VIEs.  
In December 2003, the FASB issued FIN 46R which amends and supercedes the original FIN 46. Effective December 2003, Nortel  
Networks adopted FIN 46R. Any impacts of applying FIN 46R to an entity to which FIN 46 had previously been applied are  
considered immaterial to Nortel Networks results of operations and financial condition and Nortel Networks accounting treatment  
of VIEs.  
Nortel Networks has conducted certain receivable sales with multi-seller conduits. As well, Nortel Networks has other financial  
interests and contractual arrangements which would meet the definition of a variable interest under FIN 46R, including investments  
in associated companies and joint ventures, customer financing arrangements, guarantees and indemnification arrangements, certain  
leasing arrangements and certain compensation arrangements. As of December 31, 2003, none of these interests or arrangements  
met the requirements for consolidation under FIN 46R.  
(e) Accounting for certain financial instruments with characteristics of both liabilities and equity  
In May 2003, the FASB issued SFAS No. 150, “Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments with Characteristics of both  
Liabilities and Equity” (“SFAS 150”). SFAS 150 clarifies the accounting for certain financial instruments with characteristics of  
both liabilities and equity, including mandatorily redeemable non-controlling interests, and requires that those instruments be  
classified as liabilities on the balance sheets. Previously, many of those financial instruments were classified as equity. SFAS 150 is  
effective for financial instruments entered into or modified after May 31, 2003 and otherwise is effective at the beginning of the  
first interim period beginning after June 15, 2003. In November 2003, the FASB issued FSP FAS 150-3, “Effective Date,  
Disclosures, and Transition for Mandatorily Redeemable Financial Instruments of Certain Nonpublic Entities and Certain  
Mandatorily Redeemable Non-controlling Interests under FASB Statement No. 150, Accounting for Certain Financial Instruments  
with Characteristics of Both Liabilities and Equity” (“FSP FAS 150-3”), which deferred indefinitely the effective date for applying  
the specific provisions within SFAS 150 related to the classification and measurement of mandatorily redeemable non-controlling  
interests.  
As of December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks continued to consolidate two enterprises with limited lives. Upon liquidation in 2024,  
the net assets of these entities will be distributed to the owners based on their relative interests at that time. The minority interest  
included in the consolidated balance sheet related to these entities as of December 31, 2003 was $45. Nortel Networks has not yet  
determined the fair value of this minority interest as of December 31, 2003. The adoption of SFAS 150, as amended by FSP FAS  
150-3, did not have a material impact on Nortel Networks results of operations and financial condition.  
(f) Accounting for revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables  
In November 2002, the EITF reached a consensus on EITF 00-21. In the absence of higher level accounting literature, EITF 00-21  
governs how to separate and allocate revenue to goods or services or both that are to be delivered in a bundled sales arrangement.  
EITF 00-21 applies to revenue arrangements entered into after June 30, 2003 and allows for either prospective application or  
cumulative adjustment upon adoption. Nortel Networks adopted the requirements of EITF 00-21 on a prospective basis effective  
July 1, 2003. On October 1, 2003, Nortel Networks has also adopted related interpretive guidance contained in EITF 03-5,  
“Applicability of AICPA Statement of Position 97-2 to Non-Software Deliverables in an Arrangement Containing More-Than-  
Incidental Software” (“EITF 03-5”), which addresses whether non-software deliverables included in an arrangement that contains  
software that is more than incidental to the products or services as a whole are included within the scope of SOP 97-2. The adoption  
of EITF 00-21 and EITF 03-5 did not have a material impact on Nortel Networks results of operations and financial condition.  
F-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(g) Amendment of SFAS 133 on derivative instruments and hedging activities  
In April 2003, the FASB issued SFAS No. 149, “Amendment of SFAS No. 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging  
Activities” (“SFAS 149”). SFAS 149 amends and clarifies the accounting for derivative instruments, including certain derivative  
instruments embedded in other contracts and hedging activities under SFAS 133. In particular, SFAS 149: clarifies under what  
circumstances a contract with an initial net investment meets the characteristic of a derivative as discussed in SFAS 133; clarifies  
when a derivative contains a financing component; amends the definition of an “underlying” to conform it to the language used in  
FIN 45; and amends certain other existing pronouncements. SFAS 149 is effective for contracts entered into or modified after  
June 30, 2003, except as stated below, and for hedging relationships designated after June 30, 2003.  
The provisions of SFAS 149 that relate to guidance in SFAS 133 that have been effective for fiscal quarters which began prior to  
June 15, 2003 continue to be applied in accordance with their respective effective dates. In addition, certain provisions relating to  
forward purchases or sales of when-issued securities or other securities that do not yet exist are applied to both existing contracts as  
well as new contracts entered into after June 30, 2003.  
Effective July 1, 2003, Nortel Networks applied the requirements of SFAS 149 on a prospective basis to contracts entered into or  
modified after June 30, 2003. The adoption of SFAS 149 did not have a material impact on Nortel Networks results of operations  
and financial condition.  
(h) Determining whether an arrangement contains a lease  
In May 2003, the EITF reached a consensus on Issue No. 01-8, “Determining Whether an Arrangement Contains a Lease” (“EITF  
01-8”). EITF 01-8 provides guidance on how to determine whether an arrangement contains a lease that is within the scope of  
FASB Statement No. 13, “Accounting for Leases”. The guidance in EITF 01-8 is based on whether the arrangement conveys to the  
purchaser (or the lessee) the right to use or control the use of a specific asset, and is effective for Nortel Networks for arrangements  
entered into or modified after June 30, 2003. As of December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks recorded embedded lease assets and  
liabilities of $2 included in each of plant and equipment — net (see note 5) and long-term debt (see note 11), respectively. The  
impact of EITF 01-8 on Nortel Networks future results of operations and financial condition will depend on the terms contained in  
contracts signed or contracts amended in the future.  
(i) Pensions and other post-retirement benefits  
On December 23, 2003, the FASB issued SFAS No. 132 (Revised 2003), “Employers’ Disclosures about Pensions and Other  
Postretirement Benefits” (“SFAS 132R”). SFAS 132R is a replacement of SFAS No. 132, “Employers’ Disclosures about Pensions  
and Other Postretirement Benefits (“SFAS 132”). It is effective for fiscal years ended after December 15, 2003 and the applicable  
current year requirements have been applied in the presentation of the consolidated financial statements. SFAS 132R requires  
additional disclosures regarding defined benefit pension plan and other post-retirement benefit plan assets, obligations, cash flows  
and net cost as well as retaining a number of disclosures required by SFAS 132.  
(j) Stock-based compensation  
In December 2002, the FASB issued SFAS 148, which amended the transitional provisions of SFAS 123 for companies electing to  
recognize employee stock-based compensation using the fair value based method. Effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks  
elected to expense employee stock-based compensation using the fair value based method prospectively for all awards granted,  
modified, or settled on or after January 1, 2003 (see note 2(u)).  
(k) Accounting for goodwill and other intangible assets  
In June 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets” (“SFAS 142”), effective for fiscal years  
beginning after December 15, 2001. SFAS 142 changed the accounting for goodwill from an amortization method to an  
impairment-only approach. Thus, amortization of goodwill, including goodwill recorded in past business combinations and  
amortization of intangibles with an indefinite life, ceased upon adoption of SFAS 142. For any acquisitions completed after  
June 30, 2001, goodwill and intangible assets with an indefinite life are not amortized. Nortel Networks adopted the provisions of  
SFAS 142 effective January 1, 2002.  
F-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following table presents the impact on net earnings (loss) and on basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share for the  
year ended December 31, 2001 from both continuing and discontinued operations of the SFAS 142 requirement to cease the  
amortization of goodwill as if the standard had been in effect beginning January 1, 2001:  
2001  
Reported results:  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Cumulative effect of accounting change — net of tax  
$ (23,270)  
(2,467)  
15  
Net earnings (loss) — reported  
$ (25,722)  
Adjustments:  
(a)  
Amortization of goodwill from continuing operations — net of tax  
$
$
4,067  
195  
Amortization of goodwill from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Total net adjustments  
4,262  
Adjusted results:  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Cumulative effect of accounting change — net of tax  
$ (19,203)  
(2,272)  
15  
Net earnings (loss) — adjusted  
$ (21,460)  
Reported basic earnings (loss) per common share:  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
(7.30)  
(0.78)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share — reported  
(8.08)  
Reported diluted earnings (loss) per common share:  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
(7.30)  
(0.78)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share — reported  
(8.08)  
Adjusted basic earnings (loss) per common share:  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
(6.03)  
(0.71)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share — adjusted  
(6.74)  
Adjusted diluted earnings (loss) per common share:  
— from continuing operations  
— from discontinued operations  
$
$
(6.03)  
(0.71)  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share — adjusted  
(6.74)  
(a) Included goodwill amortization of equity accounted investments of $9 (net of tax of $5).  
(l) Impairment or disposal of long-lived assets (plant and equipment and acquired technology)  
In August 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets” (“SFAS  
144”), which addressed financial accounting and reporting for the impairment or disposal of long-lived assets. SFAS 144 is  
applicable to certain long-lived assets, including those reported as discontinued operations, and develops one accounting model for  
long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale. SFAS 144 superseded SFAS No. 121, “Accounting for the Impairment of Long-lived  
Assets and for Long-lived Assets to be Disposed Of”, and APB 30 for the disposal of a segment of a business. Nortel Networks  
adopted the provisions of SFAS 144 effective January 1, 2002.  
SFAS 144 requires that long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale be measured at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less  
cost to sell, whether reported in continuing operations or in discontinued operations. Discontinued operations will no longer be  
measured at net realizable value or include amounts for operating losses that have not yet been incurred. SFAS 144 also broadened  
the reporting of discontinued operations to include the disposal of a component of an entity provided that the operations and cash  
flows of the component will be eliminated from the ongoing operations of the entity and the entity will not have any significant  
continuing involvement in the operations of the component. During the year ended December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks recorded  
write downs for plant and equipment of $382 related to long-lived assets held and used, and $38 related to long-lived assets held for  
sale. See note 7 for further information regarding these write downs.  
F-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(m) Derivative financial instruments  
Effective January 1, 2001, Nortel Networks adopted SFAS 133, and the corresponding amendments under SFAS No. 138,  
“Accounting for Certain Derivative Instruments and Certain Hedging Activities — an amendment of SFAS No. 133” (“SFAS  
138”). See note 2(t) for further information regarding the accounting for derivatives under SFAS 133.  
For the year ended December 31, 2001, the adoption of SFAS 133 resulted in a cumulative decrease in net loss of $15 (net of tax of  
$9), which has been reported as cumulative effect of accounting changes — net of tax, and a charge to OCI of $7 (net of tax of $4).  
The decrease in net loss is primarily attributable to embedded derivatives. The charge to OCI is primarily attributable to the  
effective portion of option and forward contracts related to the Canadian dollar hedge program that are designated as cash flow  
hedges. The adoption of SFAS 133 did not materially affect either the basic or diluted loss per common share.  
5. Consolidated financial statement details  
The following consolidated financial statement details are presented as of December 31 for the consolidated balance sheets and for each  
of the years ended December 31 for the consolidated statements of operations and consolidated statements of cash flows.  
Consolidated statements of operations  
Selling, general and administrative expense:  
Selling, general and administrative (“SG&A”) expense included bad debt recoveries of $180 and expense of $291 and $1,791 in the years  
ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Research and development expense:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
R&D expense  
R&D costs incurred on behalf of others  
$
$
1,960  
72  
$
$
2,083  
49  
$
$
3,116  
68  
(a)  
Total  
2,032  
2,132  
3,184  
(a)  
These costs included R&D charged to customers of Nortel Networks pursuant to contracts that provided for full recovery of the estimated cost of development,  
material, engineering, installation and other applicable costs, which were accounted for as contract costs.  
Other income (expense) — net:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Interest income  
$
$
75  
143  
105  
122  
$
$
88  
(39)  
(65)  
11  
$
$
133  
Gain (loss) on sale or write down of investments  
Currency exchange gains (losses)  
Other — net  
(368)  
(152)  
(119)  
Other income (expense) — net  
445  
(5)  
(506)  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, reversals of provisions of $87 relating to a customer bankruptcy settlement reduced cost of  
revenues and SG&A expense by $53 and $4, respectively, and increased other income (expense) — net by $30.  
F-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consolidated balance sheets  
Accounts receivable — net:  
2003  
2002  
Trade receivables  
Contracts in process  
$
$
2,117  
582  
$
$
1,863  
867  
2,699  
(194)  
2,730  
(502)  
Less: provision for doubtful accounts  
Accounts receivable — net  
2,505  
2,228  
Inventories — net:  
2003  
2002  
Raw materials  
Work in process  
Finished goods  
$
$
249  
172  
769  
$
$
339  
256  
911  
(a)  
Inventories — net  
1,190  
1,506  
(a)  
Net of inventory provisions of $1,226 and $1,180 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. Other reserves for claims related to contract manufacturers and  
suppliers of $120 and $171 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively, were included in other accrued liabilities. These accruals were related to cancellation  
charges, contracted-for inventory in excess of future demand and the settlement of certain other claims.  
Other current assets:  
2003  
2002  
Prepaid expenses  
Current assets of discontinued operations  
Other  
$
$
176  
28  
111  
$
$
162  
209  
279  
(a)  
Other current assets  
315  
650  
(a)  
See note 20 for additional information.  
Plant and equipment — net:  
2003  
2002  
Cost:  
Land  
Buildings  
Machinery and equipment  
$
62  
1,483  
2,749  
$
63  
1,433  
3,492  
4,294  
4,988  
Less accumulated depreciation:  
Buildings  
(457)  
(532)  
Machinery and equipment  
(2,181)  
(2,764)  
(2,638)  
1,656  
(3,296)  
1,692  
(a)(b)(c)  
Plant and equipment — net  
$
$
(a)  
Included assets held for sale with a carrying value of $30 and $73 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively, related to owned facilities that were being  
actively marketed. These assets were written down in previous periods to their estimated fair values less costs to sell. The write downs were included in special  
charges. Nortel Networks expects to dispose of all of these facilities by mid-2005.  
(b)  
(c)  
Included VIE assets consolidated prospectively, as required by FIN 46R, of $183 as of December 31, 2003 (see note 4(d)).  
Included embedded leases recorded prospectively, as required by EITF 01-8, of $2 as of December 31, 2003 (see note 4(h)).  
F-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Goodwill:  
The following table outlines goodwill by reportable segment:  
Wireless  
Networks  
Enterprise  
Networks  
Wireline  
Networks  
Optical  
Networks  
Other  
Total  
Balance — net as of December 31, 2001  
$
21  
$
1,658  
$
524  
$
590  
$
15  
$
2,808  
Change:  
Disposal  
Impairment  
Foreign exchange  
(2)  
(2)  
(595)  
5
(15)  
(15)  
(595)  
1
Balance — net as of December 31, 2002  
Change:  
Additions  
21  
1,656  
522  
2,199  
(a)  
13  
1
31  
5
43  
4
9
96  
10  
Foreign exchange  
Balance — net as of December 31, 2003  
$
35  
$
1,692  
$
569  
$
9
$
$
2,305  
(a)  
See note 10 for additional information.  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks performed its annual goodwill impairment test and concluded that there was  
no impairment. During the three months ended September 30, 2002, an impairment test was performed on goodwill in accordance with  
SFAS 142 for all reporting units due to a significant adverse change in the business climate and taking into consideration Nortel  
Networks market capitalization at the end of the third quarter of 2002. All of Nortel Networks reporting units had fair values in excess of  
their carrying values with the exception of Optical Networks. As a result of the impairment test, Nortel Networks recorded a write down  
of goodwill of $595 within the Optical Networks segment during the year ended December 31, 2002.  
Intangible assets — net:  
2003  
2002  
(a)  
Acquired technology  
$
$
45  
41  
$
$
98  
41  
(b)  
Other intangible assets  
Pension intangible assets  
(c)  
Intangible assets — net  
86  
139  
(a)  
(b)  
As of December 31, 2003, acquired technology was fully amortized.  
Other intangible assets are being amortized over a ten year period ending in 2013. Amortization expense for the next five years commencing in 2004 is expected to  
be $9, $6, $5, $5 and $4, respectively. The amortization expense is denominated in a foreign currency and may fluctuate due to changes in foreign exchange rates.  
Pension intangible assets were recorded as required by SFAS No. 87, “Employers’ Accounting for Pensions”. Amounts are not amortized but are adjusted as part of  
the annual minimum pension liability assessment.  
(c)  
Other accrued liabilities:  
2003  
2002  
Outsourcing and selling, general and administrative related  
Customer deposits  
$
302  
73  
$
486  
69  
Product related  
Warranty  
Deferred income  
Miscellaneous taxes  
Income taxes payable  
Current liabilities of discontinued operations  
120  
387  
761  
76  
111  
6
171  
408  
1,108  
74  
150  
63  
Interest payable  
62  
67  
Advance billings in excess of revenues recognized to date on long-term contracts  
Other  
509  
98  
394  
267  
Other accrued liabilities  
$
2,505  
$
3,257  
F-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other liabilities:  
2003  
2002  
Pension, post-employment and post-retirement benefit liabilities  
Long-term provisions  
$
$
1,973  
972  
$
$
1,645  
1,116  
Other liabilities  
2,945  
2,761  
Minority interests in subsidiary companies:  
2003  
2002  
(a)  
Preferred shares of principal operating subsidiary  
(b)  
(c)  
Series 5, issued November 26, 1996 for consideration of Canadian $400  
Series 7, issued November 28, 1997 for consideration of Canadian $350  
Other  
$
$
294  
242  
81  
$
$
294  
242  
95  
Minority interests in subsidiary companies  
617  
631  
(a)  
(b)  
NNL is authorized to issue an unlimited number of Class A and Class B preferred shares.  
As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, 16 million of Class A Series 5 preferred shares were outstanding. As of December 1, 2001, holders of Series 5 preferred shares  
are entitled to, if declared, a monthly floating cumulative preferential cash dividend based on Canadian prime rates.  
(c)  
As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, 14 million of Class A Series 7 preferred shares were outstanding. As of December 1, 2002, holders of the Series 7 preferred  
shares are entitled to, if declared, a monthly floating non-cumulative preferential cash dividend based on Canadian prime rates.  
Consolidated statements of cash flows  
Change in operating assets and liabilities:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Restricted cash and cash equivalents  
Accounts receivable  
Inventories  
Income taxes  
Restructuring  
$
$
200  
(231)  
429  
$
$
(231)  
938  
984  
1,256  
(1,094)  
(1,324)  
286  
$
$
5,564  
2,757  
(959)  
(1,121)  
(556)  
1,498  
18  
(558)  
(462)  
451  
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities  
Other operating assets and liabilities  
Change in operating assets and liabilities  
(153)  
815  
7,183  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Cash on hand and balances with banks  
Short-term investments  
$
$
756  
3,241  
$
$
934  
2,856  
$
$
1,312  
2,162  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year  
3,997  
3,790  
3,474  
Acquisitions of investments and businesses — net of cash acquired:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Cash acquired  
Total net assets acquired other than cash  
$
$
(12)  
(163)  
$
$
(29)  
$
$
(10)  
(2,370)  
Total purchase price  
Less:  
Cash acquired  
(175)  
(29)  
(2,380)  
12  
105  
10  
2,291  
Non-cash consideration paid other than common share options and contingent consideration  
Acquisitions of investments and businesses — net of cash acquired  
Interest and taxes paid (recovered):  
F-39  
(58)  
(29)  
(79)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Cash interest paid  
Cash taxes paid (recovered) — net  
$
$
186  
(4)  
$
$
289  
(1,208)  
$
$
253  
20  
Receivables sales:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Proceeds from new securitizations  
Proceeds from collections reinvested in revolving period securitizations  
$
$
651  
52  
$
$
562  
276  
$
$
789  
688  
6. Segment information  
General description  
During 2003 and up to September 30, 2004, Nortel Networks operations were organized around four reportable segments consisting of  
Wireless Networks, Enterprise Networks, Wireline Networks and Optical Networks. Wireless Networks included network access and  
core networking products for voice and data communications that span second and third generation wireless technologies and most major  
global standards for mobile networks and related professional services. Enterprise Networks included circuit and packet voice solutions,  
data networking and security solutions and the related professional services used by enterprise customers. Wireline Networks included  
circuit and packet voice solutions, data networking and security solutions and the related professional services used by service provider  
customers. Optical Networks included metropolitan, regional and long-haul optical transport and switching solutions and managed  
broadband services and related professional services for both service provider and enterprise customers.  
“Other” represented miscellaneous business activities and corporate functions. None of these activities meet the quantitative criteria to be  
disclosed as reportable segments. As described in note 20, Nortel Networks access solutions operations were discontinued during the year  
ended December 31, 2001. These operations were previously included as a separate business activity within “other”. The data below  
excludes amounts related to the access solutions operations.  
Effective October 1, 2004, a new streamlined organizational structure was established that involved, among other things, combining the  
businesses of Nortel Networks four segments into two business organizations: (i) Carrier Networks and Global Operations, and  
(ii) Enterprise Networks. Nortel Networks is reviewing the impact of these changes on its reportable segments.  
Nortel Networks president and chief executive officer (the “CEO”) has been identified as the chief operating decision maker in assessing  
the performance of the segments and the allocation of resources to the segments. Each reportable segment is managed separately with  
each segment manager reporting directly to the CEO. The CEO relies on the information derived directly from the Nortel Networks  
management reporting system. In 2003, Nortel Networks reported that the primary financial measure used by the former chief operating  
decision maker in assessing performance and allocating resources to the segments was contribution margin, a measure that was  
comprised of gross profit less SG&A expense. In April 2004, Nortel Networks and NNL’s board of directors appointed a new CEO.  
Commencing in the second quarter of 2004, the primary financial measure used by the CEO in assessing performance and allocating  
resources to the segments is management earnings (loss) before income taxes (“Management EBT”), a measure that includes contribution  
margin, R&D expense, interest expense, other income (expense) — net, minority interests — net of tax and equity in net loss of  
associated companies — net of tax. As a result of the change in Nortel Networks primary financial measure used to assess the  
performance of the segments during the period in which Nortel Networks financial reports as described in note 23 have been delayed, and  
because both contribution margin and Management EBT were available to the former chief operating decision maker during 2003, Nortel  
Networks has determined that it is appropriate to disclose both contribution margin and Management EBT for the periods presented.  
Costs associated with shared services and other corporate costs are allocated to the segments based on usage determined generally by  
headcount. Costs not allocated to the segments are primarily related to Nortel Networks corporate compliance and other non-operational  
activities and are included in “other”. In addition, the CEO does not review asset information on a segmented basis in order to assess  
performance and allocate resources. The accounting policies of the reportable segments are the same as those applied to the consolidated  
financial statements.  
F-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Segments  
The following tables set forth information by segment for the years ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Revenues  
Wireless Networks  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
Other  
$
4,389  
2,589  
2,005  
1,179  
31  
$
4,161  
2,422  
2,572  
1,820  
33  
$
5,699  
3,222  
4,328  
5,050  
601  
Total  
$
$
10,193  
$
$
11,008  
$
$
18,900  
Contribution margin  
Wireless Networks  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
Other  
1,573  
560  
612  
(2)  
(341)  
1,104  
316  
736  
(778)  
(26)  
515  
263  
611  
(1,524)  
(1,688)  
Total  
$
$
2,402  
$
$
1,352  
$
$
(1,823)  
Management EBT  
Wireless Networks  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
Other  
695  
279  
171  
(260)  
(306)  
256  
29  
178  
(1,274)  
(209)  
(456)  
(141)  
(205)  
(2,504)  
(2,634)  
Total  
579  
(1,020)  
(5,940)  
In-process research and development expense  
Amortization of acquired technology and other  
Amortization of goodwill  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges  
(101)  
(16)  
(284)  
4
(157)  
(110)  
(2,095)  
21  
(15)  
(806)  
(4,058)  
(248)  
(14,816)  
(138)  
2,751  
Gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
80  
468  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
$
262  
$
(2,893)  
$ (23,270)  
Product revenues  
The following table sets forth external revenues by product for the years ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Wireless solutions  
Circuit and packet voice solutions  
Optical solutions  
Data networking and security solutions  
Other  
$
$
4,389  
3,044  
1,413  
1,316  
31  
$
$
4,161  
3,193  
1,997  
1,624  
33  
$
$
5,699  
5,224  
5,409  
1,967  
601  
Total  
10,193  
11,008  
18,900  
F-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
During the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, no customers had revenues greater than 10 percent of consolidated revenues.  
Geographic information  
The following table sets forth external revenues by geographic region based on the location of the customer for the years ended  
December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
U.S.  
EMEA  
Canada  
Other regions  
Total  
$
$
5,424  
2,366  
587  
$
$
5,823  
2,500  
648  
$
$
10,136  
4,380  
1,076  
(a)  
1,816  
2,037  
3,308  
10,193  
11,008  
18,900  
(a)  
The Asia Pacific and CALA regions.  
Long-lived assets  
The following table sets forth long-lived assets representing plant and equipment — net, goodwill and other intangible assets — net by  
geographic region as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
U.S.  
EMEA  
Canada  
Other regions  
$
$
2,648  
616  
683  
$
$
2,734  
506  
646  
100  
144  
Total  
4,047  
4,030  
F-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Special charges  
During 2003, Nortel Networks continued to implement its restructuring work plan initiated in 2001. In addition, as described below,  
certain exit activities were initiated in 2003.  
Special charges recorded from January 1, 2001 to December 31, 2003 were as follows:  
Contract  
settlement  
and lease  
costs  
Intangible  
asset  
impair-  
ments  
Plant and  
equipment  
write downs  
Workforce  
reduction  
Other  
Total  
Provision balance as of January 1, 2001  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
Revisions to prior accruals  
Cash drawdowns  
Non-cash drawdowns  
$
$
45  
1,174  
42  
(1,003)  
14  
$
$
$
$
$
39  
(2)  
(8)  
$
$
$
45  
11,426  
3,517  
(127)  
(1,121)  
(12,760)  
8
11,426  
897  
(108)  
(110)  
1,000  
(59)  
(941)  
407  
(11,833)  
Foreign exchange and other adjustments  
10  
(2)  
Provision balance as of December 31, 2001  
282  
677  
$
29  
$
988  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
Revisions to prior accruals  
Cash drawdowns  
Non-cash drawdowns  
952  
(132)  
(788)  
(100)  
(2)  
225  
8
(286)  
475  
(55)  
(420)  
(20)  
595  
27  
595  
1,679  
(179)  
(1,094)  
(1,142)  
(6)  
(622)  
Foreign exchange and other adjustments  
(4)  
(a)  
Provision balance as of December 31, 2002  
$
$
212  
$
$
620  
$
$
$
$
9
$
$
$
$
841  
Other special charges  
Revisions to prior accruals  
Cash drawdowns  
Non-cash drawdowns  
Foreign exchange and other adjustments  
199  
(44)  
(274)  
(41)  
12  
64  
19  
(275)  
74  
(28)  
(46)  
(9)  
337  
(53)  
(558)  
(87)  
40  
28  
(a)  
Provision balance as of December 31, 2003  
64  
456  
520  
(a)  
As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, the short-term provision balance was $206 and $507, respectively, and the long-term provision balance was $314 and $334,  
respectively, which was included in long-term provisions, as a component of other liabilities.  
Regular full-time (“RFT”) employee notifications included in special charges were as follows:  
Employees (approximate)  
(a)  
(b)  
Direct  
Indirect  
Total  
RFT employee notifications by period:  
During 2001  
During 2002  
13,900  
3,400  
22,200  
9,300  
1,400  
36,100  
12,700  
1,800  
During 2003  
400  
RFT employee notifications for the three years ended December 31, 2003  
17,700  
32,900  
50,600  
(a)  
(b)  
Direct employees included employees performing manufacturing, assembly, test and inspection activities associated with the production of Nortel Networks  
products.  
Indirect employees included employees performing manufacturing management, sales, marketing, research and development and administrative activities.  
Year ended December 31, 2003  
For the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks recorded total special charges of $284, which was net of revisions of $53 related  
to prior accruals.  
Workforce reduction charges of $199 were related to severance and benefit costs associated with approximately 1,800 employees notified  
of termination. The workforce reduction was primarily in the U.S., Canada and EMEA and extended across all segments.  
F-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Offsetting these charges were revisions to prior accruals of $44 which were primarily related to termination benefits where actual costs  
were lower than the estimated amounts across all segments. During 2003, the workforce reduction provision balance was drawn down by  
cash payments of $274 and by a non-cash pension settlement loss of $41. The remaining provision is expected to be substantially drawn  
down by the end of 2004.  
Contract settlement and lease costs of $64 consisted of negotiated settlements to cancel or renegotiate contracts and net lease charges  
related to leased facilities (comprised of office, warehouse and manufacturing space) and leased furniture that were identified as no  
longer required across all segments. These lease costs, net of anticipated sublease income, included non-cancelable lease terms from the  
date leased facilities ceased to be used and termination penalties. In addition to these charges were revisions to prior accruals of $19  
resulting primarily from changes in estimates for sublease income and costs to vacate certain properties, across all segments. During  
2003, the provision balance for contract settlement and lease costs was drawn down by cash payments of $275. The remaining provision,  
net of approximately $317 in estimated sublease income, is expected to be substantially drawn down by the end of 2013.  
Included in the above contract settlement and lease costs and net revisions to prior accruals were charges related to activities initiated by  
Nortel Networks in 2003 to exit certain leased facilities and leases for assets no longer used, across all segments. The table below  
summarizes the total costs estimated to be incurred as a result of these activities, which have met the criteria described in SFAS 146, the  
balance of these accrued expenses as of December 31, 2003 and the movement in these accruals. These costs have been valued using the  
estimated fair value method prescribed under SFAS 146. Nortel Networks expects to have completed these activities by mid-2022, based  
on existing lease terms.  
Accrued  
balance as  
of January  
1, 2003  
Costs  
incurred  
during  
2003  
Payments  
made  
Adjustments  
made  
Accrued  
balance as  
of December  
31, 2003  
during  
2003  
during  
2003  
(a)  
Lease costs  
$
$
50  
$
(8)  
$
(6)  
$
36  
(a) Total estimated costs, net of estimated sublease income, associated with these accruals are $62.  
Plant and equipment charges of $74 were largely related to current period write downs to fair value less costs to sell for various leasehold  
improvements and excess Optical Networks equipment held for sale. Offsetting these charges were revisions of $28 to prior write downs  
of assets held for sale related primarily to adjustments to original plans or estimated amounts for certain facility closures.  
Year ended December 31, 2002  
For the year ended December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks recorded total special charges of $2,095, which were net of revisions of $179  
related to prior accruals.  
Workforce reduction charges of $952 were related to severance and benefit costs associated with approximately 12,700 employees  
notified of termination. The workforce reduction was primarily in the U.S., Canada and EMEA and extended across all segments.  
Offsetting these charges were revisions to prior accruals of $132 which were primarily related to termination benefits where actual costs  
were lower than the estimated amounts across all segments. Workforce reduction charges included $124 for pension and post-retirement  
benefits other than pension, settlement and curtailment costs. During 2002, the workforce reduction provision balance was drawn down  
by cash payments of $788 and by $100 of non-cash pension and post-retirement benefits other than pension, settlement and curtailment  
costs attributable to the notified employee group charged against the provision.  
Contract settlement and lease costs of $225 consisted of negotiated settlements to cancel or renegotiate contracts and net lease charges  
related to leased facilities (comprised of office, warehouse and manufacturing space) and leased manufacturing equipment that were no  
longer required, across all segments. In addition to these charges were revisions to prior accruals of $8 resulting primarily from changes  
in estimates for sublease income and costs to vacate certain properties, across all segments. During the year ended December 31, 2002,  
the provision balance for contract settlement and lease costs was drawn down by cash payments of $286. The remaining provision  
balance was net of approximately $402 in estimated sublease income.  
Plant and equipment charges of $475 were related to current period write downs to fair value less costs to sell for various owned facilities  
and plant and manufacturing related equipment. These charges for facilities and equipment included $358 related to specialized plant  
infrastructure and equipment within Optical Networks with the remaining charges for facilities and equipment arising across all  
segments.  
F-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fair value was determined using quoted market prices or the anticipated cash flows discounted at a rate commensurate with the risks  
involved. Offsetting these charges were revisions of $55 to prior write downs of assets held for sale related primarily to additional  
proceeds from disposals of equipment from Optical Networks and other segments in excess of amounts previously expected and  
adjustments to original plans or estimated amounts for certain facility closures across all segments.  
Within Optical Networks, Nortel Networks performed assessments of certain plant and equipment due to the then current market  
conditions and the delay in the anticipated recovery of that segment and concluded that the assets’ carrying values were not fully  
recoverable from estimated future cash flows. As a result, Nortel Networks recorded a charge to income of $358 to write down the value  
of this equipment to its fair value less costs to sell. Included in the $358 write down was $34 related to equipment held for sale, which  
was part of the Bookham Technology plc (“Bookham”) transaction (see note 10).  
Intangible asset impairments of $27 reflected write downs in acquired technology associated with Xros, Inc. (“Xros”), the 980 NPLC  
business and CoreTek.  
Goodwill impairment charges were $595. As a result of the continued decline during 2002, in both Nortel Networks overall market value  
generally and within Optical Networks specifically, Nortel Networks as part of its review of financial results during the year ended  
December 31, 2002, evaluated the goodwill associated with the businesses within Optical Networks for potential impairment. The  
conclusion of those evaluations was that the fair value associated with the businesses within Optical Networks could no longer support  
the carrying value of the remaining goodwill associated with them. As a result, Nortel Networks recorded a goodwill impairment charge  
of $595. Fair value was estimated using the then expected present value of discounted future cash flows of the businesses within Optical  
Networks. The discount rate used ranged from 12 to 16 percent and the terminal values were estimated based on terminal growth rates  
ranging from 3 to 5 percent. The assumptions supporting the estimated future cash flows, including the discount rate and estimated  
terminal values, reflected management’s best estimates.  
Year ended December 31, 2001  
For the year ended December 31, 2001, Nortel Networks recorded total special charges of $14,816, which were net of revisions of $127  
related to prior accruals.  
Workforce reduction charges of $1,174 were related to the cost of severance and benefits associated with approximately 36,100  
employees notified of termination. The workforce reduction was primarily in the U.S., Canada and EMEA and extended across all  
segments. In addition to these charges were revisions to prior accruals of $42 which were primarily related to termination benefits where  
actual costs were higher than the estimated amounts across all segments. During the year ended December 31, 2001, the workforce  
reduction provision balance was drawn down by cash payments of $1,003 and offset by $14 of non-cash pension settlement and  
curtailment costs attributable to the notified employee group charged against the provision.  
Contract settlement and lease costs of $897 related to negotiated settlements to cancel or renegotiate contracts and net lease charges  
related to a number of leased facilities (comprised of office, warehouse and manufacturing space) and leased manufacturing equipment  
that were no longer required, across all segments. Offsetting these charges were revisions to prior accruals of $108 primarily related to  
contract settlement costs which were lower than the estimated amounts across all segments. During the year ended December 31, 2001,  
the provision balance for contract settlement and lease costs was drawn down by cash payments of $110. The remaining provision  
balance was net of approximately $496 in estimated sublease revenues.  
Plant and equipment charges of $1,000 included write downs of $167 for owned facilities, $435 for leasehold improvements and certain  
information technology equipment associated with the exiting of leased and owned facilities and $398 for certain plant and  
manufacturing related equipment. Owned facility write downs of $167 included $76 for specific owned facilities across all segments  
primarily within the U.S., Canada and EMEA and $91 for a specialized manufacturing facility in the U.S. within Optical Networks. The  
carrying values of the above owned facilities have been reflected at their net realizable value based on market assessments for general  
purpose facilities. Offsetting these charges were revisions of $59 to prior write downs resulting primarily from adjustments to original  
plans or estimated amounts for certain facility closures. These revisions related primarily to global operations and Optical Networks.  
Plant and manufacturing related equipment write downs of $398 included $103 for equipment within global operations, and $295 for  
specialized plant infrastructure and equipment within Optical Networks.  
F-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Goodwill and other intangible assets impairment charges totaled $11,833 during the year ended December 31, 2001. In addition to the  
charge of $11,727 described below, this amount included a goodwill impairment charge of $106 related to the remaining net book value  
of goodwill associated with the prior acquisitions of MICOM Communications, Corp. and Dimension Enterprises, Inc. (“Dimension”).  
As part of Nortel Networks work plan to streamline its business, the decision was made to exit all technologies and consulting services  
related to these prior acquisitions. The results related to these prior acquisitions were not material to the business, results of operations  
and financial condition of Nortel Networks.  
Nortel Networks, as part of its review of financial results during the year ended December 31, 2001, performed an assessment of the  
carrying values of intangible assets recorded in connection with its various acquisitions. The assessment during that period was  
performed in light of the then significant negative industry and economic trends impacting Nortel Networks operations and expected  
future growth rates, and the adjustment of technology valuations. The conclusion of the assessment was that the decline in market  
conditions within the telecommunications industry was significant and other than temporary. As a result, Nortel Networks recorded a  
$11,727 impairment of goodwill and other intangible assets based on the amount by which the carrying amount of these assets exceeded  
their fair value. The impairment was primarily related to the goodwill within Enterprise Networks, Optical Networks and Other and was  
associated with the acquisitions of Alteon, the 980 NPLC business, Xros, Qtera Corporation, Photonic Technologies, Inc. (“Photonic”),  
EPiCON, Inc. (“EPiCON”) and Clarify Inc. (“Clarify”).  
Fair value was determined based on discounted future cash flows for the businesses that had separately distinguishable goodwill and  
intangible asset balances and whose operations had not yet been fully integrated into Nortel Networks. The cash flow periods used were  
five years, the discount rate used was 20 percent and the terminal values were estimated based upon terminal growth rates ranging from 5  
to 11 percent reflecting management’s best estimates at the time. The discount rate was based upon Nortel Networks weighted-average  
cost of capital as adjusted for the risks associated with the operations.  
8. Income taxes  
As of December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks net deferred tax assets, excluding discontinued operations, were $3,575, reflecting temporary  
differences between the financial reporting and tax treatment of certain current assets and liabilities and non-current assets and liabilities,  
in addition to the tax benefit of net operating and capital loss carryforwards and tax credit carryforwards.  
In accordance with SFAS No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes” (“SFAS 109”), Nortel Networks reviews all available positive and  
negative evidence to evaluate the recoverability of the deferred tax assets. This includes a review of such evidence as the carryforward  
periods of the significant tax assets, Nortel Networks history of generating taxable income in its material tax jurisdictions and Nortel  
Networks cumulative consolidated loss position.  
Based on this review, Nortel Networks concluded that the valuation allowance as of December 31, 2003 was appropriate. Further, Nortel  
Networks determined that it was more likely than not that the remaining deferred tax assets would be realized. If market conditions  
deteriorate or future results of operations are less than expected, an additional tax valuation allowance may be required for all or a portion  
of Nortel Networks deferred tax assets.  
Nortel Networks is subject to ongoing examinations by certain taxation authorities of the jurisdictions in which it operates. Nortel  
Networks regularly assesses the status of these examinations and the potential for adverse outcomes to determine the adequacy of the  
provision for income and other taxes. Nortel Networks believes that it has adequately provided for tax adjustments that are probable as a  
result of any ongoing examination.  
Nortel Networks had previously entered into Advance Pricing Arrangements (“APAs”) with the taxation authorities of the U.S. and  
Canada in connection with its intercompany transfer pricing and cost sharing arrangements between Canada and the U.S. These  
arrangements expired in 1999 and 2000. In 2002, Nortel Networks filed APA requests with the taxation authorities of the U.S., Canada  
and the United Kingdom (“U.K.”) that are expected to apply to the taxation years beginning in 2000. The APA requests are currently  
under consideration. Nortel Networks has applied the transfer pricing methodology proposed in the APA requests since 2001. As part of  
the APA applications, Nortel Networks has requested that the methodology adopted in 2001 be applied retroactively to the 2000 taxation  
year. If the retroactive application is accepted by the taxation authorities, it would result in an increase in taxable income in certain  
jurisdictions offset by an equal decrease in taxable income in the other jurisdictions. Nortel Networks has provided for any taxes and  
interest that would be due as a result of retroactive application of the APAs.  
F-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Although the outcome of the APA applications are uncertain, Nortel Networks does not believe the ultimate resolution of these  
negotiations will have a material adverse effect on its consolidated financial position, results of operations or cash flows. However, if this  
matter is resolved unfavorably, it could have a material adverse effect on Nortel Networks consolidated financial position, results of  
operations or cash flows.  
The following is a reconciliation of income taxes, calculated at the Canadian combined federal and provincial income tax rate, to the  
income tax benefit (expense) included in the consolidated statements of operations for each of the years ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Income taxes at Canadian rates  
(2003 — 35.8%, 2002 — 39.4%, 2001 — 40.8%)  
Reduction of Canadian taxes applicable to manufacturing profits  
Difference between Canadian rates and rates applicable to subsidiaries in the U.S. and other jurisdictions  
Difference between basic Canadian rates and rates applicable to gain (loss) on sale of businesses  
Non-deductible amortization of acquired intangibles and IPR&D expense  
Foreign operation tax credit  
$
(101)  
(23)  
$
1,320  
(54)  
(33)  
(4)  
(219)  
$
10,541  
(64)  
(524)  
(128)  
(6,800)  
902  
Valuation allowances on tax benefits  
Utilization of losses  
(15)  
98  
(811)  
71  
(1,348)  
24  
Other  
121  
198  
148  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
$
$
80  
$
$
468  
$
$
2,751  
Details of Nortel Networks income (loss):  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes, minority interests and equity in net loss of associated  
companies:  
Canadian, excluding gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets  
U.S. and other, excluding gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets  
Gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets  
(201)  
478  
4
(1,270)  
(2,100)  
21  
(3,457)  
(22,242)  
(138)  
$
$
281  
$
$
(3,349)  
$ (25,837)  
Income tax benefit (expense):  
Canadian, excluding gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets  
U.S. and other, excluding gain (loss) on sale of businesses and assets  
Gain on sale of businesses and assets  
188  
(108)  
140  
335  
(7)  
$
$
329  
2,510  
(88)  
$
80  
$
468  
2,751  
Income tax benefit (expense):  
Current  
Deferred  
$
$
30  
50  
$
$
43  
425  
$
$
1,238  
1,513  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
80  
468  
2,751  
F-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following table shows the significant components included in deferred income taxes as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Assets:  
Tax benefit of loss carryforwards and tax credits  
Provisions and reserves  
Post-retirement benefits other than pensions  
Plant and equipment  
Pension plan liabilities  
Deferred compensation  
$
5,633  
714  
234  
122  
433  
277  
$
4,602  
1,735  
104  
72  
285  
32  
Unrealized losses on investments  
3
7,413  
6,833  
Valuation allowance  
(3,344)  
(3,024)  
4,069  
3,809  
Liabilities:  
Acquired technology  
Provisions and reserves  
Plant and equipment  
Other  
341  
48  
38  
679  
6
105  
51  
494  
774  
Net deferred income tax assets  
$
3,575  
$
3,035  
Subsequent to 2003, Nortel Networks determined that it expects to settle certain income tax matters which will result in a reduction of its  
provisions and reserves liability along with an offsetting reduction in its tax benefit of loss carryforwards and tax credits of approximately  
$140. The balance of the provisions and reserves liability relates to certain tax credit and transfer pricing matters, including the  
retroactive application of the APA.  
Nortel Networks has not provided for foreign withholding taxes or deferred income tax liabilities for temporary differences related to the  
undistributed earnings of foreign subsidiaries since Nortel Networks does not currently expect to repatriate these earnings. It is not  
practical to reasonably estimate the amount of additional deferred income tax liabilities or foreign withholding taxes that may be payable  
should these earnings be distributed in the future.  
As of December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks had the following net operating and capital loss carryforwards and tax credits which are  
scheduled to expire in the following years:  
Net  
Operating  
Capital  
losses  
Tax  
(b)  
(a)  
losses  
credits  
Total  
2004 - 2006  
2007 - 2009  
2010 - 2016  
2017 - 2023  
Indefinitely  
$
$
102  
776  
1,806  
3,251  
1,784  
$
$
80  
$
268  
319  
550  
243  
23  
$
$
370  
1,095  
2,436  
3,494  
6,233  
4,426  
7,719  
4,506  
$
1,403  
13,628  
(a)  
(b)  
The capital losses related primarily to the U.K. and may only be used to offset future capital gains. Nortel Networks has recorded a full valuation allowance against  
this future tax benefit.  
Global investment tax credits of $41, $78 and $154 have been applied against the income tax provision in 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively. Unused tax credits can  
be utilized to offset future income taxes payable primarily in Canada.  
9. Employee benefit plans  
Nortel Networks maintains various retirement programs covering substantially all of its employees, consisting of defined benefit, defined  
contribution and investment plans.  
Nortel Networks has four kinds of capital accumulation and retirement programs: balanced capital accumulation and retirement programs  
(the “Balanced Program”) and investor capital accumulation and retirement programs (the “Investor Program”) available to substantially  
all of its North American employees; flexible benefits plan, which includes a group personal pension plan (the “Flexible Benefits Plan”),  
available to substantially all of its employees in the U.K.; and traditional capital accumulation and retirement programs that include  
F-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
defined benefit pension plans (the “Traditional Program”) which are closed to new entrants in the U.K. and portions of which are closed  
to new entrants in the U.S. and Canada. Although these four kinds of programs represent Nortel Networks major retirement programs and  
may be available to employees in combination and/or as options within a program, Nortel Networks also has smaller pension plan  
arrangements in other countries. Certain of the prior year amounts for 2002 and 2001 have been adjusted to include pension plans not  
previously presented.  
Nortel Networks also provides other benefits, including post-retirement benefits and post-employment benefits. Employees in the  
Traditional Program are eligible for their existing company sponsored post-retirement benefits or a modified version of these benefits,  
depending on age or years of service. Employees in the Balanced Program are eligible for post-retirement benefits at reduced company  
contribution levels, while employees in the Investor Program have access to post-retirement benefits by purchasing a Nortel Networks-  
sponsored retiree health care plan at their own cost.  
Nortel Networks policy is to fund defined benefit pension and other benefits based on accepted actuarial methods as permitted by  
regulatory authorities. The funded amounts reflect actuarial assumptions regarding compensation, interest and other projections. Pension  
and other benefit costs reflected in the consolidated statements of operations are based on the projected benefit method of valuation. A  
measurement date of September 30 is used annually to determine pension and other post-retirement benefit measurements for the pension  
plans and other post-retirement benefit plans that make up the majority of plan assets and obligations.  
In 2003, the impact of reductions in discount rates and changes in foreign exchange rates more than offset the favorable impacts of strong  
pension asset returns and the voluntary contributions made by Nortel Networks. As a result, Nortel Networks was required to adjust the  
minimum pension liability for certain plans, representing the amount by which the accumulated benefit obligation less the fair value of  
the plan assets was greater than the recorded liability. The effect of this adjustment was to increase accumulated other comprehensive  
loss (before tax) by $219, increase intangible assets by $1 and increase pension liabilities by $220.  
F-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following details the unfunded status of the defined benefit plans and post-retirement benefits other than pensions, and the associated  
amounts recognized in the consolidated balance sheets as of December 31:  
Defined benefit plans  
Post-retirement benefits  
2003  
2002  
2003  
2002  
Change in benefit obligation:  
Benefit obligation — beginning  
Service cost  
Interest cost  
Plan participants’ contributions  
Plan amendments  
$
6,187  
118  
401  
7
$
6,053  
158  
402  
12  
$
568  
9
40  
3
$
529  
10  
37  
2
5
Actuarial loss (gain)  
Divestitures/settlements  
Benefits paid  
362  
(116)  
(459)  
850  
(19)  
(386)  
(320)  
287  
106  
(37)  
65  
20  
(3)  
(31)  
4
Foreign exchange  
Benefit obligation — ending  
$
$
7,355  
$
$
6,187  
$
$
754  
$
$
568  
Change in plan assets:  
Fair value of plan assets — beginning  
Actual return on plan assets  
Employer contributions  
Plan participants’ contributions  
Divestitures/settlements  
Benefits paid  
4,386  
626  
399  
5,009  
(270)  
153  
41  
3
31  
3
(37)  
9
41  
28  
2
(31)  
1
7
12  
(170)  
(459)  
626  
(424)  
(320)  
226  
Foreign exchange  
Fair value of plan assets — ending  
$
$
5,415  
$
$
4,386  
$
$
50  
$
$
41  
Unfunded status of the plans  
(1,940)  
(1)  
20  
1,664  
108  
(1,801)  
(4)  
20  
1,403  
113  
(704)  
(29)  
119  
3
(527)  
(31)  
13  
Unrecognized net plan benefits existing at January 1, 1987  
Unrecognized prior service cost (credit)  
Unrecognized net actuarial losses (gains)  
Contributions after measurement date  
Net amount recognized  
$
$
(149)  
$
$
(269)  
$
$
(611)  
$
$
(545)  
Amount recognized in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets consist of:  
Other liabilities — long-term  
Other liabilities — current  
(1,290)  
(72)  
(1,040)  
(93)  
41  
(581)  
(30)  
(516)  
(29)  
Intangible assets — net  
42  
Foreign currency translation adjustment  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss  
151  
1,020  
22  
801  
Net amount recognized  
$
(149)  
$
(269)  
$
(611)  
$
(545)  
The following details selected information for defined benefit plans, all of which have accumulated benefit obligations in excess of the  
fair value of plan assets as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Projected benefit obligation  
Accumulated benefit obligation  
Fair value of plan assets  
$
$
$
7,355  
6,797  
5,415  
$
$
$
6,187  
5,562  
4,386  
F-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following details the net pension expense and the underlying assumptions for the defined benefit plans for the years ended  
December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Pension expense:  
Service cost  
$
118  
401  
(395)  
9
50  
48  
$
158  
402  
(417)  
7
17  
94  
$
200  
413  
(470)  
8
(26)  
1
Interest cost  
Expected return on plan assets  
Amortization of prior service cost  
Amortization of net losses (gains)  
Settlement losses (gains)  
Curtailment losses (gains)  
40  
17  
Net pension expense  
$
$
$
231  
$
$
$
301  
$
$
$
143  
Allocation of net pension expense:  
Continuing operations  
Discontinued operations  
231  
301  
141  
2
Net pension expense  
231  
301  
143  
Weighted-average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations as at December 31:  
Discount rate  
5.8%  
3.7%  
6.3%  
3.7%  
6.7%  
3.7%  
Rate of compensation increase  
Weighted-average assumptions used to determine net pension expense for years ended December 31:  
Discount rate  
6.3%  
7.8%  
3.7%  
6.7%  
7.8%  
3.7%  
7.0%  
8.1%  
4.6%  
Expected rate of return on plan assets  
Rate of compensation increase  
The following details the amounts included within other comprehensive income (loss) for the year ended December 31:  
Defined benefit plans  
2003  
2002  
690  
Increase in minimum pension liability included in other comprehensive income (loss)  
$
219  
$
F-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following details the net cost components, all related to continuing operations, and underlying assumptions of post-retirement  
benefits other than pensions for the years ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Post-retirement benefit cost:  
Service cost  
Interest cost  
Expected return on plan assets  
Amortization  
Settlements and curtailments  
$
$
9
40  
(3)  
(3)  
$
$
10  
37  
(3)  
(3)  
(9)  
$
$
13  
36  
(3)  
(5)  
(21)  
Net post-retirement benefit cost  
43  
32  
20  
Weighted-average assumptions used to determine benefit obligations as at December 31:  
Discount rate  
6.0%  
6.8%  
7.0%  
Weighted-average assumptions used to determine net post-retirement benefit cost for years ended December 31:  
Discount rate  
Expected rate of return on plan assets  
Weighted-average health care cost trend rate  
Weighted-average ultimate health care cost trend rate  
Year in which ultimate health care cost trend rate will be achieved  
6.8%  
8.0%  
8.5%  
4.8%  
2010  
7.0%  
8.0%  
8.0%  
4.7%  
2009  
7.5%  
8.0%  
7.3%  
5.1%  
2005  
Assumed health care cost trend rates have a significant effect on the amounts reported for health care plans. A one percentage-point  
change in assumed health care cost trend rates would have the following effects for the years ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Effect on aggregate of service and interest costs  
1% increase  
1% decrease  
$
$
5
(4)  
$
$
5
(4)  
$
$
5
(4)  
Effect on accumulated post-retirement benefit obligations  
1% increase  
1% decrease  
$
$
66  
(55)  
$
$
57  
(46)  
$
$
56  
(46)  
The target allocation percentages and the year-end percentages based on actual asset balances of the defined benefit plans as of  
December 31 are as follows:  
2003  
2002  
Target  
Actual  
Target  
Actual  
Debt instruments  
Equity securities  
39%  
61%  
39%  
61%  
39%  
61%  
44%  
56%  
The primary investment objective of the defined benefit plans is to invest in a cost effective manner which will provide sufficient funding  
for the liabilities of these plans. The defined benefit plans maintain a long-term perspective in regard to investment philosophy and return  
expectations which are reflective of the fact that the liabilities of the defined benefit plans mature over an extended period of time. The  
investments have risk characteristics consistent with underlying defined benefit plan demographics and liquidity requirements, and are  
consistent and compliant with all regulatory standards.  
The primary investment performance objective is to obtain competitive rates of return on investments at or above their assigned  
benchmarks while minimizing risk and volatility by maintaining an appropriately diversified portfolio. The benchmarks selected are  
industry-standard and widely-accepted indices.  
The primary method of managing risk within the portfolio is through diversification among and within asset categories, and through the  
utilization of a wide array of active and passive investment managers. Broadly, the assets are allocated between debt and equity  
instruments. Included within the debt instruments are government and corporate fixed income securities, money market securities,  
mortgage-backed securities and inflation indexed securities. Generally, these debt  
F-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
instruments are considered investment grade. Included in equity securities are developed and emerging market stocks of companies at a  
variety of capitalization levels. The securities are predominantly publicly traded. The amount of employer and related-party securities  
that the defined benefit plans may hold is governed by the statutory limitations of the jurisdictions of the applicable plans. Included in  
equity securities of the defined benefit plans are common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation with an aggregate market value of $13  
(0.2 percent of total plan assets) and $3 (0.1 percent of total plan assets) as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively.  
As a policy, assets within the defined benefit plans are reviewed to the target allocations at least on a quarterly basis and adjustments  
made as appropriate. The plans commission periodic asset and liability studies to determine the optimal allocation of the portfolio’s  
assets. These studies consider a variety of the plan characteristics, including membership, benefits, and liquidity needs, and utilize mean-  
variance analysis of historic and projected investment returns to develop a range of acceptable asset mixes among a variety of asset  
classes.  
To develop the expected long-term rate of return on assets assumption, Nortel Networks considered the weighted-average historical  
returns and the future expectations for returns for each asset class.  
Nortel Networks made cash contributions of approximately $140 in 2004 to the defined benefit plans, which excluded $78 of deferred  
contributions for 2004 which were made in 2003, and approximately $30 in 2004 to the post-retirement benefit plans.  
Under the terms of the Balanced Program, Investor Program and Traditional Program, eligible employees may contribute a portion of  
their compensation to an investment plan. Based on the specific program that the employee is enrolled in, Nortel Networks matches a  
percentage of the employee’s contributions up to a certain limit. The cost of these investment plans was $73, $89 and $139 for the years  
ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Under the terms of the Balanced Program and Flexible Benefits Plan, Nortel Networks contributes a fixed percentage of employees’  
eligible earnings to a defined contribution plan arrangement. The cost of these plan arrangements was $17, $21 and $30 for the years  
ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
10. Acquisitions, divestitures and closures  
Acquisitions  
Nortel Networks Germany and Nortel Networks France  
On October 19, 2002, Nortel Networks, through various subsidiaries, entered into a number of put option and call option agreements as  
well as a share exchange agreement with European Aeronautic Defence and Space Company EADS N.V. (“EADS”), its partner at that  
time in three European joint ventures. The written options were marked to fair value through the consolidated statements of operations at  
each period end until they were exercised. At December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks estimated the fair value of the written options to be  
approximately $81, which was included within other accrued liabilities, and the corresponding loss was recorded in other income  
(expense) — net during the year ended December 31, 2002. A further mark to fair value adjustment and loss of $18 was recorded during  
the year ended December 31, 2003. The purchased options and the share exchange were initially recorded at fair value and were assessed  
for impairment throughout their term until they were exercised or expired. The estimated fair values of the options were based on an  
estimate of the current fair values of the respective joint ventures using an option-pricing model that is dependent on the assumptions  
used concerning the amount of volatility and the discount rates that reflect varying degrees of risk.  
On July 1, 2003, EADS exercised its put option to sell its minority interest of 45 percent in Nortel Networks France S.A.S. (“NNF”) to  
Nortel Networks. On July 18, 2003, Nortel Networks exercised its call option and share exchange rights to acquire the minority interest  
held by EADS of 42 percent in Nortel Networks Germany GmbH & Co. KG (“NNG”) and to sell Nortel Networks equity interest of  
41 percent in EADS Telecom S.A.S., formerly EADS Defence and Security Networks S.A.S (“EADS Telecom”) to EADS. The  
transactions were completed on September 18, 2003.  
During the three months ended September 30, 2003, Nortel Networks recorded the acquisitions of the minority interests of NNF and  
NNG based on preliminary valuation estimates totaling $241. The purchase price of $241 included $58 of cash, an in-kind component of  
approximately $82 representing the return of a loan note that was owed to Nortel Networks by EADS Telecom and the remaining shares  
of EADS Telecom held by Nortel Networks. The allocation of the purchase price resulted in the elimination of $23 of minority interest,  
settlement of a net liability of $94 related to the  
F-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
put and call options and an increase of $45 in intangible assets and $79 in goodwill. The intangible assets of $45 related primarily to  
customer contracts and customer relationships and are being amortized based on their expected pattern of benefit to future periods using  
estimates of undiscounted cash flows, and were included in intangible assets on the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2003.  
The sale of Nortel Networks 41 percent interest in EADS Telecom has resulted in the receipt of cash of $12 and a reduction in equity  
investments of $23. As a result of this transaction, Nortel Networks recognized a gain of $79 which is included in other income (expense)  
— net for the year ended December 31, 2003. Except as noted below, there was no additional impact on the results of operations and  
financial condition, as NNF and NNG were already included in the consolidated results.  
During the three months ended December 31, 2003, the valuation report for NNF and NNG was completed by a third party appraiser. As  
a result of the finalization of this valuation, an additional gain of $17 was recorded with a corresponding increase in goodwill on the  
transaction (see note 5 for goodwill by reportable segment).  
Other acquisitions  
The following table sets out certain information for an acquisition completed by Nortel Networks in the year ended December 31, 2001,  
and excludes those entities acquired which were subsequently included as discontinued operations (see note 20). This acquisition was  
accounted for using the purchase method. The consolidated financial statements include the operating results of this business from the  
date of acquisition.  
Purchase price allocation  
Net tangible  
assets  
(liabilities)  
Deferred  
stock option  
compensation  
Purchase  
price  
Acquired  
technology  
Closing date  
Acquisition  
Goodwill  
IPR&D  
2001  
February 13  
(a) (b)  
980 NPLC business  
$
2,291  
$
1,890  
$
402  
$
15  
$
(16)  
$
(a)  
(b)  
The 980 NPLC business consisted of the design and manufacture of G08 980 nanometer pump-laser chips.  
Excludes additional consideration that may become payable.  
F-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In connection with the acquisition of the 980 NPLC business from JDS, Nortel Networks Corporation issued approximately 65.7 million  
common shares. The Purchase Agreement included additional consideration, not included in the purchase price, which would be payable  
after December 31, 2003 in common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation. The actual number of common shares to be issued to satisfy  
the additional consideration was between 10.9 million and 16.4 million common shares depending on Nortel Networks Corporation  
common share price at that date. A purchase arrangement with JDS may reduce in whole or in part the number of common shares that  
Nortel Networks would be required to deliver. There were no assumed options, assumed warrants or cash included as part of the  
acquisition. As of December 31, 2003, the purchase arrangement was completed (see note 14).  
Divestitures  
Sale of Arris Group, Inc. investment  
On November 24, 2003, Nortel Networks sold 9 million shares of Arris Group, Inc. (“Arris Group”) for cash consideration of $49, which  
resulted in a gain of $31. Following this transaction, Nortel Networks owned 5 million Arris Group common shares or 6.6 percent of  
Arris Group outstanding common shares (see note 20).  
High speed module operations  
On August 10, 2003, Nortel Networks sold certain assets related to its high speed module operations to BreconRidge Manufacturing  
Solutions Corporation (“BreconRidge”). Nortel Networks received proceeds of $6 in the form of cash and a note receivable. As a result  
of this transaction, Nortel Networks recorded a loss of $1 during the year ended December 31, 2003. The transaction included a minimum  
purchase commitment with BreconRidge requiring Nortel Networks to purchase approximately $11 and $33 of products during 2003 and  
2004, respectively (see note 14).  
Optical components operations  
On November 8, 2002, Nortel Networks sold certain plant and equipment, inventory, patents and other intellectual property and  
trademarks relating to its optical components business to Bookham. Included in the sale was the transfer of Nortel Networks transmitter  
and receiver, pump laser and amplifier businesses located in Paignton, U.K., Harlow, U.K., Ottawa, Canada, Zurich, Switzerland and  
Poughkeepsie, New York. Nortel Networks also transferred approximately 1,200 employees to Bookham in the transaction. Nortel  
Networks received 61 million common shares of Bookham, 9 million warrants with a strike price of one-third pence Sterling, notes  
receivable of $50 and cash of $10. The transaction included a minimum purchase commitment with Bookham requiring Nortel Networks  
to purchase approximately $120 of product from Bookham between November 8, 2002 and March 31, 2004 (see note 14).  
During the three months ended September 30, 2002, Nortel Networks classified the assets sold to Bookham as held for sale and assigned  
an estimated fair value of $47 to them resulting in a charge of $123 ($89 to cost of revenues and $34 to special charges). A subsequent  
increase in Bookham’s common share price prior to the November 8, 2002 close date resulted in an increase in the value assigned to the  
consideration received. As a result, Nortel Networks recorded a gain on sale of businesses and assets of $29 during the year ended  
December 31, 2002.  
As a result of the transaction, Nortel Networks received a 29.8 percent ownership interest in Bookham. Due to restrictions on Nortel  
Networks ability to vote the common shares, ability to appoint directors to the board or otherwise exercise significant influence over  
Bookham, the investment has been accounted for using the cost method.  
During 2003, Nortel Networks sold 30 million shares of Bookham for cash proceeds of $32 and recorded a gain of $6 which is included  
in other income (expense) — net for the year ended December 31, 2003. As a result of this transaction, Nortel Networks reduced its  
ownership interest in Bookham to approximately 14 percent.  
Service commerce operations  
On February 1, 2002, Nortel Networks sold to MetaSolv, Inc. (“MetaSolv”) certain assets of its Service Commerce operation support  
system (“OSS”) business and MetaSolv assumed certain liabilities. The transaction included software assets obtained as part of the  
Architel Systems Corporation (“Architel”) acquisition and certain additional assets of Nortel Networks service management and business  
management OSS groups. Nortel Networks received proceeds of $35 and recorded a gain on sale of $10 related to the transaction in  
2002. During the year ended December 31, 2001, Nortel Networks recorded a write down of the carrying value of the Architel assets  
identified for disposition of $233 to estimated net realizable value.  
F-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sale of Clarify  
On November 28, 2001, Nortel Networks sold substantially all of the assets of its then wholly owned subsidiary, Clarify, including  
patents, intellectual property and trademarks, to Amdocs Limited for approximately $200 in cash, resulting in a gain of $16.  
Closures  
As part of its restructuring work plan initiated in 2001, Nortel Networks closed the operations of CoreTek and Xros in 2002. In 2001,  
Nortel Networks closed the operations of EPiCON, Photonic and Dimension (see note 7).  
As described in note 7, the amount of goodwill and acquired technology associated with a number of Nortel Networks prior acquisitions  
was written down by $622 and $11,833, during the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
11. Long-term debt, credit and support facilities  
Long-term debt  
The following table shows the components of long-term debt as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
6.00% Notes due September 1, 2003  
6.125% Notes due February 15, 2006  
7.40% Notes due June 15, 2006  
$
$
164  
1,314  
1,275  
(a)  
150  
1,800  
200  
150  
20  
53  
184  
178  
150  
1,800  
200  
150  
88  
72  
265  
4.25% Convertible Senior Notes due September 1, 2008  
6.875% Notes due September 1, 2023  
(a)  
7.875% Notes due June 15, 2026  
Other long-term debt with various repayment terms and a weighted-average interest rate of 3.49% for 2003 and 4.60% for 2002  
Fair value adjustment attributable to hedged debt obligations  
Obligations associated with consolidated VIEs  
(b)  
(c)  
Obligations under capital leases and sale leasebacks  
4,010  
119  
4,203  
243  
Less: Long-term debt due within one year  
Long-term debt  
$
3,891  
$
3,960  
(a)  
Notes were issued by Nortel Networks Capital Corporation, an indirect wholly owned finance subsidiary of NNL, and are fully and unconditionally guaranteed by  
NNL.  
(b)  
(c)  
Represents obligations of certain VIEs consolidated prospectively, as required by FIN 46R, of $184 as of December 31, 2003 (see note 4(d)).  
Included lease obligations recorded prospectively, in accordance with EITF 01-8, of $2 as of December 31, 2003 (see note 4(h)).  
As of December 31, 2003, the amounts of long-term debt payable for each of the years ending December 31 consisted of:  
2004  
2005  
2006  
2007  
2008  
Thereafter  
$
$
119  
16  
1,492  
15  
1,816  
552  
Total long-term debt payable  
4,010  
F-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On August 15, 2001, Nortel Networks completed an offering of $1,800 of 4.25% convertible Senior Notes (the “Senior Notes”), due on  
September 1, 2008. The Senior Notes pay interest on a semi-annual basis on March 1 and September 1, which began March 1, 2002. The  
Senior Notes are convertible, at any time by holders into common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation, at an initial conversion price of  
$10 per common share, subject to adjustment upon the occurrence of certain events. Nortel Networks may redeem some or all of the  
Senior Notes in cash at any time on or after September 7, 2004 at a redemption price of between 100% and 102.125% of the principal  
amount of the Senior Notes, depending on the redemption date, plus accrued and unpaid interest and additional interest, if any, to the date  
of the redemption. In addition, Nortel Networks may be required to redeem the Senior Notes in cash and/or common shares of Nortel  
Networks Corporation under certain circumstances such as a change in control, or Nortel Networks may redeem the Senior Notes at its  
option under certain circumstances such as a change in the applicable Canadian withholding tax legislation. NNL is the full and  
unconditional guarantor of the Senior Notes in the event Nortel Networks does not make payments for the principal, interest, premium, if  
any, or other amounts, if any, as they are due. The guarantee is a direct, unconditional and unsubordinated obligation of NNL.  
On February 8, 2001, NNL completed an offering of $1,500 of 6.125% Notes due on February 15, 2006 (the “6.125% Notes”). The  
6.125% Notes pay interest on a semi-annual basis on February 15 and August 15, which began on August 15, 2001. The 6.125% Notes  
are redeemable, at any time at NNL’s option, at a redemption price equal to the principal amount thereof plus accrued and unpaid interest  
and a make-whole premium.  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks purchased a portion of its 6.125% Notes with a face value of $39. The  
transaction resulted in a gain of $4 which was included in the consolidated statement of operations within other income (expense) — net  
for the year ended December 31, 2003.  
During the year ended December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks paid $162 to purchase a portion of its 6.00% Notes due on September 1,  
2003 and its 6.125% Notes with carrying values of $36 and $186, respectively. The early extinguishment of debt resulted in a gain of $60  
which was included in the consolidated statement of operations within other income (expense) — net for the year ended December 31,  
2002.  
During the year ended December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks sold an office building for $24 and concurrent with the sale Nortel Networks  
leased the property back for a period of fifteen years at an average annual rental of $3. The lease is renewable at Nortel Networks option  
for four additional five year terms. The lease requires that a letter of credit for $1 be provided while Nortel Networks bonds are rated  
below investment grade. As a result of the letter of credit structure, the transaction has been recorded as a financing transaction rather  
than a sale, and the building and related accounts will continue to be recognized in the consolidated financial statements.  
During the year ended December 31, 2001, Nortel Networks sold an office building for $9 and, concurrent with the sale, Nortel Networks  
leased the property back for a period of fifteen years at an average annual rental of $1. The lease is renewable at Nortel Networks option  
for three additional five year terms. The lease requires that Nortel Networks indemnify the landlord against environmental contamination  
caused by unrelated third parties during the lease term. As a result of the indemnification, the transaction has been recorded as a financing  
transaction rather than a sale, and the building and related accounts will continue to be recognized in the consolidated financial  
statements.  
During the year ended December 31, 2001, Nortel Networks sold an office building for $137 and, concurrent with the sale, Nortel  
Networks leased the property back for a period of fifteen years at an average annual rental of $18. The lease is renewable at Nortel  
Networks option for four additional five year terms. The lease is classified as a capital lease. As such, the transaction has been recorded  
as a financing transaction rather than a sale, and the building and related accounts will continue to be recognized in the consolidated  
financial statements.  
See note 23 for additional information related to Nortel Networks and NNL’s debt securities.  
Credit facilities  
As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, Nortel Networks had total unused committed credit facilities of $750 under the NNL and Nortel  
Networks Inc. (“NNI”) $750 April 2000 five year credit facilities (the “Five Year Facilities”). See note 23 for additional information.  
F-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Support facility  
On February 14, 2003, Nortel Networks principal operating subsidiary, NNL, entered into an agreement with Export Development  
Canada (“EDC”) regarding arrangements to provide for support, on a secured basis, of certain performance related obligations arising out  
of normal course business activities for the benefit of Nortel Networks (the “EDC Support Facility”). On July 10, 2003, NNL and EDC  
amended the terms of the EDC Support Facility by extending the termination date of the facility to December 31, 2005 from June 30,  
2004 (see notes 23 and 24).  
As of December 31, 2003, the EDC Support Facility provided for up to $750 in support including $300 of committed revolving support  
for performance bonds or similar instruments, of which $151 was utilized, $150 of uncommitted support for receivables sales and/or  
securitizations, of which none was utilized, and $300 of uncommitted support for performance bonds and/or receivables sales and/or  
securitizations, of which $183 was utilized (see note 23).  
On February 14, 2003, NNL’s obligations under the EDC Support Facility became secured on an equal and ratable basis under the  
security agreements entered into by NNL and various of its subsidiaries that pledged substantially all of the assets of NNL in favor of the  
banks under the Five Year Facilities and the holders of Nortel Networks public debt securities. This security became effective in favor of  
the banks and the public debt holders on April 4, 2002 (for additional information relating to the EDC Support Facility and the related  
security agreements, see notes 23 and 24).  
12. Financial instruments and hedging activities  
Risk management  
Nortel Networks net earnings (loss) and cash flows may be negatively impacted by fluctuating interest rates, foreign exchange rates and  
equity prices. To effectively manage these market risks, Nortel Networks enters into foreign currency forwards, foreign currency swaps,  
foreign currency option contracts, interest rate swaps and equity forward contracts. Nortel Networks does not hold or issue derivative  
financial instruments for trading purposes.  
Foreign currency risk  
Nortel Networks enters into option contracts to limit its exposure to exchange fluctuations on future revenue or expenditure streams  
expected to occur within the next twelve months, and forward contracts, which are denominated in various currencies, to limit its  
exposure to exchange fluctuations on existing assets and liabilities and on future revenue or expenditure streams expected to occur within  
the next twelve months. Option and forward contracts used to hedge future revenue or expenditure streams are designated as cash flow  
hedges and hedge specific exposures. Option and forward contracts that do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting are also used to  
economically hedge the impact of fluctuations in exchange rates on existing assets and liabilities and on future revenue and expenditure  
streams.  
The following table provides a summary of the total notional amounts of option and forward contracts as of December 31:  
(a)  
(b)  
Currency  
2003  
2002  
Options  
Canadian dollar  
Forwards  
Canadian dollar  
British pound  
Euro  
$
$
37  
$
$
52  
375  
435  
74  
920  
8
555  
75  
Other  
206  
1,127  
1,610  
(a)  
(b)  
All notional amounts of option and forward contracts matured no later than the end of 2004.  
All notional amounts of option and forward contracts matured no later than the end of 2003.  
Interest rate risk  
Nortel Networks enters into interest rate swap contracts to minimize the impact of interest rate fluctuations on the fair value of its long-  
term debt. These contracts swap fixed interest rate payments for floating rate payments and certain swaps are designated as fair value  
hedges. The fair value adjustment related to the effective portion of interest rate  
F-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
swaps and the corresponding fair value adjustment to the hedged debt obligation included within long-term debt are recorded to interest  
expense within the consolidated statements of operations. These swap contracts have remaining terms to maturity between 2 and  
2.5 years.  
On January 27, 2003, various cross currency coupon swaps (notional amount of Canadian $350) were terminated. There was no impact to  
net earnings (loss) on termination as these instruments were not designated as hedges and changes in fair value were previously  
accounted for in the consolidated statements of operations.  
Hedge ineffectiveness and the discontinuance of cash flow hedges and fair value hedges that were accounted for in accordance with  
SFAS 133 had no material impact on the net earnings (loss) for the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002 and were reported within  
other income (expense) — net in the consolidated statements of operations.  
The following table provides a summary of interest rate swap contracts and cross currency coupon swap contracts and their aggregated  
weighted-average rates as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Interest rate swap contracts:  
Received-fixed swaps — notional amount  
Average fixed rate received  
$
$
875  
6.3%  
2.6%  
$
$
975  
6.3%  
3.2%  
Average floating rate paid  
Cross currency coupon swap contracts:  
Received-cross currency coupon swaps — notional amount  
Average floating rate received (Canadian $)  
Average floating rate paid (U.S. $)  
224  
2.9%  
1.5%  
Equity price risk  
Nortel Networks enters into equity forward contracts with terms from eight to fourteen months to hedge the variability in future cash  
flows associated with certain compensation obligations that vary based on future Nortel Networks Corporation common share prices.  
These contracts fix the price of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares and are cash settled on maturity to offset changes in the  
compensation liability based on changes in the share price from the inception of the forward contract. Certain equity forward contracts  
are designated as cash flow hedges when all criteria for hedge accounting are met and the changes in fair value of the forward contract  
are recorded in OCI and reclassified to SG&A when the underlying compensation expense is recorded. Other equity forward contracts  
that are not designated in a hedging relationship and are considered economic hedges of the compensation obligation are carried at fair  
value with changes in fair value recorded in other income (expense) — net. The total notional amount of these contracts as of  
December 31, 2003 and 2002 was $47 and $4, respectively, and the average fixed Nortel Networks Corporation common share price was  
$3.45 and $2.42, respectively. The fair value of these contracts as of December 31, 2003 and 2002 was $10 and $(2), respectively.  
Fair value  
The estimated fair values approximate amounts at which financial instruments could be exchanged in a current transaction between  
willing parties. The fair values are based on estimates using present value and other valuation techniques that are significantly affected by  
the assumptions used concerning the amount and timing of estimated future cash flows and discount rates that reflect varying degrees of  
risk. Specifically, the fair value of interest rate swaps and forward contracts reflected: the present value of the expected future cash flows  
if settlement had taken place on December 31, 2003 and 2002; the fair value of option contracts reflected the cash flows due to or by  
Nortel Networks if settlement had taken place on December 31, 2003 and 2002; and the fair value of long-term debt instruments reflected  
a current yield valuation based on observed market prices as of December 31, 2003 and 2002. Accordingly, the fair value estimates are  
not necessarily indicative of the amounts that Nortel Networks could potentially realize in a current market exchange.  
F-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following table provides the carrying amounts and fair values for financial assets and liabilities for which fair value differed from the  
carrying amount and fair values recorded for derivative financial instruments in accordance with SFAS 133 as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Carrying  
amount  
Fair  
value  
Carrying  
amount  
Fair  
value  
Financial liabilities:  
Long-term debt due within one year  
Long-term debt  
$
$
119  
3,891  
$
$
119  
3,812  
$
$
243  
3,960  
$
$
234  
2,413  
Derivative financial instruments net asset (liability) position:  
(a)  
Interest rate swap contracts  
$
$
$
61  
19  
$
$
$
61  
19  
$
$
$
80  
(28)  
1
$
$
$
80  
(28)  
1
(b)  
Forward and option contracts  
(a )  
Cross currency coupon swap contracts  
(a)  
(b)  
Recorded in other assets.  
Comprised of other assets of $34 and other liabilities of $15 as of December 31, 2003, and other assets of $10 and other liabilities of $38 as of December 31, 2002.  
Credit risk  
Credit risk on financial instruments arises from the potential for counterparties to default on their contractual obligations to Nortel  
Networks. Nortel Networks is exposed to credit risk in the event of non-performance, but does not anticipate non-performance by any of  
the counterparties. Nortel Networks limits its credit risk by dealing with counterparties that are considered to be of high credit quality.  
The maximum potential loss on all financial instruments may exceed amounts recognized in the consolidated financial statements.  
However, Nortel Networks maximum exposure to credit loss in the event of non-performance by the other party to the derivative  
contracts is limited to those derivatives that had a positive fair value of $95 as of December 31, 2003. Nortel Networks is also exposed to  
credit risk from customers. However, Nortel Networks global orientation has resulted in a large number of diverse customers which  
minimizes concentrations of credit risk.  
Other derivatives  
Nortel Networks may invest in warrants to purchase securities of other companies as a strategic investment or receive warrants in various  
transactions. Warrants that relate to publicly traded companies or that can be net share settled are deemed derivative financial instruments  
under SFAS 133. Such warrants are generally not eligible to be designated as hedging instruments as there is no corresponding  
underlying exposure. In addition, Nortel Networks may enter into certain commercial contracts containing derivative financial  
instruments.  
Receivables sales  
In 2003, 2002 and 2001, Nortel Networks entered into various agreements to sell certain of its receivables. These receivables were sold at  
a discount of $20, $25 and $36 from book value for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively, at annualized  
discount rates of approximately 2 percent to 6 percent, 3 percent to 5 percent and 5 percent to 8 percent for the years ended December 31,  
2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively. Certain receivables have been sold with limited recourse, not exceeding 10 percent, of $7, $9 and $7  
as of December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Under certain agreements, Nortel Networks has continued as servicing agent and/or has provided limited recourse. The fair value of these  
retained interests is based on the market value of servicing the receivables, historical payment patterns and appropriate discount rates as  
applicable. Generally, trade receivables that are sold do not experience prepayments. Nortel Networks, when acting as the servicing  
agent, generally does not record an asset or liability related to servicing as the annual servicing fees are equivalent to those that would be  
paid to a third party servicing agent. Also, Nortel Networks has not historically experienced significant credit losses with respect to  
receivables sold with limited recourse and, as such, no liability was recognized.  
F-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, total accounts receivable securitized and under Nortel Networks management were $359 and $423,  
respectively.  
There is a possibility that the actual performance of receivables or the cost of servicing the receivables will differ from the assumptions  
used to determine fair values at the transfer date and at each reporting date. Assuming hypothetical, simultaneous, unfavorable variations  
of up to 20 percent in credit losses, discount rate used and cost of servicing the receivables, the pre-tax impact on the value of the retained  
interests and servicing assets would not be significant.  
13. Guarantees  
Nortel Networks has entered into agreements that contain features which meet the definition of a guarantee under FIN 45. FIN 45 defines  
a guarantee as a contract that contingently requires Nortel Networks to make payments (either in cash, financial instruments, other assets,  
common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation or through the provision of services) to a third party based on changes in an underlying  
economic characteristic (such as interest rates or market value) that is related to an asset, a liability or an equity security of the guaranteed  
party or a third party’s failure to perform under a specified agreement. A description of the major types of Nortel Networks outstanding  
guarantees as of December 31, 2003 is provided below:  
(a) Business sale and business combination agreements  
In connection with agreements for the sale of portions of its business, including certain discontinued operations, Nortel Networks  
has typically retained the liabilities of a business which relate to events occurring prior to its sale, such as tax, environmental,  
litigation and employment matters. Nortel Networks generally indemnifies the purchaser of a Nortel Networks business in the event  
that a third party asserts a claim against the purchaser that relates to a liability retained by Nortel Networks. Some of these types of  
guarantees have indefinite terms while others have specific terms extending to June 2008.  
Nortel Networks also entered into guarantees related to the escrow of shares in business combinations in prior periods. These types  
of agreements generally include indemnities that require Nortel Networks to indemnify counterparties for loss incurred from  
litigation that may be suffered by counterparties arising under such agreements. These types of indemnities apply over a specified  
period of time from the date of the business combinations and do not provide for any limit on the maximum potential amount.  
Nortel Networks is unable to estimate the maximum potential liability for these types of indemnification guarantees as the business  
sale agreements generally do not specify a maximum amount and the amounts are dependent upon the outcome of future contingent  
events, the nature and likelihood of which cannot be determined.  
Historically, Nortel Networks has not made any significant indemnification payments under such agreements and no significant  
liability has been accrued in the consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligations associated with these guarantees.  
In conjunction with the sale of a subsidiary to a third party, Nortel Networks guaranteed to the purchaser that specified annual  
volume levels would be achieved by the business sold over a ten year period ending December 31, 2007. The maximum amount  
that Nortel Networks may be required to pay under the volume guarantee as of December 31, 2003 is $8. A liability of $6 has been  
accrued in the consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligation associated with this guarantee as of December 31,  
2003.  
(b) Intellectual property indemnification obligations  
Nortel Networks has periodically entered into agreements with customers and suppliers that include limited intellectual property  
indemnification obligations that are customary in the industry. These types of guarantees typically have indefinite terms and  
generally require Nortel Networks to compensate the other party for certain damages and costs incurred as a result of third party  
intellectual property claims arising from these transactions.  
F-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The nature of the intellectual property indemnification obligations generally prevents Nortel Networks from making a reasonable  
estimate of the maximum potential amount it could be required to pay to its customers and suppliers. Historically, Nortel Networks  
has not made any significant indemnification payments under such agreements. A liability of $6 has been accrued in the  
consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligations associated with these guarantees as of December 31, 2003.  
(c) Lease agreements  
Nortel Networks has entered into agreements with its lessors that guarantee the lease payments of certain assignees of its facilities  
to lessors. Generally, these lease agreements relate to facilities Nortel Networks vacated prior to the end of the term of its lease.  
These lease agreements require Nortel Networks to make lease payments throughout the lease term if the assignee fails to make  
scheduled payments. Most of these lease agreements also require Nortel Networks to pay for facility restoration costs at the end of  
the lease term if the assignee fails to do so. These lease agreements have expiration dates through June 2015. The maximum amount  
that Nortel Networks may be required to pay under these types of agreements is $57 as of December 31, 2003. Nortel Networks  
generally has the ability to attempt to recover such lease payments from the defaulting party through rights of subrogation.  
Historically, Nortel Networks has not made any significant payments under these types of guarantees and no significant liability has  
been accrued in the consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligations associated with these guarantees.  
(d) Third party debt agreements  
Nortel Networks has guaranteed the debt of certain customers. These third party debt agreements require Nortel Networks to make  
debt payments throughout the term of the related debt instrument if the customer fails to make scheduled debt payments. These  
third party debt agreements have expiration dates extending to May 2012. The maximum amount that Nortel Networks may be  
required to pay under these types of debt agreements is $8 as of December 31, 2003. Under most such arrangements, the Nortel  
Networks guarantee is secured, usually by the assets being purchased or financed. A liability of $7 has been accrued in the  
consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligations associated with these financial guarantees as of December 31,  
2003.  
(e) Indemnification of banks and agents under credit facilities, EDC Support Facility and security  
agreements  
As of December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks had agreed to indemnify the banks and agents under its credit facilities against costs or  
losses resulting from changes in laws and regulations which would increase the banks’ costs or reduce their return and from any  
legal action brought against the banks or agents related to the use of loan proceeds. Nortel Networks has also agreed to indemnify  
EDC under the EDC Support Facility against any legal action brought against EDC that relates to the provision of support under the  
EDC Support Facility. Nortel Networks has also agreed to indemnify the collateral agent under the security agreements against any  
legal action brought against the collateral agent in connection with the collateral pledged under the security agreements. These  
indemnifications generally apply to issues that arise during the term of the credit and support facilities, or for as long as the security  
agreements remain in effect (see notes 11, 23 and 24).  
Nortel Networks is unable to estimate the maximum potential liability for these types of indemnification guarantees as the  
agreements typically do not specify a maximum amount and the amounts are dependent upon the outcome of future contingent  
events, the nature and likelihood of which cannot be determined at this time.  
Historically, Nortel Networks has not made any significant indemnification payments under such agreements and no significant  
liability has been accrued in the consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligations associated with these  
indemnification guarantees.  
F-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Nortel Networks has agreed to indemnify its counterparties in receivables securitization transactions. The indemnifications  
provided to counterparties in these types of transactions may require Nortel Networks to compensate counterparties for costs  
incurred as a result of changes in laws and regulations (including tax legislation) or in the interpretations of such laws and  
regulations, or as a result of regulatory penalties that may be suffered by the counterparty as a consequence of the transaction.  
Certain receivables securitization transactions include indemnifications requiring the repurchase of the receivables if the particular  
transaction becomes invalid. As of December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks had approximately $327 of securitized receivables which  
were subject to repurchase under this provision, in which case Nortel Networks would assume all rights to collect such receivables.  
The indemnification provisions generally expire upon expiration of the securitization agreements, which extend through 2005, or  
collection of the receivable amounts by the counterparty.  
Nortel Networks is generally unable to estimate the maximum potential liability for all of these types of indemnification guarantees  
as certain agreements do not specify a maximum amount and the amounts are dependent upon the outcome of future contingent  
events, the nature and likelihood of which cannot be determined at this time.  
Historically, Nortel Networks has not made any significant indemnification payments or receivable repurchases under such  
agreements and no significant liability has been accrued in the consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligations  
associated with these guarantees.  
(f) Other indemnification agreements  
Nortel Networks has also entered into other agreements that provide indemnifications to counterparties in certain transactions  
including investment banking agreements, guarantees related to the administration of capital trust accounts, guarantees related to  
the administration of employee benefit plans, indentures for its outstanding public debt and asset sale agreements (other than the  
business sale agreements noted above). These indemnification agreements generally require Nortel Networks to indemnify the  
counterparties for costs incurred as a result of changes in laws and regulations (including tax legislation) or in the interpretations of  
such laws and regulations and/or as a result of losses from litigation that may be suffered by the counterparties arising from the  
transactions. These types of indemnification agreements normally extend over an unspecified period of time from the date of the  
transaction and do not typically provide for any limit on the maximum potential payment amount.  
The nature of such agreements prevents Nortel Networks from making a reasonable estimate of the maximum potential amount it  
could be required to pay to its counterparties. The difficulties in assessing the amount of liability result primarily from the  
unpredictability of future changes in laws, the inability to determine how laws apply to counterparties and the lack of limitations on  
the potential liability.  
Historically, Nortel Networks has not made any significant indemnification payments under such agreements and no significant  
liability has been accrued in the consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligations associated with these guarantees.  
Product warranties  
The following summarizes the accrual for product warranties that was recorded as part of other accrued liabilities in the consolidated  
balance sheets as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
Payments  
Warranties issued  
Revisions  
$
$
408  
(347)  
337  
$
$
469  
(370)  
317  
(11)  
(8)  
Balance at the end of the year  
387  
408  
14. Commitments  
Bid, performance related and other bonds  
Nortel Networks has entered into bid, performance related and other bonds associated with various contracts. Bid bonds generally have a  
term of less than twelve months, depending on the length of the bid period for the applicable contract.  
F-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Performance related and other bonds generally have a term of twelve months and are typically renewed, as required, over the term of the  
applicable contract. The various contracts to which these bonds apply generally have terms ranging from two to five years. Any potential  
payments which might become due under these bonds would be related to Nortel Networks non-performance under the applicable  
contract. Historically, Nortel Networks has not had to make material payments under these types of bonds and does not anticipate that  
any material payments will be required in the future. The following table sets forth the maximum potential amount of future payments  
under bid, performance related and other bonds, net of the corresponding restricted cash and cash equivalents, as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
(a)  
Bid and performance related bonds  
Other bonds  
$
$
427  
53  
$
$
299  
136  
(b)  
Total bid, performance related and other bonds  
480  
435  
(a)  
(b)  
Net of restricted cash and cash equivalent amounts of $14 and $188 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively.  
Net of restricted cash and cash equivalent amounts of $31 and $26 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively.  
Customer financing  
Pursuant to certain financing agreements, Nortel Networks is committed to provide future financing in connection with purchases of  
Nortel Networks products and services. Commitments to extend future financing generally have conditions for funding, fixed expiration  
or termination dates and specific interest rates and purposes. Nortel Networks attempts to limit its financing credit risk by utilizing an  
internal credit committee that monitors the credit exposure of Nortel Networks. The following table sets forth customer financing related  
information and commitments, excluding discontinued operations, as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Drawn and outstanding — gross  
Provisions for doubtful accounts  
$
$
401  
(281)  
$
$
1,120  
(824)  
(a)  
Drawn and outstanding — net  
Undrawn commitments  
120  
180  
296  
831  
(b)  
Total customer financing  
300  
1,127  
(a)  
(b)  
Included short-term and long-term amounts. Short-term and long-term amounts were included in accounts receivable — net and other assets, respectively, in the  
consolidated balance sheets.  
See note 23.  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks recorded net customer financing bad debt recoveries of $113 as a result of  
settlements and adjustments to other existing provisions. During the year ended December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks recorded net  
customer financing bad debt expense of $171. The recoveries and expense were included in the consolidated statements of operations  
within SG&A.  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks entered into certain agreements to restructure and/or settle various customer  
financing and related receivables. As a result of these transactions, Nortel Networks received cash consideration of approximately $230  
to settle outstanding receivables of approximately $610 (with a net carrying value of $120). Additional non-cash consideration received  
under one such restructuring agreement included a five year equipment and services supply agreement and the mutual release of all other  
claims between the parties.  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks reduced undrawn customer financing commitments by $651 as a result of  
the expiration or cancellation of commitments and changing customer business plans. As of December 31, 2003, approximately $108 of  
the $180 in undrawn commitments was not available for funding under the terms of the financing agreements.  
Venture capital financing  
Nortel Networks has entered into agreements with selected venture capital firms where the venture capital firms make and manage  
investments in start-ups and emerging enterprises. The agreements require Nortel Networks to fund requests for additional capital up to  
its commitments when and if requests for additional capital are solicited by the venture capital  
F-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
firm. Nortel Networks had remaining commitments, if requested, of $24 and $30 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. These  
commitments expire at various dates through 2012.  
Purchase commitments  
Nortel Networks has entered into purchase commitments with certain suppliers under which it commits to buy a minimum amount or  
percentage of designated products in exchange for price guarantees or similar concessions. In certain of these agreements, Nortel  
Networks may be required to acquire and pay for such products up to the prescribed minimum or forecasted purchases.  
During the third quarter of 2003, Nortel Networks renegotiated a key supply arrangement with a supplier. The renegotiated agreement  
requires that $2,800 in aggregate purchases with the supplier be made between June 2003 and June 2009. As of December 31, 2003, the  
remaining purchase commitment under the agreement was $2,300. The renegotiated agreement includes a graduated liquidated damages  
remedy for the benefit of the supplier if the minimum purchase commitment is not met by the end of the agreement in 2009, however,  
Nortel Networks expects to meet the minimum purchase commitment.  
Nortel Networks entered into an arrangement with a minimum purchase commitment of $120 with Bookham. The terms of the  
commitment require Nortel Networks to purchase $120 of product from Bookham between November 8, 2002 and May 31, 2004. The  
purchase commitment was fully met by December 31, 2004.  
Nortel Networks entered into an arrangement with BreconRidge with purchase commitments of approximately $11 and $33 of products  
during 2003 and 2004, respectively. The 2003 and 2004 commitments have both been met.  
Nortel Networks has agreed with JDS that if Nortel Networks purchased a minimum amount of designated products determined as a  
percentage of Nortel Networks total purchases for such products during the period from January 1, 2001 to December 31, 2003, Nortel  
Networks would be entitled to a reduction, in whole or in part, of the additional consideration otherwise payable in Nortel Networks  
Corporation common shares to JDS in connection with the acquisition of the 980 NPLC business from JDS (see note 10). On  
November 13, 2003, Nortel Networks and JDS agreed upon a modification to the measurement metrics for the period from November 8,  
2002 through the remainder of the purchase arrangement to reflect, in accordance with the terms of the underlying agreement, the  
disposition by Nortel Networks of certain of its operations. Nortel Networks believes that its purchases over the term of the purchase  
arrangement were sufficient to meet the required measurement metrics of Nortel Networks total purchases to December 31, 2003, and as  
such does not expect that any additional common shares will be issued.  
Operating leases and other commitments  
As of December 31, 2003, the future minimum payments under operating leases, outsourcing contracts, special charges related to lease  
commitments accrued for as part of restructuring contract settlement and lease costs and related sublease recoveries (see note 7),  
consisted of:  
Operating  
leases  
Outsourcing  
contracts  
Special  
charges  
Sublease  
income  
2004  
2005  
2006  
2007  
2008  
Thereafter  
$
163  
159  
145  
131  
113  
649  
$
161  
104  
104  
104  
104  
104  
$
145  
95  
72  
59  
49  
$
(23)  
(29)  
(41)  
(38)  
(33)  
248  
(153)  
Total future minimum payments  
$
1,360  
$
681  
$
668  
$
(317)  
Rental expense on operating leases for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, net of applicable sublease income, amounted  
to $260, $469 and $756, respectively.  
During the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, Nortel Networks entered into sale leaseback transactions for certain of its  
properties with carrying values of approximately $17 and $250, respectively, which resulted in a loss on disposal of $6 and $7,  
respectively.  
F-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Expenses related to outsourcing contracts for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001 amounted to $308, $364 and $498,  
respectively, and were for services provided to Nortel Networks primarily related to a portion of information services, payroll, capital  
services, accounts payable and training and human resource functions. The amount payable under Nortel Networks outsourcing contracts  
is variable to the extent that Nortel Networks workforce fluctuates from the baseline levels contained in the contracts. The table above  
shows the minimum commitment contained in the outsourcing contracts.  
15. Restricted cash and cash equivalents  
As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, approximately $63 and $249, respectively, of cash and cash equivalents was restricted as collateral  
for certain bid, performance related and other bonds as well as for certain normal course of business transactions. The cash and cash  
equivalents collateral was in addition to the payment of fees and was required as a result of the general economic and industry  
environment and NNL’s credit ratings.  
16. Capital stock  
Common shares  
Nortel Networks Corporation is authorized to issue an unlimited number of common shares without nominal or par value. The  
outstanding number of common shares and prepaid forward purchase contracts included in shareholders’ equity consisted of the  
following as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Number  
$
Number  
$
Number  
$
(Number of common shares in thousands)  
Common shares:  
Balance at beginning of the year  
Shares issued pursuant to:  
3,844,172  
$ 33,234  
3,208,285  
$ 32,245  
3,102,019  
$ 29,141  
Shareholder dividend reinvestment and stock purchase plan  
Stock option plans  
484  
20,836  
75,911  
6
528  
2,509  
1,550  
(330)  
38  
(11)  
413  
3,269  
(330)  
632,500  
142  
(12)  
858  
1
(a)  
Acquisition and acquisition related  
(b)  
Common share offering  
61  
Conversion of subsidiary preferred shares  
9,035  
(c)  
Prepaid forward purchase contracts  
321,322  
448  
Balance at end of the year  
4,166,714  
$ 33,674  
3,844,172  
$ 33,234  
3,208,285  
$ 32,245  
(Number of prepaid forward purchase contracts)  
(c)  
Prepaid forward purchase contracts:  
Balance at beginning of the year  
28,722  
(19,029)  
$
$
622  
(413)  
28,750  
(28)  
$
$
623  
(1)  
$
$
Prepaid forward purchase contract offering  
Prepaid forward purchase contracts settled  
Balance at end of the year  
9,693  
209  
28,722  
622  
(a)  
Common shares issued as part of the purchase price consideration. During the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, common shares were cancelled as earn out  
provisions were forfeited pursuant to their applicable agreements.  
(b)  
(c)  
On June 12, 2002, Nortel Networks issued 632,500 common shares for net proceeds of approximately $858, net of issue costs of $36.  
Concurrent with the common share offering on June 12, 2002, Nortel Networks issued 28,750 prepaid forward purchase contracts for net proceeds of $623, net of  
issue costs of $26, which were recorded as an element of additional paid-in capital. During the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively, 321,322 and  
448 common shares were issued as a result of the early settlement of 19,029 and 28 prepaid forward purchase contracts. The net proceeds from the settled contracts  
of $413 and $1, respectively, were transferred from additional paid-in capital to common shares.  
During the year ended December 31, 2001, Nortel Networks Corporation issued common shares to the holders of the 200 Cumulative  
Redeemable Class A Preferred Shares Series 4 (“Series 4 Preferred Shares”) of NNL, each of whom had exercised their right to exchange  
their Series 4 Preferred Shares for common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation. The number of common shares issued for each  
Series 4 Preferred Share was determined by dividing Canadian $0.50 by the  
F-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
greater of Canadian $2.50 per common share and 95 percent of the weighted-average trading price per common share of Nortel Networks  
Corporation on the TSX for the 10 trading days immediately preceding the date on which such common shares were issued in the  
exchange.  
Prepaid forward purchase contracts  
On June 12, 2002, concurrent with Nortel Networks Corporation common share offering, 28,750 equity units were offered, each initially  
evidencing its holder’s ownership of a prepaid forward purchase contract (“purchase contract”), entitling the holder to receive Nortel  
Networks Corporation common shares and specified zero-coupon U.S. treasury strips (“U.S. treasury strips”). Net proceeds to Nortel  
Networks from the purchase contracts were $623. During the year ended December 31, 2003, 19,029 purchase contracts were settled  
early, resulting in 321,322,349 Nortel Networks Corporation common shares being issued for net proceeds of $413. During the year  
ended December 31, 2002, 28 purchase contracts were settled early, resulting in 448,309 common shares being issued for net proceeds of  
$1. As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, 9,693 and 28,722 purchase contracts, respectively, were outstanding. The purchase contracts are  
classified in shareholders’ equity as part of additional paid-in capital.  
The settlement date for each remaining purchase contract is August 15, 2005, subject to acceleration or early settlement in certain cases.  
As of December 31, 2003, the aggregate number of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares issuable on the settlement date will be  
between approximately 164 million and 196 million shares, subject to certain anti-dilution adjustments (which included adjustments for  
the proposed consolidation of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares). On the settlement date (or earlier if an acceleration event  
occurs prior to the settlement date or if the holder has elected an early settlement option), Nortel Networks Corporation will issue and  
deliver to the holder of each purchase contract after February 15, 2003 between 16,885.93 and 20,263.12 of its common shares  
(depending on the applicable market value), subject to certain anti-dilution adjustments. The applicable market value will be the average  
of the closing prices of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares on the NYSE during a period shortly before the settlement date. If  
the applicable market value of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares is:  
greater than $1.692 per share, 16,885.93 common shares will be issued and delivered for each purchase contract;  
less than or equal to $1.692 per share but greater than $1.410 per share, the number of common shares to be issued and  
delivered for each purchase contract will be equal to $28,571.00 divided by the applicable market value; and  
less than or equal to $1.410 per share, 20,263.12 common shares will be issued and delivered for each purchase contract.  
A holder of purchase contracts may elect to accelerate the settlement date in respect of some or all of its purchase contracts. Upon an  
early settlement on or after August 15, 2002 and prior to February 15, 2003, the holder was entitled to receive 16,011.04 Nortel Networks  
Corporation common shares per purchase contract (regardless of the market price of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares at that  
time), subject to certain anti-dilution adjustments. Upon an early settlement on or after February 15, 2003, the holder will receive  
16,885.93 Nortel Networks Corporation common shares per purchase contract (regardless of the market price of Nortel Networks  
Corporation common shares at that time), subject to certain anti-dilution adjustments. Owing to the matters described in note 3 with  
respect to the delayed filings of the Reports, Nortel Networks is currently unable to permit holders of purchase contracts to exercise their  
early settlement rights. These rights will again become exercisable upon the effectiveness of a registration statement (or post-effective  
amendment to the shelf registration statement) filed with the SEC (with respect to the common shares to be delivered) that contains a  
related current prospectus.  
If Nortel Networks is involved in a merger, amalgamation, arrangement, consolidation or other reorganization event (other than with or  
into NNL or certain other subsidiaries) in which all of its common shares are exchanged for consideration of at least 30 percent of the  
value of which consists of cash or cash equivalents, then a holder of purchase contracts may elect to accelerate and settle some or all of  
its purchase contracts for Nortel Networks Corporation common shares.  
The settlement date under each purchase contract will automatically accelerate upon occurrence of specified events of bankruptcy,  
insolvency or reorganization with respect to Nortel Networks. Upon acceleration of the settlement date, holders will be entitled to receive  
20,263.12 Nortel Networks Corporation common shares per purchase contract (regardless of the market price of Nortel Networks  
Corporation common shares at that time), subject to certain anti-dilution adjustments.  
F-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The U.S. treasury strips were purchased directly by a representative of the underwriters from the gross proceeds of the equity unit  
offering and were delivered to a third party acting as a custodian on behalf of the equity unit holders. Nortel Networks has no obligations  
with respect to or interest in the U.S. treasury strips. Accordingly, they are not reflected in the consolidated financial statements.  
Preferred shares  
Nortel Networks Corporation is authorized to issue an unlimited number of Class A preferred shares, which rank senior to the Class B  
preferred shares and the common shares upon a distribution of capital or assets, and an unlimited number of Class B preferred shares,  
which rank junior to the Class A preferred shares and senior to the common shares upon a distribution of capital or assets, in each case  
without nominal or par value. Each of the Class A and Class B preferred shares is issuable in one or more series, each series having such  
rights, restrictions and provisions as determined by the Board of Directors of Nortel Networks Corporation at the time of issue. None of  
the Class A or Class B preferred shares of Nortel Networks Corporation has been issued.  
Dividends  
Dividends on the outstanding common shares are declared in U.S. dollars. Nortel Networks Corporation suspended future common share  
dividends after payment on June 29, 2001 of the $0.01875 per common share dividend.  
Shareholder rights plan  
At the Nortel Networks annual and special shareholders’ meeting on April 24, 2003, shareholders approved the reconfirmation and  
amendment of Nortel Networks shareholder rights plan, which will expire at the annual meeting of shareholders to be held in 2006 unless  
it is reconfirmed at that time. Under the rights plan, Nortel Networks issues one right for each Nortel Networks Corporation common  
share outstanding. These rights become exercisable upon the occurrence of certain events associated with an unsolicited takeover bid.  
17. Earnings (loss) per common share  
The following table details the weighted-average number of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares outstanding for the purposes of  
computing basic and diluted earnings (loss) per common share for the following periods:  
(a)  
(a)  
(Number of common shares in millions)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Basic weighted-average shares outstanding:  
Issued and outstanding  
Prepaid forward purchase contracts  
3,952  
378  
3,562  
270  
3,185  
(b)  
Basic weighted-average shares outstanding  
4,330  
3,832  
3,185  
Weighted-average shares dilution adjustments:  
Dilutive stock options  
2
Diluted weighted-average shares outstanding  
4,332  
3,832  
3,185  
Weighted-average shares dilution adjustments — exclusions:  
Stock options  
286  
180  
257  
180  
14  
210  
68  
(c)  
4.25% convertible Senior Notes  
(b)  
Prepaid forward purchase contracts  
(a)  
(b)  
As a result of the net loss from continuing operations for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, all potential dilutive securities were considered anti-  
dilutive.  
The impact of the minimum number of common shares to be issued upon settlement of the prepaid forward purchase contracts on a weighted-average basis  
was 378 and 270 for the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, the minimum number of Nortel  
Networks Corporation common shares to be issued upon settlement of the prepaid forward purchase contracts was 164 and 485, respectively. Had the  
weighted-average number of prepaid forward purchase contracts been settled as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, an additional nil and 14 Nortel Networks  
Corporation common shares, respectively, would have been issued above the minimum number of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares based on  
the market price of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares on the respective dates.  
(c)  
These notes were anti-dilutive for the year ended December 31, 2003.  
F-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
18. Accumulated other comprehensive loss  
The components of accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax, were as follows:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Accumulated foreign currency translation adjustment  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
$
(331)  
529  
$
(488)  
157  
$
(354)  
(134)  
(a)  
Change in foreign currency translation adjustment  
Balance at the end of the year  
198  
(331)  
(488)  
Unrealized gain (loss) on investments — net  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
24  
57  
5
19  
44  
(39)  
Change in unrealized gain (loss) on investments  
(b)  
Balance at the end of the year  
81  
24  
5
Unrealized derivative gain (loss) on cash flow hedges — net  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
(3)  
15  
(14)  
11  
(14)  
(c)  
Change in unrealized derivative gain (loss) on cash flow hedges  
Balance at the end of the year  
12  
(3)  
(14)  
(d)  
Minimum pension liability  
Balance at the beginning of the year  
Change in minimum pension liability  
(641)  
(188)  
(84)  
(557)  
(84)  
Balance at the end of the year  
(829)  
(538)  
(641)  
(951)  
(84)  
$
$
$
(581)  
Accumulated other comprehensive loss  
(a)  
(b)  
The change in the foreign currency translation adjustment was not adjusted for income taxes since it related to indefinite term investments in non-U.S.  
subsidiaries.  
Certain securities deemed available-for-sale by Nortel Networks were measured at fair value. Unrealized holding gains (losses) related to these securities were  
excluded from net earnings (loss) and were included in accumulated other comprehensive loss until realized. Unrealized gain (loss) on investments was net of  
tax of nil, nil and $3 for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively. During the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001,  
realized (gains) losses on investments of $(6), $(4) and $(32), respectively, were reclassified to other income (expense) — net in the consolidated statements  
of operations.  
(c)  
(d)  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, net derivative gains of $32 were reclassified to other income (expense) — net. Unrealized derivative gain (loss) on  
cash flow hedges is net of tax of nil, $1 and $6 for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively. During the year ended December 31,  
2002, $18 of net derivative losses were reclassified to other income (expense) — net. Nortel Networks estimates that $12 of net derivative gains  
(losses) included in accumulated other comprehensive loss will be reclassified into net earnings (loss) within the next 12 months. Also included $7 (pre-tax  
$11) of net derivative losses related to the adoption of SFAS 133 during the year ended December 31, 2001.  
Represents non-cash charges to shareholders’ equity related to the increase in the minimum required recognizable liability associated with Nortel Networks  
pension plans (see note 9). The change in minimum pension liability amount is presented net of tax of $31, $133 and $26 for the years ended December 31,  
2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
19. Stock-based compensation plans  
Stock options  
Nortel Networks grants options to purchase Nortel Networks Corporation common shares under two existing stock option plans, Nortel  
Networks Corporation 2000 Stock Option Plan (the “2000 Plan”) and Nortel Networks Corporation 1986 Stock Option Plan As Amended  
and Restated (the “1986 Plan”). Under these two plans, options to purchase Nortel Networks Corporation common shares may be granted  
to employees, and under the 2000 Plan, options may be granted to directors of Nortel Networks that entitle the holders to purchase one  
common share at a subscription price of not less than 100 percent of market value on the effective date of the grant. Subscription prices  
are stated and payable in U.S. dollars for U.S. options and in Canadian dollars for Canadian options. Generally options granted prior to  
2003 vest 33 percent on the anniversary date of the grant for three years. Options granted in 2003 generally vest 25 percent each year  
over a four year period on the anniversary date of the grant. The committee of the Board of Directors of Nortel Networks that administers  
both plans has the discretion to vary the period during which the holder has the right to exercise options and, in certain circumstances,  
may accelerate the right of the holder to exercise options, but in no case shall the exercise period exceed ten years. Nortel Networks will  
meet its obligations under both plans either by issuance, or by purchase on the open market, of Nortel Networks Corporation common  
shares.  
F-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Options granted under the 2000 Plan and 1986 Plan may be granted with or without a SAR. A SAR entitles the holder to receive payment  
of an amount equivalent to the excess of the market value of a common share at the time of exercise of the SAR over the subscription  
price of the common share to which the option relates. Options with SARs may be granted on a cancellation basis, in which case the  
exercise of one causes the cancellation of the other, or on a simultaneous basis, in which case the exercise of one causes the exercise of  
the other.  
As of December 31, 2003, the maximum number of common shares authorized by the shareholders and reserved for issuance by the  
Board of Directors of Nortel Networks under the 1986 Plan and 2000 Plan is as follows:  
(number of common shares in thousands)  
Maximum  
(a)  
1986 Plan  
(b)  
Issuable to employees  
469,718  
(a)  
2000 Plan  
Issuable to non-employee directors  
Issuable to employees  
500  
94,000  
(a)  
(b)  
In January 1995, a key contributor stock option program (the “Key Contributor Program”) was established. Under the terms of the Key Contributor Program,  
participants are granted an equal number of initial options and replacement options. The initial options generally vest after five years and expire after ten years. The  
replacement options are granted concurrently with the initial options and also expire after ten years. No Key Contributor Program options were granted for the years  
ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively, under both stock option plans.  
As of December 31, 2003, the maximum number of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares with respect to which options may be granted in any given year  
under the 1986 Plan is three percent of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares issued and outstanding at the commencement of the year, subject to certain  
adjustments.  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, approximately 892,475 Nortel Networks Corporation common shares were issued pursuant to  
the exercise of stock options granted under the 1986 Plan and 13,501 Nortel Networks Corporation common shares were issued pursuant  
to the exercise of stock options granted under the 2000 Plan.  
Nortel Networks assumed stock options plans in connection with the acquisition of various companies and granted options to purchase  
Nortel Networks Corporation common shares. The vesting periods for these assumed plans may differ from the 2000 Plan and 1986 Plan,  
but are not considered to be significant to Nortel Networks overall use of stock-based compensation.  
On June 20, 2001, Nortel Networks commenced a voluntary stock option exchange program (the “Exchange Program”) for Nortel  
Networks employees allowing employees to exchange certain outstanding stock options for new stock options, based on a prescribed  
formula. The terms of the Exchange Program required that the new grants of options would be made at least six months and a day from  
the cancellation date of the options tendered for exchange, which was July 27, 2001. Nortel Networks then Board of Directors and its  
then board appointed officers were not eligible to participate in the Exchange Program.  
F-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following is a summary of the total number of outstanding stock options and the maximum number of stock options available for  
grant:  
Weighted-  
Outstanding  
options  
(thousands)  
average  
exercise  
price  
Available  
for grant  
(thousands)  
Balance at December 31, 2000  
325,380  
55,565  
(20,836)  
(56,793)  
(93,416)  
$
$
$
$
$
32.06  
29.45  
6.53  
35.60  
51.64  
114,223  
(55,565)  
41,372  
93,416  
(a)  
Granted options under all stock option plans  
Options exercised  
(b)  
Options cancelled  
(c)  
Options cancelled under the stock option exchange program  
Balance at December 31, 2001  
Granted options under all stock option plans  
209,900  
120,335  
(3,269)  
$
$
$
23.86  
7.08  
1.81  
193,446  
(120,316)  
(c)  
Options exercised  
Options cancelled  
(b)  
(70,093)  
$
26.48  
55,036  
Balance at December 31, 2002  
Granted options under all stock option plans  
Options exercised  
256,873  
74,924  
(1,550)  
(41,849)  
$
$
$
$
15.52  
2.40  
1.99  
128,166  
(74,924)  
Options cancelled  
17.94  
34,755  
Balance at December 31, 2003  
288,398  
$
12.27  
87,997  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
Included options granted in relation to various acquisitions during the year ended December 31, 2001 of approximately 1,313.  
Included adjustments to assumed stock option plans.  
Approximately 93,416 stock options were tendered for exchange and cancelled. On January 29, 2002, Nortel Networks granted approximately 52,700 new stock  
options in connection with the Exchange Program with exercise prices in the range of U.S. $7.16 to U.S. $7.78 or Canadian $11.39 per common share.  
The following table summarizes information about stock options outstanding as of December 31, 2003:  
Options outstanding  
Options exercisable  
Weighted-  
average  
remaining  
contractual  
life  
Weighted-  
Weighted-  
Number  
outstanding  
(thousands)  
average  
exercise  
price  
Number  
exercisable  
(thousands)  
average  
exercise  
price  
Range of exercise prices  
(in years)  
$0.0084 - $2.3900  
$2.3901 - $3.5852  
$3.5853 - $5.3779  
58,476  
19,088  
11,970  
9.1  
8.9  
5.9  
$
$
$
2.32  
2.57  
4.80  
1,148  
1,042  
6,671  
$
$
$
1.49  
2.71  
4.60  
(a)  
(a)  
$5.3780 - $8.0670  
82,156  
6.5  
$
6.50  
49,888  
$
6.67  
$8.0671 - $12.1006  
$12.1007 - $18.1510  
$18.1511 - $27.2267  
$27.2268 - $40.8402  
$40.8403 - $61.2605  
$61.2606 - $91.8900  
43,880  
18,220  
25,602  
9,185  
13,455  
6,366  
3.8  
3.7  
5.0  
5.3  
4.5  
4.7  
$
$
$
$
$
$
9.50  
15.23  
23.20  
34.74  
51.60  
72.50  
41,186  
16,580  
25,026  
8,058  
12,987  
6,337  
$
$
$
$
$
$
9.57  
15.18  
23.28  
34.25  
51.88  
72.49  
(b)  
288,398  
6.30  
$
12.27  
168,923  
$
17.79  
(a)  
(b)  
Included approximately 41,069 stock options granted under the Exchange Program.  
Total number of exercisable options for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001 were 156,632 and 132,969, respectively.  
Restricted stock unit plan  
The Nortel Networks Limited Restricted Stock Unit Plan is a long-term incentive plan that generally provides executive officers and  
certain senior management with the opportunity to receive RSUs over a specified period of time if assigned performance thresholds are  
achieved and the joint leadership resources committee of the Boards of the Directors of Nortel Networks and NNL (the “Committee”)  
determines, in its discretion, to issue and settle all or a portion of the allocated RSUs. Each RSU issued entitles the holder to receive one  
common share of Nortel Networks Corporation  
F-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
purchased on the open market, or at the discretion of the Committee, or at the election of the holder in certain circumstances, cash in lieu  
of shares.  
The number of RSUs (in millions) allocated as of December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001 was approximately 20, 2 and 2, respectively.  
The RSUs allocated in 2003 may be issued and settled in four tranches at the discretion of the Committee. The Committee’s discretion is  
to be based, among other things, on the achievement of four performance thresholds over a three year term ending December 31, 2005.  
The performance criteria for each of the four performance thresholds are distinct and incremental “Return on Sales before Tax”  
percentage targets, calculated on a rolling four-quarter basis. In order to receive payout, the recipient must have continued employment  
until the date the allocated RSUs are issued and settled. Once the Committee determines that a threshold has been achieved, the  
Committee uses its discretion to determine whether additional factors should be considered in determining the number of allocated RSUs  
to be issued and settled. Such additional factors may include the performance of competitors and other relevant business, financial,  
competitive, political and other criteria deemed appropriate by the Committee. In the third quarter of 2003, Nortel Networks issued and  
settled approximately 7 million units of the RSUs allocated in 2003 (see note 23).  
The RSUs allocated in 2001 were issued at the discretion of the Committee based, among other things, on the achievement of five  
performance targets over a two year term ended March 31, 2003. Once the Committee determined whether the five performance targets  
had been achieved, it used its discretion to determine the number of allocated RSUs to be issued and settled. On May 29, 2003, Nortel  
Networks issued and settled approximately 1.5 million units in respect of the RSUs allocated in 2001.  
Directors’ deferred share compensation plans  
Under the Nortel Networks Corporation Directors’ Deferred Share Compensation Plan and the Nortel Networks Limited Directors’  
Deferred Share Compensation Plan, non-employee directors can elect to receive all or a portion of their compensation for services  
rendered as a director of Nortel Networks Corporation or NNL, any committees thereof, and as board or committee chairperson, in the  
form of share units, instead of cash. The share units are settled a specified number of trading days following the release of Nortel  
Networks financial results after the director ceases to be a member of the applicable board, and each share unit entitles the holder to  
receive one common share of Nortel Networks Corporation purchased on the open market. As of December 31, 2003 and 2002, the  
number of share units issued (in millions) was 1 and 1, respectively.  
Employee stock purchase plans  
Nortel Networks has ESPPs to facilitate the acquisition of common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation at a discount and the retention  
of such common shares by eligible employees (see note 23). The ESPPs have four offering periods each year, with each offering period  
beginning on the first day of each calendar quarter. Eligible employees may have up to 10 percent of their eligible compensation  
deducted from their pay during each offering period to contribute towards the purchase of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares.  
The Nortel Networks Corporation common shares are purchased by an independent broker through the facilities of the TSX and/or  
NYSE, and held by a custodian on behalf of the plan participants.  
For North American eligible employees, Nortel Networks Corporation common shares are purchased at a purchase price of 85 percent of  
the market price of the Nortel Networks Corporation common shares on the last trading day of the offering period. For non-North  
American eligible employees, common shares are purchased at a purchase price equal to the greater of:  
(i) 85 percent of the average of the high and low prices of common shares on the first trading day of the offering period; and  
(ii) 71.5 percent of the market price of the common shares on the last trading day of the offering period; or  
(iii) if the market price on the last trading day is equal to or less than the average of the high and low on the first trading day, the  
purchase price shall be 85 percent of the market price on the last trading day of the offering period.  
The purchases under the ESPPs for the years ended December 31 are shown below:  
F-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(number of shares in thousands)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
(a)  
Nortel Networks Corporation common shares purchased  
Weighted-average price of shares purchased  
11,532  
3.10  
38,824  
1.31  
14,648  
8.50  
$
$
$
(a)  
Compensation expense was recognized for Nortel Networks portion of the contributions. Nortel Networks contributed an amount equal to the difference between the  
market price and the purchase price.  
20. Discontinued operations  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks continued to wind down its access solutions operations and there was no  
change to the initial disposal strategy or intent to exit the business which was approved by the Nortel Networks Board of Directors on  
June 14, 2001. However, the prolonged deterioration in industry and market conditions during 2002 and 2003 delayed certain disposal  
activities beyond the original planned timeframe of one year. In particular, actions involving negotiations with customers, who were also  
affected by industry conditions, took longer than expected. Although disposal activities continued beyond the one-year period generally  
contemplated under APB 30, Nortel Networks continues to present the access solutions operations as discontinued operations in the  
consolidated financial statements. As of December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks had substantially completed the wind down of its  
discontinued operations.  
Pursuant to APB 30, the revenues, costs and expenses, assets and liabilities and cash flows of Nortel Networks access solutions  
operations have been segregated in the consolidated statements of operations, consolidated balance sheets and consolidated statements of  
cash flows, and are reported as “discontinued operations”. The following consolidated financial results for discontinued operations are  
presented as of December 31 for the consolidated balance sheets and for the years ended December 31 for the consolidated statements of  
operations and consolidated statements of cash flows:  
Consolidated statements of operations:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Revenues  
$
$
14  
$
$
158  
$
$
1,071  
(a)  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
Net gain (loss) on disposal of operations — net of tax  
184  
(498)  
(1,969)  
(b)  
(101)  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
$
184  
$
(101)  
$
(2,467)  
(a)  
(b)  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations was net of applicable income tax benefit of $96 for the year ended December 31, 2001.  
Net gain (loss) on disposal of operations was net of an applicable income tax expense (benefit) of $1, $(16) and $(367) for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002  
and 2001, respectively.  
Consolidated balance sheets:  
2003  
2002  
Deferred income taxes  
Other current assets  
$
26  
2
$
144  
65  
(a)  
(b)  
Total current assets of discontinued operations  
Other long-term assets  
28  
4
209  
127  
(b)(c)  
Total assets of discontinued operations  
$
$
32  
$
$
336  
(b)(d)  
Current liabilities  
6
1
63  
1
(b)  
Long-term liabilities  
Total liabilities of discontinued operations  
$
7
$
64  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
Included accounts receivable of nil and $20, which was net of provisions of $5 and $53, as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. Included inventories of  
nil, which was net of provisions of $75 and $102, as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively.  
Current assets, other long-term assets, current liabilities and long-term liabilities of discontinued operations were included in other current assets, other assets, other  
accrued liabilities and other liabilities, respectively, on the consolidated balance sheets.  
Included customer financing receivables of $4 and $37, which was net of provisions of $55 and $470, as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively.  
F-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(d)  
Included accruals of $6 and $63 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. The accruals consisted of future contractual obligations and estimated liabilities of  
nil and $14 and accruals of $6 and $49 during the planned period of disposition as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively.  
Consolidated statements of cash flows:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Cash flows from (used in) discontinued operations  
Operating activities  
Investing activities  
$
$
149  
241  
$
$
249  
100  
$
$
(363)  
32  
Net cash from (used in) discontinued operations  
390  
349  
(331)  
2003 Activity  
Nortel Networks recorded net earnings from discontinued operations — net of tax, of $184 in 2003. The significant items included in net  
earnings are summarized below.  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks reassessed its remaining provisions for discontinued operations and recorded  
a net gain of $68, consisting of changes in estimates of $149 for liabilities, offset by additional provisions for both short-term and long-  
term receivables of $81.  
On December 17, 2003, Nortel Networks entered into an agreement to settle an outstanding $21 note receivable from one of its  
customers, which was previously provisioned, for total cash proceeds of approximately $17. A gain of $17 was recorded as a result of  
this transaction.  
On December 23, 2003, Nortel Networks sold certain plant and equipment, inventory, patent and other intellectual property related to its  
fixed wireless access operations, to Airspan Networks Inc. (“Airspan”). Nortel Networks received cash proceeds of $13. The majority of  
the assets transferred to Airspan had previously been written off by Nortel Networks as part of its discontinued operations. As a result of  
this transaction, Nortel Networks recorded a gain of $14 during the year ended December 31, 2003.  
On March 24, 2003, Nortel Networks sold 8 million common shares of Arris Group back to Arris Group for cash consideration of $28  
pursuant to a March 11, 2003 agreement, which resulted in a gain of $12. Following this transaction, Nortel Networks interest in Arris  
Group was reduced to 18.8 percent, and it ceased equity accounting for the investment. As a result, Nortel Networks now classifies its  
remaining ownership interest in Arris Group as an available-for-sale investment within continuing operations. Nortel Networks continues  
to dispose of its interest in Arris Group and the gain or loss on the sale of shares subsequent to the first quarter of 2003 has been included  
in other income (expense) — net (see note 10).  
On March 18, 2003, Nortel Networks assigned its subordinated redeemable preferred interest (“membership interest”) in Arris  
Interactive, L.L.C. (“Arris Interactive”) to ANTEC Corporation, an Arris Group company, for cash consideration of $88. As a result of  
this transaction, Nortel Networks recorded a loss of $2. Also in connection with the March 2003 transactions, Nortel Networks received  
$11 upon settlement of a sales representation agreement with Arris Group and recorded a gain of $11.  
On March 20, 2003, Nortel Networks entered into an agreement with a customer to restructure approximately $465 of trade and customer  
financing receivables owed to Nortel Networks, the majority of which was previously provisioned. As a result of the restructuring  
agreement, Nortel Networks received consideration including cash of $125, notes receivable and an ownership interest which have been  
fully provided for and the mutual release of all other claims between the parties. A gain of $66 was recorded as a result of the transaction.  
In addition to the restructuring agreement, a five year equipment and services supply agreement was entered into requiring customer  
payment terms of either cash in advance or guarantee by letters of credit in favor of Nortel Networks.  
2002 Activity  
Nortel Networks recorded a net loss from discontinued operations — net of tax, of $101 in 2002. The significant items included in this  
net loss are summarized below.  
F-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
During the year ended December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks reassessed its remaining provisions for discontinued operations and recorded  
a net additional loss of $97. The loss consisted of additional provisions for both short-term and long-term receivables of $157, offset by  
gains of $60 due to other changes in estimates.  
On June 25, 2002, Arris Group completed a secondary public offering of 15 million common shares held by Nortel Networks. Following  
the closing of the offering, Nortel Networks owned 22 million shares, or approximately 27 percent of Arris Group’s common shares. The  
cash proceeds received were $67 and a gain of approximately $17 was recorded as a result of this transaction. During the three months  
ended March 31, 2002, Nortel Networks recorded a gain of approximately $13 due to the reduction of Nortel Networks ownership interest  
in Arris Group, received for Nortel Networks original interest in Arris Group, from approximately 49 percent to approximately 46 percent  
as a result of Arris Group’s issuance of common shares in connection with its acquisition of another company.  
In addition, during the year, as a result of negotiation with Arris Group, Nortel Networks reduced the carrying value of its membership  
interest in Arris Interactive and recorded a loss of $14.  
On April 21, 2002, Nortel Networks entered into an agreement with Aastra Technologies Limited to sell certain assets, which were  
included in discontinued operations, associated with Nortel Networks prior acquisition of Aptis Communications, Inc. (“Aptis”). The  
transaction was completed during the three months ended June 30, 2002. The consideration primarily consisted of approximately $16 in  
cash, as well as contingent cash consideration of up to $60 over four years based on the achievement of certain revenue targets by the  
business. Nortel Networks recorded a loss of approximately $44 on the transaction.  
On March 5, 2002, Nortel Networks divested its approximately 46 percent ownership interest in Elastic Networks Inc. (“Elastic  
Networks”) to Paradyne Networks, Inc. (“Paradyne”) in exchange for an approximately 8 percent ownership interest in Paradyne. Nortel  
Networks recorded a gain of approximately $7 on the transaction. The investment in Paradyne has been classified within continuing  
operations.  
On February 6, 2002, Nortel Networks divested its 68.5 percent interest in Netgear, Inc. in exchange for cash proceeds of $5, a  
subordinated, unsecured, convertible, promissory note receivable of $20, and the assumption of certain liabilities. Nortel Networks  
recorded a gain of approximately $7 on this transaction. Subsequent to 2002, Nortel Networks received cash of $20 relating to the  
repayment of the subordinated, unsecured, convertible, promissory note receivable.  
2001 Activity  
On June 14, 2001, Nortel Networks Board of Directors approved a plan to discontinue Nortel Networks access solutions operations  
consisting of all of Nortel Networks narrowband and broadband access solutions, including copper, cable and fixed wireless solutions, as  
well as Nortel Networks then consolidated membership interest in Arris Group and equity investment in Elastic Networks. Also affected  
by the decision were Nortel Networks prior acquisitions of Sonoma Systems (“Sonoma”), Promatory Communications, Inc.  
(“Promatory”), Aptis and Broadband Networks Inc.  
In connection with the decision to discontinue the access solutions operations on June 14, 2001, Nortel Networks recorded a pre-tax loss  
on disposal of the access solutions operations of $2,173 in the three months ended June 30, 2001, which reflected the estimated costs  
directly associated with Nortel Networks plan of disposition. The loss reflected: goodwill write-off of $755 associated with the acquisition  
of Sonoma and Promatory; provisions for both short-term and long-term receivables of $423; a provision for inventories of $621; other  
asset write-offs totaling $102; future contractual obligations and estimated liabilities of $123; estimated operating losses during the  
planned period of disposition of $127; and estimated workforce reduction costs of $22.  
In the three months ended June 30, 2001, Nortel Networks also reassessed the carrying value of certain investments totaling $41. Based on  
this assessment, the fair value of these assets was nil, and the write-off of $41 was included in net earnings (loss) from discontinued  
operations, net of tax of nil.  
During the six months ended December 31, 2001, Nortel Networks reassessed its remaining provisions for discontinued operations and  
recorded an additional pre-tax loss of $261. The loss consisted mainly of additional provisions for customer financing receivables and  
equity losses on investments.  
On August 24, 2001, Nortel Networks completed a transaction with Zhone Technologies, Inc. to sell the AccessNode ABM and CDS shelf  
products and the Universal Edge 9000 digital loop carrier shelf and remote access shelf products for cash proceeds of $8, which resulted in  
a loss of $9.  
F-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On August 3, 2001, Nortel Networks announced the completion of the previously announced transfer of its ownership interest in Arris  
Interactive to Arris Group, ANTEC Corporation’s new parent company. As a result, as of December 31, 2001, Nortel Networks owned a  
49.2 percent non-controlling interest in Arris Group, compared to the previous 81.25 percent controlling interest in Arris Interactive,  
including a subordinate redeemable preferred interest in Arris Interactive. Nortel Networks recorded a pre-tax gain of $113 on the  
transaction.  
On July 25, 2001, Nortel Networks completed a transaction with GE Industrial Systems Technology Management Inc., a division of  
General Electric Company, to sell the Lentronics JungleMUX SONET multiplexer and TN-1U SDH multiplexer products for cash  
proceeds of $13, which resulted in a gain of $13.  
21. Related party transactions  
In the ordinary course of business, Nortel Networks engages in transactions with certain of its equity-owned investees that are under or  
are subject to Nortel Networks significant influence and with joint ventures of Nortel Networks. These transactions are sales and  
purchases of goods and services under usual trade terms and are measured at their exchange amounts.  
Transactions with related parties for the years ended December 31 are summarized as follows:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Revenues  
Purchases  
$
$
1
$
$
8
$
$
16  
As at December 31, 2003 and 2002, receivables from and payable to related parties were insignificant.  
In 2001, Nortel Networks completed the sale of substantially all of the assets in the Cogent Defence Systems (“CDS”) business to EADS  
Telecom. At that time, Nortel Networks held a 41 percent ownership interest in EADS Telecom and EADS held the remaining  
59 percent. Under the terms of the agreement, Nortel Networks sold substantially all of its assets in the CDS business including: fixed  
assets; accounts receivable; inventory; intellectual property; and licenses (but excluding cash on hand as at the closing date) for  
consideration of approximately $143, comprised of a loan note due in 2002 and a call option to acquire an additional approximate  
7 percent ownership interest in NNF beginning in 2004. Nortel Networks recorded a gain on the sale of approximately $37 which was  
included in (gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets, and a deferred gain of $26, which is amortized into (gain) loss on sale of  
businesses and assets over the life of the assets sold to EADS Telecom. In 2002, in connection with negotiations with EADS, the loan  
note and call option were cancelled and a new loan note was issued to satisfy the remaining consideration owing in 2003. As a result,  
Nortel Networks recorded an additional gain on the sale of approximately $30, which was included in (gain) loss on sale of businesses  
and assets and a further deferred gain of $21, which is amortized into (gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets over the remaining life  
of the assets sold to EADS Telecom in 2001. During the years ended December 31, 2003 and 2002, $13 and $11, respectively, of the  
deferred gains were amortized into (gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets.  
On September 18, 2003 as a result of the sale of Nortel Networks 41 percent interest in EADS Telecom (see note 10), the remaining  
unamortized deferred gain of $23 related to the sale of substantially all of the assets in the CDS business during the year ended  
December 31, 2001, was recognized and included in (gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets.  
22. Contingencies  
Subsequent to the February 15, 2001 announcement in which Nortel Networks provided revised guidance for financial performance for  
the 2001 fiscal year and the first quarter of 2001, Nortel Networks and certain of its then current officers and directors were named as  
defendants in more than twenty-five purported class action lawsuits. These lawsuits in the U.S. District Courts for the Eastern District of  
New York, for the Southern District of New York and for the District of New Jersey and the provinces of Ontario, Quebec and British  
Columbia in Canada, on behalf of shareholders who acquired Nortel Networks Corporation securities as early as October 24, 2000 and as  
late as February 15, 2001, allege, among other things, violations of U.S. federal and Canadian provincial securities laws. These matters  
also have been the subject of review by Canadian and U.S. securities regulatory authorities. On May 11, 2001, the defendants filed  
motions to dismiss and/or stay in connection with the three proceedings in Quebec primarily based on the factual allegations lacking  
substantial connection to Quebec and the inclusion of shareholders resident in Quebec in the class claimed in the  
F-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ontario lawsuit. The plaintiffs in two of these proceedings in Quebec obtained court approval for discontinuances of their proceedings on  
January 17, 2002. The motion to dismiss and/or stay the third proceeding was heard on November 6, 2001 and the court deferred any  
determination on the motion to the judge who will hear the application for authorization to commence a class proceeding. On  
December 6, 2001, the defendants filed a motion seeking leave to appeal that decision. The motion for leave to appeal was dismissed on  
March 11, 2002. On October 16, 2001, an order in the Southern District of New York was filed consolidating twenty-five of the related  
U.S. class action lawsuits into a single case, appointing class plaintiffs and counsel for such plaintiffs. The plaintiffs served a  
consolidated amended complaint on January 18, 2002. On December 17, 2001, the defendants in the British Columbia action served  
notice of a motion requesting the court to decline jurisdiction and to stay all proceedings on the grounds that British Columbia is an  
inappropriate forum. The motion has been adjourned at the plaintiffs’ request to a future date to be set by the parties.  
A class action lawsuit against Nortel Networks was also filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York on behalf  
of shareholders who acquired the securities of JDS between January 18, 2001 and February 15, 2001, alleging violations of the same U.S.  
federal securities laws as the above-noted lawsuits.  
On April 1, 2002, Nortel Networks filed a motion to dismiss both the above consolidated U.S. shareholder class action and the above JDS  
shareholder class action complaints on the grounds that they failed to state a cause of action under U.S. federal securities laws. With  
respect to the JDS shareholder class action complaint, Nortel Networks also moved to dismiss on the separate basis that JDS shareholders  
lacked standing to sue Nortel Networks. On January 3, 2003, the District Court granted the motion to dismiss the JDS shareholder class  
action complaint and denied the motion to dismiss the consolidated U.S. class action complaint. Plaintiffs appealed the dismissal of the  
JDS shareholder class action complaint. On November 19, 2003, oral argument was held before the Second Circuit on the JDS  
shareholders’ appeal of the dismissal of their complaint. On May 19, 2004, the Second Circuit issued an opinion affirming the dismissal  
of the JDS shareholder class action complaint and on July 14, 2004 the Second Circuit denied plaintiffs’ motion for rehearing. On  
October 12, 2004, the plaintiffs filed a petition for writ of certiorari in the U.S. Supreme Court. On November 12, 2004, the defendants  
filed Brief for the Respondents in Opposition, and on November 22, 2004, the plaintiffs filed Reply to Brief in Opposition. With respect  
to the consolidated U.S. shareholder class action, the plaintiffs served a motion for class certification on March 21, 2003. On May 30,  
2003, the defendants served an opposition to the motion for class certification. Plaintiffs’ reply was served on August 1, 2003. The  
District Court held oral arguments on September 3, 2003 and issued an order granting class certification on September 5, 2003. On  
September 23, 2003, the defendants filed a motion in the Second Circuit for permission to appeal the class certification decision. The  
plaintiffs’ opposition to the motion was filed on October 2, 2003. On November 24, 2003, the Second Circuit denied the motion. On  
March 10, 2004, the District Court approved the form of notice to the class which was published and mailed.  
On July 17, 2002, a new purported class action lawsuit (the “Ontario Claim”) was filed in the Ontario Superior Court of Justice,  
Commercial List, naming Nortel Networks, certain of its current and former officers and directors and its auditors as defendants. The  
factual allegations in the Ontario Claim are substantially similar to the allegations in the consolidated amended complaint filed in the U.S.  
District Court described above. The Ontario Claim is on behalf of all Canadian residents who purchased Nortel Networks Corporation  
securities (including options on Nortel Networks Corporation securities) between October 24, 2000 and February 15, 2001. The plaintiffs  
claim damages of Canadian $5,000, plus punitive damages in the amount of Canadian $1,000, prejudgment and postjudgment interest and  
costs of the action. On September 23, 2003, the Court issued an order allowing the plaintiffs to proceed to amend the Ontario Claim and  
requiring that the plaintiffs serve class certification materials by December 15, 2003. On September 24, 2003, the plaintiffs filed a notice  
of discontinuance of the original action filed in Ontario. On December 12, 2003, plaintiffs’ counsel requested an extension of time to  
January 21, 2004 to deliver class certification materials. On January 21, 2004, plaintiffs’ counsel advised the Court that the two  
representative plaintiffs in the action no longer wished to proceed, but counsel was prepared to deliver draft certification materials  
pending the replacement of the representative plaintiffs. On February 19, 2004, the plaintiffs’ counsel advised the Court of a potential  
new representative plaintiff. On February 26, 2004, the defendants requested the Court to direct the plaintiffs’ counsel to bring a motion  
to permit the withdrawal of the current representative plaintiffs and to substitute the proposed representative plaintiff. On June 8, 2004,  
the Court signed an order allowing a Second Fresh as Amended Statement of Claim that substituted one new representative plaintiff, but  
did not change the substance of the prior claim.  
A purported class action lawsuit was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Middle District of Tennessee on December 21, 2001, on  
behalf of participants and beneficiaries of the Nortel Networks Long-Term Investment Plan (the “Plan”) at any time during the period of  
March 7, 2000 through the filing date and who made or maintained Plan investments in Nortel Networks Corporation common shares,  
under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act (“ERISA”) for Plan-wide relief and alleging, among other things, material  
misrepresentations and omissions to induce Plan participants to continue to invest in and maintain investments in Nortel Networks  
Corporation common shares in  
F-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
the Plan. A second purported class action lawsuit, on behalf of the Plan and Plan participants for whose individual accounts the Plan  
purchased Nortel Networks Corporation common shares during the period from October 27, 2000 to February 15, 2001 and making  
similar allegations was filed in the same court on March 12, 2002. A third purported class action lawsuit, on behalf of persons who are or  
were Plan participants or beneficiaries at any time since March 1, 1999 to the filing date and making similar allegations, was filed in the  
same court on March 21, 2002. The first and second purported class action lawsuits were consolidated by a new purported class action  
complaint, filed on May 15, 2002 in the same court and making similar allegations, on behalf of Plan participants and beneficiaries who  
directed the Plan to purchase or hold shares of certain funds, which held primarily Nortel Networks Corporation common shares, during  
the period from March 7, 2000 through December 21, 2001. On September 24, 2002, plaintiffs in the consolidated action filed a motion  
to consolidate all the actions and to transfer them to the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. The plaintiffs then  
filed a motion to withdraw the pending motion to consolidate and transfer. The withdrawal was granted by the District Court on  
December 30, 2002. A fourth purported class action lawsuit, on behalf of the Plan and Plan participants for whose individual accounts the  
Plan held Nortel Networks Corporation common shares during the period from March 7, 2000 through March 31, 2001 and making  
similar allegations, was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York on March 12, 2003. On March 18, 2003,  
plaintiffs in the fourth purported class action filed a motion with the Judicial Panel on Multidistrict Litigation to transfer all the actions to  
the Southern District of New York for coordinated or consolidated proceedings pursuant to 28 U.S.C. section 1407. On June 24, 2003,  
the Judicial Panel on Multidistrict Litigation issued a transfer order transferring the Southern District of New York action to the Middle  
District of Tennessee (the “Consolidated ERISA Action”). On September 12, 2003, the plaintiffs in all the actions filed a consolidated  
class action complaint. On October 28, 2003, the defendants filed a motion to dismiss the complaint and a motion to stay discovery  
pending disposition of the motion to dismiss. On March 30, 2004, the plaintiffs filed a motion for certification of a class consisting of  
participants in, or beneficiaries of, the Plan who held shares of the Nortel Networks Stock Fund during the period from March 7, 2000  
through March 31, 2001. On April 27, 2004, the Court granted the defendants’ motion to stay discovery pending resolution of  
defendants’ motion to dismiss. On June 15, 2004, the plaintiffs filed a First Amended Consolidated Class Action Complaint that added  
additional current and former officers and employees as defendants and expanded the purported class period to extend from March 7,  
2000 through to June 15, 2004.  
On March 4, 1997, Bay Networks, Inc. (“Bay Networks”), a company acquired on August 31, 1998, announced that shareholders had  
filed two separate lawsuits in the U.S. District Court for the Northern District of California (the “Federal Court”) and the California  
Superior Court, County of Santa Clara (the “California Court”), against Bay Networks and ten of Bay Networks’ then current and former  
officers and directors purportedly on behalf of a class of shareholders who purchased Bay Networks’ common shares during the period of  
May 1, 1995 through October 14, 1996. On August 17, 2000, the Federal Court granted the defendants’ motion to dismiss the federal  
complaint. On August 1, 2001, the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Ninth Circuit denied the plaintiffs’ appeal of that decision. On April 18,  
1997, a second lawsuit was filed in the California Court, purportedly on behalf of a class of shareholders who acquired Bay Networks’  
common shares pursuant to the registration statement and prospectus that became effective on November 15, 1995. The two actions in the  
California Court were consolidated in April 1998; however, the California Court denied the plaintiffs’ motion for class certification. In  
January 2000, the California Court of Appeal rejected the plaintiffs’ appeal of the decision. A petition for review was filed with the  
California Supreme Court by the plaintiffs and was denied. In February 2000, new plaintiffs who allege to have been shareholders of Bay  
Networks during the relevant periods, filed a motion for intervention in the California Court seeking to become the representatives of a  
class of shareholders. The motion was granted on June 8, 2001 and the new plaintiffs filed their complaint-in-intervention on an  
individual and purported class representative basis alleging misrepresentations made in connection with the purchase and sale of  
securities of Bay Networks in violation of California statutory and common law. On March 11, 2002, the California Court granted the  
defendants’ motion to strike the class allegations. The plaintiffs were permitted to proceed on their individual claims. The intervenor-  
plaintiffs appealed the dismissal of their class allegations. On July 25, 2003, the California Court of Appeal reversed the trial court’s  
dismissal of the intervenor-plaintiffs’ class allegations. On September 3, 2003, the defendants filed a petition for review with the  
California Supreme Court seeking permission to appeal the Court of Appeal decision. On October 22, 2003, the California Supreme  
Court denied, without opinion, the defendants’ petition for review. On December 22, 2003, the plaintiffs served their motion for  
certification of a class of purchasers of Bay Networks’ common shares from July 25, 1995 through to October 14, 1996. Hearing of the  
plaintiffs’ motion for class certification was held on May 4, 2004. On July 27, 2004, the Court entered an Amended Order Denying  
Motion of Intervenor Plaintiffs for Class Certification and Setting Further Hearing. On August 9, 2004, the intervenor-plaintiffs obtained  
Court approval to dismiss their claims and this action and, on September 30, 2004, the Court entered dismissal with prejudice of the  
entire action of all parties and all causes of action.  
Subsequent to the March 10, 2004 announcement in which Nortel Networks indicated it was likely that it would need to revise its  
previously announced unaudited results for the year ended December 31, 2003, and the results reported in  
F-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
certain of its quarterly reports for 2003, and to restate its previously filed financial results for one or more earlier periods, Nortel  
Networks and certain of its then current and former officers and directors were named as defendants in 27 purported class action lawsuits.  
These lawsuits in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York on behalf of shareholders who acquired Nortel Networks  
Corporation securities as early as February 16, 2001 and as late as May 15, 2004, allege, among other things, violations of U.S. federal  
securities laws. These matters are also the subject of investigations by Canadian and U.S. securities regulatory and criminal investigative  
authorities (see note 23). On June 30, 2004, the Court signed Orders consolidating the 27 class actions and appointing lead plaintiffs and  
lead counsel. The plaintiffs filed a consolidated class action complaint on September 10, 2004, alleging a class period of April 24, 2003  
through and including April 27, 2004. On November 5, 2004, Nortel Networks Corporation and the Audit Committee Defendants filed a  
motion to dismiss the consolidated class action complaint.  
On May 18, 2004, a purported class action lawsuit was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Middle District of Tennessee on behalf of  
participants and beneficiaries of the Plan at any time during the period of December 23, 2003 through the filing date and who made or  
maintained Plan investments in Nortel Networks Corporation common shares, under the ERISA for Plan-wide relief and alleging, among  
other things, breaches of fiduciary duty. On September 3, 2004, the Court signed a stipulated order consolidating this action with the  
Consolidated ERISA Action described above. On June 16, 2004, a second purported class action lawsuit, on behalf of the Plan and Plan  
participants for whose individual accounts the Plan purchased Nortel Networks Corporation common shares during the period from  
October 24, 2000 to June 16, 2004, and making similar allegations, was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New  
York. On August 6, 2004, the Judicial Panel on Multidistrict Litigation issued a conditional transfer order to transfer this action to the  
U.S. District Court for the Middle District of Tennessee for coordinated or consolidated proceedings pursuant to 28 U.S.C. section 1407  
with the Consolidated ERISA Action described above. On August 20, 2004, plaintiffs filed a notice of opposition to the conditional  
transfer order with the Judicial Panel. On December 6, 2004, the Judicial Panel denied the opposition and ordered the action transferred  
to the U.S. District Court for the Middle District of Tennessee for coordinated or consolidated proceedings with the Consolidated ERISA  
Action described above.  
On July 28, 2004, Nortel Networks and NNL, and certain directors and officers, and certain former directors and officers, of Nortel  
Networks and NNL, were named as defendants in a purported class proceeding in the Ontario Superior Court of Justice on behalf of  
shareholders who acquired Nortel Networks Corporation securities as early as November 12, 2002 and as late as July 28, 2004. This  
lawsuit alleges, among other things, breaches of trust and fiduciary duty, oppressive conduct and misappropriation of corporate assets and  
trust property in respect of the payment of cash bonuses to executives, officers and employees in 2003 and 2004 under the Nortel  
Networks Return to Profitability bonus program and seeks damages of Canadian $250 and an order under the Canada Business  
Corporations Act directing that an investigation be made respecting these bonus payments.  
On July 30, 2004, a shareholders’ derivative complaint was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York against  
certain directors and officers, and certain former directors and officers, of Nortel Networks alleging, among other things, breach of  
fiduciary duties owed to Nortel Networks during the period from 2000 to 2003 including by causing Nortel Networks to engage in  
unlawful conduct or failing to prevent such conduct; causing Nortel Networks to issue false statements; and violating the law.  
Except as otherwise described herein, in each of the matters described above, the plaintiffs are seeking an unspecified amount of  
monetary damages.  
Nortel Networks is also a defendant in various other suits, claims, proceedings and investigations which arise in the normal course of  
business.  
Nortel Networks is unable to ascertain the ultimate aggregate amount of monetary liability or financial impact to Nortel Networks of the  
above matters which, unless otherwise specified, seek damages from the defendants of material or indeterminate amounts or could result  
in fines and penalties. Nortel Networks cannot determine whether these actions, suits, claims and proceedings will, individually or  
collectively, have a material adverse effect on the business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity of Nortel Networks.  
Nortel Networks and any named directors and officers of Nortel Networks intend to vigorously defend these actions, suits, claims and  
proceedings.  
Environmental matters  
Nortel Networks operations are subject to a wide range of environmental laws in various jurisdictions around the world. Nortel Networks  
seeks to operate its business in compliance with such laws. In 2004, Nortel Networks expects to become subject to new European product  
content laws and product takeback and recycling requirements that will require  
F-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
full compliance by 2006. It is expected that these laws will require Nortel Networks to incur additional compliance costs. Although costs  
relating to environmental matters have not resulted in a material adverse effect on the business, results of operations, financial condition  
and liquidity in the past, there can be no assurance that Nortel Networks will not be required to incur such costs in the future. Nortel  
Networks has a corporate environmental management system standard and an environmental program to promote such compliance.  
Moreover, Nortel Networks has a periodic, risk-based, integrated environment, health and safety audit program.  
Nortel Networks environmental program focuses its activities on design for the environment, supply chain and packaging reduction  
issues. Nortel Networks works with its suppliers and other external groups to encourage the sharing of non-proprietary information on  
environmental research.  
Nortel Networks is exposed to liabilities and compliance costs arising from its past and current generation, management and disposal of  
hazardous substances and wastes. As of December 31, 2003, the accruals on the consolidated balance sheet for environmental matters  
were $33. Based on information available as of December 31, 2003, management believes that the existing accruals are sufficient to  
satisfy probable and reasonably estimable environmental liabilities related to known environmental matters. Any additional liability that  
may result from these matters, and any additional liabilities that may result in connection with other locations currently under  
investigation, are not expected to have a material adverse effect on the business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity of  
Nortel Networks.  
Nortel Networks has remedial activities under way at 12 sites which are either currently or previously owned or occupied facilities. An  
estimate of Nortel Networks anticipated remediation costs associated with all such sites, to the extent probable and reasonably estimable,  
is included in the environmental accruals referred to above in an approximate amount of $33.  
Nortel Networks is also listed as a potentially responsible party (“PRP”) under the U.S. Comprehensive Environmental Response,  
Compensation and Liability Act (“CERCLA”) at six Superfund sites in the U.S. An estimate of Nortel Networks share of the anticipated  
remediation costs associated with such Superfund sites is expected to be de minimis and is included in the environmental accruals of $33  
referred to above.  
Liability under CERCLA may be imposed on a joint and several basis, without regard to the extent of Nortel Networks involvement. In  
addition, the accuracy of Nortel Networks estimate of environmental liability is affected by several uncertainties such as additional  
requirements which may be identified in connection with remedial activities, the complexity and evolution of environmental laws and  
regulations, and the identification of presently unknown remediation requirements. Consequently, Nortel Networks liability could be  
greater than its current estimate.  
23. Subsequent events  
Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters  
As previously announced by Nortel Networks in October 2003, in late October 2003 the Nortel Networks Audit Committee initiated the  
Independent Review of the facts and circumstances leading to the First Restatement and engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection with  
the Independent Review.  
On March 10, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that as a result of the work done to date in connection with the Independent Review, it  
was re-examining the establishment, timing of, support for and release to income of certain accruals and provisions in prior periods.  
Further, it was likely that Nortel Networks would need to revise its previously announced unaudited results for the year ended  
December 31, 2003, and the results reported in certain of its quarterly reports for 2003, and to restate its previously filed financial results  
for one or more earlier periods. Nortel Networks announced on March 15, 2004 that the filing of Nortel Networks and NNL’s annual  
reports on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003 (the “2003 Annual Reports”) would be delayed beyond March 30, 2004.  
On April 5, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that the SEC had issued a formal order of investigation in connection with Nortel  
Networks previous restatement of its financial results for certain periods, as announced in October 2003, and Nortel Networks  
announcements in March 2004 regarding the likely need to revise certain previously announced results and restate previously filed  
financial results for one or more earlier periods. The matter had been the subject of an informal SEC inquiry. On April 13, 2004, Nortel  
Networks announced that it had received a letter from the staff of the Ontario Securities Commission (“OSC”) advising that there is an  
OSC Enforcement Staff investigation into the same matters that are the subject of the SEC investigation.  
F-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On April 28, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that the Independent Review was extended to include the second half of 2003 and it was  
determined that the previously announced unaudited results for the year ended December 31, 2003 needed to be revised and that the  
financial results reported in each of Nortel Networks quarterly periods of 2003 and for earlier periods including 2002 and 2001 needed to  
be restated. Nortel Networks announced that it and NNL were not expected to timely file their first quarter 2004 financial statements and,  
in accordance with Canadian securities regulations, their 2003 Canadian GAAP audited financial statements and Annual Information  
Form.  
In April 2004, Nortel Networks terminated for cause its former president and chief executive officer, former chief financial officer and  
former controller and, in August 2004, seven additional senior finance employees with significant responsibilities for Nortel Networks  
financial reporting as a whole or for their respective business units and geographic regions in August 2004.  
On May 14, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that it had received a Federal Grand Jury Subpoena for the production of certain  
documents, including financial statements and corporate, personnel and accounting records, prepared during the period from January 1,  
2000 to the date of the subpoena. The materials sought are pertinent to an ongoing criminal investigation being conducted by the U.S.  
Attorney’s Office for the Northern District of Texas, Dallas Division.  
On May 17, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that the OSC had issued a temporary order that prohibits all trading by directors, officers  
and certain current and former employees in the securities of Nortel Networks and NNL, which temporary order was replaced with a final  
order issued on May 31, 2004. The final order remains in effect until two full business days following the receipt by the OSC of all  
filings required to be made by Nortel Networks and NNL pursuant to Ontario securities laws.  
On June 29, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that it did not expect to timely file financial statements for the second quarter of 2004 and  
related periodic reports in accordance with U.S. and Canadian securities laws.  
On August 16, 2004, Nortel Networks received a letter from the Integrated Market Enforcement Team of the Royal Canadian Mounted  
Police (“RCMP”) advising Nortel Networks that the RCMP would be commencing a criminal investigation into Nortel Networks  
financial accounting situation.  
On August 19, 2004, Nortel Networks announced a new streamlined organizational structure, effective October 1, 2004, that involved,  
among other things, combining the businesses of Nortel Networks four segments into two business organizations: (i) Carrier Networks  
and Global Operations, and (ii) Enterprise Networks. Further, a focused workforce reduction of approximately 3,250 employees was  
announced. In addition, the Audit Committee anticipated that there would be work done, in addition to that portion of the inquiry which  
affects Nortel Networks and NNL’s ability to finalize their 2003 audited financial statements, in connection with its Independent Review,  
on remedial measures, internal controls and improvements to processes.  
On October 27, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that Nortel Networks and NNL did not expect to file their third quarter 2004 financial  
statements, and the related periodic reports, by the required deadlines in November 2004 in compliance with certain U.S. and Canadian  
securities regulations.  
Nortel Networks has terminated for cause 10 individuals, including its former president and chief executive officer, its former chief  
financial officer and its former controller. Nortel Networks has demanded repayment by the individuals terminated for cause of payments  
made under Nortel Networks bonus plans in respect of 2003.  
Subsequent to the March 10, 2004 announcement, numerous class action complaints, including ERISA class action complaints, have  
been filed against Nortel Networks in the U.S. and Canada. In addition, a derivative action complaint has been filed against Nortel  
Networks. Nortel Networks is subject to significant pending civil litigation which, if decided against Nortel Networks, could result in  
substantial damages or other penalties which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the business, results of operations, financial  
condition and liquidity of Nortel Networks (see note 22).  
In January 2005, the Audit Committee reported the findings of the Independent Review, together with its recommendations for governing  
principles for remedial measures that were developed for the Audit Committee by WCPHD. Each of Nortel Networks and NNL's Boards  
of Directors has adopted those recommendations in their entirety and directed management to develop a detailed plan and timetable for  
their implementation, and will monitor their implementation.  
Also in January 2005, the Nortel Networks Audit Committee determined to review the facts and circumstances leading to the restatement  
of certain revenues for specific transactions identified in the Second Restatement. This review will have a particular emphasis on the  
underlying conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues. The Audit Committee will develop any appropriate additional  
remedial measures, and has engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection with such review.  
EDC Support Facility  
On March 10, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that the filing of the 2003 Annual Reports with the SEC would be delayed. On  
March 15, 2004, Nortel Networks announced that the filing of the 2003 Annual Reports with the SEC would extend beyond March 30,  
2004 and that would result in EDC having the right to terminate its commitments under the EDC Support Facility and to exercise certain  
rights against the collateral under the related security agreements (see note 24). NNL obtained a waiver from EDC on March 29, 2004 of  
certain defaults under the EDC Support Facility related to the delay in filing the 2003 Annual Reports with the SEC, the trustees under  
Nortel Networks and NNL’s public trust indentures and EDC and to permit continued access to the EDC Support Facility in accordance  
with its terms while Nortel Networks and NNL completed their filing obligations. The waiver also applied to certain related breaches  
under the EDC Support Facility relating to the delayed filings and the planned restatements and revisions to Nortel  
F-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Networks and NNL’s prior financial results (the “Related Breaches”). The waiver was to remain in effect until the earliest of certain  
events or May 29, 2004. On March 29, 2004, NNL and EDC also amended the EDC Support Facility to provide that EDC may also  
suspend its obligation to issue NNL any additional support if events occur that have a material adverse effect on NNL’s business,  
financial position or results of operations and that such amendment would survive the waiver period.  
On May 28, 2004, NNL obtained a new waiver from EDC of certain defaults under the EDC Support Facility related to the delay in filing  
the 2003 Annual Reports and Nortel Networks and NNL’s quarterly reports on Form 10-Q for the three months ended March 31, 2004  
(the “First Quarter Reports”) and the Related Breaches, which waiver was to remain in effect until the earliest of certain events or  
August 30, 2004. This waiver reclassified the previously committed $300 revolving small bond sub-facility of the EDC Support Facility  
as uncommitted support.  
A further waiver was obtained from EDC effective August 20, 2004 (the “August Waiver”) related to the delay in filing the 2003 Annual  
Reports, the First Quarter Reports and Nortel Networks and NNL’s quarterly reports on Form 10-Q for the three months ended June 30,  
2004 (the “Second Quarter Reports”) and the Related Breaches, which waiver was to remain in effect until the earliest of certain events  
or September 30, 2004.  
On September 29, 2004, NNL obtained a new waiver from EDC (the “September Waiver”) which replaced the August Waiver on  
substantially the same terms as provided in the August Waiver except that the September Waiver was to remain in effect until the earliest  
of certain events or October 31, 2004.  
On October 29, 2004, NNL obtained a new waiver from EDC (the “October Waiver”) which replaced the September Waiver on  
substantially the same terms as the September Waiver except that the October Waiver remained in effect until the earliest of certain  
events or November 19, 2004.  
A further waiver was obtained from EDC effective November 19, 2004 (the “November Waiver”) related to the delay in filing the 2003  
Annual Reports, the First Quarter Reports, the Second Quarter Reports and Nortel Networks and NNL’s quarterly reports on Form 10-Q  
for the three months ended September 30, 2004 (the “Third Quarter Reports”, and together with the 2003 Annual Reports, the First  
Quarter Reports and the Second Quarter Reports, the “Reports”, and the Third Quarter Reports together with the First Quarter Reports  
and Second Quarter Reports, the “Quarterly Reports”) and the Related Breaches, which waiver was to remain in effect until the earliest of  
certain events or December 10, 2004.  
On December 10, 2004, NNL obtained a new waiver from EDC (the “December Waiver”) which replaced the November Waiver on  
substantially the same terms as the November Waiver except that: (i) the December Waiver included an amendment to the EDC Support  
Facility to extend the termination date of the EDC Support Facility to December 31, 2006 from December 31, 2005; and (ii) the  
December Waiver remains in effect until the earliest of certain events including the date on which Nortel Networks and NNL have filed  
all of the Reports or January 15, 2005.  
As Nortel Networks and NNL will not have filed all of the Reports by January 15, 2005, EDC will have the right on such date (absent a  
further waiver in relation to the delayed filings and the Related Breaches) to: (i) terminate the EDC Support Facility; (ii) exercise certain  
rights against collateral; or (iii) require NNL to cash collateralize all existing support.  
In addition, the Related Breaches will continue beyond the filing of the Reports. Accordingly, EDC will have the right beginning on  
January 15, 2005 (absent a further waiver of the Related Breaches) to terminate or suspend the EDC Support Facility and exercise certain  
other rights against collateral notwithstanding the filing of the Reports. While NNL is seeking a permanent waiver from EDC in  
connection with the Related Breaches, there can be no assurance that NNL will receive any waiver or as to the terms of any such waiver.  
The $300 revolving small bond sub-facility will not become committed support until all of the Reports have been filed with the SEC, the  
trustees under Nortel Networks and NNL’s public trust indentures and EDC and NNL obtains a permanent waiver of the Related  
Breaches.  
Credit facilities and security agreements  
On April 28, 2004, NNL notified the banks under the Five Year Facilities that it was terminating these facilities. Absent such termination,  
the banks would have been permitted, upon 30 days’ notice, to terminate their commitments under the Five Year Facilities as a result of  
NNL’s inability to file its annual report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003 by April 29, 2004. Upon termination, the  
Five Year Facilities were undrawn.  
F-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
As a result of the termination of the Five Year Facilities, certain foreign security agreements entered into by NNL and various of its  
subsidiaries under which shares of certain subsidiaries of NNL incorporated outside of the U.S. and Canada were pledged in favor of the  
banks under the Five Year Facilities, EDC and the holders of Nortel Networks and NNL’s outstanding public debt securities also  
terminated in accordance with their terms (see note 24). In addition, guarantees by certain subsidiaries of NNL incorporated outside of  
the U.S. and Canada terminated in accordance with their terms. Security agreements remain in place under which substantially all of the  
assets of NNL located in the U.S. and Canada and those of most of its U.S. and Canadian subsidiaries, including the shares of certain of  
NNL’s U.S. and Canadian subsidiaries, are pledged in favor of EDC and the holders of Nortel Networks and NNL’s outstanding public  
debt securities. In addition, the guarantees by certain of NNL’s wholly owned subsidiaries, including NNI, most of NNL’s Canadian  
subsidiaries, Nortel Networks (Asia) Limited, Nortel Networks (Ireland) Limited and Nortel Networks U.K. Limited, of NNL’s  
obligations under the EDC Support Facility and Nortel Networks and NNL’s outstanding public debt securities remain in place.  
Debt securities  
As a result of the delay in filing the Reports, Nortel Networks and NNL have not been in compliance with their obligations to deliver  
their respective SEC filings to relevant parties under Nortel Networks and NNL’s public debt indentures. As of December 31, 2004,  
approximately $1,800 of notes of NNL (or its subsidiaries) and $1,800 of convertible debt securities of Nortel Networks were  
outstanding.  
These delays have not resulted in an automatic event of default and acceleration of the outstanding long-term debt and such default and  
acceleration cannot occur unless notice of such non-compliance from holders of 25% of the outstanding principal amount of any relevant  
debt securities is provided to Nortel Networks or NNL, as applicable, and Nortel Networks or NNL, as applicable, fail to file and deliver  
the relevant report within 90 days after such notice is provided, all in accordance with the terms of the indentures. While such notice  
could have been given at any time after March 30, 2004, neither Nortel Networks nor NNL has received a notice to the date of this report.  
As a result of the delay in filing certain of the Reports, Nortel Networks and NNL continue not to be in compliance with their obligations  
under Nortel Networks and NNL’s public debt indentures as described above. If notice were given and acceleration of Nortel Networks  
and NNL’s debt securities were to occur, Nortel Networks may be unable to meet its payment obligations.  
Stock-based compensation plans  
As a result of Nortel Networks March 10, 2004 announcement, as described above under “Nortel Networks Audit Committee  
Independent Review; restatements; related matters”, Nortel Networks suspended as of March 10, 2004: the purchase of Nortel Networks  
Corporation common shares under the ESPPs; the exercise of outstanding options granted under the 2000 Plan or 1986 Plan, or the grant  
of any additional options under those plans, or the exercise of outstanding options granted under employee stock option plans previously  
assumed by Nortel Networks in connection with mergers and acquisitions; and the purchase of units in a Nortel Networks stock fund or  
purchase of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares under Nortel Networks defined contribution and investments plans, until such  
time, at the earliest, that Nortel Networks is in compliance with U.S. and Canadian regulatory securities filing requirements.  
Stock exchanges  
As a result of the continued delay in filing the Quarterly Reports, Nortel Networks is in breach of the continued listing requirements of  
the NYSE and the TSX. The NYSE has granted Nortel Networks and NNL an extension up to March 31, 2005 by which to file the 2003  
Annual Reports. To date, neither the NYSE nor the TSX has commenced any suspension or delisting procedures in respect of Nortel  
Networks Corporation common shares and other of Nortel Networks and NNL’s listed securities. The commencement of any suspension  
or delisting procedures by either exchange remains, at all times, at the discretion of such exchange.  
Directory and operator services business  
On August 2, 2004, Nortel Networks completed the contribution of certain assets and liabilities of its directory and operator services  
(“DOS”) business to VoltDelta Resources LLC (“VoltDelta”), a wholly owned subsidiary of Volt Information Sciences, Inc. (“VIS”), in  
return for a 24 percent interest in VoltDelta. After a period of two years, Nortel Networks and VIS each have an option to cause Nortel  
Networks to sell its VoltDelta shares to VIS for proceeds ranging from $25 to $70. As a result of this transaction, approximately 160  
Nortel Networks DOS employees in North America  
F-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
and Mexico joined VoltDelta. Nortel Networks recorded a gain on sale of businesses and assets of approximately $50 in the third quarter  
of 2004.  
Evolution of Nortel Networks supply chain strategy  
On June 29, 2004, Nortel Networks announced an agreement with Flextronics International Ltd. (“Flextronics”), regarding the divestiture  
of substantially all of Nortel Networks remaining manufacturing operations, including product integration, testing and repair operations  
carried out in Nortel Networks Systems Houses in Calgary and Montreal, Canada and Campinas, Brazil, as well as certain activities  
related to these locations, including the management of the supply chain, related suppliers, and third-party logistics. In Europe,  
Flextronics has made an offer to purchase similar operations at the Nortel Networks Monkstown, Northern Ireland and Chateaudun,  
France Systems Houses, subject to the completion of the required information and consultation process.  
Under the terms of the agreement and offer, Flextronics will also acquire Nortel Networks global repair services, as well as certain design  
assets in Ottawa and Monkstown related to hardware and embedded software design, and related product verification for certain  
established optical products.  
Nortel Networks and Flextronics have entered into a four year supply agreement for manufacturing services (whereby Flextronics will  
manage approximately $2,500 of Nortel Networks annual cost of sales) and a three year supply agreement for design services. The  
portion of the transaction related to the optical design activities in Ottawa and Monkstown was completed on November 1, 2004. The  
portions of the transaction related to the manufacturing activities in Montreal and Calgary are expected to close in the first and second  
quarters of 2005, respectively. The balance of the transaction is expected to close on separate dates occurring during the first half of  
2005. These transactions are subject to customary conditions and regulatory approvals.  
The successful completion of the agreement and offer with Flextronics will result in the transfer of approximately 2,500 employees from  
Nortel Networks to Flextronics. Nortel Networks expects to receive cash proceeds ranging from approximately $675 to $725, which will  
be allocated to each separate closing and, with respect to each closing, will be paid on an installment basis up to nine months thereafter.  
Such payments will be subject to a number of adjustments, including potential post-closing date asset valuations and potential post-  
closing indemnity payments. Flextronics also has the ability in certain cases to exercise rights to sell back to Nortel Networks certain  
inventory and equipment after the expiration of a specified period (of up to fifteen months) following each respective closing date. Nortel  
Networks does not expect such rights to be exercised with respect to any material amount of inventory and/or equipment. The cash  
proceeds estimate is comprised of approximately $475 to $525 for inventory and equipment and $200 for intangible assets. The cash  
proceeds would be partially offset by related estimated transaction costs (including transition, potential severance, and information  
technology implementation and real estate costs) of approximately $200.  
Other  
On January 8, 2004, Nortel Networks renegotiated an agreement with a certain customer and reduced Nortel Networks aggregate  
undrawn customer financing commitments from $177 to $69.  
On February 3, 2004, Nortel Networks sold approximately 7 million common shares of Entrust Inc. (“Entrust”) for cash consideration of  
$33, resulting in a gain of $18. As a result of this transaction, Nortel Networks no longer holds any equity interest in Entrust.  
On March 1, 2004, Nortel Networks purchased land and two buildings for $87 that were previously leased by Nortel Networks. As a  
result, Nortel Networks extinguished a debt of $87.  
On May 7, 2004, Nortel Networks received $80 in proceeds from the sale of certain assets in connection with a customer contract  
settlement in Latin America. This resulted in a gain of $78, which will be included in (gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets for the  
three months ended June 30, 2004.  
In August 2004, Nortel Networks entered into a contract with Bharat Sanchar Nigram Limited to establish a wireless network in India.  
Nortel Networks commitments to date for orders received under this contract have resulted in an estimated project loss of approximately  
$130, which has been recorded in the third quarter of 2004.  
F-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On October 26, 2004, Nortel Networks entered into an agreement with Foundry Networks, Inc. (“Foundry”) to settle outstanding patent  
infringement claims and counterclaims by the parties. As part of the settlement, Nortel Networks granted Foundry a four year license  
under certain patents, and Foundry paid $35 to Nortel Networks.  
On December 15 and 16, 2004, Nortel Networks sold certain notes receivable and convertible notes receivable that had been received as  
a result of the restructuring of a customer financing arrangement for cash proceeds of $116. The net carrying amount of the notes  
receivable and convertible notes receivable was $56.  
On December 23, 2004, a customer financing arrangement was restructured. The notes receivable that were restructured had a net  
carrying amount as of December 31, 2003 of $13, net of provisions for doubtful accounts of $147 ($55 of the provision is included in  
discontinued operations). Nortel Networks is currently assessing the value of the restructured notes receivable and expects that an  
increase in value from the net carrying amount has occurred.  
24. Supplemental consolidating financial information  
As of December 31, 2003, and as a result of NNL’s credit ratings, various liens, pledges and guarantees were effective under security  
agreements entered into by NNL and various of its subsidiaries that pledged substantially all of the assets of NNL in favor of the banks  
under the Five Year Facilities, EDC and the holders of Nortel Networks and NNL’s outstanding public debt securities, which debt  
securities represent substantially all of Nortel Networks consolidated long-term debt (see notes 11 and 23).  
The security agreements were originally entered into in connection with the $1,510 December 2001 364-day credit facilities (which  
expired on December 13, 2002). The security became effective April 4, 2002, following Moody’s Investors Service, Inc. (“Moody’s”)  
downgrade of NNL’s senior long-term debt rating to below investment grade, in respect of the then existing credit facilities including the  
Five Year Facilities. Consequently, on April 4, 2002 and in accordance with the negative pledge covenants in the indentures for all Nortel  
Networks outstanding public debt securities, all such public debt securities became, under the terms of the security agreements, secured  
equally and ratably with the obligations under NNL’s and NNI’s then existing credit facilities.  
As of December 31, 2003, the security provided under the security agreements was comprised of pledges of substantially all of the assets  
of NNL and those of most of its U.S. and Canadian subsidiaries and pledges of shares in certain of NNL’s other subsidiaries. In addition,  
certain of NNL’s wholly owned subsidiaries guaranteed NNL’s obligations under the credit and support facilities and outstanding public  
debt securities (the “Guarantor Subsidiaries”). Non-guarantor subsidiaries (the “Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries”) represented either wholly  
owned subsidiaries of NNL whose shares were pledged, or were the remaining subsidiaries of NNL which did not provide liens, pledges  
or guarantees (see note 23).  
If NNL’s senior long-term debt rating by Moody’s returns to Baa2 (with a stable outlook) and its rating by Standard & Poor’s returns to  
BBB (with a stable outlook), the security and guarantees will be released in full. If both the Five Year Facilities and the EDC Support  
Facility are terminated, or expire, the security and guarantees will also be released in full. NNL may provide EDC with cash collateral in  
an amount equal to the total amount of its outstanding obligations and undrawn commitments and expenses under the EDC Support  
Facility (or any other alternative collateral or arrangements acceptable to EDC) in lieu of the security provided under the security  
agreements (see note 11). Accordingly, if the EDC Support Facility is secured by cash or other alternate collateral or arrangements  
acceptable to EDC and if the Five Year Facilities are terminated or expire, the security and guarantees will also be released in full (see  
note 23 for additional related information including the termination of the Five Year Facilities).  
The following supplemental consolidating financial data illustrates, in separate columns, the composition of Nortel Networks  
Corporation, NNL, the Guarantor Subsidiaries, the Non-Guarantor Subsidiaries, eliminations and the consolidated total as of  
December 31, 2003 and 2002 and for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001 (see note 23).  
Investments in subsidiaries are accounted for using the equity method for purposes of the supplemental consolidating financial data. Net  
earnings (loss) of subsidiaries are therefore reflected in the investment account and net earnings (loss). The principal elimination entries  
eliminate investments in subsidiaries and intercompany balances and transactions. The financial data may not necessarily be indicative of  
the results of operations or financial position had the subsidiaries been operating as independent entities.  
F-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Consolidating Statements of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2003:  
Nortel  
Networks  
Corporation  
Nortel  
Networks  
Limited  
Non-  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Eliminations  
Total  
Revenues  
Cost of revenues  
$
$
3,182  
1,995  
$
7,566  
5,106  
$
2,804  
2,110  
$
(3,359)  
(3,359)  
$ 10,193  
5,852  
Gross profit  
1,187  
2,460  
694  
4,341  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Amortization of acquired technology and other  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges  
430  
814  
66  
4
1,327  
878  
246  
182  
268  
101  
16  
(28)  
(5)  
1,939  
1,960  
101  
16  
284  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
(3)  
(4)  
Operating earnings (loss)  
(127)  
86  
12  
160  
34  
45  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense  
Long-term debt  
Other  
24  
301  
445  
(83)  
(68)  
(4)  
(4)  
(69)  
(26)  
45  
(181)  
(28)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes,  
minority interests and equity in net loss of associated companies  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
(59)  
5
(113)  
184  
240  
(50)  
213  
(59)  
281  
80  
(54)  
304  
71  
351  
190  
404  
154  
(28)  
9
(35)  
(1,104)  
361  
(63)  
(36)  
Minority interests — net of tax  
Equity in net earnings (loss) of associated companies — net of tax  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
250  
184  
422  
147  
594  
95  
135  
37  
(1,139)  
(279)  
262  
184  
Net earnings (loss) before cumulative effect of accounting change  
Cumulative effect of accounting change — net of tax  
434  
569  
(4)  
689  
(8)  
172  
(1,418)  
446  
(12)  
Net earnings (loss)  
$
434  
$
565  
$
681  
$
172  
$
(1,418)  
$
434  
F-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Consolidating Statements of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2002:  
Nortel  
Networks  
Corporation  
Nortel  
Networks  
Limited  
Non-  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Eliminations  
Total  
Revenues  
Cost of revenues  
$
$
3,026  
2,720  
$
8,557  
5,433  
$
2,737  
2,262  
$
(3,312)  
(3,312)  
$ 11,008  
7,103  
Gross profit  
306  
3,124  
475  
3,905  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Amortization of acquired technology and other  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges  
4
593  
870  
1,647  
937  
20  
309  
276  
137  
110  
2,553  
2,083  
157  
110  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
346  
16  
203  
834  
(8)  
392  
320  
(29)  
595  
1,500  
(21)  
Operating earnings (loss)  
(4)  
(1,519)  
(80)  
(509)  
134  
(1,040)  
(216)  
(3,072)  
(5)  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense  
Long-term debt  
Other  
682  
(525)  
(84)  
(105)  
(53)  
(31)  
1
(220)  
(52)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes,  
minority interests and equity in net loss of associated companies  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
594  
(2)  
(1,704)  
330  
(428)  
(49)  
(1,286)  
189  
(525)  
(3,349)  
468  
592  
(1,374)  
(477)  
(1,097)  
31  
(525)  
(26)  
(2,881)  
5
Minority interests — net of tax  
Equity in net earnings (loss) of associated companies — net of tax  
(3,485)  
(789)  
(773)  
(10)  
5,040  
(17)  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
(2,893)  
(101)  
(2,163)  
(101)  
(1,250)  
(66)  
(1,076)  
4,489  
167  
(2,893)  
(101)  
Net earnings (loss)  
$
(2,994)  
$
(2,264)  
$
(1,316)  
$
(1,076)  
$
4,656  
$
(2,994)  
F-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Consolidating Statements of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2001:  
Nortel  
Networks  
Corporation  
Nortel  
Networks  
Limited  
Non-  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Eliminations  
Total  
Revenues  
Cost of revenues  
$
$
5,196  
4,639  
$
14,124  
11,044  
$
4,970  
4,319  
$
(5,390)  
(5,390)  
$ 18,900  
14,612  
Gross profit  
557  
3,080  
651  
4,288  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
In-process research and development expense  
Amortization of intangibles  
Acquired technology and other  
Goodwill  
(21)  
679  
1,085  
4,499  
1,654  
954  
377  
15  
6,111  
3,116  
15  
22  
18  
574  
1,561  
232  
2,475  
232  
806  
4,058  
248  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Special charges  
(2)  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
505  
(5)  
1,257  
1,654  
(90)  
10,169  
1,231  
233  
11,426  
3,390  
138  
Operating earnings (loss)  
21  
(1,747)  
306  
(8,027)  
(354)  
(15,267)  
(57)  
(25,020)  
(506)  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense  
Long-term debt  
Other  
(21)  
(380)  
(32)  
1
(145)  
(26)  
3
(72)  
(34)  
(6)  
(208)  
(103)  
Earnings (loss) from continuing operations before income taxes,  
minority interests and equity in net loss of associated companies  
Income tax benefit (expense)  
(31)  
(4)  
(1,612)  
1,777  
(8,450)  
309  
(15,364)  
669  
(380)  
(25,837)  
2,751  
(35)  
(23,220)  
165  
(11,171)  
(8,141)  
(4,744)  
(14,695)  
(380)  
(26)  
38,978  
(23,086)  
(34)  
Minority interests — net of tax  
Equity in net earnings (loss) of associated companies — net of tax  
(8)  
7
(150)  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations — net of tax  
(23,255)  
(2,467)  
(11,006)  
(1,994)  
(12,885)  
(1,296)  
(14,696)  
(473)  
38,572  
3,763  
(23,270)  
(2,467)  
Net earnings (loss) before cumulative effect of accounting change  
Cumulative effect of accounting change — net of tax  
(25,722)  
(13,000)  
15  
(14,181)  
(15,169)  
42,335  
(25,737)  
15  
Net earnings (loss)  
$
(25,722)  
$ (12,985)  
$
(14,181)  
$
(15,169)  
$
42,335  
$ (25,722)  
F-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Consolidating Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2003:  
Nortel  
Networks  
Corporation  
Nortel  
Networks  
Limited  
Non-  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Eliminations  
Total  
ASSETS  
Current assets  
Cash and cash equivalents  
Restricted cash and cash equivalents  
Accounts receivable — net  
Intercompany/related party accounts receivable  
Inventories — net  
Income taxes recoverable  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other current assets  
$
68  
50  
$
(8)  
$
3,164  
37  
1,671  
1,053  
565  
52  
302  
178  
$
773  
1
520  
1,099  
323  
25  
$
$
3,997  
63  
2,505  
1,190  
90  
369  
315  
25  
314  
345  
302  
13  
(2,547)  
67  
31  
106  
118  
1,089  
7,022  
2,847  
(2,547)  
8,529  
Total current assets  
Investments  
5,728  
1,995  
166  
475  
40  
1,673  
102  
(7,568)  
537  
817  
1,962  
1
1,655  
60  
285  
1,487  
364  
343  
45  
69  
175  
(196)  
(2,190)  
244  
1,656  
2,305  
86  
3,397  
374  
Intercompany advances  
Plant and equipment — net  
Goodwill  
Intangible assets — net  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other assets  
37  
$
$
5,883  
$
$
5,540  
$
$
4,486  
$
$
5,615  
$
$
(4,933)  
$ 16,591  
Total assets  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Current liabilities  
Notes payable  
Trade and other accounts payable  
Intercompany/related party accounts payable  
Payroll and benefit-related liabilities  
Contractual liabilities  
Restructuring  
Other accrued liabilities  
Long-term debt due within one year  
1
109  
2
2
347  
(4,071)  
137  
26  
52  
356  
11  
3
406  
3,211  
479  
309  
138  
12  
107  
3,298  
146  
195  
16  
$
17  
861  
(2,547)  
764  
530  
206  
2,505  
119  
26  
1,660  
101  
463  
7
138  
(3,140)  
6,307  
4,244  
(2,547)  
5,002  
Total current liabilities  
Long-term debt  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other liabilities  
1,800  
1,549  
930  
11  
127  
173  
1,811  
297  
415  
18  
204  
3,891  
191  
2,945  
Intercompany advances  
1,882  
(2,190)  
1,938  
(650)  
8,715  
6,763  
81  
(4,737)  
536  
12,029  
617  
Total liabilities  
Minority interests in subsidiary companies  
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Preferred shares  
Common shares  
Additional paid-in capital  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Accumulated deficit  
33,674  
3,341  
(32,532)  
(538)  
536  
1,211  
22,031  
(17,066)  
(522)  
237  
6,089  
1,081  
(12,661)  
1,025  
47  
1,560  
19,342  
(9)  
(22,139)  
(30)  
(820)  
(8,860)  
(42,454)  
9
51,866  
(473)  
33,674  
3,341  
(32,532)  
(538)  
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)  
3,945  
5,883  
6,190  
5,540  
(4,229)  
4,486  
(1,229)  
5,615  
(732)  
3,945  
Total shareholders’ equity  
$
$
$
$
$
(4,933)  
$ 16,591  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity  
F-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Consolidating Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2002:  
Nortel  
Networks  
Corporation  
Nortel  
Networks  
Limited  
Non-  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Eliminations  
Total  
ASSETS  
Current assets  
Cash and cash equivalents  
Restricted cash and cash equivalents  
Accounts receivable — net  
Intercompany/related party accounts receivable  
Inventories — net  
Income taxes recoverable  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other current assets  
$
35  
1
12  
$
251  
6
288  
4,147  
546  
1
$
2,392  
176  
1,524  
994  
712  
51  
$
1,112  
67  
414  
713  
248  
61  
$
$
3,790  
249  
2,226  
2
1,506  
114  
790  
(5,852)  
178  
146  
615  
395  
(15)  
109  
650  
48  
5,563  
6,859  
2,709  
(5,852)  
9,327  
Total current assets  
Investments  
Plant and equipment — net  
Goodwill  
Intangible assets — net  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other assets  
5,124  
(26)  
36  
1,531  
425  
39  
1,077  
605  
(8,055)  
865  
1,954  
2
1,510  
1,278  
518  
402  
245  
98  
21  
395  
1,119  
237  
1,692  
2,199  
139  
2,582  
785  
(1,529)  
$
$
5,182  
$
$
9,240  
$
$
4,413  
$
$
4,388  
$
$
(6,262)  
$ 16,961  
Total assets  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Current liabilities  
Notes payable  
Trade and other accounts payable  
Intercompany/related party accounts payable  
Payroll and benefit-related liabilities  
Contractual liabilities  
Restructuring  
Other accrued liabilities  
Long-term debt due within one year  
289  
(1)  
41  
2
342  
110  
104  
43  
78  
540  
174  
3
391  
3,052  
298  
536  
329  
25  
70  
2,401  
83  
316  
100  
433  
55  
$
30  
803  
(5,852)  
485  
894  
507  
3,257  
243  
2,243  
14  
329  
1,393  
6,866  
3,483  
(5,852)  
6,219  
Total current liabilities  
Long-term debt  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other liabilities  
1,800  
1,603  
263  
764  
166  
84  
2,071  
391  
(10)  
1,455  
3,960  
337  
2,761  
(1,529)  
2,129  
4,023  
9,187  
5,319  
95  
(7,381)  
536  
13,277  
631  
Total liabilities  
Minority interests in subsidiary companies  
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Preferred shares  
Common shares  
Additional paid-in capital  
Deferred stock option compensation  
Accumulated deficit  
33,234  
3,753  
(17)  
(32,966)  
(951)  
536  
1,211  
22,007  
(17,596)  
(941)  
342  
6,129  
1,432  
(13,423)  
746  
46  
2,134  
19,507  
(26)  
(22,565)  
(122)  
(924)  
(9,474)  
(42,946)  
26  
53,584  
317  
33,234  
3,753  
(17)  
(32,966)  
(951)  
Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)  
3,053  
5,182  
5,217  
9,240  
(4,774)  
4,413  
(1,026)  
4,388  
583  
3,053  
Total shareholders’ equity  
$
$
$
$
$
(6,262)  
$ 16,961  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity  
F-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Consolidating Statements of Cash Flows for the year ended December 31, 2003:  
Nortel  
Networks  
Corporation  
Nortel  
Networks  
Limited  
Non-  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Eliminations  
Total  
Cash flows from (used in) operating activities  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Adjustments to reconcile net earnings (loss) from continuing  
operations to net cash from (used in) operating activities, net of  
effects from acquisitions and divestitures of businesses:  
Amortization and depreciation  
$
250  
$
422  
$
594  
$
135  
$
(1,139)  
$
262  
75  
249  
217  
2
(9)  
4
13  
541  
Non-cash portion of special charges and related asset write  
downs  
Equity in net loss of associated companies  
Current and deferred stock option compensation  
Deferred income taxes  
(304)  
15  
14  
9
(351)  
4
5
83  
(4)  
(7)  
291  
190  
(831)  
76  
(404)  
19  
(82)  
74  
(4)  
(904)  
(741)  
1,506  
87  
36  
42  
(50)  
161  
(4)  
(51)  
(786)  
(153)  
1,104  
35  
Other liabilities  
4
(Gain) loss on repurchases of outstanding debt securities  
(Gain) loss on sale or write-down of investments and businesses  
Other — net  
Change in operating assets and liabilities  
Intercompany/related party activity  
(40)  
(974)  
396  
161  
766  
2
(836)  
Net cash from (used in) operating activities of continuing operations  
(93)  
(114)  
383  
(91)  
85  
Cash flows from (used in) investing activities  
Expenditures for plant and equipment  
Proceeds on disposals of plant and equipment  
Acquisitions of investments and businesses — net of cash acquired  
Proceeds on sale of investments and businesses  
(41)  
7
(60)  
6
(85)  
28  
(6)  
(46)  
3
8
(172)  
38  
(58)  
107  
101  
Net cash from (used in) investing activities of continuing operations  
(88)  
38  
(35)  
(85)  
Cash flows from (used in) financing activities  
Dividends on preferred shares  
Dividends paid by subsidiaries to minority interests  
Increase (decrease) in notes payable — net  
Proceeds from long-term debt  
Repayments of long-term debt  
Repayments of capital leases payable  
3
(35)  
(199)  
4
(49)  
(69)  
35  
(35)  
(35)  
(45)  
(270)  
(12)  
3
(2)  
(12)  
Issuance of common shares  
Net cash from (used in) financing activities of continuing operations  
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents  
3
3
(234)  
2
(10)  
137  
(118)  
34  
(359)  
176  
Net cash from (used in) continuing operations  
Net cash from (used in) discontinued operations  
(87)  
120  
(434)  
175  
548  
224  
(210)  
(129)  
(183)  
390  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year  
33  
35  
(259)  
251  
772  
2,392  
(339)  
1,112  
207  
3,790  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year  
$
68  
$
(8)  
$
3,164  
$
773  
$
$
3,997  
F-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Consolidating Statements of Cash Flows for the year ended December 31, 2002:  
Nortel  
Networks  
Corporation  
Nortel  
Networks  
Limited  
Non-  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Eliminations  
Total  
Cash flows from (used in) operating activities  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Adjustments to reconcile net earnings (loss) from continuing  
operations to net cash from (used in) operating activities, net of  
effects from acquisitions and divestitures of businesses:  
Amortization and depreciation  
$
(2,893)  
$
(2,163)  
$
(1,250)  
$
(1,076)  
212  
$
4,489  
$
(2,893)  
87  
402  
701  
Non-cash portion of special charges and related asset write  
downs  
Equity in net loss of associated companies  
Current and deferred stock option compensation  
Deferred income taxes  
3,485  
16  
199  
789  
(417)  
(4)  
(60)  
17  
447  
(578)  
91  
464  
773  
(137)  
18  
18  
(553)  
904  
(152)  
479  
10  
110  
113  
(16)  
(17)  
(175)  
691  
(287)  
1,142  
17  
110  
(425)  
(2)  
(60)  
18  
(191)  
815  
(5,040)  
26  
Other liabilities  
(Gain) loss on repurchases of outstanding debt securities  
(Gain) loss on sale or write-down of investments and businesses  
Other — net  
Change in operating assets and liabilities  
Intercompany/related party activity  
64  
(202)  
348  
Net cash from (used in) operating activities of continuing operations  
818  
(1,592)  
487  
44  
(525)  
(768)  
Cash flows from (used in) investing activities  
Expenditures for plant and equipment  
Proceeds on disposals of plant and equipment  
Acquisitions of investments and businesses — net of cash acquired  
Proceeds on sale of investments and businesses  
Investments in subsidiaries  
(65)  
16  
(5)  
23  
(242)  
390  
(24)  
33  
(45)  
48  
(352)  
406  
(29)  
104  
(2,287)  
2,287  
Net cash from (used in) investing activities of continuing operations  
(2,287)  
(31)  
157  
3
2,287  
129  
Cash flows from (used in) financing activities  
Dividends on preferred shares  
Dividends paid by subsidiaries to minority interests  
Decrease in notes payable — net  
(26)  
26  
(26)  
(26)  
(333)  
33  
(174)  
1
(159)  
32  
Proceeds from long-term debt  
Repayments of long-term debt  
Repayments of capital leases payable  
Issuance of common shares  
Issuance of prepaid forward purchase contracts  
Stock option fair value increment  
863  
623  
(460)  
(3)  
2,287  
(138)  
(13)  
(13)  
(1)  
(611)  
(17)  
863  
623  
(2,287)  
525  
(525)  
Net cash from (used in) financing activities of continuing operations  
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents  
1,486  
1,798  
13  
(849)  
45  
(141)  
16  
(1,762)  
532  
74  
Net cash from (used in) continuing operations  
Net cash from (used in) discontinued operations  
17  
188  
104  
(160)  
246  
(78)  
(1)  
(33)  
349  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year  
17  
18  
292  
(41)  
86  
2,306  
(79)  
1,191  
316  
3,474  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year  
$
35  
$
251  
$
2,392  
$
1,112  
$
$
3,790  
F-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Consolidating Statements of Cash Flows for the year ended December 31, 2001:  
Nortel  
Networks  
Corporation  
Nortel  
Networks  
Limited  
Non-  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
Guarantor  
Subsidiaries  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Eliminations  
Total  
Cash flows from (used in) operating activities  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
Adjustments to reconcile net earnings (loss) from continuing  
operations to net cash from (used in) operating activities, net of  
effects from acquisitions and divestitures of businesses:  
Amortization and depreciation  
$
(23,255)  
$ (11,006)  
$
(12,885)  
$
(14,696)  
$
38,572  
$ (23,270)  
191  
2,608  
2,866  
15  
5,665  
15  
In-process research and development expense  
Non-cash portion of special charges and related asset write  
downs  
Equity in net loss of associated companies  
Current and deferred stock option compensation  
Deferred income taxes  
23,220  
88  
11,171  
1,459  
4,744  
11,213  
(7)  
248  
12,760  
150  
248  
(1,513)  
(38,978)  
(3)  
(537)  
(797)  
(176)  
Other liabilities  
(73)  
85  
(21)  
(9)  
(Gain) loss on sale or write-down of investments and businesses  
Other — net  
Change in operating assets and liabilities  
Intercompany/related party activity  
69  
(458)  
522  
253  
184  
27  
506  
(139)  
43  
153  
(371)  
5,227  
1,788  
(588)  
1,391  
219  
(1,529)  
7,183  
(2,539)  
379  
Net cash from (used in) operating activities of continuing operations  
19  
(2,572)  
2,111  
648  
206  
Cash flows from (used in) investing activities  
Expenditures for plant and equipment  
Proceeds on disposals of plant and equipment  
Acquisitions of investments and businesses — net of cash acquired  
Proceeds on sale of investments and businesses  
Investments in subsidiaries  
(317)  
23  
(13)  
6
(833)  
185  
(76)  
403  
(152)  
10  
195  
(1,302)  
208  
(79)  
604  
Net cash from (used in) investing activities of continuing operations  
(301)  
(321)  
53  
(569)  
Cash flows from (used in) financing activities  
Dividends on preferred shares  
Dividends paid by subsidiaries to minority interests  
Increase (decrease) in notes payable — net  
Proceeds from long-term debt  
Proceeds from Parent  
Repayments of long-term debt  
Repayments of capital leases payable  
Issuance of common shares  
(123)  
(27)  
12  
1,500  
1,800  
(250)  
(3)  
39  
20  
(208)  
(5)  
27  
(27)  
(123)  
(27)  
(230)  
3,286  
(470)  
(26)  
146  
(281)  
10  
1,756  
(1,800)  
146  
(12)  
(18)  
Net cash from (used in) financing activities of continuing operations  
Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents  
(21)  
3,032  
1
(301)  
(7)  
(154)  
(4)  
2,556  
(10)  
Net cash from (used in) continuing operations  
Net cash from (used in) discontinued operations  
(2)  
160  
(108)  
1,482  
(200)  
543  
(23)  
2,183  
(331)  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents  
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year  
(2)  
20  
52  
(93)  
1,282  
1,024  
520  
671  
1,852  
1,622  
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year  
$
18  
$
(41)  
$
2,306  
$
1,191  
$
$
3,474  
F-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Quarterly Financial Data (Unaudited)  
4th Quarter  
3rd Quarter  
2nd Quarter  
1st Quarter  
(millions of U.S. dollars, except per share amounts)  
2003**  
2002  
2003  
2002  
2003  
2002  
2003  
2002  
Revenues  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
Gross profit  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
Special charges  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
Other income (expense) — net  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
Net earnings (loss) from continuing operations  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
Net earnings (loss) from discontinued operations  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
$ 2,525  
2,616  
$ 2,266  
2,344  
$ 2,350  
2,322  
$ 2,338  
2,285  
$ 2,788  
2,920  
$ 2,377  
2,298  
$ 2,906  
3,150  
$ 3,266  
1,434  
86  
1,029  
1,109  
1,192  
1,130  
910  
730  
1,028  
882  
1,013  
1,029  
1,044  
895  
819  
1,037  
178  
269  
70  
80  
1,171  
1,089  
(2)  
(22)  
361  
295  
112  
140  
463  
442  
15  
(34)  
100  
148  
(13)  
28  
23  
60  
(23)  
101  
4
94  
(9)  
(100)  
143  
(167)  
(195)  
130  
88  
(1,735)  
(1,556)  
38  
(93)  
(632)  
(452)  
(171)  
(234)  
(752)  
(690)  
501  
(1)  
(99)  
55  
43  
2
5
(1)  
(8)  
3
(62)  
190  
122  
16  
55  
27  
Net earnings (loss) before cumulative effect of accounting  
change  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
Cumulative effect of accounting change  
As previously reported  
(168)  
(294)  
185  
131  
(1,733)  
(1,551)  
37  
(101)  
(629)  
(514)  
19  
(112)  
(736)  
(635)  
528  
(8)  
(12)  
As reported or restated*  
Net earnings (loss)  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
528  
(168)  
(294)  
185  
131  
(1,733)  
(1,551)  
37  
(101)  
(629)  
(514)  
11  
(124)  
(736)  
(635)  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
— from discontinued operations  
(0.04)  
(0.05)  
0.03  
0.02  
(0.40)  
(0.36)  
0.01  
(0.02)  
(0.18)  
(0.13)  
(0.04)  
(0.06)  
(0.23)  
(0.21)  
0.12  
0.00  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
0.00  
(0.02)  
0.01  
0.01  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
(0.02)  
0.04  
0.03  
0.00  
0.01  
Basic earnings (loss) per common share  
As previously reported  
(0.04)  
(0.07)  
0.04  
0.03  
(0.40)  
(0.36)  
0.01  
(0.02)  
(0.18)  
(0.15)  
0.00  
(0.03)  
(0.23)  
(0.20)  
As reported or restated*  
0.12  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
— from continuing operations  
As previously reported  
As reported or restated*  
— from discontinued operations  
As previously reported  
(0.04)  
(0.05)  
0.03  
0.02  
(0.40)  
(0.36)  
0.01  
(0.02)  
(0.18)  
(0.13)  
(0.04)  
(0.06)  
(0.23)  
(0.21)  
0.12  
0.00  
0.00  
(0.02)  
0.01  
0.01  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
0.00  
(0.02)  
0.04  
0.03  
0.00  
0.01  
As reported or restated*  
Diluted earnings (loss) per common share  
As previously reported  
(0.04)  
(0.07)  
0.04  
0.03  
(0.40)  
(0.36)  
0.01  
(0.02)  
(0.18)  
(0.15)  
0.00  
(0.03)  
(0.23)  
(0.20)  
As reported or restated*  
0.12  
*
As discussed in note 3 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements and Management’s Discussions and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of  
Operations — Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters, the unaudited quarterly financial data for the first three quarters of  
2003 and all of 2002 have been restated. A comparison of previously reported and restated unaudited quarterly financial data is presented in the tables above.  
**  
The fourth quarter ended December 31, 2003 had not been previously reported.  
See notes 4, 7 and 10 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements for the impact of accounting changes, special charges and  
acquisitions, divestitures and closures, respectively, that affect the comparability of the above selected financial data. Additionally, the  
following significant items were recorded in the fourth quarters of 2003 and 2002:  
• During the fourth quarter of 2003, revenue of $300 and gross profit of $186 was recorded related to sales of Enterprise Networks products  
that had been previously deferred until software revenue recognition criteria were met. The gross profit impact was partially offset by an  
incremental Optical Networks inventory provision of $119. Also during the fourth quarter, bad debt recoveries of $69 were recorded as a  
reduction to selling, general and administrative expense.  
• During the fourth quarter of 2002, bonus and fringe benefit estimates were revised which reduced operating expenses by $33 and $101,  
respectively.  
F-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS  
To the Shareholders of Nortel Networks Corporation  
We have audited the consolidated financial statements of Nortel Networks Corporation and its subsidiaries (“Nortel Networks”) as of  
December 31, 2003 and 2002, and for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2003, and have issued our report thereon dated  
January 10, 2005, which report expresses an unqualified opinion and includes explanatory paragraphs relating to the restatement of the  
consolidated financial statements as of December 31, 2002 and 2001 and for each of the years then ended and the change in the method of  
accounting for stock-based compensation, asset retirement obligations and goodwill; such report is included elsewhere in this Form 10-K. Our  
audits also included the consolidated financial statement schedule of Nortel Networks listed in Item 15. This financial statement schedule is the  
responsibility of Nortel Networks management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on this consolidated financial statement schedule  
based on our audits. In our opinion, such consolidated financial statement schedule, when considered in relation to the basic consolidated  
financial statements taken as a whole, presents fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.  
/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP  
Independent Registered Chartered Accountants  
Toronto, Canada  
January 10, 2005  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Schedule II  
Consolidated  
NORTEL NETWORKS CORPORATION  
Valuation and Qualifying Accounts and Reserves  
Provision For Uncollectibles (a)  
(millions of U.S. dollars)  
Additions  
charged  
to costs  
Balance at  
beginning of  
Balance at  
end of  
(b)  
(c)  
U.S. GAAP  
year  
and expenses  
Deductions  
year  
Year 2003  
Year 2002  
Year 2001  
$
$
$
1,282  
1,540  
809  
$
$
$
(180)  
291  
1,791  
$
$
$
611  
549  
1,060  
$
$
$
491  
1,282  
1,540  
(d)  
(d)  
(a)  
(b)  
(c)  
(d)  
Excludes Discontinued Operations.  
Includes acquisitions and disposals of subsidiaries and divisions and amounts written off, and foreign exchange translation adjustments.  
Includes provisions for uncollectibles on long-term accounts receivable of $297, $780, and $761 as of December 31, 2003, 2002, and 2001, respectively.  
As restated (see note 3 to the accompanying consolidated financial statements).  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ITEM 9. Changes in and Disagreements With Accountants on Accounting and Financial  
Disclosure  
NONE  
ITEM 9A. Controls and Procedures  
In light of the relevance of the findings of the Independent Review to the matters addressed in this Item 9A, this Item 9A first sets forth in full  
the “Summary of Findings and of Recommended Remedial Measures of the Independent Review,” submitted to the Audit Committee by  
WCPHD and Huron Consulting Services LLC, or the Independent Review Summary. The balance of this Item 9A addresses, among other  
matters:  
current management’s conclusions concerning our disclosure controls and procedures as at December 31, 2003 and January 10,  
2005 and certain earlier dates (see “Current Management Conclusions Concerning Disclosure Controls and Procedures”);  
information relating to the First Restatement, including a discussion of material weaknesses in internal control over financial  
reporting identified at the time of the First Restatement (see “Additional Background — First Restatement”);  
information relating to the Second Restatement, including a discussion of material weaknesses in internal control over financial  
reporting identified over the course of the Second Restatement (see “Additional Background — Second Restatement”);  
the determination of the Audit Committee to review the facts and circumstances leading to the restatement of revenues, as part of  
the Second Restatement, for specific transactions during the periods 1999 through 2002, with particular emphasis on the underlying  
conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues, which we refer to as the Revenue Independent Review (see “Revenue  
Independent Review”);  
the current status of our internal control over financial reporting and expectations as to management conclusions and the  
independent auditor attestation required to be included in our fiscal year 2004 Annual Report on Form 10-K, or the 2004 Form 10-  
K, pursuant to Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (see “Current Status of Material Weaknesses in Internal Control Over  
Financial Reporting and Expectations as to Required Management Conclusions and Independent Auditor Attestation Pursuant to  
Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act”);  
remedial measures adopted by the Board of Directors pursuant to the recommendations of WCPHD, and remedial measures  
identified, developed and begun to be implemented by our current management, including pursuant to recommendations from D&T  
(see “Remedial Measures”); and  
changes in internal control over financial reporting (see “Remedial Measures”).  
* * * * * *  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SUMMARY OF FINDINGS AND  
OF RECOMMENDED REMEDIAL MEASURES  
OF THE INDEPENDENT REVIEW  
SUBMITTED TO THE AUDIT COMMITTEE  
OF THE BOARDS OF DIRECTORS  
OF NORTEL NETWORKS CORPORATION  
AND NORTEL NETWORKS LIMITED  
Wilmer Cutler Pickering Hale and Dorr LLP  
2445 M Street, N.W.  
Washington, D.C. 20037  
Huron Consulting Services LLC  
99 High Street  
Boston, Massachusetts 02110  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In late October 2003, Nortel Networks Corporation (“Nortel” or the “Company”) announced that it intended to restate approximately $900M of  
liabilities carried on its previously reported balance sheet as of June 30, 2003, following a comprehensive internal review of these liabilities  
(“First Restatement”). The Company stated that the principal effects of the restatement would be a reduction in previously reported net losses  
for 2000, 2001, and 2002 and an increase in shareholders’ equity and net assets previously reported on its balance sheet. Concurrent with this  
announcement, the Audit Committees of the Boards of Directors of Nortel Networks Corporation and Nortel Networks Limited (collectively,  
the “Audit Committee” and the “Board of Directors” or “Board,” respectively) initiated an independent review of the facts and circumstances  
leading to the First Restatement. The Audit Committee wanted to gain a full understanding of the events that caused significant excess  
liabilities to be maintained on the balance sheet that needed to be restated, and to recommend that the Board of Directors adopt, and direct  
management to implement, necessary remedial measures to address personnel, controls, compliance, and discipline. The Audit Committee  
engaged Wilmer Cutler Pickering Hale and Dorr LLP (“WCPHD”) to advise it in connection with its independent review. Because of the  
significant accounting issues involved in the inquiry, WCPHD retained Huron Consulting Services LLC (“Huron”) to provide expert  
accounting assistance. Huron has been involved in all phases of WCPHD’s work.  
Scope of the Independent Review  
The independent review focused initially on events relating to the establishment and release of contractual liability and other related provisions  
(also called accruals, reserves, or accrued liabilities) in the second half of 2002 and the first half of 2003, including the involvement of senior  
corporate leadership. (The review did not include provisioning activity in the first half of 2002 because it was not expected that any such  
activity could have had a material impact on the results of those quarters in light of the significant losses in those periods.) As the review  
evolved, its focus broadened to include specific provisioning activities in each of the business units and geographic regions. In light of  
concerns raised in the initial phase, the Audit Committee expanded the review to include provisioning activities in the third and fourth quarters  
of 2003.  
The Audit Committee expressly directed that requested documents be promptly provided and that employees cooperate with requests for  
interviews; the Audit Committee instructed senior management to implement these directions throughout the Company. Over the course of the  
inquiry, more than 50 current and former Nortel employees were interviewed, some more than once. While the independent inquiry did not  
examine the work of Nortel’s external auditor, Deloitte & Touche LLP, several current and former audit engagement partners were  
interviewed. Hundreds of thousands of hard copy and electronic documents and emails were collected and reviewed from corporate  
headquarters in Brampton, from company servers, and from key employees in the business units and in the regions.  
It was beyond the scope of the independent inquiry to audit or otherwise review the substantive accuracy of Nortel’s restated financial  
statements. As the inquiry progressed, the Audit Committee directed new corporate management to examine in depth the concerns identified by  
WCPHD regarding provisioning activity and to review provision releases in each of the four quarters of 2003, down to a low threshold. That  
examination, and other errors identified by management, led to a second restatement of financial results, filed today (the “Second  
Restatement”). WCPHD and Huron played no role in management’s restatement efforts. It was also beyond the scope of the independent  
inquiry to review other aspects of Nortel’s accounting practices. The Second Restatement addresses a number of these practices.  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WCPHD and Huron reported regularly to the Audit Committee on the progress of the investigation. Most, or all, of the independent and non-  
management Board members attended these Audit Committee briefings. The Chairs of the Audit Committee and of the Board of Directors  
were briefed between Audit Committee meetings to provide them with a “real time” understanding of the progress of the investigation. At the  
direction of the Audit Committee, WCPHD and Huron met regularly with new management and the Company’s external auditors to provide  
facts developed through the inquiry, so both would have this information as they proceeded through the Second Restatement. WCPHD and  
Huron also briefed Canadian and U.S. regulators on a regular basis. The Audit Committee has reviewed in detail the findings of the  
independent review and the recommended remedial measures, and it has adopted those findings and proposed remedial measures in their  
entirety. This synopsis summarizes those findings and proposed remedial measures.  
Summary of Findings of the Independent Review  
The investigation necessarily focused on the financial picture of the Company at the time that decisions were made and actions were taken  
regarding provisioning activity. Because of significant changes to financial results reflected in the Second Restatement, the restated financial  
results differ from the historical results that formed the backdrop for this inquiry.  
In summary, former corporate management (now terminated for cause) and former finance management (now terminated for cause) in the  
Company’s finance organization endorsed, and employees carried out, accounting practices relating to the recording and release of provisions  
that were not in compliance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“U.S. GAAP”) in at least four quarters, including the third and  
fourth quarters of 2002 and the first and second quarters of 2003. In three of those four quarters — when Nortel was at, or close to, break even  
— these practices were undertaken to meet internally imposed pro-forma earnings before taxes (“EBT”) targets. While the dollar value of most  
of the individual provisions was relatively small, the aggregate value of the provisions made the difference between a profit and a reported loss,  
on a pro forma basis, in the fourth quarter of 2002 and the difference between a loss and a reported profit, on a pro forma basis, in the first and  
second quarters of 2003. This conduct caused Nortel to report a loss in the fourth quarter of 2002 and to pay no employee bonuses, and to  
achieve and maintain profitability in the first and second quarters of 2003, which, in turn, caused it to pay bonuses to all Nortel employees and  
significant bonuses to senior management under bonus plans tied to a pro forma profitability metric.  
The failure to follow U.S. GAAP with respect to provisioning can be understood in light of the management, organizational structure, and  
internal controls that characterized Nortel’s finance organization. These characteristics, discussed below, include:  
Management “tone at the top” that conveyed the strong leadership message that earnings targets could be met through application  
of accounting practices that finance managers knew or ought to have known were not in compliance with U.S. GAAP and that  
questioning these practices was not acceptable;  
Lack of technical accounting expertise which fostered accounting practices not in compliance with U.S. GAAP;  
Weak or ineffective internal controls which, in turn, provided little or no check on inaccurate financial reporting;  
Operation of a complicated “matrix” structure which contributed to a lack of clear responsibility and accountability by business  
units and by regions; and  
Lack of integration between the business units and corporate management that led to a lack of transparency regarding provisioning  
activity to achieve internal EBT targets.  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Nortel posted significant losses in 2001 and 2002 and downsized its work force by nearly two-thirds. The remaining employees were asked to  
undertake significant additional responsibilities with no increase in pay and no bonuses. The Company’s former senior corporate management  
asserted, at the start of the inquiry, that the Company’s downturn, and concomitant downsizing of operations and workforce, led to a loss of  
documentation and a decline in financial discipline. Those factors, in their view, were primarily responsible for the significant excess  
provisions on the balance sheet as of June 30, 2003, which resulted in the First Restatement. While that downturn surely played a part in the  
circumstances leading to the First Restatement, the root causes ran far deeper.  
When Frank Dunn became CFO in 1999, and then CEO in 2001, he drove senior management in his finance organization to achieve EBT  
targets that he set with his senior management team. The provisioning practices adopted by Dunn and other finance employees to achieve  
internal EBT targets were not in compliance with U.S. GAAP, particularly Statement of Financial Accounting Standards Number 5 (“SFAS  
5”). SFAS 5, which governs accounting for contingencies, requires, among other things, a probability analysis for each risk before a provision  
can be recorded. It also requires that a triggering event — such as resolution of the exposure or a change in estimate — occur in the quarter to  
warrant the release of a provision. Dunn and other finance employees recognized that provisioning activity — how much to reserve for a  
particular exposure and when that reserve should be released — inherently involved application of significant judgment under U.S. GAAP.  
Dunn and others stretched the judgment inherent in the provisioning process to create a flexible tool to achieve EBT targets. They viewed  
provisioning as “a gray area.” They became comfortable with the concept that the value of a provision could be reasonably set at virtually any  
number within a wide range and that a provision release could be justified in a number of quarters after the quarter in which the exposure,  
which formed the basis for the provision, was resolved. Dunn and others exercised their judgment strategically to achieve EBT targets.  
At the direction of then-CFO Doug Beatty, a company-wide analysis of accrued liabilities on the balance sheet was  
Third quarter, 2002.  
launched in early August 2002. The CFO and the Controller, Michael Gollogly, learned that this analysis showed approximately $303M in  
provisions that were no longer required and were available for release. The CFO and the Controller, each a corporate officer, knew, or ought to  
have known, that excess provisions, if retained on the balance sheet, would cause the Company’s financial statements to be inaccurate and that  
U.S. GAAP would have required either that such provisions be released in that period and properly disclosed, or that prior period financial  
statements be restated. Instead, they permitted finance employees in the business units and in the regions to release excess accruals into income  
over the following several quarters. They acted in contravention of U.S. GAAP by failing to correct the Company’s financial statements to  
account for the significant excess accrued liabilities. Neither the CFO nor the Controller advised the Audit Committee and/or the Board of  
Directors that significant excess provisions on the balance sheet had been identified and that the Company’s financial statements might be  
inaccurate, nor did either suggest such information should be disclosed in the Company’s financial statements.  
As a result of this company-wide review, senior finance employees recognized that their respective business unit or region had excess  
provisions on Nortel’s balance sheet, and directed other finance employees to track these excess provisions. Nortel finance employees had their  
own distinct term for a provision on the balance sheet that was no longer needed — it was “hard.” Each business unit developed, in varying  
levels of detail and over varying periods of time, internal “hardness” schedules that identified provisions that were no longer required and were  
available for release. Finance employees treated provisions identified on these schedules as a pool from which releases could be made to “close  
the gap” between actual EBT and EBT targets in subsequent quarters.  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
By mid-2002, employees throughout the Company were being recruited by other companies and morale was low.  
Fourth quarter, 2002.  
Corporate management sought to retain these employees but recognized that other public companies had come under criticism for awarding  
“stay” bonuses in the face of enormous losses. At management’s recommendation, the Board determined to reward employees with bonuses  
under bonus plans tied to profitability. One plan, the Return to Profitability (“RTP”) bonus, contemplated a one-time bonus payment to every  
employee, save 43 top executives, in the first quarter in which the Company achieved pro forma profitability. The 43 executives were eligible  
to receive 20% of their share of the RTP bonus in the first quarter in which the Company attained profitability, 40% after the second  
consecutive quarter of cumulative profitability, and the remaining 40% upon four quarters of cumulative profitability. In order for the RTP  
bonuses to be paid, pro forma profits had to exceed, by at least one dollar, the total cost of the bonus for that quarter. Another plan, the  
Restricted Stock Unit (“RSU”) plan, made a significant number of share units available for award by the Board to the same 43 executives in  
four installments tied to profitability milestones. Once a milestone was met, the Board had discretion whether to make the award.  
Through the first three quarters of 2002, Nortel experienced significant losses, and management reported to the Board that it expected losses  
would continue in the fourth quarter. After the initial results for the business units and regions were consolidated, they showed that Nortel  
unexpectedly would achieve pro forma profitability in the fourth quarter. Frank Dunn, who had been promoted to CEO in 2001, understood  
that profitability had been attained from an operational standpoint but determined that it was unwise to report profitability and pay bonuses in  
the fourth quarter because performance for the rest of the year had been poor. He determined that provisions should be taken to cause a loss for  
the quarter. Over a two day period late in the closing process, the CFO and the Controller worked with employees in the finance organizations  
in the business units, the regions, and in global operations, to identify and record additional provisions totaling more than $175 million. All of  
these provisions were recorded “top-side” — that is, by employees in the office of the Controller based on information provided by the  
business units, regions and global operations — because of the late date in the closing process on which they were made. Nortel’s results for  
the fourth quarter of 2002 turned from an unexpected profit into the loss previously forecasted by management to the Board of Directors.  
Neither the CEO, the CFO, nor the Controller advised the Audit Committee and/or the Board of Directors of this concerted provisioning  
activity to improperly turn a profit into a loss. Nortel has since determined that many of these provisions were not recorded in compliance with  
U.S. GAAP, and has reversed those provisions in the Second Restatement. The loss then reported by Nortel in the fourth quarter meant that no  
employee bonuses were paid for that quarter.  
While Nortel had announced publicly that it expected to achieve pro forma profitability in the second quarter of 2003,  
First quarter, 2003.  
Dunn told a number of employees that he intended to achieve profitability one quarter earlier, and he established internal EBT targets for each  
business unit and for corporate to reach that goal. At Dunn’s direction, “roadmaps” were developed to show how the targets could be achieved.  
These roadmaps made clear that the internal EBT targets for the quarter could only be met through release from the balance sheet of excess  
provisions that lacked an accounting trigger in the quarter. At the request of finance management in each business unit, finance employees  
identified excess, or “hard,” provisions from the balance sheet, and, together, they determined which provisions to release to close the gap and  
meet the internal EBT targets. That release activity was supplemented by releases, directed by the CFO and by the Controller, of excess  
corporate provisions that had been identified in the third quarter of 2002 as available for release. Releases of provisions by corporate and by  
each business unit and region, including excess provisions, totaling $361M, enabled Nortel to show a consolidated pro forma profit in the first  
quarter, notwithstanding that its operations were running at a loss. The Finance Vice Presidents of the business units and two of the three  
regions, the Asia Controller, the CFO, the Controller, and the CEO knew, or ought to have known, that U.S. GAAP did not permit the release,  
without proper justification, of excess provisions into the income statement. Nortel has since determined that many of these releases in this  
quarter were not in accordance with U.S. GAAP, and has reversed those releases in the First and Second Restatements and restated the releases  
into proper quarters.  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When presenting the preliminary results for the quarter to the Audit Committee, the Controller inaccurately represented that the vast majority  
of these releases were “business as usual” and in compliance with U.S. GAAP, and that the remaining releases were one time, non-recurring  
events and in compliance with U.S. GAAP. Further, the CFO and the Controller failed to advise the Audit Committee and/or the Board of  
Directors that release of excess corporate provisions was required to achieve profitability and make up for the shortfall in operational results;  
that such releases were needed to cover the cost of the bonus compensation; that no event in the quarter triggered the releases (as required by  
U.S. GAAP); that the releases implicated Staff Accounting Bulletin 99 (relating to materiality) because they turned a loss for the quarter into a  
profit; and that they retained a significant amount of excess provisions on the balance sheet to be used, when needed, in a subsequent quarter.  
In separate executive sessions held by the Audit Committee with the CFO and the Controller, neither the CFO nor the Controller raised quality  
of earnings issues nor questioned the payment of the RTP bonus. Based on management’s representations, the Audit Committee approved the  
quarterly results, and the Board approved the award of the RTP bonus.  
Seeking to continue to show profitability in the second quarter and meet the first RSU milestone and the second  
Second quarter, 2003.  
tranche of the RTP bonus, senior corporate management developed internal EBT targets to achieve pro forma profitability. As was the case in  
the first quarter, it became clear during the quarter that operational results would be a loss. At the request of finance management in each  
business unit, finance employees again identified “hard” provisions from the balance sheet, and, together, they determined which provisions to  
release to close the gap and achieve the internal EBT targets. Nortel has since determined that many of these releases were not in accordance  
with U.S. GAAP, and has reversed those releases in the First and Second Restatements and restated the releases into proper quarters. In both  
the first and second quarters of 2003, the dollar value of many individual releases was relatively small, but the aggregate value of the releases  
made the difference between a pro forma loss and profit in each quarter.  
The CEO, the CFO and the Controller failed to advise the Audit Committee or the Board of Directors that operations of the business units were  
running at a loss during the second quarter and that the validity of many of the numerous provision releases, totaling more than $370 million,  
could be questionable. Based on management’s representations, the Audit Committee approved the quarterly results, and the Board approved  
payment of the second tranche of the RTP bonus and awarded restricted stock under the RSU plan.  
In light of concerns raised by the inappropriate accounting judgments outlined above, the Audit  
Third and fourth quarters, 2003.  
Committee expanded its investigation to determine whether excess provisions were released to meet internal EBT targets in each of these two  
quarters. No evidence emerged to suggest an intent to release provisions strategically in those quarters to meet EBT targets. Given the  
significant volume of provision releases in these two quarters, the Audit Committee directed management to review provision releases, down to  
a low threshold, using the same methods used to evaluate the releases made in the first half of the year. This review has resulted in additional  
adjustments for these quarters, which are reflected in the Second Restatement.  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Governing Principles for Remedial Measures  
The Audit Committee asked WCPHD to recommend governing principles, based on its independent inquiry, to prevent recurrence of the  
inappropriate accounting conduct, to rebuild a finance environment based on transparency and integrity, and to ensure sound financial  
reporting and comprehensive disclosure. The recommendations developed by WCPHD and provided to the Audit Committee were directed at:  
Establishing standards of conduct to be enforced through appropriate discipline;  
Infusing strong technical skills and experience into the finance organization;  
Requiring comprehensive, on-going training on increasingly complex accounting standards;  
Strengthening and improving internal controls and processes;  
Establishing a compliance program throughout the Company which is appropriately staffed and funded;  
Requiring management to provide clear and concise information, in a timely manner, to the Board to facilitate its decision-making;  
and  
Implementing an information technology platform that improves the reliability of financial reporting and reduces the opportunities  
for manipulation of results.  
These recommendations were grouped into three categories — people, processes and technology — and are discussed below:  
People  
An effective “tone at the top” requires effective policies and procedures, but these alone are not sufficient. Those who manage and lead the  
Company, and are its officers, must exercise the highest fiduciary duties to the Company and shareholders and must be accountable, both to  
corporate management and the Board, for accurately reporting financial results.  
Based on periodic reports by WCPHD on the progress of the independent inquiry, the Audit Committee recommended, and the Board of  
Directors approved, termination for cause of the CEO, the CFO, the Controller, and seven additional senior finance employees. The Board of  
Directors determined that each of these individuals had significant responsibilities for Nortel’s financial reporting as a whole, or for their  
respective business units and geographic regions, and that each was aware, or ought to have been aware, that Nortel’s provisioning activity,  
described above, did not comply with U.S. GAAP. Nortel has formally demanded the return of all bonus compensation paid to each of these  
individuals in 2003. Once the Board receives responses to this demand, it should determine the appropriate course of action to pursue with each  
of these ten former employees.  
Senior corporate officers, including the four Presidents of the business units during the period covered by this inquiry, the four Presidents of  
the regions, and the President of Global Operations, now recognize that inappropriate activity involving provisioning occurred “on their  
watch.” While they lacked an understanding that certain provisioning activities in their respective business units were not in compliance with  
U.S. GAAP, they now recognize that such conduct was instrumental in achieving the reported results in the fourth quarter of 2002 and the first  
and second quarters of 2003. To demonstrate personal commitment to the governing principles stated above and to lead the Company forward,  
each of these officers has volunteered to return to the Company the entire RTP bonus that he or she was awarded, net of taxes already paid, and  
to disclaim any opportunity to receive the third and fourth installments of the RSU bonus, which the Board has accepted. In light of the Board’s  
expectation that senior employees of the Company will lead by example, the Board should decline to award the third and fourth tranches of the  
RSU plan to the remaining eligible employees, irrespective of whether the profitability metrics for such bonuses are met as a result of the  
Second Restatement.  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Board of Directors must make clear that it has not tolerated, and will not in the future tolerate, accounting conduct that involves the  
misapplication of U.S. GAAP. It must further communicate its expectation that every Nortel employee will adhere to the highest ethical  
standards; will have training and experience commensurate with his or her job responsibilities; and will be held accountable for his or her  
actions and decisions. The Board of Directors and management should continue to address the issues associated with the inappropriate use of  
provisions.  
Recent experience has shown that the Nortel finance organization lacks sufficient technical accounting expertise. Many finance employees are  
“career” Nortel employees and learned accounting at Nortel. Whatever basic accounting knowledge is resident within Nortel is largely  
knowledge of Canadian GAAP, not U.S. GAAP. Nortel reported in accordance with Canadian GAAP until 2000, when it switched to reporting  
in accordance with U.S. GAAP. High quality finance employees are critical to the soundness of the Company’s financial reporting systems and  
controls so that the results of operations are reported accurately and in a timely manner. The Board of Directors should direct management to  
recruit, from outside Nortel, individuals with strong accounting and financial reporting skills and a proven record of integrity and ethical  
behavior to fill key finance positions. The Board should also direct management to review the training and experience of Nortel mid-level  
finance employees and to supplement this expertise, where appropriate, by hiring individuals from outside Nortel with strong accounting  
training and background.  
Nortel has long had an internal “technical accounting group” to which finance employees were supposed to turn for resolution of difficult  
accounting questions and for technical accounting interpretations. While this practice is a sound one, the practical application has fallen short.  
Finance employees did not regularly turn to this group for resolution of an issue, and it was far from clear that this group had the “last word”  
on such issues. That technical accounting group should be led by a very senior finance executive with in-depth knowledge of, and experience  
in applying, U.S. GAAP. Management should be directed to conduct a benchmarking study to evaluate whether the technical accounting group  
is properly organized; its personnel component is consistent with other similar companies; its staff has appropriate and current expertise; and  
its authority to resolve accounting issues and technical interpretations is clearly defined within the organization.  
Notwithstanding the enormous time and resources that the Company has devoted to restatement activities for the past year, many employees  
appear to lack a clear understanding of the accounting issues that gave rise to the restatements. That is perhaps not surprising in light of the  
lack of basic U.S. GAAP training and expertise in the finance organization. Management has taken significant steps to remedy this deficit by  
requiring mandatory training, developed by external consultants, and taught by knowledgeable finance employees. These remedial training  
programs are an important first step, but much more must be done to ensure that the finance organization is fluent in governing accounting  
standards and principles. Widespread training, by outside experts, at all levels of the finance organization, must continue so that all finance  
employees receive comprehensive training in U.S. GAAP and in the consequences of failing to follow U.S. GAAP. Going forward,  
management should develop in depth, on-going continuing education programs that explain continuously evolving complex accounting  
standards. Management should assess the staffing of its training organization, and the adequacy of its trainers. Every Nortel employee,  
including each finance employee, must now acknowledge annually, in writing, that he or she has read Nortel’s code of conduct and will adhere  
to that code. The certification for each finance employee should be expanded to include an acknowledgement that each such employee is  
familiar with all applicable U.S. GAAP requirements. In addition, the Board should consider whether each finance employee should be  
required to complete a certain number of hours of continuing professional education each year.  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Processes  
A basic component of sound corporate oversight is the control structure. Internal controls — the Company’s accounting policies,  
organizational structure, systems, processes, employees, leadership, and culture — working together, foster accurate financial reporting and  
sound disclosure in a timely manner. While management has recognized weaknesses in existing processes and controls, and has taken steps to  
remedy these deficiencies, more needs to be done.  
Nortel is a multi-national organization that has changed organizational structure over the past several years. One legacy of this changing  
structure is a matrix organization in which there is no clear assignment of responsibility for assessing the adequacy and usage of contractual  
liability provisions; even where responsibility is clear, it is unlikely that sufficient monitoring is in place to make sure that provisioning activity  
is in accord with U.S. GAAP. The need for the matrix organization must be re-examined in light of the risks that it poses to financial discipline  
and accountability and, if a matrix structure continues to be used, clear accountability must be established.  
Historically, finance employees responsible for meeting EBT targets had authority to record and release provisions. That practice must end  
immediately. The control organization must have sole authority to make these decisions and record these entries. The Board of Directors must  
insist that the re-engineering of the control organization be a management priority. In addition, the Controller and the control organization,  
working with the General Counsel, must develop standards of transparency in financial reporting that meet both the letter and the spirit of legal  
requirements.  
Nortel’s written accounting policies must be reviewed and, where necessary, rewritten to ensure strict adherence to U.S. GAAP and provide  
numerous “real life” examples of practical applications. Procedures must be adopted to identify evolving interpretations of accounting  
standards and best practices under U.S. GAAP and to develop and conform Nortel’s policies in a timely manner. Employees charged with  
responsibility for Nortel’s accounting policies must have substantial knowledge of the strengths and weaknesses of the financial organization  
and knowledge of best practices in similarly situated companies and ensure that accounting practices follow Nortel’s policies. These policies  
must be communicated to finance and control employees, and management must stress the importance of adherence to the policies and impose  
sanctions if they are not followed.  
The internal audit function must be strengthened and must provide an independent check on the integrity of financial reporting. Historically,  
Nortel’s internal auditor focused solely on “operational” reviews and had no role in determining whether Nortel’s accounting policies were in  
compliance with U.S. GAAP or in evaluating whether these policies were properly applied. The Audit Committee has already established new  
priorities for the internal auditor relating to the evaluation of risk exposures for financial reporting. Internal audit should continue its practice of  
proposing an annual work plan, and should ensure that the work plan focuses on the new priorities set by the Audit Committee. The Company  
is currently conducting a search to fill the vacant position of internal auditor. The internal audit function requires a leader with substantial  
experience in applying U.S. GAAP in a similarly-situated company and great familiarity in applying professional standards issued by the  
Institute of Internal Auditors. The internal auditor should report to the CEO to remove any potential threat to independence. The internal  
auditor should continue to have direct and regular access to the Board and the Audit Committee. Staffing of internal audit must be consistent  
with its mandate.  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
These governing principles are an effort to forge a framework for rebuilding the Nortel finance environment. Equally important, the Board, the  
CEO, and the CFO must continue to promote high ethical standards throughout the Company. Words announcing adherence to the highest  
standard of integrity are relatively easy to express, but it is actions, not words, that count. The Board has established the position of a Chief  
Ethics and Compliance Officer. The Board has also adopted a code of ethical conduct and business practices which outlines principles to guide  
ethical decision-making and provides practical answers to ethics questions regularly asked in the workplace. The Board should direct  
management to enhance significantly the existing compliance program. Together, the code and a strengthened compliance program set the tone  
and the standards of behavior that the Company expects from its employees. Employees must be convinced of the Company’s commitment to  
an ethical climate, and of the central role that they play in ensuring that the Company’s code is followed. They must view compliance with the  
Company’s code of conduct, standards, and control systems as a central priority, and understand they will be rewarded for ethical behavior,  
even if it uncovers some problem that others might prefer to remain undisclosed. On a regular basis, the Board should review the activities of  
the compliance office, the strength of the compliance program, and the risks it has addressed.  
The Board must receive from management, in sufficient time prior to meetings, all materials necessary for it to monitor and act on business  
risks affecting Nortel and information relating to decisions the Board is being asked to make. The Audit Committee needs clear and concise  
information relating to Nortel’s financial reporting. The Board should implement a process whereby management would provide a quarterly  
assessment of the overall quality and transparency of Nortel’s financial reporting and suggestions for improvements in form and content, which  
the external auditors would review and comment. The Board’s practice of receiving all information respecting Nortel’s financial performance  
on a consolidated basis, and of each of its business units, only from the CFO should change. The heads of each business unit should be  
expected to take full responsibility for the financial results of their respective businesses and to provide quarterly presentations to the Board  
with the senior finance employee in that business unit. Periodically, the Audit Committee should have separate, executive sessions with the  
chief operations and finance employees for each business unit to discuss issues specific to their businesses.  
Technology  
Management has announced that it intends to acquire and install a SAP information technology platform to facilitate production of accurate  
financial results in a timely and cost effective manner. The objectives of any technology platform implemented by Nortel should include  
identification of existing control procedures that are redundant or inefficient; prevention/detection and correction of errors on a timely basis;  
prevention or detection of fraud; simplification of systems and increased productivity; reduction of opportunities for manual intervention;  
ability to trace transactions from start to finish; improved operation of controls; and substantive analysis of results, including both operating  
and financial metrics. In sum, those responsible for implementing SAP should have a strong focus on re-engineering existing processes so that  
the control elements intrinsic to the SAP system are effective.  
* * * * * *  
After thorough consideration, the Audit Committee has recommended, and the Board of Directors has approved, adoption of each of these  
recommendations. The Board of Directors has directed management to develop a detailed plan and timetable for the implementation of these  
recommendations and intends to monitor the implementation of these principles by management.  
* * * * * * [End of Independent Review Summary]  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Current Management Conclusions Concerning Disclosure Controls and Procedures  
In January 2005, we carried out an evaluation under the supervision and with the participation of management, including the current CEO and  
current CFO, pursuant to Rule 13a-15 under the Exchange Act, of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures as at  
December 31, 2003 (the end of the period covered by this report) and as at January 10, 2005. The CEO and CFO were appointed to such  
positions as at April 28, 2004, with the CFO having served in such capacity on an interim basis since March 15, 2004.  
In making this evaluation, the CEO and CFO considered, among other matters:  
the Second Restatement and the revisions to our preliminary unaudited results for the year ended December 31, 2003;  
the findings of the Independent Review summarized above in the Independent Review Summary;  
the terminations for cause of our former president and chief executive officer, former chief financial officer, former controller and  
seven additional senior finance employees during the course of the Independent Review and the reasons therefor as described in the  
Independent Review Summary;  
the material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting that we and our external auditor, D&T have identified (as  
more fully described below);  
the measures we have identified, developed and begun to implement beginning in November 2003 to remedy those material  
weaknesses (as more fully described below);  
our omission of 1999 and 2000 selected financial data from this report, and our decision not to amend our 2002 Form 10-K/A and  
our 2003 quarterly reports (as more fully described below); and  
the decision of the Audit Committee to undertake the Revenue Independent Review (as more fully described below).  
Based on this evaluation, the CEO and CFO have concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures, as at December 31, 2003 and  
January 10, 2005, were not effective to provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed in the reports we file and submit  
under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported as and when required.  
In light of this conclusion and as part of the extensive work undertaken in connection with the Second Restatement, we have applied  
compensating procedures and processes as necessary to ensure the reliability of our financial reporting. Accordingly, management believes,  
based on its knowledge, that (i) this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to  
make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which they were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this  
report and (ii) the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects our  
financial condition, results of operations and cash flows as at, and for, the periods presented in this report.  
The Second Restatement and other matters listed above have also resulted in the re-evaluation, in January 2005, of the effectiveness of our  
disclosure controls and procedures as at December 31, 2002, March 31, 2003, June 30, 2003 and September 30, 2003. Based on these  
evaluations and in consideration of the Second Restatement and other matters listed above, the CEO and CFO have concluded that our  
disclosure controls and procedures, as at December 31, 2002, March 31, 2003, June 30, 2003 and September 30, 2003, were not effective to  
provide reasonable assurance that information required to be disclosed in the reports we file and submit under the Exchange Act is recorded,  
processed, summarized and reported as and when required.  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
These new conclusions are in contrast to conclusions reached as a result of previous evaluations carried out under the supervision and with the  
participation of management, including the former chief executive officer and former chief financial officer. In particular, these conclusions  
differ from the conclusions stated in our 2002 Annual Report on Form 10-K and Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q for the quarters ended  
March 31, 2003 and June 30, 2003 that our disclosure controls and procedures were so effective as at December 31, 2002, March 31, 2003 and  
June 30, 2003, respectively. They also differ from the conclusions based upon the re-evaluations carried out in December 2003 under the  
supervision and with the participation of management, including the former president and chief executive officer and former chief financial  
officer, as stated in our amended 2002 Annual Report on Form 10-K/A, or the 2002 Form 10-K/A, and amended Quarterly Reports on Form  
10-Q for the quarters ended March 31, 2003 and June 30, 2003, or the 2003 Form 10-Q/As, that our disclosure controls and procedures were so  
effective as at December 31, 2002, March 31, 2003 and June 30, 2003, respectively, after taking into account the First Restatement and the  
identification of certain material weaknesses. These new conclusions also differ from the conclusions stated in our Quarterly Report on Form  
10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2003 that our disclosure controls and procedures were so effective as at September 30, 2003, after  
taking into account the First Restatement and the identification of certain material weaknesses.  
* * * * * *  
Additional Background  
This section provides additional information with respect to the identified material weaknesses and other deficiencies, as well as certain  
additional background information regarding the First Restatement and the Second Restatement.  
In this report, unless otherwise indicated, the terms “material weakness” and “reportable condition” have the meanings as formerly set forth  
under standards established by the AICPA, which were applicable with respect to 2003. The AICPA then defined a (i) “reportable condition”  
as a matter that comes to an auditor’s attention that represents a significant deficiency in the design or operation of internal control that could  
adversely affect an entity’s ability to initiate, record, process and report financial data consistent with the assertions of management in the  
financial statements and (ii) “material weakness” as a reportable condition in which the design or operation of one or more of the internal  
control components does not reduce to a relatively low level the risk that misstatements caused by error or fraud in amounts that would be  
material in relation to the financial statements being audited may occur and not be detected within a timely period by employees in the normal  
course of performing their assigned functions.  
First Restatement  
Overview  
In May 2003, we commenced certain balance sheet reviews at the direction of certain members of former management that led to the  
Comprehensive Review, which resulted in the First Restatement. Each of the former members of management terminated for cause had  
responsibility for their respective positions at the time of the Comprehensive Review and First Restatement. As disclosed in our Quarterly  
Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2003, the Comprehensive Review was initiated “[I]n light of a period of unprecedented  
industry adjustment and subsequent restructuring actions, including workforce reductions and asset write-downs . . . . The amounts under  
review were recorded when our balance sheet  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
and income statement were much larger. Specifically, what would have been relatively minor amounts in prior periods may be considered to be  
material to current periods.” As noted in the Independent Review Summary, “Nortel posted significant losses in 2001 and 2002 and downsized  
its work force by nearly two-thirds. The remaining employees were asked to undertake significant additional responsibilities with no additional  
increase in pay and no bonuses. The Company’s former senior corporate management asserted, at the start of the inquiry, that the Company’s  
downturn, and concomitant downsizing of operations and workforce, led to a loss of documentation and a decline in financial discipline. Those  
factors, in their view, were primarily responsible for the significant excess provisions on the balance sheet as at June 30, 2003, which resulted  
in the First Restatement. While that downturn surely played a part in the circumstances leading to the First Restatement, the root causes ran far  
deeper.” The root causes of the First Restatement, as identified in the Independent Review, are more fully discussed in the Independent Review  
Summary.  
The Comprehensive Review purported to (i) identify balance sheet accounts that, as at June 30, 2003, were not supportable and required  
adjustment; (ii) determine whether such adjustments related to the third quarter of 2003 or prior periods; and (iii) document certain account  
balances in accordance with our accounting policies and procedures. The Comprehensive Review, as supplemented by additional procedures  
carried out between July 2003 and November 2003 to quantify the effects of potential adjustments in the relevant periods and review the  
appropriateness of releases of certain contractual liability and other related provisions (also called accruals, reserves or accrued liabilities) in  
the six fiscal quarters ending with the fiscal quarter ended June 30, 2003, formed the basis for the adjustments made to the financial statements  
in the First Restatement.  
On December 23, 2003, we filed with the SEC the 2002 Form 10-K/A and the 2003 Form 10-Q/As reflecting the First Restatement. As  
disclosed in those reports, the net effect of the First Restatement adjustments was a reduction in accumulated deficit of $497 million,  
$178 million and $31 million as at December 31, 2002, 2001 and 2000, respectively. The following were the principal adjustments of the First  
Restatement:  
Approximately $935 million and $514 million of certain liabilities (primarily accruals and provisions) carried on our previously  
reported consolidated balance sheet as at December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively, were released to income in prior periods.  
We determined to correct certain known errors previously not recorded because the amount of the errors was not material to the  
consolidated financial statements. Specifically, among other items, we made certain revenue adjustments to reflect revenue that  
should have been deferred instead of recognized in a particular period.  
We made adjustments to correct errors related to deferred income tax assets and foreign currency translation accounts and made  
reclassification adjustments within the consolidated balance sheet to better reflect the underlying nature of certain items. These  
reclassifications did not impact our net assets as at the end of any period.  
Material Weaknesses and Other Deficiencies in Internal Control over Financial Reporting Identified at the Time of the First  
Restatement  
In 2003, we, together with D&T, identified a number of deficiencies in our internal control over financial reporting.  
On July 24, 2003, D&T first informed the Audit Committee that deficiencies in documentary support for certain accruals and provisions on our  
balance sheet as at June 30, 2003 constituted a reportable condition, but not a material weakness, in our internal control over financial  
reporting. In particular,  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D&T concluded, in respect of this reportable condition, that it was unclear, due to the lack of documentation regarding support for certain  
provisions and accruals, the passage of time and the turnover of personnel, as to what adjustments, if any, should have been made in prior  
years. D&T noted that its assessment was based on such information as was available at the date of its communication to the Audit Committee  
and the materiality of the underlying amounts in the context of 2003 reported results. This conclusion was initially disclosed in our Quarterly  
Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2003.  
On November 18, 2003, as part of the communications by D&T to the Audit Committee with respect to D&T’s interim audit procedures for the  
year ended December 31, 2003, D&T informed the Audit Committee that there were two reportable conditions, each of which constituted a  
material weakness in our internal control over financial reporting. No other reportable conditions were communicated by D&T to the Audit  
Committee at the time of the First Restatement. These reportable conditions were as follows:  
lack of compliance with established Nortel Networks procedures for monitoring and adjusting balances related to certain accruals  
and provisions, including restructuring charges; and  
lack of compliance with established Nortel Networks procedures for appropriately applying U.S. GAAP to the initial recording of  
certain liabilities, including those described in SFAS No. 5, and to foreign currency translation as described in SFAS No. 52.  
The foregoing material weaknesses contributed to the need for the First Restatement. Upon completion of our assessment of our internal  
control over financial reporting as at December 31, 2004 pursuant to Section 404(a) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 and related SEC rules,  
or SOX 404, we currently expect to conclude that these material weaknesses continue to exist as at December 31, 2004, and we continue to  
identify, develop and begin to implement remedial measures to address them, as described below.  
Second Restatement  
Independent Review  
In late October 2003, the Audit Committee initiated the Independent Review in order to, as noted in the Independent Review Summary, “gain a  
full understanding of the events that caused significant excess liabilities to be maintained on the balance sheet that needed to be restated, and to  
recommend that the Board of Directors adopt, and direct management to implement, necessary remedial measures to address personnel,  
controls, compliance and discipline.” As noted in the Independent Review Summary, “[t]he [Independent Review] focused initially on events  
relating to the establishment and release of contractual liability and other related provisions . . . in the second half of 2002 and the first half of  
2003, including the involvement of senior corporate leadership. . . . As the [Independent Review] evolved, its focus broadened to include  
specific provisioning activities in each of the business units and geographic regions. In light of concerns raised in the initial phase of the  
[Independent Review], the Audit Committee expanded the review to include provisioning activities in the third and fourth quarters of 2003.”  
As discussed more fully above in the Independent Review Summary, the Independent Review concluded that “[i]n summary, former corporate  
management (now terminated for cause) and former finance management (now terminated for cause) in the Company’s finance organization  
endorsed, and employees carried out, accounting practices relating to the recording and release of provisions that were not in compliance with  
[U.S. GAAP] in at least four quarters, including the third and fourth quarters of 2002 and the first and second quarters of 2003. In three of  
those four quarters — when Nortel was at, or close to, break even — these practices were undertaken to meet internally imposed pro-forma  
earnings before taxes  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
... targets. While the dollar value of most of the individual provisions was relatively small, the aggregate value of the provisions made the  
difference between a profit and a reported loss, on a pro forma basis, in the fourth quarter of 2002 and the difference between a loss and a  
reported profit, on a pro forma basis, in the first and second quarters of 2003.”  
Second Restatement Process  
As noted in the Independent Review Summary, “[a]s the [Independent Review] progressed, the Audit Committee directed new corporate  
management to examine in-depth the concerns identified by WCPHD regarding provisioning activity and to review provision releases in each  
of the four quarters of 2003, down to a low threshold. That examination, and other errors identified by management, led to [the Second  
Restatement]....”  
In addition to this examination of provisioning activity, management, including our new CFO, undertook various initiatives aimed at ensuring  
the reliability and integrity of the audited consolidated financial statements included in this report. As part of these efforts, our new CFO  
encouraged employees across our finance organization to raise any questions or concerns regarding other potential accounting errors that  
should be reviewed for possible adjustment in the Second Restatement. In addition, as management identified individual customer contracts  
and transactions for re-examination of the establishment and release of provisions, management also undertook a review of many of those  
contracts and transactions more generally to understand the broader nature of the original accounting for the contract or transaction. This  
individual contract and transaction review also identified additional accounting issues. As a result of these initiatives, management, with the  
assistance of outside consultants, then undertook further detailed reviews of our significant accounting policies, specific transactions and  
communications and other documents relating to the identified issues. As a result, the Second Restatement included adjustments to correct  
errors relating to a number of accounting issues other than provisioning.  
In particular, management identified various errors involving recognition of revenues. To identify, assess and remedy these errors,  
management, assisted by outside consultants, reviewed a substantial number of individual transactions as well as significant accounting  
policies across all of our major product lines and geographical regions. As part of our review of individual contracts, we analyzed the relevant  
contractual provisions (such as delivery and acceptance terms), delivery and other data from our logistics systems, characteristics of the  
particular products and customers and the manner in which revenue recognition policies were applied. We also utilized databases within our  
accounting systems to identify additional contracts that might raise revenue recognition issues. In light of the increasing magnitude of the total  
revenue adjustments identified by the beginning of November 2004, the Board of Directors directed management to conduct additional focused  
revenue reviews in selected periods in order to test the conclusions we had reached and identify any potential additional revenue adjustments.  
Management has completed these reviews.  
Overall in the Second Restatement, as a result of adjustments to correct errors related to revenue recognition, we increased revenues by an  
aggregate of $1,492 million in 2001 and $439 million in 2002. We also increased previously announced 2003 revenues by an aggregate of  
$386 million. Most of these adjustments constituted the recognition of revenues that had previously been improperly recognized in prior years  
and should have been deferred (often over a number of years). This also had the effect of reducing previously reported revenues in 1998, 1999  
and 2000 by approximately $158 million, $355 million and $2,866 million, respectively. Of these adjustments identified in the Second  
Restatement, approximately $750 million of revenues has been deferred to years after 2003, while approximately $250 million of revenues was  
permanently reversed, as described below.  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In light of the total magnitude of these revenue adjustments, we present below an overview of the principal revenue adjustments required in the  
Second Restatement to correct accounting errors related to revenue recognition and the general circumstances that gave rise to them. In  
addition, as described under “Revenue Independent Review”, the Audit Committee has determined to review the facts and circumstances  
leading to the restatement of these revenues for specific transactions identified in the Second Restatement. The Revenue Independent Review  
will have a particular emphasis on the underlying conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues, and will consider any appropriate  
additional remedial measures, including those involving internal controls and processes.  
— An increase of $1,624 million in 2001 and $211 million in 2002.  
Title and delivery  
Of this amount, we made adjustments of approximately $870 million in 2001 and $200 million in 2002 to correct errors relating to passage of  
product title or risk of loss. Both employee input and our review of the broader original accounting treatment of certain individual contracts  
identified a specific customer contract as warranting re-examination of the timing of revenue recognition relative to the timing of passage of  
product title. Following a detailed review, we determined that revenues had been recorded erroneously before title had passed. We also  
reviewed other similar contracts and determined that corrections were also required where title or risk of loss had not passed. These corrections  
principally impacted North American contracts in our Optical and Wireline businesses.  
Some of the adjustments related to title and risk of loss issues described above resulted in a permanent reversal of revenues, rather than a  
deferral of revenues to later periods. In certain cases, revenues were recognized in error in a particular period (before title had passed and the  
criteria for revenue recognition had been met) and a bad debt expense was subsequently recorded due to collectibility issues. In such cases,  
both entries were reversed. Following those corrections, if title in fact never passed or the other criteria were never met, and the customer failed  
to pay, the revenues were not recognized in subsequent periods but instead permanently reversed. We permanently reversed a total of  
approximately $150 million of revenues in 2000 and $25 million in 2001 as a result of title and risk of loss adjustments.  
We also identified errors related to title and delivery issues in connection with arrangements known as “bill and hold” transactions, in which  
revenue is recognized before actual delivery of the product. Corrections of these errors resulted in the deferral of revenue into later periods,  
which had the effect of a net increase to revenues of approximately $760 million in 2001 and $10 million in 2002. Our scrutiny of this issue  
was similarly prompted by employee input. In this situation, we determined that the relevant accounting policy had been incorrectly applied to  
a number of contracts, and revenues were recognized where the relevant criteria had not been fully met. In reviewing individual contracts, we  
examined, among other things: whether significant product returns had occurred in later periods, the accounts receivable history, whether better  
pricing was provided for the particular purchase order to incent a customer to enter into a bill and hold arrangement, whether purchase orders  
were eventually placed by the customer and whether third-party corroboration was available as to whether the arrangement was at the request  
of the customer or Nortel Networks. As a result of our consideration of these factors, we deferred all revenues associated with bill and hold  
arrangements to subsequent periods. We no longer recognize revenue on bill and hold arrangements before delivery occurs and all other criteria  
of revenue recognition are fully met.  
— A decrease of $190 million in 2001 and an increase of $45 million in 2002 and  
Undelivered elements and liquidated damages  
$204 million in 2003.  
Another area of review prompted by our review of the broader original accounting treatment of certain individual contracts was related to  
certain optical product transactions where revenues related to undelivered product elements were erroneously recognized. In these cases,  
revenues for customer orders  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
were recognized upon delivery of interim product solutions pending the availability of the later generation optical product that the customer  
had ordered. In this circumstance, revenues for the order should have been deferred until the undelivered element was delivered as we did not  
have evidence supporting the fair value of the undelivered element. Accordingly, we restated the recorded revenues, deferring recognition to  
subsequent periods, which had the effect of a net decrease to revenues of approximately $40 million in 2001 and an increase to revenues of  
approximately $190 million in 2002 and $25 million in 2003.  
We also focused on accounting for software revenue recognition more generally, particularly in our Optical business. In Fall 2004, we sought  
the views of the SEC’s Office of the Chief Accountant, or OCA, on one issue with respect to our historical and continuing accounting  
treatment under U.S. GAAP of revenues recognized on sales of certain optical products containing embedded software. We advised the OCA  
that we believed our historical accounting treatment of these optical products was appropriate, and we were fully supported in this conclusion  
by D&T. We, in consultation with D&T, nevertheless decided to obtain the views of the OCA on our analysis and conclusions due to the  
judgments involved in the applicable accounting analysis and the significant impact a different conclusion could have had on our reported  
revenues (namely, the deferred recognition of substantial revenues over a number of subsequent years). Following discussions with us, the  
OCA did not approve or disapprove our accounting in this area, and we concluded that we would not make any adjustments to our accounting  
treatment of the sales of these optical products as part of the Second Restatement.  
We also considered revenue recognition policies related to post-contract support, or PCS, with respect to all business lines, and identified  
certain Enterprise products that presented issues. For these products, we recognized revenues at the time of delivery of the product but before  
completion of PCS or other future services agreed to in the contract. Because in some cases we did not have vendor specific objective evidence  
of fair value for those services (for example, where we made available free software upgrades on our website), U.S. GAAP requires the  
revenues to be recognized over the PCS period. Accordingly, we corrected this error and deferred the revenues to subsequent periods, resulting  
in a net decrease to revenues of approximately $140 million in 2001 and $155 million in 2002 and a net increase of approximately $170 million  
in 2003.  
Fixed or determinable fees—An increase of $133 million in 2002.  
As a result of our focus on accounting for software revenue recognition more generally as described above, we identified a specific contract for  
which revenue for sales had been recognized but the criteria for revenue recognition had not been met, including the criteria that contract fees  
be either fixed or determinable. Accordingly, we corrected this error and deferred the revenues to subsequent periods when customer payments  
became due and all criteria for revenue recognition were met.  
—An increase of $151 million in 2001.  
Reseller transactions  
As a result of employee input, we determined that a certain reseller lacked economic substance apart from Nortel Networks at the time of the  
relevant transaction. In such a case, we should have deferred revenues and recognized them only upon the reseller’s sale of the products to an  
end customer. Accordingly, we corrected this error and deferred the revenues to subsequent periods.  
—A decrease of approximately $55 million in 2000 and $20 million in 2001.  
Reciprocal arrangements  
In our review of a particular contract in connection with other issues described above, we determined that it also involved a reciprocal  
arrangement with the customer. Instead of recognizing the full amount of  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
revenues we received on the sale of products or services, the amounts we paid the customer under the reciprocal arrangement should have been  
treated as a reduction of revenues. Through our review of a substantial number of individual contracts, as noted above, we also identified a  
limited number of other reciprocal arrangements, which were recorded as permanent reductions in revenue.  
—A decrease of approximately $40 million in 2001 and an increase of  
Application of SOP 81-1 and other revenue recognition items  
approximately $80 million in 2002 and $140 million in 2003.  
As we continued to review the application of our accounting policies, as well as specific contracts, we discovered errors related principally to  
the incorrect application of percentage of completion accounting for certain transactions. Our review also included an analysis of the  
accounting for product credits, liquidated damages and other incentives. We corrected these errors, which resulted in both deferrals of revenues  
to subsequent periods and movement of revenues to earlier periods.  
Other accounting practices that management examined and adjusted as part of the Second Restatement included, among other things, the  
following (as described in more detail below):  
our foreign exchange accounting, as part of the plan to address the identified material weakness related to foreign currency  
translation described above;  
intercompany balances that did not eliminate upon consolidation and related provisions;  
the accounting treatment of the February 2001 acquisition of the 980 NPLC business from JDS and the related OEM Purchase and  
Sale Agreement;  
special charges relating to goodwill, inventory impairment, contract settlement costs and other charges; and  
the accounting treatment of certain elements of discontinued operations.  
In sum, the key components of the Second Restatement process were as follows:  
involvement and oversight by current senior finance personnel, with regular communications to the global finance organization to  
monitor progress and ensure consistency, and open and regular dialogue with our external auditors;  
maintenance of a restatement database to track issues and adjustments;  
establishment of a process to evaluate certain potential provisions and releases that may not have been fully addressed in the First  
Restatement, including a review of all First Restatement processes, and enhanced balance sheet reviews at the business unit,  
regional and statutory entity levels;  
establishment of processes to evaluate certain potential restatement items related to our revenue recognition policies and practices  
and other accounting issues;  
validation processes, including detailed review of supporting documentation to ensure adjustments were appropriately  
substantiated; and  
identification, development and initial implementation of remedial actions, as further described under “Remedial Measures” below.  
As discussed above under “Current Management Conclusions Concerning Disclosure Controls and Procedures”, as a result of the extensive  
work undertaken in connection with the Second Restatement, management believes, based on its knowledge, that (i) this report does not  
contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the  
circumstances under which they were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
report and (ii) the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects our  
financial condition, results of operations and cash flows as at, and for, the periods presented in this report.  
Principal Adjustments  
The following are the principal Second Restatement adjustments:  
An increase of $386 million in previously announced revenues and a decrease of $298 million in previously announced net earnings  
for the year ended December 31, 2003, with the following adjustments on a quarterly basis:  
a decrease of $79 million in previously reported revenues and $135 million in previously reported net earnings for the first  
quarter of 2003, resulting in our reporting a net loss rather than net earnings for the period;  
a decrease of $53 million in previously reported revenues and $138 million in previously reported net earnings for the second  
quarter of 2003, resulting in our reporting a net loss rather than net earnings for the period;  
an increase of $78 million in previously reported revenues and a decrease of $54 million in previously reported net earnings for  
the third quarter of 2003; and  
an increase of $440 million in previously announced revenues and $29 million in previously announced net earnings for the  
fourth quarter of 2003.  
An increase of $439 million in previously reported revenues and a reduction of $272 million in previously reported net loss for the  
year ended December 31, 2002, with the following adjustments on a quarterly basis:  
an increase of $244 million in previously reported revenues and a decrease of $101 million in previously reported net loss for  
the first quarter of 2002;  
an increase of $132 million in previously reported revenues and a decrease of $115 million in previously reported net loss for  
the second quarter of 2002;  
a decrease of $28 million in previously reported revenues and $182 million in previously reported net loss for the third quarter  
of 2002; and  
an increase of $91 million in previously reported revenues and $126 million in previously reported net loss for the fourth  
quarter of 2002.  
An increase of $1,492 million in previously reported revenues and a reduction of $1,433 million in previously reported net loss for  
the year ended December 31, 2001.  
The principal adjustments primarily relate to the following matters (each of which reflects a number of related adjustments that have been  
aggregated for disclosure purposes):  
Adjustments to revenues and cost of revenues to address various aspects of our revenue recognition policies and practices increased  
revenues by a total of $439 million in 2002 and $1,492 million in 2001, and increased cost of revenues by a total of $305 million in  
2002 and $598 million in 2001. The revenue matters adjusted are discussed in detail above under “Second Restatement Process”.  
Foreign exchange adjustments increased our pre-tax loss by a total of $63 million in 2002 and $132 million in 2001. These  
adjustments resulted from the re-examination of the determination of the functional currency for certain entities and the incorrect  
treatment of significant long-term inter-company positions, and the incorrect classification of certain foreign exchange gains and  
losses.  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Correction of certain inter-company balances that did not properly eliminate upon consolidation and related provisions resulted in a  
decrease of $36 million and an increase of $42 million to pre-tax loss for 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Adjustments to previously recorded special charges relating to goodwill, inventory impairment, contract settlement costs and other  
charges resulted in a total decrease to special charges of $78 million in 2002 and $845 million in 2001. These adjustments consisted  
primarily of the following:  
goodwill impairment and amortization charges were reduced, and cost of revenues were increased, as a result of the re-  
examination of the accounting for the deferred consideration associated with our acquisition of the 980 NPLC business from  
JDS;  
goodwill recorded from certain acquisitions was reduced due to corrections to purchase accounting allocations, which in turn  
reduced the subsequent goodwill impairment charges and amortization that were a component of special charges;  
inventory impairments incorrectly classified as special charges were reclassified to cost of revenues; and  
contract settlement costs and other items were adjusted primarily due to changes in estimates and/or assumptions that were  
previously recorded in the incorrect period.  
Corrections to various accruals, provisions or other transactions, primarily due to the incorrect application of U.S. GAAP to the  
initial recording of such liabilities, or the failure to subsequently adjust such liabilities in the correct period, resulted in a decrease of  
$314 million and an increase of $59 million in our net loss in 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Adjustments to the accounting treatment of certain components of discontinued operations, initially recorded by us in June 2001,  
resulted in an increase of $121 million and a decrease of $529 million to the net loss from discontinued operations — net of tax in  
2002 and 2001, respectively.  
For additional information concerning adjustments made in the Second Restatement, see notes 3 and 23 to the accompanying audited  
consolidated financial statements and “—Developments in 2004—Restatements” in the MD&A section of this report.  
Use of Estimates in Financial Reporting; Omission of 1999 and 2000 Selected Financial Data; Decision Not to Amend Certain  
Previous Filings  
As described above, two material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting were identified at the time of the First  
Restatement. During the Second Restatement process, a number of additional material weaknesses in our internal control over financial  
reporting were identified, as described below. Due to, among other factors, these material weaknesses, the significant turnover in our finance  
personnel, changes in accounting systems, documentation weaknesses and the passage of time generally, the Second Restatement involved the  
efforts of hundreds of our finance personnel and a number of outside consultants and advisors. As described above, the process required the  
review and verification of a substantial number of documents and communications, and related accounting entries, over multiple fiscal periods.  
In addition, the review of accruals and provisions and the application of accounting literature to certain matters in the Second Restatement,  
including revenue recognition, foreign exchange, special charges and discontinued operations, was complicated by the passage of time, the lack  
of availability of supporting records and the turnover of finance personnel noted above. As a result of this complexity, estimates and  
assumptions that impact both the quantum of the various recorded adjustments and the fiscal period to which they were attributed were  
required in the determination of certain of the Second Restatement  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
adjustments. We believe the procedures followed in determining such estimates were appropriate and reasonable using the best available  
information.  
Also as a result of the above factors, as well as a likely inability to obtain third party corroboration in certain cases due to the substantial  
industry adjustment in the telecommunications industry beginning in 2001, we believe that extensive additional efforts over an extended period  
of time would be required to restate our 1999 and 2000 selected financial data. We also believe that selected financial data for these periods  
would not be meaningful to investors due to this industry adjustment, which significantly impacted our financial results in 2001 and subsequent  
periods and limits the relevance of financial results in periods prior to 2001 for purposes of analysis of trends in subsequent periods. Given the  
long delay in filing the Reports, we believed that investor understanding would be better aided by the dedication of our resources to the  
preparation of the current financial and other information included in this and future reports. As a result, except for the selected balance sheet  
data as at December 31, 2000, financial data for the years ended December 31, 1999 and 2000 has not been restated or presented in the  
“Selected Financial Data (Unaudited)” section of this report. This omitted data is normally required to be included in an Annual Report on  
Form 10-K.  
A number of our and NNL’s past filings with the SEC remain subject to ongoing review by the SEC’s Division of Corporation Finance (which  
could result in the need to amend this or our other filings). In addition, the Second Restatement involved the restatement of our consolidated  
financial statements for 2001 and 2002 and the first, second and third quarters of 2003. Amendments to our prior filings with the SEC would be  
required in order for us to be in full compliance with our reporting obligations under the Exchange Act. However, for the same reasons  
discussed above, we do not believe that it would be feasible for us to amend our 2002 Form 10-K/A. In addition, we believe that amended  
disclosure in the 2002 Form 10-K/A, 2003 Form 10-Q/As and 2003 Form 10-Q would in large part repeat the disclosure in this report and  
expected to be contained in the 2004 Form 10-Qs. Accordingly, we do not plan to amend our 2002 Form 10-K/A, 2003 Form 10-Q/As or 2003  
Form 10-Q. We believe that we have included in this report all information needed for current investor understanding and will take similar  
steps in our 2004 Form 10-Qs.  
Material Weaknesses in Internal Control over Financial Reporting Identified During the Second Restatement  
Over the course of the Second Restatement process, we, together with D&T, identified a number of reportable conditions, each constituting a  
material weakness, in our internal control over financial reporting as at December 31, 2003. In September 2004, management first notified the  
Audit Committee of the possibility of additional material weaknesses. Over the remainder of the Second Restatement process, management and  
D&T identified a total of six material weaknesses. On January 10, 2005, D&T confirmed to the Audit Committee that it had identified these six  
material weaknesses. No other reportable conditions were identified by us or D&T at the time of the Second Restatement. The material  
weaknesses identified were:  
lack of compliance with written Nortel Networks procedures for monitoring and adjusting balances related to certain accruals and  
provisions, including restructuring charges and contract and customer accruals;  
lack of compliance with Nortel Networks procedures for appropriately applying applicable GAAP to the initial recording of certain  
liabilities, including those described in SFAS No. 5, and to foreign currency translation as described in SFAS No. 52;  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
lack of sufficient personnel with appropriate knowledge, experience and training in U.S. GAAP and lack of sufficient analysis and  
documentation of the application of U.S. GAAP to transactions, including, but not limited to, revenue transactions;  
lack of a clear organization and accountability structure within the accounting function, including insufficient review and  
supervision, combined with financial reporting systems that are not integrated and which require extensive manual interventions;  
lack of sufficient awareness of, and timely and appropriate remediation of, internal control issues by Nortel Networks personnel;  
and  
an inappropriate ‘tone at the top’, which contributed to the lack of a strong control environment. As reported in the Independent  
Review Summary included above, there was a “Management ‘tone at the top’ that conveyed the strong leadership message that  
earnings targets could be met through application of accounting practices that finance managers knew or ought to have known were  
not in compliance with U.S. GAAP and that questioning these practices was not acceptable”.  
The foregoing material weaknesses contributed to the need for the Second Restatement. Upon completion of our assessment of our internal  
control over financial reporting as at December 31, 2004 pursuant to SOX 404, we currently expect to conclude that the first five of these six  
material weaknesses continue to exist as at December 31, 2004, and we continue to identify, develop and begin to implement remedial  
measures to address them, as described below.  
* * * * * *  
Current Status of Material Weaknesses in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting and Expectations as to Required Management  
Conclusions and Independent Auditor Attestation Pursuant to Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act  
As noted in “MD&A — Risk factors/Forward looking statements”, our 2004 Form 10-K must comply with SOX 404, which requires  
management to assess the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting annually and to include in our Annual Report on Form  
10-K a management report on that assessment, together with an attestation by our independent registered public accounting firm. As noted  
above, upon completion of our assessment of our internal control over financial reporting as at December 31, 2004, we currently expect to  
conclude that the first five of the six material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting described immediately above continue  
to exist as at December 31, 2004 (and also constitute “material weaknesses” as now defined under standards established by the Public  
Company Accounting Oversight Board). Accordingly, management expects to conclude that our internal control over financial reporting as at  
December 31, 2004 is ineffective, and D&T has advised us that they expect their report on management’s assessment of internal control over  
financial reporting also to indicate that internal control over financial reporting is ineffective.  
* * * * * *  
Revenue Independent Review  
As more fully described above, over the course of the Second Restatement process, management identified certain accounting practices that it  
determined should be adjusted as part of the Second Restatement. In particular, management identified certain errors related to revenue  
recognition and undertook a process of revenue reviews. In light of the resulting adjustments to previously reported revenues, the Audit  
Committee has determined to review the facts and circumstances leading to the restatement of these revenues for specific transactions  
identified in the Second Restatement. The  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Revenue Independent Review will have a particular emphasis on the underlying conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues.  
The Audit Committee will seek a full understanding of the historic events that required the revenues for these specific transactions to be  
restated and will consider any appropriate additional remedial measures, including those involving internal controls and processes. The Audit  
Committee has engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection with the Revenue Independent Review.  
* * * * * *  
Remedial Measures  
At the recommendation of the Audit Committee, the Board of Directors adopted all of the recommendations for remedial measures contained  
in the Independent Review Summary. The Board of Directors has directed management to develop a detailed plan and timetable for the  
implementation of these recommendations and will monitor their implementation. In addition, we have identified, developed and begun to  
implement a number of measures to strengthen our internal control over financial reporting and address the material weaknesses identified  
above, including pursuant to recommendations from D&T. These measures are in the process of being reviewed in light of the  
recommendations of the Independent Review and certain of these measures may be superseded by the plans for the implementation of the  
recommendations of the Independent Review. A summary of these measures, as well as previously announced personnel actions, follows.  
Personnel Actions in Response to the First Restatement and Independent Review.  
We terminated for cause our former president and chief executive officer, former chief financial officer and former controller  
in April 2004 (the former chief financial officer and former controller having been placed on paid leaves of absence in  
March 2004).  
We terminated for cause seven additional senior finance employees with significant responsibilities for our financial reporting  
as a whole or for their respective business units and geographic regions in August 2004.  
Renewed Commitment to Best Corporate Practices and Ethical Conduct.  
In August 2004, we adopted a new strategic plan that includes a renewed commitment to best corporate practices and ethical  
conduct, including the establishment of the office of a chief ethics and compliance officer (which has been filled on an interim  
basis pending the permanent appointment of Susan E. Shepard, as now announced).  
Over the course of the Second Restatement, our current CEO and current CFO have communicated to employees the  
importance of the Second Restatement process, reliable and transparent financial reporting and ethical conduct. Those  
communications included formal presentations as part of our annual executive conference in November 2004.  
In June 2004 management recommended, the joint leadership resources committee recommended and the Board of Directors  
subsequently approved that financial accountability be included as a key qualitative factor in the individual leadership  
performance objectives for determination of incentive cash awards under our annual incentive plan.  
Extended Balance Sheet Reviews.  
We have developed a plan to extend our balance sheet reviews through the implementation of enhanced review procedures to:  
require greater frequency of timely statutory and segment balance sheet reviews,  
clarify responsibilities within Nortel Networks for organizing balance sheet  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
reviews, and  
establish minimum documentation requirements with respect to balance sheet entries.  
As part of the initial development of this plan, in the first quarter of 2004, we increased our focus on the review of specific  
balance sheet accounts.  
Review of Finance Department Organizational Structure. We announced, and began to implement, plans to transform our finance  
organization, which include a renewed commitment to transparency as a fundamental goal. Measures we have begun to implement  
include:  
In the first quarter of 2004, we began to enhance our global technical accounting group and establish global contract review  
and global finance governance teams.  
We engaged Accenture, a global management consulting and technology services firm, in the third quarter of 2004 to assess  
the finance organization’s structure, processes and systems, with an expected assessment completion date of March 2005.  
We established a global corporate finance Sarbanes-Oxley compliance group beginning in the third quarter of 2004.  
We have hired additional full-time finance personnel (with a focus on qualified accounting professionals) as part of an  
initiative introduced by the CFO and controller in March 2004.  
Training Initiatives.  
We re-established our formal training group (led by the global finance governance team described above) to implement  
ongoing training programs for finance personnel globally. The group’s focus includes training with respect to SFAS No. 5;  
accounting for hedging and derivatives; revenue recognition, accruals and provisions; and SFAS No. 52.  
Internal Audit.  
In the first quarter of 2004, we modified the mandate of our Internal Audit function to place a greater emphasis on the  
adequacy of, and compliance with, procedures relating to internal control over financial reporting.  
In October 2004, we engaged outside consultants to conduct a strategic performance review of the internal audit function. The  
objective of this review is to ensure that internal audit continues to meet professional internal audit standards and moves  
towards audit best practices.  
Manual Journal Entry Processes.  
In the fourth quarter of 2003, we began to modify our manual journal entry processes by implementing new procedures, with  
a focus on approvals of manual journal entries, more stringent documentation processes and reduction of user access to  
manual journal entry functions.  
As noted above, we continue to identify, develop and begin to implement remedial measures, including the development of a detailed plan and  
timetable for the implementation of the recommendations of the Independent Review. As part of the Revenue Independent Review, the Audit  
Committee will also consider any appropriate additional remedial measures, including those involving internal controls and processes.  
The above mentioned changes in internal control over financial reporting materially affected our internal control over financial reporting, and  
these changes and expected changes as a result of remedial measures to be developed and implemented are reasonably likely to materially  
affect our internal control over financial reporting in the future. We intend to continue to make ongoing assessments of our internal controls  
and procedures periodically and as a result of the recommendations of the Independent Review and any additional recommendations of the  
Revenue Independent Review.  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ITEM 10. Directors and Executive Officers of the Registrant  
Directors of the registrant  
Directors are elected at the annual meeting of shareholders, except that we can appoint directors in certain circumstances between annual  
meetings. Each person who is appointed or elected to the board of directors will hold that position until the earliest of: (i) the close of the next  
annual meeting of shareholders; (ii) the date he or she ceases to be a director by operation of law; or (iii) the date he or she resigns.  
The committee on directors and the board of directors of the Company remain committed to ensuring an orderly succession, continuity and  
renewal. This process was commenced in 2003 and resulted in the appointment of Dr. Bischoff and Mr. Manley in the second quarter of 2004.  
On January 10, 2005, the committee on directors advised the board of directors that five of the current directors have decided not to stand for  
re-election at our next annual and special meeting of shareholders to be held as soon as practicable after the completion and filing of the 2004  
and 2003 audited annual financial statements (the “AGM”). These directors and the year of their initial election to the board of directors are:  
Mr. Wilson (1991), Mr. Fortier (1992), Mr. Smith (1994), Mrs. Saucier (1997) and Mr. Blanchard (1997). All of the current members of the  
board of directors who will not be standing for re-election at the next AGM are committed to continuing in their current roles until the next  
AGM. The committee on directors has identified two additional candidates not listed below, who the board of directors expects will be  
nominated at the next AGM for election as directors. The board of directors of the Company today appointed Mr. McCormick and Mr. Pearce  
directors of the Company effective immediately after the filing with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission of this Annual  
Report on Form 10-K of the Company for the year ended December 31, 2003. The board of directors of Nortel Networks Limited also  
appointed Mr. McCormick and Mr. Pearce directors of Nortel Networks Limited, effective immediately after the filing with the United States  
Securities and Exchange Commission of the Annual Report on Form 10-K of Nortel Networks Limited for the year ended December 31, 2003.  
Set out below is certain information concerning the individuals who currently have been nominated to be elected as directors of the  
Company at our next AGM and certain information concerning the five of our current directors who will not be standing for re-election at the  
AGM.  
Name  
Age  
62  
62  
59  
63  
69  
62  
59  
55  
64  
64  
62  
58  
70  
64  
Position with the Company  
Dr. Manfred Bischoff  
The Hon. James Johnston Blanchard  
Robert Ellis Brown  
John Edward Cleghorn  
L. Yves Fortier  
Director  
Director (not standing for re-election)  
Director  
Director  
Director (not standing for re-election)  
Robert Alexander Ingram  
John A. MacNaughton  
The Hon. John Manley  
Richard D. McCormick  
William Arthur Owens  
Harry J. Pearce  
Director  
Nominee  
Director  
Nominee  
President and Chief Executive Officer and Director  
Nominee  
Guylaine Saucier  
Director (not standing for re-election)  
Director (not standing for re-election)  
Sherwood H. Smith, Jr.  
Lynton Ronald Wilson  
Chairman (non-executive) and Director (not standing for re-  
election)  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
, 62, Starnberg, Federal Republic of Germany, was appointed as a director of  
DR. MANFRED BISCHOFF  
the Company and Nortel Networks Limited on April 29, 2004. Dr. Bischoff has been Chairman of the Board  
of European Aeronautic Defence and Space Company EADS N.V., an aerospace company, since July 2000  
and Delegate for Aerospace at DaimlerChrysler AG since January 2004. Dr. Bischoff was a member of the  
board of management of DaimlerChrysler AG, an automotive manufacturing company, from May 1995 to  
December 2003 and President and Chief Executive Officer of DaimlerChrysler Aerospace AG from  
May 1995 to March 2000. He is also a member of the Supervisory Board of Bayerische Hypo-und  
Vereinsbank AG, Fraport AG, Gerling-Konzern Versicherungs-Beteiligungs-AG, J.M. Voith AG, Lagardère  
SCA and Royal KPN N.V.  
, 59, Westmount, Québec, Canada, has been a director of the Company since  
ROBERT ELLIS BROWN  
March 7, 2000 and of Nortel Networks Limited since April 27, 2000. Mr. Brown has been President and Chief  
Executive Officer of CAE Inc., a flight training, services and equipment company, since August 2004 and has  
been a director of ACE Aviation Holdings Inc., the parent holding company under which the reorganized Air  
Canada is held, since October 2004. After being appointed a director of Air Canada, a commercial airline  
company, in March 2003, he was appointed Vice-Chairman of the Board from April 2003 to May 2003 and  
Chairman of the Board from May 2003 to September 2004. On April 1, 2003, Air Canada obtained an initial  
order from the Ontario Superior Court of Justice providing creditor protection under the  
Companies Creditors  
, such order being subsequently amended in connection with the proceedings. On April 1,  
Arrangement Act  
2003, Air Canada also made a concurrent petition for recognition and ancillary relief under Section 304 of the  
United States Bankruptcy Code. Air Canada successfully completed its restructuring process and emerged  
from creditor protection in September 2004. Mr. Brown served as a Director and Chairman of the Board of  
Air Canada during its restructuring. Mr. Brown has been the Chairman of Vanguard Response Systems Inc.  
since November 2003. Mr. Brown was the President and Chief Executive Officer of Bombardier Inc. from  
February 1999 to December 2002.  
, O.C., F.C.A., 63, Toronto, Ontario, Canada, has been a director of the  
JOHN EDWARD CLEGHORN  
Company and of Nortel Networks Limited since May 24, 2001. Mr. Cleghorn was Chairman and Chief  
Executive Officer of the Royal Bank of Canada from January 1995 to July 2001. He is also Chairman of the  
Board of SNC-Lavalin Group Inc., an engineering and construction company, and a director of Canadian  
Pacific Railway Company, Canadian Pacific Railway Limited, Finning International Inc. and Molson Inc. He  
is Chancellor Emeritus of Wilfrid Laurier University, Member of the Faculty of Management International  
Advisory Board, McGill University and is the Immediate Past Chairman and a director of the Historica  
Foundation of Canada.  
, 62, Durham, North Carolina, United States, has been a director of the  
ROBERT ALEXANDER INGRAM  
Company since March 7, 2000 and of Nortel Networks Limited since April 29, 1999. Mr. Ingram has been  
Vice-Chairman Pharmaceuticals of GlaxoSmithKline plc, a corporation involved in the research,  
development, manufacturing and sale of pharmaceuticals, since January 2003. Mr. Ingram was the Chief  
Operating Officer and President, Pharmaceutical Operations of GlaxoSmithKline plc from January 2001 to  
January 2003. He was Chief Executive of Glaxo Wellcome plc from October 1997 to December 2000 and  
Chairman of Glaxo Wellcome Inc., Glaxo Wellcome plc’s United States subsidiary, from January 1999 to  
December 2000. Mr. Ingram is also non-executive Chairman of the Board of OSI Pharmaceuticals, Inc., a  
biotechnology company, and a director of Edwards Lifesciences Corporation, Lowe’s Companies, Inc., Misys  
plc, VALEANT Pharmaceuticals International and Wachovia Corporation.  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
, C.M., 59, Toronto, Ontario, Canada, has been nominated for election as a  
JOHN A. MacNAUGHTON  
director of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited for the first time. Mr. MacNaughton has served since  
September 1999 as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Canada Pension Plan Investment Board, a  
Crown Corporation created by an Act of Parliament in 1997 to invest the assets of the Canada Pension Plan.  
He is due to retire from that position on January 14, 2005. Prior to September 1999, he served as President of  
Nesbitt Burns Inc., the investment banking arm of Bank of Montreal, from September 1994 to March 1999.  
Mr. MacNaughton is a Trustee of the University Health Network, an academic health science centre. He is a  
Governor of CCAF-FCVI Inc., a research and education foundation focused on governance, accountability,  
management and audit in the public sector.  
, 55, Ottawa, Ontario, Canada, was appointed as a director of the Company  
THE HON. JOHN MANLEY  
and Nortel Networks Limited on May 26, 2004. Mr. Manley has been a senior counsel at the law firm of  
McCarthy Tétrault LLP since May 2004. Mr. Manley was previously the Member of Parliament for Ottawa  
South from November 1988 to June 2004 and Chairman of the Ontario Power Generation Review Committee,  
which was responsible for reviewing the state of the energy system of Ontario, from December 2003 to  
March 2004. As a Member of Parliament, Mr. Manley also held various positions in the Canadian federal  
government, including Deputy Prime Minister of Canada from January 2002 to December 2003, Minister of  
Finance from June 2002 to December 2003, Chair of the Cabinet Committee on Public Security and Anti-  
Terrorism from October 2001 to December 2003, Minister of Foreign Affairs from October 2000 to  
January 2002 and Minister of Industry prior thereto.  
, 64, Denver, Colorado, United States, served as Chairman of US WEST, Inc.,  
RICHARD D. McCORMICK  
a telecommunications company, from June 1998 until his retirement in May 1999. He was chairman, president  
and chief executive officer of US WEST, Inc. from 1992 until 1998. He is also a director of HealthTrio Inc.,  
United Technologies Corporation, Unocal Corporation and Wells Fargo and Company. From 1994 to 2003,  
Mr. McCormick was also a director of UAL Corporation, the parent holding company and sole shareholder of  
United Air Lines, Inc. On December 9, 2002, UAL Corporation, United Air Lines, Inc. and 26 direct and  
indirect wholly owned subsidiaries of UAL Corporation filed voluntary petitions to reorganize their  
businesses under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code in the United States Bankruptcy Court for  
the Northern District of Illinois, Eastern Division.  
, 64, Kirkland, Washington, United States, has been a director of the  
WILLIAM ARTHUR OWENS  
Company and of Nortel Networks Limited since February 28, 2002. Mr. Owens has been President and Chief  
Executive Officer of the Company and of Nortel Networks Limited since April 2004. Mr. Owens was  
Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Teledesic LLC, a satellite communications company, from  
December 2001 to April 2004, after having served as Vice Chairman and Co-Chief Executive Officer from  
August 1998 to December 2001. Mr. Owens was Vice-Chairman of the Board of Directors of Science  
Applications International Corporation (or SAIC), a research and engineering firm representing the largest  
employee-owned high technology company in the United States, from March 1996 to August 1998, and  
served as SAIC’s President and Chief Operating Officer from December 1996 to August 1998 and Vice-  
President from March 1996 to December 1996. Prior to joining SAIC, Mr. Owens was Vice Chairman of the  
Joint Chiefs of Staff, the second-ranking military officer in the United States. As part of his role with the Joint  
Chiefs of Staff, he had responsibility for the reorganization and restructuring of the armed forces in the post-  
Cold War era. Mr. Owens is also a director of DaimlerChrysler AG. Mr. Owens was the Chairman and  
founder of a private five-state wireless telecommunication venture. Mr. Owens was also a director of IFusion  
Com Corporation, a company involved in developing Internet services and systems, for approximately one  
year, his tenure ending in March 1997. On March 28, 1997, IFusion Com Corporation filed a voluntary  
petition to reorganize its businesses under Chapter 11 of the United States Bankruptcy Code in the United  
States Bankruptcy Court for the Southern District of New York, United States.  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
, 62, Bloomfield Hills, Michigan, United States, was Chairman of the Board of Hughes  
HARRY J. PEARCE  
Electronics Corporation (now The DIRECTV Group, Inc.), a company engaged in digital television  
entertainment, broadband satellite and network services as well as global video and data broadcasting, from  
June 2001 to January 2004. He was a director and Vice-Chairman of General Motors Corporation from  
January 1996 to June 2001. Mr. Pearce is also a director of Marriott International, Inc. and MDU Resources  
Group, Inc.  
We would like to acknowledge the many years of contribution and service to the Company and Nortel Networks Limited by Messrs. Lynton  
Ronald Wilson, L. Yves Fortier, Sherwood H. Smith, Jr., Mrs. Guylaine Saucier and the Honorable James Johnston Blanchard.  
Mr. Wilson has been a director of the Company since March 7, 2000 and of Nortel Networks Limited since April 25, 1991 and non-  
executive Chairman of the Board of the Company and of Nortel Networks Limited since February 2002. Mr. Wilson was executive Chairman  
of the Board of the Company and of Nortel Networks Limited from November 2001 to February 2002. He was non-executive Chairman of the  
Board of the Company and of Nortel Networks Limited from April 2001 to November 2001. Mr. Wilson was Chairman of the Board of  
Directors of BCE Inc., a telecommunications company, from May 1998 to April 2000, serving in a non-executive capacity from January 1999.  
He is Chairman of the Board of CAE Inc., a flight training, services and equipment company, and a director of DaimlerChrysler AG and  
DaimlerChrysler Canada Inc.  
Mr. Fortier has been a director of the Company since March 7, 2000 and Nortel Networks Limited since April 30, 1992. He also serves on  
the pension fund policy committee of Nortel Networks Limited. He is a senior partner and Co-Chairman of the law firm of Ogilvy Renault.  
Mr. Fortier was Canada’s Ambassador to the United Nations from 1988 to 1992. Since 2001, he has been a Trustee of the International  
Accounting Standards Committee Foundation. He is also Chairman of the Board of Alcan Inc., Governor (Chairman of the Board) of Hudson’s  
Bay Company, and a director of NOVA Chemicals Corporation and Royal Bank of Canada.  
Mr. Smith, having reached the age of retirement and the term limit under the Company’s corporate governance guidelines, will not be  
standing again for re-election at the AGM. Mr. Smith has been a director of the Company since March 7, 2000 and of Nortel Networks Limited  
since April 28, 1994. He serves on the audit committee and the joint leadership resources committee of the Company, and on the audit  
committee, the joint leadership resources committee and the pension fund policy committee (Chairman) of Nortel Networks Limited.  
Mr. Smith is Chairman Emeritus of the Board at CP&L. He is also a trustee of Northwestern Mutual Life Insurance Company, Chairman of the  
Triangle Universities Center for Advanced Studies and Vice-Chairman of the Research Triangle Foundation.  
Mrs. Saucier has been a director of the Company since March 7, 2000 and of Nortel Networks Limited since May 1, 1997. Mrs. Saucier was  
Chair of the Joint Committee on Corporate Governance, which was established by the Canadian Institute of Chartered Accountants, the  
Canadian Venture Exchange, and the Toronto Stock Exchange in 2000 to review the state of corporate governance in Canada and make  
recommendations thereon. She was also Chair of The Canadian Institute of Chartered Accountants from June 1999 to June 2000. Mrs. Saucier  
was Chairman of the Board and a director of the Canadian Broadcasting Corporation, a public broadcaster, from April 1995 to December 2000.  
She is also a director of Altran Technologies SA, AXA Assurances Inc., Bank of Montreal, Petro-Canada and Tembec Inc.  
Mr. Blanchard has been a director of the Company since March 7, 2000 and of Nortel Networks Limited since May 1, 1997. Mr. Blanchard  
has been a partner in the law firm of Piper Rudnick LLP (now DLA Piper Rudnick Gray Cary) since October 2002 and prior to October 2002  
was a shareholder in the law firm of Verner, Liipfert, Bernhard, McPherson and Hand, Chartered since April 1996. He was previously United  
States Ambassador to Canada, Governor of the State of Michigan and a member of the United States House of Representatives. Mr. Blanchard  
is also a director of Bennett Environmental, Inc., Brascan Corporation, Enbridge Inc., LDMI Communications, Inc. and Teknion Corporation.  
Shareholders who wish to have the committee on directors of the board of directors of the Company consider the nomination of any person  
for director should communicate with the Company’s corporate secretary at the Company’s principal executive offices at 8200 Dixie Road,  
Suite 100, Brampton, Ontario, L5T 5P6.  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Executive officers and certain other non-executive board appointed officers of the Registrant  
The executive officers and certain other non-executive board appointed officers of the Company are appointed, and may be removed, by the  
Board of Directors of the Company. Generally, executive officers and other non-executive officers hold their offices until a successor is  
appointed or until the officer resigns. As of December 31, 2004, the names of the executive officers and non-executive board appointed officers  
of the Company, their ages, offices currently held and year of appointment thereto were as follows:  
Year of  
Appointment  
Name and age  
Office and position currently held  
Martha Helena Bejar (42)  
Chahram Bolouri (50)  
President, CALA  
2004  
2004  
2002  
2004  
2004  
2004  
2000  
2000  
2002  
2003  
2002  
2004  
2004  
2004  
2004  
2003  
2004  
2004  
2004  
2004  
2004  
2001  
2004  
2004  
2002  
2004  
2003  
2004  
2000  
2003  
2004  
President, Global Services  
President, Enterprise Networks  
Assistant Secretary and Counsel — Securities  
Assistant General Counsel — Securities and Corporate Secretary  
President, Carrier Networks  
Chief Legal Officer  
Senior Vice-President, Human Resources  
Vice-President, Tax  
President, Asia Pacific  
Chief Information Officer  
Chief Strategy Officer  
Chief Financial Officer  
President, CDMA  
President, GSM/UMTS  
President and Chief Executive Officer, Greater China  
Chief Ethics and Compliance Officer  
Chief Technology Officer  
Special Advisor  
President and Chief Executive Officer  
Controller  
President, Europe, Middle East and Africa  
Chief Marketing Officer  
President, Federal Network Solutions  
President, Enterprise Accounts  
President, Wireline/Optical  
Assistant Controller  
Malcolm Kevin Collins (44)  
Tracy Sarah Jane Connelly McGilley (33)*  
Gordon Allan Davies (42)*  
Pascal Debon (57)  
Nicholas John DeRoma (57)  
William John Donovan (47)  
John Marshall Doolittle (41)*  
John Joseph Giamatteo (37)  
Albert Roger Hitchcock (39)  
Dion Constandino Joannou (39)  
William Robert Kerr (50)  
Richard Stephen Lowe (54)  
Peter David MacKinnon (42)  
Robert Yu Lang Mao (61)  
William F. McCauley** (73)  
Brian William McFadden (51)  
Donald Gregory Mumford (58)  
William Arthur Owens (64)  
MaryAnne Elisabeth Pahapill (43)  
Stephen Charles Pusey (43)  
Ralph Edward Clenton Richardson (43)  
Charles Raymond Saffell, Jr. (58)  
Steven Leo Schilling (48)  
Stephen Francis Slattery (45)  
Karen Elizabeth Sledge (43)*  
Susan Louise Spradley (43)  
Katharine Berghuis Stevenson (42)  
Masood Ahmad Tariq (54)  
Tracey Lynn Vickruck* ** (46)  
President, Global Operations  
Treasurer  
President, Global Alliances  
Assistant Treasurer  
Non-executive board appointed officers  
Appointed on an interim basis  
*
**  
All the above-named executive officers and non-executive board appointed officers of the Company have been employed in their current  
position or other senior positions with Nortel Networks during the past five years, except as follows:  
T.S.J. Connelly McGilley, prior to her appointment as Assistant Secretary effective in December 2004, held the position of Counsel —  
Securities in the Nortel Networks Limited legal department;  
J.M. Doolittle was, prior to returning to Nortel Networks in September 1999, Vice President, Finance of The Bank of Montreal, a  
Canadian chartered bank, from August 1997 and Director, Treasury, Europe and Asia, Nortel Networks, prior thereto;  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
W.R. Kerr, prior to returning to Nortel Networks as Chief Financial Officer in March 2004, held various senior finance positions with  
Nortel Networks from January 1999 (and prior thereto) until his retirement in December 2001. He has also served as a director of Bank  
of China (Canada) since June 1, 1997;  
R.Y.L. Mao was, prior to returning to Nortel Networks in January 2003, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Foxconn (Beijing)  
Precision Component Industries, Ltd., a manufacturer of mobile communication terminal devices, from November 2002 to December  
2002, and Chief Executive Officer, Nortel China, prior thereto;  
W.F. McCauley was a consultant prior to his appointment as Chief Ethics and Compliance Officer of Nortel Networks effective October  
28, 2004. Mr. McCauley was engaged in consulting on various matters in a variety of industries during the period from 1998 until his  
appointment with Nortel Networks, except from September 1999 to June 2001 when he was a director of the Kyle Foundation, a non-  
profit enterprise engaged in causes associated with child cancer care. From August 2004 until his appointment as Chief Ethics and  
Compliance Officer, he acted as an independent consultant to Nortel Networks on matters related to the ethics and compliance function  
of the Company and its subsidiaries. In addition, Mr. McCauley is currently a member of the respective advisory committees of  
Actuarial Consulting Group, a pension planning and execution enterprise, and High-Tech Engineering, a specialty steel and titanium  
manufacturing company, as well as the Ship Systems Advisory Committee of Northrop Grumman Corp., a company engaged in ship  
building, primarily for the U.S. Navy. He is also a director, and member of the investment and audit committees, of Pacific Specialty  
Insurance Group, a property and casualty insurance enterprise, a foundation trustee of the U.S. Naval Academy and a board trustee of  
Scripps Foundation, an organization engaged in the oversight of six hospitals in southern California;  
W.A. Owens was, prior to his appointment as President and Chief Executive Officer in April 2004, Chairman and Chief Executive  
Officer of Teledesic LLC, a satellite communications company, from December 2001 to April 2004, after having served as Vice  
Chairman and Co-Chief Executive Officer from August 1998 to December 2001. Mr. Owens was Vice-Chairman of the Board of  
Directors of Science Applications International Corporation (or SAIC), a research and engineering firm representing the largest  
employee-owned high technology company in the United States, from March 1996 to August 1998, and served as SAIC’s President and  
Chief Operating Officer from December 1996 to August 1998 and Vice-President from March 1996 to December 1996. Prior to joining  
SAIC, Mr. Owens was Vice Chairman of the Joint Chiefs of Staff, and the second-ranking military officer in the United States. As part  
of his role with the Joint Chiefs of Staff, he had responsibility for the reorganization and restructuring of the armed forces in the post-  
Cold War era. Mr. Owens is also a director of DaimlerChrysler AG. Mr. Owens was the Chairman and founder of a private five-state  
wireless telecommunication venture. Mr. Owens has been a director of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited since February 2002;  
R.E.C. Richardson was, prior to his appointment as Chief Marketing Officer effective October 1, 2004, Vice President, Global  
Marketing Enterprise Networks from April 2004 to September 2004. Mr. Richardson was a consultant from April 2003 to March 2004  
and prior thereto was Chief Sales and Marketing Officer, and member of the board of directors, at T-Mobile UK, the UK wireless unit of  
Deutsche Telekom AG, from April 2001 to March 2003. Prior to that, Mr. Richardson was Vice President Worldwide Developer  
Relations and Worldwide Solutions Marketing, Apple Computer, a company engaged in the desktop and notebook computer industry as  
well as the production of operating systems and professional applications, from December 1997 to March 2001;  
C.R. Saffell, Jr. was, prior to his appointment as President, Federal Network Solutions in October, 2004, Senior Vice President for  
National Security Solutions, Titan Corporation, a technology developer and systems integrator that provides a range of systems solutions  
primarily for the Department of Defense, the Department of Homeland Security, intelligence and other U.S. government agencies, from  
December 1988 to March 2004;  
K.E. Sledge, prior to her appointment as Assistant Controller in July 2003, held various finance positions with Nortel Networks; and  
T.L. Vickruck was, prior to returning to Nortel Networks in August 2004, Team Leader, Corporate Treasury, Financial Controls Office  
of Royal Bank of Canada, a Canadian chartered bank, from September 2003 to June 2004. She was Director, Global Treasury Centre,  
Nortel Networks from September 2000 to June 2002 and prior thereto was Director, Treasury Operations, Americas Nortel Networks  
from January 1999 to September 2000.  
Subsequent appointment  
Susan E. Shepard, 61, will succeed Mr. W.F. McCauley in the position of Chief Ethics and Compliance Officer effective February 21, 2005.  
Mr. McCauley will work with Ms. Shepard to transition the position of Chief Ethics and Compliance Officer. Over the course of her career,  
Ms. Shepard has served in a number of positions specifically related to ethics and compliance. Ms. Shepard has been a Commissioner for the  
New York State Ethics Commission since May 2003. In addition, prior to becoming engaged in private practice in 1997, Ms. Shepard was  
Commissioner of Investigation for New York City (1990 to 1994), Chief Counsel to the New York State Commission of Investigation (1986 to  
1990) and an Assistant United States Attorney for the Eastern District of New York (1976 to 1986).  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 16(a) beneficial ownership reporting compliance  
Section 16(a) of the United States Securities Exchange Act of 1934 requires directors and executive officers of the Company to file reports  
concerning their ownership of Company equity securities with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission, the New York Stock  
Exchange, and the Company. Based solely on a review of the information received and written representations from the persons subject to  
Section 16(a), we believe that all of the Company’s directors and executive officers filed their required reports on a timely basis during 2004  
and 2003.  
Audit committee financial expert  
The boards of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited have determined that Mr. J.E. Cleghorn meets the criteria required by  
the United States Securities and Exchange Commission for an “audit committee financial expert” (United States GAAP). Mr. Cleghorn is  
“independent” under the requirements for the “independence” of audit committee members under the New York Stock Exchange (or NYSE)  
corporate governance listing standards.  
Audit committee  
The Company and Nortel Networks Limited have audit committees in accordance with Section 3(a)(58)(A) of the United States Securities  
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. The audit committees have identical memberships. The members of both audit committees are J.E.  
Cleghorn (Chairman), M. Bischoff, R.E. Brown, R.A. Ingram, G. Saucier, and S.H. Smith, Jr.  
Code of ethics and other corporate governance matters  
The Company and Nortel Networks Limited have adopted a code of business conduct and ethics, known as “Living the Values: A Guide to  
Ethical Business Practices at Nortel Networks”, which applies to the chief executive officer, chief financial officer and controller, and other  
persons performing similar functions, as well as to directors and all other employees. Certain waivers under the Guide if granted by the boards  
of directors or any committee thereof to directors of the Company or Nortel Networks Limited or officers will be posted on our website at  
, in accordance with applicable law and the requirements of the stock exchanges on which the Company or Nortel Networks  
www.nortel.com  
Limited securities are listed and of securities regulatory authorities as adopted or amended and in force from time to time.  
The audit committees of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited have each adopted a charter, known as the “Audit Committee  
Mandate”. The committee on directors of the Company acts as the nominating committee and makes corporate governance recommendations  
to the board of directors of the Company. The committee on directors has adopted a charter, known as the “Committee on Directors Mandate”.  
The joint leadership resources committee acts as the compensation committee of Nortel Networks. The joint leadership resources committee  
has adopted a charter, known as the “Joint Leadership Resources Committee Mandate”. The Company and Nortel Networks Limited have  
adopted corporate governance guidelines, known as the “Statement of Governance Guidelines”.  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Guide to Ethical Business Practices, the Audit Committee Mandates, the Committee on Directors Mandate, the Joint Leadership  
Resources Mandate, and the Statement of Governance Guidelines, as well as any future amendments to these documents, are available free of  
charge on our website at  
or by writing to the corporate secretary at Nortel Networks Corporation, 8200 Dixie Road,  
www.nortel.com  
Suite 100, Brampton, Ontario L6T 5P6.  
ITEM 11. Executive Compensation  
The following tables are presented in accordance with the rules of the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.  
Summary compensation table  
The following tables set forth the compensation awarded to, earned by, or paid to each of the Company’s named executive officers for  
services rendered by them to the Company and its subsidiaries in (1) 2004, 2003 and 2002, and (2) 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2004  
Long Term  
Compensation  
Awards  
Securities  
Other Annual Underlying  
Payouts  
Annual Compensation  
Name  
And Principal  
Position  
LTIP  
Payouts  
(#)  
All Other  
Compensation  
($)  
70,298(2)  
Salary  
($)  
681,818  
Bonus  
($)(1)  
Compensation  
Options  
(#)  
Year  
2004  
2003  
2002  
2004  
2003  
($)  
W.A. Owens*  
President and Chief  
Executive Officer  
P. Debon**  
10,445(3)  
590,000  
590,000  
85,577(4)(5)  
92,346(4)(5)  
President, Carrier  
Networks  
743,400(6)  
90,000(7)  
1,475,000(8)(9)  
745,000(10)  
2002  
2004  
2003  
537,143  
530,000  
501,667  
250,000  
125,875(4)(5)(11)  
38,601(12)(13)  
65,430(12)(13)  
B.W. McFadden**  
Chief Technology Officer  
90,000(7)  
745,000(10)  
528,675(6)  
1,291,000(8)(9)  
2002  
2004  
2003  
458,545  
530,000  
496,667  
250,000  
16,503(12)(13)  
6,500(14)  
6,000(14)  
S.L. Spradley**  
President, Global  
Operations  
609,325(6)  
1,285,000(8)(9)  
575,000(10)  
2002  
2004  
2003  
354,275  
526,000  
526,000  
291,999(15)  
5,500(14)  
31,960(12)(13)  
54,494(12)(13)  
N.J. DeRoma  
Chief Legal Officer  
524,685(6)  
135,000(7)  
1,315,000(8)(9)  
535,000(10)  
2002  
2004  
2003  
526,000  
417,043(17)  
868,750  
24,038(13)(16)  
250,000  
17,885(12)(13)  
9,138(12)(13)  
26,145(12)(13)  
F.A. Dunn*  
Former President and  
Chief Executive Officer  
225,000(7)  
745,000(10)(19)  
– (18)  
3,540,000(8)(19)  
2002  
825,000  
750,000(20)  
24,747(12)(13)  
On April 27, 2004, Mr. Dunn’s employment as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited was terminated for cause and  
Mr. Owens was appointed President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited.  
*
**  
(1)  
Prior to the change in positions effective October 1, 2004 in accordance with the corporate reorganization announced by the Company on August 19, 2004, Messrs. Debon  
and McFadden and Ms. Spradley held, respectively, the positions of: President, Wireless Networks; President, Optical Networks; and President, Wireline Networks.  
Incentive cash awards for each fiscal year under the Nortel Networks Limited SUCCESS Incentive Plan (or SUCCESS Plan), including payments made in connection with  
the “Return to Profitability” bonus program component of that plan, in respect of each of the fiscal years, whether or not deferred by the named executive officer. On  
April 27, 2004, the Company and Nortel Networks Limited terminated for cause the employment of each of its then president and chief executive officer, chief financial  
officer and controller. On August 19, 2004, the Company announced that seven individuals with, or who had, significant responsibilities for financial reporting at the line  
of business and regional levels were terminated for cause. Nortel Networks has demanded from these individuals repayment of any payments made under bonus plans in  
respect of 2003, including any awards under the SUCCESS Plan. See footnotes (8) and (19) below.  
(2)  
Represents contributions under the Nortel Networks Long-Term Investment Plan ($1,038), expatriate expenses related to Mr. Owens’ responsibilities as President and  
Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited ($43,588) and fees earned as a non-employee director prior to being appointed as President and  
Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited ($25,672). See “Compensation of directors”.  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(3)  
(4)  
Represents a tax reimbursement payment in connection with certain permanent transfer expenses.  
Certain payments paid in euros have been converted to United States dollars and included in this amount. Payments have been converted using the average of the exchange  
rates in effect during each year equal to US$1.00 = .8027 euros for 2004, US$1.00 = .8830 euros for 2003 and US$1.00 = 1.0615 euros for 2002.  
(5)  
Represents contributions under the Nortel Networks Long-Term Investment Plan or Nortel Networks (UK) Pension Plan, as applicable ($3,268 in 2004, $7,200 in 2003  
and $8,467 in 2002), and expatriate, permanent transfer and other similar expenses related to Mr. Debon’s global responsibilities as President, Wireless Networks ($82,309  
in 2004, $85,146 in 2003 and $117,408 in 2002).  
(6)  
(7)  
Represents a SUCCESS Plan annual incentive award. Nortel Networks has demanded that the individuals described in footnote (1) whose employment was terminated for  
cause repay any payments made under bonus plans in respect of 2003, including SUCCESS Plan annual incentive awards.  
Represents the number of restricted stock units issued and settled in respect of restricted stock units allocated under the 2001 program of the Nortel Networks Limited  
Restricted Stock Unit Plan (or RSU Plan). Restricted stock units allocated in 2001 had a two year performance period that was divided into five shorter performance  
segments. The performance criteria included resizing activity targets for the first segment, and corporate performance objectives under the incentive plan for the remaining  
four segments. Although the joint leadership resources committee determined that certain of the distinct performance objectives were not achieved, it exercised its  
discretion in May 2003 to authorize the issuance and settlement in the form of common shares of the Company (net of withholding taxes) of 90 percent of the restricted  
stock units allocated under the 2001 program based on its consideration of the improved financial performance of the Company during the two-year performance period  
and the Company’s overall performance over that period as compared to its key competitors. The total before tax value of the restricted stock units that were issued and  
settled, using the purchase price of our common shares on the date of purchase, was: Cdn$945,293 ($672,902) for Mr. Dunn; $274,050 for Mr. Debon; Cdn$378,117  
($269,161) for Mr. McFadden, and Cdn$567,176 ($403,741) for Mr. DeRoma. Amounts have been converted using the exchange rates listed in footnote (13) below.  
(8)  
(9)  
Represents a Return to Profitability program award under the SUCCESS Plan. Nortel Networks has demanded that the individuals described in footnote (1) whose  
employment was terminated for cause repay any payments made under bonus plans in respect of 2003, including any Return to Profitability program awards. See footnotes  
(1), (9) and (19).  
Mr. Debon, Mr. McFadden, Ms. Spradley and Mr. DeRoma have voluntarily undertaken to pay to the Company over a three year period an amount equal to their Return to  
Profitability program bonus awarded in 2003 (net of any taxes deducted at the source). The following additional current members of senior management have similarly  
voluntarily agreed to pay their respective Return to Profitability program bonus awards: Messrs. Bolouri, Collins, Donovan, Giamatteo, Joannou, Mao, Mumford and  
Pusey. See “Voluntary undertaking: Return to Profitability bonus program and 2003 restricted stock unit program”.  
(10)  
Represents the number of restricted stock units issued and settled in respect of restricted stock units allocated under the 2003 program of the RSU Plan. Each unit entitled  
the holder to receive one common share of the Company or, subject to certain conditions, a cash payment equal to the common share value. In respect of payments made  
under the 2003 program of the RSU Plan, each named executive officer, other than Mr. Dunn, received in July 2003 restricted stock units in connection with the  
achievement of the first performance threshold as at the end of the second fiscal quarter of 2003 (100% in the form of common shares) and in February 2004 restricted  
stock units in connection with the achievement of the second performance threshold as at the end of the third fiscal quarter of 2003 (50% in the form of common shares  
and 50% in the form of cash). These individuals continue to hold the common shares received as a result of the settlement of their restricted stock units. Mr. Dunn received  
in July 2003 restricted stock units in connection with the achievement of the first performance threshold (100% in the form of common shares) but did not receive  
restricted stock units in connection with the achievement of the second performance threshold. The before tax total value of restricted stock units issued and settled was:  
Cdn$2,983,204 ($2,123,579) for Mr. Dunn; $3,783,743 for Mr. Debon; $2,920,339 for Ms Spradley; Cdn$5,085,873 ($3,620,354) for Mr. McFadden; and Cdn$3,652,271  
($2,599,851) for Mr. DeRoma. Restricted stock units are valued using the purchase price of the common shares on the date of purchase (for share settlement) and on the  
average price for the specified 20 day trading period for cash settlement (where applicable). Amounts have been converted using the exchange rates listed in footnote (13)  
below. See “Long-term incentive plans — awards in last two fiscal years — 2003” for a description of the applicable performance criteria. See footnote (19) below.  
(11)  
Certain payments paid in United Kingdom pounds have been converted to United States dollars and included in this amount. Payments have been converted using the  
average of the exchange rates in effect equal to US$1.00 = UK£0.6661 for 2002.  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(12)  
(13)  
Represents contributions made under the Nortel Networks Limited Investment Plan for Employees — Canada.  
Represents the United States dollar equivalent of payments actually earned or paid in Canadian dollars. Amounts have been converted using the average of the exchange  
rates in effect during each year equal to US$1.00 = CDN$1.2978 for 2004, US$1.00 = Cdn$1.4048 for 2003 and US$1.00 = Cdn$1.5708 for 2002.  
(14)  
(15)  
Represents contributions under the Nortel Networks Long-Term Investment Plan.  
In June 2001, the Company commenced a voluntary stock option exchange program whereby eligible employees could exchange certain then outstanding stock options for  
new options based on a prescribed formula. In January 2002, new stock options were granted to eligible employees who participated in the stock option exchange  
program, with exercise prices at the fair market value of the Company’s common shares on the date of grant. Prior to Ms. Spradley’s appointment as an officer of the  
Company, she was an employee eligible to participate in the voluntary stock option exchange program. As a result, 41,999 of the stock options granted to Ms. Spradley in  
2002 were granted pursuant to the voluntary stock option exchange program.  
(16)  
(17)  
Amounts paid to reimburse Mr. DeRoma for income taxes payable by him in accordance with his employment agreement. Mr. DeRoma’s employment agreement is  
described below under “Certain employment arrangements”.  
Includes Cdn$151,898 base salary for accrued vacation paid as required in accordance with corporate policy and applicable law as a result of the termination of  
employment for cause.  
(18)  
(19)  
Mr. Dunn did not receive any annual incentive bonus under the SUCCESS Plan with respect to 2003. See footnotes (1), (8) and (19).  
As a result of the termination of Mr. Dunn’s employment for cause on April 27, 2004, the Company and Nortel Networks Limited have demanded repayment of the  
Return to Profitability program bonus award under the SUCCESS Plan of $3,540,000 and the 745,000 restricted stock units issued and settled in respect of restricted stock  
units allocated under the 2003 program of the RSU Plan. See footnotes (8) and (10).  
(20)  
These options terminated and expired automatically upon the termination of Mr. Dunn’s employment for cause on April 27, 2004.  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2003  
Long Term  
Compensation  
Annual Compensation  
Other Annual  
Awards  
Payouts  
Securities  
Underlying  
Options  
(#)  
Name  
And Principal  
Position  
LTIP  
Payouts  
(#)  
All Other  
Compensation  
($)  
Salary  
($)  
Bonus  
($)(1)  
Compensation  
($)  
Year  
F.A. Dunn*  
2003  
868,750  
– (2)  
225,000(3)  
26,145(4)(5)  
President and Chief  
Executive Officer  
3,540,000(6)(7)  
745,000(7)(8)  
2002  
2001  
2003  
825,000  
564,833  
590,000  
750,000(9)  
1,500,000(9)(10)  
24,747(4)(5)  
16,806(4)(5)  
P. Debon**  
743,400(11)  
90,000(3)  
745,000(8)  
92,346(12)(13)  
President, Wireless  
Networks  
1,475,000(6)(14)  
2002  
2001  
2003  
537,143  
440,417  
496,667  
250,000  
650,000  
125,875(12)(13)(15)  
332,020(13)(15)  
6,000(17)  
68,713(15)(16)  
S.L. Spradley**  
President, Wireline  
Networks  
609,325(11)  
575,000(8)  
1,285,000(6)(14)  
2002  
2001  
2003  
354,275  
269,026  
510,000  
291,999(18)  
5,500(17)  
5,100(17)  
– (19)  
C. Bolouri**  
President, Global  
Operations  
589,050(11)  
135,000(3)  
63,404(4)(5)  
1,275,000(6)(14)  
535,000(8)  
2002  
2001  
2003  
510,000  
459,000  
526,000  
250,000  
700,000  
18,358(4)(5)  
27,440(4)(5)  
54,494(4)(5)  
N.J. DeRoma  
524,685(11)  
135,000(3)  
Chief Legal Officer  
1,315,000(6)(14)  
535,000(8)  
2002  
2001  
526,000  
493,750  
24,038(5)(20)  
62,921(5)(20)  
250,000  
650,000  
17,885(4)(5)  
27,642(4)(5)  
*
On April 27, 2004, Mr. Dunn’s employment as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited was terminated for cause and  
Mr. W.A. Owens was appointed President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited. The compensation for his successor Mr. W.A.  
Owens, President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited, is described below under “Certain employment arrangements”.  
In accordance with the corporate reorganization announced by the Company on August 19, 2004, effective October 1, 2004, Messrs. Debon and Bolouri and Ms. Spradley  
were, respectively, appointed to the positions of: President, Carrier Networks; President, Global Services; and President, Global Operations.  
**  
(1)  
Incentive cash awards for each fiscal year under the Nortel Networks Limited SUCCESS Incentive Plan (or SUCCESS Plan), including payments made in connection with  
the “Return to Profitability” bonus program component of that plan, in respect of each of the fiscal years, whether or not deferred by the named executive officer. On  
April 27, 2004, the Company and Nortel Networks Limited terminated for cause the employment of each of their then president and chief executive officer, chief financial  
officer and controller. On August 19, 2004, the Company announced that seven individuals with, or who had, significant responsibilities for financial reporting at the line  
of business and regional levels were terminated for cause. Nortel Networks has demanded from these individuals repayment of any payments made under bonus plans in  
respect of 2003, including any awards under the SUCCESS Plan. See footnotes (6) and (7) below.  
(2)  
(3)  
Mr. Dunn did not receive any annual incentive bonus under the SUCCESS Plan with respect to 2003. See footnotes (1), (6) and (7).  
Represents the number of restricted stock units issued and settled in respect of restricted stock units allocated under the 2001 program of the Nortel Networks Limited  
Restricted Stock Unit Plan (or RSU Plan). Restricted stock units allocated in 2001 had a two year performance period that was divided into five shorter performance  
segments. The performance criteria included resizing activity targets for the first segment, and corporate performance objectives  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
under the incentive plan for the remaining four segments. Although the joint leadership resources committee determined that certain of the distinct performance objectives  
were not achieved, it exercised its discretion in May 2003 to authorize the issuance and settlement in the form of common shares of the Company (net of withholding  
taxes) of 90 percent of the restricted stock units allocated under the 2001 program based on its consideration of the improved financial performance of the Company  
during the two-year performance period and the Company’s overall performance over that period as compared to its key competitors. The total before tax value of the  
restricted stock units that were issued and settled, using the purchase price of our common shares on the date of purchase, was: Cdn$945,293 ($672,902) for Mr. Dunn;  
$274,050 for Mr. Debon; Cdn$567,176 ($403,741) for Mr. Bolouri; and Cdn$567,176 ($403,741) for Mr. DeRoma. Amounts have been converted using the exchange  
rates listed in footnote (5) below.  
(4)  
(5)  
Represents contributions made under the Nortel Networks Limited Investment Plan for Employees — Canada.  
Represents the United States dollar equivalent of payments actually earned or paid in Canadian dollars. Amounts have been converted using the average of the exchange  
rates in effect during each year equal to US$1.00 = Cdn$1.4048 for 2003, US$1.00 = Cdn$1.5708 for 2002 and US$1.00 = Cdn$1.5489 for 2001.  
(6)  
(7)  
(8)  
Represents a Return to Profitability program award under the SUCCESS Plan. Nortel Networks has demanded that the individuals described in footnote (1) whose  
employment was terminated for cause repay any payments made under bonus plans in respect of 2003, including any Return to Profitability program awards. See footnotes  
(1), (7) and (14).  
As a result of the termination of Mr. Dunn’s employment for cause on April 27, 2004, the Company and Nortel Networks Limited have demanded repayment of the  
Return to Profitability program bonus award under the SUCCESS Plan of $3,540,000 and the 745,000 restricted stock units issued and settled in respect of restricted stock  
units allocated under the 2003 program of the RSU Plan. See footnotes (6) and (8).  
Represents the number of restricted stock units issued and settled in respect of restricted stock units allocated under the 2003 program of the RSU Plan. Each unit entitled  
the holder to receive one common share of the Company or, subject to certain conditions, a cash payment equal to the common share value. In respect of payments made  
under the 2003 program of the RSU Plan, each named executive officer, other than Mr. Dunn, received in July 2003 restricted stock units in connection with the  
achievement of the first performance threshold as at the end of the second fiscal quarter of 2003 (100% in the form of common shares) and in February 2004 restricted  
stock units in connection with the achievement of the second performance threshold as at the end of the third fiscal quarter of 2003 (50% in the form of common shares  
and 50% in the form of cash). These individuals continue to hold the common shares received as a result of the settlement of their restricted stock units. Mr. Dunn received  
in July 2003 restricted stock units in connection with the achievement of the first performance threshold (100% in the form of common shares) but did not receive  
restricted stock units in connection with the achievement of the second performance threshold. The before tax total value of restricted stock units issued and settled was:  
Cdn$2,983,204 ($2,123,579) for Mr. Dunn; $3,783,743 for Mr. Debon; $2,920,339 for Ms Spradley; Cdn$3,652,271 ($2,599,851) for Mr. Bolouri; and Cdn$3,652,271  
($2,599,851) for Mr. DeRoma. Restricted stock units are valued using the purchase price of the common shares on the date of purchase (for share settlement) and on the  
average price for the specified 20 day trading period for cash settlement (where applicable). Amounts have been converted using the exchange rates listed in footnote (5)  
above. See “Long-term incentive plans — awards in last two fiscal years — 2003” for a description of the applicable performance criteria. See footnote (7) above.  
(9)  
These options terminated and expired automatically upon the termination of Mr. Dunn’s employment for cause on April 27, 2004.  
(10)  
This amount has been reduced from the previously reported amount to reflect Mr. Dunn’s voluntary return for immediate cancellation in June 2003 of 250,000 stock  
options that were originally granted in 2001.  
(11)  
(12)  
Represents a SUCCESS Plan annual incentive award. Nortel Networks has demanded that the individuals described in footnote (1) whose employment was terminated for  
cause repay any payments made under bonus plans in respect of 2003, including any SUCCESS Plan annual incentive awards.  
Certain payments paid in euros have been converted and included in this amount. Payments have been converted using the average of the exchange rates in effect during  
each year equal to US$1.00 = .8830 euros for 2003 and US$1.00 = 1.0615 euros for 2002.  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(13)  
(14)  
Represents contributions under the Nortel Networks Long-Term Investment Plan or Nortel Networks (UK) Pension Plan, as applicable ($7,200 in 2003, $8,467 in 2002  
and $6,068 in 2001), and expatriate, permanent transfer and other similar expenses related to Mr. Debon’s global responsibilities as President, Wireless Networks ($85,146  
in 2003, $117,408 in 2002 and $325,952 in 2001).  
Mr. Debon, Mr. Bolouri, Ms. Spradley and Mr. DeRoma have voluntarily undertaken to pay to the Company over a three year period an amount equal to their Return to  
Profitability program bonus awarded in 2003 (net of any taxes deducted at the source). The following additional current members of senior management have similarly  
voluntarily agreed to pay their respective Return to Profitability program bonus awards: Messrs. Collins, Donovan, Giamatteo, Joannou, Mao, McFadden, Mumford and  
Pusey. See “Voluntary undertaking: Return to Profitability bonus program and 2003 restricted stock unit program”.  
(15)  
(16)  
Certain payments paid in United Kingdom pounds have been converted and included in this amount. Payments have been converted using the average of the exchange  
rates in effect during each year equal to US$1.00 = UK£0.6661 for 2002 and US$1.00 = UK£0.6909 for 2001.  
Mr. Debon’s responsibilities during 2001 as President, Wireless Networks were global in nature and his offices and personal residences spanned several geographies. As a  
result, transportation services and benefits (automobile benefits, commercial air travel, train and car services) for Mr. Debon totaled $48,010 in 2001.  
(17)  
(18)  
Represents contributions under the Nortel Networks Long-Term Investment Plan.  
In June 2001, the Company commenced a voluntary stock option exchange program whereby eligible employees could exchange certain then outstanding stock options for  
new options based on a prescribed formula. In January 2002, new stock options were granted to eligible employees who participated in the stock option exchange  
program, with exercise prices at the fair market value of the Company’s common shares on the date of grant. Prior to Ms. Spradley’s appointment as an officer of the  
Company, she was an employee eligible to participate in the voluntary stock option exchange program. As a result, 41,999 of the stock options granted to Ms. Spradley in  
2002 were granted pursuant to the voluntary stock option exchange program.  
(19)  
(20)  
All of Ms. Spradley’s options that were granted in 2001 were cancelled in connection with her participation in the voluntary stock option exchange program. See footnote  
(18) above.  
Amounts paid to reimburse Mr. DeRoma for income taxes payable by him in accordance with his employment agreement. Mr. DeRoma’s employment agreement is  
described below under “Certain employment arrangements”.  
Annual cash incentive awards  
Annual cash bonus awards under the SUCCESS Plan are based on achieving corporate and individual performance objectives for a calendar  
year. The joint leadership resources committee retains full discretion in determining whether, and the extent to which, corporate performance  
objectives have been met and whether, and to what extent, an annual award under the SUCCESS Plan will be made. An annual award is  
determined as a percentage of annual base salary by reference to individual job scope, complexity and responsibilities, and by individual  
performance and contribution, as well as corporate performance.  
The joint leadership resources committee recommended the corporate performance objectives for 2004, which were approved by the boards  
of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited in January 2004. The corporate performance objectives for 2004 were revenue,  
earnings, cash flow and leadership (which included customer engagement, technology leadership and market perception). The joint leadership  
resources committee also have discretion to consider other business factors in making a final determination of corporate performance for 2004.  
In June 2004, management recommended, and the joint leadership resources committee and the boards of directors of the Company and Nortel  
Networks Limited subsequently approved, that financial accountability be included as a key quantitative factor in the individual leadership  
performance objectives for determination of incentive cash awards under the SUCCESS Plan. The financial accountability objective includes,  
among other things: (i) compliance with financial reporting obligations under United States and Canadian securities laws and the requirements  
of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002; (ii) an assessment of training with respect to financial reporting responsibilities and understanding of  
general accepted accounting principles across Nortel Networks; and (iii) progress on the implementation of process and system improvements  
related to accounting and management information systems across Nortel Networks. As of the date of this report, no annual cash bonus awards  
have been made with respect to the fiscal year ended December 31, 2004.  
Voluntary undertaking: Return to Profitability bonus program and 2003 restricted stock  
unit program  
In a letter, dated January 10, 2005 to Mr. Lynton (Red) Wilson, the Chairman of the board of directors of the Company, the members of the  
core executive leadership team of Nortel Networks (each, a “Member”) affirmed their voluntary, unilateral and unconditional undertaking to (i)  
pay to the Company over a three year period an amount equal to the entire Return to Profitability (“RTP”) bonus paid to each such Member in  
2003 (net of any taxes deducted at the source) regardless of whether the profitability metrics associated with the RTP were met on a restated  
basis and (ii) not accept, and accordingly disclaim, any potential award of either the third of fourth tranches of 2003 restricted stock units  
(regardless whether applicable financial targets for these bonuses were achieved). The Members indicated in their letter that, while they did not  
engage in the improper accounting activities identified by the Independent Review, they share the board of directors’ deep disappointment in  
these actions and events and are determined to make clear to Nortel Networks employees, investors and others that such activities are  
unacceptable to them.  
The following table sets forth the amount of the RTP bonus (the “RTP Amount”) to be paid by each Member:  
Member  
RTP Amount (Net)  
Chahram Bolouri  
Malcolm Kevin Collins  
Pascal Debon  
Cdn. $891,697  
GBP £395,409  
U.S. $1,078,963  
Cdn. $953,747  
U.S. $640,271  
U.S. $259,875  
U.S. $328,412  
U.S. $627,500  
Cdn. $899,630  
Cdn. $921,500  
GBP £473,173  
U.S. $967,694  
Nicholas John DeRoma  
William John Donovan  
John Joseph Giamatteo  
Dion Constandino Joannou  
Robert Yu Lang Mao  
Brian William McFadden  
Donald Gregory Mumford  
Stephen Charles Pusey  
Susan Louise Spradley  
Option grants in 2004 and 2003  
No options were granted to any of the named executive officers for 2004 during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2004 and no options  
were granted to any of the named executive officers for 2003 during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Aggregate option exercises in 2004 and 2003 and year-end option values  
No options were exercised by any named executive officers for 2004 during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2004 and no options were  
exercised by any named executive officers for 2003 during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003. The following tables set forth: (i) the  
value of unexercised options held by named executive officers for 2004 as at December 31, 2004; and (ii) the value of unexercised options held  
by named executive officers for 2003 as at December 31, 2003, respectively.  
2004  
Number of Securities  
Underlying  
Value of Unexercised  
In-the-Money  
Options at Fiscal Year-End ($)(4)  
Common  
Shares Acquired  
On Exercise  
(#)  
Unexercised Options at Fiscal  
Year-End (#)(1)(2)(3)(4)  
Value  
Realized ($)  
Name  
Exercisable  
Unexercisable  
Exercisable  
Unexercisable  
W.A. Owens  
P. Debon  
1,358,666(5)  
1,133666(Cdn)  
238,665(6)  
243,334  
B.W. McFadden  
S.L. Spradley  
N.J. DeRoma  
163,334(Cdn)  
83,334  
1,290,000(Cdn)(5)  
80,000  
243,334(Cdn)  
F.A. Dunn*  
– (7)  
– (Cdn)(7)  
– (7)  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
*
On April 27, 2004, Mr. Dunn’s employment as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited was terminated for cause.  
(1)  
As adjusted to reflect the two-for-one stock split of Nortel Networks Limited’s common shares effective at the close of business on January 7, 1998, the stock dividend of  
one common share on each issued and outstanding common share of Nortel Networks Limited effective at the close of business on August 17, 1999, and the two-for-one  
stock split of the Company’s common shares effective at the close of business on May 5, 2000, where applicable.  
(2)  
Includes the following number of “replacement options”: 160,000 for Mr. Debon; 80,000 for Mr. McFadden (which will expire in January 2009 and which are unavailable  
for exercise pursuant to the terms of the replacement option program); and 160,000 for Mr. DeRoma. Mr. Dunn had also received 120,000 replacement options, which he  
subsequently voluntarily returned for immediate cancellation in June 2003. See also footnote (6) below. Replacement options are granted pursuant to the key contributor  
stock option program. Under that program, a participant is granted concurrently an equal number of initial options and replacement options. The initial options and the  
replacement options expire ten years from the date of grant. The initial options have an exercise price equal to the market value of common shares on the date of grant and  
the replacement options have an exercise price equal to the market value of common shares on the date all of the initial options are fully exercised, provided that in no  
event will the exercise price be less than the exercise price of the initial options. Replacement options are generally exercisable commencing 36 months after the date all of  
the initial options are fully exercised, provided that the participant beneficially owns a number of common shares at least equal to the number of common shares subject to  
the initial options less any common shares sold to pay for options costs, applicable taxes, and brokerage costs associated with the exercise of the initial options.  
(3)  
(4)  
As the Company grants both United States dollar and Canadian dollar stock options, the options are listed separately for each currency, where applicable. Unless otherwise  
stated, all options are United States dollar options.  
As at December 31, 2004, none of the outstanding exercisable or unexercisable United States dollar or Canadian dollar stock options held by the named executive officers  
had an exercise price that exceeded the closing price of the Company’s common shares on the last trading day of the year on, respectively, the New York Stock Exchange  
for United States stock options and on the Toronto Stock Exchange for Canadian stock options. On December 31, 2004, the closing price of the Company’s common shares  
on the New York Stock Exchange and the Toronto Stock Exchange was $3.47 and Cdn$4.16, respectively. The weighted average exercise price of the outstanding  
exercisable and unexercisable United States dollar and Canadian dollar stock options as at December 31, 2004 was: $14.51 for options held by Mr. Debon; $6.30 for  
options held by Ms. Spradley; Cdn$24.32 for options held by Mr. McFadden; and Cdn$25.18 for Mr. DeRoma’s Canadian dollar stock options and $11.29 for his United  
States dollar stock options. Where applicable, weighted average price has been calculated assuming that replacement options that currently do not have set exercise prices  
will have exercise prices equal to the exercise prices of the corresponding initial options. See footnote (2) above.  
(5)  
(6)  
The remaining two thirds of the performance accelerated stock options previously granted to Messrs. Debon, McFadden and DeRoma vested and became exercisable in  
January 2004, the other one third having vested and became exercisable in December 2003.  
Prior to Ms. Spradley’s appointment as an officer of the Company, she was an employee eligible to participate in the voluntary stock option exchange program. As a result,  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
41,999 of the stock options granted to Ms. Spradley in 2002 were granted pursuant to the voluntary stock option exchange program. All of those options were  
exercisable as of December 31, 2004.  
(7)  
As a result of the termination of Mr. Dunn’s employment for cause on April 27, 2004, all United States dollar and Canadian dollar options held by Mr. Dunn terminated  
and expired automatically on April 27, 2004, including all performance accelerated stock options.  
2003  
Number of Securities  
Underlying  
Unexercised Options at Fiscal  
Year-End (#)(1)(2)(3)(4)  
Value of Unexercised  
In-the-Money  
Options at Fiscal Year-End ($)(4)  
Common  
Shares Acquired  
On Exercise  
(#)  
Value  
Realized ($)  
Name  
Exercisable  
Unexercisable  
Exercisable  
Unexercisable  
F.A. Dunn  
750,000(Cdn) (5)(6)  
1,500,000(Cdn)(5)  
–(7)  
P. Debon  
891,999 (6)  
148,665 (8)  
710,001  
S.L. Spradley  
C. Bolouri  
173,334(8)  
931,332(Cdn) (6)  
686,668(Cdn)  
870,001(Cdn)  
N.J. DeRoma  
663,333(Cdn) (6)  
80,000  
(1)  
(2)  
As adjusted to reflect the two-for-one stock split of Nortel Networks Limited’s common shares effective at the close of business on January 7, 1998, the stock dividend of  
one common share on each issued and outstanding common share of Nortel Networks Limited effective at the close of business on August 17, 1999, and the two-for-one  
stock split of the Company’s common shares effective at the close of business on May 5, 2000, where applicable.  
Includes the following number of previously granted “replacement options”: 160,000 for Mr. Debon; 120,000 for Mr. Bolouri; and 160,000 for Mr. DeRoma. Mr. Dunn  
had also been granted 120,000 replacement options, which he subsequently voluntarily returned for immediate cancellation in June 2003. See also footnotes (5) and  
(7) below. Replacement options are granted pursuant to the Company’s key contributor stock option program. Under that program, a participant is granted concurrently an  
equal number of initial options and replacement options. The initial options and the replacement options expire ten years from the date of grant. The initial options have an  
exercise price equal to the market value of common shares of the Company on the date of grant and the replacement options have an exercise price equal to the market  
value of common shares on the date all of the initial options are fully exercised, provided that in no event will the exercise price be less than the exercise price of the initial  
options. Replacement options are generally exercisable commencing 36 months after the date all of the initial options are fully exercised, provided that the participant  
beneficially owns a number of common shares at least equal to the number of common shares subject to the initial options less any common shares sold to pay for options  
costs, applicable taxes, and brokerage costs associated with the exercise of the initial options.  
(3)  
(4)  
As the Company grants both United States dollar and Canadian dollar stock options, the options are listed separately for each currency, where applicable. Unless otherwise  
stated, all options are United States dollar options.  
As at December 31, 2003, all of the outstanding exercisable or unexercisable United States dollar or Canadian dollar stock options held by the named executive officers  
had an exercise price that exceeded the closing price of the Company’s common shares on the last trading day of the year on, respectively, the New York Stock Exchange  
for United States stock options and on the Toronto Stock Exchange for Canadian stock options. On December 31, 2003, the closing price of the Company’s common shares  
on the New York Stock Exchange and the Toronto Stock Exchange was $4.23 and Cdn$5.49, respectively. The weighted average exercise price of the outstanding  
exercisable and unexercisable United States dollar and Canadian dollar stock options as at December 31, 2003 was: Cdn$8.95 for options held by Mr. Dunn; $14.51 for  
options held by Mr. Debon; $6.30 for options held by Ms. Spradley; Cdn$37.06 for options held by Mr. Bolouri; and Cdn$25.18 for Mr. DeRoma’s Canadian dollar stock  
options and $11.29 for his United States dollar stock options. Where applicable, weighted average price has been calculated assuming that replacement options that  
currently do not have set exercise prices will have exercise prices equal to the exercise prices of the corresponding initial options. See footnote (2) above.  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(5)  
(6)  
As a result of the termination of Mr. Dunn’s employment for cause on April 27, 2004, all options held by Mr. Dunn terminated and expired automatically on April 27,  
2004, including all performance accelerated stock options. Previously, in June 2003, Mr. Dunn voluntarily returned for immediate cancellation 934,668 previously granted  
Canadian dollar stock options, comprised of 851,334 exercisable plus 83,334 unexercisable options as well as 120,000 exercisable replacement options referenced in  
footnote (2) above. See also footnote (7) below.  
One third of the performance accelerated stock options previously granted to Messrs. Dunn, Debon, Bolouri and DeRoma in 2001 vested and became exercisable in  
December 2003. Other than Mr. Dunn, who did not have any additional performance accelerated stock options accelerated, the remaining two thirds of the performance  
accelerated stock options held by Messrs. Debon, Bolouri and DeRoma vested and became exercisable in January 2004.  
(7)  
(8)  
In June 2003, Mr. Dunn voluntarily turned in for immediate cancellation 200,000 unexercisable United States dollar stock options originally granted in July 1999.  
Prior to Ms. Spradley’s appointment as an officer of the Company, she was an employee eligible to participate in the voluntary stock option exchange program. As a result,  
41,999 of the stock options granted to Ms. Spradley in 2002 were granted pursuant to the voluntary stock option exchange program. Of those options, 35,332 were  
exercisable as of December 31, 2003.  
Long-term incentive plans — awards in last two fiscal years  
No long-term incentives were granted under any long-term incentive plan to any of the named executive officers for 2004 during the fiscal  
year ended December 31, 2004.  
The following table sets forth certain information concerning the allocation of restricted stock units to the named executive officers for 2003  
under the Nortel Networks Limited Restricted Stock Unit Plan (or RSU Plan) during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003.  
Estimated Future Payouts Under Non-Share  
Performance or Other  
Price Based Plans  
Number of Shares,  
Units or Other Rights  
(#)(1)(2)  
Period Until  
Maturation or Payout  
(2)  
Name  
Threshold(#)  
Target(#)  
Maximum(#)  
(2)  
F.A. Dunn  
P. Debon  
2,980,000(3)  
1,490,000  
1,150,000  
1,070,000  
1,070,000  
2003 to 2005  
2003 to 2005  
2003 to 2005  
2003 to 2005  
2003 to 2005  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
2,980,000(3)  
1,490,000  
1,150,000  
1,070,000  
1,070,000  
S.L. Spradley  
C. Bolouri  
N.J. DeRoma  
(1)  
(2)  
When issued and settled, a restricted stock unit entitles the holder to receive one common share of the Company or, in the discretion of the joint leadership resources  
committee or at the election of the holder in certain circumstances, cash in lieu thereof.  
The 2003 program has a three-year performance period ending December 31, 2005. The three-year performance period includes four performance thresholds that may be  
achieved at any time during the performance period. The performance criteria for each of the four thresholds are distinct “Return on Sales before Tax” (or ROSBT)  
percentage targets, calculated on a rolling four-quarter basis. The joint leadership resources committee assesses the Company’s performance on a quarterly basis against  
each of these thresholds and further considers the Company’s performance as compared to its competitors and certain business, financial, competitive, political and other  
relevant criteria in determining, in the committee’s discretion, whether any or a portion of the allocated restricted stock units will be issued and settled to participants. In  
respect of 2003, the committee exercised its discretion to authorize the issuance of restricted stock units to the named executive officers based, among other things, on the  
achievement of two performance thresholds. On January 10, 2005, the joint leadership resources committee exercised the discretion reserved to it with respect to the 2003  
program of the RSU Plan and determined, and the boards of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited confirmed and approved, that no additional restricted  
stock units will be issued with respect to the 2003 program (including in connection with the achievement of the third and fourth ROSBT performance targets or otherwise)  
and that all unissued restricted stock units under the 2003 program are immediately terminated and cancelled in their entirety. Information regarding restricted stock units  
issued and settled under the 2003 program of the RSU Plan is disclosed in the “Summary Compensation Table — 2003” above under “Long Term Compensation —  
Payouts”. On April 27, 2004, the Company and Nortel Networks Limited terminated for cause the employment of each of their then chief financial officer and controller.  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Company and Nortel Networks Limited have demanded repayment from the chief financial officer and controller of the restricted stock units issued and settled in  
July 2003 with respect to the achievement of the first performance threshold and, with respect to the controller, the restricted stock units issued and settled in January 2004  
with respect to the achievement of the second performance threshold. All restricted stock units allocated to the chief financial officer and the controller that were not issued  
have been forfeited. See footnote (3) regarding restricted stock units allocated to the president and chief executive officer.  
(3)  
As a result of the termination of Mr. Dunn’s employment for cause on April 27, 2004, Mr. Dunn’s allocated but unissued restricted stock units were automatically  
forfeited. With respect to the restricted stock units issued to him and settled in July 2003 with respect to the achievement of the first performance threshold, the Company  
and Nortel Networks Limited have demanded repayment as noted in the “Summary Compensation Table” above.  
Retirement plans  
The Company has several pension plans. The following descriptions relate to pension plans to which the named executive officers for 2004  
and the named executive officers for 2003 are eligible to participate.  
The non-contributory defined benefit pension plans (or base plans) in Canada and in the United States are generally available to employees  
and executives who were participants prior to May 1, 2000. There is also the Nortel Networks Supplementary Executive Retirement Plan  
which is available to eligible executives. The benefit calculated under the Supplementary Executive Retirement Plan is reduced by the pension  
benefits payable under the registered/qualified defined benefit pension plans and the non-qualified/excess plans. Effective January 1, 2000, the  
Supplementary Executive Retirement Plan was closed to new participants.  
Defined Benefit Pension Plan — Canada  
A defined benefit pension plan, the Nortel Networks Limited Managerial and Non-Negotiated Pension Plan, is maintained for eligible  
employees and executives in Canada. This plan has two different formulas, called Part I and Part II.  
The Part I formula provides a monthly benefit at retirement based on years of service and a pension accrual of 1.3 percent of the average  
annual earnings of the best three consecutive years. An early retirement reduction applies for retirement prior to age 60. Eligible earnings  
include base salary and, where applicable, overtime, off-shift differentials and an individual sales commission factor. Effective January 1,  
1999, the Part I defined benefit formula was closed to new participants.  
The Part II formula was introduced January 1, 1999. Employees who were participants in Part I could continue to participate in Part I, or  
move to the new Part II formula, at their election. Part II provides a benefit based on pension credits and the average annual earnings for the  
highest three consecutive years in the last ten years prior to retirement or other termination of employment. Pension credits are earned during  
each year of participation based on the participant’s age attained in the year and on years of service. Eligible earnings include base salary and,  
where applicable, incentive awards or bonuses, if any, paid under the Nortel Networks Limited SUCCESS Incentive Plan (or SUCCESS Plan),  
overtime, off-shift differentials and sales commissions. Effective May 1, 2000, the Part II defined benefit formula was closed to new  
participants.  
The Part II benefit can be paid in a lump sum or as an actuarially equivalent annuity. Under the annual income option, there are reductions  
for retirement prior to normal retirement age of 65. Certain grandfathering rules exist for employees and executives who were participating in  
the pension plan as at December 31, 1998.  
The Income Tax Act (Canada) (or ITA) limits the amount of pension that may be paid under a registered pension plan. Pension benefits  
within the ITA limit are funded by a pension trust that is separate from the general assets of Nortel Networks Limited. Pension benefits that  
exceed the ITA limits are paid from an excess plan, and are funded from Nortel Networks Limited’s general assets and the general assets of  
Nortel Networks Technology Corporation (or NNTC), an affiliate of the Company.  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Defined Benefit Pension Plan — United States  
A defined benefit pension plan, the Nortel Networks Retirement Income Plan, is maintained for eligible employees and executives in the  
United States. Benefits are paid to plan participants under one of two formulas, depending on elections made by the plan participant: the  
Pension Service Plan (or PSP) formula or the Cash Balance Plan formula.  
The PSP formula is available for participants who are employees of Nortel Networks Inc. (or NNI) or other Nortel Networks subsidiaries  
located in the United States who enrolled in the plan prior to May 1, 2000, and who elected prior to May 1, 2000 to be covered by the PSP  
formula. As of May 1, 2000, the PSP formula under the Nortel Networks Retirement Income Plan was closed to new participants. The PSP  
formula provides a benefit based on pension credits and average earnings for the highest 1,095 consecutive calendar days of compensation out  
of the last 3,650 days prior to retirement or other termination of employment. Pension credits are earned during each year of participation based  
on the participant’s age attained in the year and on years of service. Eligible earnings include base salary and, where applicable, incentive  
awards or bonuses, if any, paid under the SUCCESS Plan, overtime, off-shift differentials and sales commissions.  
A new defined benefit pension formula, the Cash Balance Plan, was established, effective May 1, 2000, based on pay credits and interest  
credits. Employees who were participants in the PSP could continue to participate in the PSP, or move to the new Cash Balance Plan, or elect  
to opt out of the pension plan. The Cash Balance Plan formula provides a monthly credit equal to 4% of eligible earnings, with interest being  
credited monthly based on the month’s starting balance. Eligible earnings include base salary and, where applicable, incentive awards or  
bonuses, if any, paid under the SUCCESS Plan, overtime, off-shift differentials and sales commissions earned prior to retirement or other  
termination of employment.  
The PSP and Cash Balance Plan benefits can be paid in a lump sum or as an actuarially equivalent annuity.  
Certain grandfathering rules exist for employees and executives who were participating in the pension plan as at December 31, 1998.  
Federal laws place limitations on compensation amounts that may be included under a qualified pension plan ($205,000 in 2004) as well as  
limitations on the total benefit that may be paid from such plans. Pension benefits within the limit are funded by a pension trust that is separate  
from the general assets of NNI. Pension benefits applicable to compensation that exceeds federal limitations and pension benefits in excess of  
the limitations on total benefits are paid from a restoration (excess) plan, and are funded from NNI’s general assets.  
Supplementary Executive Retirement Plan  
Eligible executives in Canada and the United States also participate in the Supplementary Executive Retirement Plan (or SERP). Effective  
January 1, 2000, the SERP was closed to new participants and there are only 19 executives who remain eligible to participate in the SERP.  
For Canadian executives participating in the SERP as at December 31, 1998 who elected, effective January 1, 1999, to remain in Part I of  
the pension plan, the SERP formula provides a benefit based on years of service and a pension accrual of 1.3 percent of the final average  
earnings of the best three consecutive years. An early retirement reduction of seven percent a year prior to age 60 applies in the case of  
retirement prior to this age. The maximum total annual retirement benefit cannot exceed 60 percent of an executive’s final average earnings at  
retirement. Eligible earnings include base salary plus the incentive award or bonus, if any, paid under the SUCCESS Plan, and commissions,  
however a bonus or commissions will not be included in a given year to the extent that it exceeds 60 percent of a participant’s base salary for  
that calendar year.  
New SERP plan provisions, which became effective January 1, 1999 and are applicable to Part II members participating in the Canadian  
plan and to US PSP formula members, provide a benefit based on pension credits and final average earnings for the highest three consecutive  
years in the last ten years prior to retirement, to a maximum benefit of 550 percent of final average earnings. Pension credits are earned during  
each year of participation based on the participant’s age attained in the year and on years of service. Eligible earnings include base salary plus  
the incentive award or bonus, if any, paid under the SUCCESS Plan, and commissions, however a bonus or commissions will not be included  
in a given year to the extent that it exceeds 60 percent of a participant’s base salary for that calendar year.  
All participating executives at December 31, 1998 have their benefits protected under the pre-1999 grandfathered SERP formula.  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pension benefits from the SERP are funded from the general assets of, respectively, Nortel Networks Limited and NNTC in Canada and  
Nortel Networks Inc. in the United States.  
The following tables show the aggregate approximate annual retirement benefits for an eligible executive officer for certain compensation  
and years of service categories assuming retirement at age 65, and assuming grandfathering provisions do not apply.  
Table I estimates the total retirement benefit (including the SERP) for all participating United States executives (PSP formula members),  
and for participating Canadian executives who elected and continue to participate in Part II of the Nortel Networks Limited Managerial and  
Non-Negotiated Pension Plan. It estimates the benefit payable as a life annuity with a 60 percent survivor pension.  
The approximate benefits for the service of Messrs. Debon, McFadden and DeRoma (named executive officers in 2004) and Mr. Bolouri (a  
named executive officer in 2003, along with Messrs. Debon and DeRoma) are shown in Table I. The approximate total eligible earnings and  
years of credited pensionable service at December 31, 2004 was: $808,525 and 4.92 years of United States service for Mr. Debon; $708,816  
and 27.50 years of Canadian service for Mr. McFadden; and $823,931 and 5.58 years of Canadian pensionable service for Mr. DeRoma.  
Mr. DeRoma is also eligible to receive additional credited pensionable service, up to a maximum of 8.125 years, under the terms of his  
employment agreement. See “Certain Employment Arrangements”. The approximate total eligible earnings and years of credited pensionable  
service for Mr. Bolouri at December 31, 2003 was $696,984 and 22 years of Canadian service.  
Table I  
Years of Service  
Total Earnings  
15  
20  
25  
30  
35  
$600,000  
700,000  
$138,578  
161,674  
184,770  
207,866  
230,963  
254,059  
277,155  
300,251  
323,348  
346,444  
369,540  
392,636  
415,733  
438,829  
461,925  
$169,034  
197,206  
225,379  
253,551  
281,724  
309,896  
338,068  
366,241  
394,413  
422,585  
450,758  
478,930  
507,102  
535,275  
563,447  
$207,612  
242,215  
276,817  
311,419  
346,021  
380,623  
415,225  
449,827  
484,429  
519,031  
553,633  
588,235  
622,837  
657,439  
692,042  
$235,023  
274,194  
313,365  
352,535  
391,706  
430,876  
470,047  
509,217  
548,388  
587,558  
626,729  
665,900  
705,070  
744,241  
783,411  
$273,602  
319,202  
364,802  
410,403  
456,003  
501,603  
547,203  
592,804  
638,404  
684,004  
729,605  
775,205  
820,805  
866,406  
912,006  
800,000  
900,000  
1,000,000  
1,100,000  
1,200,000  
1,300,000  
1,400,000  
1,500,000  
1,600,000  
1,700,000  
1,800,000  
1,900,000  
2,000,000  
Table II estimates the benefits calculated under the United States Cash Balance Plan formula under the Nortel Networks Retirement Income  
Plan for participating employees and executives, payable as a straight life annuity.  
The approximate benefits for Mr. Owens and Ms. Spradley’s service are shown in Table II. The approximate total eligible earnings and  
years of credited service at December 31, 2004 for Mr. Owens was $680,328 and .75 years of United States service and $1,139,325 and  
16.67 years of United States service for Ms. Spradley. As Mr. Owens and Ms. Spradley are in the Cash Balance Plan, eligible earnings for  
2004 reflect 2004 base salary and for Ms. Spradley it also included the one-time award paid during 2004 under the SUCCESS Plan. Mr. Owens  
is also eligible for a Special Pension Arrangement. See “Certain Employment Arrangements”.  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table II  
Years of Service  
Total Earnings  
5
10  
15  
20  
25  
30  
35  
$600,000  
700,000  
$10,330  
12,051  
13,773  
15,494  
17,216  
18,938  
20,659  
22,381  
24,103  
25,824  
27,546  
29,267  
30,989  
32,711  
34,432  
$20,659  
24,102  
27,546  
30,989  
34,432  
37,875  
41,318  
44,762  
48,205  
51,648  
55,091  
58,534  
61,978  
65,421  
68,864  
$30,989  
36,153  
41,318  
46,483  
51,648  
56,813  
61,977  
67,142  
72,307  
77,472  
82,636  
87,801  
92,966  
98,131  
103,296  
$41,318  
48,204  
55,091  
61,977  
68,863  
75,750  
82,636  
89,522  
96,409  
103,295  
110,181  
117,068  
123,954  
130,840  
137,727  
$51,648  
60,256  
$61,978  
72,307  
$72,308  
84,359  
800,000  
68,864  
82,637  
96,411  
900,000  
77,472  
92,967  
108,462  
120,513  
132,565  
144,616  
156,667  
168,719  
180,770  
192,821  
204,873  
216,924  
228,975  
241,027  
1,000,000  
1,100,000  
1,200,000  
1,300,000  
1,400,000  
1,500,000  
1,600,000  
1,700,000  
1,800,000  
1,900,000  
2,000,000  
86,080  
103,296  
113,626  
123,956  
134,285  
144,615  
154,945  
165,274  
175,604  
185,933  
196,263  
206,593  
94,688  
103,296  
111,904  
120,512  
129,120  
137,728  
146,336  
154,944  
163,552  
172,160  
On April 27, 2004, the Company and Nortel Networks Limited terminated for cause the employment of each of their then president and  
chief executive officer, chief financial officer and controller. On August 19, 2004, the Company announced that seven individuals with, or who  
had, significant responsibilities for financial reporting at the line of business and regional levels were terminated for cause and that Nortel  
Networks will demand repayment of payments made under bonus plans in respect of 2003. As a result, where applicable and permitted under  
applicable law, the pension benefits for the terminated executives were recalculated to include base salary only in 2003.  
As a result of the termination of Mr. Dunn’s employment for cause on April 27, 2004, he was no longer eligible for any SERP benefit that  
would have otherwise applied as a result of his past election to remain in Part I of the pension plan. Upon the termination of his employment  
for cause, Mr. Dunn received Cdn$2,416,517.18 representing the commuted value of the pension benefits accrued pursuant to the Nortel  
Networks Limited Managerial and Non-Negotiated Pension Plan. The payment was calculated based on Mr. Dunn’s 27.92 years of service in  
accordance with the Part I formula described under “Defined Benefit Pension Plan — Canada”.  
Certain employment arrangements  
On August 31, 2004, the Company and Nortel Networks Limited entered into an employment agreement with William A. Owens  
confirming Mr. Owens’ appointment as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited as of April 27,  
2004. The agreement provides that Mr. Owens will receive a base salary of $1,000,000 and will be eligible for a targeted annual bonus of  
170% of base salary under the Nortel Networks Limited SUCCESS Incentive Plan. Under the agreement, Mr. Owens will receive a special  
pension benefit that will accrue ratably over the first five years of his employment as President and Chief Executive Officer. Assuming  
retirement at the end of such five years, Mr. Owens will receive an estimated monthly pension benefit of $33,540, payable over the five year  
period following his retirement.  
Mr. Owens is based at the registrant’s offices in Ontario, Canada. In connection with his relocation to Ontario, Mr. Owens will be eligible  
for certain benefits under the Nortel Networks-International Assignment Relocation program, in accordance with the generally applicable terms  
of such program and consistent with his senior executive position.  
Mr. DeRoma entered into an employment agreement in April 1997, prior to commencing employment as Vice-President and Deputy  
General Counsel. Pursuant to the agreement, the Company agreed to make a gross-up payment to Mr. DeRoma for calendar years 1997 through  
2000. The gross-up payment was intended to place Mr. DeRoma in the same after-tax position with respect to his base salary and any annual  
incentive award as if he were a resident of the State of Connecticut and a taxpayer in the United States. After June 2000, this gross-up was  
subject to annual review by the joint  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
leadership resources committee of the boards of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited, and was not renewed subsequent to  
March 2002. Under the terms of the agreement, Mr. DeRoma is also eligible for the Nortel Networks Limited Special Pension Credit Program  
which covered new executive hires older than age 35. Mr. DeRoma will be credited, for pension purposes, with additional years and months  
equal to one half of the years between the age of 35 and Mr. DeRoma’s age at the time of hire, if he retires after the age of 60, to a maximum of  
8.125 years.  
Other than Mr. Dunn, each of the named executive officers and certain other executive officers of the Company, including the current  
President and Chief Executive Officer, currently participate in the Nortel Networks Corporation Executive Retention and Termination Plan (or  
ERTP). The ERTP provides that if a participant’s employment is terminated without cause within a period commencing 30 days prior to the  
date of a change in control of the Company and ending 24 months after the date of a change in control of the Company, or the participant  
resigns for good reason (including, among other things, a reduction in overall compensation, geographic relocation or reduction in  
responsibility, in each case without the consent of the participant) within 24 months following the date of a change in control of the Company,  
the participant will be entitled to certain payments and benefits, including (i) the payment of an amount equal to three times (in the case of the  
chief executive officer) and two times (in the case of the other named executive officers) of the participant’s annual base salary; (ii) the  
payment of an amount equal to 300 percent (in the case of the chief executive officer) and 200 percent (in the case of the other named  
executive officers) of the participant’s target annual incentive bonus; (iii) accelerated vesting of all or substantially all stock options; and  
(iv) the “pay-out” at target of any restricted stock units under the Nortel Networks Limited Restricted Stock Unit Plan.  
For purposes of the ERTP, a change in control is deemed to occur if:  
(i) any party or group acquires beneficial ownership of securities of the Company representing more than 20 percent of the outstanding  
securities entitled to vote in the election of directors of the Company;  
(ii) the Company participates in a business combination, including, among other things, a merger, amalgamation, reorganization, sale  
of all or substantially all of its assets, or plan of arrangement, unless the business combination only involves the Company and/or its  
affiliates or, following the completion of the business combination, the Company’s common shareholders beneficially own, directly  
or indirectly, more than 50 percent of the then-outstanding voting shares of the entity resulting from the business combination (or of  
an entity which ultimately controls such entity) and a majority of the members of the board of directors of the entity resulting from  
the business combination (or the entity ultimately controlling such entity) were members of the board of directors of the Company  
when the business combination was approved or the initial agreement in connection with the business combination was executed;  
(iii) the persons who were directors of the Company on the effective date of the ERTP cease (for reasons other than death or disability)  
to constitute at least a majority of the Company’s board of directors; provided, that any person who was not a director on the  
effective date of the ERTP shall be deemed to be an incumbent director if such person was elected or appointed to the Company’s  
board of directors by, or on the recommendation of or with the approval of, at least two-thirds of the directors who then qualify as  
incumbent directors unless such election, appointment, recommendation or approval was the result of any actual or publicly  
threatened proxy contest for the election of directors; or  
(iv) any other event occurs which the Company’s board of directors determines in good faith could reasonably be expected to give rise  
to a change in control.  
Until June 30, 2003, each of the named executive officers (other than Mr. Dunn) and certain other executive officers of the Company were  
eligible to participate in the Nortel Networks Corporation Special Retention Plan (or SRP). The SRP provided that if a participant’s  
employment was terminated by the participant for good reason or by the Company without cause during the period from November 1, 2001 to  
June 30, 2003, that participant would have been entitled to certain payments and benefits. Other than payments made in accordance with the  
SRP in March 2003 in connection with a former executive officer’s previously announced termination of employment, no amounts were paid  
or became payable in 2003 to any executive officer prior to June 30, 2003.  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Compensation of directors  
Effective January 1, 2002, each non-employee director of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited elected to receive all compensation  
for services rendered as a member of the board of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited, any committees thereof, and as  
board or committee chairperson, in the form of share units, instead of cash, under the Directors’ Deferred Share Compensation Plans  
maintained by the Company and Nortel Networks Limited. The share units are settled a specified number of trading days following the release  
of the Company’s financial results after the director ceases to be a member of the applicable board, and each share unit entitles the holder to  
receive one common share of the Company. Effective January 1, 2004, each non-employee director of the Company and Nortel Networks  
Limited was entitled to elect to receive fees in cash, in share units under the Directors’ Deferred Share Compensation Plans or in a combination  
of cash and share units.  
The compensation of directors is considered on a combined basis in light of the overall governance structure of the Company and Nortel  
Networks Limited. Director compensation is set solely on an annual fee basis (paid quarterly in arrears) and fees are not paid for board or  
committee meeting attendance. From January 1, 2002 to December 31, 2003, directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited, who  
were not salaried employees of the Company or any of its subsidiaries, received an annual Nortel Networks Limited board retainer of $50,000,  
an annual committee membership retainer of $12,500 (or $6,250 each for membership on the same committee of the boards of the Company  
and Nortel Networks Limited) and, except as noted below, an annual committee chairperson fee of $7,500 (or $3,750 each for chairing the  
same committee of the boards of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited). Effective July 25, 2002, the fee for the audit committee  
chairperson was increased to $17,500 (or $8,750 for each audit committee of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited) in recognition of the  
significant responsibilities assumed by the audit committee chairperson.  
Annual directors’ fees were initially increased effective January 1, 2004, after having been essentially unchanged for the previous two year  
period, as described above. However, in light of the challenges subsequently faced by the Company and Nortel Networks Limited, the boards  
of directors in July 2004 decreased the annual directors’ fees back to the fees in effect prior to January 1, 2004. The boards of directors also  
determined that the directors’ fees to be paid during the remainder of 2004 would be reduced so that the total amount of the directors’ fees paid  
for 2004 would equal the amount of fees that would have been paid under the 2003 directors’ fee schedule. Accordingly, the net effect of these  
determinations was that the directors’ fees paid to non-employee directors remain essentially unchanged since January 1, 2002.  
Between January 1, 2004 to June 30, 2004, directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited, who were not salaried employees of the  
Company or any of its subsidiaries, received an annual Nortel Networks Limited board retainer of $60,000 and an annual committee  
membership retainer and, except as described below, an annual committee chairperson retainer of $12,500 (or $6,250 each for membership on  
or chairing the same committee of the boards of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited). The fee for the audit committee chairperson was  
$27,500 or $13,750 for each audit committee, in recognition of the significant responsibilities assumed by the audit committee chairperson.  
The Company maintains, at its cost, life insurance for directors, who are not salaried employees of the Company and Nortel Networks  
Limited. Such insurance is in an amount of Cdn$100,000 while a director and in an amount of Cdn$75,000 following retirement at or after age  
65 or, at any lesser age after ten years of board membership (including Nortel Networks Limited board membership).  
Directors entitled to the above remuneration are also reimbursed for reasonable travel and living expenses properly incurred by them in  
attending any meetings of the boards of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited or their committees or for performing services  
as directors.  
Effective January 1, 2004, amended share ownership guidelines adopted by the boards of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks  
Limited require each non-chairman director to own, directly or indirectly, common shares of the Company having a fair market value of at  
least $300,000 within five years from the earlier of the date he or she was first elected or appointed to the boards of directors of the Company  
or Nortel Networks Limited. Share ownership guideline compliance must thereafter be maintained during an individual’s tenure as a director.  
The chairman of the board must own, directly or indirectly, common shares of the Company having a fair market value of at least $1,600,000  
within five years from the earlier of the date he or she was first appointed as chairman of the boards of directors of the Company or Nortel  
Networks Limited. A newly elected director is required to elect to receive at least 50 percent of his or her annual compensation for serving as a  
director of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited or, in the case of a newly appointed chairman of the board of directors, at least  
50 percent of his or her annual compensation for serving as a director and as  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
chairman of the board of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited, in the form of share units until such time as the share  
ownership guidelines are met. Share units credited under the Directors’ Deferred Share Compensation Plans are included in the calculation of  
the number of common shares of the Company owned by a director for this purpose. Messrs. Bischoff and Manley have been prevented under  
applicable securities laws from participating in the Directors Deferred Share Compensation Plans due to the delay in the filing of the restated  
financial statements and related periodic reports of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited.  
Retirement benefits are not paid to non-employee directors of the Company or to non-employee directors of Nortel Networks Limited  
elected after January 1, 1996. Non-employee directors of Nortel Networks Limited elected prior to January 1, 1996 are entitled to receive  
retirement benefits equal to 75 percent of the greater of $27,500 and the annual retainer paid to each director at retirement, indexed to reflect  
approximately half of the increase in directors’ retainers after retirement. The benefits are payable for a maximum of ten years.  
From his appointment in April 2001 to December 31, 2003, Mr. Wilson’s additional compensation for serving as non-executive chairman of  
the board of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited from each of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited was $45,000 per  
fiscal quarter. As with the directors’ annual fees, Mr. Wilson’s additional compensation for serving as non-executive chairman of the board of  
the Company and of Nortel Networks Limited was initially increased to $50,000 per fiscal quarter from each of the Company and Nortel  
Networks Limited for the period from January 1, 2004 to June 30, 2004. Effective July 1, 2004, his additional compensation for serving as non-  
executive chairman of the board of directors of the Company and of Nortel Networks Limited was reduced back to the $45,000 per fiscal  
quarter that was being paid prior to January 1, 2004 by each of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited. The boards of directors also  
determined that the amount of additional compensation for serving as non-executive chairman paid to Mr. Wilson from July 1, 2004 to  
December 31, 2004 would be reduced so that the total amount of additional compensation to be paid to Mr. Wilson in 2004 for serving as non-  
executive Chairman would equal his pre-2004 compensation. The net effect of these determinations was that the additional fees paid to  
Mr. Wilson for serving as non-executive Chairman remain unchanged since his original appointment.  
Compensation committee interlocks and insider participation  
The joint leadership resources committee of the boards of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited is comprised of members  
from the boards of directors of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited. The members of the joint committee are Messrs. R.E. Brown  
(chairman), S.H. Smith, Jr., and L.R. Wilson. Mr. Owens served as a member of the joint committee until April 27, 2004, but resigned from the  
committee prior to being appointed President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited. No other changes to  
the membership of the joint committee have occurred during 2004 or 2003. No member of the joint committee was an officer (within the  
meaning of applicable United States securities rules) or employee of the Company or any of its subsidiaries at any time during 2004 or 2003.  
No executive officer of the Company serves on the board of directors or compensation committee of any other entity that has or has had one  
or more of its executive officers serving as a member of the Company’s board of directors.  
ITEM 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management  
Security ownership of certain beneficial owners  
We are not aware of any person who, as of December 31, 2004, beneficially owned or exercised control or direction over more than five  
percent of the Company’s common shares.  
Security ownership of directors and management  
The following table shows the number of common shares of the Company and Bookham Technology plc beneficially owned, as of  
January 7, 2005 (unless otherwise noted), by each of the Company’s directors, nominees for directors and the individuals named in the 2004  
and 2003 summary compensation tables set forth above under “Executive Compensation”, as well as by the directors and executive officers as  
a group, with the exception that common shares held under Canadian and U.S. investment plans and common shares subject to stock options  
are as of December 31, 2004. Bookham Technology plc was an affiliate of the Company as of December 31, 2004.  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A person is deemed to be a beneficial owner of a common share if that person has, or shares, the power to direct the vote or investment of  
the common share. Under applicable United States securities laws, a person is also deemed to be a beneficial owner of a common share if such  
person has the right to acquire the share within 60 days (whether or not, in the case of a stock option, the current market price of the underlying  
common share is below the stock option exercise price). More than one person may be deemed a beneficial owner of a common share and a  
person need not have an economic interest in a share to be a beneficial owner.  
Amount and Nature of  
Beneficial Ownership (1)  
Name of Beneficial Owner  
Title of Class of Security  
Common shares of the Company  
M. Bischoff*  
J.J. Blanchard  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
19,392 (2)  
114,395 (3)  
417,281 (4)  
123,254 (3)  
29,000 (5)  
132,249 (3)  
22,585 (6)  
132,889 (3)  
10,756 (7)  
133,243 (3)  
42,804,520 (8)  
R.E. Brown  
J.E. Cleghorn  
L.Y. Fortier  
R.A. Ingram  
J.A. MacNaughton**  
J. Manley*  
R.D. McCormick**  
W.A. Owens  
Common shares of the Company  
Common shares of the Company  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
100,000  
103,917 (3)  
H.J. Pearce**  
G. Saucier  
Common shares of the Company  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
10,000  
28,673 (9)  
129,397 (3)  
131,192 (10)  
157,173 (3)  
1,201,871 (11)  
564,470 (3)  
S.H. Smith, Jr.  
L.R. Wilson  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
F.A. Dunn***  
P. Debon  
B.W. McFadden  
S.L. Spradley  
C. Bolouri****  
N.J. DeRoma  
Directors and executive officers as a group  
(consisting of 36 persons, comprised of the current  
directors and current executive officers)  
Common shares of the Company  
Common shares of the Company  
Common shares of the Company  
Common shares of the Company  
Common shares of the Company  
Common shares of the Company  
Common shares of the Company  
Share units  
793,510 (12)  
1,958,167 (13)  
1,718,388 (14)  
615,255 (15)  
1,909,380 (16)  
1,919,233 (17)  
23,396,591 (18)  
1,590,987 (3)  
Common shares of Bookham Technology plc  
*
Messrs. Bischoff and Manley were each appointed a director of the Company and of Nortel Networks Limited on April 29, 2004 and May 26, 2004, respectively.  
Messrs. Bischoff and Manley have been prevented under applicable securities laws from participating in the Directors’ Deferred Share Compensation Plans due to the  
delay in the filing of the restated financial statements and related periodic reports of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited and, since May 31, 2004, have been subject  
to an Ontario Securities Commission management cease trade order prohibiting trading by directors, officers and certain current and former employees in securities of the  
Company until after the filing of the restated financial statements and related periodic reports of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited.  
**  
Nominee for election as a director of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited for the first time.  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
***  
Mr. Dunn ceased to be President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited on April 27, 2004 and ceased to be a director of the Company  
and Nortel Networks Limited on May 21, 2004.  
****  
(1)  
A named executive officer in 2003 only.  
Except as set forth below, each person has sole investment and voting power with respect to the common shares beneficially owned by such person. Includes common  
shares subject to stock options exercisable by December 31, 2004 or that become exercisable within 60 days from December 31, 2004 (whether or not the market price of  
the underlying common shares is below the stock option exercise price). As of December 31, 2004, each director and named executive officer individually, and the  
directors and executive officers as a group, beneficially owned less than 1.0 percent of the outstanding common shares of the Company.  
(2)  
(3)  
Includes 8,000 common shares subject to stock options.  
Share units issued under the Nortel Networks Corporation Directors’ Deferred Share Compensation Plan and the Nortel Networks Limited Directors’ Deferred Share  
Compensation Plan. Each share unit represents the right to receive one common share of the Company. Those plans are described under “Compensation of Directors”.  
(4)  
Includes 8,000 common shares subject to stock options. Excludes 94 common shares beneficially owned by Mr. Brown’s son residing with Mr. Brown and 671 common  
shares beneficially owned by Mr. Brown’s spouse. Mr. Brown disclaims beneficial ownership of those excluded shares.  
(5)  
(6)  
Includes 4,000 common shares subject to stock options.  
Includes 8,000 common shares subject to stock options. Excludes 5,000 common shares beneficially owned by Mr. Fortier’s spouse. Mr. Fortier disclaims beneficial  
ownership of those excluded shares.  
(7)  
(8)  
Includes 8,000 common shares subject to stock options and 1,800 common shares as to which Mr. Ingram shares investment and voting power with his spouse.  
Represents common shares beneficially owned as of December 31, 2004 by the Canada Pension Plan Investment Board of which Mr. MacNaughton is the President and  
Chief Executive Officer. He is due to retire from that position on January 14, 2005. Mr. MacNaughton disclaims beneficial ownership of these shares.  
(9)  
Includes 8,000 common shares subject to stock options and 20,673 common shares beneficially owned by a corporation that is wholly-owned by Mrs. Saucier.  
(10)  
Includes 8,000 common shares subject to stock options. Excludes 1,600 common shares beneficially owned by Mr. Smith’s spouse. Mr. Smith disclaims beneficial  
ownership of those excluded shares.  
(11)  
(12)  
Includes 38,000 common shares subject to stock options and 1,157,855 common shares beneficially owned by a corporation that is wholly-owned by Mr. Wilson.  
Excludes 2,204 common shares beneficially owned by Mr. Wilson’s spouse. Mr. Wilson disclaims beneficial ownership of those excluded shares.  
Includes 5,000 common shares beneficially owned by Mr. Dunn’s son as to which Mr. Dunn shares investment power. Excludes 10,000 common shares beneficially  
owned by Mr. Dunn’s spouse and daughter residing with Mr. Dunn. Mr. Dunn disclaims beneficial ownership of those 15,000 included and excluded shares. As Mr. Dunn  
was no longer an insider of the Company effective May 21, 2004, the number of common shares reported as part of his holdings is based on information in our corporate  
records and Mr. Dunn’s filings on the Canadian insider reporting system, the System for Electronic Disclosure by Insiders, as at May 12, 2004 and reports filed pursuant  
to Section 16(a) of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934.  
(13)  
(14)  
(15)  
(16)  
Includes 1,442,000 common shares subject to stock options.  
Includes 1,217,000 common shares subject to stock options.  
Includes 321,999 common shares subject to stock options.  
Includes 1,498,000 common shares subject to stock options.  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(17)  
(18)  
Includes 1,453,334 common shares subject to stock options and 397,127 common shares as to which Mr. DeRoma shares investment and voting power with his spouse.  
Includes 15,124,239 common shares subject to stock options. Also includes 420,920 common shares as to which investment and voting power is shared with one or  
more other persons. Excludes 52,854 common shares as to which beneficial ownership is disclaimed.  
Equity compensation plan information  
2004  
The table below provides information as of December 31, 2004 with respect to common shares of the Company that may be issued under  
the following equity compensation plans:  
Nortel Networks Corporation 2000 Stock Option Plan (the “2000 Stock Option Plan”); and  
Nortel Networks Corporation 1986 Stock Option Plan as amended and restated (the “1986 Stock Option Plan” and, collectively  
with the 2000 Stock Option Plan, the “Stock Option Plans”).  
The table does not provide information with respect to equity compensation plans that have expired or are no longer in effect. The Company  
and its subsidiaries maintain other equity compensation plans that permit awards to directors, officers and other employees to be paid in  
common shares of the Company that are not issued from treasury but are purchased on the open market for immediate delivery to plan  
participants. Such plans are not dilutive to shareholders and information with respect to such plans is not required to be included in the table.  
Plan category  
A
B
C
Number of common  
shares to be issued  
upon exercise of  
outstanding options,  
warrants and rights  
Weighted average  
exercise price of  
outstanding  
options, warrants  
and rights  
Number of common shares  
remaining available for future  
issuance under equity compensation  
plans (excluding common shares  
reflected in column A)  
Equity compensation plans approved by shareholders (1)  
Equity compensation plans not approved by shareholders (2)  
Total (3)  
278,710,155  
$10.87  
73,062,123  
278,710,155  
$10.87  
73,062,123  
(1)  
Consists of the Stock Option Plans.  
(2)  
None. Except for the plans noted in footnote (3) below, all equity compensation plans involving the issuance of common shares from treasury have received  
shareholder approval.  
(3)  
This table does not include information on any options, warrants or rights outstanding under plans that have been assumed by the Company and its subsidiaries in  
connection with merger, consolidation or other acquisition transactions (the “Assumed Stock Option Plans”). As of December 31, 2004, 20,278,215 common shares of  
the Company were issuable upon the exercise of outstanding options under the Assumed Stock Option Plans. The weighted average exercise price of such outstanding  
options is $23.11 per common share. No additional options may be granted under the Assumed Stock Option Plans.  
2003  
The table below provides information as of December 31, 2003 with respect to common shares of the Company that may be issued under  
the following equity compensation plans:  
Nortel Networks Corporation 2000 Stock Option Plan (the “2000 Stock Option Plan”); and  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Nortel Networks Corporation 1986 Stock Option Plan as amended and restated (the “1986 Stock Option Plan” and, collectively  
with the 2000 Stock Option Plan, the “Stock Option Plans”).  
The table does not provide information with respect to equity compensation plans that have expired or are no longer in effect. The Company  
and its subsidiaries maintain other equity compensation plans that permit awards to directors, officers and other employees to be paid in  
common shares of the Company that are not issued from treasury but are purchased on the open market for immediate delivery to plan  
participants. Such plans are not dilutive to shareholders and information with respect to such plans is not required to be included in the table.  
Plan category  
A
B
C
Number of common  
shares to be issued  
upon exercise of  
outstanding options,  
warrants and rights  
Weighted average  
exercise price of  
outstanding  
options, warrants  
and rights  
Number of common shares  
remaining available for future  
issuance under equity compensation  
plans (excluding common shares  
reflected in column A)  
Equity compensation plans approved by shareholders (1)  
Equity compensation plans not approved by shareholders (2)  
Total (3)  
270,793,165  
$11.52  
87,996,421  
270,793,165  
$11.52  
87,996,421  
(1)  
Consists of the Stock Option Plans.  
(2)  
None. Except for the plans noted in footnote (3) below, all equity compensation plans involving the issuance of common shares from treasury have received  
shareholder approval.  
(3)  
This table does not include information on any options, warrants or rights outstanding under plans that have been assumed by the Company and its subsidiaries in  
connection with merger, consolidation or other acquisition transactions (the “Assumed Stock Option Plans”). As of December 31, 2003, 22,109,241 common shares of  
the Company were issuable upon the exercise of outstanding options under the Assumed Stock Option Plans. The weighted average exercise price of such outstanding  
options is $25.52 per common share. No additional options may be granted under the Assumed Stock Option Plans.  
ITEM 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions  
The Company and its subsidiaries paid the law firm of Ogilvy Renault, of which Mr. Fortier is a senior partner and Co-Chairman, fees for  
legal services with respect to several matters in 2003 and 2004 and are expected to continue to pay fees for legal services in 2005.  
The Company and its subsidiaries paid the law firm of Piper Rudnick LLP, of which Mr. Blanchard is a partner, fees for legal services with  
respect to several matters in 2003 and 2004 and are expected to continue to pay fees for legal services in 2005.  
The Company and its subsidiaries paid the law firm of McCarthy Tétrault LLP fees for legal services in 2003 and 2004. In May 2004,  
Mr. Manley became a senior counsel of the law firm of McCarthy Tétrault LLP, serving as an independent consultant but not a partner.  
McCarthy Tétrault LLP represents a former executive of Nortel Networks in connection with matters related to his former association with  
Nortel Networks, including certain civil proceedings commenced in 2001, the fees for which are being paid by the Company pursuant to  
indemnification provisions of applicable law.  
Indebtedness of management  
The Company provides relocation assistance to employees who are requested to relocate that is designed to minimize the financial exposure  
to employees as a result of the move. In the past, the assistance has included housing loans, advances on real estate equity, and payments on  
behalf of employees of direct costs associated with the move. The assistance offered is specific to each employee and is structured to be  
competitive in the area to which the employee is relocated, subject  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
to the overall relocation policy. Effective July 30, 2002, and in accordance with the United States Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, the Company  
no longer offers its executive officers housing loans as part of their relocation assistance.  
No loans have been extended by the Company or its subsidiaries to any director or executive officer of the Company since January 1, 2003.  
Neither the Company nor its subsidiaries have given any guarantee, support agreement, letter of credit, or similar arrangement or  
understanding, to any other entity in connection with indebtedness of current and former directors or executive officers since January 1, 2003.  
As at December 31, 2004, approximately $3.6 million of indebtedness was owed by current and former employees to the Company and its  
subsidiaries. Except for the indebtedness previously owed by a recently appointed executive officer as set out in the table below, no current or  
former director or executive officer had any loans outstanding since January 1, 2003.  
Table of Indebtedness of Directors and Executive Officers  
Largest Amount Outstanding  
Name and Principal  
Position  
Involvement of  
Company or Subsidiary  
January 1, 2003 -  
December 31, 2004 ($)  
Amount Outstanding  
as at December 31, 2004 ($)  
Martha H. Bejar (1)  
President, CALA  
Lender  
200,000  
0
(1)  
A subsidiary of the Company extended a housing loan to Ms. Bejar in 2001 in connection with a relocation. The loan was for a period of 10 years, interest-free and secured  
against Ms. Bejar’s residence. The full amount of this indebtedness was repaid by Ms. Bejar prior to her appointment as an executive officer effective October 1, 2004.  
ITEM 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services  
Deloitte & Touche LLP, the member firms of Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu, and their respective affiliates (or, collectively, the Deloitte  
Entities) are the principal independent accountants of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited.  
In accordance with applicable laws and the requirements of stock exchanges and securities regulatory authorities, the audit committees of  
the Company and Nortel Networks Limited pre-approve all audit and non-audit services to be provided by the Deloitte Entities. In addition, in  
April 2002, the audit committees of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited recommended for approval, and the boards of directors of the  
Company and Nortel Networks Limited approved, a policy that thereafter the Company’s and Nortel Networks Limited’s auditors would be  
retained solely to provide audit and audit-related services and advice with respect to tax matters, and that the auditors would not be retained to  
provide consulting services, such as information technology services. The boards’ policy applies to new engagements and did not affect limited  
term engagements in effect at the time the policy was approved.  
Certain services in each fee category below were not subject to the audit committee pre-approval requirements as the fees related to  
engagements for services prior to the audit committee pre-approval requirements coming into effect. Five percent of the fees billed for 2003 are  
for engagements that were undertaken prior to the pre-approval requirements coming into effect and were primarily for tax compliance  
services. Services for which the fees were less than one percent of the total fees billed by the Deloitte Entities for 2003 were inadvertently not  
pre-approved by the audit committees but were promptly brought to the attention of the audit committees and, in accordance with applicable  
laws and the requirements of securities regulatory authorities, were approved prior to the completion of the services associated with those fees.  
Audit Fees  
The Company and Nortel Networks Limited prepare financial statements in accordance with United States generally accepted accounting  
principles (or US GAAP) and Canadian generally accepted accounting principles (or Canadian GAAP). Deloitte Entities billed to date the  
Company and its subsidiaries $14.3 million for 2004 for the following audit services: (i) interim audit work related to the audit of the annual  
consolidated financial statements of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited for the year ended December 31, 2004; (ii) reviews of the  
financial statements of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited included as comparative financial statements in Forms 10-Q for the periods  
ended March 31, 2004 and June 30, 2004; and (ii) audit of internal controls over financial reporting as required under the United States  
Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Deloitte Entities billed to date the Company and its subsidiaries $55.0 million and $8.1 million for 2003 and  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2002, respectively, for the following audit services: (i) audits of the annual consolidated financial statements of the Company and Nortel  
Networks Limited included in annual reports on Form 10-K and annual reports to shareholders for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2003  
and 2002; (ii) reviews of the interim financial statements of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited included in quarterly reports on Form  
10-Q and quarterly reports to shareholders for the periods ended March 31, June 30 and September 30, 2003 and 2002 (and in a Nortel  
Networks Limited amended Form 10-Q/A for the period ended September 30, 2003); (iii) audits and reviews of the restated financial  
statements of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited included in their respective amended annual reports on Form 10-K/A for the fiscal  
year ended December 31, 2002 and amended quarterly reports on Form 10-Q/A for the periods ended March 31 and June 30, 2003; (iv) audits  
and reviews of the restated financial statements of the Company and Nortel Networks Limited included as comparative financial statements in  
their respective Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2003; (v) audits of individual subsidiary statutory financial statements; and  
(vi) comfort letters, attest services, statutory and regulatory audits, consents and other services related to United States Securities and Exchange  
Commission matters.  
Audit-Related Fees  
Deloitte Entities billed to date the Company and its subsidiaries $2.8 million, $3.1 million and $1.1 million for 2004, 2003 and 2002,  
respectively, for the following audit-related services: (i) audit of pension plan financial statements; (ii) financial accounting and reporting  
consultations; (iii) information system reviews; (iv) advisory services related to the United States Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002; (v) accounting  
consultations and audits in connection with dispositions; (vi) internal control reviews; and (vii) accounting consultations regarding financial  
accounting standards for various local business-related transactions.  
Tax Fees  
Deloitte Entities billed the Company and its subsidiaries $7.1 million, $14.6 million and $13.7 million for 2004, 2003 and 2002,  
respectively for tax compliance services. Tax compliance services are services rendered based upon facts already in existence or transactions  
that have already occurred to document, compute and obtain government approval for amounts to be included in tax filings and consisted of:  
(i) assistance in filing tax returns in various jurisdictions; (ii) sales and use, property and other tax return assistance; (iii) research and  
development tax credit documentation and analysis for purposes of filing amended returns; (iv) transfer pricing documentation; (v) requests for  
technical advice from taxing authorities; (vi) assistance with tax audits and appeals; and (vii) preparation of expatriate tax returns.  
All Other Fees  
Deloitte Entities billed the Company and its subsidiaries $0, $0 and $1.7 million for 2004, 2003 and 2002, respectively, for the following  
services: (i) non-financial information systems design and implementation; (ii) financial information systems design and implementation; (iii)  
immigration services; and (iv) review of import/export and social security requirements/reports. Approximately $1.0 million of the above  
services billed by Deloitte Entities in 2002 were for services provided by Deloitte Consulting.  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PART IV  
ITEM 15. Exhibits, Financial Statement Schedules and Reports on Form 8-K  
Financial Statements  
1.  
The index to the Consolidated Financial Statements appears on page •.  
Financial Statement Schedules  
.
2
Page  
Quarterly Financial Data (Unaudited)  
F-93  
Report of Independent Registered Chartered Accountants  
178  
179  
II — Valuation and Qualifying Accounts and Reserves, Provision for Uncollectibles  
Audited Financial Statements and the notes thereto of Nortel Networks S.A., prepared in accordance with  
United States generally accepted accounting principles, for the three years ended December 31, 2003  
180  
All other schedules are omitted because they are inapplicable or not required.  
Individual financial statements of entities accounted for by the equity method have been omitted because no such entity constitutes a  
“significant subsidiary” requiring such disclosure at December 31, 2003.  
3.  
Reports on Form 8-K  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 24, 2003 related to its financial results for the third quarter of  
2003.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 13, 2003 related to a press release announcing the expected  
timing for the filing of its Form 10-Q for the fiscal year of 2003.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 23, 2003 relating to a press release announcing the  
confirmation of the filing of a Form 10-K/A for 2002, a Form 10-Q/A for the first quarter of 2003 and a Form 10-Q/A for the second quarter of  
2003.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated January 29, 2004 concerning its financial results for the fourth quarter  
of 2003 and full year 2003.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated March 10, 2004 related to a press release announcing the delay of  
filing of its financial results for the third quarter of 2003.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated March 15, 2004 related to a press release announcing the appointments  
of a new Chief Financial Officer and Controller on an interim basis.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated March 30, 2004 related to a press release announcing the waiver from  
Export Development Canada and update regarding the timing of the first quarter 2004 results announcement and Annual Shareholders’  
Meeting.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated April 5, 2004 related to a press release updating the status of the  
Securities and Exchange Commission inquiry.  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated April 14, 2004 related to a press release updating the status of Ontario  
Securities Commission inquiry.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated April 28, 2004 related to a press release announcing the appointment  
of William A. Owens as President and Chief Executive Officer, other management changes and an update on a number of matters, including  
the status of certain prior year financial statements.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K/A dated April 28, 2004 amending debt securities information contained in a  
press release dated March 10, 2004.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated April 29, 2004 related to a press release announcing the appointment  
of Dr. rer. Pol. Manfred Bischoff to the Nortel Networks Board of Directors.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 14, 2004 related to a press release announcing Nortel Networks  
receipt of a federal grand jury subpoena from the U.S. Attorney’s Office for the production of certain documents.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 18, 2004 related to a press release announcing a temporary cease  
trade order issued by the Ontario Securities Commission.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 25, 2004 related to the resignation of Frank Andrew Dunn as a  
director effective May 21, 2004.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 26, 2004 related to a press release announcing the appointment of  
The Hon. John Manley to the Nortel Networks Board of Directors.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 31, 2004 related to a press release announcing that Nortel  
Networks Limited had obtained a new waiver from Export Development Canada.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated June 2, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update on its  
financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated June 15, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update on its  
financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated June 23, 2004 related to a press release announcing court approval for  
extending the time for calling the 2004 Annual Shareholders’ Meeting.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated June 24, 2004 related to a letter received from the Toronto Stock  
Exchange advising of a breach of its financial statements filing requirements.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated June 29, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update on its  
financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 6, 2004 related to an agreement reached with Flextronics  
International Ltd.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 13, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update on its  
financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated July 27, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update on its  
financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated August 10, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update on  
its financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated August 17, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update of  
the RCMP review.  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated August 19, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update on  
its financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated August 20, 2004 related to a press release announcing a new waiver  
from Export Development Canada.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated September 2, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update  
on its financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated September 2, 2004 related to an employment agreement with William  
Owens, President and Chief Executive Officer.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated September 16, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update  
on its financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated September 30, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update  
on its financial restatement process and announcing that Nortel Networks Limited had obtained a new waiver from Export Development  
Canada.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K/A dated September 30, 2004 amending details of its previously announced  
work plan contained in a press release dated August 19, 2004.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 14, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update on  
its financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K/A dated October 18, 2004 amending certain information concerning the  
timing and implementation of certain matters under the existing agreement with Flextronics International Ltd. contained in a press release  
dated June 29, 2004.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 27, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update on  
its financial restatement process and other matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 2, 2004 related to a press release announcing a new waiver  
from Export Development Canada.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 12, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update  
on its financial restatement process and other matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 19, 2004 related to a press release announcing a new waiver  
from Export Development Canada.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 24, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update  
on its financial restatement process and other matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated November 30, 2004 updating certain information concerning on the  
Corporation’s Annual Shareholders’ Meeting.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 8, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update  
on its financial restatement process and other matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 10, 2004 related to a press release announcing a new waiver  
from Export Development Canada.  
Nortel Networks Limited filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 16, 2004 related to a press release providing limited estimated  
unaudited financial results for the third quarter of 2004, and updated limited estimated unaudited results for the first and second quarters of  
2004 and for the years 2001, 2002 and 2003.  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 22, 2004 related to a press release providing a status update  
on its financial restatement process and other related matters.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated January 4, 2005 related to a press release advising that the New York  
Stock Exchange has granted a three month extension to file the 2003 Annual Reports on Form 10-K with the Securities and Exchange  
Commission.  
Nortel Networks Corporation filed a Current Report on Form 8-K dated January 7, 2005 related to a press release providing a status update on  
its financial restatement process and other related matters.  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4.  
Exhibit Index  
The items listed as Exhibits 10.2 to 10.7, 10.27 to 10.45 and item 10.49 relate to management contracts or compensatory plans or  
arrangements.  
Exhibit  
Number  
Description  
*2.  
Amended and Restated Arrangement Agreement involving BCE Inc., Nortel Networks Corporation, formerly known as New  
Nortel Inc., and Nortel Networks Limited, formerly known as Nortel Networks Corporation, made as of January 26, 2000, as  
amended and restated March 13, 2000 (including Plan of Arrangement under Section 192 of the  
Canada Business Corporations  
) (filed as Exhibit 2.1 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated May 1, 2000).  
Act  
*3.1  
*3.2  
*4.1  
Restated Certificate and Articles of Incorporation of Nortel Networks Corporation (filed as Exhibit 3 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated October 18, 2000).  
By-Law No. 1 of Nortel Networks Corporation (filed as Exhibit 3.2 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-  
K for the year ended December 31, 2000).  
Shareholders Rights Plan Agreement dated as of March 13, 2000 between Nortel Networks Corporation and Montreal Trust  
Company of Canada, which includes the Form of Rights Certificate as Exhibit A thereto, as amended by the Registration  
Statement on Form 8-A/A filed on May 1, 2000, as further amended and restated by Registration Statement dated February 14,  
2003 (filed as Exhibit 3 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form 8-A/A filed on April 25, 2003).  
*4.2  
*4.3  
Indenture dated as of November 30, 1988, between Nortel Networks Limited and The Toronto-Dominion Bank Trust Company,  
as trustee, related to debt securities authenticated and delivered thereunder, which comprised the 6% Notes due September 1,  
2003, and the 6 7/8% Notes due September 1, 2023 issued by Nortel Networks Limited (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 1999).  
Indenture dated as of February 15, 1996, among Nortel Networks Limited, as issuer and guarantor, Nortel Networks Capital  
Corporation, formerly Northern Telecom Capital Corporation, as issuer, and The Bank of New York, as trustee, related to debt  
securities and guarantees authenticated and delivered thereunder, which comprised the 7.40% Notes due 2006 and the 7.875%  
Notes due 2026 (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-1720) of Nortel Networks Limited and  
Nortel Networks Capital Corporation).  
*4.4  
*4.5  
Indenture dated as of December 15, 2000 among Nortel Networks Limited, as issuer and guarantor, Nortel Networks Capital  
Corporation, as issuer, and Citibank, N.A., as trustee, related to debt securities authenticated and delivered thereunder (filed as  
Exhibit 4.1 to Registration Statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-51888) of Nortel Networks Limited and Nortel Networks Capital  
Corporation).  
First Supplemental Indenture dated as of February 1, 2001 to Indenture dated as of December 15, 2000 among Nortel Networks  
Limited, as issuer and guarantor, Nortel Networks Capital Corporation, as issuer, and Citibank, N.A., as trustee, related to 6.125%  
Notes due 2006 (filed as Exhibit 4.1 to Nortel Networks Limited’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated February 2, 2001).  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Number  
Description  
*4.6  
Instrument of Resignation, Appointment and Acceptance entered into as of December 19, 2002, effective as of January 2, 2003,  
among Nortel Networks Limited, as issuer and guarantor, Nortel Networks Capital Corporation, as issuer, Citibank, N.A. and  
Deutsche Bank Trust Company Americas, with respect to the Indenture dated as of December 5, 2000, as supplemented by a First  
Supplemental Indenture dated as of February 1, 2001 related to debt securities (filed as Exhibit 4.6 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002).  
*4.7  
Indenture dated as of August 15, 2001 between Nortel Networks Corporation, Nortel Networks Limited, as guarantor, and  
Bankers Trust Company, as trustee, related to convertible debt securities and guarantees authenticated and delivered thereunder,  
which comprised the 4.25% Convertible Senior Notes due 2008 (filed as Exhibit 4 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly  
Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2001).  
*10.1  
Third Amended and Restated Reciprocal Credit Agreement dated as of December 19, 2002 between Nortel Networks Corporation,  
Nortel Networks Limited and the other parties who have executed the agreement (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002).  
*10.2  
*10.3  
*10.4  
*10.5  
*10.6  
Nortel Networks Supplementary Executive Retirement Plan, as amended effective October 18, 2001 and October 23, 2002 (filed  
as Exhibit 10.2 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002).  
Agreement dated April 29, 1997 related to the remuneration of the Chief Legal Officer (filed as Exhibit 10.3 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001).  
Acknowledgement effective as of June 1, 2000 related to the remuneration of the Chief Legal Officer (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to  
Nortel Networks Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001).  
Statement describing the retirement arrangements of the former President and Chief Executive Officer (filed as Exhibit 10.5 to  
Nortel Networks Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001).  
Nortel Networks Corporation Executive Retention and Termination Plan, as amended and restated, effective from June 26, 2002  
(filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30,  
2002).  
*10.7  
*10.8  
Nortel Networks Corporation Special Retention Plan effective August 1, 2001 and expired on June 30, 2003 (filed as Exhibit 10.3  
to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2001).  
Purchase Contract and Unit Agreement dated as of June 12, 2002 among Nortel Networks Corporation, Computershare Trust  
Company of Canada, as purchase contract agent, and Holders (as defined therein) from time to time (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to  
Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2002).  
*10.9  
Five Year Credit Agreement dated as of April 12, 2000, among Nortel Networks Limited, as borrower, various banks, as lenders,  
Royal Bank of Canada and Toronto Dominion Bank, as co-syndication agents, and J.P. Morgan Canada, as administrative agent  
(filed as Exhibit 10.4 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2001).  
*10.10  
Five Year Credit Agreement dated as of April 12, 2000, among Nortel Networks Limited, as guarantor, Nortel Networks Inc., as  
borrower, various banks, as lenders, ABN AMRO Bank N.V., Bank of America N.A. and Citibank N.A., as co-syndication agents,  
and Morgan Guaranty Trust Company of New York, as administrative agent (which terminated on April 28, 2004) (filed as  
Exhibit 10.5 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2001).  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Number  
Description  
*10.11  
U.S. Guarantee and Security Agreement dated as of the first day of the “Collateral Period” (as defined therein) among Nortel  
Networks Limited, Nortel Networks Inc. and certain of their subsidiaries and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent (filed as  
Exhibit 99.1 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated January 18, 2002).  
*10.12  
*10.13  
*10.14  
*10.15  
*10.16  
*10.17  
*10.18  
Amendment No. 1 dated as of December 12, 2002 to the U.S. Guarantee and Security Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among  
Nortel Networks Limited, Nortel Networks Inc., the Subsidiary Lien Grantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as  
Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 99.2 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 13, 2002).  
Canadian Guarantee and Security Agreement dated as of the first day of the “Collateral Period” (as defined therein) among Nortel  
Networks Limited and certain of its subsidiaries and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 99.1 to Nortel  
Networks Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated February 4, 2002).  
Amendment No. 1 dated as of December 12, 2002 to the Canadian Guarantee and Security Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002  
among Nortel Networks Limited, Nortel Networks Inc., the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as  
Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 99.3 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 13, 2002).  
Form of Nortel Networks Limited Foreign Subsidiary Guarantee dated as of April 4, 2002 and schedule thereto listing the specific  
foreign subsidiary guarantees which are not attached as exhibits (filed as Exhibit 10.8 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly  
Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002).  
Amendment No. 1 dated as of December 12, 2002 to certain Foreign Subsidiary Guarantees dated as of April 4, 2002 among  
Nortel Networks (Ireland) Limited, Nortel Networks UK Limited, Nortel Networks (Asia) Limited and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as  
Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 99.4 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated December 13, 2002).  
Foreign Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel Networks Limited, the Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and  
JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 10.9 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-  
Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002).  
Foreign Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel Networks Limited, Nortel Networks International Corporation  
and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 10.10 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on  
Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002).  
*10.19  
*10.20  
Foreign Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel Networks Inc. and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent  
(filed as Exhibit 10.11 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002).  
Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel Networks Limited, Nortel Networks International Finance & Holding  
B.V., Nortel Networks S.A., and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 10.12 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002).  
*10.21  
Foreign Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel Networks International Finance & Holding B.V., Nortel  
Communications Holdings (1997) Limited, Nortel Networks AB and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent, together with  
(a) the Supplementing Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel Networks International Finance & Holding,  
B.V. and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent, (b) the Pledge Agreement Supplement dated as of April 4, 2002 between  
Nortel Networks Limited and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent, and (c) the Pledge Agreement Supplement dated as of  
April 4, 2002 between Nortel Networks U.K. Limited and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 10.13 to  
Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002).  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Number  
Description  
*10.22  
Foreign Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 between Nortel Networks International Finance & Holding B.V. and  
JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent, together with (a) the Pledge Agreement Supplement, dated as of April 4, 2002  
between Nortel Networks Optical Components Limited and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent, and (b) the Pledge  
Agreement Supplement dated as of April 4, 2002 between Nortel Networks International Finance & Holding B.V., Nortel  
Networks Optical Components Limited and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 10.14 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002).  
*10.23  
*10.24  
*10.25  
*10.26  
Pledge Agreement Supplement dated as of May 20, 2002 between Nortel Networks Mauritius Ltd and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as  
Collateral Agent supplementing the Foreign Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel Networks International  
Finance & Holding B.V., Nortel Communications Holdings (1997) Limited, Nortel Networks AB and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as  
Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 10.5 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended  
June 30, 2002).  
Pledge Agreement Supplement dated as of May 15, 2002 between Nortel Networks International Finance & Holding B.V. and  
JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent, supplementing the Foreign Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel  
Networks International Finance & Holding B.V., Nortel Communications Holdings (1997) Limited, Nortel Networks AB and  
JPMorgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 10.6 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-  
Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2002).  
Pledge Agreement Supplement dated as of June 4, 2002 between Nortel Networks Singapore Pte Ltd, and JPMorgan Chase Bank,  
as Collateral Agent, supplementing the Foreign Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel Networks International  
Finance & Holding B.V., Nortel Communications Holdings (1997) Limited, Nortel Networks AB and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as  
Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 10.7 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended  
June 30, 2002).  
Pledge Agreement Supplement dated as of May 15, 2002 between Nortel Networks Limited and JPMorgan Chase Bank, as  
Collateral Agent, supplementing the Foreign Pledge Agreement dated as of April 4, 2002 among Nortel Networks Limited, the  
Subsidiary Guarantors party thereto and JP Morgan Chase Bank, as Collateral Agent (filed as Exhibit 10.8 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2002).  
*10.27  
*10.28  
*10.29  
*10.30  
Nortel Networks Limited SUCCESS Plan as amended and restated on July 28, 2003 with effect from January 1, 2003 (filed as  
Exhibit 10.1 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2003).  
Supplementary Pension Credits Arrangement (filed as Exhibit 10.14 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Registration Statement on  
Form S-1 (No. 2-71087)).  
Statements describing the right of certain executives in Canada to defer all or part of their short-term and long-term incentive  
awards (filed as Exhibit 10.4 to Nortel Networks Limited’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2000).  
Statement describing eligibility for the Group Life Insurance Plan for directors who are not salaried employees of Nortel  
Networks Corporation (filed as Exhibit 10.30 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended  
December 31, 2002).  
10.31  
10.32  
Resolutions of the Board of Directors of Nortel Networks Corporation dated December 18, 2003, related to the remuneration of  
the chairman of the board, directors and chairman of the audit committee, effective January 1, 2004.  
Resolutions of the Board of Directors of Nortel Networks Limited dated December 18, 2003, related to the remuneration of the  
chairman of the board, directors and chairman of the audit committee, effective January 1, 2004.  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Number  
Description  
*10.33  
Resolutions of the Board of Directors of Nortel Networks Limited dated December 17, 1993, as amended by resolutions of the  
Board of Directors of Nortel Networks Limited dated February 29, 1996, providing for retirement compensation of directors who  
are not salaried employees of Nortel Networks Limited or its subsidiaries (filed as Exhibit 10.33 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s  
Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2002).  
*10.34  
*10.35  
*10.36  
Agreement between a director of Nortel Networks Corporation and Nortel Networks Limited and the respective companies dated  
June 22, 2001 setting forth the arrangements with respect to serving as non-executive chairman of each of the board of directors of  
Nortel Networks Corporation and Nortel Networks Limited (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly  
Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2001).  
Amended General description of cash bonus for employees and executives of Nortel Networks Corporation and Nortel Networks  
Limited as originally filed as Exhibit 10.5 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended  
September 30, 2002 (filed as Exhibit 10.01 to the Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter  
ended June 30, 2003).  
Nortel Networks Limited Restricted Stock Unit Plan dated as of January 30, 1997, as amended effective April 29, 1999,  
September 1, 1999, February 15, 2000, May 1, 2000, November 15, 2000 and January 23, 2003 (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Nortel  
Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2003).  
10.37  
10.38  
Nortel Networks Corporation Directors’ Deferred Share Compensation Plan effective January 1, 2002 as amended and restated  
May 29, 2003, as amended and restated December 18, 2003 effective January 1, 2004.  
Nortel Networks Limited Directors’ Deferred Share Compensation Plan effective June 30, 1998 as amended and restated May 1,  
2000, as further amended and restated effective January 1, 2002, as amended and restated May 29, 2003, as amended and restated  
December 18, 2003 effective January 1, 2004.  
*10.39  
Nortel Networks Corporation 1986 Stock Option Plan as Amended and Restated, as amended effective April 30, 1992, April 27,  
1995, December 28, 1995, April 8, 1998, February 25, 1999, April 29, 1999, September 1, 1999, December 16, 1999, May 1,  
2000 and January 31, 2002 (filed as Exhibit 10.1 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter  
ended March 31, 2002).  
*10.40  
*10.41  
Nortel Networks Corporation 2000 Stock Option Plan as amended effective May 1, 2000 and January 31, 2002 (filed as  
Exhibit 10.2 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2002).  
Nortel Networks NA Inc., formerly known as Bay Networks, Inc., 1994 Stock Option Plan as Amended and Restated, as amended  
effective May 1, 2000 (filed as Exhibit 4.3 to Post-Effective Amendment No. 2 on Form S-8 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s  
Registration Statement on Form S-4 (No. 333-9066)).  
*10.42  
*10.43  
*10.44  
Nortel Networks/BCE 1985 Stock Option Plan (Plan of Arrangement 2000) (filed as Exhibit 10.5 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2000).  
Nortel Networks/BCE 1999 Stock Option Plan (Plan of Arrangement 2000) (filed as Exhibit 10.6 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2000).  
Assumption Agreement between Nortel Networks Corporation and Nortel Networks Limited dated March 5, 2001, regarding the  
assumption and agreement by Nortel Networks Corporation to perform certain covenants and obligations of Nortel Networks  
Limited under the Nortel Networks Limited Executive Retention and Termination Plan (filed as Exhibit 10.25 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2000).  
*10.45  
Nortel Networks U.S. Deferred Compensation Plan (filed as Exhibit 4.3 to Post-Effective Amendment No. 1 to Nortel Networks  
Corporation’s Registration Statement on Form S-8 (No. 333-11558)).  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Number  
Description  
*10.46  
Master Facility Agreement dated as of February 14, 2003 between Nortel Networks Limited and Export Development Canada  
(filed as Exhibit 99.2 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated February 14, 2003).  
*10.47  
*10.48  
Master Indemnity Agreement dated as of February 14, 2003 between Nortel Networks Limited and Export Development Canada  
(filed as Exhibit 99.3 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Current Report on Form 8-K dated February 14, 2003).  
Amending Agreement No. 1 dated as of July 10, 2003 to the Master Facility Agreement dated as of February 14, 2003 between  
Nortel Networks Limited and Export Development Canada (filed as Exhibit 99.2 to Nortel Networks Corporation’s Current  
Report on Form 8-K dated July 10, 2003).  
*10.49  
Letter dated June 23, 2003 from the former, President and Chief Executive Officer of Nortel Networks, to the Joint Leadership  
Resources Committee of the Board of Directors of Nortel Networks Corporation and Nortel Networks Limited regarding the  
voluntary return for cancellation of certain stock options to purchase common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation (filed as  
Exhibit 10.4 to the Nortel Networks Corporation’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2003).  
21.  
23.1  
23.2  
24.  
Subsidiaries of the Registrant (see page • ).  
Consent of Deloitte & Touche LLP.  
Consent of Deloitte & Associes.  
Power of Attorney of certain directors and officers.  
Rule 13a — 14(a)/15d — 14(a) Certification of the President and Chief Executive Officer.  
Rule 13a — 14(a)/15d — 14(a) Certification of the Chief Financial Officer.  
31.1  
31.2  
32.  
Certification of the President and Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350 as  
adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002.  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS S.A.  
(A Subsidiary of Nortel Networks Limited)  
For the three years ended December 31, 2003  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM  
To the Shareholders and Board of Directors of Nortel Networks S.A.  
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Nortel Networks S.A., a subsidiary of Nortel Networks Limited, and its  
subsidiaries as of December 31, 2003 and 2002 and the related consolidated statements of operations, shareholders’ equity and cash flows for  
each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2003 (all expressed in Euros). These financial statements are the responsibility of  
Nortel Networks S.A. management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.  
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those  
standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material  
misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An  
audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall  
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.  
In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Nortel Networks S.A. and  
its subsidiaries as of December 31, 2003 and 2002 and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the  
period ended December 31, 2003 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.  
As described in note 3 to the consolidated financial statements, the accompanying consolidated financial statements of Nortel Networks S.A. as  
of December 31, 2002, and for each of the two years in the period then ended have been restated.  
As described in note 4 to the consolidated financial statements, effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. changed its method of  
accounting for stock-based compensation in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (“SFAS”) No. 148, “Accounting for  
Stock-based Compensation — Transition and Disclosure”. Also, as described in note 4, effective January 1, 2002, Nortel Networks S.A.  
changed its method of accounting for goodwill in accordance with SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets”.  
Deloitte & Associés  
(formerly Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu)  
Société de Commissaires aux Comptes  
/s/ Nicholas L.E. ROLT  
Neuilly, France  
January 10, 2005  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS S.A.  
(a Subsidiary of Nortel Networks Limited)  
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31  
(thousands of Euros)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
As restated*  
356,316  
As restated*  
767,713  
Revenues — external  
344,008  
515,478  
— related parties  
458,918  
439,072  
859,486  
657,128  
815,234  
600,367  
1,206,785  
1,116,766  
Cost of revenues  
Gross profit  
202,358  
214,867  
90,019  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Amortization of intangibles  
Acquired technology and other  
Goodwill  
70,274  
236,967  
69,482  
264,275  
175,433  
249,603  
255  
3,434  
Special charges  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
24,563  
13,883  
83,427  
16,171  
20,607  
74,772  
(10,243)  
Operating earnings (loss)  
(143,584)  
(218,488)  
(423,587)  
Other income (expense) — net  
Foreign exchange gain (loss)  
Interest expense  
2,015  
1,043  
(3,221)  
23,038  
(5,531)  
(9,885)  
53,998  
(1,710)  
(11,286)  
Earnings (loss) before income taxes and minority interest  
Minority interest  
(143,747)  
(756)  
(210,866)  
3,052  
(382,585)  
8,973  
Income tax benefit  
5,614  
1,640  
34,073  
Net earnings (loss)  
(138,889)  
(206,174)  
(339,539)  
* See note 3  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS S.A.  
(a Subsidiary of Nortel Networks Limited)  
Consolidated Balance Sheets as at December 31  
(thousands of Euros)  
2003  
2002  
As restated*  
ASSETS  
Current assets  
Cash and cash equivalents  
74,352  
113,411  
66,197  
150,419  
83,955  
80,070  
Accounts receivable (less provisions of 19,324 for 2003, 32,499 for 2002)  
Inventories — net  
Receivables from related parties  
Other current assets  
254,697  
17,469  
234,071  
106,364  
526,126  
654,879  
Total current assets  
Long-term receivable from related party  
Investments at cost  
Plant and equipment — net  
Goodwill  
Intangible assets — net  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other assets  
140,010  
16,176  
218,121  
3,454  
43,268  
6
184,169  
19,683  
8,929  
47,510  
786,417  
1,075,914  
Total assets  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Current liabilities  
Note payable to related party  
Trade and other accounts payable  
Payables to related parties  
Payroll and benefit-related liabilities  
Contractual liabilities  
Restructuring  
Other accrued liabilities  
Long-term debt due within one year  
160  
141,799  
32,002  
68,960  
23,822  
9,224  
91,151  
89,326  
50,809  
37,818  
13,346  
174,260  
3,073  
105,739  
3,241  
384,947  
459,783  
Total current liabilities  
Other liabilities  
Long-term deferred income  
Long-term debt  
9,615  
18,092  
73,217  
70,000  
2,837  
17,231  
76,457  
220,000  
Long-term note payable to related party  
555,871  
776,308  
9,757  
Total liabilities  
Minority interest  
Commitments (note 13)  
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Common shares, 0.005 par value — Authorized shares: unlimited;  
Issued and outstanding: 91,308,951 for 2003 and 61,308,951 for 2002  
Additional paid-in capital  
456,544  
(26,417)  
(199,581)  
306,544  
43,997  
(60,692)  
Accumulated deficit  
230,546  
786,417  
289,849  
Total shareholders’ equity  
1,075,914  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity  
* See note 3  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS S.A.  
(a Subsidiary of Nortel Networks Limited)  
Consolidated Statements of Shareholders’ Equity  
Additional  
Retained  
earnings  
(deficit)  
Total  
shareholders’  
equity  
Common  
shares  
paid-in  
capital  
(thousands of Euros)  
35,762  
202,171  
148,039  
(35,773)  
(339,539)  
385,972  
(35,773)  
(339,539)  
Balance at December 31, 2000 as restated*  
Payment of dividends  
Net earnings (loss)  
35,762  
485,363  
(214,581)  
202,171  
(227,273)  
372,755  
(206,174)  
10,660  
485,363  
Balance at December 31, 2001 as restated*  
Common shares issued  
Capital restructuring  
(158,174)  
Net earnings (loss)  
(206,174)  
306,544  
150,000  
43,997  
(60,692)  
289,849  
150,000  
1,333  
(83,800)  
(31,017)  
43,070  
Balance at December 31, 2002 as restated*  
Common shares issued  
Stock based compensation  
Acquisition of Northern Telecom France  
Acquisition of Nortel Networks France  
Gain on related party transactions  
Net earnings (loss)  
1,333  
(83,800)  
(31,017)  
43,070  
(138,889)  
(138,889)  
456,544  
(26,417)  
(199,581)  
230,546  
Balance at December 31, 2003  
* See note 3  
A Statement of Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) has not been presented as there are no other comprehensive income (loss) items.  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS S.A.  
(a Subsidiary of Nortel Networks Limited)  
Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31  
(thousands of Euros)  
2003  
2002  
2001  
As restated*  
As restated*  
Cash flows from (used in) operating activities  
Net loss  
(138,889)  
(206,174)  
(339,539)  
Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash from (used in) operating activities:  
Amortization and depreciation  
Non-cash portion of special charges and related assets write down  
63,536  
(4,242)  
13,883  
45,964  
50,060  
20,607  
(37,249)  
5,997  
(16,240)  
(3,728)  
16,171  
Deferred income taxes  
(Gain) loss on disposal of assets  
(Gain) loss on disposal of investments  
Current and deferred stock option compensation  
Changes in operating assets and liabilities:  
Accounts receivable  
Receivables from related parties  
Inventories  
Accounts payable and accrued liabilities  
Payables to related parties  
1,333  
(29,456)  
27,947  
13,873  
(17,843)  
(57,165)  
4
22,451  
246,248  
31,612  
(25,908)  
(437,236)  
(161)  
124,235  
24,699  
40,672  
(179,972)  
257,754  
(27,416)  
44,679  
Income taxes  
Other operating assets and liabilities  
89,510  
(36,488)  
Net cash used in operating activities  
(37,509)  
(347,249)  
(31,713)  
Cash flows from (used in) investing activities  
Expenditures for plant and equipment  
Expenditure for investments  
(41,246)  
(154,192)  
58,940  
596  
(57,631)  
(2,490)  
9,909  
754  
(108,601)  
(9,296)  
23,834  
8,855  
(6,614)  
Proceeds on disposal of investments  
Proceeds on disposal of plant and equipment  
Divestiture of investments & businesses — net cash divested  
Increase (decrease) in other financial assets  
9,147  
(7,147)  
Net cash used in investing activities  
(126,755)  
(56,605)  
(91,822)  
Cash flows from (used in) financing activities  
Issuance of common shares  
(Increase) decrease in receivables from related parties — net  
Increase (decrease) in notes payable to related parties — net  
(Increase) decrease in long-term receivables  
Increase (decrease) in notes payable  
204,363  
(142,329)  
320,000  
(3,295)  
2,319  
181,000  
531  
4,750  
(29,736)  
91,437  
(3,240)  
Dividend paid  
Net cash from financing activities  
88,197  
378,739  
(25,115)  
158,864  
35,329  
(76,067)  
Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents  
150,419  
74,352  
175,534  
150,419  
140,205  
175,534  
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year  
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year  
* See note 3  
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these financial statements  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
NORTEL NETWORKS S.A.  
(a Subsidiary of Nortel Networks Limited)  
Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements  
(thousands of euros, unless otherwise stated)  
1. Nortel Networks S.A.  
All of the shares of Nortel Networks S.A. are owned by Nortel Networks Limited (“Nortel Networks”) and Nortel Networks International  
Finance & Holding B.V. (“NNIF&H B.V.”), which is an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of Nortel Networks. Nortel Networks S.A.  
(formerly known as Nortel Matra Cellular SCA) is a French société anonyme (limited liability company) established in 1992. Nortel  
Networks S.A. develops wireless network equipment for Nortel Networks customers. This includes the engineering, configuration and  
implementation of various Nortel Networks products for wireless network applications.  
On June 24, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. acquired the outstanding shares of Northern Telecom France S.A. (“Northern Telecom France”)  
from Nortel Networks Inc. (“NNI”), a subsidiary of Nortel Networks (see note 9). Northern Telecom France is a holding company that  
was then holding interests of 17.8 percent in Nortel Networks France S.A.S. (“Nortel Networks France”) and 13.2 percent in EADS  
Telecom S.A.S., formerly EADS Defence and Security Networks S.A.S. (“EADS Telecom”).  
On December 18, 2003, through a series of transactions Nortel Networks S.A. acquired all outstanding shares of Nortel Networks France  
not already under its control from Nortel Networks and from NNIF&H B.V. (see note 9). Nortel Networks France primarily distributes  
Wireline, Optical and Enterprise products of Nortel Networks in France either directly or through various distribution channels.  
2. Significant accounting policies  
Basis of presentation  
The consolidated financial statements of Nortel Networks S.A. have been prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally  
accepted in the United States (“U.S.”) (“GAAP”) and the rules and regulations of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the  
“SEC”) for the preparation of financial statements.  
Nortel Networks S.A. and certain affiliates entered into a series of complex transactions during the periods presented that constituted a  
reorganization and transfers of share ownership of entities under common control (see note 9). The transactions have been accounted for  
at historical cost in a manner similar to a pooling of interest, and in accordance with Statement of Financial Accounting Standards  
(“SFAS”) No. 141 “Business Combinations” (“SFAS 141”) all prior period financial statements presented have been restated as if the  
reorganization took place at the beginning of such periods.  
As described in note 3, the consolidated statements of operations, shareholders’ equity and cash flows for the years ended December 31,  
2002 and 2001 and the consolidated balance sheet as of December 31, 2002, including the applicable notes, were restated.  
These financial statements have been prepared on the basis that Nortel Networks S.A. is a going concern. Nortel Networks S.A. has  
received a pledge of support from Nortel Networks.  
(a) Principles of consolidation  
The financial statements of entities which are controlled by Nortel Networks S.A. through voting equity interests, referred to as  
subsidiaries, are consolidated. Entities which are jointly controlled, referred to as joint ventures, and entities which are not  
controlled but over which Nortel Networks S.A. has the ability to exercise significant influence, referred to as associated  
companies, are accounted for using the equity method. Variable Interest Entities (“VIEs”) (which include, but are not limited to,  
special purpose entities, trusts, partnerships, certain joint ventures and other legal structures), as defined by the Financial  
Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) in FASB Interpretation (“FIN”) No. 46 (Revised 2003), “Consolidation of Variable Interest  
Entities — an Interpretation of Accounting Research Bulletin No. 51” (“FIN 46R”), are entities in which equity investors do not  
have the characteristics of a “controlling financial interest” or there is not sufficient equity at risk for the entity to finance its  
activities without additional subordinated financial support. VIEs are consolidated by Nortel Networks S.A. when it is determined,  
that it will, as the primary beneficiary, absorb the majority of the VIEs expected losses and/or  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
expected residual returns. Intercompany accounts and transactions are eliminated upon consolidation and unrealized intercompany  
gains and losses are eliminated when accounting under the equity method.  
(b) Use of estimates  
Nortel Networks S.A. makes estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of  
contingent assets and liabilities as of the date of the consolidated financial statements and the reported amounts of revenues and  
expenses during the reporting period. Actual results may differ from those estimates. Estimates are used when accounting for items  
and matters such as revenue recognition, allowances for uncollectible accounts receivable and customer financing, receivables  
sales, inventory obsolescence, product warranty, amortization, asset valuations, impairment assessments, employee benefits, taxes,  
restructuring and other provisions, stock-based compensation and contingencies.  
(c) Translation of foreign currencies  
The functional currency of Nortel Networks S.A. is the euro.  
Transactions and financial statement items denominated in a currency other than the euro are translated into euros at the exchange  
rates in effect at the balance sheet dates for monetary assets and liabilities, and at historical exchange rates for non-monetary assets  
and liabilities. Revenue and expenses are translated at average rates for the period, except for amortization and depreciation which  
are translated on the same basis as the related assets. Resulting translation gains or losses are reflected in net earnings (loss).  
(d) Revenue recognition  
Nortel Networks S.A. products and services are generally sold as part of a contract and the terms of the contracts, taken as a whole,  
determine the appropriate revenue recognition methods.  
Depending upon the terms of the contract and types of products and services sold, Nortel Networks S.A. recognizes revenue under  
American Institute of Certified Public Accountants Statement of Position (“SOP”) 81-1, “Accounting for Performance of  
Construction-Type and Certain Production-Type Contracts” (“SOP 81-1”), SOP 97-2, “Software Revenue Recognition” (“SOP 97-  
2”), and SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin (“SAB”) 104, “Revenue Recognition” (“SAB 104”), which was preceded by SAB 101,  
“Revenue Recognition in Financial Statements” (“SAB 101”). Revenue is recognized net of cash discounts and allowances.  
Effective July 1, 2003, for contracts involving multiple deliverables, where the deliverables are governed by more than one  
authoritative accounting standard, Nortel Networks S.A. generally applies the FASB Emerging Issues Task Force (“EITF”) Issue  
No. 00-21, “Revenue Arrangements with Multiple Deliverables” (“EITF 00-21”), and evaluates each deliverable to determine  
whether it represents a separate unit of accounting based on the following criteria: (a) whether the delivered item has value to the  
customer on a standalone basis, (b) whether there is objective and reliable evidence of the fair value of the undelivered item(s), and  
(c) if the contract includes a general right of return relative to the delivered item, delivery or performance of the undelivered item(s)  
is considered probable and substantially in the control of Nortel Networks S.A. If objective and reliable evidence of fair value exists  
for all units of accounting in the contract, revenue is allocated to each unit of accounting or element based on relative fair values. In  
situations where there is objective and reliable evidence of fair value for all undelivered elements, but not for delivered elements,  
the residual method is used to allocate the contract consideration. Under the residual method, the amount of revenue allocated to  
delivered elements equals the total arrangement consideration less the aggregate fair value of any undelivered elements. Each unit  
of accounting is then accounted for under the applicable revenue recognition guidance.  
For arrangements that include hardware and software where software is considered more than incidental to the hardware, provided  
that the software is not essential to the functionality of the hardware and the hardware and software represent separate units of  
accounting, revenue related to the software element is recognized under SOP 97-2 and revenue related to the hardware element is  
recognized under SOP 81-1 or SAB 104. For arrangements where the software is considered more than incidental and essential to  
the functionality of the hardware, or where the hardware is not considered a separate unit of accounting from the software  
deliverables, revenue is recognized for the software and the hardware as a single unit of accounting pursuant to SOP 97-2 for off-  
the-shelf products and pursuant to SOP 81-1 for customized products.  
Prior to July 1, 2003, for contracts involving multiple elements, Nortel Networks S.A. allocated revenue to each element based on  
the relative fair value or the residual method, as applicable. Provided none of the undelivered elements are essential to the  
functionality of the delivered elements, revenue related to the software element is  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
recognized under SOP 97-2 and revenue related to the hardware element is recognized under SOP 81-1 or SAB 101.  
For accounting units related to customized network solutions and certain network build outs, revenues are recognized under SOP  
81-1 using the percentage-of-completion method. In using the percentage-of-completion method, revenues are generally recorded  
based on a measure of the percentage of costs incurred to date on a contract relative to the estimated total expected contract costs.  
Profit estimates on long-term contracts are revised periodically based on changes in circumstances and any losses on contracts are  
recognized in the period that such losses become known. Generally, the terms of long-term contracts provide for progress billing  
based on completion of certain phases of work. Contract revenues recognized, based on costs incurred towards the completion of  
the project, that are unbilled are accumulated in the contracts in progress account included in accounts receivable — net. Billings in  
excess of revenues recognized to date on long-term contracts are recorded as advance billings in excess of revenues within other  
accrued liabilities.  
Revenue for hardware that does not require significant customization, and where any software is considered incidental, is  
recognized under SAB 104. Under SAB 104, revenue is recognized provided that persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists,  
delivery has occurred or services have been rendered, the fee is fixed or determinable, and collectibility is reasonably assured. For  
hardware, delivery is considered to have occurred upon shipment provided that risk of loss, and title in certain jurisdictions, have  
been transferred to the customer.  
Engineering, installation and other service revenues are recognized as the services are performed.  
Nortel Networks S.A. makes certain sales through multiple distribution channels, primarily resellers and distributors. These  
customers are generally given certain rights of return. For products sold through these distribution channels, revenue is recognized  
from product sale at the time of shipment to the distribution channel when persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists, delivery  
has occurred, the fee is fixed or determinable and collection is reasonably assured. Accruals for estimated sales returns and other  
allowances are recorded at the time of revenue recognition and are based on contract terms and prior claims experience.  
Software revenue is generally recognized under SOP 97-2. For software arrangements involving multiple elements, Nortel  
Networks allocates revenue to each element based on the relative fair value or the residual method, as applicable, and using vendor  
specific objective evidence of fair values, which is based on prices charged when the element is sold separately. Software revenue  
accounted for under SOP 97-2 is recognized when: persuasive evidence of an arrangement exists; the software is delivered in  
accordance with all terms and conditions of the customer contracts; the fee is fixed or determinable; and collection is reasonably  
assured. Revenue related to post-contract support, including technical support and unspecified when-and-if available software  
upgrades (“PCS”), is recognized ratably over the PCS term. Nortel Networks S.A. provides extended payment terms on certain  
software contracts and may sell these receivables to third parties. The fees on these contracts are considered fixed or determinable if  
the contracts are similar to others for which Nortel Networks S.A. has a standard business practice of providing extended payment  
terms and has a history of successfully collecting under the original payment terms without making concessions.  
Under SAB 104 or SOP 97-2, if fair value does not exist for any undelivered element, revenue is not recognized until the earlier of  
(i) the undelivered element is delivered or (ii) fair value of the undelivered element exists, unless the undelivered element is a  
service, in which case revenue is recognized as the service is performed once the service is the only undelivered element.  
(e) Research and development  
Research and development (“R&D”) costs are charged to net earnings (loss) in the periods in which they are incurred. However,  
costs incurred pursuant to specific contracts with third parties for which Nortel Networks S.A. is obligated to deliver a product are  
charged to cost of revenues in the same period as the related revenue is recognized. Related global investment tax credits are  
deducted from the income tax provision.  
(f) Income taxes  
Nortel Networks S.A. provides for income taxes using the asset and liability method. This approach recognizes the amount of taxes  
payable or refundable for the current year as well as deferred tax assets and liabilities for the future tax consequence of events  
recognized in the consolidated financial statements and tax returns. Deferred income taxes are adjusted to reflect the effects of  
changes in tax laws or enacted tax rates.  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In establishing the appropriate income tax valuation allowances, Nortel Networks S.A. assesses the realizability of its net deferred  
tax assets and based on all available evidence, both positive and negative, determines whether it is more likely than not that the  
remaining net deferred tax assets or a portion thereof will be realized.  
(g) Cash and cash equivalents  
Cash and cash equivalents consist of cash on hand, balances with banks and short-term investments. All highly liquid investments  
with original maturities of three months or less are classified as cash and cash equivalents. The fair value of cash and cash  
equivalents approximates the amounts shown in the consolidated financial statements.  
(h) Provision for doubtful accounts  
The provision for doubtful accounts for trade, notes and long-term receivables due from customers is established based on an  
assessment of a customer’s credit quality, as well as subjective factors and trends, including the aging of receivable balances.  
Generally, these credit assessments occur prior to the inception of the credit exposure and at regular reviews during the life of the  
exposure.  
(i) Inventories  
Inventories are valued at the lower of cost (calculated generally on a first-in, first-out basis) or market. The cost of finished goods  
and work in process is comprised of material, labor and manufacturing overhead. Provisions for inventory are based on estimates of  
future customer demand for products, including general economic conditions, growth prospects within the customer’s ultimate  
marketplaces and market acceptance of current and pending products. In addition, full provisions are generally recorded for surplus  
inventory in excess of one year’s forecast demand or inventory deemed obsolete.  
(j) Receivables sales  
Transfers of accounts receivable that meet the criteria for surrender of control under FASB Statement of Financial Accounting  
Standard (“SFAS”) No. 140, “Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities”, are  
accounted for as sales. Generally, Nortel Networks S.A. retains servicing rights and, in some cases, provides limited recourse when  
it sells receivables. A gain or loss is recorded in other income (expense) — net at the date of the receivables sale and is based upon,  
in part, the previous carrying amount of the receivables involved in the transfer allocated between the assets sold and the retained  
interests based on their relative fair value at the date of the transfer. Fair value is generally estimated based on the present value of  
the estimated future cash flows expected under management’s assumptions, including discount rates assigned commensurate with  
risks. Retained interests are classified as available for sale securities.  
Nortel Networks S.A., when acting as the servicing agent, generally does not record an asset or liability related to servicing as the  
annual servicing fees are equivalent to those that would be paid to a third party servicing agent. Certain transactions will enable  
Nortel Networks S.A., when acting as the servicing agent, to receive a servicing bonus at the maturity of the transaction if certain  
performance criteria are met. The ultimate collection of servicing bonuses is based primarily on the collectibility and credit  
experience of the receivables sold and is sometimes paid at the discretion of the transferee. Nortel Networks S.A. initially records  
the non-discretionary servicing bonus at fair value which is the discounted value of the estimated future cash flows taking into  
consideration future estimated interest rates and credit losses. Generally, the discretionary servicing bonus is initially recorded at a  
fair value of nil due to the fact that it is paid at the discretion of the transferee and based on the determination that future credit  
losses will offset any such servicing bonus. Nortel Networks S.A. reviews the fair value assigned to retained interests, including the  
servicing bonus, at each reporting date subsequent to the date of the transfer to determine if there is an other than temporary  
impairment. Fair value is reviewed using similar valuation techniques as those used to initially measure the retained interest and, if  
a change in events or circumstances warrants, the fair value is adjusted and any other than temporary impairments are recorded in  
other income (expense) — net.  
(k) Investments  
Investments in equity securities of companies over which Nortel Networks S.A. does not exert significant influence are accounted  
for using the cost method. Nortel Networks S.A. monitors its investments for factors indicating other than temporary impairment  
and records a charge to net earnings (loss) when appropriate.  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(l) Plant and equipment  
Plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is generally calculated on a straight-line basis  
over the expected useful lives of the plant and equipment. The expected useful lives of buildings are twenty to forty years, and of  
machinery and equipment are five to ten years.  
(m) Impairment or disposal of long-lived assets (plant and equipment and other intangible assets)  
Long-lived assets held and used  
Nortel Networks S.A. tests long-lived assets or asset groups held and used for recoverability when events or changes in  
circumstances indicate that their carrying amount may not be recoverable. Circumstances which could trigger a review include, but  
are not limited to: significant decreases in the market price of the asset; significant adverse changes in the business climate or legal  
factors; the accumulation of costs significantly in excess of the amount originally expected for the acquisition or construction of the  
asset; current period cash flow or operating losses combined with a history of losses or a forecast of continuing losses associated  
with the use of the asset; and a current expectation that the asset will more likely than not be sold or disposed of significantly before  
the end of its estimated useful life.  
Recoverability is assessed based on the carrying amount of the asset and the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected to result  
from the use and the eventual disposal of the asset or asset group. An impairment loss is recognized when the carrying amount is  
not recoverable and exceeds the fair value of the asset or asset group. The impairment loss is measured as the amount by which the  
carrying amount exceeds fair value.  
Long-lived assets held for sale  
Long-lived assets are classified as held for sale when certain criteria are met, which include: management’s commitment to a plan  
to sell the assets; the availability of the assets for immediate sale in their present condition; whether an active program to locate  
buyers and other actions to sell the assets have been initiated; whether the sale of the assets is probable and their transfer is expected  
to qualify for recognition as a completed sale within one year; whether the assets are being marketed at reasonable prices in relation  
to their fair value; and how unlikely it is that significant changes will be made to the plan to sell the assets.  
Nortel Networks S.A. measures long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less cost to  
sell. These assets are not depreciated. Fair value is determined using quoted market prices or the anticipated cash flows discounted  
at a rate commensurate with the risk involved.  
Long-lived assets to be disposed of other than by sale  
Nortel Networks S.A. classifies assets that will be disposed of other than by sale as held and used until the disposal transaction  
occurs. The assets continue to be depreciated based on revisions to their estimated useful lives until the date of disposal or  
abandonment.  
Recoverability is assessed based on the carrying amount of the asset and the sum of the undiscounted cash flows expected to result  
from the remaining period of use and the eventual disposal of the asset or asset group. An impairment loss is recognized when the  
carrying amount is not recoverable and exceeds the fair value of the asset or asset group. The impairment loss is measured as the  
amount by which the carrying amount exceeds fair value.  
(n) Goodwill  
Goodwill represents the excess of the purchase price of an acquired enterprise over the fair value of the identifiable assets acquired  
and liabilities assumed. Nortel Networks S.A. tests for impairment of goodwill on an annual basis as of October 1 and at any other  
time if events occur or circumstances change that would indicate that it is more likely than not that the fair value of the reporting  
unit has been reduced below its carrying amount (see note 4(i)).  
Circumstances that could trigger an impairment test include: a significant adverse change in the business climate or legal factors; an  
adverse action or assessment by a regulator; unanticipated competition; the loss of key personnel; the likelihood that a reporting  
unit or significant portion of a reporting unit will be sold or otherwise disposed of; the results of testing for recoverability of a  
significant asset group within a reporting unit; and the recognition of a goodwill impairment loss in the financial statements of a  
subsidiary that is a component of a reporting unit.  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The impairment test for goodwill is a two-step process. Step one consists of a comparison of the fair value of a reporting unit with  
its carrying amount, including the goodwill allocated to the reporting unit. Measurement of the fair value of a reporting unit is based  
on one or more fair value measures including present value techniques of estimated future cash flows and estimated amounts at  
which the unit as a whole could be bought or sold in a current transaction between willing parties. If the carrying amount of the  
reporting unit exceeds the fair value, step two requires the fair value of the reporting unit to be allocated to the underlying assets  
and liabilities of that reporting unit, resulting in an implied fair value of goodwill. If the carrying amount of the reporting unit  
goodwill exceeds the implied fair value of that goodwill, an impairment loss equal to the excess is recorded in net earnings (loss).  
(o) Intangible assets  
The intangible assets are comprised principally of customer related intangibles which are amortized over their estimated useful lives  
of approximately nine years.  
(p) Warranty costs  
As part of the normal sale of product, Nortel Networks S.A. provides its customers with product warranties that extend for periods  
generally ranging from one to six years from the date of sale. A liability for the expected cost of warranty-related claims is  
established when products are sold. In estimating warranty liability, historical material replacement costs and the associated labor to  
correct the product defect are considered. Revisions are made when actual experience differs materially from historical experience.  
Known product defects are specifically accrued for as Nortel Networks S.A. becomes aware of such defects.  
(q) State sponsored pension plans  
All employees are covered for pension entitlements under state sponsored pension plans, funded by regular contributions that are  
reflected in net earnings (loss).  
(r) Financial instruments  
The financial instruments that may subject Nortel Networks S.A. to concentrations of credit risk are principally comprised of cash  
and cash equivalents and trade accounts receivable. The carrying values of monetary assets and liabilities approximate their fair  
value. Cash and cash equivalents are, when not held with related parties, for the most part held by three major financial institutions.  
Deposits held with banks may exceed the amount of insurance provided on such deposits. These deposits may generally be  
redeemed upon demand. Nortel Networks S.A. customer base is dispersed across the main Western European countries. Nortel  
Networks S.A. performs ongoing credit evaluations of its customers and maintains an allowance for potential credit losses for sales  
in high-risk countries.  
(s) Stock-based compensation  
In December 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 148, “Accounting for Stock-Based Compensation - Transition and Disclosure — an  
Amendment of FASB Statement No. 123” (“SFAS 148”), which amended the transitional provisions of SFAS No. 123,  
“Accounting for Stock-based Compensation” (“SFAS 123”), for companies electing to recognize employee stock-based  
compensation using the fair value based method.  
Prior to January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A., as permitted under SFAS 123, applied the intrinsic value method under Accounting  
Principles Board Opinion (“APB”) No. 25, “Accounting for Stock Issued to Employees” (“APB 25”), and related interpretations in  
accounting for its employee stock-based compensation plans.  
Effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. elected to expense employee stock-based compensation using the fair value based  
method prospectively for all awards granted, modified, or settled on or after January 1, 2003. The fair value at grant date of stock  
options is estimated using the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. Compensation expense is recognized on a straight line basis  
over the stock option vesting period. The impact of the adoption of the fair value based method for expense recognition of  
employee awards resulted in 1,333 (net of tax of nil) of stock option expense during 2003.  
Stock-based awards that are settled or may be settled in cash or shares purchased on the open market at the option of employees or  
directors are recorded as liabilities. The measurement of the liability and compensation cost for these awards is based on the  
intrinsic value of the award and is recorded in net earnings (loss) over the vesting period of the award. Changes in Nortel Networks  
payment obligation subsequent to vesting of the award and prior  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
to the settlement date are recorded in net earnings (loss) in the period incurred. The payment amount is established for Stock  
Appreciation Rights (“SARs”) on the date of exercise of the award by the employee, for Restricted Stock Units (“RSUs”) on the  
vesting date of the award. Stock-based awards which are substantively discretionary in nature are recorded in the period that the  
issuance and settlement of the award is approved.  
Under various stock option programs of Nortel Networks Corporation (“NNC”), the ultimate parent company of Nortel Networks  
S.A., options may be granted to various eligible employees and directors of Nortel Networks S.A. to purchase common shares of  
Nortel Networks Corporation.  
NNC has stock purchase plans for eligible employees in eligible countries (including France), to facilitate the acquisition of the  
common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation at a discount (“ESPPs”). Nortel Networks S.A. contribution to the ESPPs is  
recorded as compensation expense on a quarterly basis as the obligation to contribute is incurred.  
Had Nortel Networks S.A. applied the fair value based method to all stock-based awards in all periods, reported net earnings  
(loss) would have been adjusted to the pro forma amounts indicated below for the following years ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Net earnings (loss) — reported  
Stock-based compensation — reported  
Stock-based compensation — pro forma  
(138,889)  
2,133  
(10,435)  
(206,174)  
463  
(34,685)  
(339,539)  
917  
(45,134)  
(a)  
(b)  
Net earnings (loss) — pro forma  
(147,191)  
(240,396)  
(383,756)  
(a)  
(b)  
Stock-based compensation — reported, included, for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001:  
i.  
Stock option expense of 1,333, nil and nil, respectively, which was net of tax of nil in each period;  
ii.  
iii.  
Employer portion of ESPPs contributions expense of 314, 463 and 917, respectively, which was net of tax of 25, 51 and 72, respectively;  
RSUs expense of 486, nil and nil, respectively, which was net of tax of 98, nil and nil respectively.  
Stock-based compensation — pro forma expense for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, which was net of tax of nil.  
The following weighted average assumptions were used in computing the fair value of stock options for purposes of expense  
recognition and pro forma disclosures, as applicable, for the following periods:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Black-Scholes weighted-average assumptions  
Expected dividend yield  
Expected volatility  
Risk-free interest rate  
Expected option life in years  
0.00%  
92.49%  
2.81%  
4
0.00%  
71.33%  
4.49%  
4
0.00%  
70.36%  
4.49%  
4
$
1.6  
$
3.5  
$
8.4  
Weighted-average stock option fair value per option granted (U.S.$)  
(t) Recent accounting pronouncements  
In March 2004, the EITF reached consensus on Issue No. 03-1, “The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its  
Application to Certain Investments” (“EITF 03-1”). EITF 03-1 provides guidance on determining when an investment is considered  
impaired, whether that impairment is other than temporary and the measurement of an impairment loss. EITF 03-1 is applicable to  
marketable debt and equity securities within the scope of SFAS No. 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity  
Securities” (“SFAS 115”), and SFAS No. 124, “Accounting for Certain Investments Held by Not-for-Profit Organizations”, and  
equity securities that are not subject to the scope of SFAS 115 and not accounted for under the equity method of accounting. In  
September 2004, the FASB issued FSP EITF 03-1-1, “Effective Date of Paragraphs 10-20 of EITF Issue No. 03-1, “The Meaning  
of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its Application to Certain Investments”, which delays the effective date for the  
measurement and recognition criteria contained in EITF 03-1 until final application guidance is issued. The delay does not suspend  
the requirement to recognize other-than-temporary impairments as required by existing authoritative literature. The adoption of  
EITF 03-1 is not expected to have a material impact on Nortel Networks S.A. results of operations and financial position.  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Comparative figures  
Certain 2002 and 2001 figures in the consolidated financial statements have been reclassified to conform to the 2003 presentation and  
have been restated as set out in note 3.  
3. Restatement  
First Restatement  
In May 2003, NNC and its subsidiaries (including Nortel Networks S.A.) commenced certain balance sheet reviews at the direction of  
certain members of former management that led to a comprehensive review and analysis of its assets and liabilities (the “Comprehensive  
Review”), which resulted in the restatement (effected in December 2003) of its consolidated financial statements for the years ended  
December 31, 2002, 2001 and 2000 and for the quarters ended March 31, 2003 and June 30, 2003 (the “First Restatement”).  
The Comprehensive Review purported to (i) identify balance sheet accounts that, as of June 30, 2003, were not supportable and required  
adjustment; (ii) determine whether such adjustments related to the third quarter of 2003 or prior periods; and (iii) document certain  
account balances in accordance with NNC accounting policies and procedures. The Comprehensive Review, as supplemented by  
additional procedures carried out between July 2003 and November 2003 to quantify the effects of potential adjustments in the relevant  
periods and review the appropriateness of releases of certain contractual liability and other related provisions (also called accruals,  
reserves or accrued liabilities) in the six fiscal quarters ending with the fiscal quarter ended June 30, 2003, formed the basis for the  
adjustments made to the financial statements in the First Restatement.  
On December 23, 2003, NNC filed with the SEC an amended Annual Report on Form 10-K/A for the year ended December 31, 2002 (the  
“2002 Form 10-K/A”) and amended Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q/A for the first and second quarters of 2003 (the “2003 Form 10-  
Q/As”) reflecting the First Restatement. As disclosed in those reports, the net effect of the First Restatement adjustments for Nortel  
Networks S.A. was a reduction in accumulated deficit of 27,835 and 6,022 as of December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively, and a  
reduction in the accumulated retained earnings of 1,975 as of December 31, 2000.  
Second Restatement  
In late October 2003, the Audit Committee of NNC’s and Nortel Networks’s Boards of Directors (the “Audit Committee”) initiated an  
independent review of the facts and circumstances leading to the First Restatement (the “Independent Review”) and engaged the law firm  
now known as Wilmer Cutler Pickering Hale & Dorr LLP (“WCPHD”) to advise it in connection with the Independent Review. The  
Audit Committee sought to gain a full understanding of the events that caused significant excess liabilities to be maintained on the  
balance sheet that needed to be restated, and to recommend that the Board adopt, and direct management to implement, necessary  
remedial measures to address personnel, controls, compliance and discipline. The Independent Review focused initially on events relating  
to the establishment and release of contractual liability and other related provisions in the second half of 2002 and the first half of 2003,  
including the involvement of senior corporate leadership. As the Independent Review evolved, its focus broadened to include specific  
provisioning activities in each of the business units and geographic regions. In light of concerns raised in the initial phase of the  
Independent Review, the Audit Committee expanded the review to include provisioning activities in the third and fourth quarters of 2003.  
As the Independent Review progressed, the Audit Committee directed new corporate management to examine in depth the concerns  
identified by WCPHD regarding provisioning activity and to review provision releases in each of the four quarters of 2003, down to a  
low threshold. That examination, and other errors identified by management, led to the restatement of Nortel Networks consolidated  
financial statements and Nortel Networks S.A.’s consolidated financial statements for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001 and  
the quarters ended March 31, 2003 and 2002, June 30, 2003 and 2002 and September 30, 2003 and 2002 (the “Second Restatement”).  
Over the course of the Second Restatement process, management identified certain accounting practices that it determined should be  
adjusted as part of the Second Restatement. In particular, management identified certain errors related to revenue recognition and  
undertook a process of revenue reviews.  
Due to, among other factors, significant turnover in NNC finance personnel, changes in accounting systems, documentation weaknesses,  
and identified material weaknesses in internal controls over financial reporting the Second Restatement involved hundreds of NNC  
finance personnel and a number of outside consultants and advisors. The process required the review and verification of a substantial  
number of documents and communications and related accounting entries over multiple fiscal periods. In addition, the review of  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
accruals and provisions and the application of accounting literature to certain matters in the Second Restatement, including revenue  
recognition, foreign exchange, special charges and discontinued operations, was complicated by the passage of time, lack of availability  
of supporting records and the turnover of finance personnel. As a result of this complexity, estimates and assumptions that impact both  
the quantum of the various recorded adjustments and the fiscal period to which they were attributed were required in the determination of  
certain of the Second Restatement adjustments. Nortel Networks S.A. believes the procedures followed in determining such estimates  
were appropriate and reasonable using the best available information.  
The following tables present the impact of the Second Restatement adjustments (and Pooling of Interest adjustments, see notes 2 and 9)  
to Nortel Networks S.A.’s previously reported consolidated statements of operations and a summary of the adjustments from the Second  
Restatement for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001. The Second Restatement adjustments related primarily to the following  
items, each of which reflect a number of related adjustments that have been aggregated for disclosure purposes, and are described in the  
paragraphs following the tables below:  
Accruals and provisions  
Related party transactions  
Plant and equipment  
Consolidated Statement of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2002  
As  
previously  
reported  
Second  
Restatement  
Adjustments  
Pooling of  
interest  
Adjustments  
As  
pooled and  
restated  
Revenues — external  
— related parties  
214,922  
473,223  
141,394  
(8,943)  
356,316  
458,918  
(5,362)  
688,145  
595,637  
(5,362)  
(45,011)  
132,451  
49,741  
815,234  
600,367  
Cost of revenues  
Gross profit  
92,508  
31,998  
257,585  
58,854  
39,649  
(3,700)  
6,690  
2,646  
82,710  
41,184  
21,927  
16,171  
214,867  
69,482  
264,275  
83,427  
16,171  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Special charges — other special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
Operating earnings (loss)  
Other income (expenses) — net  
Foreign exchange gain (loss)  
Interest expense  
(255,929)  
18,962  
(1,557)  
(6,524)  
34,013  
(1,486)  
331  
3,428  
5,562  
(4,305)  
(81)  
(218,488)  
23,038  
(5,531)  
(9,885)  
(3,280)  
Earnings (loss) before income taxes and minority interest  
Minority interest — net of tax  
Income tax benefit  
(245,048)  
29,578  
4,604  
3,052  
(40)  
(210,866)  
3,052  
1,680  
1,640  
Net earnings (loss)  
(243,368)  
29,578  
7,616  
(206,174)  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Summary of Restatement Adjustments for the year ended December 31, 2002:  
Accruals and  
provisions  
Related party  
transactions  
Plant and  
equipment  
Total  
adjustments  
Revenues — external  
Revenues — related parties  
(5,362)  
(5,362)  
(5,362)  
(5,362)  
Cost of revenues  
9,030  
(54,524)  
483  
(45,011)  
Gross profit  
(9,030)  
(420)  
6,690  
2,646  
(1,541)  
306  
49,162  
(483)  
(3,280)  
39,649  
(3,700)  
6,690  
2,646  
(1,486)  
331  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Special charges — other special charges  
Other income (expense) — net  
Foreign exchange gain (loss)  
Interest expense  
184  
25  
(129)  
(3,280)  
(3,280)  
Total restatement adjustments  
(19,181)  
49,371  
(612)  
29,578  
Consolidated Statements of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2001  
As  
Second  
Restatement  
Adjustments  
Pooling of  
interest  
Adjustments  
As  
pooled and  
restated  
previously  
reported  
Revenues — external  
— related parties  
275,915  
429,643  
491,798  
(371)  
767,713  
439,072  
9,800  
705,558  
809,472  
9,800  
(74,439)  
491,427  
381,733  
1,206,785  
1,116,766  
Cost of revenues  
Gross profit (loss)  
(103,914)  
74,617  
253,327  
84,239  
(2,876)  
(13,677)  
109,694  
103,692  
9,953  
90,019  
175,433  
249,603  
3,434  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Amortization of goodwill  
Special charges  
3,434  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
74,463  
(8,095)  
20,607  
8,404  
(10,243)  
20,607  
74,772  
(10,243)  
Operating earnings (loss)  
Other income (expense) — net  
Foreign exchange gain (loss)  
Interest expense  
(506,321)  
46,240  
4,442  
108,887  
(266)  
(26,153)  
8,024  
(6,152)  
(3,432)  
(423,587)  
53,998  
(1,710)  
(5,033)  
(2,821)  
(11,286)  
Earnings (loss) before income taxes and minority interest  
Minority interest — net of tax  
Income tax benefit  
(460,672)  
26,198  
105,800  
(27,713)  
8,973  
7,875  
(382,585)  
8,973  
34,073  
Net earnings (loss)  
(434,474)  
105,800  
(10,865)  
(339,539)  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Summary of Restatement Adjustments for the year ended December 31, 2001:  
Accruals and  
provisions  
Related party  
transactions  
Plant and  
equipment  
Total  
adjustments  
Revenues — external  
Revenues — related parties  
9,800  
9,800  
9,800  
(60,747)  
8
9,800  
(74,439)  
Cost of revenues  
(13,700)  
Gross profit  
13,700  
(55)  
(13,358)  
(8,095)  
(435)  
70,547  
(8)  
84,239  
(2,876)  
(13,677)  
(8,095)  
(266)  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Special charges — other special charges  
Other income (expense) — net  
Interest expense  
75  
(2,821)  
(319)  
94  
(2,821)  
(2,821)  
Total restatement adjustments  
34,773  
70,622  
405  
105,800  
(a) Accruals and provisions  
The adjustments primarily correct certain accruals, provisions or other transactions which were either initially recorded incorrectly in  
prior periods or not properly released or adjusted for changes in estimates and/or assumptions in the appropriate periods. The adjustments  
primarily impacted cost of revenues, selling, general and administrative expense, research and development expense, special charges and  
other expense and resulted in an increase to the net loss in the year ending December 31, 2002 and a decrease to the net loss for the year  
ended December 31, 2001. These adjustments are described below.  
2002  
2001  
Increase (decrease) from adjustments of accruals and provisions  
Cost of revenues  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Special charges  
Other expense  
Foreign exchange  
9,030  
(420)  
6,690  
2,646  
1,541  
(306)  
(13,700)  
(55)  
(13,358)  
(8,095)  
435  
19,181  
(34,773)  
Net increase (decrease) to net loss  
Details of the items listed above are provided in the following tables.  
Cost of revenues  
The variations to cost of revenues were due to the following factors:  
2002  
2001  
Increase (decrease) of cost of revenues  
Product related  
Customer related  
Related party  
Employee related  
Other accounts payable  
Tax  
1,036  
(1,042)  
(157)  
4,423  
2,010  
2,645  
115  
(4,194)  
(743)  
(500)  
(4,330)  
(920)  
(3,110)  
97  
Other  
9,030  
(13,700)  
Net increase (decrease) of cost of revenues  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
The variations to selling, general and administrative expense were due to the following factors:  
2002  
2001  
Increase (decrease) of selling, general and administrative expense  
Customer related  
Employee related  
Other accounts payable  
Tax  
(102)  
(300)  
(28)  
1,910  
(1,900)  
(44)  
(1,910)  
1,899  
Other  
(420)  
(55)  
Net increase (decrease) of selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
The variations to research and development costs were due to the following factors:  
2002  
2001  
Increase (decrease) of research and development  
Product related  
Related party  
Other accounts payable  
Tax  
(5,734)  
(150)  
9,334  
3,521  
(281)  
(1,585)  
(7,787)  
(3,986)  
Other  
6,690  
(13,358)  
Net increase (decrease) of research and development  
Special Charges  
As part of the Second Restatement process, the transactions impacting special charges were reviewed. As a result, various adjustments  
have been made to correct certain items. The adjustments resulted in an increase of 2,646 and a decrease of 8,095 to special charges for  
the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively. Adjustments for restructuring related mainly to plant and equipment and real  
estate related items. Nortel Networks S.A. determined that these items were accrued in error and the Second Restatement therefore  
cancels the original accruals in the period they were recorded. Accruals originally set-up in the year ended December 31, 2002 amounting  
to 5,449 were adjusted. This adjustment was more than offset by the cancellation of accruals amounting to 8,095 originally setup in the  
year ended December 31, 2001 and released in the year ended December 31, 2002.  
Other expenses  
For the year ended December, 31 2002 the 1,235 increase in the other expenses was primarily the result of adjustments to provisions for  
litigations of 816, unrecoverable advances to suppliers for 594 partially offset by foreign exchange gains of 306 relating to items  
provided in error under restructuring. For the year ended December 31, 2001 the 435 increase in the other expenses was the result of an  
adjustment for 497 to a payroll related accrual partially offset by a gain recorded on payments received from doubtful accounts fully  
provided for 62.  
(b) Related party transactions  
A large portion of the activity of Nortel Networks S.A. is carried out with related parties. The adjustments to the financial statements of  
Nortel Networks have therefore resulted in changes in revenues and cost of revenues from and to related parties of Nortel Networks S.A.  
The analysis of out of balances positions (see below) has also led to certain corrections of revenue and cost of revenues with related  
parties. The following table summarizes the adjustments to related party revenues and cost of revenues:  
2002  
2001  
Increase (decrease) of revenue from related parties  
Increase (decrease) of cost of revenues to related parties  
Residual profit sharing adjustment  
Other  
(5,362)  
9,800  
(49,668)  
(4,856)  
(60,747)  
49,162  
70,547  
Net increase (decrease) of gross profit from related parties  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Residual profit sharing  
Adjustments to cost of revenues of Nortel Networks S.A. are primarily due to adjustments to the results of Nortel Networks resulting  
from the restatements. These adjustments impact the cost of revenues of Nortel Networks S.A. through the global profit split  
methodology implemented since 2001 (see note 10). The share of Nortel Networks S.A. in the global profit of Nortel Networks was  
increased by 49,668 and 60,747 for the years ending December 31, 2002 and December 31, 2001 respectively.  
Related party revenues and cost of revenues  
Adjustments to revenues from related parties of Nortel Networks S.A. are primarily due to errors in the timing of the revenue recognition  
from a profit split agreement by which Nortel Networks S.A. is entitled to receive a share of the profit recognized by certain affiliated  
parties. An amount of 9,800 of revenue related to this agreement was recognized in the year ended December 31, 2002 whereas Nortel  
Networks S.A. determined that this revenue should have been recognized in the year ended December 31, 2001.  
The reduction of 9,800 of related party revenues in the year ended December 31, 2002 resulting from this adjustment is partially offset  
by another adjustment for an amount of 4,438 that was recorded to correct a reduction in related party revenues recorded in the year  
ended December, 31 2002. The reduction of related party revenue recorded in the year ended December 31, 2002 was a correction of  
related party revenues recorded in error in the year ended December 31, 2000. The adjustment is reprofiling the reduction of revenues  
from related parties to the year ended December 31, 2000. An adjustment was recorded to the cost of revenues to related parties (see  
below) on the same transaction for the same amount resulting in an increase to cost of revenues to related parties by 4,438.  
The reduction of 4,856 in cost of revenues to related parties in the year ended December 31, 2001 related mainly to the correction of an  
amount of 9,900 billed to Nortel Networks S.A. in error under a profit split agreement partially offset by an increase of cost of revenues  
to related parties for 4,438 due to the correction of an error recorded in the year ended December, 31 2002 and that was correcting an  
error that had taken place in the year ended December 31, 2000. Another adjustment for 365 to cost of revenues to related parties was  
recorded to correct certain charges that had not been expensed in error.  
Related party out of balances  
As part of the Second Restatement process, Nortel Networks S.A. undertook a review of the inter-company out-of-balance positions. The  
timing of the significant underlying out-of-balance positions has been identified and corrections recorded in the appropriate periods. The  
adjustments for the out-of-balance positions resulted in approximately a 61 and a 75 decrease to the previously reported net loss for the  
years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
(c) Plant and equipment  
As a result of the Independent Review, various accounts were examined. Certain known errors that were previously not recorded because  
the amount of the errors was not material to the financial statements of Nortel Networks S.A. were also corrected. The following table  
summarizes the adjustments relative to plant and equipment.  
2002  
2001  
Net increase (decrease) from other adjustments to above items  
Cost of revenues  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Other income (expense) — net  
483  
(3,280)  
8
(2,821)  
(319)  
(94)  
129  
Interest on long-term debt  
3,280  
2,821  
612  
(405)  
Net increase (decrease) from other adjustments to above items  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Costs of revenues, research and development expense  
Adjustments to cost of revenues and research and development were mainly driven by corrections of errors in the depreciation periods of  
various plant and equipment, items that had been classified as plant and equipment in error and that should have been expensed, as well  
as the timing of the write off of certain plant and equipment. Adjustments to other expenses were related to items that had been classified  
as fixed assets in error and that should have been expensed, as well as a reclassification of selling, general and administration expense to  
interest payment (see below “Interest on long term debt”).  
Interest on long- term debt  
As part of the Second Restatement process, the accounting for a lease transaction entered into by Nortel Networks S.A. in 1999 was also  
reviewed and it was determined that the lease had incorrectly been recorded as an operating lease. The lease should have been classified  
as a capital lease in accordance with SFAS No. 98 and was therefore restated as such. The impact on the balance sheet of Nortel  
Networks S.A. as of December 31, 2002 of that restatement was an increase of plant and equipment by 79,028, an increase of the long  
term debt by 76,457 and an increase of the short term debt by 3,073. The related interest expense were also reclassified from selling,  
general and administration expense to interest expense for 3,280 and 2,821 for the years ending December 31, 2002 and 2001  
respectively. That restatement had no impact on net earnings.  
Consolidated balance sheet as at December 31, 2002, as restated  
In addition to the effects on the consolidated statements of operations discussed above, the restatement impacted the consolidated balance  
sheet as at December 31, 2002. The following consolidated balance sheet presents the cumulative impact of the restatement adjustments  
described above classified by balance sheet line item as at December 31, 2002.  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2002  
As  
previously  
reported  
Second  
Restatement  
Adjustments  
Pooling of  
interest  
Adjustments  
As  
pooled and  
restated  
ASSETS  
Current assets  
Cash and cash equivalents  
Accounts receivable  
Inventories — net  
Receivables from related parties  
Other current assets  
66,687  
45,665  
58,385  
123,272  
99,490  
897  
164  
838  
82,835  
38,126  
20,847  
(4,438)  
9,846  
150,419  
83,955  
80,070  
234,071  
106,364  
115,237  
(2,972)  
393,499  
114,164  
147,216  
654,879  
Total current assets  
Long-term receivable from related party  
Investments at cost  
Plant and equipment — net  
Goodwill  
Intangible assets — net  
Deferred income taxes — net  
Other assets  
140,010  
5,632  
126,948  
10,544  
8,544  
3,454  
7,964  
140,010  
16,176  
218,121  
3,454  
43,268  
6
82,629  
35,304  
6
701,399  
196,793  
177,722  
1,075,914  
Total assets  
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Current liabilities  
Trade and other accounts payable  
Payables to related parties  
Payroll and benefit-related liabilities  
Contractual Liabilities  
Restructuring  
80,257  
52,023  
44,503  
33,818  
15,231  
161,005  
1,406  
(7,531)  
333  
(1,488)  
(3,401)  
(4,500)  
3,073  
9,488  
44,834  
5,973  
5,488  
1,516  
17,755  
91,151  
89,326  
50,809  
37,818  
13,346  
174,260  
3,073  
Other accrued liabilities  
Long-term debt due within one year  
386,837  
(12,108)  
85,054  
459,783  
Total current liabilities  
Other liabilities  
Long-term deferred Income  
Long-term debt  
1,837  
268  
732  
17,231  
2,837  
17,231  
76,457  
220,000  
76,457  
Long-term note payable to related party  
200,000  
20,000  
588,674  
64,617  
123,017  
9,757  
776,308  
9,757  
Total liabilities  
Minority interest  
SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY  
Common shares, 0.005 par value  
Additional paid-in capital  
Accumulated deficit  
306,544  
(193,819)  
43,997  
951  
306,544  
43,997  
(60,692)  
132,176  
112,725  
701,399  
132,176  
196,793  
44,948  
289,849  
Total shareholders’ equity  
177,722  
1,075,914  
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity  
4. Accounting changes  
(a) Guarantees  
In November 2002, the FASB issued FIN 45, “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including  
Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others — an interpretation of FASB Statements No. 5, 57 and 107 and rescission of FASB  
interpretation No. 34” (“FIN 45”). FIN 45 defines a guarantee as a contract that contingently requires a guarantor to pay a  
guaranteed party as a result of changes in an underlying economic characteristic (such as interest rates or market value) that is  
related to an asset, a liability or an equity security of the guaranteed party or a third party’s failure to perform under a specified  
agreement. FIN 45 requires that a liability be recognized for the estimated fair value of the guarantee at its inception. Guarantees  
issued prior to January 1, 2003 are not subject to the recognition and measurement provisions, but are subject to expanded  
disclosure requirements. Nortel Networks S.A. has entered into agreements that contain features which meet the definition of a  
guarantee under FIN 45. Effective December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks S.A. adopted the disclosure requirements of FIN 45. In  
addition, effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. adopted the initial recognition and measurement provisions of FIN 45  
which apply on a prospective basis to certain guarantees  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
issued or modified after December 31, 2002. The adoption of FIN 45 did not have a material impact on the results of operations and  
financial condition of Nortel Networks S.A. (see note 12).  
(b) Asset retirement obligations  
In June 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 143, “Accounting for Asset Retirement Obligations” (“SFAS 143”), which applies to  
certain obligations associated with the retirement of tangible long-lived assets. SFAS 143 requires that a liability be initially  
recognized for the estimated fair value of the obligation when it is incurred. The associated asset retirement cost is capitalized as  
part of the carrying amount of the long-lived asset and depreciated over the remaining life of the underlying asset and the associated  
liability is accreted to the estimated fair value of the obligation at the settlement date through periodic accretion charges to net  
earnings (loss). When the obligation is settled, any difference between the final cost and the recorded amount is recognized as  
income or loss on settlement. Effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. adopted the initial recognition and measurement  
provisions of SFAS 143 and identified certain asset retirement obligations to remediate leased premises and buildings and  
equipment situated on leased land. The adoption of SFAS 143 did not have a material impact on the results of operations and  
financial condition of Nortel Networks S.A.  
(c) Accounting for costs associated with exit or disposal activities  
In June 2002, the FASB issued SFAS No. 146, “Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities” (“SFAS 146”),  
which is effective for exit or disposal activities initiated after December 31, 2002. SFAS 146 supercedes EITF Issue No. 94-3,  
“Liability Recognition for Certain Employee Termination Benefits and Other Costs to Exit an Activity (including Certain Costs  
Incurred in a Restructuring)” (“EITF 94-3”). SFAS 146 requires recognition of costs associated with an exit or disposal activity  
when the liability is incurred, whereas under EITF 94-3, a liability for an exit cost was recognized when an entity committed to an  
exit plan. In addition, SFAS 146 establishes that fair value is the objective for initial measurement of the liability. The effect of  
SFAS 146 was to change the timing of recognition and the basis for measuring certain liabilities and therefore created valuation  
differences between SFAS 146 and EITF 94-3. Exit and disposal activities initiated before December 31, 2002 continue to be  
accounted for under EITF 94-3. Nortel Networks S.A. adopted the requirements of SFAS 146 effective January 1, 2003. The  
adoption of SFAS 146 did not have a material impact on Nortel Networks S.A. results of operations and financial condition.  
(d) Consolidation of variable interest entities  
In January 2003, the FASB issued FIN 46, “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities an Interpretation of Accounting Research  
Bulletin No. 51, ‘Consolidated Financial Statements’ (“FIN 46”)”. FIN 46 clarifies the application of consolidation guidance to  
those entities defined as VIEs (which includes, but is not limited to special purpose entities, trusts, partnerships, certain joint  
ventures and other legal structures) in which equity investors do not have the characteristics of a “controlling financial interest” or  
there is not sufficient equity at risk for the entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support. FIN 46  
applied immediately to all VIEs created after January 31, 2003 and by the beginning of the first interim or annual reporting period  
commencing after June 15, 2003 for VIEs created prior to February 1, 2003. In October 2003, the FASB issued FSP FIN 46-6,  
“Effective Date of FASB Interpretation No. 46”, deferring the effective date for applying the provisions of FIN 46 for VIEs created  
prior to February 1, 2003 to the end of the first interim or annual period ending after December 15, 2003. While the criteria for  
deferral were met, Nortel Networks S.A. elected early application of FIN 46. In December 2003, the FASB issued FIN 46R which  
amends and supercedes the original FIN 46. Effective December 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. adopted FIN 46R. Any impacts of  
applying FIN 46R to an entity to which FIN 46 had previously been applied are considered immaterial to Nortel Networks S.A.  
results of operations and financial condition and Nortel Networks S.A. accounting treatment of VIEs.  
(e) Accounting for revenue arrangements with multiple deliverables  
In November 2002, the EITF reached a consensus on EITF 00-21. In the absence of higher level accounting literature, EITF 00-21  
governs how to separate and allocate revenue to goods or services or both that are to be delivered in a bundled sales arrangement.  
EITF 00-21 applies to revenue arrangements entered into after June 30, 2003 and allows for either prospective application or  
cumulative adjustment upon adoption. Nortel Networks S.A. adopted the requirements of EITF 00-21 on a prospective basis  
effective July 1, 2003. On October 1, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. also adopted related interpretive guidance contained in EITF 03-  
5, “Applicability of AICPA Statement of Position 97-2 to Non-Software Deliverables in an Arrangement Containing More-Than-  
Incidental Software” (“EITF 03-5”), which addresses whether non-software deliverables included in an arrangement that contains  
software is more than incidental to the products or services as a whole are included within the scope of  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SOP 97-2. The adoption of EITF 00-21 and EITF 03-5 did not have a material impact on Nortel Networks S.A. results of operations  
and financial condition.  
(f) Amendment of SFAS 133 on derivative instruments and hedging activities  
In April 2003, the FASB issued SFAS No. 149, “Amendment of SFAS No. 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging  
Activities” (“SFAS 149”). SFAS 149 amends and clarifies accounting for derivative instruments, including certain derivative  
instruments embedded in other contracts and hedging activities under SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and  
Hedging Activities” (“SFAS 133”). In particular, SFAS 149: clarifies under what circumstances a contract with an initial net  
investment meets the characteristic of a derivative as discussed in SFAS 133; clarifies when a derivative contains a financing  
component; amends the definition of an “underlying” to conform it to the language used in FIN 45; and amends certain other  
existing pronouncements. SFAS 149 is effective for contracts entered into or modified after June 30, 2003, except as stated below,  
and for hedging relationships designated after June 30, 2003.  
The provisions of SFAS 149 that relate to guidance in SFAS 133 that have been effective for fiscal quarters which began prior to  
June 15, 2003 continue to be applied in accordance with their respective effective dates. In addition, certain provisions relating to  
forward purchases or sales of when-issued securities or other securities that do not yet exist are applied to both existing contracts as  
well as new contracts entered into after June 30, 2003.  
Effective July 1, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. applied the requirements of SFAS 149 on a prospective basis to contracts entered into  
or modified after June 30, 2003. The adoption of SFAS 149 did not have a material impact on Nortel Networks S.A. results of  
operations and financial condition.  
(g) Determining whether an arrangement contains a lease  
In May 2003, the EITF reached a consensus on Issue No. 01-8, “Determining Whether an Arrangement Contains a Lease” (“EITF  
01-8”). EITF 01-8 provides guidance on how to determine whether an arrangement contains a lease that is within the scope of  
FASB Statement No. 13, “Accounting for Leases.” The guidance in EITF 01-8 is based on whether the arrangement conveys to the  
purchaser (or the lessee) the right to use or control the use of a specific asset, and is effective for Nortel Networks S.A. for  
arrangements entered into or modified after June 30, 2003. The impact of EITF 01-8 on Nortel Networks S.A. future results of  
operations and financial condition will depend on the terms contained in contracts signed or contracts amended in the future.  
(h) Stock-based compensation  
In December 2002, the FASB issued SFAS 148, which amended the transitional provisions of SFAS 123 for companies electing to  
recognize employee stock-based compensation using the fair value based method. Effective January 1, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A.  
elected to expense employee stock-based compensation using the fair value based method prospectively for all awards granted,  
modified, or settled on or after January 1, 2003 (see note 2(s)).  
(i) Accounting for goodwill and other intangible assets  
In June 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets” (“SFAS 142”), effective for fiscal years  
beginning after December 15, 2001. SFAS 142 changed the accounting for goodwill from an amortization method to an  
impairment-only approach. Thus, amortization of goodwill, including goodwill recorded in past business combinations and  
amortization of intangibles with an indefinite life, ceased upon adoption of SFAS 142. For any acquisitions completed after  
June 30, 2001, goodwill and intangible assets with an indefinite life are not amortized. Nortel Networks S.A. adopted the provisions  
of SFAS 142 effective January 1, 2002.  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following table presents the impact on net earnings (loss) for the year ended December 31, 2001 of the SFAS 142 requirement  
to cease the amortization of goodwill as if the standard had been in effect beginning January 1, 2001.  
2001  
Net earnings (loss) — reported  
Amortization of goodwill  
(339,539)  
3,434  
Net earnings (loss) — adjusted  
(336,105)  
(j) Impairment or disposal of long-lived assets (plant and equipment)  
In August 2001, the FASB issued SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets” (“SFAS  
144”), which addressed financial accounting and reporting for the impairment or disposal of long-lived assets. SFAS 144 is  
applicable to certain long-lived assets, including those reported as discontinued operations, and develops one accounting model for  
long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale. SFAS 144 superseded SFAS No. 121, “Accounting for the Impairment of Long-lived  
Assets and for Long-lived Assets to be Disposed Of”, and APB No. 30, “Reporting the Results of Operations — Reporting the  
Effects of Disposal of a Segment of a Business, and Extraordinary, Unusual and Infrequently Occurring Events and  
Transactions” (“APB 30”), for the disposal of a segment of a business. Nortel Networks S.A. adopted the provisions of SFAS 144  
effective January 1, 2002.  
SFAS 144 requires that long-lived assets to be disposed of by sale be measured at the lower of carrying amount or fair value less  
cost to sell, whether reported in continuing operations or in discontinued operations. Discontinued operations will no longer be  
measured at net realizable value or include amounts for operating losses that have not yet been incurred. SFAS 144 also broadened  
the reporting of discontinued operations to include the disposal of a component of an entity provided that the operations and cash  
flows of the component will be eliminated from the ongoing operations of the entity and the entity will not have any significant  
continuing involvement in the operations of the component. The adoption of SFAS 144 did not have a material impact on Nortel  
Networks S.A. results of operations and financial condition.  
(k) Derivative financial instruments  
Effective January 1, 2001, Nortel Networks S.A. adopted SFAS 133, and the corresponding amendments under SFAS No. 138,  
“Accounting for Certain Derivative Instruments and Certain Hedging Activities — an amendment of SFAS No. 133” (“SFAS  
138”).  
The adoption of SFAS 133 did not have a material impact on Nortel Networks S.A. results of operations and financial condition.  
5. Consolidated financial statement details  
The following consolidated financial statement details are presented as of December 31 for the consolidated balance sheets and for each  
of the years ended December 31 for the consolidated statements of operations and consolidated statements of cash flows.  
Consolidated statements of operations  
Research and development expense:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
R&D expense  
R&D costs incurred on behalf of others  
236,967  
5,445  
264,275  
9,098  
249,603  
2,885  
(a)  
Total  
242,412  
273,373  
252,488  
(a)  
These costs included R&D charged to customers of Nortel Networks S.A. pursuant to contracts that provided for full recovery of the estimated cost of development,  
material, engineering, installation and other applicable costs, which were accounted for as contract costs.  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other income (expense) — net:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
(a)  
Royalties — net  
(4,479)  
6,494  
16,559  
6,479  
29,888  
24,110  
Other — net  
Other income (expenses) — net  
2,015  
23,038  
53,998  
(a)  
Certain affiliated entities pay royalty fees to Nortel Networks S.A. on their total Global System for Mobile communications (“GSM”) technology sales (4 percent of  
total GSM sales in 2003, 5 percent in 2002, and 10 percent in 2001). Nortel Networks France pays 7 percent of its revenue to affiliated entities.  
Consolidated balance sheets  
Accounts receivable — net:  
2003  
2002  
Total receivables  
Contracts in process  
77,924  
35,487  
78,013  
5,942  
Accounts receivable — net  
113,411  
83,955  
Inventories — net:  
2003  
2002  
Raw materials  
Work in process  
Finished goods  
11,628  
42,244  
12,325  
21,801  
43,122  
15,147  
(a)  
Inventories — net  
66,197  
80,070  
(a)  
Net of inventory provisions of 41,064 and 31,638 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively. Included in trade and other accounts payable are accruals of  
12,941 as of December 31, 2003 for cancellation charges, for inventory in excess of future demand and for the settlement of certain other claims related to contract  
manufacturers or suppliers.  
Other current assets:  
2003  
2002  
Employee receivables  
Put option  
Prepaid rent and other  
Other receivables  
1,196  
1,047  
(a)  
8,654  
7,619  
77,500  
15,250  
12,567  
Other current assets  
17,469  
106,364  
(a)  
The put option was exercised on July 1, 2003 (see note 9).  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Plant and equipment — net:  
2003  
2002  
Cost:  
Land and buildings  
Leasehold improvements  
Machinery and equipment  
Furniture and fixtures  
Computers  
104,810  
31,243  
219,818  
44,058  
6,893  
114,660  
38,310  
203,553  
37,146  
22,130  
15,885  
Other  
1,430  
408,252  
431,684  
Less accumulated depreciation:  
Buildings  
Leasehold improvements  
Machinery and equipment  
Furniture and fixtures  
Computers  
(15,943)  
(21,872)  
(141,072)  
(38,604)  
(5,700)  
(16,681)  
(34,356)  
(115,201)  
(19,355)  
(19,340)  
(8,630)  
Other  
(892)  
(224,083)  
184,169  
(213,563)  
218,121  
(a)(b)  
Plant and equipment — net  
(a)  
(b)  
Included assets held for sale with a carrying value of 10,897 and 14,799 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively, related to owned facilities that were  
being actively marketed. These assets were written down in previous periods to their estimated fair values less costs to sell. The write downs were included in  
special charges. Nortel Networks S.A. expects to dispose of all of these facilities by mid-2005.  
Included leased assets as required by SFAS No. 98 of 75,927 and 79,028 as of December 31, 2003 and 2002, respectively.  
Goodwill:  
The following table outlines goodwill by reportable segment:  
Wireless  
Networks  
Enterprise  
Networks  
Wireline  
Networks  
Optical  
Networks  
Other  
Total  
Balance — net as of December 31, 2001 and 2002  
Change:  
Additions  
(a)  
8,857  
8,070  
2,756  
19,683  
Foreign exchange  
Balance — net as of December 31, 2003  
8,857  
8,070  
2,756  
19,683  
(a)  
See note 9 for additional information.  
During the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. performed its annual goodwill impairment test and concluded that there  
was no impairment.  
Intangible assets — net:  
2003  
2002  
(a)  
Other intangible assets — net  
8,929  
3,454  
(a)  
Other intangible assets are being amortized over their estimated useful lives. Amortization expense is expected to be 1,020 for each of the next eight years  
commencing in 2004 and 769 thereafter.  
Investment at cost — net:  
2003  
2002  
European Aeronautic Defense & Space Telecom S.A.S  
Matra Nortel Communication Distribution S.A.S  
15,871  
305  
Investment at cost — net  
16,176  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other accrued liabilities:  
2003  
2002  
(a)  
Put option  
4,565  
9,676  
4,772  
6,379  
4,755  
48,050  
7,104  
12,941  
3,856  
3,641  
77,500  
9,079  
19,994  
10,535  
3,776  
1,538  
15,181  
16,114  
7,958  
4,075  
8,510  
Selling, general and administrative related  
Customer deposit  
Product related  
Warranty  
Miscellaneous taxes  
Deferred income  
Research and development  
Contract manufacturers  
Guarantees to purchasers of disposed businesses  
Other  
Other accrued liabilities  
105,739  
174,260  
(a)  
The put option was exercised on July 1, 2003 (see note 9).  
Long-term debt:  
The amounts of long-term debt payable for each of the years ending December 31 consisted of:  
2003  
2002  
2003  
2004  
2005  
2006  
2007  
2008  
Thereafter  
3,241  
3,417  
3,603  
3,798  
4,005  
58,394  
3,073  
3,241  
3,417  
3,603  
3,798  
4,005  
58,393  
76,458  
3,241  
79,530  
3,073  
Less: Long-term debt due within one year  
Long-term debt  
73,217  
76,457  
Long term debt is entirely related to the lease of a building entered into by Nortel Networks S.A. in the year ended December 31, 1999.  
The lease is classified as a capital lease. As such, the transaction has been recorded as a financing transaction and the building and related  
accounts will continue to be recognized in the consolidated financial statements. The lease term is May 2013. The payable amounts above  
exclude interest as such interest is variable and is based on Euribor (2.1% at December 31, 2003).  
Consolidated statements of cash flows  
Interest and taxes paid (recovered):  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Cash interest paid  
Cash taxes paid (recovered) — net  
3,376  
(1,801)  
9,937  
(2,940)  
10,694  
28,779  
Receivables sales:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Proceeds from collections reinvested in revolving period securitizations  
30,273  
346,536  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Segment information  
General description  
During 2003 and up to September 30, 2004, Nortel Networks S.A. operations (including the operations of Northern Telecom France and  
Nortel Networks France (see note 2)) were organized around four reportable segments consisting of Wireless Networks, Enterprise  
Networks, Wireline Networks and Optical Networks. Wireless Networks included network access and core networking products for voice  
and data communications that span second and third generation wireless technologies and most major global standards for mobile  
networks and related professional services. Enterprise Networks included circuit and packet voice solutions, data networking and security  
solutions and the related professional services used by enterprise customers. Wireline Networks included circuit and packet voice  
solutions, data networking and security solutions and the related professional services used by service provider customers. Optical  
Networks included metropolitan, regional and long-haul optical transport and switching solutions and managed broadband services and  
related professional services for both service provider and enterprise customers.  
“Other” represented miscellaneous business activities and corporate functions. None of these activities meet the quantitative criteria to be  
disclosed as reportable segments.  
Effective October 1, 2004, a new streamlined organizational structure was established that involved, among other things, combining the  
businesses of Nortel Networks S.A. four segments into two business organizations: (i) Carrier Networks and Global Operations, and (ii)  
Enterprise Networks. Nortel Networks S.A. is reviewing the impact of these changes on its reportable segments.  
Nortel Networks S.A. president and chief executive officer together with the president of Nortel Networks France have been identified as  
the chief operating decision makers (the “Decision Makers”) in assessing the performance of the segments and the allocation of resources  
to the segments. The Decision Makers rely on the information derived directly from the Nortel Networks Corporation management  
reporting system. The primary financial measure used by the Decision Makers in assessing performance and allocating resources is  
management earnings (loss) before income taxes (“Management EBT”), a measure that includes contribution margin, R&D expense,  
interest expense, other income (expense) — net and minority interest. Previously, the primary financial measure used by the Decision  
Makers in assessing performance and allocating resources was contribution margin, a measure that was comprised of gross profit less  
SG&A. As both contribution margin and Management EBT were available to the Decision Makers during 2003, Nortel Networks S.A.  
has determined that it is appropriate to disclose both contribution margin and Management EBT for the periods presented.  
Costs associated with shared services and other corporate costs are allocated to the segments based on usage determined generally by  
headcount. Costs not allocated to the segments are primarily related to corporate compliance and other non-operational activities and are  
included in “other”. In addition, the Decision Makers do not review asset information on a segmented basis in order to assess  
performance and allocate resources. The accounting policies of the reportable segments are the same as those applied to the consolidated  
financial statements.  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Segments  
The following tables set forth information by segment for the years ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Revenues  
Wireless Networks  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
Other  
214,732  
51,018  
50,729  
21,065  
6,464  
164,829  
64,538  
63,523  
40,083  
23,343  
202,741  
87,860  
130,322  
136,753  
210,037  
Total  
344,008  
356,316  
767,713  
Contribution Margin  
Wireless Networks  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
Other  
1,361  
9,956  
28,774  
3,989  
51,869  
20,554  
52,369  
16,728  
3,865  
(105,374)  
(5,786)  
52,157  
(19,765)  
(6,646)  
88,004  
Total  
132,084  
145,385  
(85,414)  
Management EBT  
Wireless Networks  
Enterprise Networks  
Wireline Networks  
Optical Networks  
Other  
(150,465)  
13,735  
27,681  
8,863  
(289,002)  
14,958  
55,661  
14,003  
96,164  
(265,215)  
(13,588)  
44,421  
(34,813)  
(15,847)  
(5,616)  
Total  
(105,802)  
(108,216)  
(285,042)  
Amortization of acquired technology and other  
Amortization of Goodwill  
255  
3,434  
Special charges  
(Gain) loss on sale of businesses and assets  
Income tax benefit  
24,563  
13,883  
(5,614)  
83,427  
16,171  
(1,640)  
95,379  
(10,243)  
(34,073)  
Net earnings (loss)  
(138,889)  
(206,174)  
(339,539)  
The “Other” segment includes disposed business such as the products contributed to EADS Telecom (see note 9). These products would  
mainly have been reported in the Enterprise segment prior to the contribution.  
Major customers  
The following table sets forth information on revenue and receivables from two separate external customers located in France for the  
years ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Revenues from largest customers as a percentage of external revenues:  
Largest customer  
23%  
16%  
11%  
Second largest customer  
23%  
15%  
7%  
Receivables from largest customers as a percentage of external receivables  
Largest customer  
11%  
52%  
9%  
24%  
10%  
19%  
Second largest customer  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Geographic information  
The following table sets forth external revenues by geographic region based on the location of the customer for the years ended  
December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
External revenues  
France  
264,398  
79,550  
60  
259,717  
95,950  
649  
614,648  
150,872  
2,193  
(a)  
EMEA - excluding France  
Other  
Total  
344,008  
356,316  
767,713  
(a)  
Europe, Middle East and Africa  
Long-lived assets  
Substantially all long-lived assets are located in France.  
7. Special charges  
During 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. continued to implement its restructuring work plan initiated in 2001. Special charges recorded from  
January 1, 2001 to December 31, 2003 were as follows:  
Contract  
settlement  
and lease  
costs  
Plant and  
equipment  
write downs  
Intangible  
asset  
impairments  
Workforce  
reduction  
Other  
Total  
Provision balance as of January 1, 2001  
Goodwill impairment  
Other special charges  
Cash drawdowns  
Non-cash drawdowns  
1,042  
34,419  
(34,372)  
661  
1,936  
(378)  
20,607  
1,703  
20,607  
74,772  
(34,926)  
(41,901)  
17,123  
(176)  
21,294  
(21,294)  
(20,607)  
Provision balance as of December 31, 2001  
1,089  
16,947  
2,219  
20,255  
Other special charges  
Cash drawdowns  
Non-cash drawdowns  
73,105  
(64,232)  
612  
(13,208)  
(1,925)  
9,294  
(9,294)  
416  
(1,677)  
83,427  
(79,117)  
(11,219)  
Provision balance as of December 31, 2002  
9,962  
2,426  
958  
13,346  
Other special charges  
Cash drawdowns  
Non-cash drawdowns  
19,133  
(24,399)  
4,382  
(2,310)  
776  
(776)  
272  
(1,200)  
24,563  
(27,909)  
(776)  
Provision balance as of December 31, 2003  
4,696  
4,498  
30  
9,224  
Regular full-time (“RFT”) employee notifications included in special charges were as follows:  
Employees (approximate)  
(b)  
(a)  
Direct  
Indirect  
Total  
RFT employee notifications by period:  
During 2001  
During 2002  
140  
41  
169  
170  
677  
24  
310  
718  
193  
During 2003  
RFT employee notifications as at December 31, 2003  
350  
871  
1221  
(a)  
(b)  
Direct employees included employees performing manufacturing, assembly, test and inspection activities associated with the production of Nortel Networks S.A.  
products.  
Indirect employees included employees performing manufacturing management, sales, marketing, research and development and administrative activities.  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Year ended December 31, 2003  
For the year ended December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. recorded total special charges of 24,563.  
Workforce reduction charges of 19,133 were related to severance and benefit costs associated with the approximately 193 employees  
notified of termination. During 2003, the workforce reduction provision balance was drawn down by cash payments of 24,399, resulting  
in an ending provision balance for workforce reduction of 4,696. The remaining provision is expected to be substantially drawn down  
by the end of 2004.  
Contract settlement and lease costs consisted of 4,382 for negotiated settlements to cancel or renegotiate contracts and net lease charges  
related to leased facilities that were identified as no longer required. During 2003, the provision balance for contract settlement and lease  
costs was drawn down by cash payments of 2,310 resulting in an ending balance of 4,498. The remaining provision, net of  
approximately 2,953 in estimated sublease income, is expected to be substantially drawn down by the end of 2008.  
Year ended December 31, 2002  
For the year ended December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks S.A. recorded total special charges of 83,427.  
Workforce reduction charges of 73,105 were related to severance and benefit costs associated with the approximately 718 employees  
notified of termination. During 2002, the workforce reduction provision balance was drawn down by cash payments of 64,232, resulting  
in an ending provision balance for workforce reduction of 9,962.  
Contract settlement and lease costs consisted of 612 negotiated settlements to cancel or renegotiate contracts and net lease charges  
related to leased facilities that were identified as no longer required. During 2002, the provision balance for contract settlement and lease  
costs was drawn down by cash payments of 13,208, resulting in an ending provision balance of 2,426.  
Plant and equipment write downs of approximately 9,294 related primarily to the write down to net realizable value of leasehold  
improvements and manufacturing equipment.  
Other consists primarily of contract settlement costs to either cancel or renegotiate existing supply contracts..  
Year ended December 31, 2001  
For the year ended December 31, 2001, Nortel Networks S.A. recorded total special charges of 95,379 related to streamlining its  
operations and activities.  
Workforce reduction charges of 34,419 were related to severance and benefit costs associated with the approximately 310 employees  
notified of termination. During 2001, the workforce reduction provision balance was drawn down by cash payments of 34,372, resulting  
in an ending provision balance for workforce reduction of 1,089.  
Contract settlement and lease costs of 17,123 consisted of 2,009 of negotiated settlements to cancel or renegotiate contracts and  
15,114 of net lease charges related to a number of operating leases no longer required. Lease costs represent Nortel Networks S.A.  
future contractual obligations under its applicable operating leases net of approximately 2,964 in expected sublease revenue on leases  
that Nortel Networks S.A. cannot terminate. During 2001, the provision balance for contract settlement and lease costs was drawn down  
by cash payments of 176, resulting in a provision balance of 16,947.  
Plant and equipment write downs of approximately 21,294 related primarily to the write down to net realizable value of leasehold  
improvements and manufacturing equipment in the Châteaudun facility.  
Other consisted primarily of contract settlement costs to either cancel or renegotiate existing supply contracts.  
Goodwill impairment charge of 20,607 related to the goodwill of Nortel Networks France.  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8. Income taxes  
The following is a reconciliation of income taxes, calculated at the French income tax rate, to the income tax benefit (expense) included  
in the consolidated statements of operations for the years ended December 31:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Income taxes at French rates  
(2003 - 35.4% 2002 - 35.4% 2001 - 36.4%)  
Research and development credit  
Foreign tax  
50,886  
6,104  
(485)  
74,647  
6,098  
(2,119)  
(77,259)  
139,325  
14,058  
(2,950)  
Change in valuation allowance  
(16,347)  
(138,796)  
(a)  
Other  
(34,544)  
5,614  
273  
22,436  
34,073  
Income tax benefit/(provision)  
1,640  
Income tax benefit/(provision)  
Current  
Deferred  
(490)  
6,104  
(2,270)  
3,910  
5,068  
29,005  
Income tax benefit/(provision)  
5,614  
1,640  
34,073  
(a)  
Other includes rate differential as well as permanent differences.  
The following table shows the significant components included in deferred income taxes as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Assets:  
Tax benefit of tax credits  
Tax benefit of losses  
Provisions and reserves  
24,398  
302,380  
12,710  
20,065  
333,946  
(40,719)  
339,488  
313,292  
Valuation allowance  
(263,894)  
(247,547)  
75,594  
28,084  
65,745  
22,477  
Liabilities:  
Plant and equipment  
Net deferred income tax assets  
47,510  
43,268  
The deferred income tax assets are all receivable in cash from the French government within the next 3 years as of December 31, 2003 or  
can be offset against taxes currently payable in that same period.  
As of December 31, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. had consolidated net operating loss carry forwards of approximately 747,359 which  
will carry forward indefinitely and net capital loss carryforwards of 73,997 which expire in 2006 to 2013.  
Nortel Networks S.A. and certain subsidiaries are currently subject to an examination by taxation authorities in France and have received  
a preliminary notice of proposed assessment for a material amount. No amount has been included in the provision for income taxes for  
this notice of proposed assessment as Nortel Networks S.A. believes that this proposed assessment is without merit. However, if this  
matter is ultimately resolved unfavourably, it could have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial position, results of  
operations, cash flows or tax carryforward attributes of Nortel Networks S.A.  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9. Acquisitions and divestitures  
Acquisitions  
Northern Telecom France  
On June 24, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. acquired the outstanding shares of Northern Telecom France from NNI for a purchase price of  
83,800 in cash. The purchase price has been presented as a decrease of 83,800 in the additional paid-in capital of Nortel Networks S.A.  
as Northern Telecom France has already been included in the financial statement presentation for all periods (see note 2). Northern  
Telecom France is a holding company that was then holding interests of 17.8% in Nortel Networks France and 13.2% in EADS Telecom.  
Nortel Networks France  
On October 19, 2002, Nortel Networks S.A., and certain other subsidiaries of Nortel Networks, entered into a number of conditional put  
option and call option agreements as well as a share exchange agreement with European Aeronautic Defence and Space Company EADS  
N.V. (“EADS”), Nortel Networks partner at that time in three European joint ventures. On July 1, 2003, EADS exercised its put option to  
sell its minority interest of 45 percent in Nortel Networks France to Nortel Networks S.A., which then immediately exercised its put  
option to sell this interest to Nortel Networks. The transactions were completed on September 18, 2003. As a result, the put option  
liability to EADS and the put option asset from Nortel Networks, both in the amount of 77,500, were removed from the balance sheet of  
Nortel Networks S.A. as of that date.  
On December 18, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. acquired the remaining interest in Nortel Networks France from Nortel Networks and  
NNIF&H B.V. for a purchase price of 39,375 (including 34,460 in cash) and 31,017 respectively. The acquisition of the remaining  
interest in the net assets of Nortel Networks France was recorded using their historical costs as recorded by Nortel Networks and  
NNIF&H B.V. The interest acquired from Nortel Networks was recorded in the accompanying financial statements on September 18,  
2003, the date the interest was acquired by Nortel Networks from EADS. This acquisition resulted in a reduction of minority interest of  
10,512 and recording of 9,180 related primarily to customer contracts and customer relationships (“customer related intangibles”) and  
19,683 of goodwill. The customer related intangibles will be amortized over their estimated useful lives averaging nine years. The  
purchase price relating to the interest acquired from NNIF&H B.V. has been presented as a decrease of 31,017 in additional paid-in  
capital of Nortel Networks S.A. as this interest in Nortel Networks France has already been included in the financial statement  
presentation for all periods (see note 2).  
Divestitures  
EADS Telecom  
On July 18, 2003, Nortel Networks and its subsidiaries exercised the call option and share exchange rights to acquire the minority interest  
held by EADS of 42 percent in Nortel Networks Germany GmbH & Co. KG (“NNG”) and to sell Nortel Networks equity interest of  
41 percent in EADS Telecom to EADS. These transactions were completed on September 18, 2003 along with the purchase of Nortel  
Networks France. Nortel Networks S.A. held an aggregate interest in EADS Telecom of 15 percent or 259,969 shares as of that date.  
During that period, Nortel Networks S.A. sold 215,170 shares of EADS Telecom to NNIF&H B.V. for 48,783. The resulting gain from  
this related party transaction of 35,648 has been recorded as additional paid-in capital. Nortel Networks S.A. also sold 44,799 shares of  
EADS Telecom directly to EADS for 10,157 in cash. As this transaction was part of a greater transaction between Nortel Networks S.A.  
affiliates and EADS, the resulting gain of 7,422 has also been recorded as paid in capital.  
On May 29, 2001, Nortel Networks France contributed certain of its enterprise activities to EADS Telecom in exchange for shares of  
EADS Telecom. The activities that were contributed were assessed to be approximately 8 percent of the value of Nortel Networks France  
before the contribution. The fair value of the net assets contributed to EADS Telecom was estimated to be 73,480. The contribution  
included the full ownership of five foreign subsidiaries of Nortel Networks France. The contribution was effective as of May 1, 2001. A  
gain of 14,262 was recorded on that transaction.  
Subsequent to the contribution, Nortel Networks France transferred the shares received from EADS Telecom in consideration for the  
contribution to its shareholders as an in-kind dividend.  
Matra Nortel Communication Distribution  
On September 30, 2001, Nortel Networks France sold 80.1% of its participation in its subsidiary, Matra Nortel Communication  
Distribution S.A.S. (“MNCD”), to third parties for 30,032 in cash. Cash has been collected in 2002 and 2001, respectively for 9,909  
and 20,123. MNCD was the main distribution channel of Nortel Networks France and EADS Telecom in France. A gain of 16,240 was  
recorded on that transaction.  
Following the sale of MNCD, Nortel Networks France subscribed on December 10, 2002 for 249,000 common shares of SPIE  
Communication (formerly MNCD) at par for an amount of 2,490. The additional subscription represented 15.33 percent of the share  
capital of SPIE Communication. 199,449 of the new shares of SPIE Communication subscribed by Nortel Networks France representing  
12.28 percent of the share capital of SPIE Communication were sold on the same day to third parties for nil. A loss of 1,995 was  
recorded on that transaction. Nortel Networks France had entered into the transaction as part of the commitment taken in favour of the  
purchasers of MNCD (see note 13).  
The remaining 3.05 percent interest of Nortel Networks France in SPIE Communication was sold on June 30, 2003 to third parties for an  
amount of 915 in cash. A gain of 610 was recorded on that transaction.  
Nortel Networks France also granted in the year ended December 31, 2002 a loan amounting to 9,146 to SPIE Communication. The  
loan was refunded in the year ended December 31, 2003.  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10. Related party transactions  
In the ordinary course of business, Nortel Networks S.A. engages in transactions with Nortel Networks and certain of Nortel Networks  
affiliates. These transactions are measured at their exchange amounts.  
Transactions with related parties for the years ended December 31 are summarized as follows:  
2003  
2002  
2001  
Billed to related parties  
Revenues  
Other income (expense) — net  
515,478  
19,572  
458,918  
43,741  
439,072  
58,389  
Billed from related parties  
Purchases  
Selling, general and administrative expense  
Research and development expense  
Interest expense  
127,327  
19,494  
16,536  
778  
230,763  
44,085  
22,722  
4,617  
424,816  
15,149  
18,105  
627  
Capital acquisitions  
Business transferred to related parties  
88  
15,365  
4,450  
33,755  
23,624  
21,905  
Issuance of common shares  
150,000  
485,363  
The following table shows the balance sheet position in respect of related parties as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Receivables from related parties  
Due from Nortel Networks Limited  
Due from affiliates  
109,388  
145,309  
152,892  
81,179  
Payables to related parties  
Due to Nortel Networks Limited  
Due to affiliates  
1,991  
30,011  
12,529  
76,797  
Long-term notes receivable from Nortel Networks Limited  
140,010  
Notes payable to related parties  
Current  
160  
Long-term  
70,000  
220,000  
Head office cost  
Nortel Networks S.A. was charged until December 31, 2001 by Nortel Networks for its share of head office costs incurred by Nortel  
Networks that are attributable to the activities of Nortel Networks S.A. These charges, which are included in selling, general and  
administrative expense, amounted to 4,017 in 2001.  
Global profit split  
Nortel Networks S.A. participates with Nortel Networks and certain of Nortel Networks S.A. affiliates in various agreements with respect  
to intercompany product sale and purchase transactions, including research and development costs. Prior to 2001, the pricing of  
intercompany transactions between Nortel Networks S.A. and certain of its affiliates was determined through the application of various  
methodologies intended to produce arm’s length results and pricing for Nortel Networks S.A. Nortel Networks S.A. also shared in global  
research and development costs based on the benefits derived from the research and development utilized in its geographic market.  
Effective January 1, 2001, the global research and development cost sharing methodology was replaced with a global profit split  
methodology based upon the historical research and development costs of the participants, and further intended to produce arm’s length  
results for Nortel Networks S.A. Under that methodology, Nortel Networks S.A. received a charge in 2001 of approximately 114,271, a  
credit of approximately 65,013 for 2002 and a charge of approximately 58,224 for 2003. These were all allocated to the cost of  
revenues.  
Other profit sharing agreements  
Nortel Networks S.A. has entered into certain agreements with a related party under which the profit or loss that the affiliate is recording  
on certain contracts with external customers is split on a defined basis between the affiliate and Nortel Networks S.A. The agreements are  
aimed to produce arm’s length results and pricing for Nortel Networks S.A. and remunerate the know-how that Nortel Networks S.A. is  
sharing with the affiliate.  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In accordance with these agreements Nortel Networks S.A. recorded related party revenues of approximately 35,903, 3,000, and  
28,963 in the years 2003, 2002, and 2001 respectively. No cost of revenues to related parties are directly linked to these transactions.  
Representative activity  
Nortel Networks France is acting as the representative of certain of its affiliates in certain transactions with a French based customer. The  
benefit of these transactions is not retained by Nortel Networks France and is transferred back to the affiliates having actually performed  
the transaction. No revenue is recognized by Nortel Networks France on these transactions. The amounts billed to Nortel Networks  
France under these agreements were 15,365, 33,755 and 21,905 for 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Royalties  
Nortel Networks France pays royalties amounting to seven percent of its revenue to certain of its affiliates in remuneration for the right to  
market Nortel Networks products in the French market. The amounts billed to Nortel Networks France under these agreements were  
6,527, 9,997 and 21,694 for 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
Sale of investment  
Through a series of complex transactions taking place from July 2003 to September 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. sold the interest it was  
holding in EADS Telecom to NNIF&H B.V. and EADS. As these transactions were part of a greater transaction between Nortel  
Networks S.A.’s affiliates and EADS the resulting gain of 43,070 has been recorded as paid in capital (see note 9).  
Financing transactions  
On December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks provided Nortel Networks S.A. with a subordinated loan in the aggregate amount of 200,000.  
This loan is classified as a long-term note payable to a related party. The repayment of the loan, in case of bankruptcy, insolvency or  
liquidation, is subordinated to the prior repayment of any of Nortel Networks S.A. existing or future secured and unsecured creditors.  
Nortel Networks S.A. may repay the whole or any part of the outstanding amount of the loan subject to notifying Nortel Networks in  
advance of its irrevocable decision to make the repayment. The loan bears interest at a rate per annum equal to Euribor rate plus one  
percent (3.1 percent at December 31, 2003). Interest is payable at the end of each interest period, subject to Nortel Networks S.A. having  
positive net earnings and the interest payments not exceeding 40 percent of the positive net earnings. The amount outstanding under that  
loan as of December 31, 2003 and 2002 was 50,000 and 200.000, respectively. The loan is payable upon the discretion of Nortel  
Networks S.A. and has been classified as long-term in the accompanying balance sheet as management does not intend on repayment  
prior to January 1, 2005.  
On December 19, 2002, Nortel Networks S.A. provided Nortel Networks with a revolving loan in the amount of 200,000. This loan is  
classified as a long-term note receivable to a related party. The loan bears interest at a rate per annum equal to Euribor plus one percent.  
Interest is accrued and due unless an amount larger than the outstanding amount of advances is outstanding under the subordinated loan.  
The term of the loan is two year and can be accelerated at the request of Nortel Networks S.A. The amount outstanding under that loan as  
of December 31, 2003 and 2002 was 48,573 and 140,010 respectively.  
At December 31, 2001, Nortel Networks S.A. had a revolving note payable with an affiliated company in the amount of 106,048. This  
payable was settled in full in 2002.  
On December 31, 2002, Nortel Networks provided Nortel Networks France with a subordinated loan in the aggregate amount of 20,000.  
This loan is classified as a long-term note payable to a related party. This loan is included in the balance due to related parties for Nortel  
Networks S.A. as of December 31, 2003, as a result of the acquisition of Nortel Networks France (see note 9). The repayment of the loan,  
in case of bankruptcy, insolvency or liquidation, is subordinated to the prior repayment of any of Nortel Networks France’s existing or  
future secured and unsecured creditors. Nortel Networks France may repay the whole or any part of the outstanding amount of the loan  
subject to notifying Nortel Networks in advance of its irrevocable decision to make the repayment. The loan bears interest at a rate per  
annum equal to Euribor plus one percent (3.1 percent at December 31, 2003). Interest is payable at the end of each interest period, subject  
to Nortel Networks France having positive net earnings and the interest payments not exceeding 40 percent of the positive net earnings.  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11. Financial instruments  
Share pledge  
The security agreements that were entered into in connection with the December 2001 364-day syndicated credit facilities of Nortel  
Networks and its subsidiary, NNI , provided for the granting of security in the event that Nortel Networks debt ratings fell below  
investment grade. As of December 31, 2003, the security included pledges by Nortel Networks and NNIF&H B.V. of their shares of  
Nortel Networks S.A. (see note 16).  
The security became effective in the second quarter of 2002, following the downgrade by Moody’s Investors Services, Inc. (“Moody’s”)  
of Nortel Networks senior long-term debt to below investment grade. At that time, the security became effective in respect of the  
December 2001 364-day syndicated credit facilities, which have since expired, as well as any other credit facilities and public debt  
securities of Nortel Networks which, by their terms, required that the security also apply to them. This included: the April 2002 364-day  
revolving credit facilities of Nortel Networks and NNI, which were terminated in the fourth quarter of 2002; the April 2000 five year  
syndicated credit facilities of Nortel Networks and NNI, which were terminated in the second quarter of 2004 (the “Five Year  
Facilities”); Nortel Networks consolidated outstanding public debt securities; and Nortel Networks guarantee of NNC’s 4.25%  
Convertible Senior Notes due September 1, 2008.  
On February 14, 2003, Nortel Networks entered into an agreement with Export Development Canada (“EDC”) regarding arrangements to  
provide for support, on a secured basis, of certain performance related obligations arising out of normal course business activities for the  
benefit of Nortel Networks (the “EDC Support Facility”). On February 14, 2003, Nortel Networks obligations under the EDC Support  
Facility became secured on an equal and ratable basis under the security agreements with the banks under the Five Year Facilities and the  
public debt holders.  
If Nortel Networks senior long-term debt rating by Moody’s returns to Baa2 (with a stable outlook) and its rating by Standard & Poor’s  
returns to BBB (with a stable outlook), the security will be released in full. If both the Five Year Facilities and the EDC Support Facilities  
are terminated, or expire, the security and guarantees will also be released in full (see note 16). Nortel Networks may provide EDC with  
cash collateral in an amount equal to the total amount of its outstanding obligations and undrawn commitments and expenses under the  
EDC Support Facility (or any other alternative collateral or arrangements acceptable to EDC) in lieu of the security provided under the  
security agreements. Accordingly, if the EDC Support Facility is secured by cash or other alternate collateral or arrangements acceptable  
to EDC and if the Five Year Facilities are terminated or expire, the security and guarantees will also be released in full for additional  
information related to the security agreements, the termination of the pledges of the Five Year Facilities subsequent to December 31,  
2003 (and the resulting termination by Nortel Networks and NNIF&H B.V. of their shares in Nortel Networks S.A., see note 16).  
Receivables sales  
In 2002 and 2001, Nortel Networks S.A. entered into various agreements to sell certain of its receivables. These receivables were sold at  
a discount of 463 and 2,884 from book value for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively, at annualized discount  
rates of approximately 3 percent to 4.5 percent and 5 percent to 6 percent for the years ended December 31, 2002 and 2001, respectively.  
These programs were discontinued in 2002.  
12. Guarantees  
Nortel Networks S.A. has entered into agreements that contain features which meet the definition of a guarantee under FIN 45. FIN 45  
defines a guarantee as a contract that contingently requires Nortel Networks S.A. to make payments (either in cash, financial instruments,  
other assets, or through the provision of services) to a third party based on changes in an underlying economic characteristic (such as  
interest rates or market value) that is related to an asset, a liability or an equity security of the guaranteed party or a third party’s failure to  
perform under a specified agreement. A description of the major types of Nortel Networks S.A. outstanding guarantees as of  
December 31, 2003 is provided below.  
Nortel Networks S.A. has entered into an agreement to indemnify a certain lessor, through the term of the lease, which expires in  
May 2013, against costs incurred as a result of changes in laws and regulations (including tax legislation) or in the interpretations of such  
laws and regulations and/or as a result of losses from litigation that may be suffered by them or if the transaction becomes invalid. The  
maximum amount that Nortel Networks may be required to pay if the transaction becomes invalid is approximately 76,457. The lease  
pursuant to which the guarantee was provided is a capital lease and this liability is, therefore, part of the debt of Nortel Networks S.A.  
The maximum potential losses resulting from the other types of lease guarantees cannot be reasonably estimated. The difficulties in  
assessing the amount of liability result primarily from the unpredictability of the triggering events of the  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
guarantees and the lack of limitations on the potential liability. Historically, Nortel Networks S.A. has not made any significant  
indemnification payments under such agreements and no amount has been accrued in the accompanying consolidated financial statements  
with respect to these indemnification guarantees.  
Other indemnification agreements  
Nortel Networks S.A. has also entered into other agreements that provide indemnifications to counterparties in certain transactions  
including investment banking agreements and asset sale agreements. These indemnification agreements generally require Nortel  
Networks S.A. to indemnify the counterparties for costs incurred as a result of changes in laws and regulations (including tax legislation)  
or in the interpretations of such laws and regulations and/or as a result of losses from litigation that may be suffered by the counterparties  
arising from the transactions. These types of indemnification agreements normally extend over an unspecified period of time from the  
date of the transaction and do not typically provide for any limit on the maximum potential payment amount.  
The nature of such agreements prevents Nortel Networks S.A. from making a reasonable estimate of the maximum potential amount it  
could be required to pay to its counterparties. The difficulties in assessing the amount of liability result primarily from the  
unpredictability of future changes in laws, the inability to determine how laws apply to counterparties and the lack of limitations on the  
potential liability.  
Historically, Nortel Networks S.A. has not made any significant indemnification payments under such agreements and no significant  
liability has been accrued in the consolidated financial statements with respect to the obligations associated with these guarantees.  
Product warranties  
The following summarizes the accrual for product warranties that was recorded as part of other accrued liabilities in the consolidated  
balance sheets as of December 31:  
2003  
2002  
Balance at beginning of the year  
Payments  
Warranties issued  
14,311  
(37,697)  
34,537  
31,223  
(43,092)  
26,180  
Balance at the end of the year  
11,151  
14,311  
13. Commitments  
Bid, performance related and other bonds  
Nortel Networks S.A. has entered into bid, performance related and other bonds associated with various contracts. Bid bonds generally  
have a term of less than twelve months, depending on the length of the bid period for the applicable contract. Performance related and  
other bonds generally have a term of twelve months and are typically renewed, as required, over the term of the applicable contract. The  
various contracts to which these bonds apply generally have terms ranging from two to five years. Any potential payments which might  
become due under these bonds would be related to Nortel Networks S.A. non-performance under the applicable contract. Historically,  
Nortel Networks S.A. has not had to make material payments under these types of bonds and does not anticipate that any material  
payments will be required in the future. The total amount of the bonds that were available and undrawn was 31,719, as of December 31,  
2003, 31,674, as of December 31, 2002 and 29,398 as of December 31, 2001.  
Joint ventures/minority interests/disposed business  
Nortel Networks France entered into an agreement on December 31, 1997 under which Financière Matra Communication (“Fimacom”)  
(a subsidiary of Nortel Networks France) was sold to a third party. Fimacom’s business was to finance Nortel Networks France’s  
customers and certain volume commitments were undertaken by Nortel Networks France to the purchaser for the following ten years.  
Through December 31, 2003, the cumulative actual volumes realized by the purchaser are above the commitments of Nortel Networks  
France but, because the commitments are larger each year and the business has been shrinking for the last three years, it is probable that  
the targeted cumulative volumes for 2004 and the following years will not be met. Depending on the actual volume booked by the  
purchaser in 2004, Nortel Networks France could be obliged to pay up to a maximum of 6,629 to the purchaser as a result of the  
transaction (in 2004 or in any subsequent year until December 31, 2007). In this regard, an amount of 5,055 was accrued during 2003,  
the related liability is included within “Other liabilities”.  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On September 30, 2001, Nortel Networks France sold its subsidiary MNCD to a third party. Under this transaction, Nortel Networks  
France has taken certain commitments relative to the amount of the net assets of MNCD as of September 30, 2001. Nortel Networks  
France has already had to make several payments under this commitment. An amount of 2,226 was accrued and is included in “Other  
accrued liabilities”. Further costs could be incurred in relation to this transaction that cannot be reasonably estimated at this time.  
Operating leases and other commitments  
As of December 31, 2003, the future minimum payments under both operating leases and outsourcing contracts consisted of:  
Operating  
leases*  
Outsourcing  
contracts*  
2004  
2005  
2006  
2007  
2008  
Thereafter  
6,796  
2,805  
2,502  
291  
18,887  
17,483  
17,260  
17,049  
16,843  
16,646  
Total future minimum payments  
12,394  
104,168  
*
All figures exclude value added taxes.  
Rental expense on operating leases for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001 amounted to 7,928, 27,441 and 31,960,  
respectively.  
Expenses related to outsourcing contracts for the years ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001 amounted to 15,614, 23,341 and  
16,026, respectively, and were for services provided to Nortel Networks S.A. primarily related to a portion of information services,  
accounts payable and purchasing. The amount payable under Nortel Networks S.A. outsourcing contracts is variable to the extent that  
Nortel Networks S.A. workforce fluctuates from the baseline levels contained in the contracts. The table above shows the minimum  
commitment contained in the outsourcing contracts.  
14. Shareholders’ equity  
On December 30, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. issued 30,000,000 common shares to Nortel Networks for proceeds of 150,000, which  
was comprised of a conversion of the subordinated loan granted by Nortel Networks (see note 10).  
On December 18, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. purchased the outstanding shares of Nortel Networks France under the control of  
NNIF&H B.V. (see note 9). As a result of the acquisition of these shares the additional paid-in capital of Nortel Networks S.A. was  
decreased by 31,017.  
On July 18, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. sold the shares of EADS Telecom that it was then holding to NNIF&H B.V. and EADS (see note  
9). A gain of 43,070 was recorded on that related party transaction that was recorded as additional paid-in capital.  
On June 24, 2003, Nortel Networks S.A. purchased the outstanding shares of Northern Telecom France (see note 9). As a result of the  
acquisition of these shares the additional paid in capital of Nortel Networks S.A. was decreased by 83,800.  
On December 16, 2002 Nortel Networks S.A. issued 40,872,534 common shares to Nortel Networks for net cash proceeds of 204,363.  
On May 21, 2002, Nortel Networks S.A. issued 11,677,519 common shares to Nortel Networks and 6,451,612 shares to NNIF&H B.V.  
for net proceeds of 281,000, which was comprised of a conversion of long-term notes payable.  
On May 21, 2002 Nortel Networks S.A. Board of Directors approved a reorganization of Nortel Networks S.A. capital accounts that  
resulted in the reduction of accumulated deficit of 372,755, the reduction of additional paid-in capital of 158,174 and the reduction of  
common shares of 214,581.  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On June 30, 2001 the shareholders meeting of Nortel Networks France approved a dividend payment of 61,812 payable in EADS  
Telecom shares that resulted in the reduction of retained earnings of 21,912 and minority interest of 27,816. An amount of 12,084  
was paid to other companies pooled by Nortel Networks S.A.  
On June 25, 2001 the shareholders meeting of Nortel Networks France approved a dividend payment of 35,275 payable in cash that  
resulted in the reduction of retained earnings of 13,861, and the reduction of minority interest of 15,874. An amount of 5,540 was  
paid to other companies pooled by Nortel Networks S.A.  
15. Stock-based compensation plans  
Stock options  
Nortel Networks Corporation grants options to purchase Nortel Networks Corporation common shares under two existing stock option  
plans, Nortel Networks Corporation 2000 Stock Option Plan (the “2000 Plan”) and Nortel Networks Corporation 1986 Stock Option Plan  
As Amended and Restated (the “1986 Plan”). Under these two plans, options to purchase Nortel Networks Corporation common shares  
may be granted to employees, and under the 2000 Plan, options may be granted to directors of Nortel Networks that entitle the holders to  
purchase one common share at a subscription price of not less than 100 percent of market value on the effective date of the grant.  
Subscription prices are stated and payable in U.S. dollars for U.S. options and in Canadian dollars for Canadian options. Generally  
options granted prior to 2003 vest 33 1/3 percent on the anniversary date of the grant for three years. Options granted in 2003 generally  
vest 25 percent each year over a four year period on the anniversary date of the grant. The committee of the Board of Directors of Nortel  
Networks that administers both plans has the discretion to vary the period during which the holder has the right to exercise options and, in  
certain circumstances, may accelerate the right of the holder to exercise options, but in no case shall the exercise period exceed ten years.  
Options granted under the 2000 Plan and 1986 Plan may be granted with or without a SAR. A SAR entitles the holder to receive payment  
of an amount equivalent to the excess of the market value of a common share at the time of exercise of the SAR over the subscription  
price of the common share to which the option relates. Options with SARs may be granted on a cancellation basis, in which case the  
exercise of one causes the cancellation of the other, or on a simultaneous basis, in which case the exercise of one causes the exercise of  
the other.  
As of December 31, 2003, the maximum number of common shares authorized by the shareholders and reserved for issuance by the  
Board of Directors of Nortel Networks Corporation under the 1986 Plan and 2000 Plan is as follows:  
(number of common shares in thousands)  
Maximum  
(a)  
1986 Plan  
(b)  
Issuable to employees  
469,718  
(a)  
2000 Plan  
Issuable to non-employee directors  
Issuable to employees  
500  
94,000  
(a)  
In January 1995, a key contributor stock option program (the “Key Contributor Program”) was established. Under the terms of the Key Contributor Program,  
participants are granted an equal number of initial options and replacement options. The initial options generally vest after five years and expire after ten years. The  
replacement options are granted concurrently with the initial options and also expire after ten years. No Key Contributor Program options were granted for the years  
ended December 31, 2003, 2002 and 2001, respectively, under both stock option plans.  
(b)  
As of December 31, 2003, the maximum number of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares with respect to which options may be granted in any given year  
under the 1986 Plan is three percent of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares issued and outstanding at the commencement of the year, subject to certain  
adjustments.  
Nortel Networks S.A. assumed stock options plans in connection with the acquisition of various companies and granted options to  
purchase Nortel Networks Corporation common shares. The vesting periods for these assumed plans may differ from the 2000 Plan and  
1986 Plan, but are not considered to be significant to Nortel Networks overall use of stock-based compensation.  
On June 20, 2001, NNC commenced a voluntary stock option exchange program (the “Exchange Program”) for Nortel Networks S.A.  
employees allowing employees to exchange certain outstanding stock options for new stock options, based on a prescribed formula. The  
terms of the Exchange Program required that the new grants of options would be made at least six months and a day from the cancellation  
date of the options tendered for exchange, which was July 27, 2001. Nortel Networks Corporation then Board of Directors and its then  
board appointed officers were not eligible to participate in the Exchange Program.  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The following is a summary of the total number of outstanding stock options issued to employees of Nortel Networks S.A.:  
Outstanding  
Weighted  
options average exercise  
(thousands)  
price (U.S.$)  
Balance at December 31, 2000  
Granted options under all stock option plans  
Options exercised  
Options cancelled  
Options cancelled under stock option exchange program  
6,976  
1,320  
(157)  
(1,086)  
(3,604)  
$
$
$
$
38.10  
30.36  
8.91  
47.84  
51.43  
(a)  
$
Balance at December 31, 2001  
Granted options under all stock option plans  
Options exercised  
Options cancelled  
3,449  
5,556  
$
19.47  
6.39  
(a)  
$
$
$
(1,312)  
13.56  
Balance at December 31, 2002  
7,693  
(681)  
227  
4,247  
(4)  
$
$
$
$
$
$
11.03  
9.77  
10.21  
2.37  
2.89  
Eligible employees transferred out of Nortel Networks S.A.  
Eligible employees transferred in Nortel Networks S.A.  
Granted options under all stock option plans  
Options exercised  
Options cancelled  
(843)  
11.40  
Balance at December 31, 2003  
10,639  
$
7.70  
(a)  
Approximately 3,604 stock options were tendered for exchange and cancelled. On January 29, 2002, Nortel Networks granted approximately 2,264 new stock  
options in connection with the Exchange Program with exercise prices in the range of U.S.$7.16 to U.S.$7.39 per common share.  
The following table summarizes information about stock options outstanding as of December 31, 2003:  
Options outstanding  
Weighted  
Options exercisable  
average  
Remaining  
Weighted  
average  
exercise  
Weighted  
Number  
outstanding  
(thousands)  
Number  
exercisable  
(thousands)  
average  
exercise  
contractual  
life (in years)  
Range of exercise prices  
price (U.S.$)  
price (U.S.$)  
U.S.$1.0600 — U.S.$2.3900  
U.S.$2.3901 — U.S.$3.5852  
U.S.$3.5853 — U.S.$5.3779  
U.S.$5.3780 — U.S.$8.0670  
U.S.$8.0671 — U.S.$12.1006  
U.S.$12.1007 — U.S.$18.1510  
U.S.$18.1511 — U.S.$27.2267  
U.S.$27.2268 — U.S.$40.8402  
U.S.$40.8403 — U.S.$61.2605  
U.S.$61.2606 — U.S.$84.6834  
4,001  
304  
96  
9.1  
9.1  
1.9  
$
$
$
2.34  
2.58  
4.50  
38  
4
85  
$
$
$
1.96  
3.34  
4.52  
(a)  
4,006  
7.4  
$
6.44  
2,182  
$
6.77  
(a)  
933  
130  
914  
98  
68  
89  
4.6  
4.8  
5.8  
6.6  
6.3  
6.2  
$
$
$
$
$
$
9.51  
15.31  
23.21  
34.30  
50.47  
74.41  
870  
130  
884  
74  
69  
89  
$
$
$
$
$
$
9.61  
15.31  
23.35  
33.99  
50.47  
74.41  
10,639  
7.6  
$
7.70  
4,425  
$
13.30  
(a)  
Includes approximately 1,591 stock options granted on January 29, 2002 under the Exchange Program.  
Employee stock purchase plans  
Nortel Networks has ESPPs (including in France) to facilitate the acquisition of common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation at a  
discount and the retention of such common shares by eligible employees. The ESPPs have four offering periods each year, with each  
offering period beginning on the first day of each calendar quarter. Eligible  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
employees may have up to 10 percent of their eligible compensation deducted from their pay during each offering period to contribute  
towards the purchase of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares. The Nortel Networks Corporation common shares are purchased  
by an independent broker through the facilities of the TSX and/or NYSE, and held by a custodian on behalf of the plan participants.  
For non-North American eligible employees, common shares are purchased at a purchase price equal to the greater of:  
(i) 85 percent of the average of the high and low prices of common shares on the first trading day of the offering period; and  
(ii) 71.5 percent of the market price of the common shares on the last trading day of the offering period; or  
(iii) if the market price on the last trading day is equal to or less than the average of the high and low on the first trading day, the  
purchase price shall be 85 percent of the market price on the last trading day of the offering period.  
Nortel Networks Company Savings Plan  
Eligible employees of Nortel Networks S.A. and other direct or indirect subsidiaries of Nortel Networks in France, including joint  
ventures in which Nortel Networks holds an interest of greater than 50% as of October 30, 2002, may elect to participate in the Nortel  
Networks Company Savings Plan (the “PEE”) instead of the ESPP in France. Under the PEE, which is a collective savings scheme  
governed by French labor law, participants hold units of a Nortel Networks collective investment fund of which approximately 60% is  
invested mainly in common shares of Nortel Networks Corporation, and the remainder in liquid assets. Participants may make voluntary  
contributions up to 10% of their eligible gross earnings, and the employer contributes an amount equal to 25% of each participant’s  
contributions, up to certain maximum amounts per participant per year. The employer contributions are subject to welfare surtaxes but  
exempt from social security charges and income tax in France. The common shares are purchased on a monthly basis by the plan  
custodian, through the facilities of the New York Stock Exchange.  
16. Subsequent events  
Nortel Networks Audit Committee Independent Review; restatements; related matters  
As previously announced by NNC in October 2003, in late October 2003 the Audit Committee initiated the Independent Review of the  
facts and circumstances leading to the First Restatement and engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection with the Independent Review.  
On March 10, 2004, NNC announced that as a result of the work done to date in connection with the Independent Review, it was re-  
examining the establishment, timing of, support for and release to income of certain accruals and provisions in prior periods. Further, it  
was likely that NNC and Nortel Networks would need to revise its previously announced unaudited results for the year ended  
December 31, 2003, and the results reported in certain of its quarterly reports for 2003, and to restate its previously filed financial results  
for one or more earlier periods. NNC announced on March 15, 2004 that the filing of NNC and Nortel Networks annual reports on Form  
10-K for the year ended December 31, 2003 (the “2003 Annual Reports”) would be delayed beyond March 30, 2004.  
On April 5, 2004, NNC announced that the SEC had issued a formal order of investigation in connection with NNC’s previous  
restatement of its financial results for certain periods, as announced in October 2003, and NNC’s announcements in March 2004  
regarding the likely need to revise certain previously announced results and restate previously filed financial results for one or more  
earlier periods. The matter had been the subject of an informal SEC inquiry. On April 13, 2004, NNC announced that it had received a  
letter from the staff of the Ontario Securities Commission (“OSC”) advising that there is an OSC Enforcement Staff investigation into the  
same matters that are the subject of the SEC investigation.  
On April 28, 2004, NNC announced that the Independent Review was extended to include the second half of 2003 and it was determined  
that the previously announced unaudited results for the year ended December 31, 2003 needed to be revised and that the financial results  
reported in each of NNC’s and Nortel Networks quarterly periods of 2003 and for earlier periods including 2002 and 2001 needed to be  
restated. NNC announced that it and Nortel Networks were not expected to timely file their first quarter 2004 financial statements and, in  
accordance with Canadian securities regulations, their 2003 Canadian GAAP audited financial statements and Annual Information Form.  
In April 2004, NNC terminated for cause its former president and chief executive officer, former chief financial officer and former  
controller and, in August 2004, seven additional senior finance employees with significant responsibilities for NNC financial reporting as  
a whole or for their respective business units and geographic regions in August 2004.  
On May 14, 2004, NNC announced that it had received a Federal Grand Jury Subpoena for the production of certain documents,  
including financial statements and corporate, personnel and accounting records, prepared during the period from January 1, 2000 to the  
date of the subpoena. The materials sought are pertinent to an ongoing criminal investigation being conducted by the U.S. Attorney’s  
Office for the Northern District of Texas, Dallas Division.  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
On May 17, 2004, NNC announced that the OSC had issued a temporary order that prohibits all trading by directors, officers and certain  
current and former employees in the securities of Nortel Networks and NNC, which temporary order was replaced with a final order  
issued on May 31, 2004. The final order remains in effect until two full business days following the receipt by the OSC of all filings  
required to be made by Nortel Networks and NNC pursuant to Ontario securities laws.  
On June 29, 2004, NNC announced that it did not expect to timely file financial statements for the second quarter of 2004 and related  
periodic reports in accordance with U.S. and Canadian securities laws.  
On August 16, 2004, NNC received a letter from the Integrated Market Enforcement Team of the Royal Canadian Mounted Police  
(“RCMP”) advising NNC that the RCMP would be commencing a criminal investigation into NNC’s financial accounting situation.  
On August 19, 2004, NNC announced a new streamlined organizational structure, effective October 1, 2004, that involved, among other  
things, combining the businesses of NNC’s four segments into two business organizations: (i) Carrier Networks and Global Operations,  
and (ii) Enterprise Networks. Further, a focused workforce reduction of approximately 3,250 employees was announced. In addition, the  
Audit Committee anticipated that there would be work done, in addition to that portion of the inquiry which affects Nortel Networks and  
NNC’s ability to finalize their 2003 audited financial statements, in connection with its Independent Review, on remedial measures,  
internal controls and improvements to processes.  
On October 27, 2004, NNC announced that Nortel Networks and NNC did not expect to file their third quarter 2004 financial statements,  
and the related periodic reports, by the required deadlines in November 2004 in compliance with certain U.S. and Canadian securities  
regulations.  
Subsequent to the March 10, 2004 announcement, numerous class action complaints, including ERISA class action complaints, have  
been filed against Nortel Networks and NNC in the U.S. and Canada. In addition, a derivative action complaint has been filed against  
NNC. Nortel Networks and NNC are subject to significant pending civil litigation which, if decided against Nortel Networks and NNC,  
could result in substantial damages or other penalties which, in turn, could have a material adverse effect on the business, results of  
operations, financial condition and liquidity of Nortel Networks.  
In January 2005, the Audit Committee reported the findings of the Independent Review, together with its recommendations for governing  
principles for remedial measures that were developed for the Audit Committee by WCPHD. Each of NNC and Nortel Networks’ Boards  
of Directors has adopted those recommendations in their entirety and directed management to develop a detailed plan and timetable for  
their implementation, and will monitor their implementation.  
Also in January 2005, the Audit Committee determined to review the facts and circumstances leading to the restatement of certain  
revenues for specific transactions identified in the Second Restatement. This review will have a particular emphasis on the underlying  
conduct that led to the initial recognition of these revenues. The Audit Committee will develop any appropriate additional remedial  
measures, and has engaged WCPHD to advise it in connection with such review.  
Security agreements  
On April 28 2004, Nortel Networks notified the lenders under the Five Year Facilities that it was terminating the Five Year Facilities. As  
a result of the termination of the Five Year Facilities, certain foreign security agreements entered into by Nortel Networks and various of  
its subsidiaries, including the pledges by Nortel Networks and NNIF&H B.V. of their shares in Nortel Networks S.A, also terminated in  
accordance with their terms.  
Stock-based compensation plans  
As a result of Nortel Networks March 10, 2004 announcement, as described above under “Nortel Networks Audit Committee  
Independent Review; restatements; related matters”, Nortel Networks suspended as of March 10, 2004: the purchase of Nortel Networks  
Corporation common shares under the ESPPs; the exercise of outstanding options granted under the 2000 Plan or 1986 Plan, or the grant  
of any additional options under those plans, or the exercise of outstanding options granted under employee stock option plans previously  
assumed by Nortel Networks in connection with mergers and acquisitions; and the purchase of units in a Nortel Networks stock fund or  
purchase of Nortel Networks Corporation common shares under Nortel Networks defined contribution and investments plans, until such  
time that Nortel Networks is in compliance with U.S. and Canadian regulatory securities filing requirements.  
Evolution of Nortel Networks supply chain strategy  
On June 29, 2004, Nortel Networks announced an agreement with Flextronics International Ltd. (“Flextronics”), regarding the divestiture  
of substantially all of Nortel Networks remaining manufacturing operations, including product integration, testing and repair operations  
carried out in Nortel Networks Systems Houses in Calgary and Montreal, Canada and Campinas, Brazil, as well as certain activities  
related to these locations, including the management of the supply chain, related suppliers, and third-party logistics. In Europe,  
Flextronics has made an offer  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
to purchase similar operations at the Nortel Networks Monkstown, Northern Ireland and Chateaudun, France Systems Houses, subject to  
the completion of the required information and consultation process. The Chateaudun System House is a property of Nortel Networks  
S.A.  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SIGNATURES  
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report  
to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Brampton, Ontario, Canada on the 10th day of  
January, 2005.  
NORTEL NETWORKS CORPORATION  
By:  
/s/ WILLIAM A. OWENS  
(William A. Owens, President and  
Chief Executive Officer)  
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on  
behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated on the 10th day of January, 2005.  
Signature  
Title  
Principal Executive Officer  
/s/ WILLIAM A. OWENS  
President and Chief Executive Officer, and a  
Director  
(WILLIAM A. OWENS)  
Principal Financial Officer  
/s/ WILLIAM R. KERR  
(WILLIAM R. KERR)  
Chief Financial Officer  
Principal Accounting Officer  
/s/ MARYANNE E. PAHAPILL  
Controller  
(MARYANNE E. PAHAPILL)  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Directors  
M. BISCHOFF*  
R.A. INGRAM*  
(M. BISCHOFF)  
(R.A. INGRAM)  
J.J. BLANCHARD*  
J. MANLEY*  
(J.J. BLANCHARD)  
(J. MANLEY)  
R.E. BROWN*  
W.A. OWENS*  
(R.E. BROWN)  
(W.A. OWENS)  
J.E. CLEGHORN  
*
G. SAUCIER*  
(J.E. CLEGHORN)  
(G. SAUCIER)  
L.Y. FORTIER*  
S.H. SMITH, JR.*  
(L.Y. FORTIER)  
(S.H. SMITH, JR.)  
L.R. WILSON*  
(L.R. WILSON)  
/s/ GORDON A. DAVIES  
By:*  
224  
(GORDON A. DAVIES, as attorney-in fact)  
January 10, 2005  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Q See Security Camera QC444 403 User Guide
Quadra Fire Indoor Fireplace QVI 30FB User Guide
RCA CRT Television F27450, F32444, F32450, F36444, F36450 User Guide
Renesas Switch M38D59T RLFS User Guide
Riccar Sewing Machine R552 User Guide
Saeco Coffee Makers Espresso Maker TALEARINGPLUS User Guide
Sakar Digital Camera 92045 User Guide
Samsung DVR SMT 190Dx User Guide
Sanyo CRT Television AVM 3651G User Guide
Sears Fitness Equipment 83128782 User Guide